calc.texi (Logarithmic Units): New section
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / calc.texi
CommitLineData
4009494e
GM
1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2@comment %**start of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
3@c smallbook
db78a8cb 4@setfilename ../../info/calc
4009494e 5@c [title]
5a83c46e 6@settitle GNU Emacs Calc Manual
4009494e
GM
7@setchapternewpage odd
8@comment %**end of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
9
8289f37b 10@include emacsver.texi
9f534a47 11
4009494e
GM
12@c The following macros are used for conditional output for single lines.
13@c @texline foo
14@c `foo' will appear only in TeX output
15@c @infoline foo
16@c `foo' will appear only in non-TeX output
17
18@c @expr{expr} will typeset an expression;
19@c $x$ in TeX, @samp{x} otherwise.
20
21@iftex
22@macro texline
23@end macro
24@alias infoline=comment
25@alias expr=math
26@alias tfn=code
27@alias mathit=expr
8dc6104d 28@alias summarykey=key
4009494e
GM
29@macro cpi{}
30@math{@pi{}}
31@end macro
32@macro cpiover{den}
33@math{@pi/\den\}
34@end macro
35@end iftex
36
37@ifnottex
38@alias texline=comment
39@macro infoline{stuff}
40\stuff\
41@end macro
42@alias expr=samp
43@alias tfn=t
44@alias mathit=i
8dc6104d
JB
45@macro summarykey{ky}
46\ky\
47@end macro
4009494e
GM
48@macro cpi{}
49@expr{pi}
50@end macro
51@macro cpiover{den}
52@expr{pi/\den\}
53@end macro
54@end ifnottex
55
56
57@tex
58% Suggested by Karl Berry <karl@@freefriends.org>
59\gdef\!{\mskip-\thinmuskip}
60@end tex
61
62@c Fix some other things specifically for this manual.
63@iftex
64@finalout
65@mathcode`@:=`@: @c Make Calc fractions come out right in math mode
66@tex
67\gdef\coloneq{\mathrel{\mathord:\mathord=}}
68
69\gdef\beforedisplay{\vskip-10pt}
70\gdef\afterdisplay{\vskip-5pt}
71\gdef\beforedisplayh{\vskip-25pt}
72\gdef\afterdisplayh{\vskip-10pt}
73@end tex
74@newdimen@kyvpos @kyvpos=0pt
75@newdimen@kyhpos @kyhpos=0pt
76@newcount@calcclubpenalty @calcclubpenalty=1000
77@ignore
78@newcount@calcpageno
79@newtoks@calcoldeverypar @calcoldeverypar=@everypar
80@everypar={@calceverypar@the@calcoldeverypar}
4009494e
GM
81@ifx@ninett@undefinedzzz@font@ninett=cmtt9@fi
82@catcode`@\=0 \catcode`\@=11
83\r@ggedbottomtrue
84\catcode`\@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
85@end ignore
86@end iftex
87
88@copying
5a83c46e 89@ifinfo
4009494e 90This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator.
5a83c46e
JB
91@end ifinfo
92@ifnotinfo
9f534a47
JB
93This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator, included with
94GNU Emacs @value{EMACSVER}.
5a83c46e 95@end ifnotinfo
4009494e 96
73b0cd50 97Copyright @copyright{} 1990-1991, 2001-2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4009494e
GM
98
99@quotation
100Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
6a2c4aec 101under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
4009494e
GM
102any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
103Invariant Sections being just ``GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE'', with the
104Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and with the Back-Cover
105Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license is included in the section
106entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
107
6f093307
GM
108(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
109modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
110developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
4009494e
GM
111@end quotation
112@end copying
113
114@dircategory Emacs
115@direntry
62e034c2 116* Calc: (calc). Advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool.
4009494e
GM
117@end direntry
118
119@titlepage
120@sp 6
121@center @titlefont{Calc Manual}
122@sp 4
5a83c46e 123@center GNU Emacs Calc
4009494e
GM
124@c [volume]
125@sp 5
126@center Dave Gillespie
127@center daveg@@synaptics.com
128@page
129
130@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
4009494e
GM
131@insertcopying
132@end titlepage
133
134
135@summarycontents
136
137@c [end]
138
139@contents
140
141@c [begin]
142@ifnottex
143@node Top, Getting Started, (dir), (dir)
144@chapter The GNU Emacs Calculator
145
146@noindent
147@dfn{Calc} is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool
148written by Dave Gillespie that runs as part of the GNU Emacs environment.
149
150This manual, also written (mostly) by Dave Gillespie, is divided into
151three major parts: ``Getting Started,'' the ``Calc Tutorial,'' and the
152``Calc Reference.'' The Tutorial introduces all the major aspects of
153Calculator use in an easy, hands-on way. The remainder of the manual is
154a complete reference to the features of the Calculator.
155@end ifnottex
156
157@ifinfo
158For help in the Emacs Info system (which you are using to read this
159file), type @kbd{?}. (You can also type @kbd{h} to run through a
160longer Info tutorial.)
161@end ifinfo
162
5dc584b5
KB
163@insertcopying
164
4009494e
GM
165@menu
166* Getting Started:: General description and overview.
167@ifinfo
168* Interactive Tutorial::
169@end ifinfo
170* Tutorial:: A step-by-step introduction for beginners.
171
172* Introduction:: Introduction to the Calc reference manual.
173* Data Types:: Types of objects manipulated by Calc.
174* Stack and Trail:: Manipulating the stack and trail buffers.
175* Mode Settings:: Adjusting display format and other modes.
176* Arithmetic:: Basic arithmetic functions.
177* Scientific Functions:: Transcendentals and other scientific functions.
178* Matrix Functions:: Operations on vectors and matrices.
179* Algebra:: Manipulating expressions algebraically.
180* Units:: Operations on numbers with units.
181* Store and Recall:: Storing and recalling variables.
182* Graphics:: Commands for making graphs of data.
183* Kill and Yank:: Moving data into and out of Calc.
184* Keypad Mode:: Operating Calc from a keypad.
185* Embedded Mode:: Working with formulas embedded in a file.
186* Programming:: Calc as a programmable calculator.
187
188* Copying:: How you can copy and share Calc.
189* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
190* Customizing Calc:: Customizing Calc.
191* Reporting Bugs:: How to report bugs and make suggestions.
192
193* Summary:: Summary of Calc commands and functions.
194
195* Key Index:: The standard Calc key sequences.
196* Command Index:: The interactive Calc commands.
197* Function Index:: Functions (in algebraic formulas).
198* Concept Index:: General concepts.
199* Variable Index:: Variables used by Calc (both user and internal).
200* Lisp Function Index:: Internal Lisp math functions.
201@end menu
202
203@ifinfo
204@node Getting Started, Interactive Tutorial, Top, Top
205@end ifinfo
206@ifnotinfo
207@node Getting Started, Tutorial, Top, Top
208@end ifnotinfo
209@chapter Getting Started
210@noindent
211This chapter provides a general overview of Calc, the GNU Emacs
212Calculator: What it is, how to start it and how to exit from it,
213and what are the various ways that it can be used.
214
215@menu
216* What is Calc::
217* About This Manual::
218* Notations Used in This Manual::
219* Demonstration of Calc::
220* Using Calc::
221* History and Acknowledgements::
222@end menu
223
224@node What is Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started, Getting Started
225@section What is Calc?
226
227@noindent
228@dfn{Calc} is an advanced calculator and mathematical tool that runs as
229part of the GNU Emacs environment. Very roughly based on the HP-28/48
230series of calculators, its many features include:
231
232@itemize @bullet
233@item
234Choice of algebraic or RPN (stack-based) entry of calculations.
235
236@item
237Arbitrary precision integers and floating-point numbers.
238
239@item
240Arithmetic on rational numbers, complex numbers (rectangular and polar),
241error forms with standard deviations, open and closed intervals, vectors
242and matrices, dates and times, infinities, sets, quantities with units,
243and algebraic formulas.
244
245@item
246Mathematical operations such as logarithms and trigonometric functions.
247
248@item
249Programmer's features (bitwise operations, non-decimal numbers).
250
251@item
252Financial functions such as future value and internal rate of return.
253
254@item
255Number theoretical features such as prime factorization and arithmetic
256modulo @var{m} for any @var{m}.
257
258@item
259Algebraic manipulation features, including symbolic calculus.
260
261@item
262Moving data to and from regular editing buffers.
263
264@item
265Embedded mode for manipulating Calc formulas and data directly
266inside any editing buffer.
267
268@item
269Graphics using GNUPLOT, a versatile (and free) plotting program.
270
271@item
272Easy programming using keyboard macros, algebraic formulas,
273algebraic rewrite rules, or extended Emacs Lisp.
274@end itemize
275
276Calc tries to include a little something for everyone; as a result it is
277large and might be intimidating to the first-time user. If you plan to
278use Calc only as a traditional desk calculator, all you really need to
279read is the ``Getting Started'' chapter of this manual and possibly the
280first few sections of the tutorial. As you become more comfortable with
281the program you can learn its additional features. Calc does not
282have the scope and depth of a fully-functional symbolic math package,
283but Calc has the advantages of convenience, portability, and freedom.
284
285@node About This Manual, Notations Used in This Manual, What is Calc, Getting Started
286@section About This Manual
287
288@noindent
289This document serves as a complete description of the GNU Emacs
3bf8054f 290Calculator. It works both as an introduction for novices and as
4009494e
GM
291a reference for experienced users. While it helps to have some
292experience with GNU Emacs in order to get the most out of Calc,
293this manual ought to be readable even if you don't know or use Emacs
294regularly.
295
3bf8054f 296This manual is divided into three major parts:@: the ``Getting
4ce54f6b
CY
297Started'' chapter you are reading now, the Calc tutorial, and the Calc
298reference manual.
4009494e
GM
299@c [when-split]
300@c This manual has been printed in two volumes, the @dfn{Tutorial} and the
301@c @dfn{Reference}. Both volumes include a copy of the ``Getting Started''
302@c chapter.
303
304If you are in a hurry to use Calc, there is a brief ``demonstration''
305below which illustrates the major features of Calc in just a couple of
306pages. If you don't have time to go through the full tutorial, this
307will show you everything you need to know to begin.
308@xref{Demonstration of Calc}.
309
310The tutorial chapter walks you through the various parts of Calc
311with lots of hands-on examples and explanations. If you are new
312to Calc and you have some time, try going through at least the
313beginning of the tutorial. The tutorial includes about 70 exercises
314with answers. These exercises give you some guided practice with
315Calc, as well as pointing out some interesting and unusual ways
316to use its features.
317
318The reference section discusses Calc in complete depth. You can read
319the reference from start to finish if you want to learn every aspect
320of Calc. Or, you can look in the table of contents or the Concept
321Index to find the parts of the manual that discuss the things you
322need to know.
323
17587b1b 324@c @cindex Marginal notes
4009494e
GM
325Every Calc keyboard command is listed in the Calc Summary, and also
326in the Key Index. Algebraic functions, @kbd{M-x} commands, and
327variables also have their own indices.
17587b1b
JB
328@c @texline Each
329@c @infoline In the printed manual, each
330@c paragraph that is referenced in the Key or Function Index is marked
331@c in the margin with its index entry.
4009494e
GM
332
333@c [fix-ref Help Commands]
3bf8054f
JB
334You can access this manual on-line at any time within Calc by pressing
335the @kbd{h i} key sequence. Outside of the Calc window, you can press
336@kbd{C-x * i} to read the manual on-line. From within Calc the command
337@kbd{h t} will jump directly to the Tutorial; from outside of Calc the
338command @kbd{C-x * t} will jump to the Tutorial and start Calc if
339necessary. Pressing @kbd{h s} or @kbd{C-x * s} will take you directly
340to the Calc Summary. Within Calc, you can also go to the part of the
341manual describing any Calc key, function, or variable using
342@w{@kbd{h k}}, @kbd{h f}, or @kbd{h v}, respectively. @xref{Help Commands}.
4009494e
GM
343
344@ifnottex
345The Calc manual can be printed, but because the manual is so large, you
346should only make a printed copy if you really need it. To print the
347manual, you will need the @TeX{} typesetting program (this is a free
348program by Donald Knuth at Stanford University) as well as the
349@file{texindex} program and @file{texinfo.tex} file, both of which can
350be obtained from the FSF as part of the @code{texinfo} package.
351To print the Calc manual in one huge tome, you will need the
352source code to this manual, @file{calc.texi}, available as part of the
353Emacs source. Once you have this file, type @kbd{texi2dvi calc.texi}.
354Alternatively, change to the @file{man} subdirectory of the Emacs
355source distribution, and type @kbd{make calc.dvi}. (Don't worry if you
356get some ``overfull box'' warnings while @TeX{} runs.)
357The result will be a device-independent output file called
358@file{calc.dvi}, which you must print in whatever way is right
359for your system. On many systems, the command is
360
361@example
362lpr -d calc.dvi
363@end example
364
365@noindent
366or
367
368@example
369dvips calc.dvi
370@end example
371@end ifnottex
372@c Printed copies of this manual are also available from the Free Software
373@c Foundation.
374
375@node Notations Used in This Manual, Demonstration of Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started
376@section Notations Used in This Manual
377
378@noindent
379This section describes the various notations that are used
380throughout the Calc manual.
381
382In keystroke sequences, uppercase letters mean you must hold down
383the shift key while typing the letter. Keys pressed with Control
384held down are shown as @kbd{C-x}. Keys pressed with Meta held down
385are shown as @kbd{M-x}. Other notations are @key{RET} for the
386Return key, @key{SPC} for the space bar, @key{TAB} for the Tab key,
387@key{DEL} for the Delete key, and @key{LFD} for the Line-Feed key.
388The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards, it is
389whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
390regularly using Emacs.
391
392(If you don't have the @key{LFD} or @key{TAB} keys on your keyboard,
393the @kbd{C-j} and @kbd{C-i} keys are equivalent to them, respectively.
394If you don't have a Meta key, look for Alt or Extend Char. You can
395also press @key{ESC} or @kbd{C-[} first to get the same effect, so
396that @kbd{M-x}, @kbd{@key{ESC} x}, and @kbd{C-[ x} are all equivalent.)
397
398Sometimes the @key{RET} key is not shown when it is ``obvious''
399that you must press @key{RET} to proceed. For example, the @key{RET}
400is usually omitted in key sequences like @kbd{M-x calc-keypad @key{RET}}.
401
402Commands are generally shown like this: @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision})
403or @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}). This means that the command is
404normally used by pressing the @kbd{p} key or @kbd{C-x * k} key sequence,
405but it also has the full-name equivalent shown, e.g., @kbd{M-x calc-precision}.
406
407Commands that correspond to functions in algebraic notation
408are written: @kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}]. This means
409the @kbd{C} key is equivalent to @kbd{M-x calc-cos}, and that
410the corresponding function in an algebraic-style formula would
411be @samp{cos(@var{x})}.
412
413A few commands don't have key equivalents: @code{calc-sincos}
414[@code{sincos}].
415
416@node Demonstration of Calc, Using Calc, Notations Used in This Manual, Getting Started
417@section A Demonstration of Calc
418
419@noindent
420@cindex Demonstration of Calc
421This section will show some typical small problems being solved with
422Calc. The focus is more on demonstration than explanation, but
423everything you see here will be covered more thoroughly in the
424Tutorial.
425
426To begin, start Emacs if necessary (usually the command @code{emacs}
427does this), and type @kbd{C-x * c} to start the
428Calculator. (You can also use @kbd{M-x calc} if this doesn't work.
429@xref{Starting Calc}, for various ways of starting the Calculator.)
430
431Be sure to type all the sample input exactly, especially noting the
432difference between lower-case and upper-case letters. Remember,
433@key{RET}, @key{TAB}, @key{DEL}, and @key{SPC} are the Return, Tab,
434Delete, and Space keys.
435
436@strong{RPN calculation.} In RPN, you type the input number(s) first,
437then the command to operate on the numbers.
438
439@noindent
440Type @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + Q} to compute
441@texline @math{\sqrt{2+3} = 2.2360679775}.
442@infoline the square root of 2+3, which is 2.2360679775.
443
444@noindent
445Type @kbd{P 2 ^} to compute
446@texline @math{\pi^2 = 9.86960440109}.
447@infoline the value of `pi' squared, 9.86960440109.
448
449@noindent
450Type @key{TAB} to exchange the order of these two results.
451
452@noindent
453Type @kbd{- I H S} to subtract these results and compute the Inverse
454Hyperbolic sine of the difference, 2.72996136574.
455
456@noindent
457Type @key{DEL} to erase this result.
458
459@strong{Algebraic calculation.} You can also enter calculations using
460conventional ``algebraic'' notation. To enter an algebraic formula,
461use the apostrophe key.
462
463@noindent
464Type @kbd{' sqrt(2+3) @key{RET}} to compute
465@texline @math{\sqrt{2+3}}.
466@infoline the square root of 2+3.
467
468@noindent
469Type @kbd{' pi^2 @key{RET}} to enter
470@texline @math{\pi^2}.
471@infoline `pi' squared.
472To evaluate this symbolic formula as a number, type @kbd{=}.
473
474@noindent
475Type @kbd{' arcsinh($ - $$) @key{RET}} to subtract the second-most-recent
476result from the most-recent and compute the Inverse Hyperbolic sine.
477
478@strong{Keypad mode.} If you are using the X window system, press
479@w{@kbd{C-x * k}} to get Keypad mode. (If you don't use X, skip to
480the next section.)
481
482@noindent
483Click on the @key{2}, @key{ENTER}, @key{3}, @key{+}, and @key{SQRT}
484``buttons'' using your left mouse button.
485
486@noindent
487Click on @key{PI}, @key{2}, and @tfn{y^x}.
488
489@noindent
490Click on @key{INV}, then @key{ENTER} to swap the two results.
491
492@noindent
493Click on @key{-}, @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, and @key{SIN}.
494
495@noindent
496Click on @key{<-} to erase the result, then click @key{OFF} to turn
497the Keypad Calculator off.
498
499@strong{Grabbing data.} Type @kbd{C-x * x} if necessary to exit Calc.
500Now select the following numbers as an Emacs region: ``Mark'' the
501front of the list by typing @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or @kbd{C-@@} there,
502then move to the other end of the list. (Either get this list from
503the on-line copy of this manual, accessed by @w{@kbd{C-x * i}}, or just
504type these numbers into a scratch file.) Now type @kbd{C-x * g} to
505``grab'' these numbers into Calc.
506
507@example
508@group
5091.23 1.97
5101.6 2
5111.19 1.08
512@end group
513@end example
514
515@noindent
516The result @samp{[1.23, 1.97, 1.6, 2, 1.19, 1.08]} is a Calc ``vector.''
517Type @w{@kbd{V R +}} to compute the sum of these numbers.
518
519@noindent
520Type @kbd{U} to Undo this command, then type @kbd{V R *} to compute
521the product of the numbers.
522
523@noindent
524You can also grab data as a rectangular matrix. Place the cursor on
525the upper-leftmost @samp{1} and set the mark, then move to just after
526the lower-right @samp{8} and press @kbd{C-x * r}.
527
528@noindent
529Type @kbd{v t} to transpose this
530@texline @math{3\times2}
531@infoline 3x2
532matrix into a
533@texline @math{2\times3}
534@infoline 2x3
535matrix. Type @w{@kbd{v u}} to unpack the rows into two separate
536vectors. Now type @w{@kbd{V R + @key{TAB} V R +}} to compute the sums
537of the two original columns. (There is also a special
538grab-and-sum-columns command, @kbd{C-x * :}.)
539
540@strong{Units conversion.} Units are entered algebraically.
541Type @w{@kbd{' 43 mi/hr @key{RET}}} to enter the quantity 43 miles-per-hour.
542Type @w{@kbd{u c km/hr @key{RET}}}. Type @w{@kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}}}.
543
544@strong{Date arithmetic.} Type @kbd{t N} to get the current date and
545time. Type @kbd{90 +} to find the date 90 days from now. Type
546@kbd{' <25 dec 87> @key{RET}} to enter a date, then @kbd{- 7 /} to see how
547many weeks have passed since then.
548
549@strong{Algebra.} Algebraic entries can also include formulas
550or equations involving variables. Type @kbd{@w{' [x + y} = a, x y = 1] @key{RET}}
551to enter a pair of equations involving three variables.
552(Note the leading apostrophe in this example; also, note that the space
3bf8054f 553in @samp{x y} is required.) Type @w{@kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}}} to solve
4009494e
GM
554these equations for the variables @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
555
556@noindent
557Type @kbd{d B} to view the solutions in more readable notation.
558Type @w{@kbd{d C}} to view them in C language notation, @kbd{d T}
559to view them in the notation for the @TeX{} typesetting system,
560and @kbd{d L} to view them in the notation for the La@TeX{} typesetting
561system. Type @kbd{d N} to return to normal notation.
562
563@noindent
564Type @kbd{7.5}, then @kbd{s l a @key{RET}} to let @expr{a = 7.5} in these formulas.
3bf8054f 565(That's the letter @kbd{l}, not the numeral @kbd{1}.)
4009494e
GM
566
567@ifnotinfo
568@strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
569manual. Type @kbd{C-x * c} to return to Calc after each of these
570commands: @kbd{h k t N} to read about the @kbd{t N} command,
571@kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the @code{sqrt} function, and
572@kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
573@end ifnotinfo
574@ifinfo
575@strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
576manual. Remember to type the letter @kbd{l}, then @kbd{C-x * c}, to
577return here after each of these commands: @w{@kbd{h k t N}} to read
578about the @w{@kbd{t N}} command, @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the
579@code{sqrt} function, and @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
580@end ifinfo
581
582Press @key{DEL} repeatedly to remove any leftover results from the stack.
583To exit from Calc, press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again.
584
585@node Using Calc, History and Acknowledgements, Demonstration of Calc, Getting Started
586@section Using Calc
587
588@noindent
589Calc has several user interfaces that are specialized for
590different kinds of tasks. As well as Calc's standard interface,
591there are Quick mode, Keypad mode, and Embedded mode.
592
593@menu
594* Starting Calc::
595* The Standard Interface::
596* Quick Mode Overview::
597* Keypad Mode Overview::
598* Standalone Operation::
599* Embedded Mode Overview::
600* Other C-x * Commands::
601@end menu
602
603@node Starting Calc, The Standard Interface, Using Calc, Using Calc
604@subsection Starting Calc
605
606@noindent
607On most systems, you can type @kbd{C-x *} to start the Calculator.
608The key sequence @kbd{C-x *} is bound to the command @code{calc-dispatch},
609which can be rebound if convenient (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
610
611When you press @kbd{C-x *}, Emacs waits for you to press a second key to
612complete the command. In this case, you will follow @kbd{C-x *} with a
613letter (upper- or lower-case, it doesn't matter for @kbd{C-x *}) that says
614which Calc interface you want to use.
615
616To get Calc's standard interface, type @kbd{C-x * c}. To get
617Keypad mode, type @kbd{C-x * k}. Type @kbd{C-x * ?} to get a brief
618list of the available options, and type a second @kbd{?} to get
619a complete list.
620
621To ease typing, @kbd{C-x * *} also works to start Calc. It starts the
622same interface (either @kbd{C-x * c} or @w{@kbd{C-x * k}}) that you last
623used, selecting the @kbd{C-x * c} interface by default.
624
625If @kbd{C-x *} doesn't work for you, you can always type explicit
626commands like @kbd{M-x calc} (for the standard user interface) or
627@w{@kbd{M-x calc-keypad}} (for Keypad mode). First type @kbd{M-x}
628(that's Meta with the letter @kbd{x}), then, at the prompt,
629type the full command (like @kbd{calc-keypad}) and press Return.
630
631The same commands (like @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}) that start
632the Calculator also turn it off if it is already on.
633
634@node The Standard Interface, Quick Mode Overview, Starting Calc, Using Calc
635@subsection The Standard Calc Interface
636
637@noindent
638@cindex Standard user interface
639Calc's standard interface acts like a traditional RPN calculator,
640operated by the normal Emacs keyboard. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}
641to start the Calculator, the Emacs screen splits into two windows
642with the file you were editing on top and Calc on the bottom.
643
644@smallexample
645@group
646
647...
648--**-Emacs: myfile (Fundamental)----All----------------------
649--- Emacs Calculator Mode --- |Emacs Calculator Trail
6502: 17.3 | 17.3
6511: -5 | 3
652 . | 2
653 | 4
654 | * 8
655 | ->-5
656 |
92e15881 657--%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All----- --%*- *Calc Trail*
4009494e
GM
658@end group
659@end smallexample
660
661In this figure, the mode-line for @file{myfile} has moved up and the
662``Calculator'' window has appeared below it. As you can see, Calc
663actually makes two windows side-by-side. The lefthand one is
664called the @dfn{stack window} and the righthand one is called the
665@dfn{trail window.} The stack holds the numbers involved in the
666calculation you are currently performing. The trail holds a complete
667record of all calculations you have done. In a desk calculator with
668a printer, the trail corresponds to the paper tape that records what
669you do.
670
671In this case, the trail shows that four numbers (17.3, 3, 2, and 4)
672were first entered into the Calculator, then the 2 and 4 were
673multiplied to get 8, then the 3 and 8 were subtracted to get @mathit{-5}.
674(The @samp{>} symbol shows that this was the most recent calculation.)
675The net result is the two numbers 17.3 and @mathit{-5} sitting on the stack.
676
677Most Calculator commands deal explicitly with the stack only, but
678there is a set of commands that allow you to search back through
679the trail and retrieve any previous result.
680
681Calc commands use the digits, letters, and punctuation keys.
682Shifted (i.e., upper-case) letters are different from lowercase
683letters. Some letters are @dfn{prefix} keys that begin two-letter
684commands. For example, @kbd{e} means ``enter exponent'' and shifted
685@kbd{E} means @expr{e^x}. With the @kbd{d} (``display modes'') prefix
686the letter ``e'' takes on very different meanings: @kbd{d e} means
687``engineering notation'' and @kbd{d E} means ``@dfn{eqn} language mode.''
688
689There is nothing stopping you from switching out of the Calc
690window and back into your editing window, say by using the Emacs
691@w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window}) command. When the cursor is
692inside a regular window, Emacs acts just like normal. When the
693cursor is in the Calc stack or trail windows, keys are interpreted
694as Calc commands.
695
696When you quit by pressing @kbd{C-x * c} a second time, the Calculator
697windows go away but the actual Stack and Trail are not gone, just
698hidden. When you press @kbd{C-x * c} once again you will get the
699same stack and trail contents you had when you last used the
700Calculator.
701
702The Calculator does not remember its state between Emacs sessions.
703Thus if you quit Emacs and start it again, @kbd{C-x * c} will give you
704a fresh stack and trail. There is a command (@kbd{m m}) that lets
705you save your favorite mode settings between sessions, though.
706One of the things it saves is which user interface (standard or
707Keypad) you last used; otherwise, a freshly started Emacs will
708always treat @kbd{C-x * *} the same as @kbd{C-x * c}.
709
710The @kbd{q} key is another equivalent way to turn the Calculator off.
711
712If you type @kbd{C-x * b} first and then @kbd{C-x * c}, you get a
713full-screen version of Calc (@code{full-calc}) in which the stack and
714trail windows are still side-by-side but are now as tall as the whole
715Emacs screen. When you press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again to quit,
716the file you were editing before reappears. The @kbd{C-x * b} key
717switches back and forth between ``big'' full-screen mode and the
718normal partial-screen mode.
719
720Finally, @kbd{C-x * o} (@code{calc-other-window}) is like @kbd{C-x * c}
721except that the Calc window is not selected. The buffer you were
3bf8054f
JB
722editing before remains selected instead. If you are in a Calc window,
723then @kbd{C-x * o} will switch you out of it, being careful not to
724switch you to the Calc Trail window. So @kbd{C-x * o} is a handy
725way to switch out of Calc momentarily to edit your file; you can then
726type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch back into Calc when you are done.
4009494e
GM
727
728@node Quick Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, The Standard Interface, Using Calc
729@subsection Quick Mode (Overview)
730
731@noindent
732@dfn{Quick mode} is a quick way to use Calc when you don't need the
733full complexity of the stack and trail. To use it, type @kbd{C-x * q}
734(@code{quick-calc}) in any regular editing buffer.
735
736Quick mode is very simple: It prompts you to type any formula in
737standard algebraic notation (like @samp{4 - 2/3}) and then displays
738the result at the bottom of the Emacs screen (@mathit{3.33333333333}
739in this case). You are then back in the same editing buffer you
740were in before, ready to continue editing or to type @kbd{C-x * q}
741again to do another quick calculation. The result of the calculation
742will also be in the Emacs ``kill ring'' so that a @kbd{C-y} command
743at this point will yank the result into your editing buffer.
744
745Calc mode settings affect Quick mode, too, though you will have to
746go into regular Calc (with @kbd{C-x * c}) to change the mode settings.
747
748@c [fix-ref Quick Calculator mode]
749@xref{Quick Calculator}, for further information.
750
751@node Keypad Mode Overview, Standalone Operation, Quick Mode Overview, Using Calc
752@subsection Keypad Mode (Overview)
753
754@noindent
755@dfn{Keypad mode} is a mouse-based interface to the Calculator.
756It is designed for use with terminals that support a mouse. If you
757don't have a mouse, you will have to operate Keypad mode with your
758arrow keys (which is probably more trouble than it's worth).
759
760Type @kbd{C-x * k} to turn Keypad mode on or off. Once again you
761get two new windows, this time on the righthand side of the screen
762instead of at the bottom. The upper window is the familiar Calc
763Stack; the lower window is a picture of a typical calculator keypad.
764
765@tex
766\dimen0=\pagetotal%
767\advance \dimen0 by 24\baselineskip%
768\ifdim \dimen0>\pagegoal \vfill\eject \fi%
769\medskip
770@end tex
771@smallexample
772@group
773|--- Emacs Calculator Mode ---
774|2: 17.3
775|1: -5
776| .
92e15881 777|--%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calcul
5a83c46e 778|----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
4009494e
GM
779|FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
780|----+----+----+----+----+----|
781| LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
782|----+----+----+----+----+----|
783|SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
784|----+----+----+----+----+----|
785| ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
786|-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
787| INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
788|-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
789| HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
790|-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
791|EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
792|-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
793| OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
794|-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
795@end group
796@end smallexample
797
798Keypad mode is much easier for beginners to learn, because there
799is no need to memorize lots of obscure key sequences. But not all
800commands in regular Calc are available on the Keypad. You can
801always switch the cursor into the Calc stack window to use
802standard Calc commands if you need. Serious Calc users, though,
803often find they prefer the standard interface over Keypad mode.
804
805To operate the Calculator, just click on the ``buttons'' of the
806keypad using your left mouse button. To enter the two numbers
807shown here you would click @w{@kbd{1 7 .@: 3 ENTER 5 +/- ENTER}}; to
808add them together you would then click @kbd{+} (to get 12.3 on
809the stack).
810
811If you click the right mouse button, the top three rows of the
812keypad change to show other sets of commands, such as advanced
813math functions, vector operations, and operations on binary
814numbers.
815
816Because Keypad mode doesn't use the regular keyboard, Calc leaves
817the cursor in your original editing buffer. You can type in
818this buffer in the usual way while also clicking on the Calculator
819keypad. One advantage of Keypad mode is that you don't need an
820explicit command to switch between editing and calculating.
821
822If you press @kbd{C-x * b} first, you get a full-screen Keypad mode
823(@code{full-calc-keypad}) with three windows: The keypad in the lower
824left, the stack in the lower right, and the trail on top.
825
826@c [fix-ref Keypad Mode]
827@xref{Keypad Mode}, for further information.
828
829@node Standalone Operation, Embedded Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, Using Calc
830@subsection Standalone Operation
831
832@noindent
833@cindex Standalone Operation
834If you are not in Emacs at the moment but you wish to use Calc,
835you must start Emacs first. If all you want is to run Calc, you
836can give the commands:
837
838@example
839emacs -f full-calc
840@end example
841
842@noindent
843or
844
845@example
846emacs -f full-calc-keypad
847@end example
848
849@noindent
850which run a full-screen Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * c}) or
851a full-screen X-based Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * k}).
852In standalone operation, quitting the Calculator (by pressing
853@kbd{q} or clicking on the keypad @key{EXIT} button) quits Emacs
854itself.
855
856@node Embedded Mode Overview, Other C-x * Commands, Standalone Operation, Using Calc
857@subsection Embedded Mode (Overview)
858
859@noindent
860@dfn{Embedded mode} is a way to use Calc directly from inside an
861editing buffer. Suppose you have a formula written as part of a
862document like this:
863
864@smallexample
865@group
866The derivative of
867
868 ln(ln(x))
869
870is
871@end group
872@end smallexample
873
874@noindent
875and you wish to have Calc compute and format the derivative for
876you and store this derivative in the buffer automatically. To
877do this with Embedded mode, first copy the formula down to where
3bf8054f
JB
878you want the result to be, leaving a blank line before and after the
879formula:
4009494e
GM
880
881@smallexample
882@group
883The derivative of
884
885 ln(ln(x))
886
887is
888
889 ln(ln(x))
890@end group
891@end smallexample
892
893Now, move the cursor onto this new formula and press @kbd{C-x * e}.
3bf8054f
JB
894Calc will read the formula (using the surrounding blank lines to tell
895how much text to read), then push this formula (invisibly) onto the Calc
896stack. The cursor will stay on the formula in the editing buffer, but
897the line with the formula will now appear as it would on the Calc stack
898(in this case, it will be left-aligned) and the buffer's mode line will
899change to look like the Calc mode line (with mode indicators like
900@samp{12 Deg} and so on). Even though you are still in your editing
901buffer, the keyboard now acts like the Calc keyboard, and any new result
902you get is copied from the stack back into the buffer. To take the
903derivative, you would type @kbd{a d x @key{RET}}.
4009494e
GM
904
905@smallexample
906@group
907The derivative of
908
909 ln(ln(x))
910
911is
912
9131 / ln(x) x
914@end group
915@end smallexample
916
5fafc247
JB
917(Note that by default, Calc gives division lower precedence than multiplication,
918so that @samp{1 / ln(x) x} is equivalent to @samp{1 / (ln(x) x)}.)
3bf8054f 919
4009494e
GM
920To make this look nicer, you might want to press @kbd{d =} to center
921the formula, and even @kbd{d B} to use Big display mode.
922
923@smallexample
924@group
925The derivative of
926
927 ln(ln(x))
928
929is
930% [calc-mode: justify: center]
931% [calc-mode: language: big]
932
933 1
934 -------
935 ln(x) x
936@end group
937@end smallexample
938
939Calc has added annotations to the file to help it remember the modes
940that were used for this formula. They are formatted like comments
941in the @TeX{} typesetting language, just in case you are using @TeX{} or
942La@TeX{}. (In this example @TeX{} is not being used, so you might want
943to move these comments up to the top of the file or otherwise put them
944out of the way.)
945
946As an extra flourish, we can add an equation number using a
947righthand label: Type @kbd{d @} (1) @key{RET}}.
948
949@smallexample
950@group
951% [calc-mode: justify: center]
952% [calc-mode: language: big]
953% [calc-mode: right-label: " (1)"]
954
955 1
956 ------- (1)
957 ln(x) x
958@end group
959@end smallexample
960
961To leave Embedded mode, type @kbd{C-x * e} again. The mode line
962and keyboard will revert to the way they were before.
963
964The related command @kbd{C-x * w} operates on a single word, which
4a65fb7a
JB
965generally means a single number, inside text. It searches for an
966expression which ``looks'' like a number containing the point.
967Here's an example of its use:
4009494e
GM
968
969@smallexample
970A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 1 degrees.
971@end smallexample
972
973Place the cursor on the @samp{1}, then type @kbd{C-x * w} to enable
974Embedded mode on that number. Now type @kbd{3 /} (to get one-third),
975and @kbd{I T} (the Inverse Tangent converts a slope into an angle),
976then @w{@kbd{C-x * w}} again to exit Embedded mode.
977
978@smallexample
979A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 18.4349488229 degrees.
980@end smallexample
981
982@c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
983@xref{Embedded Mode}, for full details.
984
985@node Other C-x * Commands, , Embedded Mode Overview, Using Calc
986@subsection Other @kbd{C-x *} Commands
987
988@noindent
989Two more Calc-related commands are @kbd{C-x * g} and @kbd{C-x * r},
990which ``grab'' data from a selected region of a buffer into the
991Calculator. The region is defined in the usual Emacs way, by
992a ``mark'' placed at one end of the region, and the Emacs
993cursor or ``point'' placed at the other.
994
995The @kbd{C-x * g} command reads the region in the usual left-to-right,
996top-to-bottom order. The result is packaged into a Calc vector
997of numbers and placed on the stack. Calc (in its standard
998user interface) is then started. Type @kbd{v u} if you want
999to unpack this vector into separate numbers on the stack. Also,
1000@kbd{C-u C-x * g} interprets the region as a single number or
1001formula.
1002
1003The @kbd{C-x * r} command reads a rectangle, with the point and
1004mark defining opposite corners of the rectangle. The result
1005is a matrix of numbers on the Calculator stack.
1006
1007Complementary to these is @kbd{C-x * y}, which ``yanks'' the
1008value at the top of the Calc stack back into an editing buffer.
1009If you type @w{@kbd{C-x * y}} while in such a buffer, the value is
1010yanked at the current position. If you type @kbd{C-x * y} while
1011in the Calc buffer, Calc makes an educated guess as to which
1012editing buffer you want to use. The Calc window does not have
1013to be visible in order to use this command, as long as there
1014is something on the Calc stack.
1015
1016Here, for reference, is the complete list of @kbd{C-x *} commands.
1017The shift, control, and meta keys are ignored for the keystroke
1018following @kbd{C-x *}.
1019
1020@noindent
1021Commands for turning Calc on and off:
1022
1023@table @kbd
1024@item *
1025Turn Calc on or off, employing the same user interface as last time.
1026
1027@item =, +, -, /, \, &, #
1028Alternatives for @kbd{*}.
1029
1030@item C
1031Turn Calc on or off using its standard bottom-of-the-screen
1032interface. If Calc is already turned on but the cursor is not
1033in the Calc window, move the cursor into the window.
1034
1035@item O
1036Same as @kbd{C}, but don't select the new Calc window. If
1037Calc is already turned on and the cursor is in the Calc window,
1038move it out of that window.
1039
1040@item B
1041Control whether @kbd{C-x * c} and @kbd{C-x * k} use the full screen.
1042
1043@item Q
1044Use Quick mode for a single short calculation.
1045
1046@item K
1047Turn Calc Keypad mode on or off.
1048
1049@item E
1050Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current formula.
1051
1052@item J
1053Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off, select the interesting part.
1054
1055@item W
1056Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current word (number).
1057
1058@item Z
1059Turn Calc on in a user-defined way, as defined by a @kbd{Z I} command.
1060
1061@item X
1062Quit Calc; turn off standard, Keypad, or Embedded mode if on.
1063(This is like @kbd{q} or @key{OFF} inside of Calc.)
1064@end table
1065@iftex
1066@sp 2
1067@end iftex
1068
1069@noindent
1070Commands for moving data into and out of the Calculator:
1071
1072@table @kbd
1073@item G
1074Grab the region into the Calculator as a vector.
1075
1076@item R
1077Grab the rectangular region into the Calculator as a matrix.
1078
1079@item :
1080Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its columns.
1081
1082@item _
1083Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its rows.
1084
1085@item Y
1086Yank a value from the Calculator into the current editing buffer.
1087@end table
1088@iftex
1089@sp 2
1090@end iftex
1091
1092@noindent
1093Commands for use with Embedded mode:
1094
1095@table @kbd
1096@item A
1097``Activate'' the current buffer. Locate all formulas that
1098contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols and record their locations
1099so that they can be updated automatically as variables are changed.
1100
1101@item D
1102Duplicate the current formula immediately below and select
1103the duplicate.
1104
1105@item F
1106Insert a new formula at the current point.
1107
1108@item N
1109Move the cursor to the next active formula in the buffer.
1110
1111@item P
1112Move the cursor to the previous active formula in the buffer.
1113
1114@item U
1115Update (i.e., as if by the @kbd{=} key) the formula at the current point.
1116
1117@item `
1118Edit (as if by @code{calc-edit}) the formula at the current point.
1119@end table
1120@iftex
1121@sp 2
1122@end iftex
1123
1124@noindent
1125Miscellaneous commands:
1126
1127@table @kbd
1128@item I
1129Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc manual.
1130(This is the same as @kbd{h i} inside of Calc.)
1131
1132@item T
1133Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Tutorial.
1134
1135@item S
1136Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Summary.
1137
1138@item L
1139Load Calc entirely into memory. (Normally the various parts
1140are loaded only as they are needed.)
1141
1142@item M
1143Read a region of written keystroke names (like @kbd{C-n a b c @key{RET}})
1144and record them as the current keyboard macro.
1145
1146@item 0
1147(This is the ``zero'' digit key.) Reset the Calculator to
1148its initial state: Empty stack, and initial mode settings.
1149@end table
1150
1151@node History and Acknowledgements, , Using Calc, Getting Started
1152@section History and Acknowledgements
1153
1154@noindent
1155Calc was originally started as a two-week project to occupy a lull
1156in the author's schedule. Basically, a friend asked if I remembered
1157the value of
1158@texline @math{2^{32}}.
1159@infoline @expr{2^32}.
1160I didn't offhand, but I said, ``that's easy, just call up an
1161@code{xcalc}.'' @code{Xcalc} duly reported that the answer to our
1162question was @samp{4.294967e+09}---with no way to see the full ten
1163digits even though we knew they were there in the program's memory! I
1164was so annoyed, I vowed to write a calculator of my own, once and for
1165all.
1166
1167I chose Emacs Lisp, a) because I had always been curious about it
1168and b) because, being only a text editor extension language after
1169all, Emacs Lisp would surely reach its limits long before the project
1170got too far out of hand.
1171
1172To make a long story short, Emacs Lisp turned out to be a distressingly
1173solid implementation of Lisp, and the humble task of calculating
1174turned out to be more open-ended than one might have expected.
1175
1176Emacs Lisp didn't have built-in floating point math (now it does), so
4bb49b43
JB
1177this had to be simulated in software. In fact, Emacs integers would
1178only comfortably fit six decimal digits or so---not enough for a decent
1179calculator. So I had to write my own high-precision integer code as
1180well, and once I had this I figured that arbitrary-size integers were
1181just as easy as large integers. Arbitrary floating-point precision was
1182the logical next step. Also, since the large integer arithmetic was
1183there anyway it seemed only fair to give the user direct access to it,
1184which in turn made it practical to support fractions as well as floats.
1185All these features inspired me to look around for other data types that
1186might be worth having.
4009494e
GM
1187
1188Around this time, my friend Rick Koshi showed me his nifty new HP-28
1189calculator. It allowed the user to manipulate formulas as well as
1190numerical quantities, and it could also operate on matrices. I
1191decided that these would be good for Calc to have, too. And once
1192things had gone this far, I figured I might as well take a look at
1193serious algebra systems for further ideas. Since these systems did
1194far more than I could ever hope to implement, I decided to focus on
1195rewrite rules and other programming features so that users could
1196implement what they needed for themselves.
1197
1198Rick complained that matrices were hard to read, so I put in code to
1199format them in a 2D style. Once these routines were in place, Big mode
1200was obligatory. Gee, what other language modes would be useful?
1201
1202Scott Hemphill and Allen Knutson, two friends with a strong mathematical
1203bent, contributed ideas and algorithms for a number of Calc features
1204including modulo forms, primality testing, and float-to-fraction conversion.
1205
1206Units were added at the eager insistence of Mass Sivilotti. Later,
1207Ulrich Mueller at CERN and Przemek Klosowski at NIST provided invaluable
1208expert assistance with the units table. As far as I can remember, the
1209idea of using algebraic formulas and variables to represent units dates
1210back to an ancient article in Byte magazine about muMath, an early
1211algebra system for microcomputers.
1212
1213Many people have contributed to Calc by reporting bugs and suggesting
1214features, large and small. A few deserve special mention: Tim Peters,
1215who helped develop the ideas that led to the selection commands, rewrite
1216rules, and many other algebra features;
1217@texline Fran\c{c}ois
1218@infoline Francois
1219Pinard, who contributed an early prototype of the Calc Summary appendix
1220as well as providing valuable suggestions in many other areas of Calc;
1221Carl Witty, whose eagle eyes discovered many typographical and factual
1222errors in the Calc manual; Tim Kay, who drove the development of
1223Embedded mode; Ove Ewerlid, who made many suggestions relating to the
1224algebra commands and contributed some code for polynomial operations;
f10d0e80 1225Randal Schwartz, who suggested the @code{calc-eval} function; Juha
4009494e 1226Sarlin, who first worked out how to split Calc into quickly-loading
f10d0e80
JB
1227parts; Bob Weiner, who helped immensely with the Lucid Emacs port; and
1228Robert J. Chassell, who suggested the Calc Tutorial and exercises as
1229well as many other things.
4009494e
GM
1230
1231@cindex Bibliography
1232@cindex Knuth, Art of Computer Programming
1233@cindex Numerical Recipes
1234@c Should these be expanded into more complete references?
1235Among the books used in the development of Calc were Knuth's @emph{Art
1236of Computer Programming} (especially volume II, @emph{Seminumerical
1237Algorithms}); @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky,
1238and Vetterling; Bevington's @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis
1239for the Physical Sciences}; @emph{Concrete Mathematics} by Graham,
1240Knuth, and Patashnik; Steele's @emph{Common Lisp, the Language}; the
1241@emph{CRC Standard Math Tables} (William H. Beyer, ed.); and
1242Abramowitz and Stegun's venerable @emph{Handbook of Mathematical
1243Functions}. Also, of course, Calc could not have been written without
1244the excellent @emph{GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, by Bil Lewis and
1245Dan LaLiberte.
1246
1247Final thanks go to Richard Stallman, without whose fine implementations
1248of the Emacs editor, language, and environment, Calc would have been
1249finished in two weeks.
1250
1251@c [tutorial]
1252
1253@ifinfo
1254@c This node is accessed by the `C-x * t' command.
1255@node Interactive Tutorial, Tutorial, Getting Started, Top
1256@chapter Tutorial
1257
1258@noindent
1259Some brief instructions on using the Emacs Info system for this tutorial:
1260
1261Press the space bar and Delete keys to go forward and backward in a
1262section by screenfuls (or use the regular Emacs scrolling commands
1263for this).
1264
1265Press @kbd{n} or @kbd{p} to go to the Next or Previous section.
1266If the section has a @dfn{menu}, press a digit key like @kbd{1}
1267or @kbd{2} to go to a sub-section from the menu. Press @kbd{u} to
1268go back up from a sub-section to the menu it is part of.
1269
1270Exercises in the tutorial all have cross-references to the
1271appropriate page of the ``answers'' section. Press @kbd{f}, then
1272the exercise number, to see the answer to an exercise. After
1273you have followed a cross-reference, you can press the letter
1274@kbd{l} to return to where you were before.
1275
1276You can press @kbd{?} at any time for a brief summary of Info commands.
1277
59ee4113 1278Press the number @kbd{1} now to enter the first section of the Tutorial.
4009494e
GM
1279
1280@menu
1281* Tutorial::
1282@end menu
1283
1284@node Tutorial, Introduction, Interactive Tutorial, Top
1285@end ifinfo
1286@ifnotinfo
1287@node Tutorial, Introduction, Getting Started, Top
1288@end ifnotinfo
1289@chapter Tutorial
1290
1291@noindent
1292This chapter explains how to use Calc and its many features, in
1293a step-by-step, tutorial way. You are encouraged to run Calc and
1294work along with the examples as you read (@pxref{Starting Calc}).
1295If you are already familiar with advanced calculators, you may wish
1296@c [not-split]
1297to skip on to the rest of this manual.
1298@c [when-split]
1299@c to skip on to volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}.
1300
1301@c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
1302This tutorial describes the standard user interface of Calc only.
1303The Quick mode and Keypad mode interfaces are fairly
1304self-explanatory. @xref{Embedded Mode}, for a description of
1305the Embedded mode interface.
1306
1307The easiest way to read this tutorial on-line is to have two windows on
59ee4113
JB
1308your Emacs screen, one with Calc and one with the Info system. Press
1309@kbd{C-x * t} to set this up; the on-line tutorial will be opened in the
1310current window and Calc will be started in another window. From the
1311Info window, the command @kbd{C-x * c} can be used to switch to the Calc
1312window and @kbd{C-x * o} can be used to switch back to the Info window.
1313(If you have a printed copy of the manual you can use that instead; in
1314that case you only need to press @kbd{C-x * c} to start Calc.)
4009494e
GM
1315
1316This tutorial is designed to be done in sequence. But the rest of this
1317manual does not assume you have gone through the tutorial. The tutorial
1318does not cover everything in the Calculator, but it touches on most
1319general areas.
1320
1321@ifnottex
1322You may wish to print out a copy of the Calc Summary and keep notes on
1323it as you learn Calc. @xref{About This Manual}, to see how to make a
1324printed summary. @xref{Summary}.
1325@end ifnottex
1326@iftex
1327The Calc Summary at the end of the reference manual includes some blank
1328space for your own use. You may wish to keep notes there as you learn
1329Calc.
1330@end iftex
1331
1332@menu
1333* Basic Tutorial::
1334* Arithmetic Tutorial::
1335* Vector/Matrix Tutorial::
1336* Types Tutorial::
1337* Algebra Tutorial::
1338* Programming Tutorial::
1339
1340* Answers to Exercises::
1341@end menu
1342
1343@node Basic Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial, Tutorial
1344@section Basic Tutorial
1345
1346@noindent
1347In this section, we learn how RPN and algebraic-style calculations
1348work, how to undo and redo an operation done by mistake, and how
1349to control various modes of the Calculator.
1350
1351@menu
1352* RPN Tutorial:: Basic operations with the stack.
1353* Algebraic Tutorial:: Algebraic entry; variables.
1354* Undo Tutorial:: If you make a mistake: Undo and the trail.
1355* Modes Tutorial:: Common mode-setting commands.
1356@end menu
1357
1358@node RPN Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1359@subsection RPN Calculations and the Stack
1360
1361@cindex RPN notation
1362@ifnottex
1363@noindent
1364Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1365system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1366(Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1367Jan Lukasiewicz.)
1368@end ifnottex
1369@tex
1370\noindent
1371Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1372system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1373(Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1374Jan \L ukasiewicz.)
1375@end tex
1376
1377The central component of an RPN calculator is the @dfn{stack}. A
1378calculator stack is like a stack of dishes. New dishes (numbers) are
1379added at the top of the stack, and numbers are normally only removed
1380from the top of the stack.
1381
1382@cindex Operators
1383@cindex Operands
1384In an operation like @expr{2+3}, the 2 and 3 are called the @dfn{operands}
1385and the @expr{+} is the @dfn{operator}. In an RPN calculator you always
1386enter the operands first, then the operator. Each time you type a
1387number, Calc adds or @dfn{pushes} it onto the top of the Stack.
1388When you press an operator key like @kbd{+}, Calc @dfn{pops} the appropriate
1389number of operands from the stack and pushes back the result.
1390
1391Thus we could add the numbers 2 and 3 in an RPN calculator by typing:
1392@kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} +}. (The @key{RET} key, Return, corresponds to
1393the @key{ENTER} key on traditional RPN calculators.) Try this now if
1394you wish; type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch into the Calc window (you can type
1395@kbd{C-x * c} again or @kbd{C-x * o} to switch back to the Tutorial window).
1396The first four keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 2 and 3 onto the stack.
1397The @kbd{+} key ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
1398and pushes the result (5) back onto the stack. Here's how the stack
1399will look at various points throughout the calculation:
1400
1401@smallexample
1402@group
1403 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1404 . 1: 3 .
1405 .
1406
1407 C-x * c 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} + @key{DEL}
1408@end group
1409@end smallexample
1410
1411The @samp{.} symbol is a marker that represents the top of the stack.
1412Note that the ``top'' of the stack is really shown at the bottom of
1413the Stack window. This may seem backwards, but it turns out to be
1414less distracting in regular use.
1415
1416@cindex Stack levels
1417@cindex Levels of stack
1418The numbers @samp{1:} and @samp{2:} on the left are @dfn{stack level
1419numbers}. Old RPN calculators always had four stack levels called
1420@expr{x}, @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and @expr{t}. Calc's stack can grow
1421as large as you like, so it uses numbers instead of letters. Some
1422stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric argument that says
1423which stack level to work on. Normal commands like @kbd{+} always
1424work on the top few levels of the stack.
1425
1426@c [fix-ref Truncating the Stack]
1427The Stack buffer is just an Emacs buffer, and you can move around in
1428it using the regular Emacs motion commands. But no matter where the
1429cursor is, even if you have scrolled the @samp{.} marker out of
1430view, most Calc commands always move the cursor back down to level 1
1431before doing anything. It is possible to move the @samp{.} marker
1432upwards through the stack, temporarily ``hiding'' some numbers from
1433commands like @kbd{+}. This is called @dfn{stack truncation} and
1434we will not cover it in this tutorial; @pxref{Truncating the Stack},
1435if you are interested.
1436
1437You don't really need the second @key{RET} in @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3
1438@key{RET} +}. That's because if you type any operator name or
1439other non-numeric key when you are entering a number, the Calculator
1440automatically enters that number and then does the requested command.
1441Thus @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +} will work just as well.
1442
1443Examples in this tutorial will often omit @key{RET} even when the
1444stack displays shown would only happen if you did press @key{RET}:
1445
1446@smallexample
1447@group
14481: 2 2: 2 1: 5
1449 . 1: 3 .
1450 .
1451
1452 2 @key{RET} 3 +
1453@end group
1454@end smallexample
1455
1456@noindent
1457Here, after pressing @kbd{3} the stack would really show @samp{1: 2}
1458with @samp{Calc:@: 3} in the minibuffer. In these situations, you can
1459press the optional @key{RET} to see the stack as the figure shows.
1460
1461(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} (This tutorial will include exercises
1462at various points. Try them if you wish. Answers to all the exercises
1463are located at the end of the Tutorial chapter. Each exercise will
1464include a cross-reference to its particular answer. If you are
1465reading with the Emacs Info system, press @kbd{f} and the
1466exercise number to go to the answer, then the letter @kbd{l} to
1467return to where you were.)
1468
1469@noindent
1470Here's the first exercise: What will the keystrokes @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2
1471@key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -} compute? (@samp{*} is the symbol for
1472multiplication.) Figure it out by hand, then try it with Calc to see
1473if you're right. @xref{RPN Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1474
1475(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Compute
1476@texline @math{(2\times4) + (7\times9.4) + {5\over4}}
1477@infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4}
1478using the stack. @xref{RPN Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
1479
1480The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards. It is
1481whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
1482regularly using Emacs. The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the
1483top value on the stack. (You can still get that value back from
1484the Trail if you should need it later on.) There are many places
1485in this tutorial where we assume you have used @key{DEL} to erase the
1486results of the previous example at the beginning of a new example.
1487In the few places where it is really important to use @key{DEL} to
1488clear away old results, the text will remind you to do so.
1489
1490(It won't hurt to let things accumulate on the stack, except that
1491whenever you give a display-mode-changing command Calc will have to
1492spend a long time reformatting such a large stack.)
1493
1494Since the @kbd{-} key is also an operator (it subtracts the top two
1495stack elements), how does one enter a negative number? Calc uses
1496the @kbd{_} (underscore) key to act like the minus sign in a number.
1497So, typing @kbd{-5 @key{RET}} won't work because the @kbd{-} key
1498will try to do a subtraction, but @kbd{_5 @key{RET}} works just fine.
1499
1500You can also press @kbd{n}, which means ``change sign.'' It changes
1501the number at the top of the stack (or the number being entered)
1502from positive to negative or vice-versa: @kbd{5 n @key{RET}}.
1503
1504@cindex Duplicating a stack entry
1505If you press @key{RET} when you're not entering a number, the effect
1506is to duplicate the top number on the stack. Consider this calculation:
1507
1508@smallexample
1509@group
15101: 3 2: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 81
1511 . 1: 3 . 1: 9 .
1512 . .
1513
1514 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * @key{RET} *
1515@end group
1516@end smallexample
1517
1518@noindent
1519(Of course, an easier way to do this would be @kbd{3 @key{RET} 4 ^},
1520to raise 3 to the fourth power.)
1521
1522The space-bar key (denoted @key{SPC} here) performs the same function
1523as @key{RET}; you could replace all three occurrences of @key{RET} in
1524the above example with @key{SPC} and the effect would be the same.
1525
1526@cindex Exchanging stack entries
1527Another stack manipulation key is @key{TAB}. This exchanges the top
1528two stack entries. Suppose you have computed @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +}
1529to get 5, and then you realize what you really wanted to compute
1530was @expr{20 / (2+3)}.
1531
1532@smallexample
1533@group
15341: 5 2: 5 2: 20 1: 4
1535 . 1: 20 1: 5 .
1536 . .
1537
1538 2 @key{RET} 3 + 20 @key{TAB} /
1539@end group
1540@end smallexample
1541
1542@noindent
1543Planning ahead, the calculation would have gone like this:
1544
1545@smallexample
1546@group
15471: 20 2: 20 3: 20 2: 20 1: 4
1548 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1549 . 1: 3 .
1550 .
1551
1552 20 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 + /
1553@end group
1554@end smallexample
1555
1556A related stack command is @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (hold @key{META} and type
1557@key{TAB}). It rotates the top three elements of the stack upward,
1558bringing the object in level 3 to the top.
1559
1560@smallexample
1561@group
15621: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 20 3: 30
1563 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 30 2: 10
1564 . 1: 30 1: 10 1: 20
1565 . . .
1566
1567 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
1568@end group
1569@end smallexample
1570
1571(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Suppose the numbers 10, 20, and 30 are
1572on the stack. Figure out how to add one to the number in level 2
1573without affecting the rest of the stack. Also figure out how to add
1574one to the number in level 3. @xref{RPN Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
1575
1576Operations like @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/}, and @kbd{^} pop two
1577arguments from the stack and push a result. Operations like @kbd{n} and
1578@kbd{Q} (square root) pop a single number and push the result. You can
1579think of them as simply operating on the top element of the stack.
1580
1581@smallexample
1582@group
15831: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 25 1: 5
1584 . . 1: 16 . .
1585 .
1586
1587 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} @key{RET} * + Q
1588@end group
1589@end smallexample
1590
1591@noindent
1592(Note that capital @kbd{Q} means to hold down the Shift key while
1593typing @kbd{q}. Remember, plain unshifted @kbd{q} is the Quit command.)
1594
1595@cindex Pythagorean Theorem
1596Here we've used the Pythagorean Theorem to determine the hypotenuse of a
1597right triangle. Calc actually has a built-in command for that called
1598@kbd{f h}, but let's suppose we can't remember the necessary keystrokes.
1599We can still enter it by its full name using @kbd{M-x} notation:
1600
1601@smallexample
1602@group
16031: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1604 . 1: 4 .
1605 .
1606
1607 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} M-x calc-hypot
1608@end group
1609@end smallexample
1610
1611All Calculator commands begin with the word @samp{calc-}. Since it
1612gets tiring to type this, Calc provides an @kbd{x} key which is just
1613like the regular Emacs @kbd{M-x} key except that it types the @samp{calc-}
1614prefix for you:
1615
1616@smallexample
1617@group
16181: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1619 . 1: 4 .
1620 .
1621
1622 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} x hypot
1623@end group
1624@end smallexample
1625
1626What happens if you take the square root of a negative number?
1627
1628@smallexample
1629@group
16301: 4 1: -4 1: (0, 2)
1631 . . .
1632
1633 4 @key{RET} n Q
1634@end group
1635@end smallexample
1636
1637@noindent
1638The notation @expr{(a, b)} represents a complex number.
1639Complex numbers are more traditionally written @expr{a + b i};
1640Calc can display in this format, too, but for now we'll stick to the
1641@expr{(a, b)} notation.
1642
1643If you don't know how complex numbers work, you can safely ignore this
1644feature. Complex numbers only arise from operations that would be
1645errors in a calculator that didn't have complex numbers. (For example,
1646taking the square root or logarithm of a negative number produces a
1647complex result.)
1648
1649Complex numbers are entered in the notation shown. The @kbd{(} and
1650@kbd{,} and @kbd{)} keys manipulate ``incomplete complex numbers.''
1651
1652@smallexample
1653@group
16541: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
1655 . 1: 2 . 3 .
1656 . .
1657
1658 ( 2 , 3 )
1659@end group
1660@end smallexample
1661
1662You can perform calculations while entering parts of incomplete objects.
1663However, an incomplete object cannot actually participate in a calculation:
1664
1665@smallexample
1666@group
16671: ( ... 2: ( ... 3: ( ... 1: ( ... 1: ( ...
1668 . 1: 2 2: 2 5 5
1669 . 1: 3 . .
1670 .
1671 (error)
1672 ( 2 @key{RET} 3 + +
1673@end group
1674@end smallexample
1675
1676@noindent
1677Adding 5 to an incomplete object makes no sense, so the last command
1678produces an error message and leaves the stack the same.
1679
1680Incomplete objects can't participate in arithmetic, but they can be
1681moved around by the regular stack commands.
1682
1683@smallexample
1684@group
16852: 2 3: 2 3: 3 1: ( ... 1: (2, 3)
16861: 3 2: 3 2: ( ... 2 .
1687 . 1: ( ... 1: 2 3
1688 . . .
1689
16902 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} ( M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} )
1691@end group
1692@end smallexample
1693
1694@noindent
1695Note that the @kbd{,} (comma) key did not have to be used here.
1696When you press @kbd{)} all the stack entries between the incomplete
1697entry and the top are collected, so there's never really a reason
1698to use the comma. It's up to you.
1699
1700(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} To enter the complex number @expr{(2, 3)},
1701your friend Joe typed @kbd{( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )}. What happened?
1702(Joe thought of a clever way to correct his mistake in only two
1703keystrokes, but it didn't quite work. Try it to find out why.)
1704@xref{RPN Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
1705
1706Vectors are entered the same way as complex numbers, but with square
1707brackets in place of parentheses. We'll meet vectors again later in
1708the tutorial.
1709
1710Any Emacs command can be given a @dfn{numeric prefix argument} by
1711typing a series of @key{META}-digits beforehand. If @key{META} is
1712awkward for you, you can instead type @kbd{C-u} followed by the
1713necessary digits. Numeric prefix arguments can be negative, as in
1714@kbd{M-- M-3 M-5} or @w{@kbd{C-u - 3 5}}. Calc commands use numeric
1715prefix arguments in a variety of ways. For example, a numeric prefix
1716on the @kbd{+} operator adds any number of stack entries at once:
1717
1718@smallexample
1719@group
17201: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 1: 60
1721 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 .
1722 . 1: 30 1: 30
1723 . .
1724
1725 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u 3 +
1726@end group
1727@end smallexample
1728
1729For stack manipulation commands like @key{RET}, a positive numeric
1730prefix argument operates on the top @var{n} stack entries at once. A
1731negative argument operates on the entry in level @var{n} only. An
1732argument of zero operates on the entire stack. In this example, we copy
1733the second-to-top element of the stack:
1734
1735@smallexample
1736@group
17371: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10
1738 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 3: 20
1739 . 1: 30 1: 30 2: 30
1740 . . 1: 20
1741 .
1742
1743 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u -2 @key{RET}
1744@end group
1745@end smallexample
1746
1747@cindex Clearing the stack
1748@cindex Emptying the stack
1749Another common idiom is @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}, which clears the stack.
1750(The @kbd{M-0} numeric prefix tells @key{DEL} to operate on the
1751entire stack.)
1752
1753@node Algebraic Tutorial, Undo Tutorial, RPN Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1754@subsection Algebraic-Style Calculations
1755
1756@noindent
1757If you are not used to RPN notation, you may prefer to operate the
1758Calculator in Algebraic mode, which is closer to the way
1759non-RPN calculators work. In Algebraic mode, you enter formulas
1760in traditional @expr{2+3} notation.
1761
5fafc247
JB
1762@strong{Notice:} Calc gives @samp{/} lower precedence than @samp{*}, so
1763that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}; this is not
1764standard across all computer languages. See below for details.
4009494e
GM
1765
1766You don't really need any special ``mode'' to enter algebraic formulas.
1767You can enter a formula at any time by pressing the apostrophe (@kbd{'})
1768key. Answer the prompt with the desired formula, then press @key{RET}.
1769The formula is evaluated and the result is pushed onto the RPN stack.
1770If you don't want to think in RPN at all, you can enter your whole
1771computation as a formula, read the result from the stack, then press
1772@key{DEL} to delete it from the stack.
1773
1774Try pressing the apostrophe key, then @kbd{2+3+4}, then @key{RET}.
1775The result should be the number 9.
1776
1777Algebraic formulas use the operators @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*},
1778@samp{/}, and @samp{^}. You can use parentheses to make the order
1779of evaluation clear. In the absence of parentheses, @samp{^} is
1780evaluated first, then @samp{*}, then @samp{/}, then finally
1781@samp{+} and @samp{-}. For example, the expression
1782
1783@example
17842 + 3*4*5 / 6*7^8 - 9
1785@end example
1786
1787@noindent
1788is equivalent to
1789
1790@example
17912 + ((3*4*5) / (6*(7^8)) - 9
1792@end example
1793
1794@noindent
1795or, in large mathematical notation,
1796
1797@ifnottex
1798@example
1799@group
1800 3 * 4 * 5
18012 + --------- - 9
1802 8
1803 6 * 7
1804@end group
1805@end example
1806@end ifnottex
1807@tex
4009494e
GM
1808\beforedisplay
1809$$ 2 + { 3 \times 4 \times 5 \over 6 \times 7^8 } - 9 $$
1810\afterdisplay
1811@end tex
1812
1813@noindent
1814The result of this expression will be the number @mathit{-6.99999826533}.
1815
1816Calc's order of evaluation is the same as for most computer languages,
1817except that @samp{*} binds more strongly than @samp{/}, as the above
1818example shows. As in normal mathematical notation, the @samp{*} symbol
1819can often be omitted: @samp{2 a} is the same as @samp{2*a}.
1820
1821Operators at the same level are evaluated from left to right, except
1822that @samp{^} is evaluated from right to left. Thus, @samp{2-3-4} is
1823equivalent to @samp{(2-3)-4} or @mathit{-5}, whereas @samp{2^3^4} is equivalent
1824to @samp{2^(3^4)} (a very large integer; try it!).
1825
1826If you tire of typing the apostrophe all the time, there is
1827Algebraic mode, where Calc automatically senses
1828when you are about to type an algebraic expression. To enter this
1829mode, press the two letters @w{@kbd{m a}}. (An @samp{Alg} indicator
1830should appear in the Calc window's mode line.)
1831
1832Press @kbd{m a}, then @kbd{2+3+4} with no apostrophe, then @key{RET}.
1833
1834In Algebraic mode, when you press any key that would normally begin
1835entering a number (such as a digit, a decimal point, or the @kbd{_}
1836key), or if you press @kbd{(} or @kbd{[}, Calc automatically begins
1837an algebraic entry.
1838
1839Functions which do not have operator symbols like @samp{+} and @samp{*}
1840must be entered in formulas using function-call notation. For example,
1841the function name corresponding to the square-root key @kbd{Q} is
1842@code{sqrt}. To compute a square root in a formula, you would use
1843the notation @samp{sqrt(@var{x})}.
1844
1845Press the apostrophe, then type @kbd{sqrt(5*2) - 3}. The result should
1846be @expr{0.16227766017}.
1847
1848Note that if the formula begins with a function name, you need to use
1849the apostrophe even if you are in Algebraic mode. If you type @kbd{arcsin}
1850out of the blue, the @kbd{a r} will be taken as an Algebraic Rewrite
1851command, and the @kbd{csin} will be taken as the name of the rewrite
1852rule to use!
1853
1854Some people prefer to enter complex numbers and vectors in algebraic
1855form because they find RPN entry with incomplete objects to be too
1856distracting, even though they otherwise use Calc as an RPN calculator.
1857
1858Still in Algebraic mode, type:
1859
1860@smallexample
1861@group
18621: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (8, -1) 2: (8, -1) 1: (9, -1)
1863 . 1: (1, -2) . 1: 1 .
1864 . .
1865
1866 (2,3) @key{RET} (1,-2) @key{RET} * 1 @key{RET} +
1867@end group
1868@end smallexample
1869
1870Algebraic mode allows us to enter complex numbers without pressing
1871an apostrophe first, but it also means we need to press @key{RET}
1872after every entry, even for a simple number like @expr{1}.
1873
1874(You can type @kbd{C-u m a} to enable a special Incomplete Algebraic
1875mode in which the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys use algebraic entry even
1876though regular numeric keys still use RPN numeric entry. There is also
1877Total Algebraic mode, started by typing @kbd{m t}, in which all
1878normal keys begin algebraic entry. You must then use the @key{META} key
1879to type Calc commands: @kbd{M-m t} to get back out of Total Algebraic
1880mode, @kbd{M-q} to quit, etc.)
1881
1882If you're still in Algebraic mode, press @kbd{m a} again to turn it off.
1883
1884Actual non-RPN calculators use a mixture of algebraic and RPN styles.
1885In general, operators of two numbers (like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*})
1886use algebraic form, but operators of one number (like @kbd{n} and @kbd{Q})
1887use RPN form. Also, a non-RPN calculator allows you to see the
1888intermediate results of a calculation as you go along. You can
1889accomplish this in Calc by performing your calculation as a series
1890of algebraic entries, using the @kbd{$} sign to tie them together.
1891In an algebraic formula, @kbd{$} represents the number on the top
1892of the stack. Here, we perform the calculation
1893@texline @math{\sqrt{2\times4+1}},
1894@infoline @expr{sqrt(2*4+1)},
1895which on a traditional calculator would be done by pressing
1896@kbd{2 * 4 + 1 =} and then the square-root key.
1897
1898@smallexample
1899@group
19001: 8 1: 9 1: 3
1901 . . .
1902
1903 ' 2*4 @key{RET} $+1 @key{RET} Q
1904@end group
1905@end smallexample
1906
1907@noindent
1908Notice that we didn't need to press an apostrophe for the @kbd{$+1},
1909because the dollar sign always begins an algebraic entry.
1910
1911(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} How could you get the same effect as
1912pressing @kbd{Q} but using an algebraic entry instead? How about
1913if the @kbd{Q} key on your keyboard were broken?
1914@xref{Algebraic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1915
1916The notations @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on stand for higher stack
1917entries. For example, @kbd{' $$+$ @key{RET}} is just like typing @kbd{+}.
1918
1919Algebraic formulas can include @dfn{variables}. To store in a
1920variable, press @kbd{s s}, then type the variable name, then press
1921@key{RET}. (There are actually two flavors of store command:
1922@kbd{s s} stores a number in a variable but also leaves the number
1923on the stack, while @w{@kbd{s t}} removes a number from the stack and
1924stores it in the variable.) A variable name should consist of one
1925or more letters or digits, beginning with a letter.
1926
1927@smallexample
1928@group
19291: 17 . 1: a + a^2 1: 306
1930 . . .
1931
1932 17 s t a @key{RET} ' a+a^2 @key{RET} =
1933@end group
1934@end smallexample
1935
1936@noindent
1937The @kbd{=} key @dfn{evaluates} a formula by replacing all its
1938variables by the values that were stored in them.
1939
1940For RPN calculations, you can recall a variable's value on the
1941stack either by entering its name as a formula and pressing @kbd{=},
1942or by using the @kbd{s r} command.
1943
1944@smallexample
1945@group
19461: 17 2: 17 3: 17 2: 17 1: 306
1947 . 1: 17 2: 17 1: 289 .
1948 . 1: 2 .
1949 .
1950
1951 s r a @key{RET} ' a @key{RET} = 2 ^ +
1952@end group
1953@end smallexample
1954
1955If you press a single digit for a variable name (as in @kbd{s t 3}, you
1956get one of ten @dfn{quick variables} @code{q0} through @code{q9}.
1957They are ``quick'' simply because you don't have to type the letter
1958@code{q} or the @key{RET} after their names. In fact, you can type
1959simply @kbd{s 3} as a shorthand for @kbd{s s 3}, and likewise for
1960@kbd{t 3} and @w{@kbd{r 3}}.
1961
1962Any variables in an algebraic formula for which you have not stored
1963values are left alone, even when you evaluate the formula.
1964
1965@smallexample
1966@group
19671: 2 a + 2 b 1: 34 + 2 b
1968 . .
1969
1970 ' 2a+2b @key{RET} =
1971@end group
1972@end smallexample
1973
1974Calls to function names which are undefined in Calc are also left
1975alone, as are calls for which the value is undefined.
1976
1977@smallexample
1978@group
19791: 2 + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5, 6) + foo(3)
1980 .
1981
1982 ' log10(100) + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5,6) + foo(3) @key{RET}
1983@end group
1984@end smallexample
1985
1986@noindent
1987In this example, the first call to @code{log10} works, but the other
1988calls are not evaluated. In the second call, the logarithm is
1989undefined for that value of the argument; in the third, the argument
1990is symbolic, and in the fourth, there are too many arguments. In the
1991fifth case, there is no function called @code{foo}. You will see a
1992``Wrong number of arguments'' message referring to @samp{log10(5,6)}.
1993Press the @kbd{w} (``why'') key to see any other messages that may
1994have arisen from the last calculation. In this case you will get
1995``logarithm of zero,'' then ``number expected: @code{x}''. Calc
1996automatically displays the first message only if the message is
1997sufficiently important; for example, Calc considers ``wrong number
1998of arguments'' and ``logarithm of zero'' to be important enough to
1999report automatically, while a message like ``number expected: @code{x}''
2000will only show up if you explicitly press the @kbd{w} key.
2001
2002(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Joe entered the formula @samp{2 x y},
2003stored 5 in @code{x}, pressed @kbd{=}, and got the expected result,
2004@samp{10 y}. He then tried the same for the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)},
2005expecting @samp{10 (1+y)}, but it didn't work. Why not?
2006@xref{Algebraic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2007
2008(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} What result would you expect
2009@kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} to give? What if you then type @kbd{0 *}?
2010@xref{Algebraic Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2011
2012One interesting way to work with variables is to use the
2013@dfn{evaluates-to} (@samp{=>}) operator. It works like this:
2014Enter a formula algebraically in the usual way, but follow
2015the formula with an @samp{=>} symbol. (There is also an @kbd{s =}
2016command which builds an @samp{=>} formula using the stack.) On
2017the stack, you will see two copies of the formula with an @samp{=>}
2018between them. The lefthand formula is exactly like you typed it;
2019the righthand formula has been evaluated as if by typing @kbd{=}.
2020
2021@smallexample
2022@group
20232: 2 + 3 => 5 2: 2 + 3 => 5
20241: 2 a + 2 b => 34 + 2 b 1: 2 a + 2 b => 20 + 2 b
2025 . .
2026
2027' 2+3 => @key{RET} ' 2a+2b @key{RET} s = 10 s t a @key{RET}
2028@end group
2029@end smallexample
2030
2031@noindent
2032Notice that the instant we stored a new value in @code{a}, all
2033@samp{=>} operators already on the stack that referred to @expr{a}
2034were updated to use the new value. With @samp{=>}, you can push a
2035set of formulas on the stack, then change the variables experimentally
2036to see the effects on the formulas' values.
2037
2038You can also ``unstore'' a variable when you are through with it:
2039
2040@smallexample
2041@group
20422: 2 + 5 => 5
20431: 2 a + 2 b => 2 a + 2 b
2044 .
2045
2046 s u a @key{RET}
2047@end group
2048@end smallexample
2049
2050We will encounter formulas involving variables and functions again
2051when we discuss the algebra and calculus features of the Calculator.
2052
2053@node Undo Tutorial, Modes Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2054@subsection Undo and Redo
2055
2056@noindent
2057If you make a mistake, you can usually correct it by pressing shift-@kbd{U},
2058the ``undo'' command. First, clear the stack (@kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}) and exit
2059and restart Calc (@kbd{C-x * * C-x * *}) to make sure things start off
2060with a clean slate. Now:
2061
2062@smallexample
2063@group
20641: 2 2: 2 1: 8 2: 2 1: 6
2065 . 1: 3 . 1: 3 .
2066 . .
2067
2068 2 @key{RET} 3 ^ U *
2069@end group
2070@end smallexample
2071
2072You can undo any number of times. Calc keeps a complete record of
2073all you have done since you last opened the Calc window. After the
2074above example, you could type:
2075
2076@smallexample
2077@group
20781: 6 2: 2 1: 2 . .
2079 . 1: 3 .
2080 .
2081 (error)
2082 U U U U
2083@end group
2084@end smallexample
2085
2086You can also type @kbd{D} to ``redo'' a command that you have undone
2087mistakenly.
2088
2089@smallexample
2090@group
2091 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 6 1: 6
2092 . 1: 3 . .
2093 .
2094 (error)
2095 D D D D
2096@end group
2097@end smallexample
2098
2099@noindent
2100It was not possible to redo past the @expr{6}, since that was placed there
2101by something other than an undo command.
2102
2103@cindex Time travel
2104You can think of undo and redo as a sort of ``time machine.'' Press
2105@kbd{U} to go backward in time, @kbd{D} to go forward. If you go
2106backward and do something (like @kbd{*}) then, as any science fiction
2107reader knows, you have changed your future and you cannot go forward
2108again. Thus, the inability to redo past the @expr{6} even though there
2109was an earlier undo command.
2110
2111You can always recall an earlier result using the Trail. We've ignored
2112the trail so far, but it has been faithfully recording everything we
2113did since we loaded the Calculator. If the Trail is not displayed,
2114press @kbd{t d} now to turn it on.
2115
2116Let's try grabbing an earlier result. The @expr{8} we computed was
2117undone by a @kbd{U} command, and was lost even to Redo when we pressed
2118@kbd{*}, but it's still there in the trail. There should be a little
2119@samp{>} arrow (the @dfn{trail pointer}) resting on the last trail
2120entry. If there isn't, press @kbd{t ]} to reset the trail pointer.
2121Now, press @w{@kbd{t p}} to move the arrow onto the line containing
2122@expr{8}, and press @w{@kbd{t y}} to ``yank'' that number back onto the
2123stack.
2124
2125If you press @kbd{t ]} again, you will see that even our Yank command
2126went into the trail.
2127
2128Let's go further back in time. Earlier in the tutorial we computed
2129a huge integer using the formula @samp{2^3^4}. We don't remember
2130what it was, but the first digits were ``241''. Press @kbd{t r}
2131(which stands for trail-search-reverse), then type @kbd{241}.
2132The trail cursor will jump back to the next previous occurrence of
2133the string ``241'' in the trail. This is just a regular Emacs
2134incremental search; you can now press @kbd{C-s} or @kbd{C-r} to
2135continue the search forwards or backwards as you like.
2136
2137To finish the search, press @key{RET}. This halts the incremental
2138search and leaves the trail pointer at the thing we found. Now we
2139can type @kbd{t y} to yank that number onto the stack. If we hadn't
2140remembered the ``241'', we could simply have searched for @kbd{2^3^4},
2141then pressed @kbd{@key{RET} t n} to halt and then move to the next item.
2142
2143You may have noticed that all the trail-related commands begin with
2144the letter @kbd{t}. (The store-and-recall commands, on the other hand,
2145all began with @kbd{s}.) Calc has so many commands that there aren't
2146enough keys for all of them, so various commands are grouped into
2147two-letter sequences where the first letter is called the @dfn{prefix}
2148key. If you type a prefix key by accident, you can press @kbd{C-g}
2149to cancel it. (In fact, you can press @kbd{C-g} to cancel almost
2150anything in Emacs.) To get help on a prefix key, press that key
2151followed by @kbd{?}. Some prefixes have several lines of help,
2152so you need to press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see them all.
2153You can also type @kbd{h h} to see all the help at once.
2154
2155Try pressing @kbd{t ?} now. You will see a line of the form,
2156
2157@smallexample
2158trail/time: Display; Fwd, Back; Next, Prev, Here, [, ]; Yank: [MORE] t-
2159@end smallexample
2160
2161@noindent
2162The word ``trail'' indicates that the @kbd{t} prefix key contains
2163trail-related commands. Each entry on the line shows one command,
2164with a single capital letter showing which letter you press to get
2165that command. We have used @kbd{t n}, @kbd{t p}, @kbd{t ]}, and
2166@kbd{t y} so far. The @samp{[MORE]} means you can press @kbd{?}
2167again to see more @kbd{t}-prefix commands. Notice that the commands
2168are roughly divided (by semicolons) into related groups.
2169
2170When you are in the help display for a prefix key, the prefix is
2171still active. If you press another key, like @kbd{y} for example,
2172it will be interpreted as a @kbd{t y} command. If all you wanted
2173was to look at the help messages, press @kbd{C-g} afterwards to cancel
2174the prefix.
2175
2176One more way to correct an error is by editing the stack entries.
2177The actual Stack buffer is marked read-only and must not be edited
2178directly, but you can press @kbd{`} (the backquote or accent grave)
2179to edit a stack entry.
2180
2181Try entering @samp{3.141439} now. If this is supposed to represent
2182@cpi{}, it's got several errors. Press @kbd{`} to edit this number.
2183Now use the normal Emacs cursor motion and editing keys to change
2184the second 4 to a 5, and to transpose the 3 and the 9. When you
2185press @key{RET}, the number on the stack will be replaced by your
2186new number. This works for formulas, vectors, and all other types
2187of values you can put on the stack. The @kbd{`} key also works
2188during entry of a number or algebraic formula.
2189
2190@node Modes Tutorial, , Undo Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2191@subsection Mode-Setting Commands
2192
2193@noindent
2194Calc has many types of @dfn{modes} that affect the way it interprets
2195your commands or the way it displays data. We have already seen one
2196mode, namely Algebraic mode. There are many others, too; we'll
2197try some of the most common ones here.
2198
2199Perhaps the most fundamental mode in Calc is the current @dfn{precision}.
2200Notice the @samp{12} on the Calc window's mode line:
2201
2202@smallexample
92e15881 2203--%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All------
4009494e
GM
2204@end smallexample
2205
2206@noindent
2207Most of the symbols there are Emacs things you don't need to worry
2208about, but the @samp{12} and the @samp{Deg} are mode indicators.
2209The @samp{12} means that calculations should always be carried to
221012 significant figures. That is why, when we type @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /},
2211we get @expr{0.142857142857} with exactly 12 digits, not counting
2212leading and trailing zeros.
2213
2214You can set the precision to anything you like by pressing @kbd{p},
2215then entering a suitable number. Try pressing @kbd{p 30 @key{RET}},
2216then doing @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /} again:
2217
2218@smallexample
2219@group
22201: 0.142857142857
22212: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2222 .
2223@end group
2224@end smallexample
2225
2226Although the precision can be set arbitrarily high, Calc always
2227has to have @emph{some} value for the current precision. After
2228all, the true value @expr{1/7} is an infinitely repeating decimal;
2229Calc has to stop somewhere.
2230
2231Of course, calculations are slower the more digits you request.
2232Press @w{@kbd{p 12}} now to set the precision back down to the default.
2233
2234Calculations always use the current precision. For example, even
2235though we have a 30-digit value for @expr{1/7} on the stack, if
2236we use it in a calculation in 12-digit mode it will be rounded
2237down to 12 digits before it is used. Try it; press @key{RET} to
2238duplicate the number, then @w{@kbd{1 +}}. Notice that the @key{RET}
2239key didn't round the number, because it doesn't do any calculation.
2240But the instant we pressed @kbd{+}, the number was rounded down.
2241
2242@smallexample
2243@group
22441: 0.142857142857
22452: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
22463: 1.14285714286
2247 .
2248@end group
2249@end smallexample
2250
2251@noindent
2252In fact, since we added a digit on the left, we had to lose one
2253digit on the right from even the 12-digit value of @expr{1/7}.
2254
2255How did we get more than 12 digits when we computed @samp{2^3^4}? The
2256answer is that Calc makes a distinction between @dfn{integers} and
2257@dfn{floating-point} numbers, or @dfn{floats}. An integer is a number
2258that does not contain a decimal point. There is no such thing as an
2259``infinitely repeating fraction integer,'' so Calc doesn't have to limit
2260itself. If you asked for @samp{2^10000} (don't try this!), you would
2261have to wait a long time but you would eventually get an exact answer.
2262If you ask for @samp{2.^10000}, you will quickly get an answer which is
2263correct only to 12 places. The decimal point tells Calc that it should
2264use floating-point arithmetic to get the answer, not exact integer
2265arithmetic.
2266
2267You can use the @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) command to convert a
2268floating-point value to an integer, and @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float})
2269to convert an integer to floating-point form.
2270
2271Let's try entering that last calculation:
2272
2273@smallexample
2274@group
22751: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311689e3010
2276 . 1: 10000 .
2277 .
2278
2279 2.0 @key{RET} 10000 @key{RET} ^
2280@end group
2281@end smallexample
2282
2283@noindent
2284@cindex Scientific notation, entry of
2285Notice the letter @samp{e} in there. It represents ``times ten to the
2286power of,'' and is used by Calc automatically whenever writing the
2287number out fully would introduce more extra zeros than you probably
2288want to see. You can enter numbers in this notation, too.
2289
2290@smallexample
2291@group
22921: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311678e3010
2293 . 1: 10000. .
2294 .
2295
2296 2.0 @key{RET} 1e4 @key{RET} ^
2297@end group
2298@end smallexample
2299
2300@cindex Round-off errors
2301@noindent
2302Hey, the answer is different! Look closely at the middle columns
2303of the two examples. In the first, the stack contained the
2304exact integer @expr{10000}, but in the second it contained
2305a floating-point value with a decimal point. When you raise a
2306number to an integer power, Calc uses repeated squaring and
2307multiplication to get the answer. When you use a floating-point
2308power, Calc uses logarithms and exponentials. As you can see,
2309a slight error crept in during one of these methods. Which
2310one should we trust? Let's raise the precision a bit and find
2311out:
2312
2313@smallexample
2314@group
2315 . 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.995063116880828e3010
2316 . 1: 10000. .
2317 .
2318
2319 p 16 @key{RET} 2. @key{RET} 1e4 ^ p 12 @key{RET}
2320@end group
2321@end smallexample
2322
2323@noindent
2324@cindex Guard digits
2325Presumably, it doesn't matter whether we do this higher-precision
2326calculation using an integer or floating-point power, since we
2327have added enough ``guard digits'' to trust the first 12 digits
2328no matter what. And the verdict is@dots{} Integer powers were more
2329accurate; in fact, the result was only off by one unit in the
2330last place.
2331
2332@cindex Guard digits
2333Calc does many of its internal calculations to a slightly higher
2334precision, but it doesn't always bump the precision up enough.
2335In each case, Calc added about two digits of precision during
2336its calculation and then rounded back down to 12 digits
2337afterward. In one case, it was enough; in the other, it
2338wasn't. If you really need @var{x} digits of precision, it
2339never hurts to do the calculation with a few extra guard digits.
2340
2341What if we want guard digits but don't want to look at them?
2342We can set the @dfn{float format}. Calc supports four major
2343formats for floating-point numbers, called @dfn{normal},
2344@dfn{fixed-point}, @dfn{scientific notation}, and @dfn{engineering
2345notation}. You get them by pressing @w{@kbd{d n}}, @kbd{d f},
2346@kbd{d s}, and @kbd{d e}, respectively. In each case, you can
2347supply a numeric prefix argument which says how many digits
2348should be displayed. As an example, let's put a few numbers
2349onto the stack and try some different display modes. First,
2350use @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}} to clear the stack, then enter the four
2351numbers shown here:
2352
2353@smallexample
2354@group
23554: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
23563: 12345. 3: 12300. 3: 1.2345e4 3: 1.23e4 3: 12345.000
23572: 123.45 2: 123. 2: 1.2345e2 2: 1.23e2 2: 123.450
23581: 12.345 1: 12.3 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.23e1 1: 12.345
2359 . . . . .
2360
2361 d n M-3 d n d s M-3 d s M-3 d f
2362@end group
2363@end smallexample
2364
2365@noindent
2366Notice that when we typed @kbd{M-3 d n}, the numbers were rounded down
2367to three significant digits, but then when we typed @kbd{d s} all
2368five significant figures reappeared. The float format does not
2369affect how numbers are stored, it only affects how they are
2370displayed. Only the current precision governs the actual rounding
2371of numbers in the Calculator's memory.
2372
2373Engineering notation, not shown here, is like scientific notation
2374except the exponent (the power-of-ten part) is always adjusted to be
2375a multiple of three (as in ``kilo,'' ``micro,'' etc.). As a result
2376there will be one, two, or three digits before the decimal point.
2377
2378Whenever you change a display-related mode, Calc redraws everything
2379in the stack. This may be slow if there are many things on the stack,
2380so Calc allows you to type shift-@kbd{H} before any mode command to
2381prevent it from updating the stack. Anything Calc displays after the
2382mode-changing command will appear in the new format.
2383
2384@smallexample
2385@group
23864: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
23873: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 1.2345e4 3: 12345.
23882: 123.450 2: 123.450 2: 1.2345e1 2: 1.2345e1 2: 123.45
23891: 12.345 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.2345e2 1: 1.2345e2 1: 12.345
2390 . . . . .
2391
2392 H d s @key{DEL} U @key{TAB} d @key{SPC} d n
2393@end group
2394@end smallexample
2395
2396@noindent
2397Here the @kbd{H d s} command changes to scientific notation but without
2398updating the screen. Deleting the top stack entry and undoing it back
2399causes it to show up in the new format; swapping the top two stack
2400entries reformats both entries. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command refreshes the
2401whole stack. The @kbd{d n} command changes back to the normal float
2402format; since it doesn't have an @kbd{H} prefix, it also updates all
2403the stack entries to be in @kbd{d n} format.
2404
2405Notice that the integer @expr{12345} was not affected by any
2406of the float formats. Integers are integers, and are always
2407displayed exactly.
2408
2409@cindex Large numbers, readability
2410Large integers have their own problems. Let's look back at
2411the result of @kbd{2^3^4}.
2412
2413@example
24142417851639229258349412352
2415@end example
2416
2417@noindent
2418Quick---how many digits does this have? Try typing @kbd{d g}:
2419
2420@example
24212,417,851,639,229,258,349,412,352
2422@end example
2423
2424@noindent
2425Now how many digits does this have? It's much easier to tell!
2426We can actually group digits into clumps of any size. Some
2427people prefer @kbd{M-5 d g}:
2428
2429@example
243024178,51639,22925,83494,12352
2431@end example
2432
2433Let's see what happens to floating-point numbers when they are grouped.
2434First, type @kbd{p 25 @key{RET}} to make sure we have enough precision
2435to get ourselves into trouble. Now, type @kbd{1e13 /}:
2436
2437@example
243824,17851,63922.9258349412352
2439@end example
2440
2441@noindent
2442The integer part is grouped but the fractional part isn't. Now try
2443@kbd{M-- M-5 d g} (that's meta-minus-sign, meta-five):
2444
2445@example
244624,17851,63922.92583,49412,352
2447@end example
2448
2449If you find it hard to tell the decimal point from the commas, try
2450changing the grouping character to a space with @kbd{d , @key{SPC}}:
2451
2452@example
245324 17851 63922.92583 49412 352
2454@end example
2455
2456Type @kbd{d , ,} to restore the normal grouping character, then
2457@kbd{d g} again to turn grouping off. Also, press @kbd{p 12} to
2458restore the default precision.
2459
2460Press @kbd{U} enough times to get the original big integer back.
2461(Notice that @kbd{U} does not undo each mode-setting command; if
2462you want to undo a mode-setting command, you have to do it yourself.)
2463Now, type @kbd{d r 16 @key{RET}}:
2464
2465@example
246616#200000000000000000000
2467@end example
2468
2469@noindent
2470The number is now displayed in @dfn{hexadecimal}, or ``base-16'' form.
2471Suddenly it looks pretty simple; this should be no surprise, since we
2472got this number by computing a power of two, and 16 is a power of 2.
2473In fact, we can use @w{@kbd{d r 2 @key{RET}}} to see it in actual binary
2474form:
2475
2476@example
24772#1000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 @dots{}
2478@end example
2479
2480@noindent
2481We don't have enough space here to show all the zeros! They won't
2482fit on a typical screen, either, so you will have to use horizontal
2483scrolling to see them all. Press @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} to scroll the
2484stack window left and right by half its width. Another way to view
2485something large is to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the top of
2486stack in a separate window. (Press @kbd{C-c C-c} when you are done.)
2487
2488You can enter non-decimal numbers using the @kbd{#} symbol, too.
2489Let's see what the hexadecimal number @samp{5FE} looks like in
2490binary. Type @kbd{16#5FE} (the letters can be typed in upper or
2491lower case; they will always appear in upper case). It will also
2492help to turn grouping on with @kbd{d g}:
2493
2494@example
24952#101,1111,1110
2496@end example
2497
2498Notice that @kbd{d g} groups by fours by default if the display radix
2499is binary or hexadecimal, but by threes if it is decimal, octal, or any
2500other radix.
2501
2502Now let's see that number in decimal; type @kbd{d r 10}:
2503
2504@example
25051,534
2506@end example
2507
2508Numbers are not @emph{stored} with any particular radix attached. They're
2509just numbers; they can be entered in any radix, and are always displayed
2510in whatever radix you've chosen with @kbd{d r}. The current radix applies
2511to integers, fractions, and floats.
2512
2513@cindex Roundoff errors, in non-decimal numbers
2514(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Your friend Joe tried to enter one-third
2515as @samp{3#0.1} in @kbd{d r 3} mode with a precision of 12. He got
2516@samp{3#0.0222222...} (with 25 2's) in the display. When he multiplied
2517that by three, he got @samp{3#0.222222...} instead of the expected
2518@samp{3#1}. Next, Joe entered @samp{3#0.2} and, to his great relief,
2519saw @samp{3#0.2} on the screen. But when he typed @kbd{2 /}, he got
2520@samp{3#0.10000001} (some zeros omitted). What's going on here?
2521@xref{Modes Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2522
2523@cindex Scientific notation, in non-decimal numbers
2524(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Scientific notation works in non-decimal
2525modes in the natural way (the exponent is a power of the radix instead of
2526a power of ten, although the exponent itself is always written in decimal).
2527Thus @samp{8#1.23e3 = 8#1230.0}. Suppose we have the hexadecimal number
2528@samp{f.e8f} times 16 to the 15th power: We write @samp{16#f.e8fe15}.
2529What is wrong with this picture? What could we write instead that would
2530work better? @xref{Modes Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2531
2532The @kbd{m} prefix key has another set of modes, relating to the way
2533Calc interprets your inputs and does computations. Whereas @kbd{d}-prefix
2534modes generally affect the way things look, @kbd{m}-prefix modes affect
2535the way they are actually computed.
2536
2537The most popular @kbd{m}-prefix mode is the @dfn{angular mode}. Notice
2538the @samp{Deg} indicator in the mode line. This means that if you use
2539a command that interprets a number as an angle, it will assume the
2540angle is measured in degrees. For example,
2541
2542@smallexample
2543@group
25441: 45 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001 1: 0.5
2545 . . . .
2546
2547 45 S 2 ^ c 1
2548@end group
2549@end smallexample
2550
2551@noindent
2552The shift-@kbd{S} command computes the sine of an angle. The sine
2553of 45 degrees is
2554@texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2};
2555@infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2};
2556squaring this yields @expr{2/4 = 0.5}. However, there has been a slight
2557roundoff error because the representation of
2558@texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2}
2559@infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2}
2560wasn't exact. The @kbd{c 1} command is a handy way to clean up numbers
2561in this case; it temporarily reduces the precision by one digit while it
2562re-rounds the number on the top of the stack.
2563
2564@cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2565(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe computed the sine
2566of 45 degrees as shown above, then, hoping to avoid an inexact
2567result, he increased the precision to 16 digits before squaring.
2568What happened? @xref{Modes Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2569
2570To do this calculation in radians, we would type @kbd{m r} first.
2571(The indicator changes to @samp{Rad}.) 45 degrees corresponds to
2572@cpiover{4} radians. To get @cpi{}, press the @kbd{P} key. (Once
2573again, this is a shifted capital @kbd{P}. Remember, unshifted
2574@kbd{p} sets the precision.)
2575
2576@smallexample
2577@group
25781: 3.14159265359 1: 0.785398163398 1: 0.707106781187
2579 . . .
2580
2581 P 4 / m r S
2582@end group
2583@end smallexample
2584
2585Likewise, inverse trigonometric functions generate results in
2586either radians or degrees, depending on the current angular mode.
2587
2588@smallexample
2589@group
25901: 0.707106781187 1: 0.785398163398 1: 45.
2591 . . .
2592
2593 .5 Q m r I S m d U I S
2594@end group
2595@end smallexample
2596
2597@noindent
2598Here we compute the Inverse Sine of
2599@texline @math{\sqrt{0.5}},
2600@infoline @expr{sqrt(0.5)},
2601first in radians, then in degrees.
2602
2603Use @kbd{c d} and @kbd{c r} to convert a number from radians to degrees
2604and vice-versa.
2605
2606@smallexample
2607@group
26081: 45 1: 0.785398163397 1: 45.
2609 . . .
2610
2611 45 c r c d
2612@end group
2613@end smallexample
2614
2615Another interesting mode is @dfn{Fraction mode}. Normally,
2616dividing two integers produces a floating-point result if the
2617quotient can't be expressed as an exact integer. Fraction mode
2618causes integer division to produce a fraction, i.e., a rational
2619number, instead.
2620
2621@smallexample
2622@group
26232: 12 1: 1.33333333333 1: 4:3
26241: 9 . .
2625 .
2626
2627 12 @key{RET} 9 / m f U / m f
2628@end group
2629@end smallexample
2630
2631@noindent
2632In the first case, we get an approximate floating-point result.
2633In the second case, we get an exact fractional result (four-thirds).
2634
2635You can enter a fraction at any time using @kbd{:} notation.
2636(Calc uses @kbd{:} instead of @kbd{/} as the fraction separator
2637because @kbd{/} is already used to divide the top two stack
2638elements.) Calculations involving fractions will always
2639produce exact fractional results; Fraction mode only says
2640what to do when dividing two integers.
2641
2642@cindex Fractions vs. floats
2643@cindex Floats vs. fractions
2644(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} If fractional arithmetic is exact,
2645why would you ever use floating-point numbers instead?
2646@xref{Modes Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
2647
2648Typing @kbd{m f} doesn't change any existing values in the stack.
2649In the above example, we had to Undo the division and do it over
2650again when we changed to Fraction mode. But if you use the
2651evaluates-to operator you can get commands like @kbd{m f} to
2652recompute for you.
2653
2654@smallexample
2655@group
26561: 12 / 9 => 1.33333333333 1: 12 / 9 => 1.333 1: 12 / 9 => 4:3
2657 . . .
2658
2659 ' 12/9 => @key{RET} p 4 @key{RET} m f
2660@end group
2661@end smallexample
2662
2663@noindent
2664In this example, the righthand side of the @samp{=>} operator
2665on the stack is recomputed when we change the precision, then
2666again when we change to Fraction mode. All @samp{=>} expressions
2667on the stack are recomputed every time you change any mode that
2668might affect their values.
2669
2670@node Arithmetic Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Tutorial
2671@section Arithmetic Tutorial
2672
2673@noindent
2674In this section, we explore the arithmetic and scientific functions
2675available in the Calculator.
2676
2677The standard arithmetic commands are @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/},
2678and @kbd{^}. Each normally takes two numbers from the top of the stack
2679and pushes back a result. The @kbd{n} and @kbd{&} keys perform
2680change-sign and reciprocal operations, respectively.
2681
2682@smallexample
2683@group
26841: 5 1: 0.2 1: 5. 1: -5. 1: 5.
2685 . . . . .
2686
2687 5 & & n n
2688@end group
2689@end smallexample
2690
2691@cindex Binary operators
2692You can apply a ``binary operator'' like @kbd{+} across any number of
2693stack entries by giving it a numeric prefix. You can also apply it
2694pairwise to several stack elements along with the top one if you use
2695a negative prefix.
2696
2697@smallexample
2698@group
26993: 2 1: 9 3: 2 4: 2 3: 12
27002: 3 . 2: 3 3: 3 2: 13
27011: 4 1: 4 2: 4 1: 14
2702 . . 1: 10 .
2703 .
2704
27052 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 + U 10 M-- M-3 +
2706@end group
2707@end smallexample
2708
2709@cindex Unary operators
2710You can apply a ``unary operator'' like @kbd{&} to the top @var{n}
2711stack entries with a numeric prefix, too.
2712
2713@smallexample
2714@group
27153: 2 3: 0.5 3: 0.5
27162: 3 2: 0.333333333333 2: 3.
27171: 4 1: 0.25 1: 4.
2718 . . .
2719
27202 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 & M-2 &
2721@end group
2722@end smallexample
2723
2724Notice that the results here are left in floating-point form.
2725We can convert them back to integers by pressing @kbd{F}, the
2726``floor'' function. This function rounds down to the next lower
2727integer. There is also @kbd{R}, which rounds to the nearest
2728integer.
2729
2730@smallexample
2731@group
27327: 2. 7: 2 7: 2
27336: 2.4 6: 2 6: 2
27345: 2.5 5: 2 5: 3
27354: 2.6 4: 2 4: 3
27363: -2. 3: -2 3: -2
27372: -2.4 2: -3 2: -2
27381: -2.6 1: -3 1: -3
2739 . . .
2740
2741 M-7 F U M-7 R
2742@end group
2743@end smallexample
2744
2745Since dividing-and-flooring (i.e., ``integer quotient'') is such a
2746common operation, Calc provides a special command for that purpose, the
2747backslash @kbd{\}. Another common arithmetic operator is @kbd{%}, which
2748computes the remainder that would arise from a @kbd{\} operation, i.e.,
2749the ``modulo'' of two numbers. For example,
2750
2751@smallexample
2752@group
27532: 1234 1: 12 2: 1234 1: 34
27541: 100 . 1: 100 .
2755 . .
2756
27571234 @key{RET} 100 \ U %
2758@end group
2759@end smallexample
2760
2761These commands actually work for any real numbers, not just integers.
2762
2763@smallexample
2764@group
27652: 3.1415 1: 3 2: 3.1415 1: 0.1415
27661: 1 . 1: 1 .
2767 . .
2768
27693.1415 @key{RET} 1 \ U %
2770@end group
2771@end smallexample
2772
2773(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The @kbd{\} command would appear to be a
2774frill, since you could always do the same thing with @kbd{/ F}. Think
2775of a situation where this is not true---@kbd{/ F} would be inadequate.
2776Now think of a way you could get around the problem if Calc didn't
2777provide a @kbd{\} command. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2778
2779We've already seen the @kbd{Q} (square root) and @kbd{S} (sine)
2780commands. Other commands along those lines are @kbd{C} (cosine),
2781@kbd{T} (tangent), @kbd{E} (@expr{e^x}) and @kbd{L} (natural
2782logarithm). These can be modified by the @kbd{I} (inverse) and
2783@kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix keys.
2784
2785Let's compute the sine and cosine of an angle, and verify the
2786identity
2787@texline @math{\sin^2x + \cos^2x = 1}.
2788@infoline @expr{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}.
2789We'll arbitrarily pick @mathit{-64} degrees as a good value for @expr{x}.
2790With the angular mode set to degrees (type @w{@kbd{m d}}), do:
2791
2792@smallexample
2793@group
27942: -64 2: -64 2: -0.89879 2: -0.89879 1: 1.
27951: -64 1: -0.89879 1: -64 1: 0.43837 .
2796 . . . .
2797
2798 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} S @key{TAB} C f h
2799@end group
2800@end smallexample
2801
2802@noindent
2803(For brevity, we're showing only five digits of the results here.
2804You can of course do these calculations to any precision you like.)
2805
2806Remember, @kbd{f h} is the @code{calc-hypot}, or square-root of sum
2807of squares, command.
2808
2809Another identity is
2810@texline @math{\displaystyle\tan x = {\sin x \over \cos x}}.
2811@infoline @expr{tan(x) = sin(x) / cos(x)}.
2812@smallexample
2813@group
2814
28152: -0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
28161: 0.43837 . .
2817 .
2818
2819 U / I T
2820@end group
2821@end smallexample
2822
2823A physical interpretation of this calculation is that if you move
2824@expr{0.89879} units downward and @expr{0.43837} units to the right,
2825your direction of motion is @mathit{-64} degrees from horizontal. Suppose
2826we move in the opposite direction, up and to the left:
2827
2828@smallexample
2829@group
28302: -0.89879 2: 0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
28311: 0.43837 1: -0.43837 . .
2832 . .
2833
2834 U U M-2 n / I T
2835@end group
2836@end smallexample
2837
2838@noindent
2839How can the angle be the same? The answer is that the @kbd{/} operation
2840loses information about the signs of its inputs. Because the quotient
2841is negative, we know exactly one of the inputs was negative, but we
2842can't tell which one. There is an @kbd{f T} [@code{arctan2}] function which
2843computes the inverse tangent of the quotient of a pair of numbers.
2844Since you feed it the two original numbers, it has enough information
2845to give you a full 360-degree answer.
2846
2847@smallexample
2848@group
28492: 0.89879 1: 116. 3: 116. 2: 116. 1: 180.
28501: -0.43837 . 2: -0.89879 1: -64. .
2851 . 1: 0.43837 .
2852 .
2853
2854 U U f T M-@key{RET} M-2 n f T -
2855@end group
2856@end smallexample
2857
2858@noindent
2859The resulting angles differ by 180 degrees; in other words, they
2860point in opposite directions, just as we would expect.
2861
2862The @key{META}-@key{RET} we used in the third step is the
2863``last-arguments'' command. It is sort of like Undo, except that it
2864restores the arguments of the last command to the stack without removing
2865the command's result. It is useful in situations like this one,
2866where we need to do several operations on the same inputs. We could
2867have accomplished the same thing by using @kbd{M-2 @key{RET}} to duplicate
2868the top two stack elements right after the @kbd{U U}, then a pair of
2869@kbd{M-@key{TAB}} commands to cycle the 116 up around the duplicates.
2870
2871A similar identity is supposed to hold for hyperbolic sines and cosines,
2872except that it is the @emph{difference}
2873@texline @math{\cosh^2x - \sinh^2x}
2874@infoline @expr{cosh(x)^2 - sinh(x)^2}
2875that always equals one. Let's try to verify this identity.
2876
2877@smallexample
2878@group
28792: -64 2: -64 2: -64 2: 9.7192e54 2: 9.7192e54
28801: -64 1: -3.1175e27 1: 9.7192e54 1: -64 1: 9.7192e54
2881 . . . . .
2882
2883 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} H C 2 ^ @key{TAB} H S 2 ^
2884@end group
2885@end smallexample
2886
2887@noindent
2888@cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2889Something's obviously wrong, because when we subtract these numbers
2890the answer will clearly be zero! But if you think about it, if these
2891numbers @emph{did} differ by one, it would be in the 55th decimal
2892place. The difference we seek has been lost entirely to roundoff
2893error.
2894
2895We could verify this hypothesis by doing the actual calculation with,
2896say, 60 decimal places of precision. This will be slow, but not
2897enormously so. Try it if you wish; sure enough, the answer is
28980.99999, reasonably close to 1.
2899
2900Of course, a more reasonable way to verify the identity is to use
2901a more reasonable value for @expr{x}!
2902
2903@cindex Common logarithm
2904Some Calculator commands use the Hyperbolic prefix for other purposes.
2905The logarithm and exponential functions, for example, work to the base
2906@expr{e} normally but use base-10 instead if you use the Hyperbolic
2907prefix.
2908
2909@smallexample
2910@group
29111: 1000 1: 6.9077 1: 1000 1: 3
2912 . . . .
2913
2914 1000 L U H L
2915@end group
2916@end smallexample
2917
2918@noindent
2919First, we mistakenly compute a natural logarithm. Then we undo
2920and compute a common logarithm instead.
2921
2922The @kbd{B} key computes a general base-@var{b} logarithm for any
2923value of @var{b}.
2924
2925@smallexample
2926@group
29272: 1000 1: 3 1: 1000. 2: 1000. 1: 6.9077
29281: 10 . . 1: 2.71828 .
2929 . .
2930
2931 1000 @key{RET} 10 B H E H P B
2932@end group
2933@end smallexample
2934
2935@noindent
2936Here we first use @kbd{B} to compute the base-10 logarithm, then use
2937the ``hyperbolic'' exponential as a cheap hack to recover the number
29381000, then use @kbd{B} again to compute the natural logarithm. Note
2939that @kbd{P} with the hyperbolic prefix pushes the constant @expr{e}
2940onto the stack.
2941
2942You may have noticed that both times we took the base-10 logarithm
2943of 1000, we got an exact integer result. Calc always tries to give
2944an exact rational result for calculations involving rational numbers
2945where possible. But when we used @kbd{H E}, the result was a
2946floating-point number for no apparent reason. In fact, if we had
2947computed @kbd{10 @key{RET} 3 ^} we @emph{would} have gotten an
2948exact integer 1000. But the @kbd{H E} command is rigged to generate
2949a floating-point result all of the time so that @kbd{1000 H E} will
2950not waste time computing a thousand-digit integer when all you
2951probably wanted was @samp{1e1000}.
2952
2953(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Find a pair of integer inputs to
2954the @kbd{B} command for which Calc could find an exact rational
2955result but doesn't. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2956
2957The Calculator also has a set of functions relating to combinatorics
2958and statistics. You may be familiar with the @dfn{factorial} function,
2959which computes the product of all the integers up to a given number.
2960
2961@smallexample
2962@group
29631: 100 1: 93326215443... 1: 100. 1: 9.3326e157
2964 . . . .
2965
2966 100 ! U c f !
2967@end group
2968@end smallexample
2969
2970@noindent
2971Recall, the @kbd{c f} command converts the integer or fraction at the
2972top of the stack to floating-point format. If you take the factorial
2973of a floating-point number, you get a floating-point result
2974accurate to the current precision. But if you give @kbd{!} an
2975exact integer, you get an exact integer result (158 digits long
2976in this case).
2977
2978If you take the factorial of a non-integer, Calc uses a generalized
2979factorial function defined in terms of Euler's Gamma function
2980@texline @math{\Gamma(n)}
2981@infoline @expr{gamma(n)}
2982(which is itself available as the @kbd{f g} command).
2983
2984@smallexample
2985@group
29863: 4. 3: 24. 1: 5.5 1: 52.342777847
29872: 4.5 2: 52.3427777847 . .
29881: 5. 1: 120.
2989 . .
2990
2991 M-3 ! M-0 @key{DEL} 5.5 f g
2992@end group
2993@end smallexample
2994
2995@noindent
2996Here we verify the identity
2997@texline @math{n! = \Gamma(n+1)}.
2998@infoline @expr{@var{n}!@: = gamma(@var{n}+1)}.
2999
3000The binomial coefficient @var{n}-choose-@var{m}
3001@texline or @math{\displaystyle {n \choose m}}
3002is defined by
3003@texline @math{\displaystyle {n! \over m! \, (n-m)!}}
3004@infoline @expr{n!@: / m!@: (n-m)!}
3005for all reals @expr{n} and @expr{m}. The intermediate results in this
3006formula can become quite large even if the final result is small; the
3007@kbd{k c} command computes a binomial coefficient in a way that avoids
3008large intermediate values.
3009
3010The @kbd{k} prefix key defines several common functions out of
3011combinatorics and number theory. Here we compute the binomial
3012coefficient 30-choose-20, then determine its prime factorization.
3013
3014@smallexample
3015@group
30162: 30 1: 30045015 1: [3, 3, 5, 7, 11, 13, 23, 29]
30171: 20 . .
3018 .
3019
3020 30 @key{RET} 20 k c k f
3021@end group
3022@end smallexample
3023
3024@noindent
a8b14149
JB
3025You can verify these prime factors by using @kbd{V R *} to multiply
3026together the elements of this vector. The result is the original
3027number, 30045015.
4009494e
GM
3028
3029@cindex Hash tables
3030Suppose a program you are writing needs a hash table with at least
303110000 entries. It's best to use a prime number as the actual size
3032of a hash table. Calc can compute the next prime number after 10000:
3033
3034@smallexample
3035@group
30361: 10000 1: 10007 1: 9973
3037 . . .
3038
3039 10000 k n I k n
3040@end group
3041@end smallexample
3042
3043@noindent
3044Just for kicks we've also computed the next prime @emph{less} than
304510000.
3046
3047@c [fix-ref Financial Functions]
3048@xref{Financial Functions}, for a description of the Calculator
3049commands that deal with business and financial calculations (functions
3050like @code{pv}, @code{rate}, and @code{sln}).
3051
3052@c [fix-ref Binary Number Functions]
3053@xref{Binary Functions}, to read about the commands for operating
3054on binary numbers (like @code{and}, @code{xor}, and @code{lsh}).
3055
3056@node Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial
3057@section Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3058
3059@noindent
3060A @dfn{vector} is a list of numbers or other Calc data objects.
3061Calc provides a large set of commands that operate on vectors. Some
3062are familiar operations from vector analysis. Others simply treat
3063a vector as a list of objects.
3064
3065@menu
3066* Vector Analysis Tutorial::
3067* Matrix Tutorial::
3068* List Tutorial::
3069@end menu
3070
3071@node Vector Analysis Tutorial, Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3072@subsection Vector Analysis
3073
3074@noindent
3075If you add two vectors, the result is a vector of the sums of the
3076elements, taken pairwise.
3077
3078@smallexample
3079@group
30801: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [8, 8, 3]
3081 . 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3082 .
3083
3084 [1,2,3] s 1 [7 6 0] s 2 +
3085@end group
3086@end smallexample
3087
3088@noindent
3089Note that we can separate the vector elements with either commas or
3090spaces. This is true whether we are using incomplete vectors or
3091algebraic entry. The @kbd{s 1} and @kbd{s 2} commands save these
3092vectors so we can easily reuse them later.
3093
3094If you multiply two vectors, the result is the sum of the products
3095of the elements taken pairwise. This is called the @dfn{dot product}
3096of the vectors.
3097
3098@smallexample
3099@group
31002: [1, 2, 3] 1: 19
31011: [7, 6, 0] .
3102 .
3103
3104 r 1 r 2 *
3105@end group
3106@end smallexample
3107
3108@cindex Dot product
3109The dot product of two vectors is equal to the product of their
3110lengths times the cosine of the angle between them. (Here the vector
3111is interpreted as a line from the origin @expr{(0,0,0)} to the
3112specified point in three-dimensional space.) The @kbd{A}
3113(absolute value) command can be used to compute the length of a
3114vector.
3115
3116@smallexample
3117@group
31183: 19 3: 19 1: 0.550782 1: 56.579
31192: [1, 2, 3] 2: 3.741657 . .
31201: [7, 6, 0] 1: 9.219544
3121 . .
3122
3123 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / I C
3124@end group
3125@end smallexample
3126
3127@noindent
3128First we recall the arguments to the dot product command, then
3129we compute the absolute values of the top two stack entries to
3130obtain the lengths of the vectors, then we divide the dot product
3131by the product of the lengths to get the cosine of the angle.
3132The inverse cosine finds that the angle between the vectors
3133is about 56 degrees.
3134
3135@cindex Cross product
3136@cindex Perpendicular vectors
3137The @dfn{cross product} of two vectors is a vector whose length
3138is the product of the lengths of the inputs times the sine of the
3139angle between them, and whose direction is perpendicular to both
3140input vectors. Unlike the dot product, the cross product is
3141defined only for three-dimensional vectors. Let's double-check
3142our computation of the angle using the cross product.
3143
3144@smallexample
3145@group
31462: [1, 2, 3] 3: [-18, 21, -8] 1: [-0.52, 0.61, -0.23] 1: 56.579
31471: [7, 6, 0] 2: [1, 2, 3] . .
3148 . 1: [7, 6, 0]
3149 .
3150
3151 r 1 r 2 V C s 3 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / A I S
3152@end group
3153@end smallexample
3154
3155@noindent
3156First we recall the original vectors and compute their cross product,
3157which we also store for later reference. Now we divide the vector
3158by the product of the lengths of the original vectors. The length of
3159this vector should be the sine of the angle; sure enough, it is!
3160
3161@c [fix-ref General Mode Commands]
3162Vector-related commands generally begin with the @kbd{v} prefix key.
3163Some are uppercase letters and some are lowercase. To make it easier
3164to type these commands, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix key acts the same as
3165the @kbd{v} key. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to make all
3166prefix keys have this property.)
3167
3168If we take the dot product of two perpendicular vectors we expect
3169to get zero, since the cosine of 90 degrees is zero. Let's check
3170that the cross product is indeed perpendicular to both inputs:
3171
3172@smallexample
3173@group
31742: [1, 2, 3] 1: 0 2: [7, 6, 0] 1: 0
31751: [-18, 21, -8] . 1: [-18, 21, -8] .
3176 . .
3177
3178 r 1 r 3 * @key{DEL} r 2 r 3 *
3179@end group
3180@end smallexample
3181
3182@cindex Normalizing a vector
3183@cindex Unit vectors
3184(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Given a vector on the top of the
3185stack, what keystrokes would you use to @dfn{normalize} the
3186vector, i.e., to reduce its length to one without changing its
3187direction? @xref{Vector Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3188
3189(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Suppose a certain particle can be
3190at any of several positions along a ruler. You have a list of
3191those positions in the form of a vector, and another list of the
3192probabilities for the particle to be at the corresponding positions.
3193Find the average position of the particle.
3194@xref{Vector Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3195
3196@node Matrix Tutorial, List Tutorial, Vector Analysis Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3197@subsection Matrices
3198
3199@noindent
3200A @dfn{matrix} is just a vector of vectors, all the same length.
3201This means you can enter a matrix using nested brackets. You can
3202also use the semicolon character to enter a matrix. We'll show
3203both methods here:
3204
3205@smallexample
3206@group
32071: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3208 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3209 . .
3210
3211 [[1 2 3] [4 5 6]] ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6] @key{RET}
3212@end group
3213@end smallexample
3214
3215@noindent
3216We'll be using this matrix again, so type @kbd{s 4} to save it now.
3217
3218Note that semicolons work with incomplete vectors, but they work
3219better in algebraic entry. That's why we use the apostrophe in
3220the second example.
3221
3222When two matrices are multiplied, the lefthand matrix must have
3223the same number of columns as the righthand matrix has rows.
3224Row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of the result is effectively the
3225dot product of row @expr{i} of the left matrix by column @expr{j}
3226of the right matrix.
3227
3228If we try to duplicate this matrix and multiply it by itself,
3229the dimensions are wrong and the multiplication cannot take place:
3230
3231@smallexample
3232@group
32331: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] * [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3234 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3235 .
3236
3237 @key{RET} *
3238@end group
3239@end smallexample
3240
3241@noindent
3242Though rather hard to read, this is a formula which shows the product
3243of two matrices. The @samp{*} function, having invalid arguments, has
3244been left in symbolic form.
3245
3246We can multiply the matrices if we @dfn{transpose} one of them first.
3247
3248@smallexample
3249@group
32502: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 14, 32 ] 1: [ [ 17, 22, 27 ]
3251 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 32, 77 ] ] [ 22, 29, 36 ]
32521: [ [ 1, 4 ] . [ 27, 36, 45 ] ]
3253 [ 2, 5 ] .
3254 [ 3, 6 ] ]
3255 .
3256
3257 U v t * U @key{TAB} *
3258@end group
3259@end smallexample
3260
3261Matrix multiplication is not commutative; indeed, switching the
3262order of the operands can even change the dimensions of the result
3263matrix, as happened here!
3264
3265If you multiply a plain vector by a matrix, it is treated as a
3266single row or column depending on which side of the matrix it is
3267on. The result is a plain vector which should also be interpreted
3268as a row or column as appropriate.
3269
3270@smallexample
3271@group
32722: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [14, 32]
3273 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] .
32741: [1, 2, 3]
3275 .
3276
3277 r 4 r 1 *
3278@end group
3279@end smallexample
3280
3281Multiplying in the other order wouldn't work because the number of
3282rows in the matrix is different from the number of elements in the
3283vector.
3284
3285(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Use @samp{*} to sum along the rows
3286of the above
3287@texline @math{2\times3}
3288@infoline 2x3
3289matrix to get @expr{[6, 15]}. Now use @samp{*} to sum along the columns
3290to get @expr{[5, 7, 9]}.
3291@xref{Matrix Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3292
3293@cindex Identity matrix
3294An @dfn{identity matrix} is a square matrix with ones along the
3295diagonal and zeros elsewhere. It has the property that multiplication
3296by an identity matrix, on the left or on the right, always produces
3297the original matrix.
3298
3299@smallexample
3300@group
33011: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3302 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3303 . 1: [ [ 1, 0, 0 ] .
3304 [ 0, 1, 0 ]
3305 [ 0, 0, 1 ] ]
3306 .
3307
3308 r 4 v i 3 @key{RET} *
3309@end group
3310@end smallexample
3311
3312If a matrix is square, it is often possible to find its @dfn{inverse},
3313that is, a matrix which, when multiplied by the original matrix, yields
3314an identity matrix. The @kbd{&} (reciprocal) key also computes the
3315inverse of a matrix.
3316
3317@smallexample
3318@group
33191: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ -2.4, 1.2, -0.2 ]
3320 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2.8, -1.4, 0.4 ]
3321 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ -0.73333, 0.53333, -0.2 ] ]
3322 . .
3323
3324 r 4 r 2 | s 5 &
3325@end group
3326@end smallexample
3327
3328@noindent
3329The vertical bar @kbd{|} @dfn{concatenates} numbers, vectors, and
3330matrices together. Here we have used it to add a new row onto
3331our matrix to make it square.
3332
3333We can multiply these two matrices in either order to get an identity.
3334
3335@smallexample
3336@group
33371: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ] 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ]
3338 [ 0., 1., 0. ] [ 0., 1., 0. ]
3339 [ 0., 0., 1. ] ] [ 0., 0., 1. ] ]
3340 . .
3341
3342 M-@key{RET} * U @key{TAB} *
3343@end group
3344@end smallexample
3345
3346@cindex Systems of linear equations
3347@cindex Linear equations, systems of
3348Matrix inverses are related to systems of linear equations in algebra.
3349Suppose we had the following set of equations:
3350
3351@ifnottex
3352@group
3353@example
3354 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3355 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3356 7a + 6b = 3
3357@end example
3358@end group
3359@end ifnottex
3360@tex
4009494e
GM
3361\beforedisplayh
3362$$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3363\halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3364 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3365 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3366 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3367 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3368 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3369 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr}
3370$$
3371\afterdisplayh
3372@end tex
3373
3374@noindent
3375This can be cast into the matrix equation,
3376
3377@ifnottex
3378@group
3379@example
3380 [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] [ [ a ] [ [ 6 ]
3381 [ 4, 5, 6 ] * [ b ] = [ 2 ]
3382 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ c ] ] [ 3 ] ]
3383@end example
3384@end group
3385@end ifnottex
3386@tex
4009494e
GM
3387\beforedisplay
3388$$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 \cr 4 & 5 & 6 \cr 7 & 6 & 0 }
3389 \times
3390 \pmatrix{ a \cr b \cr c } = \pmatrix{ 6 \cr 2 \cr 3 }
3391$$
3392\afterdisplay
3393@end tex
3394
3395We can solve this system of equations by multiplying both sides by the
3396inverse of the matrix. Calc can do this all in one step:
3397
3398@smallexample
3399@group
34002: [6, 2, 3] 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
34011: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
3402 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
3403 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3404 .
3405
3406 [6,2,3] r 5 /
3407@end group
3408@end smallexample
3409
3410@noindent
3411The result is the @expr{[a, b, c]} vector that solves the equations.
3412(Dividing by a square matrix is equivalent to multiplying by its
3413inverse.)
3414
3415Let's verify this solution:
3416
3417@smallexample
3418@group
34192: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [6., 2., 3.]
3420 [ 4, 5, 6 ] .
3421 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
34221: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3423 .
3424
3425 r 5 @key{TAB} *
3426@end group
3427@end smallexample
3428
3429@noindent
3430Note that we had to be careful about the order in which we multiplied
3431the matrix and vector. If we multiplied in the other order, Calc would
3432assume the vector was a row vector in order to make the dimensions
3433come out right, and the answer would be incorrect. If you
3434don't feel safe letting Calc take either interpretation of your
3435vectors, use explicit
3436@texline @math{N\times1}
3437@infoline Nx1
3438or
3439@texline @math{1\times N}
3440@infoline 1xN
3441matrices instead. In this case, you would enter the original column
3442vector as @samp{[[6], [2], [3]]} or @samp{[6; 2; 3]}.
3443
3444(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Algebraic entry allows you to make
3445vectors and matrices that include variables. Solve the following
3446system of equations to get expressions for @expr{x} and @expr{y}
3447in terms of @expr{a} and @expr{b}.
3448
3449@ifnottex
3450@group
3451@example
3452 x + a y = 6
3453 x + b y = 10
3454@end example
3455@end group
3456@end ifnottex
3457@tex
4009494e
GM
3458\beforedisplay
3459$$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
3460 x &+ b y = 10}
3461$$
3462\afterdisplay
3463@end tex
3464
3465@noindent
3466@xref{Matrix Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3467
3468@cindex Least-squares for over-determined systems
3469@cindex Over-determined systems of equations
3470(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} A system of equations is ``over-determined''
3471if it has more equations than variables. It is often the case that
3472there are no values for the variables that will satisfy all the
3473equations at once, but it is still useful to find a set of values
3474which ``nearly'' satisfy all the equations. In terms of matrix equations,
3475you can't solve @expr{A X = B} directly because the matrix @expr{A}
3476is not square for an over-determined system. Matrix inversion works
3477only for square matrices. One common trick is to multiply both sides
3478on the left by the transpose of @expr{A}:
3479@ifnottex
3480@samp{trn(A)*A*X = trn(A)*B}.
3481@end ifnottex
3482@tex
4009494e
GM
3483$A^T A \, X = A^T B$, where $A^T$ is the transpose \samp{trn(A)}.
3484@end tex
3485Now
3486@texline @math{A^T A}
3487@infoline @expr{trn(A)*A}
3488is a square matrix so a solution is possible. It turns out that the
3489@expr{X} vector you compute in this way will be a ``least-squares''
3490solution, which can be regarded as the ``closest'' solution to the set
3491of equations. Use Calc to solve the following over-determined
3492system:
3493
3494@ifnottex
3495@group
3496@example
3497 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3498 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3499 7a + 6b = 3
3500 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
3501@end example
3502@end group
3503@end ifnottex
3504@tex
4009494e
GM
3505\beforedisplayh
3506$$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3507\halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3508 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3509 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3510 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3511 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3512 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3513 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
3514 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
3515$$
3516\afterdisplayh
3517@end tex
3518
3519@noindent
3520@xref{Matrix Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
3521
3522@node List Tutorial, , Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3523@subsection Vectors as Lists
3524
3525@noindent
3526@cindex Lists
3527Although Calc has a number of features for manipulating vectors and
3528matrices as mathematical objects, you can also treat vectors as
3529simple lists of values. For example, we saw that the @kbd{k f}
3530command returns a vector which is a list of the prime factors of a
3531number.
3532
3533You can pack and unpack stack entries into vectors:
3534
3535@smallexample
3536@group
35373: 10 1: [10, 20, 30] 3: 10
35382: 20 . 2: 20
35391: 30 1: 30
3540 . .
3541
3542 M-3 v p v u
3543@end group
3544@end smallexample
3545
3546You can also build vectors out of consecutive integers, or out
3547of many copies of a given value:
3548
3549@smallexample
3550@group
35511: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4]
3552 . 1: 17 1: [17, 17, 17, 17]
3553 . .
3554
3555 v x 4 @key{RET} 17 v b 4 @key{RET}
3556@end group
3557@end smallexample
3558
3559You can apply an operator to every element of a vector using the
3560@dfn{map} command.
3561
3562@smallexample
3563@group
35641: [17, 34, 51, 68] 1: [289, 1156, 2601, 4624] 1: [17, 34, 51, 68]
3565 . . .
3566
3567 V M * 2 V M ^ V M Q
3568@end group
3569@end smallexample
3570
3571@noindent
3572In the first step, we multiply the vector of integers by the vector
3573of 17's elementwise. In the second step, we raise each element to
3574the power two. (The general rule is that both operands must be
3575vectors of the same length, or else one must be a vector and the
3576other a plain number.) In the final step, we take the square root
3577of each element.
3578
3579(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Compute a vector of powers of two
3580from
3581@texline @math{2^{-4}}
3582@infoline @expr{2^-4}
3583to @expr{2^4}. @xref{List Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3584
3585You can also @dfn{reduce} a binary operator across a vector.
3586For example, reducing @samp{*} computes the product of all the
3587elements in the vector:
3588
3589@smallexample
3590@group
35911: 123123 1: [3, 7, 11, 13, 41] 1: 123123
3592 . . .
3593
3594 123123 k f V R *
3595@end group
3596@end smallexample
3597
3598@noindent
3599In this example, we decompose 123123 into its prime factors, then
3600multiply those factors together again to yield the original number.
3601
3602We could compute a dot product ``by hand'' using mapping and
3603reduction:
3604
3605@smallexample
3606@group
36072: [1, 2, 3] 1: [7, 12, 0] 1: 19
36081: [7, 6, 0] . .
3609 .
3610
3611 r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
3612@end group
3613@end smallexample
3614
3615@noindent
3616Recalling two vectors from the previous section, we compute the
3617sum of pairwise products of the elements to get the same answer
3618for the dot product as before.
3619
3620A slight variant of vector reduction is the @dfn{accumulate} operation,
3621@kbd{V U}. This produces a vector of the intermediate results from
3622a corresponding reduction. Here we compute a table of factorials:
3623
3624@smallexample
3625@group
36261: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] 1: [1, 2, 6, 24, 120, 720]
3627 . .
3628
3629 v x 6 @key{RET} V U *
3630@end group
3631@end smallexample
3632
3633Calc allows vectors to grow as large as you like, although it gets
3634rather slow if vectors have more than about a hundred elements.
3635Actually, most of the time is spent formatting these large vectors
3636for display, not calculating on them. Try the following experiment
3637(if your computer is very fast you may need to substitute a larger
3638vector size).
3639
3640@smallexample
3641@group
36421: [1, 2, 3, 4, ... 1: [2, 3, 4, 5, ...
3643 . .
3644
3645 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3646@end group
3647@end smallexample
3648
3649Now press @kbd{v .} (the letter @kbd{v}, then a period) and try the
3650experiment again. In @kbd{v .} mode, long vectors are displayed
3651``abbreviated'' like this:
3652
3653@smallexample
3654@group
36551: [1, 2, 3, ..., 500] 1: [2, 3, 4, ..., 501]
3656 . .
3657
3658 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3659@end group
3660@end smallexample
3661
3662@noindent
3663(where now the @samp{...} is actually part of the Calc display).
3664You will find both operations are now much faster. But notice that
3665even in @w{@kbd{v .}} mode, the full vectors are still shown in the Trail.
3666Type @w{@kbd{t .}} to cause the trail to abbreviate as well, and try the
3667experiment one more time. Operations on long vectors are now quite
3668fast! (But of course if you use @kbd{t .} you will lose the ability
3669to get old vectors back using the @kbd{t y} command.)
3670
3671An easy way to view a full vector when @kbd{v .} mode is active is
3672to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the vector; editing always works
3673with the full, unabbreviated value.
3674
3675@cindex Least-squares for fitting a straight line
3676@cindex Fitting data to a line
3677@cindex Line, fitting data to
3678@cindex Data, extracting from buffers
3679@cindex Columns of data, extracting
3680As a larger example, let's try to fit a straight line to some data,
3681using the method of least squares. (Calc has a built-in command for
3682least-squares curve fitting, but we'll do it by hand here just to
3683practice working with vectors.) Suppose we have the following list
3684of values in a file we have loaded into Emacs:
3685
3686@smallexample
3687 x y
3688 --- ---
3689 1.34 0.234
3690 1.41 0.298
3691 1.49 0.402
3692 1.56 0.412
3693 1.64 0.466
3694 1.73 0.473
3695 1.82 0.601
3696 1.91 0.519
3697 2.01 0.603
3698 2.11 0.637
3699 2.22 0.645
3700 2.33 0.705
3701 2.45 0.917
3702 2.58 1.009
3703 2.71 0.971
3704 2.85 1.062
3705 3.00 1.148
3706 3.15 1.157
3707 3.32 1.354
3708@end smallexample
3709
3710@noindent
3711If you are reading this tutorial in printed form, you will find it
3712easiest to press @kbd{C-x * i} to enter the on-line Info version of
3713the manual and find this table there. (Press @kbd{g}, then type
3714@kbd{List Tutorial}, to jump straight to this section.)
3715
3716Position the cursor at the upper-left corner of this table, just
3717to the left of the @expr{1.34}. Press @kbd{C-@@} to set the mark.
3718(On your system this may be @kbd{C-2}, @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}, or @kbd{NUL}.)
3719Now position the cursor to the lower-right, just after the @expr{1.354}.
3720You have now defined this region as an Emacs ``rectangle.'' Still
3721in the Info buffer, type @kbd{C-x * r}. This command
3722(@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) will pop you back into the Calculator, with
3723the contents of the rectangle you specified in the form of a matrix.
3724
3725@smallexample
3726@group
37271: [ [ 1.34, 0.234 ]
3728 [ 1.41, 0.298 ]
3729 @dots{}
3730@end group
3731@end smallexample
3732
3733@noindent
3734(You may wish to use @kbd{v .} mode to abbreviate the display of this
3735large matrix.)
3736
3737We want to treat this as a pair of lists. The first step is to
3738transpose this matrix into a pair of rows. Remember, a matrix is
3739just a vector of vectors. So we can unpack the matrix into a pair
3740of row vectors on the stack.
3741
3742@smallexample
3743@group
37441: [ [ 1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3745 [ 0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ] ] 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3746 . .
3747
3748 v t v u
3749@end group
3750@end smallexample
3751
3752@noindent
3753Let's store these in quick variables 1 and 2, respectively.
3754
3755@smallexample
3756@group
37571: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] .
3758 .
3759
3760 t 2 t 1
3761@end group
3762@end smallexample
3763
3764@noindent
3765(Recall that @kbd{t 2} is a variant of @kbd{s 2} that removes the
3766stored value from the stack.)
3767
3768In a least squares fit, the slope @expr{m} is given by the formula
3769
3770@ifnottex
3771@example
3772m = (N sum(x y) - sum(x) sum(y)) / (N sum(x^2) - sum(x)^2)
3773@end example
3774@end ifnottex
3775@tex
4009494e
GM
3776\beforedisplay
3777$$ m = {N \sum x y - \sum x \sum y \over
3778 N \sum x^2 - \left( \sum x \right)^2} $$
3779\afterdisplay
3780@end tex
3781
3782@noindent
3783where
3784@texline @math{\sum x}
3785@infoline @expr{sum(x)}
3786represents the sum of all the values of @expr{x}. While there is an
3787actual @code{sum} function in Calc, it's easier to sum a vector using a
3788simple reduction. First, let's compute the four different sums that
3789this formula uses.
3790
3791@smallexample
3792@group
37931: 41.63 1: 98.0003
3794 . .
3795
3796 r 1 V R + t 3 r 1 2 V M ^ V R + t 4
3797
3798@end group
3799@end smallexample
3800@noindent
3801@smallexample
3802@group
38031: 13.613 1: 33.36554
3804 . .
3805
3806 r 2 V R + t 5 r 1 r 2 V M * V R + t 6
3807@end group
3808@end smallexample
3809
3810@ifnottex
3811@noindent
3812These are @samp{sum(x)}, @samp{sum(x^2)}, @samp{sum(y)}, and @samp{sum(x y)},
3813respectively. (We could have used @kbd{*} to compute @samp{sum(x^2)} and
3814@samp{sum(x y)}.)
3815@end ifnottex
3816@tex
4009494e
GM
3817These are $\sum x$, $\sum x^2$, $\sum y$, and $\sum x y$,
3818respectively. (We could have used \kbd{*} to compute $\sum x^2$ and
3819$\sum x y$.)
3820@end tex
3821
3822Finally, we also need @expr{N}, the number of data points. This is just
3823the length of either of our lists.
3824
3825@smallexample
3826@group
38271: 19
3828 .
3829
3830 r 1 v l t 7
3831@end group
3832@end smallexample
3833
3834@noindent
3835(That's @kbd{v} followed by a lower-case @kbd{l}.)
3836
3837Now we grind through the formula:
3838
3839@smallexample
3840@group
38411: 633.94526 2: 633.94526 1: 67.23607
3842 . 1: 566.70919 .
3843 .
3844
3845 r 7 r 6 * r 3 r 5 * -
3846
3847@end group
3848@end smallexample
3849@noindent
3850@smallexample
3851@group
38522: 67.23607 3: 67.23607 2: 67.23607 1: 0.52141679
38531: 1862.0057 2: 1862.0057 1: 128.9488 .
3854 . 1: 1733.0569 .
3855 .
3856
3857 r 7 r 4 * r 3 2 ^ - / t 8
3858@end group
3859@end smallexample
3860
3861That gives us the slope @expr{m}. The y-intercept @expr{b} can now
3862be found with the simple formula,
3863
3864@ifnottex
3865@example
3866b = (sum(y) - m sum(x)) / N
3867@end example
3868@end ifnottex
3869@tex
4009494e
GM
3870\beforedisplay
3871$$ b = {\sum y - m \sum x \over N} $$
3872\afterdisplay
3873\vskip10pt
3874@end tex
3875
3876@smallexample
3877@group
38781: 13.613 2: 13.613 1: -8.09358 1: -0.425978
3879 . 1: 21.70658 . .
3880 .
3881
3882 r 5 r 8 r 3 * - r 7 / t 9
3883@end group
3884@end smallexample
3885
3886Let's ``plot'' this straight line approximation,
3887@texline @math{y \approx m x + b},
3888@infoline @expr{m x + b},
3889and compare it with the original data.
3890
3891@smallexample
3892@group
38931: [0.699, 0.735, ... ] 1: [0.273, 0.309, ... ]
3894 . .
3895
3896 r 1 r 8 * r 9 + s 0
3897@end group
3898@end smallexample
3899
3900@noindent
3901Notice that multiplying a vector by a constant, and adding a constant
3902to a vector, can be done without mapping commands since these are
3903common operations from vector algebra. As far as Calc is concerned,
3904we've just been doing geometry in 19-dimensional space!
3905
3906We can subtract this vector from our original @expr{y} vector to get
3907a feel for the error of our fit. Let's find the maximum error:
3908
3909@smallexample
3910@group
39111: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: 0.0897
3912 . . .
3913
3914 r 2 - V M A V R X
3915@end group
3916@end smallexample
3917
3918@noindent
3919First we compute a vector of differences, then we take the absolute
3920values of these differences, then we reduce the @code{max} function
3921across the vector. (The @code{max} function is on the two-key sequence
3922@kbd{f x}; because it is so common to use @code{max} in a vector
3923operation, the letters @kbd{X} and @kbd{N} are also accepted for
3924@code{max} and @code{min} in this context. In general, you answer
3925the @kbd{V M} or @kbd{V R} prompt with the actual key sequence that
3926invokes the function you want. You could have typed @kbd{V R f x} or
3927even @kbd{V R x max @key{RET}} if you had preferred.)
3928
3929If your system has the GNUPLOT program, you can see graphs of your
3930data and your straight line to see how well they match. (If you have
3931GNUPLOT 3.0 or higher, the following instructions will work regardless
3932of the kind of display you have. Some GNUPLOT 2.0, non-X-windows systems
3933may require additional steps to view the graphs.)
3934
3935Let's start by plotting the original data. Recall the ``@var{x}'' and ``@var{y}''
3936vectors onto the stack and press @kbd{g f}. This ``fast'' graphing
3937command does everything you need to do for simple, straightforward
3938plotting of data.
3939
3940@smallexample
3941@group
39422: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
39431: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3944 .
3945
3946 r 1 r 2 g f
3947@end group
3948@end smallexample
3949
3950If all goes well, you will shortly get a new window containing a graph
3951of the data. (If not, contact your GNUPLOT or Calc installer to find
3952out what went wrong.) In the X window system, this will be a separate
3953graphics window. For other kinds of displays, the default is to
3954display the graph in Emacs itself using rough character graphics.
3955Press @kbd{q} when you are done viewing the character graphics.
3956
3957Next, let's add the line we got from our least-squares fit.
3958@ifinfo
3959(If you are reading this tutorial on-line while running Calc, typing
3960@kbd{g a} may cause the tutorial to disappear from its window and be
3961replaced by a buffer named @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}. The tutorial
3962will reappear when you terminate GNUPLOT by typing @kbd{g q}.)
3963@end ifinfo
3964
3965@smallexample
3966@group
39672: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
39681: [0.273, 0.309, 0.351, ... ]
3969 .
3970
3971 @key{DEL} r 0 g a g p
3972@end group
3973@end smallexample
3974
3975It's not very useful to get symbols to mark the data points on this
3976second curve; you can type @kbd{g S g p} to remove them. Type @kbd{g q}
3977when you are done to remove the X graphics window and terminate GNUPLOT.
3978
3979(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} An earlier exercise showed how to do
3980least squares fitting to a general system of equations. Our 19 data
3981points are really 19 equations of the form @expr{y_i = m x_i + b} for
3982different pairs of @expr{(x_i,y_i)}. Use the matrix-transpose method
3983to solve for @expr{m} and @expr{b}, duplicating the above result.
3984@xref{List Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3985
3986@cindex Geometric mean
3987(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} If the input data do not form a
3988rectangle, you can use @w{@kbd{C-x * g}} (@code{calc-grab-region})
3989to grab the data the way Emacs normally works with regions---it reads
3990left-to-right, top-to-bottom, treating line breaks the same as spaces.
3991Use this command to find the geometric mean of the following numbers.
3992(The geometric mean is the @var{n}th root of the product of @var{n} numbers.)
3993
3994@example
39952.3 6 22 15.1 7
3996 15 14 7.5
3997 2.5
3998@end example
3999
4000@noindent
4001The @kbd{C-x * g} command accepts numbers separated by spaces or commas,
4002with or without surrounding vector brackets.
4003@xref{List Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4004
4005@ifnottex
4006As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4007us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4008@var{n}-choose-0 minus @var{n}-choose-1 plus @var{n}-choose-2, and so
4009on up to @var{n}-choose-@var{n},
4010always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4011for @expr{n=6}.
4012@end ifnottex
4013@tex
4014As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4015us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4016${n \choose 0} - {n \choose 1} + {n \choose 2} - \cdots \pm {n \choose n}$
4017always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4018for \cite{n=6}.
4019@end tex
4020
4021@smallexample
4022@group
40231: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7] 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
4024 . .
4025
4026 v x 7 @key{RET} 1 -
4027
4028@end group
4029@end smallexample
4030@noindent
4031@smallexample
4032@group
40331: [1, -6, 15, -20, 15, -6, 1] 1: 0
4034 . .
4035
4036 V M ' (-1)^$ choose(6,$) @key{RET} V R +
4037@end group
4038@end smallexample
4039
4040The @kbd{V M '} command prompts you to enter any algebraic expression
4041to define the function to map over the vector. The symbol @samp{$}
4042inside this expression represents the argument to the function.
4043The Calculator applies this formula to each element of the vector,
4044substituting each element's value for the @samp{$} sign(s) in turn.
4045
4046To define a two-argument function, use @samp{$$} for the first
4047argument and @samp{$} for the second: @kbd{V M ' $$-$ @key{RET}} is
4048equivalent to @kbd{V M -}. This is analogous to regular algebraic
4049entry, where @samp{$$} would refer to the next-to-top stack entry
4050and @samp{$} would refer to the top stack entry, and @kbd{' $$-$ @key{RET}}
4051would act exactly like @kbd{-}.
4052
4053Notice that the @kbd{V M '} command has recorded two things in the
4054trail: The result, as usual, and also a funny-looking thing marked
4055@samp{oper} that represents the operator function you typed in.
4056The function is enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets, and the argument is
4057denoted by a @samp{#} sign. If there were several arguments, they
4058would be shown as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on. (For example,
4059@kbd{V M ' $$-$} will put the function @samp{<#1 - #2>} on the
4060trail.) This object is a ``nameless function''; you can use nameless
4061@w{@samp{< >}} notation to answer the @kbd{V M '} prompt if you like.
4062Nameless function notation has the interesting, occasionally useful
4063property that a nameless function is not actually evaluated until
4064it is used. For example, @kbd{V M ' $+random(2.0)} evaluates
4065@samp{random(2.0)} once and adds that random number to all elements
4066of the vector, but @kbd{V M ' <#+random(2.0)>} evaluates the
4067@samp{random(2.0)} separately for each vector element.
4068
4069Another group of operators that are often useful with @kbd{V M} are
4070the relational operators: @kbd{a =}, for example, compares two numbers
4071and gives the result 1 if they are equal, or 0 if not. Similarly,
4072@w{@kbd{a <}} checks for one number being less than another.
4073
4074Other useful vector operations include @kbd{v v}, to reverse a
4075vector end-for-end; @kbd{V S}, to sort the elements of a vector
4076into increasing order; and @kbd{v r} and @w{@kbd{v c}}, to extract
4077one row or column of a matrix, or (in both cases) to extract one
4078element of a plain vector. With a negative argument, @kbd{v r}
4079and @kbd{v c} instead delete one row, column, or vector element.
4080
4081@cindex Divisor functions
4082(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The @expr{k}th @dfn{divisor function}
4083@tex
4084$\sigma_k(n)$
4085@end tex
4086is the sum of the @expr{k}th powers of all the divisors of an
4087integer @expr{n}. Figure out a method for computing the divisor
4088function for reasonably small values of @expr{n}. As a test,
4089the 0th and 1st divisor functions of 30 are 8 and 72, respectively.
4090@xref{List Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4091
4092@cindex Square-free numbers
4093@cindex Duplicate values in a list
4094(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @kbd{k f} command produces a
4095list of prime factors for a number. Sometimes it is important to
4096know that a number is @dfn{square-free}, i.e., that no prime occurs
4097more than once in its list of prime factors. Find a sequence of
4098keystrokes to tell if a number is square-free; your method should
4099leave 1 on the stack if it is, or 0 if it isn't.
4100@xref{List Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4101
4102@cindex Triangular lists
4103(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Build a list of lists that looks
4104like the following diagram. (You may wish to use the @kbd{v /}
4105command to enable multi-line display of vectors.)
4106
4107@smallexample
4108@group
41091: [ [1],
4110 [1, 2],
4111 [1, 2, 3],
4112 [1, 2, 3, 4],
4113 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5],
4114 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] ]
4115@end group
4116@end smallexample
4117
4118@noindent
4119@xref{List Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4120
4121(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Build the following list of lists.
4122
4123@smallexample
4124@group
41251: [ [0],
4126 [1, 2],
4127 [3, 4, 5],
4128 [6, 7, 8, 9],
4129 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
4130 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
4131@end group
4132@end smallexample
4133
4134@noindent
4135@xref{List Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4136
4137@cindex Maximizing a function over a list of values
4138@c [fix-ref Numerical Solutions]
4139(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} Compute a list of values of Bessel's
4140@texline @math{J_1(x)}
4141@infoline @expr{J1}
4142function @samp{besJ(1,x)} for @expr{x} from 0 to 5 in steps of 0.25.
4143Find the value of @expr{x} (from among the above set of values) for
4144which @samp{besJ(1,x)} is a maximum. Use an ``automatic'' method,
4145i.e., just reading along the list by hand to find the largest value
4146is not allowed! (There is an @kbd{a X} command which does this kind
4147of thing automatically; @pxref{Numerical Solutions}.)
4148@xref{List Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4149
4150@cindex Digits, vectors of
4151(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} You are given an integer in the range
4152@texline @math{0 \le N < 10^m}
4153@infoline @expr{0 <= N < 10^m}
4154for @expr{m=12} (i.e., an integer of less than
4155twelve digits). Convert this integer into a vector of @expr{m}
4156digits, each in the range from 0 to 9. In vector-of-digits notation,
4157add one to this integer to produce a vector of @expr{m+1} digits
4158(since there could be a carry out of the most significant digit).
4159Convert this vector back into a regular integer. A good integer
4160to try is 25129925999. @xref{List Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4161
4162(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Your friend Joe tried to use
4163@kbd{V R a =} to test if all numbers in a list were equal. What
4164happened? How would you do this test? @xref{List Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4165
4166(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The area of a circle of radius one
4167is @cpi{}. The area of the
4168@texline @math{2\times2}
4169@infoline 2x2
4170square that encloses that circle is 4. So if we throw @var{n} darts at
4171random points in the square, about @cpiover{4} of them will land inside
4172the circle. This gives us an entertaining way to estimate the value of
4173@cpi{}. The @w{@kbd{k r}}
4174command picks a random number between zero and the value on the stack.
4175We could get a random floating-point number between @mathit{-1} and 1 by typing
4176@w{@kbd{2.0 k r 1 -}}. Build a vector of 100 random @expr{(x,y)} points in
4177this square, then use vector mapping and reduction to count how many
4178points lie inside the unit circle. Hint: Use the @kbd{v b} command.
4179@xref{List Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4180
4181@cindex Matchstick problem
4182(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} The @dfn{matchstick problem} provides
4183another way to calculate @cpi{}. Say you have an infinite field
4184of vertical lines with a spacing of one inch. Toss a one-inch matchstick
4185onto the field. The probability that the matchstick will land crossing
4186a line turns out to be
4187@texline @math{2/\pi}.
4188@infoline @expr{2/pi}.
4189Toss 100 matchsticks to estimate @cpi{}. (If you want still more fun,
4190the probability that the GCD (@w{@kbd{k g}}) of two large integers is
4191one turns out to be
4192@texline @math{6/\pi^2}.
4193@infoline @expr{6/pi^2}.
4194That provides yet another way to estimate @cpi{}.)
4195@xref{List Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4196
4197(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} An algebraic entry of a string in
4198double-quote marks, @samp{"hello"}, creates a vector of the numerical
4199(ASCII) codes of the characters (here, @expr{[104, 101, 108, 108, 111]}).
4200Sometimes it is convenient to compute a @dfn{hash code} of a string,
4201which is just an integer that represents the value of that string.
4202Two equal strings have the same hash code; two different strings
4203@dfn{probably} have different hash codes. (For example, Calc has
4204over 400 function names, but Emacs can quickly find the definition for
4205any given name because it has sorted the functions into ``buckets'' by
4206their hash codes. Sometimes a few names will hash into the same bucket,
4207but it is easier to search among a few names than among all the names.)
4208One popular hash function is computed as follows: First set @expr{h = 0}.
4209Then, for each character from the string in turn, set @expr{h = 3h + c_i}
4210where @expr{c_i} is the character's ASCII code. If we have 511 buckets,
4211we then take the hash code modulo 511 to get the bucket number. Develop a
4212simple command or commands for converting string vectors into hash codes.
4213The hash code for @samp{"Testing, 1, 2, 3"} is 1960915098, which modulo
4214511 is 121. @xref{List Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4215
4216(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} The @kbd{H V R} and @kbd{H V U}
4217commands do nested function evaluations. @kbd{H V U} takes a starting
4218value and a number of steps @var{n} from the stack; it then applies the
4219function you give to the starting value 0, 1, 2, up to @var{n} times
4220and returns a vector of the results. Use this command to create a
4221``random walk'' of 50 steps. Start with the two-dimensional point
4222@expr{(0,0)}; then take one step a random distance between @mathit{-1} and 1
4223in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}; then take another step, and so on. Use the
4224@kbd{g f} command to display this random walk. Now modify your random
4225walk to walk a unit distance, but in a random direction, at each step.
4226(Hint: The @code{sincos} function returns a vector of the cosine and
4227sine of an angle.) @xref{List Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4228
4229@node Types Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Tutorial
4230@section Types Tutorial
4231
4232@noindent
4233Calc understands a variety of data types as well as simple numbers.
4234In this section, we'll experiment with each of these types in turn.
4235
4236The numbers we've been using so far have mainly been either @dfn{integers}
4237or @dfn{floats}. We saw that floats are usually a good approximation to
4238the mathematical concept of real numbers, but they are only approximations
4239and are susceptible to roundoff error. Calc also supports @dfn{fractions},
4240which can exactly represent any rational number.
4241
4242@smallexample
4243@group
42441: 3628800 2: 3628800 1: 518400:7 1: 518414:7 1: 7:518414
4245 . 1: 49 . . .
4246 .
4247
4248 10 ! 49 @key{RET} : 2 + &
4249@end group
4250@end smallexample
4251
4252@noindent
4253The @kbd{:} command divides two integers to get a fraction; @kbd{/}
4254would normally divide integers to get a floating-point result.
4255Notice we had to type @key{RET} between the @kbd{49} and the @kbd{:}
4256since the @kbd{:} would otherwise be interpreted as part of a
4257fraction beginning with 49.
4258
4259You can convert between floating-point and fractional format using
4260@kbd{c f} and @kbd{c F}:
4261
4262@smallexample
4263@group
42641: 1.35027217629e-5 1: 7:518414
4265 . .
4266
4267 c f c F
4268@end group
4269@end smallexample
4270
4271The @kbd{c F} command replaces a floating-point number with the
4272``simplest'' fraction whose floating-point representation is the
4273same, to within the current precision.
4274
4275@smallexample
4276@group
42771: 3.14159265359 1: 1146408:364913 1: 3.1416 1: 355:113
4278 . . . .
4279
4280 P c F @key{DEL} p 5 @key{RET} P c F
4281@end group
4282@end smallexample
4283
4284(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} A calculation has produced the
4285result 1.26508260337. You suspect it is the square root of the
4286product of @cpi{} and some rational number. Is it? (Be sure
4287to allow for roundoff error!) @xref{Types Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4288
4289@dfn{Complex numbers} can be stored in both rectangular and polar form.
4290
4291@smallexample
4292@group
42931: -9 1: (0, 3) 1: (3; 90.) 1: (6; 90.) 1: (2.4495; 45.)
4294 . . . . .
4295
4296 9 n Q c p 2 * Q
4297@end group
4298@end smallexample
4299
4300@noindent
4301The square root of @mathit{-9} is by default rendered in rectangular form
4302(@w{@expr{0 + 3i}}), but we can convert it to polar form (3 with a
4303phase angle of 90 degrees). All the usual arithmetic and scientific
4304operations are defined on both types of complex numbers.
4305
4306Another generalized kind of number is @dfn{infinity}. Infinity
4307isn't really a number, but it can sometimes be treated like one.
4308Calc uses the symbol @code{inf} to represent positive infinity,
4309i.e., a value greater than any real number. Naturally, you can
4310also write @samp{-inf} for minus infinity, a value less than any
4311real number. The word @code{inf} can only be input using
4312algebraic entry.
4313
4314@smallexample
4315@group
43162: inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 1: nan
43171: -17 1: -inf 1: -inf 1: inf .
4318 . . . .
4319
4320' inf @key{RET} 17 n * @key{RET} 72 + A +
4321@end group
4322@end smallexample
4323
4324@noindent
4325Since infinity is infinitely large, multiplying it by any finite
4326number (like @mathit{-17}) has no effect, except that since @mathit{-17}
4327is negative, it changes a plus infinity to a minus infinity.
4328(``A huge positive number, multiplied by @mathit{-17}, yields a huge
4329negative number.'') Adding any finite number to infinity also
4330leaves it unchanged. Taking an absolute value gives us plus
4331infinity again. Finally, we add this plus infinity to the minus
4332infinity we had earlier. If you work it out, you might expect
4333the answer to be @mathit{-72} for this. But the 72 has been completely
4334lost next to the infinities; by the time we compute @w{@samp{inf - inf}}
4335the finite difference between them, if any, is undetectable.
4336So we say the result is @dfn{indeterminate}, which Calc writes
4337with the symbol @code{nan} (for Not A Number).
4338
4339Dividing by zero is normally treated as an error, but you can get
4340Calc to write an answer in terms of infinity by pressing @kbd{m i}
4341to turn on Infinite mode.
4342
4343@smallexample
4344@group
43453: nan 2: nan 2: nan 2: nan 1: nan
43462: 1 1: 1 / 0 1: uinf 1: uinf .
43471: 0 . . .
4348 .
4349
4350 1 @key{RET} 0 / m i U / 17 n * +
4351@end group
4352@end smallexample
4353
4354@noindent
4355Dividing by zero normally is left unevaluated, but after @kbd{m i}
4356it instead gives an infinite result. The answer is actually
4357@code{uinf}, ``undirected infinity.'' If you look at a graph of
4358@expr{1 / x} around @w{@expr{x = 0}}, you'll see that it goes toward
4359plus infinity as you approach zero from above, but toward minus
4360infinity as you approach from below. Since we said only @expr{1 / 0},
4361Calc knows that the answer is infinite but not in which direction.
4362That's what @code{uinf} means. Notice that multiplying @code{uinf}
4363by a negative number still leaves plain @code{uinf}; there's no
4364point in saying @samp{-uinf} because the sign of @code{uinf} is
4365unknown anyway. Finally, we add @code{uinf} to our @code{nan},
4366yielding @code{nan} again. It's easy to see that, because
4367@code{nan} means ``totally unknown'' while @code{uinf} means
4368``unknown sign but known to be infinite,'' the more mysterious
4369@code{nan} wins out when it is combined with @code{uinf}, or, for
4370that matter, with anything else.
4371
4372(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Predict what Calc will answer
4373for each of these formulas: @samp{inf / inf}, @samp{exp(inf)},
4374@samp{exp(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(uinf)},
4375@samp{abs(uinf)}, @samp{ln(0)}.
4376@xref{Types Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4377
4378(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} We saw that @samp{inf - inf = nan},
4379which stands for an unknown value. Can @code{nan} stand for
4380a complex number? Can it stand for infinity?
4381@xref{Types Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4382
4383@dfn{HMS forms} represent a value in terms of hours, minutes, and
4384seconds.
4385
4386@smallexample
4387@group
43881: 2@@ 30' 0" 1: 3@@ 30' 0" 2: 3@@ 30' 0" 1: 2.
4389 . . 1: 1@@ 45' 0." .
4390 .
4391
4392 2@@ 30' @key{RET} 1 + @key{RET} 2 / /
4393@end group
4394@end smallexample
4395
4396HMS forms can also be used to hold angles in degrees, minutes, and
4397seconds.
4398
4399@smallexample
4400@group
44011: 0.5 1: 26.56505 1: 26@@ 33' 54.18" 1: 0.44721
4402 . . . .
4403
4404 0.5 I T c h S
4405@end group
4406@end smallexample
4407
4408@noindent
4409First we convert the inverse tangent of 0.5 to degrees-minutes-seconds
4410form, then we take the sine of that angle. Note that the trigonometric
4411functions will accept HMS forms directly as input.
4412
4413@cindex Beatles
4414(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The Beatles' @emph{Abbey Road} is
441547 minutes and 26 seconds long, and contains 17 songs. What is the
4416average length of a song on @emph{Abbey Road}? If the Extended Disco
4417Version of @emph{Abbey Road} added 20 seconds to the length of each
4418song, how long would the album be? @xref{Types Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4419
4420A @dfn{date form} represents a date, or a date and time. Dates must
4421be entered using algebraic entry. Date forms are surrounded by
4422@samp{< >} symbols; most standard formats for dates are recognized.
4423
4424@smallexample
4425@group
44262: <Sun Jan 13, 1991> 1: 2.25
44271: <6:00pm Thu Jan 10, 1991> .
4428 .
4429
4430' <13 Jan 1991>, <1/10/91, 6pm> @key{RET} -
4431@end group
4432@end smallexample
4433
4434@noindent
4435In this example, we enter two dates, then subtract to find the
4436number of days between them. It is also possible to add an
4437HMS form or a number (of days) to a date form to get another
4438date form.
4439
4440@smallexample
4441@group
44421: <4:45:59pm Mon Jan 14, 1991> 1: <2:50:59am Thu Jan 17, 1991>
4443 . .
4444
4445 t N 2 + 10@@ 5' +
4446@end group
4447@end smallexample
4448
4449@c [fix-ref Date Arithmetic]
4450@noindent
4451The @kbd{t N} (``now'') command pushes the current date and time on the
4452stack; then we add two days, ten hours and five minutes to the date and
4453time. Other date-and-time related commands include @kbd{t J}, which
4454does Julian day conversions, @kbd{t W}, which finds the beginning of
4455the week in which a date form lies, and @kbd{t I}, which increments a
4456date by one or several months. @xref{Date Arithmetic}, for more.
4457
4458(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} How many days until the next
4459Friday the 13th? @xref{Types Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4460
4461(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} How many leap years will there be
4462between now and the year 10001 A.D.? @xref{Types Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4463
4464@cindex Slope and angle of a line
4465@cindex Angle and slope of a line
4466An @dfn{error form} represents a mean value with an attached standard
4467deviation, or error estimate. Suppose our measurements indicate that
4468a certain telephone pole is about 30 meters away, with an estimated
4469error of 1 meter, and 8 meters tall, with an estimated error of 0.2
4470meters. What is the slope of a line from here to the top of the
4471pole, and what is the equivalent angle in degrees?
4472
4473@smallexample
4474@group
44751: 8 +/- 0.2 2: 8 +/- 0.2 1: 0.266 +/- 0.011 1: 14.93 +/- 0.594
4476 . 1: 30 +/- 1 . .
4477 .
4478
4479 8 p .2 @key{RET} 30 p 1 / I T
4480@end group
4481@end smallexample
4482
4483@noindent
4484This means that the angle is about 15 degrees, and, assuming our
4485original error estimates were valid standard deviations, there is about
4486a 60% chance that the result is correct within 0.59 degrees.
4487
4488@cindex Torus, volume of
4489(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} The volume of a torus (a donut shape) is
4490@texline @math{2 \pi^2 R r^2}
4491@infoline @w{@expr{2 pi^2 R r^2}}
4492where @expr{R} is the radius of the circle that
4493defines the center of the tube and @expr{r} is the radius of the tube
4494itself. Suppose @expr{R} is 20 cm and @expr{r} is 4 cm, each known to
4495within 5 percent. What is the volume and the relative uncertainty of
4496the volume? @xref{Types Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4497
4498An @dfn{interval form} represents a range of values. While an
4499error form is best for making statistical estimates, intervals give
4500you exact bounds on an answer. Suppose we additionally know that
4501our telephone pole is definitely between 28 and 31 meters away,
4502and that it is between 7.7 and 8.1 meters tall.
4503
4504@smallexample
4505@group
45061: [7.7 .. 8.1] 2: [7.7 .. 8.1] 1: [0.24 .. 0.28] 1: [13.9 .. 16.1]
4507 . 1: [28 .. 31] . .
4508 .
4509
4510 [ 7.7 .. 8.1 ] [ 28 .. 31 ] / I T
4511@end group
4512@end smallexample
4513
4514@noindent
4515If our bounds were correct, then the angle to the top of the pole
4516is sure to lie in the range shown.
4517
4518The square brackets around these intervals indicate that the endpoints
4519themselves are allowable values. In other words, the distance to the
4520telephone pole is between 28 and 31, @emph{inclusive}. You can also
4521make an interval that is exclusive of its endpoints by writing
4522parentheses instead of square brackets. You can even make an interval
4523which is inclusive (``closed'') on one end and exclusive (``open'') on
4524the other.
4525
4526@smallexample
4527@group
45281: [1 .. 10) 1: (0.1 .. 1] 2: (0.1 .. 1] 1: (0.2 .. 3)
4529 . . 1: [2 .. 3) .
4530 .
4531
4532 [ 1 .. 10 ) & [ 2 .. 3 ) *
4533@end group
4534@end smallexample
4535
4536@noindent
4537The Calculator automatically keeps track of which end values should
4538be open and which should be closed. You can also make infinite or
4539semi-infinite intervals by using @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} for one
4540or both endpoints.
4541
4542(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} What answer would you expect from
4543@samp{@w{1 /} @w{(0 .. 10)}}? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 0)}}? What
4544about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{[0 .. 10]}} (where the interval actually includes
4545zero)? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 10)}}?
4546@xref{Types Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4547
4548(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} Two easy ways of squaring a number
4549are @kbd{@key{RET} *} and @w{@kbd{2 ^}}. Normally these produce the same
4550answer. Would you expect this still to hold true for interval forms?
4551If not, which of these will result in a larger interval?
4552@xref{Types Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4553
4554A @dfn{modulo form} is used for performing arithmetic modulo @var{m}.
4555For example, arithmetic involving time is generally done modulo 12
4556or 24 hours.
4557
4558@smallexample
4559@group
45601: 17 mod 24 1: 3 mod 24 1: 21 mod 24 1: 9 mod 24
4561 . . . .
4562
4563 17 M 24 @key{RET} 10 + n 5 /
4564@end group
4565@end smallexample
4566
4567@noindent
4568In this last step, Calc has divided by 5 modulo 24; i.e., it has found a
4569new number which, when multiplied by 5 modulo 24, produces the original
4570number, 21. If @var{m} is prime and the divisor is not a multiple of
4571@var{m}, it is always possible to find such a number. For non-prime
4572@var{m} like 24, it is only sometimes possible.
4573
4574@smallexample
4575@group
45761: 10 mod 24 1: 16 mod 24 1: 1000000... 1: 16
4577 . . . .
4578
4579 10 M 24 @key{RET} 100 ^ 10 @key{RET} 100 ^ 24 %
4580@end group
4581@end smallexample
4582
4583@noindent
4584These two calculations get the same answer, but the first one is
4585much more efficient because it avoids the huge intermediate value
4586that arises in the second one.
4587
4588@cindex Fermat, primality test of
4589(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} A theorem of Pierre de Fermat
4590says that
4591@texline @w{@math{x^{n-1} \bmod n = 1}}
4592@infoline @expr{x^(n-1) mod n = 1}
4593if @expr{n} is a prime number and @expr{x} is an integer less than
4594@expr{n}. If @expr{n} is @emph{not} a prime number, this will
4595@emph{not} be true for most values of @expr{x}. Thus we can test
4596informally if a number is prime by trying this formula for several
4597values of @expr{x}. Use this test to tell whether the following numbers
4598are prime: 811749613, 15485863. @xref{Types Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4599
4600It is possible to use HMS forms as parts of error forms, intervals,
4601modulo forms, or as the phase part of a polar complex number.
4602For example, the @code{calc-time} command pushes the current time
4603of day on the stack as an HMS/modulo form.
4604
4605@smallexample
4606@group
46071: 17@@ 34' 45" mod 24@@ 0' 0" 1: 6@@ 22' 15" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
4608 . .
4609
4610 x time @key{RET} n
4611@end group
4612@end smallexample
4613
4614@noindent
4615This calculation tells me it is six hours and 22 minutes until midnight.
4616
4617(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} A rule of thumb is that one year
4618is about
4619@texline @math{\pi \times 10^7}
4620@infoline @w{@expr{pi * 10^7}}
4621seconds. What time will it be that many seconds from right now?
4622@xref{Types Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4623
4624(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} You are preparing to order packaging
4625for the CD release of the Extended Disco Version of @emph{Abbey Road}.
4626You are told that the songs will actually be anywhere from 20 to 60
4627seconds longer than the originals. One CD can hold about 75 minutes
4628of music. Should you order single or double packages?
4629@xref{Types Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4630
4631Another kind of data the Calculator can manipulate is numbers with
4632@dfn{units}. This isn't strictly a new data type; it's simply an
4633application of algebraic expressions, where we use variables with
4634suggestive names like @samp{cm} and @samp{in} to represent units
4635like centimeters and inches.
4636
4637@smallexample
4638@group
46391: 2 in 1: 5.08 cm 1: 0.027778 fath 1: 0.0508 m
4640 . . . .
4641
4642 ' 2in @key{RET} u c cm @key{RET} u c fath @key{RET} u b
4643@end group
4644@end smallexample
4645
4646@noindent
4647We enter the quantity ``2 inches'' (actually an algebraic expression
4648which means two times the variable @samp{in}), then we convert it
4649first to centimeters, then to fathoms, then finally to ``base'' units,
4650which in this case means meters.
4651
4652@smallexample
4653@group
46541: 9 acre 1: 3 sqrt(acre) 1: 190.84 m 1: 190.84 m + 30 cm
4655 . . . .
4656
4657 ' 9 acre @key{RET} Q u s ' $+30 cm @key{RET}
4658
4659@end group
4660@end smallexample
4661@noindent
4662@smallexample
4663@group
46641: 191.14 m 1: 36536.3046 m^2 1: 365363046 cm^2
4665 . . .
4666
4667 u s 2 ^ u c cgs
4668@end group
4669@end smallexample
4670
4671@noindent
4672Since units expressions are really just formulas, taking the square
4673root of @samp{acre} is undefined. After all, @code{acre} might be an
4674algebraic variable that you will someday assign a value. We use the
4675``units-simplify'' command to simplify the expression with variables
4676being interpreted as unit names.
4677
4678In the final step, we have converted not to a particular unit, but to a
4679units system. The ``cgs'' system uses centimeters instead of meters
4680as its standard unit of length.
4681
4682There is a wide variety of units defined in the Calculator.
4683
4684@smallexample
4685@group
46861: 55 mph 1: 88.5139 kph 1: 88.5139 km / hr 1: 8.201407e-8 c
4687 . . . .
4688
4689 ' 55 mph @key{RET} u c kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} u c c @key{RET}
4690@end group
4691@end smallexample
4692
4693@noindent
4694We express a speed first in miles per hour, then in kilometers per
4695hour, then again using a slightly more explicit notation, then
4696finally in terms of fractions of the speed of light.
4697
4698Temperature conversions are a bit more tricky. There are two ways to
4699interpret ``20 degrees Fahrenheit''---it could mean an actual
4700temperature, or it could mean a change in temperature. For normal
4701units there is no difference, but temperature units have an offset
4702as well as a scale factor and so there must be two explicit commands
4703for them.
4704
4705@smallexample
4706@group
47071: 20 degF 1: 11.1111 degC 1: -20:3 degC 1: -6.666 degC
4708 . . . .
4709
4710 ' 20 degF @key{RET} u c degC @key{RET} U u t degC @key{RET} c f
4711@end group
4712@end smallexample
4713
4714@noindent
4715First we convert a change of 20 degrees Fahrenheit into an equivalent
4716change in degrees Celsius (or Centigrade). Then, we convert the
4717absolute temperature 20 degrees Fahrenheit into Celsius. Since
4718this comes out as an exact fraction, we then convert to floating-point
4719for easier comparison with the other result.
4720
4721For simple unit conversions, you can put a plain number on the stack.
4722Then @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u t} will prompt for both old and new units.
4723When you use this method, you're responsible for remembering which
4724numbers are in which units:
4725
4726@smallexample
4727@group
47281: 55 1: 88.5139 1: 8.201407e-8
4729 . . .
4730
4731 55 u c mph @key{RET} kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} c @key{RET}
4732@end group
4733@end smallexample
4734
4735To see a complete list of built-in units, type @kbd{u v}. Press
4736@w{@kbd{C-x * c}} again to re-enter the Calculator when you're done looking
4737at the units table.
4738
4739(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} How many seconds are there really
4740in a year? @xref{Types Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4741
4742@cindex Speed of light
4743(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} Supercomputer designs are limited by
4744the speed of light (and of electricity, which is nearly as fast).
4745Suppose a computer has a 4.1 ns (nanosecond) clock cycle, and its
4746cabinet is one meter across. Is speed of light going to be a
4747significant factor in its design? @xref{Types Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4748
4749(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 15.} Sam the Slug normally travels about
4750five yards in an hour. He has obtained a supply of Power Pills; each
4751Power Pill he eats doubles his speed. How many Power Pills can he
4752swallow and still travel legally on most US highways?
4753@xref{Types Answer 15, 15}. (@bullet{})
4754
4755@node Algebra Tutorial, Programming Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Tutorial
4756@section Algebra and Calculus Tutorial
4757
4758@noindent
4759This section shows how to use Calc's algebra facilities to solve
4760equations, do simple calculus problems, and manipulate algebraic
4761formulas.
4762
4763@menu
4764* Basic Algebra Tutorial::
4765* Rewrites Tutorial::
4766@end menu
4767
4768@node Basic Algebra Tutorial, Rewrites Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
4769@subsection Basic Algebra
4770
4771@noindent
4772If you enter a formula in Algebraic mode that refers to variables,
4773the formula itself is pushed onto the stack. You can manipulate
4774formulas as regular data objects.
4775
4776@smallexample
4777@group
47781: 2 x^2 - 6 1: 6 - 2 x^2 1: (6 - 2 x^2) (3 x^2 + y)
4779 . . .
4780
4781 ' 2x^2-6 @key{RET} n ' 3x^2+y @key{RET} *
4782@end group
4783@end smallexample
4784
4785(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Do @kbd{' x @key{RET} Q 2 ^} and
4786@kbd{' x @key{RET} 2 ^ Q} both wind up with the same result (@samp{x})?
4787Why or why not? @xref{Algebra Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4788
4789There are also commands for doing common algebraic operations on
4790formulas. Continuing with the formula from the last example,
4791
4792@smallexample
4793@group
47941: 18 x^2 + 6 y - 6 x^4 - 2 x^2 y 1: (18 - 2 y) x^2 - 6 x^4 + 6 y
4795 . .
4796
4797 a x a c x @key{RET}
4798@end group
4799@end smallexample
4800
4801@noindent
4802First we ``expand'' using the distributive law, then we ``collect''
4803terms involving like powers of @expr{x}.
4804
4805Let's find the value of this expression when @expr{x} is 2 and @expr{y}
4806is one-half.
4807
4808@smallexample
4809@group
48101: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: -25
4811 . .
4812
4813 1:2 s l y @key{RET} 2 s l x @key{RET}
4814@end group
4815@end smallexample
4816
4817@noindent
4818The @kbd{s l} command means ``let''; it takes a number from the top of
4819the stack and temporarily assigns it as the value of the variable
4820you specify. It then evaluates (as if by the @kbd{=} key) the
4821next expression on the stack. After this command, the variable goes
4822back to its original value, if any.
4823
4824(An earlier exercise in this tutorial involved storing a value in the
4825variable @code{x}; if this value is still there, you will have to
4826unstore it with @kbd{s u x @key{RET}} before the above example will work
4827properly.)
4828
4829@cindex Maximum of a function using Calculus
4830Let's find the maximum value of our original expression when @expr{y}
4831is one-half and @expr{x} ranges over all possible values. We can
4832do this by taking the derivative with respect to @expr{x} and examining
4833values of @expr{x} for which the derivative is zero. If the second
4834derivative of the function at that value of @expr{x} is negative,
4835the function has a local maximum there.
4836
4837@smallexample
4838@group
48391: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
4840 . .
4841
4842 U @key{DEL} s 1 a d x @key{RET} s 2
4843@end group
4844@end smallexample
4845
4846@noindent
4847Well, the derivative is clearly zero when @expr{x} is zero. To find
4848the other root(s), let's divide through by @expr{x} and then solve:
4849
4850@smallexample
4851@group
48521: (34 x - 24 x^3) / x 1: 34 x / x - 24 x^3 / x 1: 34 - 24 x^2
4853 . . .
4854
4855 ' x @key{RET} / a x a s
4856
4857@end group
4858@end smallexample
4859@noindent
4860@smallexample
4861@group
48621: 34 - 24 x^2 = 0 1: x = 1.19023
4863 . .
4864
4865 0 a = s 3 a S x @key{RET}
4866@end group
4867@end smallexample
4868
4869@noindent
4870Notice the use of @kbd{a s} to ``simplify'' the formula. When the
4871default algebraic simplifications don't do enough, you can use
4872@kbd{a s} to tell Calc to spend more time on the job.
4873
4874Now we compute the second derivative and plug in our values of @expr{x}:
4875
4876@smallexample
4877@group
48781: 1.19023 2: 1.19023 2: 1.19023
4879 . 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: 34 - 72 x^2
4880 . .
4881
4882 a . r 2 a d x @key{RET} s 4
4883@end group
4884@end smallexample
4885
4886@noindent
4887(The @kbd{a .} command extracts just the righthand side of an equation.
4888Another method would have been to use @kbd{v u} to unpack the equation
4889@w{@samp{x = 1.19}} to @samp{x} and @samp{1.19}, then use @kbd{M-- M-2 @key{DEL}}
4890to delete the @samp{x}.)
4891
4892@smallexample
4893@group
48942: 34 - 72 x^2 1: -68. 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: 34
48951: 1.19023 . 1: 0 .
4896 . .
4897
4898 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET} U @key{DEL} 0 s l x @key{RET}
4899@end group
4900@end smallexample
4901
4902@noindent
4903The first of these second derivatives is negative, so we know the function
4904has a maximum value at @expr{x = 1.19023}. (The function also has a
4905local @emph{minimum} at @expr{x = 0}.)
4906
4907When we solved for @expr{x}, we got only one value even though
4908@expr{34 - 24 x^2 = 0} is a quadratic equation that ought to have
4909two solutions. The reason is that @w{@kbd{a S}} normally returns a
4910single ``principal'' solution. If it needs to come up with an
4911arbitrary sign (as occurs in the quadratic formula) it picks @expr{+}.
4912If it needs an arbitrary integer, it picks zero. We can get a full
4913solution by pressing @kbd{H} (the Hyperbolic flag) before @kbd{a S}.
4914
4915@smallexample
4916@group
49171: 34 - 24 x^2 = 0 1: x = 1.19023 s1 1: x = -1.19023
4918 . . .
4919
4920 r 3 H a S x @key{RET} s 5 1 n s l s1 @key{RET}
4921@end group
4922@end smallexample
4923
4924@noindent
4925Calc has invented the variable @samp{s1} to represent an unknown sign;
4926it is supposed to be either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}. Here we have used
4927the ``let'' command to evaluate the expression when the sign is negative.
4928If we plugged this into our second derivative we would get the same,
4929negative, answer, so @expr{x = -1.19023} is also a maximum.
4930
4931To find the actual maximum value, we must plug our two values of @expr{x}
4932into the original formula.
4933
4934@smallexample
4935@group
49362: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 24.08333 s1^2 - 12.04166 s1^4 + 3
49371: x = 1.19023 s1 .
4938 .
4939
4940 r 1 r 5 s l @key{RET}
4941@end group
4942@end smallexample
4943
4944@noindent
4945(Here we see another way to use @kbd{s l}; if its input is an equation
4946with a variable on the lefthand side, then @kbd{s l} treats the equation
4947like an assignment to that variable if you don't give a variable name.)
4948
4949It's clear that this will have the same value for either sign of
4950@code{s1}, but let's work it out anyway, just for the exercise:
4951
4952@smallexample
4953@group
49542: [-1, 1] 1: [15.04166, 15.04166]
49551: 24.08333 s1^2 ... .
4956 .
4957
4958 [ 1 n , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
4959@end group
4960@end smallexample
4961
4962@noindent
4963Here we have used a vector mapping operation to evaluate the function
4964at several values of @samp{s1} at once. @kbd{V M $} is like @kbd{V M '}
4965except that it takes the formula from the top of the stack. The
4966formula is interpreted as a function to apply across the vector at the
4967next-to-top stack level. Since a formula on the stack can't contain
4968@samp{$} signs, Calc assumes the variables in the formula stand for
4969different arguments. It prompts you for an @dfn{argument list}, giving
4970the list of all variables in the formula in alphabetical order as the
4971default list. In this case the default is @samp{(s1)}, which is just
4972what we want so we simply press @key{RET} at the prompt.
4973
4974If there had been several different values, we could have used
4975@w{@kbd{V R X}} to find the global maximum.
4976
4977Calc has a built-in @kbd{a P} command that solves an equation using
4978@w{@kbd{H a S}} and returns a vector of all the solutions. It simply
4979automates the job we just did by hand. Applied to our original
4980cubic polynomial, it would produce the vector of solutions
4981@expr{[1.19023, -1.19023, 0]}. (There is also an @kbd{a X} command
4982which finds a local maximum of a function. It uses a numerical search
4983method rather than examining the derivatives, and thus requires you
4984to provide some kind of initial guess to show it where to look.)
4985
4986(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Given a vector of the roots of a
4987polynomial (such as the output of an @kbd{a P} command), what
4988sequence of commands would you use to reconstruct the original
4989polynomial? (The answer will be unique to within a constant
4990multiple; choose the solution where the leading coefficient is one.)
4991@xref{Algebra Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4992
4993The @kbd{m s} command enables Symbolic mode, in which formulas
4994like @samp{sqrt(5)} that can't be evaluated exactly are left in
4995symbolic form rather than giving a floating-point approximate answer.
4996Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}) is also useful when doing algebra.
4997
4998@smallexample
4999@group
50002: 34 x - 24 x^3 2: 34 x - 24 x^3
50011: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0]
5002 . .
5003
5004 r 2 @key{RET} m s m f a P x @key{RET}
5005@end group
5006@end smallexample
5007
5008One more mode that makes reading formulas easier is Big mode.
5009
5010@smallexample
5011@group
5012 3
50132: 34 x - 24 x
5014
5015 ____ ____
5016 V 51 V 51
50171: [-----, -----, 0]
5018 6 -6
5019
5020 .
5021
5022 d B
5023@end group
5024@end smallexample
5025
5026Here things like powers, square roots, and quotients and fractions
5027are displayed in a two-dimensional pictorial form. Calc has other
5028language modes as well, such as C mode, FORTRAN mode, @TeX{} mode
5029and La@TeX{} mode.
5030
5031@smallexample
5032@group
50332: 34*x - 24*pow(x, 3) 2: 34*x - 24*x**3
50341: @{sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0@} 1: /sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0/
5035 . .
5036
5037 d C d F
5038
5039@end group
5040@end smallexample
5041@noindent
5042@smallexample
5043@group
50443: 34 x - 24 x^3
50452: [@{\sqrt@{51@} \over 6@}, @{\sqrt@{51@} \over -6@}, 0]
50461: @{2 \over 3@} \sqrt@{5@}
5047 .
5048
5049 d T ' 2 \sqrt@{5@} \over 3 @key{RET}
5050@end group
5051@end smallexample
5052
5053@noindent
5054As you can see, language modes affect both entry and display of
5055formulas. They affect such things as the names used for built-in
5056functions, the set of arithmetic operators and their precedences,
5057and notations for vectors and matrices.
5058
5059Notice that @samp{sqrt(51)} may cause problems with older
5060implementations of C and FORTRAN, which would require something more
5061like @samp{sqrt(51.0)}. It is always wise to check over the formulas
5062produced by the various language modes to make sure they are fully
5063correct.
5064
5065Type @kbd{m s}, @kbd{m f}, and @kbd{d N} to reset these modes. (You
5066may prefer to remain in Big mode, but all the examples in the tutorial
5067are shown in normal mode.)
5068
5069@cindex Area under a curve
5070What is the area under the portion of this curve from @expr{x = 1} to @expr{2}?
5071This is simply the integral of the function:
5072
5073@smallexample
5074@group
50751: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 5.6666 x^3 - 1.2 x^5 + 3 x
5076 . .
5077
5078 r 1 a i x
5079@end group
5080@end smallexample
5081
5082@noindent
5083We want to evaluate this at our two values for @expr{x} and subtract.
5084One way to do it is again with vector mapping and reduction:
5085
5086@smallexample
5087@group
50882: [2, 1] 1: [12.93333, 7.46666] 1: 5.46666
50891: 5.6666 x^3 ... . .
5090
5091 [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5092@end group
5093@end smallexample
5094
5095(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Find the integral from 1 to @expr{y}
5096of
5097@texline @math{x \sin \pi x}
5098@infoline @w{@expr{x sin(pi x)}}
5099(where the sine is calculated in radians). Find the values of the
5100integral for integers @expr{y} from 1 to 5. @xref{Algebra Answer 3,
51013}. (@bullet{})
5102
5103Calc's integrator can do many simple integrals symbolically, but many
5104others are beyond its capabilities. Suppose we wish to find the area
5105under the curve
5106@texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5107@infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5108over the same range of @expr{x}. If you entered this formula and typed
5109@kbd{a i x @key{RET}} (don't bother to try this), Calc would work for a
5110long time but would be unable to find a solution. In fact, there is no
5111closed-form solution to this integral. Now what do we do?
5112
5113@cindex Integration, numerical
5114@cindex Numerical integration
5115One approach would be to do the integral numerically. It is not hard
5116to do this by hand using vector mapping and reduction. It is rather
5117slow, though, since the sine and logarithm functions take a long time.
5118We can save some time by reducing the working precision.
5119
5120@smallexample
5121@group
51223: 10 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9]
51232: 1 .
51241: 0.1
5125 .
5126
5127 10 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
5128@end group
5129@end smallexample
5130
5131@noindent
5132(Note that we have used the extended version of @kbd{v x}; we could
5133also have used plain @kbd{v x} as follows: @kbd{v x 10 @key{RET} 9 + .1 *}.)
5134
5135@smallexample
5136@group
51372: [1, 1.1, ... ] 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
51381: sin(x) ln(x) .
5139 .
5140
5141 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} s 1 m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
5142
5143@end group
5144@end smallexample
5145@noindent
5146@smallexample
5147@group
51481: 3.4195 0.34195
5149 . .
5150
5151 V R + 0.1 *
5152@end group
5153@end smallexample
5154
5155@noindent
5156(If you got wildly different results, did you remember to switch
5157to Radians mode?)
5158
5159Here we have divided the curve into ten segments of equal width;
5160approximating these segments as rectangular boxes (i.e., assuming
5161the curve is nearly flat at that resolution), we compute the areas
5162of the boxes (height times width), then sum the areas. (It is
5163faster to sum first, then multiply by the width, since the width
5164is the same for every box.)
5165
5166The true value of this integral turns out to be about 0.374, so
5167we're not doing too well. Let's try another approach.
5168
5169@smallexample
5170@group
51711: sin(x) ln(x) 1: 0.84147 x - 0.84147 + 0.11957 (x - 1)^2 - ...
5172 . .
5173
5174 r 1 a t x=1 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET}
5175@end group
5176@end smallexample
5177
5178@noindent
5179Here we have computed the Taylor series expansion of the function
5180about the point @expr{x=1}. We can now integrate this polynomial
5181approximation, since polynomials are easy to integrate.
5182
5183@smallexample
5184@group
51851: 0.42074 x^2 + ... 1: [-0.0446, -0.42073] 1: 0.3761
5186 . . .
5187
5188 a i x @key{RET} [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5189@end group
5190@end smallexample
5191
5192@noindent
5193Better! By increasing the precision and/or asking for more terms
5194in the Taylor series, we can get a result as accurate as we like.
5195(Taylor series converge better away from singularities in the
5196function such as the one at @code{ln(0)}, so it would also help to
5197expand the series about the points @expr{x=2} or @expr{x=1.5} instead
5198of @expr{x=1}.)
5199
5200@cindex Simpson's rule
5201@cindex Integration by Simpson's rule
5202(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Our first method approximated the
5203curve by stairsteps of width 0.1; the total area was then the sum
5204of the areas of the rectangles under these stairsteps. Our second
5205method approximated the function by a polynomial, which turned out
5206to be a better approximation than stairsteps. A third method is
5207@dfn{Simpson's rule}, which is like the stairstep method except
5208that the steps are not required to be flat. Simpson's rule boils
5209down to the formula,
5210
5211@ifnottex
5212@example
5213(h/3) * (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + ...
5214 + 2 f(a+(n-2)*h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)*h) + f(a+n*h))
5215@end example
5216@end ifnottex
5217@tex
4009494e
GM
5218\beforedisplay
5219$$ \displaylines{
5220 \qquad {h \over 3} (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + \cdots
5221 \hfill \cr \hfill {} + 2 f(a+(n-2)h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)h) + f(a+n h)) \qquad
5222} $$
5223\afterdisplay
5224@end tex
5225
5226@noindent
5227where @expr{n} (which must be even) is the number of slices and @expr{h}
5228is the width of each slice. These are 10 and 0.1 in our example.
5229For reference, here is the corresponding formula for the stairstep
5230method:
5231
5232@ifnottex
5233@example
5234h * (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + ...
5235 + f(a+(n-2)*h) + f(a+(n-1)*h))
5236@end example
5237@end ifnottex
5238@tex
4009494e
GM
5239\beforedisplay
5240$$ h (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + \cdots
5241 + f(a+(n-2)h) + f(a+(n-1)h)) $$
5242\afterdisplay
5243@end tex
5244
5245Compute the integral from 1 to 2 of
5246@texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5247@infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5248using Simpson's rule with 10 slices.
5249@xref{Algebra Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5250
5251Calc has a built-in @kbd{a I} command for doing numerical integration.
5252It uses @dfn{Romberg's method}, which is a more sophisticated cousin
5253of Simpson's rule. In particular, it knows how to keep refining the
5254result until the current precision is satisfied.
5255
5256@c [fix-ref Selecting Sub-Formulas]
5257Aside from the commands we've seen so far, Calc also provides a
5258large set of commands for operating on parts of formulas. You
5259indicate the desired sub-formula by placing the cursor on any part
5260of the formula before giving a @dfn{selection} command. Selections won't
5261be covered in the tutorial; @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}, for
5262details and examples.
5263
5264@c hard exercise: simplify (2^(n r) - 2^(r*(n - 1))) / (2^r - 1) 2^(n - 1)
5265@c to 2^((n-1)*(r-1)).
5266
5267@node Rewrites Tutorial, , Basic Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
5268@subsection Rewrite Rules
5269
5270@noindent
5271No matter how many built-in commands Calc provided for doing algebra,
5272there would always be something you wanted to do that Calc didn't have
5273in its repertoire. So Calc also provides a @dfn{rewrite rule} system
5274that you can use to define your own algebraic manipulations.
5275
5276Suppose we want to simplify this trigonometric formula:
5277
5278@smallexample
5279@group
0ff2d6c2 52801: 2 / cos(x)^2 - 2 tan(x)^2
4009494e
GM
5281 .
5282
0ff2d6c2 5283 ' 2/cos(x)^2 - 2tan(x)^2 @key{RET} s 1
4009494e
GM
5284@end group
5285@end smallexample
5286
5287@noindent
5288If we were simplifying this by hand, we'd probably replace the
5289@samp{tan} with a @samp{sin/cos} first, then combine over a common
0ff2d6c2
JB
5290denominator. The @kbd{I a s} command will do the former and the @kbd{a n}
5291algebra command will do the latter, but we'll do both with rewrite
4009494e
GM
5292rules just for practice.
5293
5294Rewrite rules are written with the @samp{:=} symbol.
5295
5296@smallexample
5297@group
0ff2d6c2 52981: 2 / cos(x)^2 - 2 sin(x)^2 / cos(x)^2
4009494e
GM
5299 .
5300
5301 a r tan(a) := sin(a)/cos(a) @key{RET}
5302@end group
5303@end smallexample
5304
5305@noindent
5306(The ``assignment operator'' @samp{:=} has several uses in Calc. All
5307by itself the formula @samp{tan(a) := sin(a)/cos(a)} doesn't do anything,
5308but when it is given to the @kbd{a r} command, that command interprets
5309it as a rewrite rule.)
5310
5311The lefthand side, @samp{tan(a)}, is called the @dfn{pattern} of the
5312rewrite rule. Calc searches the formula on the stack for parts that
5313match the pattern. Variables in a rewrite pattern are called
5314@dfn{meta-variables}, and when matching the pattern each meta-variable
5315can match any sub-formula. Here, the meta-variable @samp{a} matched
5316the actual variable @samp{x}.
5317
5318When the pattern part of a rewrite rule matches a part of the formula,
5319that part is replaced by the righthand side with all the meta-variables
5320substituted with the things they matched. So the result is
5321@samp{sin(x) / cos(x)}. Calc's normal algebraic simplifications then
5322mix this in with the rest of the original formula.
5323
5324To merge over a common denominator, we can use another simple rule:
5325
5326@smallexample
5327@group
0ff2d6c2 53281: (2 - 2 sin(x)^2) / cos(x)^2
4009494e
GM
5329 .
5330
5331 a r a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET}
5332@end group
5333@end smallexample
5334
5335This rule points out several interesting features of rewrite patterns.
5336First, if a meta-variable appears several times in a pattern, it must
5337match the same thing everywhere. This rule detects common denominators
5338because the same meta-variable @samp{x} is used in both of the
5339denominators.
5340
5341Second, meta-variable names are independent from variables in the
5342target formula. Notice that the meta-variable @samp{x} here matches
0ff2d6c2 5343the subformula @samp{cos(x)^2}; Calc never confuses the two meanings of
4009494e
GM
5344@samp{x}.
5345
5346And third, rewrite patterns know a little bit about the algebraic
5347properties of formulas. The pattern called for a sum of two quotients;
5348Calc was able to match a difference of two quotients by matching
0ff2d6c2 5349@samp{a = 2}, @samp{b = -2 sin(x)^2}, and @samp{x = cos(x)^2}.
4009494e
GM
5350
5351@c [fix-ref Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules]
5352We could just as easily have written @samp{a/x - b/x := (a-b)/x} for
5353the rule. It would have worked just the same in all cases. (If we
5354really wanted the rule to apply only to @samp{+} or only to @samp{-},
5355we could have used the @code{plain} symbol. @xref{Algebraic Properties
5356of Rewrite Rules}, for some examples of this.)
5357
5358One more rewrite will complete the job. We want to use the identity
5359@samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}, but of course we must first rearrange
5360the identity in a way that matches our formula. The obvious rule
0ff2d6c2 5361would be @samp{@w{2 - 2 sin(x)^2} := 2 cos(x)^2}, but a little thought shows
4009494e
GM
5362that the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2} will also work. The
5363latter rule has a more general pattern so it will work in many other
5364situations, too.
5365
5366@smallexample
5367@group
0ff2d6c2
JB
53681: (2 + 2 cos(x)^2 - 2) / cos(x)^2 1: 2
5369 . .
4009494e
GM
5370
5371 a r sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2 @key{RET} a s
5372@end group
5373@end smallexample
5374
5375You may ask, what's the point of using the most general rule if you
5376have to type it in every time anyway? The answer is that Calc allows
5377you to store a rewrite rule in a variable, then give the variable
5378name in the @kbd{a r} command. In fact, this is the preferred way to
5379use rewrites. For one, if you need a rule once you'll most likely
5380need it again later. Also, if the rule doesn't work quite right you
5381can simply Undo, edit the variable, and run the rule again without
5382having to retype it.
5383
5384@smallexample
5385@group
5386' tan(x) := sin(x)/cos(x) @key{RET} s t tsc @key{RET}
5387' a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET} s t merge @key{RET}
5388' sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2 @key{RET} s t sinsqr @key{RET}
5389
0ff2d6c2 53901: 2 / cos(x)^2 - 2 tan(x)^2 1: 2
4009494e
GM
5391 . .
5392
5393 r 1 a r tsc @key{RET} a r merge @key{RET} a r sinsqr @key{RET} a s
5394@end group
5395@end smallexample
5396
5397To edit a variable, type @kbd{s e} and the variable name, use regular
5398Emacs editing commands as necessary, then type @kbd{C-c C-c} to store
5399the edited value back into the variable.
5400You can also use @w{@kbd{s e}} to create a new variable if you wish.
5401
5402Notice that the first time you use each rule, Calc puts up a ``compiling''
5403message briefly. The pattern matcher converts rules into a special
5404optimized pattern-matching language rather than using them directly.
5405This allows @kbd{a r} to apply even rather complicated rules very
5406efficiently. If the rule is stored in a variable, Calc compiles it
5407only once and stores the compiled form along with the variable. That's
5408another good reason to store your rules in variables rather than
5409entering them on the fly.
5410
5411(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Type @kbd{m s} to get Symbolic
5412mode, then enter the formula @samp{@w{(2 + sqrt(2))} / @w{(1 + sqrt(2))}}.
5413Using a rewrite rule, simplify this formula by multiplying the top and
5414bottom by the conjugate @w{@samp{1 - sqrt(2)}}. The result will have
5415to be expanded by the distributive law; do this with another
5416rewrite. @xref{Rewrites Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5417
5418The @kbd{a r} command can also accept a vector of rewrite rules, or
5419a variable containing a vector of rules.
5420
5421@smallexample
5422@group
54231: [tsc, merge, sinsqr] 1: [tan(x) := sin(x) / cos(x), ... ]
5424 . .
5425
5426 ' [tsc,merge,sinsqr] @key{RET} =
5427
5428@end group
5429@end smallexample
5430@noindent
5431@smallexample
5432@group
54331: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) 1: cos(x)
5434 . .
5435
5436 s t trig @key{RET} r 1 a r trig @key{RET} a s
5437@end group
5438@end smallexample
5439
5440@c [fix-ref Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules]
5441Calc tries all the rules you give against all parts of the formula,
5442repeating until no further change is possible. (The exact order in
5443which things are tried is rather complex, but for simple rules like
5444the ones we've used here the order doesn't really matter.
5445@xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.)
5446
5447Calc actually repeats only up to 100 times, just in case your rule set
5448has gotten into an infinite loop. You can give a numeric prefix argument
5449to @kbd{a r} to specify any limit. In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} does
5450only one rewrite at a time.
5451
5452@smallexample
5453@group
54541: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x)^2 / cos(x) 1: (1 - sin(x)^2) / cos(x)
5455 . .
5456
5457 r 1 M-1 a r trig @key{RET} M-1 a r trig @key{RET}
5458@end group
5459@end smallexample
5460
5461You can type @kbd{M-0 a r} if you want no limit at all on the number
5462of rewrites that occur.
5463
5464Rewrite rules can also be @dfn{conditional}. Simply follow the rule
5465with a @samp{::} symbol and the desired condition. For example,
5466
5467@smallexample
5468@group
54691: exp(2 pi i) + exp(3 pi i) + exp(4 pi i)
5470 .
5471
5472 ' exp(2 pi i) + exp(3 pi i) + exp(4 pi i) @key{RET}
5473
5474@end group
5475@end smallexample
5476@noindent
5477@smallexample
5478@group
54791: 1 + exp(3 pi i) + 1
5480 .
5481
5482 a r exp(k pi i) := 1 :: k % 2 = 0 @key{RET}
5483@end group
5484@end smallexample
5485
5486@noindent
5487(Recall, @samp{k % 2} is the remainder from dividing @samp{k} by 2,
5488which will be zero only when @samp{k} is an even integer.)
5489
5490An interesting point is that the variables @samp{pi} and @samp{i}
5491were matched literally rather than acting as meta-variables.
5492This is because they are special-constant variables. The special
5493constants @samp{e}, @samp{phi}, and so on also match literally.
5494A common error with rewrite
5495rules is to write, say, @samp{f(a,b,c,d,e) := g(a+b+c+d+e)}, expecting
5496to match any @samp{f} with five arguments but in fact matching
5497only when the fifth argument is literally @samp{e}!
5498
5499@cindex Fibonacci numbers
5500@ignore
5501@starindex
5502@end ignore
5503@tindex fib
5504Rewrite rules provide an interesting way to define your own functions.
5505Suppose we want to define @samp{fib(n)} to produce the @var{n}th
5506Fibonacci number. The first two Fibonacci numbers are each 1;
5507later numbers are formed by summing the two preceding numbers in
5508the sequence. This is easy to express in a set of three rules:
5509
5510@smallexample
5511@group
5512' [fib(1) := 1, fib(2) := 1, fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2)] @key{RET} s t fib
5513
55141: fib(7) 1: 13
5515 . .
5516
5517 ' fib(7) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5518@end group
5519@end smallexample
5520
5521One thing that is guaranteed about the order that rewrites are tried
5522is that, for any given subformula, earlier rules in the rule set will
5523be tried for that subformula before later ones. So even though the
5524first and third rules both match @samp{fib(1)}, we know the first will
5525be used preferentially.
5526
5527This rule set has one dangerous bug: Suppose we apply it to the
5528formula @samp{fib(x)}? (Don't actually try this.) The third rule
5529will match @samp{fib(x)} and replace it with @w{@samp{fib(x-1) + fib(x-2)}}.
5530Each of these will then be replaced to get @samp{fib(x-2) + 2 fib(x-3) +
5531fib(x-4)}, and so on, expanding forever. What we really want is to apply
5532the third rule only when @samp{n} is an integer greater than two. Type
5533@w{@kbd{s e fib @key{RET}}}, then edit the third rule to:
5534
5535@smallexample
5536fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2
5537@end smallexample
5538
5539@noindent
5540Now:
5541
5542@smallexample
5543@group
55441: fib(6) + fib(x) + fib(0) 1: 8 + fib(x) + fib(0)
5545 . .
5546
5547 ' fib(6)+fib(x)+fib(0) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5548@end group
5549@end smallexample
5550
5551@noindent
5552We've created a new function, @code{fib}, and a new command,
5553@w{@kbd{a r fib @key{RET}}}, which means ``evaluate all @code{fib} calls in
5554this formula.'' To make things easier still, we can tell Calc to
5555apply these rules automatically by storing them in the special
5556variable @code{EvalRules}.
5557
5558@smallexample
5559@group
55601: [fib(1) := ...] . 1: [8, 13]
5561 . .
5562
5563 s r fib @key{RET} s t EvalRules @key{RET} ' [fib(6), fib(7)] @key{RET}
5564@end group
5565@end smallexample
5566
5567It turns out that this rule set has the problem that it does far
5568more work than it needs to when @samp{n} is large. Consider the
5569first few steps of the computation of @samp{fib(6)}:
5570
5571@smallexample
5572@group
5573fib(6) =
5574fib(5) + fib(4) =
5575fib(4) + fib(3) + fib(3) + fib(2) =
5576fib(3) + fib(2) + fib(2) + fib(1) + fib(2) + fib(1) + 1 = ...
5577@end group
5578@end smallexample
5579
5580@noindent
5581Note that @samp{fib(3)} appears three times here. Unless Calc's
5582algebraic simplifier notices the multiple @samp{fib(3)}s and combines
5583them (and, as it happens, it doesn't), this rule set does lots of
5584needless recomputation. To cure the problem, type @code{s e EvalRules}
5585to edit the rules (or just @kbd{s E}, a shorthand command for editing
5586@code{EvalRules}) and add another condition:
5587
5588@smallexample
5589fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2 :: remember
5590@end smallexample
5591
5592@noindent
5593If a @samp{:: remember} condition appears anywhere in a rule, then if
5594that rule succeeds Calc will add another rule that describes that match
5595to the front of the rule set. (Remembering works in any rule set, but
5596for technical reasons it is most effective in @code{EvalRules}.) For
5597example, if the rule rewrites @samp{fib(7)} to something that evaluates
5598to 13, then the rule @samp{fib(7) := 13} will be added to the rule set.
5599
5600Type @kbd{' fib(8) @key{RET}} to compute the eighth Fibonacci number, then
5601type @kbd{s E} again to see what has happened to the rule set.
5602
5603With the @code{remember} feature, our rule set can now compute
5604@samp{fib(@var{n})} in just @var{n} steps. In the process it builds
5605up a table of all Fibonacci numbers up to @var{n}. After we have
5606computed the result for a particular @var{n}, we can get it back
5607(and the results for all smaller @var{n}) later in just one step.
5608
5609All Calc operations will run somewhat slower whenever @code{EvalRules}
5610contains any rules. You should type @kbd{s u EvalRules @key{RET}} now to
5611un-store the variable.
5612
5613(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Sometimes it is possible to reformulate
5614a problem to reduce the amount of recursion necessary to solve it.
5615Create a rule that, in about @var{n} simple steps and without recourse
5616to the @code{remember} option, replaces @samp{fib(@var{n}, 1, 1)} with
5617@samp{fib(1, @var{x}, @var{y})} where @var{x} and @var{y} are the
5618@var{n}th and @var{n+1}st Fibonacci numbers, respectively. This rule is
5619rather clunky to use, so add a couple more rules to make the ``user
5620interface'' the same as for our first version: enter @samp{fib(@var{n})},
5621get back a plain number. @xref{Rewrites Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5622
5623There are many more things that rewrites can do. For example, there
5624are @samp{&&&} and @samp{|||} pattern operators that create ``and''
5625and ``or'' combinations of rules. As one really simple example, we
5626could combine our first two Fibonacci rules thusly:
5627
5628@example
5629[fib(1 ||| 2) := 1, fib(n) := ... ]
5630@end example
5631
5632@noindent
5633That means ``@code{fib} of something matching either 1 or 2 rewrites
5634to 1.''
5635
5636You can also make meta-variables optional by enclosing them in @code{opt}.
5637For example, the pattern @samp{a + b x} matches @samp{2 + 3 x} but not
5638@samp{2 + x} or @samp{3 x} or @samp{x}. The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x}
5639matches all of these forms, filling in a default of zero for @samp{a}
5640and one for @samp{b}.
5641
5642(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe had @samp{2 + 3 x}
5643on the stack and tried to use the rule
5644@samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x := f(a, b, x)}. What happened?
5645@xref{Rewrites Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5646
5647(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Starting with a positive integer @expr{a},
5648divide @expr{a} by two if it is even, otherwise compute @expr{3 a + 1}.
5649Now repeat this step over and over. A famous unproved conjecture
5650is that for any starting @expr{a}, the sequence always eventually
5651reaches 1. Given the formula @samp{seq(@var{a}, 0)}, write a set of
5652rules that convert this into @samp{seq(1, @var{n})} where @var{n}
5653is the number of steps it took the sequence to reach the value 1.
5654Now enhance the rules to accept @samp{seq(@var{a})} as a starting
5655configuration, and to stop with just the number @var{n} by itself.
5656Now make the result be a vector of values in the sequence, from @var{a}
5657to 1. (The formula @samp{@var{x}|@var{y}} appends the vectors @var{x}
5658and @var{y}.) For example, rewriting @samp{seq(6)} should yield the
5659vector @expr{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
5660@xref{Rewrites Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5661
5662(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} Define, using rewrite rules, a function
5663@samp{nterms(@var{x})} that returns the number of terms in the sum
5664@var{x}, or 1 if @var{x} is not a sum. (A @dfn{sum} for our purposes
5665is one or more non-sum terms separated by @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
5666so that @expr{2 - 3 (x + y) + x y} is a sum of three terms.)
5667@xref{Rewrites Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5668
5669(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} A Taylor series for a function is an
5670infinite series that exactly equals the value of that function at
5671values of @expr{x} near zero.
5672
5673@ifnottex
5674@example
5675cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + x^4 / 4! - x^6 / 6! + ...
5676@end example
5677@end ifnottex
5678@tex
4009494e
GM
5679\beforedisplay
5680$$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + {x^4 \over 4!} - {x^6 \over 6!} + \cdots $$
5681\afterdisplay
5682@end tex
5683
5684The @kbd{a t} command produces a @dfn{truncated Taylor series} which
5685is obtained by dropping all the terms higher than, say, @expr{x^2}.
5686Calc represents the truncated Taylor series as a polynomial in @expr{x}.
5687Mathematicians often write a truncated series using a ``big-O'' notation
5688that records what was the lowest term that was truncated.
5689
5690@ifnottex
5691@example
5692cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + O(x^3)
5693@end example
5694@end ifnottex
5695@tex
4009494e
GM
5696\beforedisplay
5697$$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + O(x^3) $$
5698\afterdisplay
5699@end tex
5700
5701@noindent
5702The meaning of @expr{O(x^3)} is ``a quantity which is negligibly small
5703if @expr{x^3} is considered negligibly small as @expr{x} goes to zero.''
5704
5705The exercise is to create rewrite rules that simplify sums and products of
5706power series represented as @samp{@var{polynomial} + O(@var{var}^@var{n})}.
5707For example, given @samp{1 - x^2 / 2 + O(x^3)} and @samp{x - x^3 / 6 + O(x^4)}
5708on the stack, we want to be able to type @kbd{*} and get the result
5709@samp{x - 2:3 x^3 + O(x^4)}. Don't worry if the terms of the sum are
5710rearranged or if @kbd{a s} needs to be typed after rewriting. (This one
5711is rather tricky; the solution at the end of this chapter uses 6 rewrite
5712rules. Hint: The @samp{constant(x)} condition tests whether @samp{x} is
5713a number.) @xref{Rewrites Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5714
5715Just for kicks, try adding the rule @code{2+3 := 6} to @code{EvalRules}.
5716What happens? (Be sure to remove this rule afterward, or you might get
5717a nasty surprise when you use Calc to balance your checkbook!)
5718
5719@xref{Rewrite Rules}, for the whole story on rewrite rules.
5720
5721@node Programming Tutorial, Answers to Exercises, Algebra Tutorial, Tutorial
5722@section Programming Tutorial
5723
5724@noindent
5725The Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, a highly extensible
5726language. If you know Lisp, you can program the Calculator to do
5727anything you like. Rewrite rules also work as a powerful programming
5728system. But Lisp and rewrite rules take a while to master, and often
5729all you want to do is define a new function or repeat a command a few
5730times. Calc has features that allow you to do these things easily.
5731
5732One very limited form of programming is defining your own functions.
5733Calc's @kbd{Z F} command allows you to define a function name and
5734key sequence to correspond to any formula. Programming commands use
5735the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix; the user commands they create use the lower
5736case @kbd{z} prefix.
5737
5738@smallexample
5739@group
57401: 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 1: 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6
5741 . .
5742
5743 ' 1 + x + x^2/2! + x^3/3! @key{RET} Z F e myexp @key{RET} @key{RET} @key{RET} y
5744@end group
5745@end smallexample
5746
5747This polynomial is a Taylor series approximation to @samp{exp(x)}.
5748The @kbd{Z F} command asks a number of questions. The above answers
5749say that the key sequence for our function should be @kbd{z e}; the
5750@kbd{M-x} equivalent should be @code{calc-myexp}; the name of the
5751function in algebraic formulas should also be @code{myexp}; the
5752default argument list @samp{(x)} is acceptable; and finally @kbd{y}
5753answers the question ``leave it in symbolic form for non-constant
5754arguments?''
5755
5756@smallexample
5757@group
57581: 1.3495 2: 1.3495 3: 1.3495
5759 . 1: 1.34986 2: 1.34986
5760 . 1: myexp(a + 1)
5761 .
5762
5763 .3 z e .3 E ' a+1 @key{RET} z e
5764@end group
5765@end smallexample
5766
5767@noindent
5768First we call our new @code{exp} approximation with 0.3 as an
5769argument, and compare it with the true @code{exp} function. Then
5770we note that, as requested, if we try to give @kbd{z e} an
5771argument that isn't a plain number, it leaves the @code{myexp}
5772function call in symbolic form. If we had answered @kbd{n} to the
5773final question, @samp{myexp(a + 1)} would have evaluated by plugging
5774in @samp{a + 1} for @samp{x} in the defining formula.
5775
5776@cindex Sine integral Si(x)
5777@ignore
5778@starindex
5779@end ignore
5780@tindex Si
5781(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The ``sine integral'' function
5782@texline @math{{\rm Si}(x)}
5783@infoline @expr{Si(x)}
5784is defined as the integral of @samp{sin(t)/t} for
5785@expr{t = 0} to @expr{x} in radians. (It was invented because this
5786integral has no solution in terms of basic functions; if you give it
5787to Calc's @kbd{a i} command, it will ponder it for a long time and then
5788give up.) We can use the numerical integration command, however,
5789which in algebraic notation is written like @samp{ninteg(f(t), t, 0, x)}
5790with any integrand @samp{f(t)}. Define a @kbd{z s} command and
5791@code{Si} function that implement this. You will need to edit the
5792default argument list a bit. As a test, @samp{Si(1)} should return
57930.946083. (If you don't get this answer, you might want to check that
5794Calc is in Radians mode. Also, @code{ninteg} will run a lot faster if
5795you reduce the precision to, say, six digits beforehand.)
5796@xref{Programming Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5797
5798The simplest way to do real ``programming'' of Emacs is to define a
5799@dfn{keyboard macro}. A keyboard macro is simply a sequence of
5800keystrokes which Emacs has stored away and can play back on demand.
5801For example, if you find yourself typing @kbd{H a S x @key{RET}} often,
5802you may wish to program a keyboard macro to type this for you.
5803
5804@smallexample
5805@group
58061: y = sqrt(x) 1: x = y^2
5807 . .
5808
5809 ' y=sqrt(x) @key{RET} C-x ( H a S x @key{RET} C-x )
5810
58111: y = cos(x) 1: x = s1 arccos(y) + 2 pi n1
5812 . .
5813
5814 ' y=cos(x) @key{RET} X
5815@end group
5816@end smallexample
5817
5818@noindent
5819When you type @kbd{C-x (}, Emacs begins recording. But it is also
5820still ready to execute your keystrokes, so you're really ``training''
5821Emacs by walking it through the procedure once. When you type
5822@w{@kbd{C-x )}}, the macro is recorded. You can now type @kbd{X} to
5823re-execute the same keystrokes.
5824
5825You can give a name to your macro by typing @kbd{Z K}.
5826
5827@smallexample
5828@group
58291: . 1: y = x^4 1: x = s2 sqrt(s1 sqrt(y))
5830 . .
5831
5832 Z K x @key{RET} ' y=x^4 @key{RET} z x
5833@end group
5834@end smallexample
5835
5836@noindent
5837Notice that we use shift-@kbd{Z} to define the command, and lower-case
5838@kbd{z} to call it up.
5839
5840Keyboard macros can call other macros.
5841
5842@smallexample
5843@group
58441: abs(x) 1: x = s1 y 1: 2 / x 1: x = 2 / y
5845 . . . .
5846
5847 ' abs(x) @key{RET} C-x ( ' y @key{RET} a = z x C-x ) ' 2/x @key{RET} X
5848@end group
5849@end smallexample
5850
5851(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Define a keyboard macro to negate
5852the item in level 3 of the stack, without disturbing the rest of
5853the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5854
5855(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Define keyboard macros to compute
5856the following functions:
5857
5858@enumerate
5859@item
5860Compute
5861@texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}},
5862@infoline @expr{sin(x) / x},
5863where @expr{x} is the number on the top of the stack.
5864
5865@item
5866Compute the base-@expr{b} logarithm, just like the @kbd{B} key except
5867the arguments are taken in the opposite order.
5868
5869@item
5870Produce a vector of integers from 1 to the integer on the top of
5871the stack.
5872@end enumerate
5873@noindent
5874@xref{Programming Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5875
5876(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Define a keyboard macro to compute
5877the average (mean) value of a list of numbers.
5878@xref{Programming Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5879
5880In many programs, some of the steps must execute several times.
5881Calc has @dfn{looping} commands that allow this. Loops are useful
5882inside keyboard macros, but actually work at any time.
5883
5884@smallexample
5885@group
58861: x^6 2: x^6 1: 360 x^2
5887 . 1: 4 .
5888 .
5889
5890 ' x^6 @key{RET} 4 Z < a d x @key{RET} Z >
5891@end group
5892@end smallexample
5893
5894@noindent
5895Here we have computed the fourth derivative of @expr{x^6} by
5896enclosing a derivative command in a ``repeat loop'' structure.
5897This structure pops a repeat count from the stack, then
5898executes the body of the loop that many times.
5899
5900If you make a mistake while entering the body of the loop,
5901type @w{@kbd{Z C-g}} to cancel the loop command.
5902
5903@cindex Fibonacci numbers
5904Here's another example:
5905
5906@smallexample
5907@group
59083: 1 2: 10946
59092: 1 1: 17711
59101: 20 .
5911 .
5912
59131 @key{RET} @key{RET} 20 Z < @key{TAB} C-j + Z >
5914@end group
5915@end smallexample
5916
5917@noindent
5918The numbers in levels 2 and 1 should be the 21st and 22nd Fibonacci
5919numbers, respectively. (To see what's going on, try a few repetitions
5920of the loop body by hand; @kbd{C-j}, also on the Line-Feed or @key{LFD}
5921key if you have one, makes a copy of the number in level 2.)
5922
5923@cindex Golden ratio
5924@cindex Phi, golden ratio
5925A fascinating property of the Fibonacci numbers is that the @expr{n}th
5926Fibonacci number can be found directly by computing
5927@texline @math{\phi^n / \sqrt{5}}
5928@infoline @expr{phi^n / sqrt(5)}
5929and then rounding to the nearest integer, where
5930@texline @math{\phi} (``phi''),
5931@infoline @expr{phi},
5932the ``golden ratio,'' is
5933@texline @math{(1 + \sqrt{5}) / 2}.
5934@infoline @expr{(1 + sqrt(5)) / 2}.
5935(For convenience, this constant is available from the @code{phi}
5936variable, or the @kbd{I H P} command.)
5937
5938@smallexample
5939@group
59401: 1.61803 1: 24476.0000409 1: 10945.9999817 1: 10946
5941 . . . .
5942
5943 I H P 21 ^ 5 Q / R
5944@end group
5945@end smallexample
5946
5947@cindex Continued fractions
5948(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @dfn{continued fraction}
5949representation of
5950@texline @math{\phi}
5951@infoline @expr{phi}
5952is
5953@texline @math{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( \ldots )))}.
5954@infoline @expr{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( ...@: )))}.
5955We can compute an approximate value by carrying this however far
5956and then replacing the innermost
5957@texline @math{1/( \ldots )}
5958@infoline @expr{1/( ...@: )}
5959by 1. Approximate
5960@texline @math{\phi}
5961@infoline @expr{phi}
5962using a twenty-term continued fraction.
5963@xref{Programming Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5964
5965(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Linear recurrences like the one for
5966Fibonacci numbers can be expressed in terms of matrices. Given a
5967vector @w{@expr{[a, b]}} determine a matrix which, when multiplied by this
5968vector, produces the vector @expr{[b, c]}, where @expr{a}, @expr{b} and
5969@expr{c} are three successive Fibonacci numbers. Now write a program
5970that, given an integer @expr{n}, computes the @expr{n}th Fibonacci number
5971using matrix arithmetic. @xref{Programming Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5972
5973@cindex Harmonic numbers
5974A more sophisticated kind of loop is the @dfn{for} loop. Suppose
5975we wish to compute the 20th ``harmonic'' number, which is equal to
5976the sum of the reciprocals of the integers from 1 to 20.
5977
5978@smallexample
5979@group
59803: 0 1: 3.597739
59812: 1 .
59821: 20
5983 .
5984
59850 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & + 1 Z )
5986@end group
5987@end smallexample
5988
5989@noindent
5990The ``for'' loop pops two numbers, the lower and upper limits, then
5991repeats the body of the loop as an internal counter increases from
5992the lower limit to the upper one. Just before executing the loop
5993body, it pushes the current loop counter. When the loop body
5994finishes, it pops the ``step,'' i.e., the amount by which to
5995increment the loop counter. As you can see, our loop always
5996uses a step of one.
5997
5998This harmonic number function uses the stack to hold the running
5999total as well as for the various loop housekeeping functions. If
6000you find this disorienting, you can sum in a variable instead:
6001
6002@smallexample
6003@group
60041: 0 2: 1 . 1: 3.597739
6005 . 1: 20 .
6006 .
6007
6008 0 t 7 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & s + 7 1 Z ) r 7
6009@end group
6010@end smallexample
6011
6012@noindent
6013The @kbd{s +} command adds the top-of-stack into the value in a
6014variable (and removes that value from the stack).
6015
6016It's worth noting that many jobs that call for a ``for'' loop can
6017also be done more easily by Calc's high-level operations. Two
6018other ways to compute harmonic numbers are to use vector mapping
6019and reduction (@kbd{v x 20}, then @w{@kbd{V M &}}, then @kbd{V R +}),
6020or to use the summation command @kbd{a +}. Both of these are
6021probably easier than using loops. However, there are some
6022situations where loops really are the way to go:
6023
6024(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Use a ``for'' loop to find the first
6025harmonic number which is greater than 4.0.
6026@xref{Programming Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
6027
6028Of course, if we're going to be using variables in our programs,
6029we have to worry about the programs clobbering values that the
6030caller was keeping in those same variables. This is easy to
6031fix, though:
6032
6033@smallexample
6034@group
6035 . 1: 0.6667 1: 0.6667 3: 0.6667
6036 . . 2: 3.597739
6037 1: 0.6667
6038 .
6039
6040 Z ` p 4 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 / s 7 s s a @key{RET} Z ' r 7 s r a @key{RET}
6041@end group
6042@end smallexample
6043
6044@noindent
6045When we type @kbd{Z `} (that's a back-quote character), Calc saves
6046its mode settings and the contents of the ten ``quick variables''
6047for later reference. When we type @kbd{Z '} (that's an apostrophe
6048now), Calc restores those saved values. Thus the @kbd{p 4} and
6049@kbd{s 7} commands have no effect outside this sequence. Wrapping
6050this around the body of a keyboard macro ensures that it doesn't
6051interfere with what the user of the macro was doing. Notice that
6052the contents of the stack, and the values of named variables,
6053survive past the @kbd{Z '} command.
6054
6055@cindex Bernoulli numbers, approximate
6056The @dfn{Bernoulli numbers} are a sequence with the interesting
6057property that all of the odd Bernoulli numbers are zero, and the
6058even ones, while difficult to compute, can be roughly approximated
6059by the formula
6060@texline @math{\displaystyle{2 n! \over (2 \pi)^n}}.
6061@infoline @expr{2 n!@: / (2 pi)^n}.
6062Let's write a keyboard macro to compute (approximate) Bernoulli numbers.
6063(Calc has a command, @kbd{k b}, to compute exact Bernoulli numbers, but
6064this command is very slow for large @expr{n} since the higher Bernoulli
6065numbers are very large fractions.)
6066
6067@smallexample
6068@group
60691: 10 1: 0.0756823
6070 . .
6071
6072 10 C-x ( @key{RET} 2 % Z [ @key{DEL} 0 Z : ' 2 $! / (2 pi)^$ @key{RET} = Z ] C-x )
6073@end group
6074@end smallexample
6075
6076@noindent
6077You can read @kbd{Z [} as ``then,'' @kbd{Z :} as ``else,'' and
6078@kbd{Z ]} as ``end-if.'' There is no need for an explicit ``if''
6079command. For the purposes of @w{@kbd{Z [}}, the condition is ``true''
6080if the value it pops from the stack is a nonzero number, or ``false''
6081if it pops zero or something that is not a number (like a formula).
6082Here we take our integer argument modulo 2; this will be nonzero
6083if we're asking for an odd Bernoulli number.
6084
6085The actual tenth Bernoulli number is @expr{5/66}.
6086
6087@smallexample
6088@group
60893: 0.0756823 1: 0 1: 0.25305 1: 0 1: 1.16659
60902: 5:66 . . . .
60911: 0.0757575
6092 .
6093
609410 k b @key{RET} c f M-0 @key{DEL} 11 X @key{DEL} 12 X @key{DEL} 13 X @key{DEL} 14 X
6095@end group
6096@end smallexample
6097
6098Just to exercise loops a bit more, let's compute a table of even
6099Bernoulli numbers.
6100
6101@smallexample
6102@group
61033: [] 1: [0.10132, 0.03079, 0.02340, 0.033197, ...]
61042: 2 .
61051: 30
6106 .
6107
6108 [ ] 2 @key{RET} 30 Z ( X | 2 Z )
6109@end group
6110@end smallexample
6111
6112@noindent
6113The vertical-bar @kbd{|} is the vector-concatenation command. When
6114we execute it, the list we are building will be in stack level 2
6115(initially this is an empty list), and the next Bernoulli number
6116will be in level 1. The effect is to append the Bernoulli number
6117onto the end of the list. (To create a table of exact fractional
6118Bernoulli numbers, just replace @kbd{X} with @kbd{k b} in the above
6119sequence of keystrokes.)
6120
6121With loops and conditionals, you can program essentially anything
6122in Calc. One other command that makes looping easier is @kbd{Z /},
6123which takes a condition from the stack and breaks out of the enclosing
6124loop if the condition is true (non-zero). You can use this to make
6125``while'' and ``until'' style loops.
6126
6127If you make a mistake when entering a keyboard macro, you can edit
6128it using @kbd{Z E}. First, you must attach it to a key with @kbd{Z K}.
6129One technique is to enter a throwaway dummy definition for the macro,
6130then enter the real one in the edit command.
6131
6132@smallexample
6133@group
61341: 3 1: 3 Calc Macro Edit Mode.
6135 . . Original keys: 1 <return> 2 +
6136
6137 1 ;; calc digits
6138 RET ;; calc-enter
6139 2 ;; calc digits
6140 + ;; calc-plus
6141
6142C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 2 + C-x ) Z K h @key{RET} Z E h
6143@end group
6144@end smallexample
6145
6146@noindent
6147A keyboard macro is stored as a pure keystroke sequence. The
6148@file{edmacro} package (invoked by @kbd{Z E}) scans along the
6149macro and tries to decode it back into human-readable steps.
6150Descriptions of the keystrokes are given as comments, which begin with
6151@samp{;;}, and which are ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6152Spaces and line breaks are also ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6153To enter a space into the macro, type @code{SPC}. All the special
6154characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC}, @code{DEL},
6155and @code{NUL} must be written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes
6156@code{C-} and @code{M-}.
6157
6158Let's edit in a new definition, for computing harmonic numbers.
6159First, erase the four lines of the old definition. Then, type
6160in the new definition (or use Emacs @kbd{M-w} and @kbd{C-y} commands
6161to copy it from this page of the Info file; you can of course skip
6162typing the comments, which begin with @samp{;;}).
6163
6164@smallexample
6165Z` ;; calc-kbd-push (Save local values)
61660 ;; calc digits (Push a zero onto the stack)
6167st ;; calc-store-into (Store it in the following variable)
61681 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
61691 ;; calc digits (Initial value for the loop)
6170TAB ;; calc-roll-down (Swap initial and final)
6171Z( ;; calc-kbd-for (Begin the "for" loop)
6172& ;; calc-inv (Take the reciprocal)
6173s+ ;; calc-store-plus (Add to the following variable)
61741 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
61751 ;; calc digits (The loop step is 1)
6176Z) ;; calc-kbd-end-for (End the "for" loop)
6177sr ;; calc-recall (Recall the final accumulated value)
61781 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6179Z' ;; calc-kbd-pop (Restore values)
6180@end smallexample
6181
6182@noindent
6183Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and return to the Calculator.
6184
6185@smallexample
6186@group
61871: 20 1: 3.597739
6188 . .
6189
6190 20 z h
6191@end group
6192@end smallexample
6193
6194The @file{edmacro} package defines a handy @code{read-kbd-macro} command
6195which reads the current region of the current buffer as a sequence of
6196keystroke names, and defines that sequence on the @kbd{X}
6197(and @kbd{C-x e}) key. Because this is so useful, Calc puts this
6198command on the @kbd{C-x * m} key. Try reading in this macro in the
6199following form: Press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}) at
6200one end of the text below, then type @kbd{C-x * m} at the other.
6201
6202@example
6203@group
6204Z ` 0 t 1
6205 1 TAB
6206 Z ( & s + 1 1 Z )
6207 r 1
6208Z '
6209@end group
6210@end example
6211
6212(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} A general algorithm for solving
6213equations numerically is @dfn{Newton's Method}. Given the equation
6214@expr{f(x) = 0} for any function @expr{f}, and an initial guess
6215@expr{x_0} which is reasonably close to the desired solution, apply
6216this formula over and over:
6217
6218@ifnottex
6219@example
6220new_x = x - f(x)/f'(x)
6221@end example
6222@end ifnottex
6223@tex
6224\beforedisplay
db37d257 6225$$ x_{\rm new} = x - {f(x) \over f^{\prime}(x)} $$
4009494e
GM
6226\afterdisplay
6227@end tex
6228
6229@noindent
6230where @expr{f'(x)} is the derivative of @expr{f}. The @expr{x}
6231values will quickly converge to a solution, i.e., eventually
6232@texline @math{x_{\rm new}}
6233@infoline @expr{new_x}
6234and @expr{x} will be equal to within the limits
6235of the current precision. Write a program which takes a formula
6236involving the variable @expr{x}, and an initial guess @expr{x_0},
6237on the stack, and produces a value of @expr{x} for which the formula
6238is zero. Use it to find a solution of
6239@texline @math{\sin(\cos x) = 0.5}
6240@infoline @expr{sin(cos(x)) = 0.5}
6241near @expr{x = 4.5}. (Use angles measured in radians.) Note that
6242the built-in @w{@kbd{a R}} (@code{calc-find-root}) command uses Newton's
6243method when it is able. @xref{Programming Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
6244
6245@cindex Digamma function
6246@cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
6247@cindex Euler's gamma constant
6248(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} The @dfn{digamma} function
6249@texline @math{\psi(z) (``psi'')}
6250@infoline @expr{psi(z)}
6251is defined as the derivative of
6252@texline @math{\ln \Gamma(z)}.
6253@infoline @expr{ln(gamma(z))}.
6254For large values of @expr{z}, it can be approximated by the infinite sum
6255
6256@ifnottex
6257@example
6258psi(z) ~= ln(z) - 1/2z - sum(bern(2 n) / 2 n z^(2 n), n, 1, inf)
6259@end example
6260@end ifnottex
6261@tex
6262\beforedisplay
6263$$ \psi(z) \approx \ln z - {1\over2z} -
6264 \sum_{n=1}^\infty {\code{bern}(2 n) \over 2 n z^{2n}}
6265$$
6266\afterdisplay
6267@end tex
6268
6269@noindent
6270where
6271@texline @math{\sum}
6272@infoline @expr{sum}
6273represents the sum over @expr{n} from 1 to infinity
6274(or to some limit high enough to give the desired accuracy), and
6275the @code{bern} function produces (exact) Bernoulli numbers.
6276While this sum is not guaranteed to converge, in practice it is safe.
6277An interesting mathematical constant is Euler's gamma, which is equal
6278to about 0.5772. One way to compute it is by the formula,
6279@texline @math{\gamma = -\psi(1)}.
6280@infoline @expr{gamma = -psi(1)}.
6281Unfortunately, 1 isn't a large enough argument
6282for the above formula to work (5 is a much safer value for @expr{z}).
6283Fortunately, we can compute
6284@texline @math{\psi(1)}
6285@infoline @expr{psi(1)}
6286from
6287@texline @math{\psi(5)}
6288@infoline @expr{psi(5)}
6289using the recurrence
6290@texline @math{\psi(z+1) = \psi(z) + {1 \over z}}.
6291@infoline @expr{psi(z+1) = psi(z) + 1/z}.
6292Your task: Develop a program to compute
6293@texline @math{\psi(z)};
6294@infoline @expr{psi(z)};
6295it should ``pump up'' @expr{z}
6296if necessary to be greater than 5, then use the above summation
6297formula. Use looping commands to compute the sum. Use your function
6298to compute
6299@texline @math{\gamma}
6300@infoline @expr{gamma}
6301to twelve decimal places. (Calc has a built-in command
6302for Euler's constant, @kbd{I P}, which you can use to check your answer.)
6303@xref{Programming Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
6304
6305@cindex Polynomial, list of coefficients
6306(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Given a polynomial in @expr{x} and
6307a number @expr{m} on the stack, where the polynomial is of degree
6308@expr{m} or less (i.e., does not have any terms higher than @expr{x^m}),
6309write a program to convert the polynomial into a list-of-coefficients
6310notation. For example, @expr{5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2} with @expr{m = 6}
6311should produce the list @expr{[1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]}. Also develop
6312a way to convert from this form back to the standard algebraic form.
6313@xref{Programming Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
6314
6315@cindex Recursion
6316(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The @dfn{Stirling numbers of the
6317first kind} are defined by the recurrences,
6318
6319@ifnottex
6320@example
6321s(n,n) = 1 for n >= 0,
6322s(n,0) = 0 for n > 0,
6323s(n+1,m) = s(n,m-1) - n s(n,m) for n >= m >= 1.
6324@end example
6325@end ifnottex
6326@tex
4009494e
GM
6327\beforedisplay
6328$$ \eqalign{ s(n,n) &= 1 \qquad \hbox{for } n \ge 0, \cr
6329 s(n,0) &= 0 \qquad \hbox{for } n > 0, \cr
6330 s(n+1,m) &= s(n,m-1) - n \, s(n,m) \qquad
6331 \hbox{for } n \ge m \ge 1.}
6332$$
6333\afterdisplay
6334\vskip5pt
6335(These numbers are also sometimes written $\displaystyle{n \brack m}$.)
6336@end tex
6337
6338This can be implemented using a @dfn{recursive} program in Calc; the
6339program must invoke itself in order to calculate the two righthand
6340terms in the general formula. Since it always invokes itself with
6341``simpler'' arguments, it's easy to see that it must eventually finish
6342the computation. Recursion is a little difficult with Emacs keyboard
6343macros since the macro is executed before its definition is complete.
6344So here's the recommended strategy: Create a ``dummy macro'' and assign
6345it to a key with, e.g., @kbd{Z K s}. Now enter the true definition,
6346using the @kbd{z s} command to call itself recursively, then assign it
6347to the same key with @kbd{Z K s}. Now the @kbd{z s} command will run
6348the complete recursive program. (Another way is to use @w{@kbd{Z E}}
6349or @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the whole macro at once,
6350thus avoiding the ``training'' phase.) The task: Write a program
6351that computes Stirling numbers of the first kind, given @expr{n} and
6352@expr{m} on the stack. Test it with @emph{small} inputs like
6353@expr{s(4,2)}. (There is a built-in command for Stirling numbers,
6354@kbd{k s}, which you can use to check your answers.)
6355@xref{Programming Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
6356
6357The programming commands we've seen in this part of the tutorial
6358are low-level, general-purpose operations. Often you will find
6359that a higher-level function, such as vector mapping or rewrite
6360rules, will do the job much more easily than a detailed, step-by-step
6361program can:
6362
6363(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} Write another program for
6364computing Stirling numbers of the first kind, this time using
6365rewrite rules. Once again, @expr{n} and @expr{m} should be taken
6366from the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
6367
6368@example
6369
6370@end example
6371This ends the tutorial section of the Calc manual. Now you know enough
6372about Calc to use it effectively for many kinds of calculations. But
6373Calc has many features that were not even touched upon in this tutorial.
6374@c [not-split]
6375The rest of this manual tells the whole story.
6376@c [when-split]
6377@c Volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}, tells the whole story.
6378
6379@page
6380@node Answers to Exercises, , Programming Tutorial, Tutorial
6381@section Answers to Exercises
6382
6383@noindent
6384This section includes answers to all the exercises in the Calc tutorial.
6385
6386@menu
6387* RPN Answer 1:: 1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -
6388* RPN Answer 2:: 2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4
6389* RPN Answer 3:: Operating on levels 2 and 3
6390* RPN Answer 4:: Joe's complex problems
6391* Algebraic Answer 1:: Simulating Q command
6392* Algebraic Answer 2:: Joe's algebraic woes
6393* Algebraic Answer 3:: 1 / 0
6394* Modes Answer 1:: 3#0.1 = 3#0.0222222?
6395* Modes Answer 2:: 16#f.e8fe15
6396* Modes Answer 3:: Joe's rounding bug
6397* Modes Answer 4:: Why floating point?
6398* Arithmetic Answer 1:: Why the \ command?
6399* Arithmetic Answer 2:: Tripping up the B command
6400* Vector Answer 1:: Normalizing a vector
6401* Vector Answer 2:: Average position
6402* Matrix Answer 1:: Row and column sums
6403* Matrix Answer 2:: Symbolic system of equations
6404* Matrix Answer 3:: Over-determined system
6405* List Answer 1:: Powers of two
6406* List Answer 2:: Least-squares fit with matrices
6407* List Answer 3:: Geometric mean
6408* List Answer 4:: Divisor function
6409* List Answer 5:: Duplicate factors
6410* List Answer 6:: Triangular list
6411* List Answer 7:: Another triangular list
6412* List Answer 8:: Maximum of Bessel function
6413* List Answer 9:: Integers the hard way
6414* List Answer 10:: All elements equal
6415* List Answer 11:: Estimating pi with darts
6416* List Answer 12:: Estimating pi with matchsticks
6417* List Answer 13:: Hash codes
6418* List Answer 14:: Random walk
6419* Types Answer 1:: Square root of pi times rational
6420* Types Answer 2:: Infinities
6421* Types Answer 3:: What can "nan" be?
6422* Types Answer 4:: Abbey Road
6423* Types Answer 5:: Friday the 13th
6424* Types Answer 6:: Leap years
6425* Types Answer 7:: Erroneous donut
6426* Types Answer 8:: Dividing intervals
6427* Types Answer 9:: Squaring intervals
6428* Types Answer 10:: Fermat's primality test
6429* Types Answer 11:: pi * 10^7 seconds
6430* Types Answer 12:: Abbey Road on CD
6431* Types Answer 13:: Not quite pi * 10^7 seconds
6432* Types Answer 14:: Supercomputers and c
6433* Types Answer 15:: Sam the Slug
6434* Algebra Answer 1:: Squares and square roots
6435* Algebra Answer 2:: Building polynomial from roots
6436* Algebra Answer 3:: Integral of x sin(pi x)
6437* Algebra Answer 4:: Simpson's rule
6438* Rewrites Answer 1:: Multiplying by conjugate
6439* Rewrites Answer 2:: Alternative fib rule
6440* Rewrites Answer 3:: Rewriting opt(a) + opt(b) x
6441* Rewrites Answer 4:: Sequence of integers
6442* Rewrites Answer 5:: Number of terms in sum
6443* Rewrites Answer 6:: Truncated Taylor series
6444* Programming Answer 1:: Fresnel's C(x)
6445* Programming Answer 2:: Negate third stack element
6446* Programming Answer 3:: Compute sin(x) / x, etc.
6447* Programming Answer 4:: Average value of a list
6448* Programming Answer 5:: Continued fraction phi
6449* Programming Answer 6:: Matrix Fibonacci numbers
6450* Programming Answer 7:: Harmonic number greater than 4
6451* Programming Answer 8:: Newton's method
6452* Programming Answer 9:: Digamma function
6453* Programming Answer 10:: Unpacking a polynomial
6454* Programming Answer 11:: Recursive Stirling numbers
6455* Programming Answer 12:: Stirling numbers with rewrites
6456@end menu
6457
6458@c The following kludgery prevents the individual answers from
6459@c being entered on the table of contents.
6460@tex
6461\global\let\oldwrite=\write
6462\gdef\skipwrite#1#2{\let\write=\oldwrite}
6463\global\let\oldchapternofonts=\chapternofonts
6464\gdef\chapternofonts{\let\write=\skipwrite\oldchapternofonts}
6465@end tex
6466
6467@node RPN Answer 1, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises, Answers to Exercises
6468@subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 1
6469
6470@noindent
6471@kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -}
6472
6473The result is
6474@texline @math{1 - (2 \times (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6475@infoline @expr{1 - (2 * (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6476
6477@node RPN Answer 2, RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6478@subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 2
6479
6480@noindent
6481@texline @math{2\times4 + 7\times9.5 + {5\over4} = 75.75}
6482@infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4 = 75.75}
6483
6484After computing the intermediate term
6485@texline @math{2\times4 = 8},
6486@infoline @expr{2*4 = 8},
6487you can leave that result on the stack while you compute the second
6488term. With both of these results waiting on the stack you can then
6489compute the final term, then press @kbd{+ +} to add everything up.
6490
6491@smallexample
6492@group
64932: 2 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8
64941: 4 . 2: 7 1: 66.5
6495 . 1: 9.5 .
6496 .
6497
6498 2 @key{RET} 4 * 7 @key{RET} 9.5 *
6499
6500@end group
6501@end smallexample
6502@noindent
6503@smallexample
6504@group
65054: 8 3: 8 2: 8 1: 75.75
65063: 66.5 2: 66.5 1: 67.75 .
65072: 5 1: 1.25 .
65081: 4 .
6509 .
6510
6511 5 @key{RET} 4 / + +
6512@end group
6513@end smallexample
6514
6515Alternatively, you could add the first two terms before going on
6516with the third term.
6517
6518@smallexample
6519@group
65202: 8 1: 74.5 3: 74.5 2: 74.5 1: 75.75
65211: 66.5 . 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6522 . 1: 4 .
6523 .
6524
6525 ... + 5 @key{RET} 4 / +
6526@end group
6527@end smallexample
6528
6529On an old-style RPN calculator this second method would have the
6530advantage of using only three stack levels. But since Calc's stack
6531can grow arbitrarily large this isn't really an issue. Which method
6532you choose is purely a matter of taste.
6533
6534@node RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 4, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6535@subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 3
6536
6537@noindent
6538The @key{TAB} key provides a way to operate on the number in level 2.
6539
6540@smallexample
6541@group
65423: 10 3: 10 4: 10 3: 10 3: 10
65432: 20 2: 30 3: 30 2: 30 2: 21
65441: 30 1: 20 2: 20 1: 21 1: 30
6545 . . 1: 1 . .
6546 .
6547
6548 @key{TAB} 1 + @key{TAB}
6549@end group
6550@end smallexample
6551
6552Similarly, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} gives you access to the number in level 3.
6553
6554@smallexample
6555@group
65563: 10 3: 21 3: 21 3: 30 3: 11
65572: 21 2: 30 2: 30 2: 11 2: 21
65581: 30 1: 10 1: 11 1: 21 1: 30
6559 . . . . .
6560
6561 M-@key{TAB} 1 + M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
6562@end group
6563@end smallexample
6564
6565@node RPN Answer 4, Algebraic Answer 1, RPN Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6566@subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 4
6567
6568@noindent
6569Either @kbd{( 2 , 3 )} or @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )} would have worked,
6570but using both the comma and the space at once yields:
6571
6572@smallexample
6573@group
65741: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 2: (2, ... 2: (2, ...
6575 . 1: 2 . 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
6576 . . .
6577
6578 ( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )
6579@end group
6580@end smallexample
6581
6582Joe probably tried to type @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}} to swap the
6583extra incomplete object to the top of the stack and delete it.
6584But a feature of Calc is that @key{DEL} on an incomplete object
6585deletes just one component out of that object, so he had to press
6586@key{DEL} twice to finish the job.
6587
6588@smallexample
6589@group
65902: (2, ... 2: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (2, 3)
65911: (2, 3) 1: (2, ... 1: ( ... .
6592 . . .
6593
6594 @key{TAB} @key{DEL} @key{DEL}
6595@end group
6596@end smallexample
6597
6598(As it turns out, deleting the second-to-top stack entry happens often
6599enough that Calc provides a special key, @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, to do just that.
6600@kbd{M-@key{DEL}} is just like @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}}, except that it doesn't exhibit
6601the ``feature'' that tripped poor Joe.)
6602
6603@node Algebraic Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, RPN Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6604@subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 1
6605
6606@noindent
6607Type @kbd{' sqrt($) @key{RET}}.
6608
6609If the @kbd{Q} key is broken, you could use @kbd{' $^0.5 @key{RET}}.
6610Or, RPN style, @kbd{0.5 ^}.
6611
6612(Actually, @samp{$^1:2}, using the fraction one-half as the power, is
6613a closer equivalent, since @samp{9^0.5} yields @expr{3.0} whereas
6614@samp{sqrt(9)} and @samp{9^1:2} yield the exact integer @expr{3}.)
6615
6616@node Algebraic Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Algebraic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6617@subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 2
6618
6619@noindent
6620In the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)}, @samp{x} was interpreted as a function
6621name with @samp{1+y} as its argument. Assigning a value to a variable
6622has no relation to a function by the same name. Joe needed to use an
6623explicit @samp{*} symbol here: @samp{2 x*(1+y)}.
6624
6625@node Algebraic Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6626@subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 3
6627
6628@noindent
6629The result from @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} will be the formula @expr{1 / 0}.
6630The ``function'' @samp{/} cannot be evaluated when its second argument
6631is zero, so it is left in symbolic form. When you now type @kbd{0 *},
6632the result will be zero because Calc uses the general rule that ``zero
6633times anything is zero.''
6634
6635@c [fix-ref Infinities]
6636The @kbd{m i} command enables an @dfn{Infinite mode} in which @expr{1 / 0}
6637results in a special symbol that represents ``infinity.'' If you
6638multiply infinity by zero, Calc uses another special new symbol to
6639show that the answer is ``indeterminate.'' @xref{Infinities}, for
6640further discussion of infinite and indeterminate values.
6641
6642@node Modes Answer 1, Modes Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6643@subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 1
6644
6645@noindent
6646Calc always stores its numbers in decimal, so even though one-third has
6647an exact base-3 representation (@samp{3#0.1}), it is still stored as
66480.3333333 (chopped off after 12 or however many decimal digits) inside
6649the calculator's memory. When this inexact number is converted back
6650to base 3 for display, it may still be slightly inexact. When we
6651multiply this number by 3, we get 0.999999, also an inexact value.
6652
6653When Calc displays a number in base 3, it has to decide how many digits
6654to show. If the current precision is 12 (decimal) digits, that corresponds
6655to @samp{12 / log10(3) = 25.15} base-3 digits. Because 25.15 is not an
6656exact integer, Calc shows only 25 digits, with the result that stored
6657numbers carry a little bit of extra information that may not show up on
6658the screen. When Joe entered @samp{3#0.2}, the stored number 0.666666
6659happened to round to a pleasing value when it lost that last 0.15 of a
6660digit, but it was still inexact in Calc's memory. When he divided by 2,
6661he still got the dreaded inexact value 0.333333. (Actually, he divided
66620.666667 by 2 to get 0.333334, which is why he got something a little
6663higher than @code{3#0.1} instead of a little lower.)
6664
6665If Joe didn't want to be bothered with all this, he could have typed
6666@kbd{M-24 d n} to display with one less digit than the default. (If
6667you give @kbd{d n} a negative argument, it uses default-minus-that,
6668so @kbd{M-- d n} would be an easier way to get the same effect.) Those
6669inexact results would still be lurking there, but they would now be
6670rounded to nice, natural-looking values for display purposes. (Remember,
6671@samp{0.022222} in base 3 is like @samp{0.099999} in base 10; rounding
6672off one digit will round the number up to @samp{0.1}.) Depending on the
6673nature of your work, this hiding of the inexactness may be a benefit or
6674a danger. With the @kbd{d n} command, Calc gives you the choice.
6675
6676Incidentally, another consequence of all this is that if you type
6677@kbd{M-30 d n} to display more digits than are ``really there,''
6678you'll see garbage digits at the end of the number. (In decimal
6679display mode, with decimally-stored numbers, these garbage digits are
6680always zero so they vanish and you don't notice them.) Because Calc
6681rounds off that 0.15 digit, there is the danger that two numbers could
6682be slightly different internally but still look the same. If you feel
6683uneasy about this, set the @kbd{d n} precision to be a little higher
6684than normal; you'll get ugly garbage digits, but you'll always be able
6685to tell two distinct numbers apart.
6686
6687An interesting side note is that most computers store their
6688floating-point numbers in binary, and convert to decimal for display.
6689Thus everyday programs have the same problem: Decimal 0.1 cannot be
6690represented exactly in binary (try it: @kbd{0.1 d 2}), so @samp{0.1 * 10}
6691comes out as an inexact approximation to 1 on some machines (though
6692they generally arrange to hide it from you by rounding off one digit as
6693we did above). Because Calc works in decimal instead of binary, you can
6694be sure that numbers that look exact @emph{are} exact as long as you stay
6695in decimal display mode.
6696
6697It's not hard to show that any number that can be represented exactly
6698in binary, octal, or hexadecimal is also exact in decimal, so the kinds
6699of problems we saw in this exercise are likely to be severe only when
6700you use a relatively unusual radix like 3.
6701
6702@node Modes Answer 2, Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6703@subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 2
6704
6705If the radix is 15 or higher, we can't use the letter @samp{e} to mark
6706the exponent because @samp{e} is interpreted as a digit. When Calc
6707needs to display scientific notation in a high radix, it writes
6708@samp{16#F.E8F*16.^15}. You can enter a number like this as an
6709algebraic entry. Also, pressing @kbd{e} without any digits before it
6710normally types @kbd{1e}, but in a high radix it types @kbd{16.^} and
6711puts you in algebraic entry: @kbd{16#f.e8f @key{RET} e 15 @key{RET} *} is another
6712way to enter this number.
6713
6714The reason Calc puts a decimal point in the @samp{16.^} is to prevent
6715huge integers from being generated if the exponent is large (consider
6716@samp{16#1.23*16^1000}, where we compute @samp{16^1000} as a giant
6717exact integer and then throw away most of the digits when we multiply
6718it by the floating-point @samp{16#1.23}). While this wouldn't normally
6719matter for display purposes, it could give you a nasty surprise if you
6720copied that number into a file and later moved it back into Calc.
6721
6722@node Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 4, Modes Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6723@subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 3
6724
6725@noindent
6726The answer he got was @expr{0.5000000000006399}.
6727
6728The problem is not that the square operation is inexact, but that the
6729sine of 45 that was already on the stack was accurate to only 12 places.
6730Arbitrary-precision calculations still only give answers as good as
6731their inputs.
6732
6733The real problem is that there is no 12-digit number which, when
6734squared, comes out to 0.5 exactly. The @kbd{f [} and @kbd{f ]}
6735commands decrease or increase a number by one unit in the last
6736place (according to the current precision). They are useful for
6737determining facts like this.
6738
6739@smallexample
6740@group
67411: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001
6742 . .
6743
6744 45 S 2 ^
6745
6746@end group
6747@end smallexample
6748@noindent
6749@smallexample
6750@group
67511: 0.707106781187 1: 0.707106781186 1: 0.499999999999
6752 . . .
6753
6754 U @key{DEL} f [ 2 ^
6755@end group
6756@end smallexample
6757
6758A high-precision calculation must be carried out in high precision
6759all the way. The only number in the original problem which was known
6760exactly was the quantity 45 degrees, so the precision must be raised
6761before anything is done after the number 45 has been entered in order
6762for the higher precision to be meaningful.
6763
6764@node Modes Answer 4, Arithmetic Answer 1, Modes Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6765@subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 4
6766
6767@noindent
6768Many calculations involve real-world quantities, like the width and
6769height of a piece of wood or the volume of a jar. Such quantities
6770can't be measured exactly anyway, and if the data that is input to
6771a calculation is inexact, doing exact arithmetic on it is a waste
6772of time.
6773
6774Fractions become unwieldy after too many calculations have been
6775done with them. For example, the sum of the reciprocals of the
6776integers from 1 to 10 is 7381:2520. The sum from 1 to 30 is
67779304682830147:2329089562800. After a point it will take a long
6778time to add even one more term to this sum, but a floating-point
6779calculation of the sum will not have this problem.
6780
6781Also, rational numbers cannot express the results of all calculations.
6782There is no fractional form for the square root of two, so if you type
6783@w{@kbd{2 Q}}, Calc has no choice but to give you a floating-point answer.
6784
6785@node Arithmetic Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 2, Modes Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6786@subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 1
6787
6788@noindent
6789Dividing two integers that are larger than the current precision may
6790give a floating-point result that is inaccurate even when rounded
6791down to an integer. Consider @expr{123456789 / 2} when the current
6792precision is 6 digits. The true answer is @expr{61728394.5}, but
6793with a precision of 6 this will be rounded to
6794@texline @math{12345700.0/2.0 = 61728500.0}.
6795@infoline @expr{12345700.@: / 2.@: = 61728500.}.
6796The result, when converted to an integer, will be off by 106.
6797
6798Here are two solutions: Raise the precision enough that the
6799floating-point round-off error is strictly to the right of the
6800decimal point. Or, convert to Fraction mode so that @expr{123456789 / 2}
6801produces the exact fraction @expr{123456789:2}, which can be rounded
6802down by the @kbd{F} command without ever switching to floating-point
6803format.
6804
6805@node Arithmetic Answer 2, Vector Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6806@subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 2
6807
6808@noindent
6809@kbd{27 @key{RET} 9 B} could give the exact result @expr{3:2}, but it
6810does a floating-point calculation instead and produces @expr{1.5}.
6811
6812Calc will find an exact result for a logarithm if the result is an integer
6813or (when in Fraction mode) the reciprocal of an integer. But there is
6814no efficient way to search the space of all possible rational numbers
6815for an exact answer, so Calc doesn't try.
6816
6817@node Vector Answer 1, Vector Answer 2, Arithmetic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6818@subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 1
6819
6820@noindent
6821Duplicate the vector, compute its length, then divide the vector
6822by its length: @kbd{@key{RET} A /}.
6823
6824@smallexample
6825@group
68261: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [0.27, 0.53, 0.80] 1: 1.
6827 . 1: 3.74165738677 . .
6828 .
6829
6830 r 1 @key{RET} A / A
6831@end group
6832@end smallexample
6833
6834The final @kbd{A} command shows that the normalized vector does
6835indeed have unit length.
6836
6837@node Vector Answer 2, Matrix Answer 1, Vector Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6838@subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 2
6839
6840@noindent
6841The average position is equal to the sum of the products of the
6842positions times their corresponding probabilities. This is the
6843definition of the dot product operation. So all you need to do
6844is to put the two vectors on the stack and press @kbd{*}.
6845
6846@node Matrix Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Vector Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6847@subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 1
6848
6849@noindent
6850The trick is to multiply by a vector of ones. Use @kbd{r 4 [1 1 1] *} to
6851get the row sum. Similarly, use @kbd{[1 1] r 4 *} to get the column sum.
6852
6853@node Matrix Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Matrix Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6854@subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 2
6855
6856@ifnottex
6857@example
6858@group
6859 x + a y = 6
6860 x + b y = 10
6861@end group
6862@end example
6863@end ifnottex
6864@tex
4009494e
GM
6865\beforedisplay
6866$$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
6867 x &+ b y = 10}
6868$$
6869\afterdisplay
6870@end tex
6871
6872Just enter the righthand side vector, then divide by the lefthand side
6873matrix as usual.
6874
6875@smallexample
6876@group
68771: [6, 10] 2: [6, 10] 1: [6 - 4 a / (b - a), 4 / (b - a) ]
6878 . 1: [ [ 1, a ] .
6879 [ 1, b ] ]
6880 .
6881
6882' [6 10] @key{RET} ' [1 a; 1 b] @key{RET} /
6883@end group
6884@end smallexample
6885
6886This can be made more readable using @kbd{d B} to enable Big display
6887mode:
6888
6889@smallexample
6890@group
6891 4 a 4
68921: [6 - -----, -----]
6893 b - a b - a
6894@end group
6895@end smallexample
6896
6897Type @kbd{d N} to return to Normal display mode afterwards.
6898
6899@node Matrix Answer 3, List Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6900@subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 3
6901
6902@noindent
6903To solve
6904@texline @math{A^T A \, X = A^T B},
6905@infoline @expr{trn(A) * A * X = trn(A) * B},
6906first we compute
6907@texline @math{A' = A^T A}
6908@infoline @expr{A2 = trn(A) * A}
6909and
6910@texline @math{B' = A^T B};
6911@infoline @expr{B2 = trn(A) * B};
6912now, we have a system
6913@texline @math{A' X = B'}
6914@infoline @expr{A2 * X = B2}
6915which we can solve using Calc's @samp{/} command.
6916
6917@ifnottex
6918@example
6919@group
6920 a + 2b + 3c = 6
6921 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
6922 7a + 6b = 3
6923 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
6924@end group
6925@end example
6926@end ifnottex
6927@tex
4009494e
GM
6928\beforedisplayh
6929$$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
6930\halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
6931 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6932 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6933 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
6934 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
6935 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
6936 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
6937 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
6938$$
6939\afterdisplayh
6940@end tex
6941
6942The first step is to enter the coefficient matrix. We'll store it in
6943quick variable number 7 for later reference. Next, we compute the
6944@texline @math{B'}
6945@infoline @expr{B2}
6946vector.
6947
6948@smallexample
6949@group
69501: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 4, 7, 2 ] 1: [57, 84, 96]
6951 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2, 5, 6, 4 ] .
6952 [ 7, 6, 0 ] [ 3, 6, 0, 6 ] ]
6953 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ] 1: [6, 2, 3, 11]
6954 . .
6955
6956' [1 2 3; 4 5 6; 7 6 0; 2 4 6] @key{RET} s 7 v t [6 2 3 11] *
6957@end group
6958@end smallexample
6959
6960@noindent
6961Now we compute the matrix
6962@texline @math{A'}
6963@infoline @expr{A2}
6964and divide.
6965
6966@smallexample
6967@group
69682: [57, 84, 96] 1: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64]
69691: [ [ 70, 72, 39 ] .
6970 [ 72, 81, 60 ]
6971 [ 39, 60, 81 ] ]
6972 .
6973
6974 r 7 v t r 7 * /
6975@end group
6976@end smallexample
6977
6978@noindent
6979(The actual computed answer will be slightly inexact due to
6980round-off error.)
6981
6982Notice that the answers are similar to those for the
6983@texline @math{3\times3}
6984@infoline 3x3
6985system solved in the text. That's because the fourth equation that was
6986added to the system is almost identical to the first one multiplied
6987by two. (If it were identical, we would have gotten the exact same
6988answer since the
6989@texline @math{4\times3}
6990@infoline 4x3
6991system would be equivalent to the original
6992@texline @math{3\times3}
6993@infoline 3x3
6994system.)
6995
6996Since the first and fourth equations aren't quite equivalent, they
6997can't both be satisfied at once. Let's plug our answers back into
6998the original system of equations to see how well they match.
6999
7000@smallexample
7001@group
70022: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64] 1: [5.6, 2., 3., 11.2]
70031: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
7004 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
7005 [ 7, 6, 0 ]
7006 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ]
7007 .
7008
7009 r 7 @key{TAB} *
7010@end group
7011@end smallexample
7012
7013@noindent
7014This is reasonably close to our original @expr{B} vector,
7015@expr{[6, 2, 3, 11]}.
7016
7017@node List Answer 1, List Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7018@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 1
7019
7020@noindent
7021We can use @kbd{v x} to build a vector of integers. This needs to be
7022adjusted to get the range of integers we desire. Mapping @samp{-}
7023across the vector will accomplish this, although it turns out the
7024plain @samp{-} key will work just as well.
7025
7026@smallexample
7027@group
70282: 2 2: 2
70291: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9] 1: [-4, -3, -2, -1, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4]
7030 . .
7031
7032 2 v x 9 @key{RET} 5 V M - or 5 -
7033@end group
7034@end smallexample
7035
7036@noindent
7037Now we use @kbd{V M ^} to map the exponentiation operator across the
7038vector.
7039
7040@smallexample
7041@group
70421: [0.0625, 0.125, 0.25, 0.5, 1, 2, 4, 8, 16]
7043 .
7044
7045 V M ^
7046@end group
7047@end smallexample
7048
7049@node List Answer 2, List Answer 3, List Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7050@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 2
7051
7052@noindent
7053Given @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors in quick variables 1 and 2 as before,
7054the first job is to form the matrix that describes the problem.
7055
7056@ifnottex
7057@example
7058 m*x + b*1 = y
7059@end example
7060@end ifnottex
7061@tex
4009494e
GM
7062\beforedisplay
7063$$ m \times x + b \times 1 = y $$
7064\afterdisplay
7065@end tex
7066
7067Thus we want a
7068@texline @math{19\times2}
7069@infoline 19x2
7070matrix with our @expr{x} vector as one column and
7071ones as the other column. So, first we build the column of ones, then
7072we combine the two columns to form our @expr{A} matrix.
7073
7074@smallexample
7075@group
70762: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 1: [ [ 1.34, 1 ]
70771: [1, 1, 1, ...] [ 1.41, 1 ]
7078 . [ 1.49, 1 ]
7079 @dots{}
7080
7081 r 1 1 v b 19 @key{RET} M-2 v p v t s 3
7082@end group
7083@end smallexample
7084
7085@noindent
7086Now we compute
7087@texline @math{A^T y}
7088@infoline @expr{trn(A) * y}
7089and
7090@texline @math{A^T A}
7091@infoline @expr{trn(A) * A}
7092and divide.
7093
7094@smallexample
7095@group
70961: [33.36554, 13.613] 2: [33.36554, 13.613]
7097 . 1: [ [ 98.0003, 41.63 ]
7098 [ 41.63, 19 ] ]
7099 .
7100
7101 v t r 2 * r 3 v t r 3 *
7102@end group
7103@end smallexample
7104
7105@noindent
7106(Hey, those numbers look familiar!)
7107
7108@smallexample
7109@group
71101: [0.52141679, -0.425978]
7111 .
7112
7113 /
7114@end group
7115@end smallexample
7116
7117Since we were solving equations of the form
7118@texline @math{m \times x + b \times 1 = y},
7119@infoline @expr{m*x + b*1 = y},
7120these numbers should be @expr{m} and @expr{b}, respectively. Sure
7121enough, they agree exactly with the result computed using @kbd{V M} and
7122@kbd{V R}!
7123
7124The moral of this story: @kbd{V M} and @kbd{V R} will probably solve
7125your problem, but there is often an easier way using the higher-level
7126arithmetic functions!
7127
7128@c [fix-ref Curve Fitting]
7129In fact, there is a built-in @kbd{a F} command that does least-squares
7130fits. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
7131
7132@node List Answer 3, List Answer 4, List Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7133@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 3
7134
7135@noindent
7136Move to one end of the list and press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or
7137whatever) to set the mark, then move to the other end of the list
7138and type @w{@kbd{C-x * g}}.
7139
7140@smallexample
7141@group
71421: [2.3, 6, 22, 15.1, 7, 15, 14, 7.5, 2.5]
7143 .
7144@end group
7145@end smallexample
7146
7147To make things interesting, let's assume we don't know at a glance
7148how many numbers are in this list. Then we could type:
7149
7150@smallexample
7151@group
71522: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ]
71531: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 126356422.5
7154 . .
7155
7156 @key{RET} V R *
7157
7158@end group
7159@end smallexample
7160@noindent
7161@smallexample
7162@group
71632: 126356422.5 2: 126356422.5 1: 7.94652913734
71641: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 9 .
7165 . .
7166
7167 @key{TAB} v l I ^
7168@end group
7169@end smallexample
7170
7171@noindent
7172(The @kbd{I ^} command computes the @var{n}th root of a number.
7173You could also type @kbd{& ^} to take the reciprocal of 9 and
7174then raise the number to that power.)
7175
7176@node List Answer 4, List Answer 5, List Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7177@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 4
7178
7179@noindent
7180A number @expr{j} is a divisor of @expr{n} if
7181@texline @math{n \mathbin{\hbox{\code{\%}}} j = 0}.
7182@infoline @samp{n % j = 0}.
7183The first step is to get a vector that identifies the divisors.
7184
7185@smallexample
7186@group
71872: 30 2: [0, 0, 0, 2, ...] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...]
71881: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: 0 .
7189 . .
7190
7191 30 @key{RET} v x 30 @key{RET} s 1 V M % 0 V M a = s 2
7192@end group
7193@end smallexample
7194
7195@noindent
7196This vector has 1's marking divisors of 30 and 0's marking non-divisors.
7197
7198The zeroth divisor function is just the total number of divisors.
7199The first divisor function is the sum of the divisors.
7200
7201@smallexample
7202@group
72031: 8 3: 8 2: 8 2: 8
7204 2: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: [1, 2, 3, 0, ...] 1: 72
7205 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...] . .
7206 .
7207
7208 V R + r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
7209@end group
7210@end smallexample
7211
7212@noindent
7213Once again, the last two steps just compute a dot product for which
7214a simple @kbd{*} would have worked equally well.
7215
7216@node List Answer 5, List Answer 6, List Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
7217@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 5
7218
7219@noindent
7220The obvious first step is to obtain the list of factors with @kbd{k f}.
7221This list will always be in sorted order, so if there are duplicates
7222they will be right next to each other. A suitable method is to compare
7223the list with a copy of itself shifted over by one.
7224
7225@smallexample
7226@group
72271: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0]
7228 . 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0] 1: [0, 3, 7, 7, 7, 19]
7229 . .
7230
7231 19551 k f @key{RET} 0 | @key{TAB} 0 @key{TAB} |
7232
7233@end group
7234@end smallexample
7235@noindent
7236@smallexample
7237@group
72381: [0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0] 1: 2 1: 0
7239 . . .
7240
7241 V M a = V R + 0 a =
7242@end group
7243@end smallexample
7244
7245@noindent
7246Note that we have to arrange for both vectors to have the same length
7247so that the mapping operation works; no prime factor will ever be
7248zero, so adding zeros on the left and right is safe. From then on
7249the job is pretty straightforward.
7250
7251Incidentally, Calc provides the
7252@texline @dfn{M@"obius} @math{\mu}
7253@infoline @dfn{Moebius mu}
7254function which is zero if and only if its argument is square-free. It
7255would be a much more convenient way to do the above test in practice.
7256
7257@node List Answer 6, List Answer 7, List Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
7258@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 6
7259
7260@noindent
7261First use @kbd{v x 6 @key{RET}} to get a list of integers, then @kbd{V M v x}
7262to get a list of lists of integers!
7263
7264@node List Answer 7, List Answer 8, List Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
7265@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 7
7266
7267@noindent
7268Here's one solution. First, compute the triangular list from the previous
7269exercise and type @kbd{1 -} to subtract one from all the elements.
7270
7271@smallexample
7272@group
72731: [ [0],
7274 [0, 1],
7275 [0, 1, 2],
7276 @dots{}
7277
7278 1 -
7279@end group
7280@end smallexample
7281
7282The numbers down the lefthand edge of the list we desire are called
7283the ``triangular numbers'' (now you know why!). The @expr{n}th
7284triangular number is the sum of the integers from 1 to @expr{n}, and
7285can be computed directly by the formula
7286@texline @math{n (n+1) \over 2}.
7287@infoline @expr{n * (n+1) / 2}.
7288
7289@smallexample
7290@group
72912: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
72921: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7293 . .
7294
7295 v x 6 @key{RET} 1 - V M ' $ ($+1)/2 @key{RET}
7296@end group
7297@end smallexample
7298
7299@noindent
7300Adding this list to the above list of lists produces the desired
7301result:
7302
7303@smallexample
7304@group
73051: [ [0],
7306 [1, 2],
7307 [3, 4, 5],
7308 [6, 7, 8, 9],
7309 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
7310 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
7311 .
7312
7313 V M +
7314@end group
7315@end smallexample
7316
7317If we did not know the formula for triangular numbers, we could have
7318computed them using a @kbd{V U +} command. We could also have
7319gotten them the hard way by mapping a reduction across the original
7320triangular list.
7321
7322@smallexample
7323@group
73242: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
73251: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7326 . .
7327
7328 @key{RET} V M V R +
7329@end group
7330@end smallexample
7331
7332@noindent
7333(This means ``map a @kbd{V R +} command across the vector,'' and
7334since each element of the main vector is itself a small vector,
7335@kbd{V R +} computes the sum of its elements.)
7336
7337@node List Answer 8, List Answer 9, List Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
7338@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 8
7339
7340@noindent
7341The first step is to build a list of values of @expr{x}.
7342
7343@smallexample
7344@group
73451: [1, 2, 3, ..., 21] 1: [0, 1, 2, ..., 20] 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ..., 5]
7346 . . .
7347
7348 v x 21 @key{RET} 1 - 4 / s 1
7349@end group
7350@end smallexample
7351
7352Next, we compute the Bessel function values.
7353
7354@smallexample
7355@group
73561: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ..., -0.328]
7357 .
7358
7359 V M ' besJ(1,$) @key{RET}
7360@end group
7361@end smallexample
7362
7363@noindent
7364(Another way to do this would be @kbd{1 @key{TAB} V M f j}.)
7365
7366A way to isolate the maximum value is to compute the maximum using
7367@kbd{V R X}, then compare all the Bessel values with that maximum.
7368
7369@smallexample
7370@group
73712: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ]
73721: 0.5801562 . 1: 1
7373 . .
7374
7375 @key{RET} V R X V M a = @key{RET} V R + @key{DEL}
7376@end group
7377@end smallexample
7378
7379@noindent
7380It's a good idea to verify, as in the last step above, that only
7381one value is equal to the maximum. (After all, a plot of
7382@texline @math{\sin x}
7383@infoline @expr{sin(x)}
7384might have many points all equal to the maximum value, 1.)
7385
7386The vector we have now has a single 1 in the position that indicates
7387the maximum value of @expr{x}. Now it is a simple matter to convert
7388this back into the corresponding value itself.
7389
7390@smallexample
7391@group
73922: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0., 0., ... ] 1: 1.75
73931: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ... ] . .
7394 .
7395
7396 r 1 V M * V R +
7397@end group
7398@end smallexample
7399
7400If @kbd{a =} had produced more than one @expr{1} value, this method
7401would have given the sum of all maximum @expr{x} values; not very
7402useful! In this case we could have used @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector})
7403instead. This command deletes all elements of a ``data'' vector that
7404correspond to zeros in a ``mask'' vector, leaving us with, in this
7405example, a vector of maximum @expr{x} values.
7406
7407The built-in @kbd{a X} command maximizes a function using more
7408efficient methods. Just for illustration, let's use @kbd{a X}
7409to maximize @samp{besJ(1,x)} over this same interval.
7410
7411@smallexample
7412@group
74132: besJ(1, x) 1: [1.84115, 0.581865]
74141: [0 .. 5] .
7415 .
7416
7417' besJ(1,x), [0..5] @key{RET} a X x @key{RET}
7418@end group
7419@end smallexample
7420
7421@noindent
7422The output from @kbd{a X} is a vector containing the value of @expr{x}
7423that maximizes the function, and the function's value at that maximum.
7424As you can see, our simple search got quite close to the right answer.
7425
7426@node List Answer 9, List Answer 10, List Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
7427@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 9
7428
7429@noindent
7430Step one is to convert our integer into vector notation.
7431
7432@smallexample
7433@group
74341: 25129925999 3: 25129925999
7435 . 2: 10
7436 1: [11, 10, 9, ..., 1, 0]
7437 .
7438
7439 25129925999 @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 12 @key{RET} v x 12 @key{RET} -
7440
7441@end group
7442@end smallexample
7443@noindent
7444@smallexample
7445@group
74461: 25129925999 1: [0, 2, 25, 251, 2512, ... ]
74472: [100000000000, ... ] .
7448 .
7449
7450 V M ^ s 1 V M \
7451@end group
7452@end smallexample
7453
7454@noindent
7455(Recall, the @kbd{\} command computes an integer quotient.)
7456
7457@smallexample
7458@group
74591: [0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 5, 9, 9, 9]
7460 .
7461
7462 10 V M % s 2
7463@end group
7464@end smallexample
7465
7466Next we must increment this number. This involves adding one to
7467the last digit, plus handling carries. There is a carry to the
7468left out of a digit if that digit is a nine and all the digits to
7469the right of it are nines.
7470
7471@smallexample
7472@group
74731: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, ... ]
7474 . .
7475
7476 9 V M a = v v
7477
7478@end group
7479@end smallexample
7480@noindent
7481@smallexample
7482@group
74831: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1]
7484 . .
7485
7486 V U * v v 1 |
7487@end group
7488@end smallexample
7489
7490@noindent
7491Accumulating @kbd{*} across a vector of ones and zeros will preserve
7492only the initial run of ones. These are the carries into all digits
7493except the rightmost digit. Concatenating a one on the right takes
7494care of aligning the carries properly, and also adding one to the
7495rightmost digit.
7496
7497@smallexample
7498@group
74992: [0, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 6, 0, 0, 0]
75001: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] .
7501 .
7502
7503 0 r 2 | V M + 10 V M %
7504@end group
7505@end smallexample
7506
7507@noindent
7508Here we have concatenated 0 to the @emph{left} of the original number;
7509this takes care of shifting the carries by one with respect to the
7510digits that generated them.
7511
7512Finally, we must convert this list back into an integer.
7513
7514@smallexample
7515@group
75163: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ]
75172: 1000000000000 1: [1000000000000, 100000000000, ... ]
75181: [100000000000, ... ] .
7519 .
7520
7521 10 @key{RET} 12 ^ r 1 |
7522
7523@end group
7524@end smallexample
7525@noindent
7526@smallexample
7527@group
75281: [0, 0, 20000000000, 5000000000, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7529 . .
7530
7531 V M * V R +
7532@end group
7533@end smallexample
7534
7535@noindent
7536Another way to do this final step would be to reduce the formula
7537@w{@samp{10 $$ + $}} across the vector of digits.
7538
7539@smallexample
7540@group
75411: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7542 . .
7543
7544 V R ' 10 $$ + $ @key{RET}
7545@end group
7546@end smallexample
7547
7548@node List Answer 10, List Answer 11, List Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
7549@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 10
7550
7551@noindent
7552For the list @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, the result is @expr{((a = b) = c) = d},
7553which will compare @expr{a} and @expr{b} to produce a 1 or 0, which is
7554then compared with @expr{c} to produce another 1 or 0, which is then
7555compared with @expr{d}. This is not at all what Joe wanted.
7556
7557Here's a more correct method:
7558
7559@smallexample
7560@group
75611: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7] 2: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7]
7562 . 1: 7
7563 .
7564
7565 ' [7,7,7,8,7] @key{RET} @key{RET} v r 1 @key{RET}
7566
7567@end group
7568@end smallexample
7569@noindent
7570@smallexample
7571@group
75721: [1, 1, 1, 0, 1] 1: 0
7573 . .
7574
7575 V M a = V R *
7576@end group
7577@end smallexample
7578
7579@node List Answer 11, List Answer 12, List Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
7580@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 11
7581
7582@noindent
7583The circle of unit radius consists of those points @expr{(x,y)} for which
7584@expr{x^2 + y^2 < 1}. We start by generating a vector of @expr{x^2}
7585and a vector of @expr{y^2}.
7586
7587We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7588commands.
7589
7590@smallexample
7591@group
75922: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.]
75931: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [1.16, 1.98, ..., 0.81]
7594 . .
7595
7596 v . t . 2. v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r
7597
7598@end group
7599@end smallexample
7600@noindent
7601@smallexample
7602@group
76032: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036]
76041: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036] 2: [0.53, 0.81, ..., 0.094]
7605 . .
7606
7607 1 - 2 V M ^ @key{TAB} V M k r 1 - 2 V M ^
7608@end group
7609@end smallexample
7610
7611Now we sum the @expr{x^2} and @expr{y^2} values, compare with 1 to
7612get a vector of 1/0 truth values, then sum the truth values.
7613
7614@smallexample
7615@group
76161: [0.56, 1.78, ..., 0.13] 1: [1, 0, ..., 1] 1: 84
7617 . . .
7618
7619 + 1 V M a < V R +
7620@end group
7621@end smallexample
7622
7623@noindent
7624The ratio @expr{84/100} should approximate the ratio @cpiover{4}.
7625
7626@smallexample
7627@group
76281: 0.84 1: 3.36 2: 3.36 1: 1.0695
7629 . . 1: 3.14159 .
7630
7631 100 / 4 * P /
7632@end group
7633@end smallexample
7634
7635@noindent
7636Our estimate, 3.36, is off by about 7%. We could get a better estimate
7637by taking more points (say, 1000), but it's clear that this method is
7638not very efficient!
7639
7640(Naturally, since this example uses random numbers your own answer
7641will be slightly different from the one shown here!)
7642
7643If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7644return to full-sized display of vectors.
7645
7646@node List Answer 12, List Answer 13, List Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
7647@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 12
7648
7649@noindent
7650This problem can be made a lot easier by taking advantage of some
7651symmetries. First of all, after some thought it's clear that the
7652@expr{y} axis can be ignored altogether. Just pick a random @expr{x}
7653component for one end of the match, pick a random direction
7654@texline @math{\theta},
7655@infoline @expr{theta},
7656and see if @expr{x} and
7657@texline @math{x + \cos \theta}
7658@infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)}
7659(which is the @expr{x} coordinate of the other endpoint) cross a line.
7660The lines are at integer coordinates, so this happens when the two
7661numbers surround an integer.
7662
7663Since the two endpoints are equivalent, we may as well choose the leftmost
7664of the two endpoints as @expr{x}. Then @expr{theta} is an angle pointing
7665to the right, in the range -90 to 90 degrees. (We could use radians, but
7666it would feel like cheating to refer to @cpiover{2} radians while trying
7667to estimate @cpi{}!)
7668
7669In fact, since the field of lines is infinite we can choose the
7670coordinates 0 and 1 for the lines on either side of the leftmost
7671endpoint. The rightmost endpoint will be between 0 and 1 if the
7672match does not cross a line, or between 1 and 2 if it does. So:
7673Pick random @expr{x} and
7674@texline @math{\theta},
7675@infoline @expr{theta},
7676compute
7677@texline @math{x + \cos \theta},
7678@infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)},
7679and count how many of the results are greater than one. Simple!
7680
7681We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7682commands.
7683
7684@smallexample
7685@group
76861: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72]
7687 . 1: [78.4, 64.5, ..., -42.9]
7688 .
7689
7690v . t . 1. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 180. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 90 -
7691@end group
7692@end smallexample
7693
7694@noindent
7695(The next step may be slow, depending on the speed of your computer.)
7696
7697@smallexample
7698@group
76992: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 1: [0.72, 1.14, ..., 1.45]
77001: [0.20, 0.43, ..., 0.73] .
7701 .
7702
7703 m d V M C +
7704
7705@end group
7706@end smallexample
7707@noindent
7708@smallexample
7709@group
77101: [0, 1, ..., 1] 1: 0.64 1: 3.125
7711 . . .
7712
7713 1 V M a > V R + 100 / 2 @key{TAB} /
7714@end group
7715@end smallexample
7716
7717Let's try the third method, too. We'll use random integers up to
7718one million. The @kbd{k r} command with an integer argument picks
7719a random integer.
7720
7721@smallexample
7722@group
77232: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 2: [78489, 527587, ..., 814975]
77241: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 1: [324014, 358783, ..., 955450]
7725 . .
7726
7727 1000000 v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r @key{TAB} V M k r
7728
7729@end group
7730@end smallexample
7731@noindent
7732@smallexample
7733@group
77341: [1, 1, ..., 25] 1: [1, 1, ..., 0] 1: 0.56
7735 . . .
7736
7737 V M k g 1 V M a = V R + 100 /
7738
7739@end group
7740@end smallexample
7741@noindent
7742@smallexample
7743@group
77441: 10.714 1: 3.273
7745 . .
7746
7747 6 @key{TAB} / Q
7748@end group
7749@end smallexample
7750
7751For a proof of this property of the GCD function, see section 4.5.2,
7752exercise 10, of Knuth's @emph{Art of Computer Programming}, volume II.
7753
7754If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7755return to full-sized display of vectors.
7756
7757@node List Answer 13, List Answer 14, List Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
7758@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 13
7759
7760@noindent
7761First, we put the string on the stack as a vector of ASCII codes.
7762
7763@smallexample
7764@group
77651: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7766 .
7767
7768 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET}
7769@end group
7770@end smallexample
7771
7772@noindent
7773Note that the @kbd{"} key, like @kbd{$}, initiates algebraic entry so
7774there was no need to type an apostrophe. Also, Calc didn't mind that
7775we omitted the closing @kbd{"}. (The same goes for all closing delimiters
7776like @kbd{)} and @kbd{]} at the end of a formula.
7777
7778We'll show two different approaches here. In the first, we note that
7779if the input vector is @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, then the hash code is
7780@expr{3 (3 (3a + b) + c) + d = 27a + 9b + 3c + d}. In other words,
7781it's a sum of descending powers of three times the ASCII codes.
7782
7783@smallexample
7784@group
77852: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
77861: 16 1: [15, 14, 13, ..., 0]
7787 . .
7788
7789 @key{RET} v l v x 16 @key{RET} -
7790
7791@end group
7792@end smallexample
7793@noindent
7794@smallexample
7795@group
77962: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098 1: 121
77971: [14348907, ..., 1] . .
7798 .
7799
7800 3 @key{TAB} V M ^ * 511 %
7801@end group
7802@end smallexample
7803
7804@noindent
7805Once again, @kbd{*} elegantly summarizes most of the computation.
7806But there's an even more elegant approach: Reduce the formula
7807@kbd{3 $$ + $} across the vector. Recall that this represents a
7808function of two arguments that computes its first argument times three
7809plus its second argument.
7810
7811@smallexample
7812@group
78131: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098
7814 . .
7815
7816 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' 3$$+$ @key{RET}
7817@end group
7818@end smallexample
7819
7820@noindent
7821If you did the decimal arithmetic exercise, this will be familiar.
7822Basically, we're turning a base-3 vector of digits into an integer,
7823except that our ``digits'' are much larger than real digits.
7824
7825Instead of typing @kbd{511 %} again to reduce the result, we can be
7826cleverer still and notice that rather than computing a huge integer
7827and taking the modulo at the end, we can take the modulo at each step
7828without affecting the result. While this means there are more
7829arithmetic operations, the numbers we operate on remain small so
7830the operations are faster.
7831
7832@smallexample
7833@group
78341: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 121
7835 . .
7836
7837 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' (3$$+$)%511 @key{RET}
7838@end group
7839@end smallexample
7840
7841Why does this work? Think about a two-step computation:
7842@w{@expr{3 (3a + b) + c}}. Taking a result modulo 511 basically means
7843subtracting off enough 511's to put the result in the desired range.
7844So the result when we take the modulo after every step is,
7845
7846@ifnottex
7847@example
78483 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n
7849@end example
7850@end ifnottex
7851@tex
4009494e
GM
7852\beforedisplay
7853$$ 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n $$
7854\afterdisplay
7855@end tex
7856
7857@noindent
7858for some suitable integers @expr{m} and @expr{n}. Expanding out by
7859the distributive law yields
7860
7861@ifnottex
7862@example
78639 a + 3 b + c - 511*3 m - 511 n
7864@end example
7865@end ifnottex
7866@tex
4009494e
GM
7867\beforedisplay
7868$$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511\times3 m - 511 n $$
7869\afterdisplay
7870@end tex
7871
7872@noindent
7873The @expr{m} term in the latter formula is redundant because any
7874contribution it makes could just as easily be made by the @expr{n}
7875term. So we can take it out to get an equivalent formula with
7876@expr{n' = 3m + n},
7877
7878@ifnottex
7879@example
78809 a + 3 b + c - 511 n'
7881@end example
7882@end ifnottex
7883@tex
4009494e 7884\beforedisplay
db37d257 7885$$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n^{\prime} $$
4009494e
GM
7886\afterdisplay
7887@end tex
7888
7889@noindent
7890which is just the formula for taking the modulo only at the end of
7891the calculation. Therefore the two methods are essentially the same.
7892
7893Later in the tutorial we will encounter @dfn{modulo forms}, which
7894basically automate the idea of reducing every intermediate result
7895modulo some value @var{m}.
7896
7897@node List Answer 14, Types Answer 1, List Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
7898@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 14
7899
7900We want to use @kbd{H V U} to nest a function which adds a random
7901step to an @expr{(x,y)} coordinate. The function is a bit long, but
7902otherwise the problem is quite straightforward.
7903
7904@smallexample
7905@group
79062: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
79071: 50 [ 0.4288, -0.1695 ]
7908 . [ -0.4787, -0.9027 ]
7909 ...
7910
7911 [0,0] 50 H V U ' <# + [random(2.0)-1, random(2.0)-1]> @key{RET}
7912@end group
7913@end smallexample
7914
7915Just as the text recommended, we used @samp{< >} nameless function
7916notation to keep the two @code{random} calls from being evaluated
7917before nesting even begins.
7918
7919We now have a vector of @expr{[x, y]} sub-vectors, which by Calc's
7920rules acts like a matrix. We can transpose this matrix and unpack
7921to get a pair of vectors, @expr{x} and @expr{y}, suitable for graphing.
7922
7923@smallexample
7924@group
79252: [ 0, 0.4288, -0.4787, ... ]
79261: [ 0, -0.1696, -0.9027, ... ]
7927 .
7928
7929 v t v u g f
7930@end group
7931@end smallexample
7932
7933Incidentally, because the @expr{x} and @expr{y} are completely
7934independent in this case, we could have done two separate commands
7935to create our @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers directly.
7936
7937To make a random walk of unit steps, we note that @code{sincos} of
7938a random direction exactly gives us an @expr{[x, y]} step of unit
7939length; in fact, the new nesting function is even briefer, though
7940we might want to lower the precision a bit for it.
7941
7942@smallexample
7943@group
79442: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
79451: 50 [ 0.1318, 0.9912 ]
7946 . [ -0.5965, 0.3061 ]
7947 ...
7948
7949 [0,0] 50 m d p 6 @key{RET} H V U ' <# + sincos(random(360.0))> @key{RET}
7950@end group
7951@end smallexample
7952
7953Another @kbd{v t v u g f} sequence will graph this new random walk.
7954
7955An interesting twist on these random walk functions would be to use
7956complex numbers instead of 2-vectors to represent points on the plane.
7957In the first example, we'd use something like @samp{random + random*(0,1)},
7958and in the second we could use polar complex numbers with random phase
7959angles. (This exercise was first suggested in this form by Randal
7960Schwartz.)
7961
7962@node Types Answer 1, Types Answer 2, List Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
7963@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 1
7964
7965@noindent
7966If the number is the square root of @cpi{} times a rational number,
7967then its square, divided by @cpi{}, should be a rational number.
7968
7969@smallexample
7970@group
79711: 1.26508260337 1: 0.509433962268 1: 2486645810:4881193627
7972 . . .
7973
7974 2 ^ P / c F
7975@end group
7976@end smallexample
7977
7978@noindent
7979Technically speaking this is a rational number, but not one that is
7980likely to have arisen in the original problem. More likely, it just
7981happens to be the fraction which most closely represents some
7982irrational number to within 12 digits.
7983
7984But perhaps our result was not quite exact. Let's reduce the
7985precision slightly and try again:
7986
7987@smallexample
7988@group
79891: 0.509433962268 1: 27:53
7990 . .
7991
7992 U p 10 @key{RET} c F
7993@end group
7994@end smallexample
7995
7996@noindent
7997Aha! It's unlikely that an irrational number would equal a fraction
7998this simple to within ten digits, so our original number was probably
7999@texline @math{\sqrt{27 \pi / 53}}.
8000@infoline @expr{sqrt(27 pi / 53)}.
8001
8002Notice that we didn't need to re-round the number when we reduced the
8003precision. Remember, arithmetic operations always round their inputs
8004to the current precision before they begin.
8005
8006@node Types Answer 2, Types Answer 3, Types Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8007@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 2
8008
8009@noindent
8010@samp{inf / inf = nan}. Perhaps @samp{1} is the ``obvious'' answer.
8011But if @w{@samp{17 inf = inf}}, then @samp{17 inf / inf = inf / inf = 17}, too.
8012
8013@samp{exp(inf) = inf}. It's tempting to say that the exponential
8014of infinity must be ``bigger'' than ``regular'' infinity, but as
74edaf1f 8015far as Calc is concerned all infinities are the same size.
4009494e
GM
8016In other words, as @expr{x} goes to infinity, @expr{e^x} also goes
8017to infinity, but the fact the @expr{e^x} grows much faster than
8018@expr{x} is not relevant here.
8019
8020@samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. Here we have a finite answer even though
8021the input is infinite.
8022
8023@samp{sqrt(-inf) = (0, 1) inf}. Remember that @expr{(0, 1)}
8024represents the imaginary number @expr{i}. Here's a derivation:
8025@samp{sqrt(-inf) = @w{sqrt((-1) * inf)} = sqrt(-1) * sqrt(inf)}.
8026The first part is, by definition, @expr{i}; the second is @code{inf}
8027because, once again, all infinities are the same size.
8028
8029@samp{sqrt(uinf) = uinf}. In fact, we do know something about the
8030direction because @code{sqrt} is defined to return a value in the
8031right half of the complex plane. But Calc has no notation for this,
8032so it settles for the conservative answer @code{uinf}.
8033
8034@samp{abs(uinf) = inf}. No matter which direction @expr{x} points,
8035@samp{abs(x)} always points along the positive real axis.
8036
8037@samp{ln(0) = -inf}. Here we have an infinite answer to a finite
8038input. As in the @expr{1 / 0} case, Calc will only use infinities
8039here if you have turned on Infinite mode. Otherwise, it will
8040treat @samp{ln(0)} as an error.
8041
8042@node Types Answer 3, Types Answer 4, Types Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8043@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 3
8044
8045@noindent
8046We can make @samp{inf - inf} be any real number we like, say,
8047@expr{a}, just by claiming that we added @expr{a} to the first
8048infinity but not to the second. This is just as true for complex
8049values of @expr{a}, so @code{nan} can stand for a complex number.
8050(And, similarly, @code{uinf} can stand for an infinity that points
8051in any direction in the complex plane, such as @samp{(0, 1) inf}).
8052
8053In fact, we can multiply the first @code{inf} by two. Surely
8054@w{@samp{2 inf - inf = inf}}, but also @samp{2 inf - inf = inf - inf = nan}.
8055So @code{nan} can even stand for infinity. Obviously it's just
8056as easy to make it stand for minus infinity as for plus infinity.
8057
8058The moral of this story is that ``infinity'' is a slippery fish
8059indeed, and Calc tries to handle it by having a very simple model
8060for infinities (only the direction counts, not the ``size''); but
8061Calc is careful to write @code{nan} any time this simple model is
8062unable to tell what the true answer is.
8063
8064@node Types Answer 4, Types Answer 5, Types Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8065@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 4
8066
8067@smallexample
8068@group
80692: 0@@ 47' 26" 1: 0@@ 2' 47.411765"
80701: 17 .
8071 .
8072
8073 0@@ 47' 26" @key{RET} 17 /
8074@end group
8075@end smallexample
8076
8077@noindent
8078The average song length is two minutes and 47.4 seconds.
8079
8080@smallexample
8081@group
80822: 0@@ 2' 47.411765" 1: 0@@ 3' 7.411765" 1: 0@@ 53' 6.000005"
80831: 0@@ 0' 20" . .
8084 .
8085
8086 20" + 17 *
8087@end group
8088@end smallexample
8089
8090@noindent
8091The album would be 53 minutes and 6 seconds long.
8092
8093@node Types Answer 5, Types Answer 6, Types Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8094@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 5
8095
8096@noindent
8097Let's suppose it's January 14, 1991. The easiest thing to do is
8098to keep trying 13ths of months until Calc reports a Friday.
8099We can do this by manually entering dates, or by using @kbd{t I}:
8100
8101@smallexample
8102@group
81031: <Wed Feb 13, 1991> 1: <Wed Mar 13, 1991> 1: <Sat Apr 13, 1991>
8104 . . .
8105
8106 ' <2/13> @key{RET} @key{DEL} ' <3/13> @key{RET} t I
8107@end group
8108@end smallexample
8109
8110@noindent
8111(Calc assumes the current year if you don't say otherwise.)
8112
8113This is getting tedious---we can keep advancing the date by typing
8114@kbd{t I} over and over again, but let's automate the job by using
8115vector mapping. The @kbd{t I} command actually takes a second
8116``how-many-months'' argument, which defaults to one. This
8117argument is exactly what we want to map over:
8118
8119@smallexample
8120@group
81212: <Sat Apr 13, 1991> 1: [<Mon May 13, 1991>, <Thu Jun 13, 1991>,
81221: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] <Sat Jul 13, 1991>, <Tue Aug 13, 1991>,
8123 . <Fri Sep 13, 1991>, <Sun Oct 13, 1991>]
8124 .
8125
8126 v x 6 @key{RET} V M t I
8127@end group
8128@end smallexample
8129
8130@noindent
8131Et voil@`a, September 13, 1991 is a Friday.
8132
8133@smallexample
8134@group
81351: 242
8136 .
8137
8138' <sep 13> - <jan 14> @key{RET}
8139@end group
8140@end smallexample
8141
8142@noindent
8143And the answer to our original question: 242 days to go.
8144
8145@node Types Answer 6, Types Answer 7, Types Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8146@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 6
8147
8148@noindent
8149The full rule for leap years is that they occur in every year divisible
8150by four, except that they don't occur in years divisible by 100, except
8151that they @emph{do} in years divisible by 400. We could work out the
8152answer by carefully counting the years divisible by four and the
8153exceptions, but there is a much simpler way that works even if we
8154don't know the leap year rule.
8155
8156Let's assume the present year is 1991. Years have 365 days, except
8157that leap years (whenever they occur) have 366 days. So let's count
8158the number of days between now and then, and compare that to the
8159number of years times 365. The number of extra days we find must be
8160equal to the number of leap years there were.
8161
8162@smallexample
8163@group
81641: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 2: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 1: 2925593
8165 . 1: <Tue Jan 1, 1991> .
8166 .
8167
8168 ' <jan 1 10001> @key{RET} ' <jan 1 1991> @key{RET} -
8169
8170@end group
8171@end smallexample
8172@noindent
8173@smallexample
8174@group
81753: 2925593 2: 2925593 2: 2925593 1: 1943
81762: 10001 1: 8010 1: 2923650 .
81771: 1991 . .
8178 .
8179
8180 10001 @key{RET} 1991 - 365 * -
8181@end group
8182@end smallexample
8183
8184@c [fix-ref Date Forms]
8185@noindent
8186There will be 1943 leap years before the year 10001. (Assuming,
8187of course, that the algorithm for computing leap years remains
8188unchanged for that long. @xref{Date Forms}, for some interesting
8189background information in that regard.)
8190
8191@node Types Answer 7, Types Answer 8, Types Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8192@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 7
8193
8194@noindent
8195The relative errors must be converted to absolute errors so that
8196@samp{+/-} notation may be used.
8197
8198@smallexample
8199@group
82001: 1. 2: 1.
8201 . 1: 0.2
8202 .
8203
8204 20 @key{RET} .05 * 4 @key{RET} .05 *
8205@end group
8206@end smallexample
8207
8208Now we simply chug through the formula.
8209
8210@smallexample
8211@group
82121: 19.7392088022 1: 394.78 +/- 19.739 1: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8213 . . .
8214
8215 2 P 2 ^ * 20 p 1 * 4 p .2 @key{RET} 2 ^ *
8216@end group
8217@end smallexample
8218
8219It turns out the @kbd{v u} command will unpack an error form as
8220well as a vector. This saves us some retyping of numbers.
8221
8222@smallexample
8223@group
82243: 6316.5 +/- 706.21 2: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
82252: 6316.5 1: 0.1118
82261: 706.21 .
8227 .
8228
8229 @key{RET} v u @key{TAB} /
8230@end group
8231@end smallexample
8232
8233@noindent
8234Thus the volume is 6316 cubic centimeters, within about 11 percent.
8235
8236@node Types Answer 8, Types Answer 9, Types Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
8237@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 8
8238
8239@noindent
8240The first answer is pretty simple: @samp{1 / (0 .. 10) = (0.1 .. inf)}.
8241Since a number in the interval @samp{(0 .. 10)} can get arbitrarily
8242close to zero, its reciprocal can get arbitrarily large, so the answer
8243is an interval that effectively means, ``any number greater than 0.1''
8244but with no upper bound.
8245
8246The second answer, similarly, is @samp{1 / (-10 .. 0) = (-inf .. -0.1)}.
8247
8248Calc normally treats division by zero as an error, so that the formula
8249@w{@samp{1 / 0}} is left unsimplified. Our third problem,
8250@w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 10]}}, also (potentially) divides by zero because zero
8251is now a member of the interval. So Calc leaves this one unevaluated, too.
8252
8253If you turn on Infinite mode by pressing @kbd{m i}, you will
8254instead get the answer @samp{[0.1 .. inf]}, which includes infinity
8255as a possible value.
8256
8257The fourth calculation, @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}, has the same problem.
8258Zero is buried inside the interval, but it's still a possible value.
8259It's not hard to see that the actual result of @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}
8260will be either greater than @mathit{0.1}, or less than @mathit{-0.1}. Thus
8261the interval goes from minus infinity to plus infinity, with a ``hole''
8262in it from @mathit{-0.1} to @mathit{0.1}. Calc doesn't have any way to
8263represent this, so it just reports @samp{[-inf .. inf]} as the answer.
8264It may be disappointing to hear ``the answer lies somewhere between
8265minus infinity and plus infinity, inclusive,'' but that's the best
8266that interval arithmetic can do in this case.
8267
8268@node Types Answer 9, Types Answer 10, Types Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
8269@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 9
8270
8271@smallexample
8272@group
82731: [-3 .. 3] 2: [-3 .. 3] 2: [0 .. 9]
8274 . 1: [0 .. 9] 1: [-9 .. 9]
8275 . .
8276
8277 [ 3 n .. 3 ] @key{RET} 2 ^ @key{TAB} @key{RET} *
8278@end group
8279@end smallexample
8280
8281@noindent
8282In the first case the result says, ``if a number is between @mathit{-3} and
82833, its square is between 0 and 9.'' The second case says, ``the product
8284of two numbers each between @mathit{-3} and 3 is between @mathit{-9} and 9.''
8285
8286An interval form is not a number; it is a symbol that can stand for
8287many different numbers. Two identical-looking interval forms can stand
8288for different numbers.
8289
8290The same issue arises when you try to square an error form.
8291
8292@node Types Answer 10, Types Answer 11, Types Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
8293@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 10
8294
8295@noindent
8296Testing the first number, we might arbitrarily choose 17 for @expr{x}.
8297
8298@smallexample
8299@group
83001: 17 mod 811749613 2: 17 mod 811749613 1: 533694123 mod 811749613
8301 . 811749612 .
8302 .
8303
8304 17 M 811749613 @key{RET} 811749612 ^
8305@end group
8306@end smallexample
8307
8308@noindent
8309Since 533694123 is (considerably) different from 1, the number 811749613
8310must not be prime.
8311
8312It's awkward to type the number in twice as we did above. There are
8313various ways to avoid this, and algebraic entry is one. In fact, using
8314a vector mapping operation we can perform several tests at once. Let's
8315use this method to test the second number.
8316
8317@smallexample
8318@group
83192: [17, 42, 100000] 1: [1 mod 15485863, 1 mod ... ]
83201: 15485863 .
8321 .
8322
8323 [17 42 100000] 15485863 @key{RET} V M ' ($$ mod $)^($-1) @key{RET}
8324@end group
8325@end smallexample
8326
8327@noindent
8328The result is three ones (modulo @expr{n}), so it's very probable that
832915485863 is prime. (In fact, this number is the millionth prime.)
8330
8331Note that the functions @samp{($$^($-1)) mod $} or @samp{$$^($-1) % $}
8332would have been hopelessly inefficient, since they would have calculated
8333the power using full integer arithmetic.
8334
8335Calc has a @kbd{k p} command that does primality testing. For small
8336numbers it does an exact test; for large numbers it uses a variant
8337of the Fermat test we used here. You can use @kbd{k p} repeatedly
8338to prove that a large integer is prime with any desired probability.
8339
8340@node Types Answer 11, Types Answer 12, Types Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
8341@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 11
8342
8343@noindent
8344There are several ways to insert a calculated number into an HMS form.
8345One way to convert a number of seconds to an HMS form is simply to
8346multiply the number by an HMS form representing one second:
8347
8348@smallexample
8349@group
83501: 31415926.5359 2: 31415926.5359 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8351 . 1: 0@@ 0' 1" .
8352 .
8353
8354 P 1e7 * 0@@ 0' 1" *
8355
8356@end group
8357@end smallexample
8358@noindent
8359@smallexample
8360@group
83612: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359" 1: 6@@ 6' 2.5359" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
83621: 15@@ 27' 16" mod 24@@ 0' 0" .
8363 .
8364
8365 x time @key{RET} +
8366@end group
8367@end smallexample
8368
8369@noindent
8370It will be just after six in the morning.
8371
8372The algebraic @code{hms} function can also be used to build an
8373HMS form:
8374
8375@smallexample
8376@group
83771: hms(0, 0, 10000000. pi) 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8378 . .
8379
8380 ' hms(0, 0, 1e7 pi) @key{RET} =
8381@end group
8382@end smallexample
8383
8384@noindent
8385The @kbd{=} key is necessary to evaluate the symbol @samp{pi} to
8386the actual number 3.14159...
8387
8388@node Types Answer 12, Types Answer 13, Types Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
8389@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 12
8390
8391@noindent
8392As we recall, there are 17 songs of about 2 minutes and 47 seconds
8393each.
8394
8395@smallexample
8396@group
83972: 0@@ 2' 47" 1: [0@@ 3' 7" .. 0@@ 3' 47"]
83981: [0@@ 0' 20" .. 0@@ 1' 0"] .
8399 .
8400
8401 [ 0@@ 20" .. 0@@ 1' ] +
8402
8403@end group
8404@end smallexample
8405@noindent
8406@smallexample
8407@group
84081: [0@@ 52' 59." .. 1@@ 4' 19."]
8409 .
8410
8411 17 *
8412@end group
8413@end smallexample
8414
8415@noindent
8416No matter how long it is, the album will fit nicely on one CD.
8417
8418@node Types Answer 13, Types Answer 14, Types Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
8419@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 13
8420
8421@noindent
8422Type @kbd{' 1 yr @key{RET} u c s @key{RET}}. The answer is 31557600 seconds.
8423
8424@node Types Answer 14, Types Answer 15, Types Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
8425@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 14
8426
8427@noindent
8428How long will it take for a signal to get from one end of the computer
8429to the other?
8430
8431@smallexample
8432@group
84331: m / c 1: 3.3356 ns
8434 . .
8435
8436 ' 1 m / c @key{RET} u c ns @key{RET}
8437@end group
8438@end smallexample
8439
8440@noindent
8441(Recall, @samp{c} is a ``unit'' corresponding to the speed of light.)
8442
8443@smallexample
8444@group
84451: 3.3356 ns 1: 0.81356 ns / ns 1: 0.81356
84462: 4.1 ns . .
8447 .
8448
8449 ' 4.1 ns @key{RET} / u s
8450@end group
8451@end smallexample
8452
8453@noindent
8454Thus a signal could take up to 81 percent of a clock cycle just to
8455go from one place to another inside the computer, assuming the signal
8456could actually attain the full speed of light. Pretty tight!
8457
8458@node Types Answer 15, Algebra Answer 1, Types Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
8459@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 15
8460
8461@noindent
8462The speed limit is 55 miles per hour on most highways. We want to
8463find the ratio of Sam's speed to the US speed limit.
8464
8465@smallexample
8466@group
84671: 55 mph 2: 55 mph 3: 11 hr mph / yd
8468 . 1: 5 yd / hr .
8469 .
8470
8471 ' 55 mph @key{RET} ' 5 yd/hr @key{RET} /
8472@end group
8473@end smallexample
8474
8475The @kbd{u s} command cancels out these units to get a plain
8476number. Now we take the logarithm base two to find the final
8477answer, assuming that each successive pill doubles his speed.
8478
8479@smallexample
8480@group
84811: 19360. 2: 19360. 1: 14.24
8482 . 1: 2 .
8483 .
8484
8485 u s 2 B
8486@end group
8487@end smallexample
8488
8489@noindent
8490Thus Sam can take up to 14 pills without a worry.
8491
8492@node Algebra Answer 1, Algebra Answer 2, Types Answer 15, Answers to Exercises
8493@subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 1
8494
8495@noindent
8496@c [fix-ref Declarations]
8497The result @samp{sqrt(x)^2} is simplified back to @expr{x} by the
8498Calculator, but @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is not. (Consider what happens
8499if @w{@expr{x = -4}}.) If @expr{x} is real, this formula could be
8500simplified to @samp{abs(x)}, but for general complex arguments even
8501that is not safe. (@xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell Calc
8502that @expr{x} is known to be real.)
8503
8504@node Algebra Answer 2, Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8505@subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 2
8506
8507@noindent
8508Suppose our roots are @expr{[a, b, c]}. We want a polynomial which
8509is zero when @expr{x} is any of these values. The trivial polynomial
8510@expr{x-a} is zero when @expr{x=a}, so the product @expr{(x-a)(x-b)(x-c)}
8511will do the job. We can use @kbd{a c x} to write this in a more
8512familiar form.
8513
8514@smallexample
8515@group
85161: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [1.19023, -1.19023, 0]
8517 . .
8518
8519 r 2 a P x @key{RET}
8520
8521@end group
8522@end smallexample
8523@noindent
8524@smallexample
8525@group
85261: [x - 1.19023, x + 1.19023, x] 1: (x - 1.19023) (x + 1.19023) x
8527 . .
8528
8529 V M ' x-$ @key{RET} V R *
8530
8531@end group
8532@end smallexample
8533@noindent
8534@smallexample
8535@group
85361: x^3 - 1.41666 x 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
8537 . .
8538
8539 a c x @key{RET} 24 n * a x
8540@end group
8541@end smallexample
8542
8543@noindent
8544Sure enough, our answer (multiplied by a suitable constant) is the
8545same as the original polynomial.
8546
8547@node Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 4, Algebra Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8548@subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 3
8549
8550@smallexample
8551@group
85521: x sin(pi x) 1: (sin(pi x) - pi x cos(pi x)) / pi^2
8553 . .
8554
8555 ' x sin(pi x) @key{RET} m r a i x @key{RET}
8556
8557@end group
8558@end smallexample
8559@noindent
8560@smallexample
8561@group
85621: [y, 1]
85632: (sin(pi x) - pi x cos(pi x)) / pi^2
8564 .
8565
8566 ' [y,1] @key{RET} @key{TAB}
8567
8568@end group
8569@end smallexample
8570@noindent
8571@smallexample
8572@group
85731: [(sin(pi y) - pi y cos(pi y)) / pi^2, (sin(pi) - pi cos(pi)) / pi^2]
8574 .
8575
8576 V M $ @key{RET}
8577
8578@end group
8579@end smallexample
8580@noindent
8581@smallexample
8582@group
85831: (sin(pi y) - pi y cos(pi y)) / pi^2 + (pi cos(pi) - sin(pi)) / pi^2
8584 .
8585
8586 V R -
8587
8588@end group
8589@end smallexample
8590@noindent
8591@smallexample
8592@group
85931: (sin(3.14159 y) - 3.14159 y cos(3.14159 y)) / 9.8696 - 0.3183
8594 .
8595
8596 =
8597
8598@end group
8599@end smallexample
8600@noindent
8601@smallexample
8602@group
86031: [0., -0.95493, 0.63662, -1.5915, 1.2732]
8604 .
8605
8606 v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
8607@end group
8608@end smallexample
8609
8610@node Algebra Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 1, Algebra Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8611@subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 4
8612
8613@noindent
8614The hard part is that @kbd{V R +} is no longer sufficient to add up all
8615the contributions from the slices, since the slices have varying
8616coefficients. So first we must come up with a vector of these
8617coefficients. Here's one way:
8618
8619@smallexample
8620@group
86212: -1 2: 3 1: [4, 2, ..., 4]
86221: [1, 2, ..., 9] 1: [-1, 1, ..., -1] .
8623 . .
8624
8625 1 n v x 9 @key{RET} V M ^ 3 @key{TAB} -
8626
8627@end group
8628@end smallexample
8629@noindent
8630@smallexample
8631@group
86321: [4, 2, ..., 4, 1] 1: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8633 . .
8634
8635 1 | 1 @key{TAB} |
8636@end group
8637@end smallexample
8638
8639@noindent
8640Now we compute the function values. Note that for this method we need
8641eleven values, including both endpoints of the desired interval.
8642
8643@smallexample
8644@group
86452: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
86461: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9, 2.]
8647 .
8648
8649 11 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
8650
8651@end group
8652@end smallexample
8653@noindent
8654@smallexample
8655@group
86562: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
86571: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
8658 .
8659
8660 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
8661@end group
8662@end smallexample
8663
8664@noindent
8665Once again this calls for @kbd{V M * V R +}; a simple @kbd{*} does the
8666same thing.
8667
8668@smallexample
8669@group
86701: 11.22 1: 1.122 1: 0.374
8671 . . .
8672
8673 * .1 * 3 /
8674@end group
8675@end smallexample
8676
8677@noindent
8678Wow! That's even better than the result from the Taylor series method.
8679
8680@node Rewrites Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 2, Algebra Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8681@subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 1
8682
8683@noindent
8684We'll use Big mode to make the formulas more readable.
8685
8686@smallexample
8687@group
8688 ___
8689 2 + V 2
86901: (2 + sqrt(2)) / (1 + sqrt(2)) 1: --------
8691 . ___
8692 1 + V 2
8693
8694 .
8695
8696 ' (2+sqrt(2)) / (1+sqrt(2)) @key{RET} d B
8697@end group
8698@end smallexample
8699
8700@noindent
8701Multiplying by the conjugate helps because @expr{(a+b) (a-b) = a^2 - b^2}.
8702
8703@smallexample
8704@group
8705 ___ ___
87061: (2 + V 2 ) (V 2 - 1)
8707 .
8708
8709 a r a/(b+c) := a*(b-c) / (b^2-c^2) @key{RET}
8710
8711@end group
8712@end smallexample
8713@noindent
8714@smallexample
8715@group
8716 ___ ___
87171: 2 + V 2 - 2 1: V 2
8718 . .
8719
8720 a r a*(b+c) := a*b + a*c a s
8721@end group
8722@end smallexample
8723
8724@noindent
8725(We could have used @kbd{a x} instead of a rewrite rule for the
8726second step.)
8727
8728The multiply-by-conjugate rule turns out to be useful in many
8729different circumstances, such as when the denominator involves
8730sines and cosines or the imaginary constant @code{i}.
8731
8732@node Rewrites Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8733@subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 2
8734
8735@noindent
8736Here is the rule set:
8737
8738@smallexample
8739@group
8740[ fib(n) := fib(n, 1, 1) :: integer(n) :: n >= 1,
8741 fib(1, x, y) := x,
8742 fib(n, x, y) := fib(n-1, y, x+y) ]
8743@end group
8744@end smallexample
8745
8746@noindent
8747The first rule turns a one-argument @code{fib} that people like to write
8748into a three-argument @code{fib} that makes computation easier. The
8749second rule converts back from three-argument form once the computation
8750is done. The third rule does the computation itself. It basically
8751says that if @expr{x} and @expr{y} are two consecutive Fibonacci numbers,
8752then @expr{y} and @expr{x+y} are the next (overlapping) pair of Fibonacci
8753numbers.
8754
8755Notice that because the number @expr{n} was ``validated'' by the
8756conditions on the first rule, there is no need to put conditions on
8757the other rules because the rule set would never get that far unless
8758the input were valid. That further speeds computation, since no
8759extra conditions need to be checked at every step.
8760
8761Actually, a user with a nasty sense of humor could enter a bad
8762three-argument @code{fib} call directly, say, @samp{fib(0, 1, 1)},
8763which would get the rules into an infinite loop. One thing that would
8764help keep this from happening by accident would be to use something like
8765@samp{ZzFib} instead of @code{fib} as the name of the three-argument
8766function.
8767
8768@node Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8769@subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 3
8770
8771@noindent
8772He got an infinite loop. First, Calc did as expected and rewrote
8773@w{@samp{2 + 3 x}} to @samp{f(2, 3, x)}. Then it looked for ways to
8774apply the rule again, and found that @samp{f(2, 3, x)} looks like
8775@samp{a + b x} with @w{@samp{a = 0}} and @samp{b = 1}, so it rewrote to
8776@samp{f(0, 1, f(2, 3, x))}. It then wrapped another @samp{f(0, 1, ...)}
8777around that, and so on, ad infinitum. Joe should have used @kbd{M-1 a r}
8778to make sure the rule applied only once.
8779
8780(Actually, even the first step didn't work as he expected. What Calc
8781really gives for @kbd{M-1 a r} in this situation is @samp{f(3 x, 1, 2)},
8782treating 2 as the ``variable,'' and @samp{3 x} as a constant being added
8783to it. While this may seem odd, it's just as valid a solution as the
8784``obvious'' one. One way to fix this would be to add the condition
8785@samp{:: variable(x)} to the rule, to make sure the thing that matches
8786@samp{x} is indeed a variable, or to change @samp{x} to @samp{quote(x)}
8787on the lefthand side, so that the rule matches the actual variable
8788@samp{x} rather than letting @samp{x} stand for something else.)
8789
8790@node Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8791@subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 4
8792
8793@noindent
8794@ignore
8795@starindex
8796@end ignore
8797@tindex seq
8798Here is a suitable set of rules to solve the first part of the problem:
8799
8800@smallexample
8801@group
8802[ seq(n, c) := seq(n/2, c+1) :: n%2 = 0,
8803 seq(n, c) := seq(3n+1, c+1) :: n%2 = 1 :: n > 1 ]
8804@end group
8805@end smallexample
8806
8807Given the initial formula @samp{seq(6, 0)}, application of these
8808rules produces the following sequence of formulas:
8809
8810@example
8811seq( 3, 1)
8812seq(10, 2)
8813seq( 5, 3)
8814seq(16, 4)
8815seq( 8, 5)
8816seq( 4, 6)
8817seq( 2, 7)
8818seq( 1, 8)
8819@end example
8820
8821@noindent
8822whereupon neither of the rules match, and rewriting stops.
8823
8824We can pretty this up a bit with a couple more rules:
8825
8826@smallexample
8827@group
8828[ seq(n) := seq(n, 0),
8829 seq(1, c) := c,
8830 ... ]
8831@end group
8832@end smallexample
8833
8834@noindent
8835Now, given @samp{seq(6)} as the starting configuration, we get 8
8836as the result.
8837
8838The change to return a vector is quite simple:
8839
8840@smallexample
8841@group
8842[ seq(n) := seq(n, []) :: integer(n) :: n > 0,
8843 seq(1, v) := v | 1,
8844 seq(n, v) := seq(n/2, v | n) :: n%2 = 0,
8845 seq(n, v) := seq(3n+1, v | n) :: n%2 = 1 ]
8846@end group
8847@end smallexample
8848
8849@noindent
8850Given @samp{seq(6)}, the result is @samp{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
8851
8852Notice that the @expr{n > 1} guard is no longer necessary on the last
8853rule since the @expr{n = 1} case is now detected by another rule.
8854But a guard has been added to the initial rule to make sure the
8855initial value is suitable before the computation begins.
8856
8857While still a good idea, this guard is not as vitally important as it
8858was for the @code{fib} function, since calling, say, @samp{seq(x, [])}
8859will not get into an infinite loop. Calc will not be able to prove
8860the symbol @samp{x} is either even or odd, so none of the rules will
8861apply and the rewrites will stop right away.
8862
8863@node Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 6, Rewrites Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8864@subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 5
8865
8866@noindent
8867@ignore
8868@starindex
8869@end ignore
8870@tindex nterms
8871If @expr{x} is the sum @expr{a + b}, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' must
8872be `@tfn{nterms(}@var{a}@tfn{)}' plus `@tfn{nterms(}@var{b}@tfn{)}'. If @expr{x}
8873is not a sum, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' = 1.
8874
8875@smallexample
8876@group
8877[ nterms(a + b) := nterms(a) + nterms(b),
8878 nterms(x) := 1 ]
8879@end group
8880@end smallexample
8881
8882@noindent
8883Here we have taken advantage of the fact that earlier rules always
8884match before later rules; @samp{nterms(x)} will only be tried if we
8885already know that @samp{x} is not a sum.
8886
8887@node Rewrites Answer 6, Programming Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8888@subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 6
8889
8890@noindent
8891Here is a rule set that will do the job:
8892
8893@smallexample
8894@group
8895[ a*(b + c) := a*b + a*c,
8896 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) O(x^m) := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8897 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8898 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) x^m := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8899 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8900 a O(x^n) := O(x^n) :: constant(a),
8901 x^opt(m) O(x^n) := O(x^(n+m)),
8902 O(x^n) O(x^m) := O(x^(n+m)) ]
8903@end group
8904@end smallexample
8905
8906If we really want the @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} keys to operate naturally
8907on power series, we should put these rules in @code{EvalRules}. For
8908testing purposes, it is better to put them in a different variable,
8909say, @code{O}, first.
8910
8911The first rule just expands products of sums so that the rest of the
8912rules can assume they have an expanded-out polynomial to work with.
8913Note that this rule does not mention @samp{O} at all, so it will
8914apply to any product-of-sum it encounters---this rule may surprise
8915you if you put it into @code{EvalRules}!
8916
8917In the second rule, the sum of two O's is changed to the smaller O.
8918The optional constant coefficients are there mostly so that
8919@samp{O(x^2) - O(x^3)} and @samp{O(x^3) - O(x^2)} are handled
8920as well as @samp{O(x^2) + O(x^3)}.
8921
8922The third rule absorbs higher powers of @samp{x} into O's.
8923
8924The fourth rule says that a constant times a negligible quantity
8925is still negligible. (This rule will also match @samp{O(x^3) / 4},
8926with @samp{a = 1/4}.)
8927
8928The fifth rule rewrites, for example, @samp{x^2 O(x^3)} to @samp{O(x^5)}.
8929(It is easy to see that if one of these forms is negligible, the other
8930is, too.) Notice the @samp{x^opt(m)} to pick up terms like
8931@w{@samp{x O(x^3)}}. Optional powers will match @samp{x} as @samp{x^1}
8932but not 1 as @samp{x^0}. This turns out to be exactly what we want here.
8933
8934The sixth rule is the corresponding rule for products of two O's.
8935
8936Another way to solve this problem would be to create a new ``data type''
8937that represents truncated power series. We might represent these as
8938function calls @samp{series(@var{coefs}, @var{x})} where @var{coefs} is
8939a vector of coefficients for @expr{x^0}, @expr{x^1}, @expr{x^2}, and so
8940on. Rules would exist for sums and products of such @code{series}
8941objects, and as an optional convenience could also know how to combine a
8942@code{series} object with a normal polynomial. (With this, and with a
8943rule that rewrites @samp{O(x^n)} to the equivalent @code{series} form,
8944you could still enter power series in exactly the same notation as
8945before.) Operations on such objects would probably be more efficient,
8946although the objects would be a bit harder to read.
8947
8948@c [fix-ref Compositions]
8949Some other symbolic math programs provide a power series data type
8950similar to this. Mathematica, for example, has an object that looks
8951like @samp{PowerSeries[@var{x}, @var{x0}, @var{coefs}, @var{nmin},
8952@var{nmax}, @var{den}]}, where @var{x0} is the point about which the
8953power series is taken (we've been assuming this was always zero),
8954and @var{nmin}, @var{nmax}, and @var{den} allow pseudo-power-series
8955with fractional or negative powers. Also, the @code{PowerSeries}
8956objects have a special display format that makes them look like
8957@samp{2 x^2 + O(x^4)} when they are printed out. (@xref{Compositions},
8958for a way to do this in Calc, although for something as involved as
8959this it would probably be better to write the formatting routine
8960in Lisp.)
8961
8962@node Programming Answer 1, Programming Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8963@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 1
8964
8965@noindent
8966Just enter the formula @samp{ninteg(sin(t)/t, t, 0, x)}, type
8967@kbd{Z F}, and answer the questions. Since this formula contains two
8968variables, the default argument list will be @samp{(t x)}. We want to
8969change this to @samp{(x)} since @expr{t} is really a dummy variable
8970to be used within @code{ninteg}.
8971
8972The exact keystrokes are @kbd{Z F s Si @key{RET} @key{RET} C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL} @key{RET} y}.
8973(The @kbd{C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL}} are what fix the argument list.)
8974
8975@node Programming Answer 2, Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8976@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 2
8977
8978@noindent
8979One way is to move the number to the top of the stack, operate on
8980it, then move it back: @kbd{C-x ( M-@key{TAB} n M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} C-x )}.
8981
8982Another way is to negate the top three stack entries, then negate
8983again the top two stack entries: @kbd{C-x ( M-3 n M-2 n C-x )}.
8984
8985Finally, it turns out that a negative prefix argument causes a
8986command like @kbd{n} to operate on the specified stack entry only,
8987which is just what we want: @kbd{C-x ( M-- 3 n C-x )}.
8988
8989Just for kicks, let's also do it algebraically:
8990@w{@kbd{C-x ( ' -$$$, $$, $ @key{RET} C-x )}}.
8991
8992@node Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8993@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 3
8994
8995@noindent
8996Each of these functions can be computed using the stack, or using
8997algebraic entry, whichever way you prefer:
8998
8999@noindent
9000Computing
9001@texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}}:
9002@infoline @expr{sin(x) / x}:
9003
9004Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} S @key{TAB} / C-x )}.
9005
9006Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' sin($)/$ @key{RET} C-x )}.
9007
9008@noindent
9009Computing the logarithm:
9010
9011Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{TAB} B C-x )}
9012
9013Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' log($,$$) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9014
9015@noindent
9016Computing the vector of integers:
9017
9018Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x C-x )}. (Recall that
9019@kbd{C-u v x} takes the vector size, starting value, and increment
9020from the stack.)
9021
9022Alternatively: @kbd{C-x ( ~ v x C-x )}. (The @kbd{~} key pops a
9023number from the stack and uses it as the prefix argument for the
9024next command.)
9025
9026Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' index($) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9027
9028@node Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
9029@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 4
9030
9031@noindent
9032Here's one way: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} V R + @key{TAB} v l / C-x )}.
9033
9034@node Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
9035@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 5
9036
9037@smallexample
9038@group
90392: 1 1: 1.61803398502 2: 1.61803398502
90401: 20 . 1: 1.61803398875
9041 . .
9042
9043 1 @key{RET} 20 Z < & 1 + Z > I H P
9044@end group
9045@end smallexample
9046
9047@noindent
9048This answer is quite accurate.
9049
9050@node Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
9051@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 6
9052
9053@noindent
9054Here is the matrix:
9055
9056@example
9057[ [ 0, 1 ] * [a, b] = [b, a + b]
9058 [ 1, 1 ] ]
9059@end example
9060
9061@noindent
9062Thus @samp{[0, 1; 1, 1]^n * [1, 1]} computes Fibonacci numbers @expr{n+1}
9063and @expr{n+2}. Here's one program that does the job:
9064
9065@example
9066C-x ( ' [0, 1; 1, 1] ^ ($-1) * [1, 1] @key{RET} v u @key{DEL} C-x )
9067@end example
9068
9069@noindent
9070This program is quite efficient because Calc knows how to raise a
9071matrix (or other value) to the power @expr{n} in only
9072@texline @math{\log_2 n}
9073@infoline @expr{log(n,2)}
9074steps. For example, this program can compute the 1000th Fibonacci
9075number (a 209-digit integer!) in about 10 steps; even though the
9076@kbd{Z < ... Z >} solution had much simpler steps, it would have
9077required so many steps that it would not have been practical.
9078
9079@node Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
9080@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 7
9081
9082@noindent
9083The trick here is to compute the harmonic numbers differently, so that
9084the loop counter itself accumulates the sum of reciprocals. We use
9085a separate variable to hold the integer counter.
9086
9087@smallexample
9088@group
90891: 1 2: 1 1: .
9090 . 1: 4
9091 .
9092
9093 1 t 1 1 @key{RET} 4 Z ( t 2 r 1 1 + s 1 & Z )
9094@end group
9095@end smallexample
9096
9097@noindent
9098The body of the loop goes as follows: First save the harmonic sum
9099so far in variable 2. Then delete it from the stack; the for loop
9100itself will take care of remembering it for us. Next, recall the
9101count from variable 1, add one to it, and feed its reciprocal to
9102the for loop to use as the step value. The for loop will increase
9103the ``loop counter'' by that amount and keep going until the
9104loop counter exceeds 4.
9105
9106@smallexample
9107@group
91082: 31 3: 31
91091: 3.99498713092 2: 3.99498713092
9110 . 1: 4.02724519544
9111 .
9112
9113 r 1 r 2 @key{RET} 31 & +
9114@end group
9115@end smallexample
9116
9117Thus we find that the 30th harmonic number is 3.99, and the 31st
9118harmonic number is 4.02.
9119
9120@node Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
9121@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 8
9122
9123@noindent
9124The first step is to compute the derivative @expr{f'(x)} and thus
9125the formula
9126@texline @math{\displaystyle{x - {f(x) \over f'(x)}}}.
9127@infoline @expr{x - f(x)/f'(x)}.
9128
9129(Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9130below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9131entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9132keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9133pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9134just for purposes of illustration.)
9135
9136@smallexample
9137@group
91382: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5 3: 4.5
91391: 4.5 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5
9140 . 1: -(sin(x) cos(cos(x)))
9141 .
9142
9143' sin(cos(x))-0.5 @key{RET} 4.5 m r C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET}
9144
9145@end group
9146@end smallexample
9147@noindent
9148@smallexample
9149@group
91502: 4.5
91511: x + (sin(cos(x)) - 0.5) / sin(x) cos(cos(x))
9152 .
9153
9154 / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9155@end group
9156@end smallexample
9157
9158Now, we enter the loop. We'll use a repeat loop with a 20-repetition
9159limit just in case the method fails to converge for some reason.
9160(Normally, the @w{@kbd{Z /}} command will stop the loop before all 20
9161repetitions are done.)
9162
9163@smallexample
9164@group
91651: 4.5 3: 4.5 2: 4.5
9166 . 2: x + (sin(cos(x)) ... 1: 5.24196456928
9167 1: 4.5 .
9168 .
9169
9170 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9171@end group
9172@end smallexample
9173
9174This is the new guess for @expr{x}. Now we compare it with the
9175old one to see if we've converged.
9176
9177@smallexample
9178@group
91793: 5.24196 2: 5.24196 1: 5.24196 1: 5.26345856348
91802: 5.24196 1: 0 . .
91811: 4.5 .
9182 .
9183
9184 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / Z > Z ' C-x )
9185@end group
9186@end smallexample
9187
9188The loop converges in just a few steps to this value. To check
9189the result, we can simply substitute it back into the equation.
9190
9191@smallexample
9192@group
91932: 5.26345856348
91941: 0.499999999997
9195 .
9196
9197 @key{RET} ' sin(cos($)) @key{RET}
9198@end group
9199@end smallexample
9200
9201Let's test the new definition again:
9202
9203@smallexample
9204@group
92052: x^2 - 9 1: 3.
92061: 1 .
9207 .
9208
9209 ' x^2-9 @key{RET} 1 X
9210@end group
9211@end smallexample
9212
9213Once again, here's the full Newton's Method definition:
9214
9215@example
9216@group
9217C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET} / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9218 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9219 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9220 Z >
9221 Z '
9222C-x )
9223@end group
9224@end example
9225
9226@c [fix-ref Nesting and Fixed Points]
9227It turns out that Calc has a built-in command for applying a formula
9228repeatedly until it converges to a number. @xref{Nesting and Fixed Points},
9229to see how to use it.
9230
9231@c [fix-ref Root Finding]
9232Also, of course, @kbd{a R} is a built-in command that uses Newton's
9233method (among others) to look for numerical solutions to any equation.
9234@xref{Root Finding}.
9235
9236@node Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
9237@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 9
9238
9239@noindent
9240The first step is to adjust @expr{z} to be greater than 5. A simple
9241``for'' loop will do the job here. If @expr{z} is less than 5, we
9242reduce the problem using
9243@texline @math{\psi(z) = \psi(z+1) - 1/z}.
9244@infoline @expr{psi(z) = psi(z+1) - 1/z}. We go
9245on to compute
9246@texline @math{\psi(z+1)},
9247@infoline @expr{psi(z+1)},
9248and remember to add back a factor of @expr{-1/z} when we're done. This
9249step is repeated until @expr{z > 5}.
9250
9251(Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9252below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9253entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9254keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9255pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9256just for purposes of illustration.)
9257
9258@smallexample
9259@group
92601: 1. 1: 1.
9261 . .
9262
9263 1.0 @key{RET} C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9264@end group
9265@end smallexample
9266
9267Here, variable 1 holds @expr{z} and variable 2 holds the adjustment
9268factor. If @expr{z < 5}, we use a loop to increase it.
9269
9270(By the way, we started with @samp{1.0} instead of the integer 1 because
9271otherwise the calculation below will try to do exact fractional arithmetic,
9272and will never converge because fractions compare equal only if they
9273are exactly equal, not just equal to within the current precision.)
9274
9275@smallexample
9276@group
92773: 1. 2: 1. 1: 6.
92782: 1. 1: 1 .
92791: 5 .
9280 .
9281
9282 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9283@end group
9284@end smallexample
9285
9286Now we compute the initial part of the sum:
9287@texline @math{\ln z - {1 \over 2z}}
9288@infoline @expr{ln(z) - 1/2z}
9289minus the adjustment factor.
9290
9291@smallexample
9292@group
92932: 1.79175946923 2: 1.7084261359 1: -0.57490719743
92941: 0.0833333333333 1: 2.28333333333 .
9295 . .
9296
9297 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9298@end group
9299@end smallexample
9300
9301Now we evaluate the series. We'll use another ``for'' loop counting
9302up the value of @expr{2 n}. (Calc does have a summation command,
9303@kbd{a +}, but we'll use loops just to get more practice with them.)
9304
9305@smallexample
9306@group
93073: -0.5749 3: -0.5749 4: -0.5749 2: -0.5749
93082: 2 2: 1:6 3: 1:6 1: 2.3148e-3
93091: 40 1: 2 2: 2 .
9310 . . 1: 36.
9311 .
9312
9313 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9314
9315@end group
9316@end smallexample
9317@noindent
9318@smallexample
9319@group
93203: -0.5749 3: -0.5772 2: -0.5772 1: -0.577215664892
93212: -0.5749 2: -0.5772 1: 0 .
93221: 2.3148e-3 1: -0.5749 .
9323 . .
9324
9325 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / 2 Z ) Z ' C-x )
9326@end group
9327@end smallexample
9328
9329This is the value of
9330@texline @math{-\gamma},
9331@infoline @expr{- gamma},
9332with a slight bit of roundoff error. To get a full 12 digits, let's use
9333a higher precision:
9334
9335@smallexample
9336@group
93372: -0.577215664892 2: -0.577215664892
93381: 1. 1: -0.577215664901532
9339
9340 1. @key{RET} p 16 @key{RET} X
9341@end group
9342@end smallexample
9343
9344Here's the complete sequence of keystrokes:
9345
9346@example
9347@group
9348C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9349 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9350 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9351 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9352 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9353 2 Z )
9354 Z '
9355C-x )
9356@end group
9357@end example
9358
9359@node Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
9360@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 10
9361
9362@noindent
9363Taking the derivative of a term of the form @expr{x^n} will produce
9364a term like
9365@texline @math{n x^{n-1}}.
9366@infoline @expr{n x^(n-1)}.
9367Taking the derivative of a constant
9368produces zero. From this it is easy to see that the @expr{n}th
9369derivative of a polynomial, evaluated at @expr{x = 0}, will equal the
9370coefficient on the @expr{x^n} term times @expr{n!}.
9371
9372(Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9373below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9374entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9375keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9376pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9377just for purposes of illustration.)
9378
9379@smallexample
9380@group
93812: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2 3: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2
93821: 6 2: 0
9383 . 1: 6
9384 .
9385
9386 ' 5 x^4 + (x+1)^2 @key{RET} 6 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9387@end group
9388@end smallexample
9389
9390@noindent
9391Variable 1 will accumulate the vector of coefficients.
9392
9393@smallexample
9394@group
93952: 0 3: 0 2: 5 x^4 + ...
93961: 5 x^4 + ... 2: 5 x^4 + ... 1: 1
9397 . 1: 1 .
9398 .
9399
9400 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9401@end group
9402@end smallexample
9403
9404@noindent
9405Note that @kbd{s | 1} appends the top-of-stack value to the vector
9406in a variable; it is completely analogous to @kbd{s + 1}. We could
9407have written instead, @kbd{r 1 @key{TAB} | t 1}.
9408
9409@smallexample
9410@group
94111: 20 x^3 + 2 x + 2 1: 0 1: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9412 . . .
9413
9414 a d x @key{RET} 1 Z ) @key{DEL} r 1 Z ' C-x )
9415@end group
9416@end smallexample
9417
9418To convert back, a simple method is just to map the coefficients
9419against a table of powers of @expr{x}.
9420
9421@smallexample
9422@group
94232: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
94241: 6 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
9425 . .
9426
9427 6 @key{RET} 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x
9428
9429@end group
9430@end smallexample
9431@noindent
9432@smallexample
9433@group
94342: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: 1 + 2 x + x^2 + 5 x^4
94351: [1, x, x^2, x^3, ... ] .
9436 .
9437
9438 ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ *
9439@end group
9440@end smallexample
9441
9442Once again, here are the whole polynomial to/from vector programs:
9443
9444@example
9445@group
9446C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9447 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9448 a d x @key{RET}
9449 1 Z ) r 1
9450 Z '
9451C-x )
9452
9453C-x ( 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ * C-x )
9454@end group
9455@end example
9456
9457@node Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 12, Programming Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
9458@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 11
9459
9460@noindent
9461First we define a dummy program to go on the @kbd{z s} key. The true
9462@w{@kbd{z s}} key is supposed to take two numbers from the stack and
9463return one number, so @key{DEL} as a dummy definition will make
9464sure the stack comes out right.
9465
9466@smallexample
9467@group
94682: 4 1: 4 2: 4
94691: 2 . 1: 2
9470 . .
9471
9472 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( @key{DEL} C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} 2
9473@end group
9474@end smallexample
9475
9476The last step replaces the 2 that was eaten during the creation
9477of the dummy @kbd{z s} command. Now we move on to the real
9478definition. The recurrence needs to be rewritten slightly,
9479to the form @expr{s(n,m) = s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m)}.
9480
9481(Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9482below. You can use @kbd{C-x * m} to load it from there.)
9483
9484@smallexample
9485@group
94862: 4 4: 4 3: 4 2: 4
94871: 2 3: 2 2: 2 1: 2
9488 . 2: 4 1: 0 .
9489 1: 2 .
9490 .
9491
9492 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1 Z :
9493
9494@end group
9495@end smallexample
9496@noindent
9497@smallexample
9498@group
94994: 4 2: 4 2: 3 4: 3 4: 3 3: 3
95003: 2 1: 2 1: 2 3: 2 3: 2 2: 2
95012: 2 . . 2: 3 2: 3 1: 3
95021: 0 1: 2 1: 1 .
9503 . . .
9504
9505 @key{RET} 0 a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9506@end group
9507@end smallexample
9508
9509@noindent
9510(Note that the value 3 that our dummy @kbd{z s} produces is not correct;
9511it is merely a placeholder that will do just as well for now.)
9512
9513@smallexample
9514@group
95153: 3 4: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: -6
95162: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: 9 .
95171: 2 2: 3 1: 3 .
9518 . 1: 2 .
9519 .
9520
9521 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9522
9523@end group
9524@end smallexample
9525@noindent
9526@smallexample
9527@group
95281: -6 2: 4 1: 11 2: 11
9529 . 1: 2 . 1: 11
9530 . .
9531
9532 Z ] Z ] C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} @key{DEL} 4 @key{RET} 2 z s M-@key{RET} k s
9533@end group
9534@end smallexample
9535
9536Even though the result that we got during the definition was highly
9537bogus, once the definition is complete the @kbd{z s} command gets
9538the right answers.
9539
9540Here's the full program once again:
9541
9542@example
9543@group
9544C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a =
9545 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1
9546 Z : @key{RET} 0 a =
9547 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0
9548 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9549 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9550 Z ]
9551 Z ]
9552C-x )
9553@end group
9554@end example
9555
9556You can read this definition using @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro})
9557followed by @kbd{Z K s}, without having to make a dummy definition
9558first, because @code{read-kbd-macro} doesn't need to execute the
9559definition as it reads it in. For this reason, @code{C-x * m} is often
9560the easiest way to create recursive programs in Calc.
9561
9562@node Programming Answer 12, , Programming Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
9563@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 12
9564
9565@noindent
9566This turns out to be a much easier way to solve the problem. Let's
9567denote Stirling numbers as calls of the function @samp{s}.
9568
9569First, we store the rewrite rules corresponding to the definition of
9570Stirling numbers in a convenient variable:
9571
9572@smallexample
9573s e StirlingRules @key{RET}
9574[ s(n,n) := 1 :: n >= 0,
9575 s(n,0) := 0 :: n > 0,
9576 s(n,m) := s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m) :: n >= m :: m >= 1 ]
9577C-c C-c
9578@end smallexample
9579
9580Now, it's just a matter of applying the rules:
9581
9582@smallexample
9583@group
95842: 4 1: s(4, 2) 1: 11
95851: 2 . .
9586 .
9587
9588 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( ' s($$,$) @key{RET} a r StirlingRules @key{RET} C-x )
9589@end group
9590@end smallexample
9591
9592As in the case of the @code{fib} rules, it would be useful to put these
9593rules in @code{EvalRules} and to add a @samp{:: remember} condition to
9594the last rule.
9595
9596@c This ends the table-of-contents kludge from above:
9597@tex
9598\global\let\chapternofonts=\oldchapternofonts
9599@end tex
9600
9601@c [reference]
9602
9603@node Introduction, Data Types, Tutorial, Top
9604@chapter Introduction
9605
9606@noindent
9607This chapter is the beginning of the Calc reference manual.
9608It covers basic concepts such as the stack, algebraic and
9609numeric entry, undo, numeric prefix arguments, etc.
9610
9611@c [when-split]
9612@c (Chapter 2, the Tutorial, has been printed in a separate volume.)
9613
9614@menu
9615* Basic Commands::
9616* Help Commands::
9617* Stack Basics::
9618* Numeric Entry::
9619* Algebraic Entry::
9620* Quick Calculator::
9621* Prefix Arguments::
9622* Undo::
9623* Error Messages::
9624* Multiple Calculators::
9625* Troubleshooting Commands::
9626@end menu
9627
9628@node Basic Commands, Help Commands, Introduction, Introduction
9629@section Basic Commands
9630
9631@noindent
9632@pindex calc
9633@pindex calc-mode
9634@cindex Starting the Calculator
9635@cindex Running the Calculator
9636To start the Calculator in its standard interface, type @kbd{M-x calc}.
9637By default this creates a pair of small windows, @samp{*Calculator*}
9638and @samp{*Calc Trail*}. The former displays the contents of the
9639Calculator stack and is manipulated exclusively through Calc commands.
9640It is possible (though not usually necessary) to create several Calc
9641mode buffers each of which has an independent stack, undo list, and
9642mode settings. There is exactly one Calc Trail buffer; it records a
9643list of the results of all calculations that have been done. The
9644Calc Trail buffer uses a variant of Calc mode, so Calculator commands
9645still work when the trail buffer's window is selected. It is possible
9646to turn the trail window off, but the @samp{*Calc Trail*} buffer itself
9647still exists and is updated silently. @xref{Trail Commands}.
9648
9649@kindex C-x * c
9650@kindex C-x * *
9651@ignore
9652@mindex @null
9653@end ignore
9654In most installations, the @kbd{C-x * c} key sequence is a more
9655convenient way to start the Calculator. Also, @kbd{C-x * *}
9656is a synonym for @kbd{C-x * c} unless you last used Calc
9657in its Keypad mode.
9658
9659@kindex x
9660@kindex M-x
9661@pindex calc-execute-extended-command
9662Most Calc commands use one or two keystrokes. Lower- and upper-case
9663letters are distinct. Commands may also be entered in full @kbd{M-x} form;
9664for some commands this is the only form. As a convenience, the @kbd{x}
9665key (@code{calc-execute-extended-command})
9666is like @kbd{M-x} except that it enters the initial string @samp{calc-}
9667for you. For example, the following key sequences are equivalent:
9668@kbd{S}, @kbd{M-x calc-sin @key{RET}}, @kbd{x sin @key{RET}}.
9669
3bc88bc9
JB
9670Although Calc is designed to be used from the keyboard, some of
9671Calc's more common commands are available from a menu. In the menu, the
9672arguments to the functions are given by referring to their stack level
9673numbers.
9674
4009494e
GM
9675@cindex Extensions module
9676@cindex @file{calc-ext} module
9677The Calculator exists in many parts. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}, the
9678Emacs ``auto-load'' mechanism will bring in only the first part, which
9679contains the basic arithmetic functions. The other parts will be
9680auto-loaded the first time you use the more advanced commands like trig
9681functions or matrix operations. This is done to improve the response time
9682of the Calculator in the common case when all you need to do is a
9683little arithmetic. If for some reason the Calculator fails to load an
9684extension module automatically, you can force it to load all the
9685extensions by using the @kbd{C-x * L} (@code{calc-load-everything})
9686command. @xref{Mode Settings}.
9687
9688If you type @kbd{M-x calc} or @kbd{C-x * c} with any numeric prefix argument,
9689the Calculator is loaded if necessary, but it is not actually started.
9690If the argument is positive, the @file{calc-ext} extensions are also
9691loaded if necessary. User-written Lisp code that wishes to make use
9692of Calc's arithmetic routines can use @samp{(calc 0)} or @samp{(calc 1)}
9693to auto-load the Calculator.
9694
9695@kindex C-x * b
9696@pindex full-calc
9697If you type @kbd{C-x * b}, then next time you use @kbd{C-x * c} you
9698will get a Calculator that uses the full height of the Emacs screen.
9699When full-screen mode is on, @kbd{C-x * c} runs the @code{full-calc}
9700command instead of @code{calc}. From the Unix shell you can type
9701@samp{emacs -f full-calc} to start a new Emacs specifically for use
9702as a calculator. When Calc is started from the Emacs command line
9703like this, Calc's normal ``quit'' commands actually quit Emacs itself.
9704
9705@kindex C-x * o
9706@pindex calc-other-window
9707The @kbd{C-x * o} command is like @kbd{C-x * c} except that the Calc
9708window is not actually selected. If you are already in the Calc
9709window, @kbd{C-x * o} switches you out of it. (The regular Emacs
9710@kbd{C-x o} command would also work for this, but it has a
9711tendency to drop you into the Calc Trail window instead, which
9712@kbd{C-x * o} takes care not to do.)
9713
9714@ignore
9715@mindex C-x * q
9716@end ignore
9717For one quick calculation, you can type @kbd{C-x * q} (@code{quick-calc})
9718which prompts you for a formula (like @samp{2+3/4}). The result is
9719displayed at the bottom of the Emacs screen without ever creating
9720any special Calculator windows. @xref{Quick Calculator}.
9721
9722@ignore
9723@mindex C-x * k
9724@end ignore
9725Finally, if you are using the X window system you may want to try
9726@kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) which runs Calc with a
9727``calculator keypad'' picture as well as a stack display. Click on
9728the keys with the mouse to operate the calculator. @xref{Keypad Mode}.
9729
9730@kindex q
9731@pindex calc-quit
9732@cindex Quitting the Calculator
9733@cindex Exiting the Calculator
9734The @kbd{q} key (@code{calc-quit}) exits Calc mode and closes the
9735Calculator's window(s). It does not delete the Calculator buffers.
9736If you type @kbd{M-x calc} again, the Calculator will reappear with the
9737contents of the stack intact. Typing @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}
9738again from inside the Calculator buffer is equivalent to executing
9739@code{calc-quit}; you can think of @kbd{C-x * *} as toggling the
9740Calculator on and off.
9741
9742@kindex C-x * x
9743The @kbd{C-x * x} command also turns the Calculator off, no matter which
9744user interface (standard, Keypad, or Embedded) is currently active.
9745It also cancels @code{calc-edit} mode if used from there.
9746
9747@kindex d @key{SPC}
9748@pindex calc-refresh
9749@cindex Refreshing a garbled display
9750@cindex Garbled displays, refreshing
9751The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} key sequence (@code{calc-refresh}) redraws the contents
9752of the Calculator buffer from memory. Use this if the contents of the
9753buffer have been damaged somehow.
9754
9755@ignore
9756@mindex o
9757@end ignore
9758The @kbd{o} key (@code{calc-realign}) moves the cursor back to its
9759``home'' position at the bottom of the Calculator buffer.
9760
9761@kindex <
9762@kindex >
9763@pindex calc-scroll-left
9764@pindex calc-scroll-right
9765@cindex Horizontal scrolling
9766@cindex Scrolling
9767@cindex Wide text, scrolling
9768The @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-left} and
9769@code{calc-scroll-right}. These are just like the normal horizontal
9770scrolling commands except that they scroll one half-screen at a time by
9771default. (Calc formats its output to fit within the bounds of the
9772window whenever it can.)
9773
9774@kindex @{
9775@kindex @}
9776@pindex calc-scroll-down
9777@pindex calc-scroll-up
9778@cindex Vertical scrolling
9779The @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-down}
9780and @code{calc-scroll-up}. They scroll up or down by one-half the
9781height of the Calc window.
9782
9783@kindex C-x * 0
9784@pindex calc-reset
9785The @kbd{C-x * 0} command (@code{calc-reset}; that's @kbd{C-x *} followed
9786by a zero) resets the Calculator to its initial state. This clears
9787the stack, resets all the modes to their initial values (the values
9788that were saved with @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})), clears the
9789caches (@pxref{Caches}), and so on. (It does @emph{not} erase the
9790values of any variables.) With an argument of 0, Calc will be reset to
9791its default state; namely, the modes will be given their default values.
9792With a positive prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of
9793the stack but resets everything else to its initial state; with a
9794negative prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of the
9795stack but resets everything else to its default state.
9796
4009494e
GM
9797@node Help Commands, Stack Basics, Basic Commands, Introduction
9798@section Help Commands
9799
9800@noindent
9801@cindex Help commands
9802@kindex ?
b5bdfd9f
JB
9803@kindex a ?
9804@kindex b ?
9805@kindex c ?
9806@kindex d ?
9807@kindex f ?
9808@kindex g ?
9809@kindex j ?
9810@kindex k ?
9811@kindex m ?
9812@kindex r ?
9813@kindex s ?
9814@kindex t ?
9815@kindex u ?
9816@kindex v ?
9817@kindex V ?
9818@kindex z ?
9819@kindex Z ?
4009494e
GM
9820@pindex calc-help
9821The @kbd{?} key (@code{calc-help}) displays a series of brief help messages.
9822Some keys (such as @kbd{b} and @kbd{d}) are prefix keys, like Emacs'
9823@key{ESC} and @kbd{C-x} prefixes. You can type
9824@kbd{?} after a prefix to see a list of commands beginning with that
9825prefix. (If the message includes @samp{[MORE]}, press @kbd{?} again
9826to see additional commands for that prefix.)
9827
9828@kindex h h
9829@pindex calc-full-help
9830The @kbd{h h} (@code{calc-full-help}) command displays all the @kbd{?}
9831responses at once. When printed, this makes a nice, compact (three pages)
9832summary of Calc keystrokes.
9833
9834In general, the @kbd{h} key prefix introduces various commands that
9835provide help within Calc. Many of the @kbd{h} key functions are
9836Calc-specific analogues to the @kbd{C-h} functions for Emacs help.
9837
9838@kindex h i
9839@kindex C-x * i
9840@kindex i
9841@pindex calc-info
9842The @kbd{h i} (@code{calc-info}) command runs the Emacs Info system
9843to read this manual on-line. This is basically the same as typing
9844@kbd{C-h i} (the regular way to run the Info system), then, if Info
9845is not already in the Calc manual, selecting the beginning of the
9846manual. The @kbd{C-x * i} command is another way to read the Calc
9847manual; it is different from @kbd{h i} in that it works any time,
9848not just inside Calc. The plain @kbd{i} key is also equivalent to
9849@kbd{h i}, though this key is obsolete and may be replaced with a
9850different command in a future version of Calc.
9851
9852@kindex h t
9853@kindex C-x * t
9854@pindex calc-tutorial
9855The @kbd{h t} (@code{calc-tutorial}) command runs the Info system on
9856the Tutorial section of the Calc manual. It is like @kbd{h i},
9857except that it selects the starting node of the tutorial rather
9858than the beginning of the whole manual. (It actually selects the
9859node ``Interactive Tutorial'' which tells a few things about
9860using the Info system before going on to the actual tutorial.)
9861The @kbd{C-x * t} key is equivalent to @kbd{h t} (but it works at
9862all times).
9863
9864@kindex h s
9865@kindex C-x * s
9866@pindex calc-info-summary
9867The @kbd{h s} (@code{calc-info-summary}) command runs the Info system
9868on the Summary node of the Calc manual. @xref{Summary}. The @kbd{C-x * s}
9869key is equivalent to @kbd{h s}.
9870
9871@kindex h k
9872@pindex calc-describe-key
9873The @kbd{h k} (@code{calc-describe-key}) command looks up a key
9874sequence in the Calc manual. For example, @kbd{h k H a S} looks
9875up the documentation on the @kbd{H a S} (@code{calc-solve-for})
9876command. This works by looking up the textual description of
9877the key(s) in the Key Index of the manual, then jumping to the
9878node indicated by the index.
9879
9880Most Calc commands do not have traditional Emacs documentation
9881strings, since the @kbd{h k} command is both more convenient and
9882more instructive. This means the regular Emacs @kbd{C-h k}
9883(@code{describe-key}) command will not be useful for Calc keystrokes.
9884
9885@kindex h c
9886@pindex calc-describe-key-briefly
9887The @kbd{h c} (@code{calc-describe-key-briefly}) command reads a
9888key sequence and displays a brief one-line description of it at
9889the bottom of the screen. It looks for the key sequence in the
9890Summary node of the Calc manual; if it doesn't find the sequence
9891there, it acts just like its regular Emacs counterpart @kbd{C-h c}
9892(@code{describe-key-briefly}). For example, @kbd{h c H a S}
9893gives the description:
9894
9895@smallexample
9896H a S runs calc-solve-for: a `H a S' v => fsolve(a,v) (?=notes)
9897@end smallexample
9898
9899@noindent
9900which means the command @kbd{H a S} or @kbd{H M-x calc-solve-for}
9901takes a value @expr{a} from the stack, prompts for a value @expr{v},
9902then applies the algebraic function @code{fsolve} to these values.
9903The @samp{?=notes} message means you can now type @kbd{?} to see
9904additional notes from the summary that apply to this command.
9905
9906@kindex h f
9907@pindex calc-describe-function
9908The @kbd{h f} (@code{calc-describe-function}) command looks up an
9909algebraic function or a command name in the Calc manual. Enter an
9910algebraic function name to look up that function in the Function
9911Index or enter a command name beginning with @samp{calc-} to look it
9912up in the Command Index. This command will also look up operator
9913symbols that can appear in algebraic formulas, like @samp{%} and
9914@samp{=>}.
9915
9916@kindex h v
9917@pindex calc-describe-variable
9918The @kbd{h v} (@code{calc-describe-variable}) command looks up a
9919variable in the Calc manual. Enter a variable name like @code{pi} or
9920@code{PlotRejects}.
9921
9922@kindex h b
9923@pindex describe-bindings
9924The @kbd{h b} (@code{calc-describe-bindings}) command is just like
9925@kbd{C-h b}, except that only local (Calc-related) key bindings are
9926listed.
9927
9928@kindex h n
9929The @kbd{h n} or @kbd{h C-n} (@code{calc-view-news}) command displays
9930the ``news'' or change history of Calc. This is kept in the file
9931@file{README}, which Calc looks for in the same directory as the Calc
9932source files.
9933
9934@kindex h C-c
9935@kindex h C-d
9936@kindex h C-w
9937The @kbd{h C-c}, @kbd{h C-d}, and @kbd{h C-w} keys display copying,
9938distribution, and warranty information about Calc. These work by
9939pulling up the appropriate parts of the ``Copying'' or ``Reporting
9940Bugs'' sections of the manual.
9941
9942@node Stack Basics, Numeric Entry, Help Commands, Introduction
9943@section Stack Basics
9944
9945@noindent
9946@cindex Stack basics
9947@c [fix-tut RPN Calculations and the Stack]
9948Calc uses RPN notation. If you are not familiar with RPN, @pxref{RPN
9949Tutorial}.
9950
9951To add the numbers 1 and 2 in Calc you would type the keys:
9952@kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 +}.
9953(@key{RET} corresponds to the @key{ENTER} key on most calculators.)
9954The first three keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 1 and 2 onto the stack. The
9955@kbd{+} key always ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
9956and pushes the result (3) back onto the stack. This number is ready for
9957further calculations: @kbd{5 -} pushes 5 onto the stack, then pops the
99583 and 5, subtracts them, and pushes the result (@mathit{-2}).
9959
9960Note that the ``top'' of the stack actually appears at the @emph{bottom}
9961of the buffer. A line containing a single @samp{.} character signifies
9962the end of the buffer; Calculator commands operate on the number(s)
9963directly above this line. The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack})
9964command allows you to move the @samp{.} marker up and down in the stack;
9965@pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
9966
9967@kindex d l
9968@pindex calc-line-numbering
9969Stack elements are numbered consecutively, with number 1 being the top of
9970the stack. These line numbers are ordinarily displayed on the lefthand side
9971of the window. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) command controls
9972whether these numbers appear. (Line numbers may be turned off since they
9973slow the Calculator down a bit and also clutter the display.)
9974
9975@kindex o
9976@pindex calc-realign
9977The unshifted letter @kbd{o} (@code{calc-realign}) command repositions
9978the cursor to its top-of-stack ``home'' position. It also undoes any
9979horizontal scrolling in the window. If you give it a numeric prefix
9980argument, it instead moves the cursor to the specified stack element.
9981
9982The @key{RET} (or equivalent @key{SPC}) key is only required to separate
9983two consecutive numbers.
9984(After all, if you typed @kbd{1 2} by themselves the Calculator
9985would enter the number 12.) If you press @key{RET} or @key{SPC} @emph{not}
9986right after typing a number, the key duplicates the number on the top of
9987the stack. @kbd{@key{RET} *} is thus a handy way to square a number.
9988
9989The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the top number on the stack.
9990The @key{TAB} key swaps the top two objects on the stack.
9991@xref{Stack and Trail}, for descriptions of these and other stack-related
9992commands.
9993
9994@node Numeric Entry, Algebraic Entry, Stack Basics, Introduction
9995@section Numeric Entry
9996
9997@noindent
9998@kindex 0-9
9999@kindex .
10000@kindex e
10001@cindex Numeric entry
10002@cindex Entering numbers
10003Pressing a digit or other numeric key begins numeric entry using the
10004minibuffer. The number is pushed on the stack when you press the @key{RET}
10005or @key{SPC} keys. If you press any other non-numeric key, the number is
10006pushed onto the stack and the appropriate operation is performed. If
10007you press a numeric key which is not valid, the key is ignored.
10008
10009@cindex Minus signs
10010@cindex Negative numbers, entering
10011@kindex _
10012There are three different concepts corresponding to the word ``minus,''
10013typified by @expr{a-b} (subtraction), @expr{-x}
10014(change-sign), and @expr{-5} (negative number). Calc uses three
10015different keys for these operations, respectively:
10016@kbd{-}, @kbd{n}, and @kbd{_} (the underscore). The @kbd{-} key subtracts
10017the two numbers on the top of the stack. The @kbd{n} key changes the sign
10018of the number on the top of the stack or the number currently being entered.
10019The @kbd{_} key begins entry of a negative number or changes the sign of
10020the number currently being entered. The following sequences all enter the
10021number @mathit{-5} onto the stack: @kbd{0 @key{RET} 5 -}, @kbd{5 n @key{RET}},
10022@kbd{5 @key{RET} n}, @kbd{_ 5 @key{RET}}, @kbd{5 _ @key{RET}}.
10023
10024Some other keys are active during numeric entry, such as @kbd{#} for
10025non-decimal numbers, @kbd{:} for fractions, and @kbd{@@} for HMS forms.
10026These notations are described later in this manual with the corresponding
10027data types. @xref{Data Types}.
10028
10029During numeric entry, the only editing key available is @key{DEL}.
10030
10031@node Algebraic Entry, Quick Calculator, Numeric Entry, Introduction
10032@section Algebraic Entry
10033
10034@noindent
10035@kindex '
10036@pindex calc-algebraic-entry
10037@cindex Algebraic notation
10038@cindex Formulas, entering
8dc6104d
JB
10039The @kbd{'} (@code{calc-algebraic-entry}) command can be used to enter
10040calculations in algebraic form. This is accomplished by typing the
10041apostrophe key, ', followed by the expression in standard format:
4009494e
GM
10042
10043@example
10044' 2+3*4 @key{RET}.
10045@end example
10046
10047@noindent
10048This will compute
10049@texline @math{2+(3\times4) = 14}
10050@infoline @expr{2+(3*4) = 14}
10051and push it on the stack. If you wish you can
10052ignore the RPN aspect of Calc altogether and simply enter algebraic
10053expressions in this way. You may want to use @key{DEL} every so often to
10054clear previous results off the stack.
10055
10056You can press the apostrophe key during normal numeric entry to switch
8dc6104d
JB
10057the half-entered number into Algebraic entry mode. One reason to do
10058this would be to fix a typo, as the full Emacs cursor motion and editing
10059keys are available during algebraic entry but not during numeric entry.
4009494e
GM
10060
10061In the same vein, during either numeric or algebraic entry you can
10062press @kbd{`} (backquote) to switch to @code{calc-edit} mode, where
10063you complete your half-finished entry in a separate buffer.
10064@xref{Editing Stack Entries}.
10065
10066@kindex m a
10067@pindex calc-algebraic-mode
10068@cindex Algebraic Mode
10069If you prefer algebraic entry, you can use the command @kbd{m a}
10070(@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) to set Algebraic mode. In this mode,
10071digits and other keys that would normally start numeric entry instead
10072start full algebraic entry; as long as your formula begins with a digit
10073you can omit the apostrophe. Open parentheses and square brackets also
10074begin algebraic entry. You can still do RPN calculations in this mode,
10075but you will have to press @key{RET} to terminate every number:
10076@kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} +} would accomplish the same
10077thing as @kbd{2*3+4 @key{RET}}.
10078
10079@cindex Incomplete Algebraic Mode
10080If you give a numeric prefix argument like @kbd{C-u} to the @kbd{m a}
10081command, it enables Incomplete Algebraic mode; this is like regular
10082Algebraic mode except that it applies to the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys
10083only. Numeric keys still begin a numeric entry in this mode.
10084
10085@kindex m t
10086@pindex calc-total-algebraic-mode
10087@cindex Total Algebraic Mode
10088The @kbd{m t} (@code{calc-total-algebraic-mode}) gives you an even
10089stronger algebraic-entry mode, in which @emph{all} regular letter and
10090punctuation keys begin algebraic entry. Use this if you prefer typing
10091@w{@kbd{sqrt( )}} instead of @kbd{Q}, @w{@kbd{factor( )}} instead of
10092@kbd{a f}, and so on. To type regular Calc commands when you are in
10093Total Algebraic mode, hold down the @key{META} key. Thus @kbd{M-q}
10094is the command to quit Calc, @kbd{M-p} sets the precision, and
10095@kbd{M-m t} (or @kbd{M-m M-t}, if you prefer) turns Total Algebraic
10096mode back off again. Meta keys also terminate algebraic entry, so
10097that @kbd{2+3 M-S} is equivalent to @kbd{2+3 @key{RET} M-S}. The symbol
10098@samp{Alg*} will appear in the mode line whenever you are in this mode.
10099
10100Pressing @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) a second time re-enters the previous
10101algebraic formula. You can then use the normal Emacs editing keys to
10102modify this formula to your liking before pressing @key{RET}.
10103
10104@kindex $
10105@cindex Formulas, referring to stack
10106Within a formula entered from the keyboard, the symbol @kbd{$}
10107represents the number on the top of the stack. If an entered formula
10108contains any @kbd{$} characters, the Calculator replaces the top of
10109stack with that formula rather than simply pushing the formula onto the
10110stack. Thus, @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3 on the stack, and @kbd{$*2
10111@key{RET}} replaces it with 6. Note that the @kbd{$} key always
10112initiates algebraic entry; the @kbd{'} is unnecessary if @kbd{$} is the
10113first character in the new formula.
10114
10115Higher stack elements can be accessed from an entered formula with the
10116symbols @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on. The number of stack elements
10117removed (to be replaced by the entered values) equals the number of dollar
10118signs in the longest such symbol in the formula. For example, @samp{$$+$$$}
10119adds the second and third stack elements, replacing the top three elements
10120with the answer. (All information about the top stack element is thus lost
10121since no single @samp{$} appears in this formula.)
10122
10123A slightly different way to refer to stack elements is with a dollar
10124sign followed by a number: @samp{$1}, @samp{$2}, and so on are much
10125like @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, etc., except that stack entries referred
10126to numerically are not replaced by the algebraic entry. That is, while
10127@samp{$+1} replaces 5 on the stack with 6, @samp{$1+1} leaves the 5
10128on the stack and pushes an additional 6.
10129
10130If a sequence of formulas are entered separated by commas, each formula
10131is pushed onto the stack in turn. For example, @samp{1,2,3} pushes
10132those three numbers onto the stack (leaving the 3 at the top), and
10133@samp{$+1,$-1} replaces a 5 on the stack with 4 followed by 6. Also,
10134@samp{$,$$} exchanges the top two elements of the stack, just like the
10135@key{TAB} key.
10136
10137You can finish an algebraic entry with @kbd{M-=} or @kbd{M-@key{RET}} instead
10138of @key{RET}. This uses @kbd{=} to evaluate the variables in each
10139formula that goes onto the stack. (Thus @kbd{' pi @key{RET}} pushes
10140the variable @samp{pi}, but @kbd{' pi M-@key{RET}} pushes 3.1415.)
10141
10142If you finish your algebraic entry by pressing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j})
10143instead of @key{RET}, Calc disables the default simplifications
10144(as if by @kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}) while the entry
10145is being pushed on the stack. Thus @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3
10146on the stack, but @kbd{' 1+2 @key{LFD}} pushes the formula @expr{1+2};
10147you might then press @kbd{=} when it is time to evaluate this formula.
10148
10149@node Quick Calculator, Prefix Arguments, Algebraic Entry, Introduction
10150@section ``Quick Calculator'' Mode
10151
10152@noindent
10153@kindex C-x * q
10154@pindex quick-calc
10155@cindex Quick Calculator
10156There is another way to invoke the Calculator if all you need to do
10157is make one or two quick calculations. Type @kbd{C-x * q} (or
10158@kbd{M-x quick-calc}), then type any formula as an algebraic entry.
10159The Calculator will compute the result and display it in the echo
10160area, without ever actually putting up a Calc window.
10161
10162You can use the @kbd{$} character in a Quick Calculator formula to
10163refer to the previous Quick Calculator result. Older results are
10164not retained; the Quick Calculator has no effect on the full
10165Calculator's stack or trail. If you compute a result and then
10166forget what it was, just run @code{C-x * q} again and enter
10167@samp{$} as the formula.
10168
10169If this is the first time you have used the Calculator in this Emacs
10170session, the @kbd{C-x * q} command will create the @code{*Calculator*}
10171buffer and perform all the usual initializations; it simply will
10172refrain from putting that buffer up in a new window. The Quick
10173Calculator refers to the @code{*Calculator*} buffer for all mode
10174settings. Thus, for example, to set the precision that the Quick
10175Calculator uses, simply run the full Calculator momentarily and use
10176the regular @kbd{p} command.
10177
10178If you use @code{C-x * q} from inside the Calculator buffer, the
10179effect is the same as pressing the apostrophe key (algebraic entry).
10180
10181The result of a Quick calculation is placed in the Emacs ``kill ring''
10182as well as being displayed. A subsequent @kbd{C-y} command will
10183yank the result into the editing buffer. You can also use this
10184to yank the result into the next @kbd{C-x * q} input line as a more
10185explicit alternative to @kbd{$} notation, or to yank the result
10186into the Calculator stack after typing @kbd{C-x * c}.
10187
10188If you finish your formula by typing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j}) instead
10189of @key{RET}, the result is inserted immediately into the current
10190buffer rather than going into the kill ring.
10191
10192Quick Calculator results are actually evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
10193key (which replaces variable names by their stored values, if any).
10194If the formula you enter is an assignment to a variable using the
10195@samp{:=} operator, say, @samp{foo := 2 + 3} or @samp{foo := foo + 1},
10196then the result of the evaluation is stored in that Calc variable.
10197@xref{Store and Recall}.
10198
10199If the result is an integer and the current display radix is decimal,
10200the number will also be displayed in hex, octal and binary formats. If
10201the integer is in the range from 1 to 126, it will also be displayed as
10202an ASCII character.
10203
10204For example, the quoted character @samp{"x"} produces the vector
10205result @samp{[120]} (because 120 is the ASCII code of the lower-case
10206`x'; @pxref{Strings}). Since this is a vector, not an integer, it
10207is displayed only according to the current mode settings. But
10208running Quick Calc again and entering @samp{120} will produce the
10209result @samp{120 (16#78, 8#170, x)} which shows the number in its
10210decimal, hexadecimal, octal, and ASCII forms.
10211
10212Please note that the Quick Calculator is not any faster at loading
10213or computing the answer than the full Calculator; the name ``quick''
10214merely refers to the fact that it's much less hassle to use for
10215small calculations.
10216
10217@node Prefix Arguments, Undo, Quick Calculator, Introduction
10218@section Numeric Prefix Arguments
10219
10220@noindent
10221Many Calculator commands use numeric prefix arguments. Some, such as
10222@kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}), set a parameter to the value of
10223the prefix argument or use a default if you don't use a prefix.
10224Others (like @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation})) require an argument
10225and prompt for a number if you don't give one as a prefix.
10226
10227As a rule, stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric prefix argument
10228which is interpreted as an index into the stack. A positive argument
10229operates on the top @var{n} stack entries; a negative argument operates
10230on the @var{n}th stack entry in isolation; and a zero argument operates
10231on the entire stack.
10232
10233Most commands that perform computations (such as the arithmetic and
10234scientific functions) accept a numeric prefix argument that allows the
10235operation to be applied across many stack elements. For unary operations
10236(that is, functions of one argument like absolute value or complex
10237conjugate), a positive prefix argument applies that function to the top
10238@var{n} stack entries simultaneously, and a negative argument applies it
10239to the @var{n}th stack entry only. For binary operations (functions of
10240two arguments like addition, GCD, and vector concatenation), a positive
10241prefix argument ``reduces'' the function across the top @var{n}
10242stack elements (for example, @kbd{C-u 5 +} sums the top 5 stack entries;
10243@pxref{Reducing and Mapping}), and a negative argument maps the next-to-top
10244@var{n} stack elements with the top stack element as a second argument
10245(for example, @kbd{7 c-u -5 +} adds 7 to the top 5 stack elements).
10246This feature is not available for operations which use the numeric prefix
10247argument for some other purpose.
10248
10249Numeric prefixes are specified the same way as always in Emacs: Press
10250a sequence of @key{META}-digits, or press @key{ESC} followed by digits,
10251or press @kbd{C-u} followed by digits. Some commands treat plain
10252@kbd{C-u} (without any actual digits) specially.
10253
10254@kindex ~
10255@pindex calc-num-prefix
10256You can type @kbd{~} (@code{calc-num-prefix}) to pop an integer from the
10257top of the stack and enter it as the numeric prefix for the next command.
10258For example, @kbd{C-u 16 p} sets the precision to 16 digits; an alternate
10259(silly) way to do this would be @kbd{2 @key{RET} 4 ^ ~ p}, i.e., compute 2
10260to the fourth power and set the precision to that value.
10261
10262Conversely, if you have typed a numeric prefix argument the @kbd{~} key
10263pushes it onto the stack in the form of an integer.
10264
10265@node Undo, Error Messages, Prefix Arguments, Introduction
10266@section Undoing Mistakes
10267
10268@noindent
10269@kindex U
10270@kindex C-_
10271@pindex calc-undo
10272@cindex Mistakes, undoing
10273@cindex Undoing mistakes
10274@cindex Errors, undoing
10275The shift-@kbd{U} key (@code{calc-undo}) undoes the most recent operation.
10276If that operation added or dropped objects from the stack, those objects
10277are removed or restored. If it was a ``store'' operation, you are
10278queried whether or not to restore the variable to its original value.
10279The @kbd{U} key may be pressed any number of times to undo successively
10280farther back in time; with a numeric prefix argument it undoes a
ec06459c
JB
10281specified number of operations. When the Calculator is quit, as with
10282the @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command, the undo history will be
10283truncated to the length of the customizable variable
10284@code{calc-undo-length} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}), which by default
10285is @expr{100}. (Recall that @kbd{C-x * c} is synonymous with
10286@code{calc-quit} while inside the Calculator; this also truncates the
10287undo history.)
4009494e
GM
10288
10289Currently the mode-setting commands (like @code{calc-precision}) are not
10290undoable. You can undo past a point where you changed a mode, but you
10291will need to reset the mode yourself.
10292
10293@kindex D
10294@pindex calc-redo
10295@cindex Redoing after an Undo
10296The shift-@kbd{D} key (@code{calc-redo}) redoes an operation that was
10297mistakenly undone. Pressing @kbd{U} with a negative prefix argument is
10298equivalent to executing @code{calc-redo}. You can redo any number of
10299times, up to the number of recent consecutive undo commands. Redo
10300information is cleared whenever you give any command that adds new undo
10301information, i.e., if you undo, then enter a number on the stack or make
10302any other change, then it will be too late to redo.
10303
10304@kindex M-@key{RET}
10305@pindex calc-last-args
10306@cindex Last-arguments feature
10307@cindex Arguments, restoring
10308The @kbd{M-@key{RET}} key (@code{calc-last-args}) is like undo in that
10309it restores the arguments of the most recent command onto the stack;
10310however, it does not remove the result of that command. Given a numeric
10311prefix argument, this command applies to the @expr{n}th most recent
10312command which removed items from the stack; it pushes those items back
10313onto the stack.
10314
10315The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command provides a related function
10316to @kbd{M-@key{RET}}. @xref{Stack and Trail}.
10317
10318It is also possible to recall previous results or inputs using the trail.
10319@xref{Trail Commands}.
10320
10321The standard Emacs @kbd{C-_} undo key is recognized as a synonym for @kbd{U}.
10322
10323@node Error Messages, Multiple Calculators, Undo, Introduction
10324@section Error Messages
10325
10326@noindent
10327@kindex w
10328@pindex calc-why
10329@cindex Errors, messages
10330@cindex Why did an error occur?
10331Many situations that would produce an error message in other calculators
10332simply create unsimplified formulas in the Emacs Calculator. For example,
10333@kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} pushes the formula @expr{1 / 0}; @w{@kbd{0 L}} pushes
10334the formula @samp{ln(0)}. Floating-point overflow and underflow are also
10335reasons for this to happen.
10336
10337When a function call must be left in symbolic form, Calc usually
10338produces a message explaining why. Messages that are probably
10339surprising or indicative of user errors are displayed automatically.
10340Other messages are simply kept in Calc's memory and are displayed only
10341if you type @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why}). You can also press @kbd{w} if
10342the same computation results in several messages. (The first message
10343will end with @samp{[w=more]} in this case.)
10344
10345@kindex d w
10346@pindex calc-auto-why
10347The @kbd{d w} (@code{calc-auto-why}) command controls when error messages
10348are displayed automatically. (Calc effectively presses @kbd{w} for you
10349after your computation finishes.) By default, this occurs only for
10350``important'' messages. The other possible modes are to report
10351@emph{all} messages automatically, or to report none automatically (so
10352that you must always press @kbd{w} yourself to see the messages).
10353
10354@node Multiple Calculators, Troubleshooting Commands, Error Messages, Introduction
10355@section Multiple Calculators
10356
10357@noindent
10358@pindex another-calc
10359It is possible to have any number of Calc mode buffers at once.
10360Usually this is done by executing @kbd{M-x another-calc}, which
10361is similar to @kbd{C-x * c} except that if a @samp{*Calculator*}
10362buffer already exists, a new, independent one with a name of the
10363form @samp{*Calculator*<@var{n}>} is created. You can also use the
10364command @code{calc-mode} to put any buffer into Calculator mode, but
10365this would ordinarily never be done.
10366
10367The @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command does not destroy a Calculator buffer;
10368it only closes its window. Use @kbd{M-x kill-buffer} to destroy a
10369Calculator buffer.
10370
10371Each Calculator buffer keeps its own stack, undo list, and mode settings
10372such as precision, angular mode, and display formats. In Emacs terms,
10373variables such as @code{calc-stack} are buffer-local variables. The
10374global default values of these variables are used only when a new
10375Calculator buffer is created. The @code{calc-quit} command saves
10376the stack and mode settings of the buffer being quit as the new defaults.
10377
10378There is only one trail buffer, @samp{*Calc Trail*}, used by all
10379Calculator buffers.
10380
10381@node Troubleshooting Commands, , Multiple Calculators, Introduction
10382@section Troubleshooting Commands
10383
10384@noindent
10385This section describes commands you can use in case a computation
10386incorrectly fails or gives the wrong answer.
10387
10388@xref{Reporting Bugs}, if you find a problem that appears to be due
10389to a bug or deficiency in Calc.
10390
10391@menu
10392* Autoloading Problems::
10393* Recursion Depth::
10394* Caches::
10395* Debugging Calc::
10396@end menu
10397
10398@node Autoloading Problems, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands, Troubleshooting Commands
10399@subsection Autoloading Problems
10400
10401@noindent
10402The Calc program is split into many component files; components are
10403loaded automatically as you use various commands that require them.
10404Occasionally Calc may lose track of when a certain component is
10405necessary; typically this means you will type a command and it won't
10406work because some function you've never heard of was undefined.
10407
10408@kindex C-x * L
10409@pindex calc-load-everything
10410If this happens, the easiest workaround is to type @kbd{C-x * L}
10411(@code{calc-load-everything}) to force all the parts of Calc to be
10412loaded right away. This will cause Emacs to take up a lot more
10413memory than it would otherwise, but it's guaranteed to fix the problem.
10414
10415@node Recursion Depth, Caches, Autoloading Problems, Troubleshooting Commands
10416@subsection Recursion Depth
10417
10418@noindent
10419@kindex M
10420@kindex I M
10421@pindex calc-more-recursion-depth
10422@pindex calc-less-recursion-depth
10423@cindex Recursion depth
10424@cindex ``Computation got stuck'' message
10425@cindex @code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10426@cindex @code{max-specpdl-size}
10427Calc uses recursion in many of its calculations. Emacs Lisp keeps a
10428variable @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} which limits the amount of recursion
10429possible in an attempt to recover from program bugs. If a calculation
10430ever halts incorrectly with the message ``Computation got stuck or
10431ran too long,'' use the @kbd{M} command (@code{calc-more-recursion-depth})
10432to increase this limit. (Of course, this will not help if the
10433calculation really did get stuck due to some problem inside Calc.)
10434
10435The limit is always increased (multiplied) by a factor of two. There
10436is also an @kbd{I M} (@code{calc-less-recursion-depth}) command which
10437decreases this limit by a factor of two, down to a minimum value of 200.
10438The default value is 1000.
10439
10440These commands also double or halve @code{max-specpdl-size}, another
10441internal Lisp recursion limit. The minimum value for this limit is 600.
10442
10443@node Caches, Debugging Calc, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands
10444@subsection Caches
10445
10446@noindent
10447@cindex Caches
10448@cindex Flushing caches
10449Calc saves certain values after they have been computed once. For
10450example, the @kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}) command initially ``knows'' the
10451constant @cpi{} to about 20 decimal places; if the current precision
10452is greater than this, it will recompute @cpi{} using a series
10453approximation. This value will not need to be recomputed ever again
10454unless you raise the precision still further. Many operations such as
10455logarithms and sines make use of similarly cached values such as
10456@cpiover{4} and
10457@texline @math{\ln 2}.
10458@infoline @expr{ln(2)}.
10459The visible effect of caching is that
10460high-precision computations may seem to do extra work the first time.
10461Other things cached include powers of two (for the binary arithmetic
10462functions), matrix inverses and determinants, symbolic integrals, and
10463data points computed by the graphing commands.
10464
10465@pindex calc-flush-caches
10466If you suspect a Calculator cache has become corrupt, you can use the
10467@code{calc-flush-caches} command to reset all caches to the empty state.
10468(This should only be necessary in the event of bugs in the Calculator.)
10469The @kbd{C-x * 0} (with the zero key) command also resets caches along
10470with all other aspects of the Calculator's state.
10471
10472@node Debugging Calc, , Caches, Troubleshooting Commands
10473@subsection Debugging Calc
10474
10475@noindent
10476A few commands exist to help in the debugging of Calc commands.
10477@xref{Programming}, to see the various ways that you can write
10478your own Calc commands.
10479
10480@kindex Z T
10481@pindex calc-timing
10482The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing}) command turns on and off a mode
10483in which the timing of slow commands is reported in the Trail.
10484Any Calc command that takes two seconds or longer writes a line
10485to the Trail showing how many seconds it took. This value is
10486accurate only to within one second.
10487
10488All steps of executing a command are included; in particular, time
10489taken to format the result for display in the stack and trail is
10490counted. Some prompts also count time taken waiting for them to
10491be answered, while others do not; this depends on the exact
10492implementation of the command. For best results, if you are timing
10493a sequence that includes prompts or multiple commands, define a
10494keyboard macro to run the whole sequence at once. Calc's @kbd{X}
10495command (@pxref{Keyboard Macros}) will then report the time taken
10496to execute the whole macro.
10497
10498Another advantage of the @kbd{X} command is that while it is
10499executing, the stack and trail are not updated from step to step.
10500So if you expect the output of your test sequence to leave a result
10501that may take a long time to format and you don't wish to count
10502this formatting time, end your sequence with a @key{DEL} keystroke
10503to clear the result from the stack. When you run the sequence with
10504@kbd{X}, Calc will never bother to format the large result.
10505
10506Another thing @kbd{Z T} does is to increase the Emacs variable
10507@code{gc-cons-threshold} to a much higher value (two million; the
10508usual default in Calc is 250,000) for the duration of each command.
10509This generally prevents garbage collection during the timing of
10510the command, though it may cause your Emacs process to grow
10511abnormally large. (Garbage collection time is a major unpredictable
10512factor in the timing of Emacs operations.)
10513
10514Another command that is useful when debugging your own Lisp
10515extensions to Calc is @kbd{M-x calc-pass-errors}, which disables
10516the error handler that changes the ``@code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10517exceeded'' message to the much more friendly ``Computation got
10518stuck or ran too long.'' This handler interferes with the Emacs
10519Lisp debugger's @code{debug-on-error} mode. Errors are reported
10520in the handler itself rather than at the true location of the
10521error. After you have executed @code{calc-pass-errors}, Lisp
10522errors will be reported correctly but the user-friendly message
10523will be lost.
10524
10525@node Data Types, Stack and Trail, Introduction, Top
10526@chapter Data Types
10527
10528@noindent
10529This chapter discusses the various types of objects that can be placed
10530on the Calculator stack, how they are displayed, and how they are
10531entered. (@xref{Data Type Formats}, for information on how these data
10532types are represented as underlying Lisp objects.)
10533
10534Integers, fractions, and floats are various ways of describing real
10535numbers. HMS forms also for many purposes act as real numbers. These
10536types can be combined to form complex numbers, modulo forms, error forms,
10537or interval forms. (But these last four types cannot be combined
10538arbitrarily:@: error forms may not contain modulo forms, for example.)
10539Finally, all these types of numbers may be combined into vectors,
10540matrices, or algebraic formulas.
10541
10542@menu
10543* Integers:: The most basic data type.
10544* Fractions:: This and above are called @dfn{rationals}.
10545* Floats:: This and above are called @dfn{reals}.
10546* Complex Numbers:: This and above are called @dfn{numbers}.
10547* Infinities::
10548* Vectors and Matrices::
10549* Strings::
10550* HMS Forms::
10551* Date Forms::
10552* Modulo Forms::
10553* Error Forms::
10554* Interval Forms::
10555* Incomplete Objects::
10556* Variables::
10557* Formulas::
10558@end menu
10559
10560@node Integers, Fractions, Data Types, Data Types
10561@section Integers
10562
10563@noindent
10564@cindex Integers
10565The Calculator stores integers to arbitrary precision. Addition,
10566subtraction, and multiplication of integers always yields an exact
10567integer result. (If the result of a division or exponentiation of
10568integers is not an integer, it is expressed in fractional or
10569floating-point form according to the current Fraction mode.
10570@xref{Fraction Mode}.)
10571
10572A decimal integer is represented as an optional sign followed by a
10573sequence of digits. Grouping (@pxref{Grouping Digits}) can be used to
10574insert a comma at every third digit for display purposes, but you
10575must not type commas during the entry of numbers.
10576
10577@kindex #
10578A non-decimal integer is represented as an optional sign, a radix
10579between 2 and 36, a @samp{#} symbol, and one or more digits. For radix 11
10580and above, the letters A through Z (upper- or lower-case) count as
10581digits and do not terminate numeric entry mode. @xref{Radix Modes}, for how
10582to set the default radix for display of integers. Numbers of any radix
10583may be entered at any time. If you press @kbd{#} at the beginning of a
10584number, the current display radix is used.
10585
10586@node Fractions, Floats, Integers, Data Types
10587@section Fractions
10588
10589@noindent
10590@cindex Fractions
10591A @dfn{fraction} is a ratio of two integers. Fractions are traditionally
10592written ``2/3'' but Calc uses the notation @samp{2:3}. (The @kbd{/} key
10593performs RPN division; the following two sequences push the number
10594@samp{2:3} on the stack: @kbd{2 :@: 3 @key{RET}}, or @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 /}
10595assuming Fraction mode has been enabled.)
10596When the Calculator produces a fractional result it always reduces it to
10597simplest form, which may in fact be an integer.
10598
10599Fractions may also be entered in a three-part form, where @samp{2:3:4}
10600represents two-and-three-quarters. @xref{Fraction Formats}, for fraction
10601display formats.
10602
10603Non-decimal fractions are entered and displayed as
10604@samp{@var{radix}#@var{num}:@var{denom}} (or in the analogous three-part
10605form). The numerator and denominator always use the same radix.
10606
10607@node Floats, Complex Numbers, Fractions, Data Types
10608@section Floats
10609
10610@noindent
10611@cindex Floating-point numbers
10612A floating-point number or @dfn{float} is a number stored in scientific
10613notation. The number of significant digits in the fractional part is
10614governed by the current floating precision (@pxref{Precision}). The
10615range of acceptable values is from
10616@texline @math{10^{-3999999}}
10617@infoline @expr{10^-3999999}
10618(inclusive) to
10619@texline @math{10^{4000000}}
10620@infoline @expr{10^4000000}
10621(exclusive), plus the corresponding negative values and zero.
10622
10623Calculations that would exceed the allowable range of values (such
10624as @samp{exp(exp(20))}) are left in symbolic form by Calc. The
10625messages ``floating-point overflow'' or ``floating-point underflow''
10626indicate that during the calculation a number would have been produced
10627that was too large or too close to zero, respectively, to be represented
10628by Calc. This does not necessarily mean the final result would have
10629overflowed, just that an overflow occurred while computing the result.
10630(In fact, it could report an underflow even though the final result
10631would have overflowed!)
10632
10633If a rational number and a float are mixed in a calculation, the result
10634will in general be expressed as a float. Commands that require an integer
10635value (such as @kbd{k g} [@code{gcd}]) will also accept integer-valued
10636floats, i.e., floating-point numbers with nothing after the decimal point.
10637
10638Floats are identified by the presence of a decimal point and/or an
10639exponent. In general a float consists of an optional sign, digits
10640including an optional decimal point, and an optional exponent consisting
10641of an @samp{e}, an optional sign, and up to seven exponent digits.
10642For example, @samp{23.5e-2} is 23.5 times ten to the minus-second power,
10643or 0.235.
10644
10645Floating-point numbers are normally displayed in decimal notation with
10646all significant figures shown. Exceedingly large or small numbers are
10647displayed in scientific notation. Various other display options are
10648available. @xref{Float Formats}.
10649
10650@cindex Accuracy of calculations
10651Floating-point numbers are stored in decimal, not binary. The result
10652of each operation is rounded to the nearest value representable in the
10653number of significant digits specified by the current precision,
10654rounding away from zero in the case of a tie. Thus (in the default
10655display mode) what you see is exactly what you get. Some operations such
10656as square roots and transcendental functions are performed with several
10657digits of extra precision and then rounded down, in an effort to make the
10658final result accurate to the full requested precision. However,
10659accuracy is not rigorously guaranteed. If you suspect the validity of a
10660result, try doing the same calculation in a higher precision. The
10661Calculator's arithmetic is not intended to be IEEE-conformant in any
10662way.
10663
10664While floats are always @emph{stored} in decimal, they can be entered
10665and displayed in any radix just like integers and fractions. Since a
10666float that is entered in a radix other that 10 will be converted to
10667decimal, the number that Calc stores may not be exactly the number that
10668was entered, it will be the closest decimal approximation given the
10669current precison. The notation @samp{@var{radix}#@var{ddd}.@var{ddd}}
10670is a floating-point number whose digits are in the specified radix.
10671Note that the @samp{.} is more aptly referred to as a ``radix point''
10672than as a decimal point in this case. The number @samp{8#123.4567} is
10673defined as @samp{8#1234567 * 8^-4}. If the radix is 14 or less, you can
10674use @samp{e} notation to write a non-decimal number in scientific
10675notation. The exponent is written in decimal, and is considered to be a
10676power of the radix: @samp{8#1234567e-4}. If the radix is 15 or above,
10677the letter @samp{e} is a digit, so scientific notation must be written
10678out, e.g., @samp{16#123.4567*16^2}. The first two exercises of the
10679Modes Tutorial explore some of the properties of non-decimal floats.
10680
10681@node Complex Numbers, Infinities, Floats, Data Types
10682@section Complex Numbers
10683
10684@noindent
10685@cindex Complex numbers
10686There are two supported formats for complex numbers: rectangular and
10687polar. The default format is rectangular, displayed in the form
10688@samp{(@var{real},@var{imag})} where @var{real} is the real part and
10689@var{imag} is the imaginary part, each of which may be any real number.
10690Rectangular complex numbers can also be displayed in @samp{@var{a}+@var{b}i}
10691notation; @pxref{Complex Formats}.
10692
10693Polar complex numbers are displayed in the form
10694@texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'
10695@infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'
10696where @var{r} is the nonnegative magnitude and
10697@texline @math{\theta}
10698@infoline @var{theta}
10699is the argument or phase angle. The range of
10700@texline @math{\theta}
10701@infoline @var{theta}
10702depends on the current angular mode (@pxref{Angular Modes}); it is
10703generally between @mathit{-180} and @mathit{+180} degrees or the equivalent range
10704in radians.
10705
10706Complex numbers are entered in stages using incomplete objects.
10707@xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10708
10709Operations on rectangular complex numbers yield rectangular complex
10710results, and similarly for polar complex numbers. Where the two types
10711are mixed, or where new complex numbers arise (as for the square root of
10712a negative real), the current @dfn{Polar mode} is used to determine the
10713type. @xref{Polar Mode}.
10714
10715A complex result in which the imaginary part is zero (or the phase angle
10716is 0 or 180 degrees or @cpi{} radians) is automatically converted to a real
10717number.
10718
10719@node Infinities, Vectors and Matrices, Complex Numbers, Data Types
10720@section Infinities
10721
10722@noindent
10723@cindex Infinity
10724@cindex @code{inf} variable
10725@cindex @code{uinf} variable
10726@cindex @code{nan} variable
10727@vindex inf
10728@vindex uinf
10729@vindex nan
10730The word @code{inf} represents the mathematical concept of @dfn{infinity}.
10731Calc actually has three slightly different infinity-like values:
10732@code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan}. These are just regular
10733variable names (@pxref{Variables}); you should avoid using these
10734names for your own variables because Calc gives them special
10735treatment. Infinities, like all variable names, are normally
10736entered using algebraic entry.
10737
10738Mathematically speaking, it is not rigorously correct to treat
10739``infinity'' as if it were a number, but mathematicians often do
10740so informally. When they say that @samp{1 / inf = 0}, what they
10741really mean is that @expr{1 / x}, as @expr{x} becomes larger and
10742larger, becomes arbitrarily close to zero. So you can imagine
10743that if @expr{x} got ``all the way to infinity,'' then @expr{1 / x}
10744would go all the way to zero. Similarly, when they say that
10745@samp{exp(inf) = inf}, they mean that
10746@texline @math{e^x}
10747@infoline @expr{exp(x)}
10748grows without bound as @expr{x} grows. The symbol @samp{-inf} likewise
10749stands for an infinitely negative real value; for example, we say that
10750@samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. You can have an infinity pointing in any
10751direction on the complex plane: @samp{sqrt(-inf) = i inf}.
10752
10753The same concept of limits can be used to define @expr{1 / 0}. We
10754really want the value that @expr{1 / x} approaches as @expr{x}
10755approaches zero. But if all we have is @expr{1 / 0}, we can't
10756tell which direction @expr{x} was coming from. If @expr{x} was
10757positive and decreasing toward zero, then we should say that
10758@samp{1 / 0 = inf}. But if @expr{x} was negative and increasing
10759toward zero, the answer is @samp{1 / 0 = -inf}. In fact, @expr{x}
10760could be an imaginary number, giving the answer @samp{i inf} or
10761@samp{-i inf}. Calc uses the special symbol @samp{uinf} to mean
10762@dfn{undirected infinity}, i.e., a value which is infinitely
10763large but with an unknown sign (or direction on the complex plane).
10764
10765Calc actually has three modes that say how infinities are handled.
10766Normally, infinities never arise from calculations that didn't
10767already have them. Thus, @expr{1 / 0} is treated simply as an
10768error and left unevaluated. The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode})
10769command (@pxref{Infinite Mode}) enables a mode in which
10770@expr{1 / 0} evaluates to @code{uinf} instead. There is also
10771an alternative type of infinite mode which says to treat zeros
10772as if they were positive, so that @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. While this
10773is less mathematically correct, it may be the answer you want in
10774some cases.
10775
10776Since all infinities are ``as large'' as all others, Calc simplifies,
10777e.g., @samp{5 inf} to @samp{inf}. Another example is
10778@samp{5 - inf = -inf}, where the @samp{-inf} is so large that
10779adding a finite number like five to it does not affect it.
10780Note that @samp{a - inf} also results in @samp{-inf}; Calc assumes
10781that variables like @code{a} always stand for finite quantities.
10782Just to show that infinities really are all the same size,
10783note that @samp{sqrt(inf) = inf^2 = exp(inf) = inf} in Calc's
10784notation.
10785
10786It's not so easy to define certain formulas like @samp{0 * inf} and
10787@samp{inf / inf}. Depending on where these zeros and infinities
10788came from, the answer could be literally anything. The latter
10789formula could be the limit of @expr{x / x} (giving a result of one),
10790or @expr{2 x / x} (giving two), or @expr{x^2 / x} (giving @code{inf}),
10791or @expr{x / x^2} (giving zero). Calc uses the symbol @code{nan}
10792to represent such an @dfn{indeterminate} value. (The name ``nan''
10793comes from analogy with the ``NAN'' concept of IEEE standard
10794arithmetic; it stands for ``Not A Number.'' This is somewhat of a
10795misnomer, since @code{nan} @emph{does} stand for some number or
10796infinity, it's just that @emph{which} number it stands for
10797cannot be determined.) In Calc's notation, @samp{0 * inf = nan}
10798and @samp{inf / inf = nan}. A few other common indeterminate
10799expressions are @samp{inf - inf} and @samp{inf ^ 0}. Also,
10800@samp{0 / 0 = nan} if you have turned on Infinite mode
10801(as described above).
10802
10803Infinities are especially useful as parts of @dfn{intervals}.
10804@xref{Interval Forms}.
10805
10806@node Vectors and Matrices, Strings, Infinities, Data Types
10807@section Vectors and Matrices
10808
10809@noindent
10810@cindex Vectors
10811@cindex Plain vectors
10812@cindex Matrices
10813The @dfn{vector} data type is flexible and general. A vector is simply a
10814list of zero or more data objects. When these objects are numbers, the
10815whole is a vector in the mathematical sense. When these objects are
10816themselves vectors of equal (nonzero) length, the whole is a @dfn{matrix}.
10817A vector which is not a matrix is referred to here as a @dfn{plain vector}.
10818
10819A vector is displayed as a list of values separated by commas and enclosed
10820in square brackets: @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Thus the following is a 2 row by
108213 column matrix: @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}. Vectors, like complex
10822numbers, are entered as incomplete objects. @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10823During algebraic entry, vectors are entered all at once in the usual
10824brackets-and-commas form. Matrices may be entered algebraically as nested
10825vectors, or using the shortcut notation @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3; 4, 5, 6]}},
10826with rows separated by semicolons. The commas may usually be omitted
10827when entering vectors: @samp{[1 2 3]}. Curly braces may be used in
10828place of brackets: @samp{@{1, 2, 3@}}, but the commas are required in
10829this case.
10830
10831Traditional vector and matrix arithmetic is also supported;
10832@pxref{Basic Arithmetic} and @pxref{Matrix Functions}.
10833Many other operations are applied to vectors element-wise. For example,
10834the complex conjugate of a vector is a vector of the complex conjugates
10835of its elements.
10836
10837@ignore
10838@starindex
10839@end ignore
10840@tindex vec
10841Algebraic functions for building vectors include @samp{vec(a, b, c)}
10842to build @samp{[a, b, c]}, @samp{cvec(a, n, m)} to build an
10843@texline @math{n\times m}
10844@infoline @var{n}x@var{m}
10845matrix of @samp{a}s, and @samp{index(n)} to build a vector of integers
10846from 1 to @samp{n}.
10847
10848@node Strings, HMS Forms, Vectors and Matrices, Data Types
10849@section Strings
10850
10851@noindent
10852@kindex "
10853@cindex Strings
10854@cindex Character strings
10855Character strings are not a special data type in the Calculator.
10856Rather, a string is represented simply as a vector all of whose
10857elements are integers in the range 0 to 255 (ASCII codes). You can
10858enter a string at any time by pressing the @kbd{"} key. Quotation
10859marks and backslashes are written @samp{\"} and @samp{\\}, respectively,
10860inside strings. Other notations introduced by backslashes are:
10861
10862@example
10863@group
10864\a 7 \^@@ 0
10865\b 8 \^a-z 1-26
10866\e 27 \^[ 27
10867\f 12 \^\\ 28
10868\n 10 \^] 29
10869\r 13 \^^ 30
10870\t 9 \^_ 31
10871 \^? 127
10872@end group
10873@end example
10874
10875@noindent
10876Finally, a backslash followed by three octal digits produces any
10877character from its ASCII code.
10878
10879@kindex d "
10880@pindex calc-display-strings
10881Strings are normally displayed in vector-of-integers form. The
10882@w{@kbd{d "}} (@code{calc-display-strings}) command toggles a mode in
10883which any vectors of small integers are displayed as quoted strings
10884instead.
10885
10886The backslash notations shown above are also used for displaying
10887strings. Characters 128 and above are not translated by Calc; unless
10888you have an Emacs modified for 8-bit fonts, these will show up in
10889backslash-octal-digits notation. For characters below 32, and
10890for character 127, Calc uses the backslash-letter combination if
10891there is one, or otherwise uses a @samp{\^} sequence.
10892
10893The only Calc feature that uses strings is @dfn{compositions};
10894@pxref{Compositions}. Strings also provide a convenient
10895way to do conversions between ASCII characters and integers.
10896
10897@ignore
10898@starindex
10899@end ignore
10900@tindex string
10901There is a @code{string} function which provides a different display
10902format for strings. Basically, @samp{string(@var{s})}, where @var{s}
10903is a vector of integers in the proper range, is displayed as the
10904corresponding string of characters with no surrounding quotation
10905marks or other modifications. Thus @samp{string("ABC")} (or
10906@samp{string([65 66 67])}) will look like @samp{ABC} on the stack.
10907This happens regardless of whether @w{@kbd{d "}} has been used. The
10908only way to turn it off is to use @kbd{d U} (unformatted language
10909mode) which will display @samp{string("ABC")} instead.
10910
10911Control characters are displayed somewhat differently by @code{string}.
10912Characters below 32, and character 127, are shown using @samp{^} notation
10913(same as shown above, but without the backslash). The quote and
10914backslash characters are left alone, as are characters 128 and above.
10915
10916@ignore
10917@starindex
10918@end ignore
10919@tindex bstring
10920The @code{bstring} function is just like @code{string} except that
10921the resulting string is breakable across multiple lines if it doesn't
10922fit all on one line. Potential break points occur at every space
10923character in the string.
10924
10925@node HMS Forms, Date Forms, Strings, Data Types
10926@section HMS Forms
10927
10928@noindent
10929@cindex Hours-minutes-seconds forms
10930@cindex Degrees-minutes-seconds forms
10931@dfn{HMS} stands for Hours-Minutes-Seconds; when used as an angular
10932argument, the interpretation is Degrees-Minutes-Seconds. All functions
10933that operate on angles accept HMS forms. These are interpreted as
10934degrees regardless of the current angular mode. It is also possible to
10935use HMS as the angular mode so that calculated angles are expressed in
10936degrees, minutes, and seconds.
10937
10938@kindex @@
10939@ignore
10940@mindex @null
10941@end ignore
10942@kindex ' (HMS forms)
10943@ignore
10944@mindex @null
10945@end ignore
10946@kindex " (HMS forms)
10947@ignore
10948@mindex @null
10949@end ignore
10950@kindex h (HMS forms)
10951@ignore
10952@mindex @null
10953@end ignore
10954@kindex o (HMS forms)
10955@ignore
10956@mindex @null
10957@end ignore
10958@kindex m (HMS forms)
10959@ignore
10960@mindex @null
10961@end ignore
10962@kindex s (HMS forms)
10963The default format for HMS values is
10964@samp{@var{hours}@@ @var{mins}' @var{secs}"}. During entry, the letters
10965@samp{h} (for ``hours'') or
10966@samp{o} (approximating the ``degrees'' symbol) are accepted as well as
10967@samp{@@}, @samp{m} is accepted in place of @samp{'}, and @samp{s} is
10968accepted in place of @samp{"}.
10969The @var{hours} value is an integer (or integer-valued float).
10970The @var{mins} value is an integer or integer-valued float between 0 and 59.
10971The @var{secs} value is a real number between 0 (inclusive) and 60
10972(exclusive). A positive HMS form is interpreted as @var{hours} +
10973@var{mins}/60 + @var{secs}/3600. A negative HMS form is interpreted
10974as @mathit{- @var{hours}} @mathit{-} @var{mins}/60 @mathit{-} @var{secs}/3600.
10975Display format for HMS forms is quite flexible. @xref{HMS Formats}.
10976
10977HMS forms can be added and subtracted. When they are added to numbers,
10978the numbers are interpreted according to the current angular mode. HMS
10979forms can also be multiplied and divided by real numbers. Dividing
10980two HMS forms produces a real-valued ratio of the two angles.
10981
10982@pindex calc-time
10983@cindex Time of day
10984Just for kicks, @kbd{M-x calc-time} pushes the current time of day on
10985the stack as an HMS form.
10986
10987@node Date Forms, Modulo Forms, HMS Forms, Data Types
10988@section Date Forms
10989
10990@noindent
10991@cindex Date forms
10992A @dfn{date form} represents a date and possibly an associated time.
10993Simple date arithmetic is supported: Adding a number to a date
10994produces a new date shifted by that many days; adding an HMS form to
10995a date shifts it by that many hours. Subtracting two date forms
10996computes the number of days between them (represented as a simple
10997number). Many other operations, such as multiplying two date forms,
10998are nonsensical and are not allowed by Calc.
10999
11000Date forms are entered and displayed enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets.
11001The default format is, e.g., @samp{<Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates,
11002or @samp{<3:32:20pm Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates with times.
11003Input is flexible; date forms can be entered in any of the usual
11004notations for dates and times. @xref{Date Formats}.
11005
11006Date forms are stored internally as numbers, specifically the number
11007of days since midnight on the morning of January 1 of the year 1 AD.
11008If the internal number is an integer, the form represents a date only;
11009if the internal number is a fraction or float, the form represents
11010a date and time. For example, @samp{<6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991>}
11011is represented by the number 726842.25. The standard precision of
1101212 decimal digits is enough to ensure that a (reasonable) date and
11013time can be stored without roundoff error.
11014
11015If the current precision is greater than 12, date forms will keep
11016additional digits in the seconds position. For example, if the
11017precision is 15, the seconds will keep three digits after the
11018decimal point. Decreasing the precision below 12 may cause the
11019time part of a date form to become inaccurate. This can also happen
11020if astronomically high years are used, though this will not be an
11021issue in everyday (or even everymillennium) use. Note that date
11022forms without times are stored as exact integers, so roundoff is
11023never an issue for them.
11024
11025You can use the @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) and @kbd{v u}
11026(@code{calc-unpack}) commands to get at the numerical representation
11027of a date form. @xref{Packing and Unpacking}.
11028
11029Date forms can go arbitrarily far into the future or past. Negative
11030year numbers represent years BC. Calc uses a combination of the
11031Gregorian and Julian calendars, following the history of Great
11032Britain and the British colonies. This is the same calendar that
11033is used by the @code{cal} program in most Unix implementations.
11034
11035@cindex Julian calendar
11036@cindex Gregorian calendar
11037Some historical background: The Julian calendar was created by
11038Julius Caesar in the year 46 BC as an attempt to fix the gradual
11039drift caused by the lack of leap years in the calendar used
11040until that time. The Julian calendar introduced an extra day in
11041all years divisible by four. After some initial confusion, the
11042calendar was adopted around the year we call 8 AD. Some centuries
11043later it became apparent that the Julian year of 365.25 days was
11044itself not quite right. In 1582 Pope Gregory XIII introduced the
11045Gregorian calendar, which added the new rule that years divisible
11046by 100, but not by 400, were not to be considered leap years
11047despite being divisible by four. Many countries delayed adoption
11048of the Gregorian calendar because of religious differences;
11049in Britain it was put off until the year 1752, by which time
11050the Julian calendar had fallen eleven days behind the true
11051seasons. So the switch to the Gregorian calendar in early
11052September 1752 introduced a discontinuity: The day after
11053Sep 2, 1752 is Sep 14, 1752. Calc follows this convention.
11054To take another example, Russia waited until 1918 before
11055adopting the new calendar, and thus needed to remove thirteen
11056days (between Feb 1, 1918 and Feb 14, 1918). This means that
11057Calc's reckoning will be inconsistent with Russian history between
110581752 and 1918, and similarly for various other countries.
11059
11060Today's timekeepers introduce an occasional ``leap second'' as
11061well, but Calc does not take these minor effects into account.
11062(If it did, it would have to report a non-integer number of days
11063between, say, @samp{<12:00am Mon Jan 1, 1900>} and
11064@samp{<12:00am Sat Jan 1, 2000>}.)
11065
11066Calc uses the Julian calendar for all dates before the year 1752,
11067including dates BC when the Julian calendar technically had not
11068yet been invented. Thus the claim that day number @mathit{-10000} is
11069called ``August 16, 28 BC'' should be taken with a grain of salt.
11070
11071Please note that there is no ``year 0''; the day before
11072@samp{<Sat Jan 1, +1>} is @samp{<Fri Dec 31, -1>}. These are
11073days 0 and @mathit{-1} respectively in Calc's internal numbering scheme.
11074
11075@cindex Julian day counting
7c1a0036 11076Another day counting system in common use is, confusingly, also called
4c39f404
CY
11077``Julian.'' The Julian day number is the numbers of days since
1107812:00 noon (GMT) on Jan 1, 4713 BC, which in Calc's scheme (in GMT)
db78a8cb 11079is @mathit{-1721423.5} (recall that Calc starts at midnight instead
7c1a0036
GM
11080of noon). Thus to convert a Calc date code obtained by unpacking a
11081date form into a Julian day number, simply add 1721423.5 after
11082compensating for the time zone difference. The built-in @kbd{t J}
11083command performs this conversion for you.
11084
4c39f404 11085The Julian day number is based on the Julian cycle, which was invented
7c1a0036 11086in 1583 by Joseph Justus Scaliger. Scaliger named it the Julian cycle
4c39f404 11087since it involves the Julian calendar, but some have suggested that
7c1a0036 11088Scaliger named it in honor of his father, Julius Caesar Scaliger. The
4c39f404
CY
11089Julian cycle is based on three other cycles: the indiction cycle, the
11090Metonic cycle, and the solar cycle. The indiction cycle is a 15 year
11091cycle originally used by the Romans for tax purposes but later used to
11092date medieval documents. The Metonic cycle is a 19 year cycle; 19
11093years is close to being a common multiple of a solar year and a lunar
11094month, and so every 19 years the phases of the moon will occur on the
11095same days of the year. The solar cycle is a 28 year cycle; the Julian
11096calendar repeats itself every 28 years. The smallest time period
11097which contains multiples of all three cycles is the least common
11098multiple of 15 years, 19 years and 28 years, which (since they're
11099pairwise relatively prime) is
7c1a0036
GM
11100@texline @math{15\times 19\times 28 = 7980} years.
11101@infoline 15*19*28 = 7980 years.
11102This is the length of a Julian cycle. Working backwards, the previous
11103year in which all three cycles began was 4713 BC, and so Scalinger
11104chose that year as the beginning of a Julian cycle. Since at the time
11105there were no historical records from before 4713 BC, using this year
11106as a starting point had the advantage of avoiding negative year
11107numbers. In 1849, the astronomer John Herschel (son of William
11108Herschel) suggested using the number of days since the beginning of
11109the Julian cycle as an astronomical dating system; this idea was taken
11110up by other astronomers. (At the time, noon was the start of the
11111astronomical day. Herschel originally suggested counting the days
11112since Jan 1, 4713 BC at noon Alexandria time; this was later amended to
11113noon GMT.) Julian day numbering is largely used in astronomy.
4009494e
GM
11114
11115@cindex Unix time format
11116The Unix operating system measures time as an integer number of
11117seconds since midnight, Jan 1, 1970. To convert a Calc date
11118value into a Unix time stamp, first subtract 719164 (the code
11119for @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}), then multiply by 86400 (the number of
11120seconds in a day) and press @kbd{R} to round to the nearest
11121integer. If you have a date form, you can simply subtract the
11122day @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>} instead of unpacking and subtracting
11123719164. Likewise, divide by 86400 and add @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}
11124to convert from Unix time to a Calc date form. (Note that
11125Unix normally maintains the time in the GMT time zone; you may
11126need to subtract five hours to get New York time, or eight hours
11127for California time. The same is usually true of Julian day
11128counts.) The built-in @kbd{t U} command performs these
11129conversions.
11130
11131@node Modulo Forms, Error Forms, Date Forms, Data Types
11132@section Modulo Forms
11133
11134@noindent
11135@cindex Modulo forms
11136A @dfn{modulo form} is a real number which is taken modulo (i.e., within
11137an integer multiple of) some value @var{M}. Arithmetic modulo @var{M}
11138often arises in number theory. Modulo forms are written
11139`@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}',
11140where @var{a} and @var{M} are real numbers or HMS forms, and
11141@texline @math{0 \le a < M}.
11142@infoline @expr{0 <= a < @var{M}}.
11143In many applications @expr{a} and @expr{M} will be
11144integers but this is not required.
11145
11146@ignore
11147@mindex M
11148@end ignore
11149@kindex M (modulo forms)
11150@ignore
11151@mindex mod
11152@end ignore
11153@tindex mod (operator)
11154To create a modulo form during numeric entry, press the shift-@kbd{M}
11155key to enter the word @samp{mod}. As a special convenience, pressing
11156shift-@kbd{M} a second time automatically enters the value of @expr{M}
11157that was most recently used before. During algebraic entry, either
11158type @samp{mod} by hand or press @kbd{M-m} (that's @kbd{@key{META}-m}).
11159Once again, pressing this a second time enters the current modulo.
11160
11161Modulo forms are not to be confused with the modulo operator @samp{%}.
11162The expression @samp{27 % 10} means to compute 27 modulo 10 to produce
11163the result 7. Further computations treat this 7 as just a regular integer.
11164The expression @samp{27 mod 10} produces the result @samp{7 mod 10};
11165further computations with this value are again reduced modulo 10 so that
11166the result always lies in the desired range.
11167
11168When two modulo forms with identical @expr{M}'s are added or multiplied,
11169the Calculator simply adds or multiplies the values, then reduces modulo
11170@expr{M}. If one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number,
11171the plain number is treated like a compatible modulo form. It is also
11172possible to raise modulo forms to powers; the result is the value raised
11173to the power, then reduced modulo @expr{M}. (When all values involved
11174are integers, this calculation is done much more efficiently than
11175actually computing the power and then reducing.)
11176
11177@cindex Modulo division
11178Two modulo forms `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}' and `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'
11179can be divided if @expr{a}, @expr{b}, and @expr{M} are all
11180integers. The result is the modulo form which, when multiplied by
11181`@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}', produces `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'. If
11182there is no solution to this equation (which can happen only when
11183@expr{M} is non-prime), or if any of the arguments are non-integers, the
11184division is left in symbolic form. Other operations, such as square
11185roots, are not yet supported for modulo forms. (Note that, although
11186@w{`@tfn{(}@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}@tfn{)^.5}'} will compute a ``modulo square root''
11187in the sense of reducing
11188@texline @math{\sqrt a}
11189@infoline @expr{sqrt(a)}
11190modulo @expr{M}, this is not a useful definition from the
11191number-theoretical point of view.)
11192
11193It is possible to mix HMS forms and modulo forms. For example, an
11194HMS form modulo 24 could be used to manipulate clock times; an HMS
11195form modulo 360 would be suitable for angles. Making the modulo @expr{M}
11196also be an HMS form eliminates troubles that would arise if the angular
11197mode were inadvertently set to Radians, in which case
11198@w{@samp{2@@ 0' 0" mod 24}} would be interpreted as two degrees modulo
1119924 radians!
11200
11201Modulo forms cannot have variables or formulas for components. If you
11202enter the formula @samp{(x + 2) mod 5}, Calc propagates the modulus
11203to each of the coefficients: @samp{(1 mod 5) x + (2 mod 5)}.
11204
11205You can use @kbd{v p} and @kbd{%} to modify modulo forms.
11206@xref{Packing and Unpacking}. @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
11207
11208@ignore
11209@starindex
11210@end ignore
11211@tindex makemod
11212The algebraic function @samp{makemod(a, m)} builds the modulo form
11213@w{@samp{a mod m}}.
11214
11215@node Error Forms, Interval Forms, Modulo Forms, Data Types
11216@section Error Forms
11217
11218@noindent
11219@cindex Error forms
11220@cindex Standard deviations
11221An @dfn{error form} is a number with an associated standard
11222deviation, as in @samp{2.3 +/- 0.12}. The notation
11223@texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11224@infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} sigma'
11225stands for an uncertain value which follows
11226a normal or Gaussian distribution of mean @expr{x} and standard
11227deviation or ``error''
11228@texline @math{\sigma}.
11229@infoline @expr{sigma}.
11230Both the mean and the error can be either numbers or
11231formulas. Generally these are real numbers but the mean may also be
11232complex. If the error is negative or complex, it is changed to its
11233absolute value. An error form with zero error is converted to a
11234regular number by the Calculator.
11235
11236All arithmetic and transcendental functions accept error forms as input.
11237Operations on the mean-value part work just like operations on regular
11238numbers. The error part for any function @expr{f(x)} (such as
11239@texline @math{\sin x}
11240@infoline @expr{sin(x)})
11241is defined by the error of @expr{x} times the derivative of @expr{f}
11242evaluated at the mean value of @expr{x}. For a two-argument function
11243@expr{f(x,y)} (such as addition) the error is the square root of the sum
11244of the squares of the errors due to @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
11245@tex
11246$$ \eqalign{
11247 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma)
11248 &= f(x) \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma \left| {df(x) \over dx} \right| \cr
11249 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_x, y \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_y)
11250 &= f(x,y) \hbox{\code{ +/- }}
11251 \sqrt{\left(\sigma_x \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial x}
11252 \right| \right)^2
11253 +\left(\sigma_y \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial y}
11254 \right| \right)^2 } \cr
11255} $$
11256@end tex
11257Note that this
11258definition assumes the errors in @expr{x} and @expr{y} are uncorrelated.
11259A side effect of this definition is that @samp{(2 +/- 1) * (2 +/- 1)}
11260is not the same as @samp{(2 +/- 1)^2}; the former represents the product
11261of two independent values which happen to have the same probability
11262distributions, and the latter is the product of one random value with itself.
11263The former will produce an answer with less error, since on the average
11264the two independent errors can be expected to cancel out.
11265
11266Consult a good text on error analysis for a discussion of the proper use
11267of standard deviations. Actual errors often are neither Gaussian-distributed
11268nor uncorrelated, and the above formulas are valid only when errors
11269are small. As an example, the error arising from
11270@texline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}@tfn{)}'
11271@infoline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}@tfn{)}'
11272is
11273@texline `@math{\sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11274@infoline `@var{sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11275When @expr{x} is close to zero,
11276@texline @math{\cos x}
11277@infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11278is close to one so the error in the sine is close to
11279@texline @math{\sigma};
11280@infoline @expr{sigma};
11281this makes sense, since
11282@texline @math{\sin x}
11283@infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11284is approximately @expr{x} near zero, so a given error in @expr{x} will
11285produce about the same error in the sine. Likewise, near 90 degrees
11286@texline @math{\cos x}
11287@infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11288is nearly zero and so the computed error is
11289small: The sine curve is nearly flat in that region, so an error in @expr{x}
11290has relatively little effect on the value of
11291@texline @math{\sin x}.
11292@infoline @expr{sin(x)}.
11293However, consider @samp{sin(90 +/- 1000)}. The cosine of 90 is zero, so
11294Calc will report zero error! We get an obviously wrong result because
11295we have violated the small-error approximation underlying the error
11296analysis. If the error in @expr{x} had been small, the error in
11297@texline @math{\sin x}
11298@infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11299would indeed have been negligible.
11300
11301@ignore
11302@mindex p
11303@end ignore
11304@kindex p (error forms)
11305@tindex +/-
11306To enter an error form during regular numeric entry, use the @kbd{p}
11307(``plus-or-minus'') key to type the @samp{+/-} symbol. (If you try actually
11308typing @samp{+/-} the @kbd{+} key will be interpreted as the Calculator's
11309@kbd{+} command!) Within an algebraic formula, you can press @kbd{M-+} to
11310type the @samp{+/-} symbol, or type it out by hand.
11311
11312Error forms and complex numbers can be mixed; the formulas shown above
11313are used for complex numbers, too; note that if the error part evaluates
11314to a complex number its absolute value (or the square root of the sum of
11315the squares of the absolute values of the two error contributions) is
11316used. Mathematically, this corresponds to a radially symmetric Gaussian
11317distribution of numbers on the complex plane. However, note that Calc
11318considers an error form with real components to represent a real number,
11319not a complex distribution around a real mean.
11320
11321Error forms may also be composed of HMS forms. For best results, both
11322the mean and the error should be HMS forms if either one is.
11323
11324@ignore
11325@starindex
11326@end ignore
11327@tindex sdev
11328The algebraic function @samp{sdev(a, b)} builds the error form @samp{a +/- b}.
11329
11330@node Interval Forms, Incomplete Objects, Error Forms, Data Types
11331@section Interval Forms
11332
11333@noindent
11334@cindex Interval forms
11335An @dfn{interval} is a subset of consecutive real numbers. For example,
11336the interval @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} represents all the numbers from 2 to 4,
11337inclusive. If you multiply it by the interval @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]} you
11338obtain @samp{[1 ..@: 8]}. This calculation represents the fact that if
11339you multiply some number in the range @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} by some other
11340number in the range @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]}, your result will lie in the range
11341from 1 to 8. Interval arithmetic is used to get a worst-case estimate
11342of the possible range of values a computation will produce, given the
11343set of possible values of the input.
11344
11345@ifnottex
11346Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including @dfn{closed}
11347intervals of the type shown above, @dfn{open} intervals such as
11348@samp{(2 ..@: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11349@emph{exclusive}, and @dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11350uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11351terms,
11352@samp{[2 ..@: 4]} means @expr{2 <= x <= 4}, whereas
11353@samp{[2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 <= x < 4},
11354@samp{(2 ..@: 4]} represents @expr{2 < x <= 4}, and
11355@samp{(2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 < x < 4}.
11356@end ifnottex
11357@tex
11358Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including \dfn{closed}
11359intervals of the type shown above, \dfn{open} intervals such as
11360\samp{(2 ..\: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11361\emph{exclusive}, and \dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11362uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11363terms,
11364$$ \eqalign{
11365 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x \le 4 \cr
11366 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x < 4 \cr
11367 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x \le 4 \cr
11368 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x < 4 \cr
11369} $$
11370@end tex
11371
11372The lower and upper limits of an interval must be either real numbers
11373(or HMS or date forms), or symbolic expressions which are assumed to be
11374real-valued, or @samp{-inf} and @samp{inf}. In general the lower limit
11375must be less than the upper limit. A closed interval containing only
11376one value, @samp{[3 ..@: 3]}, is converted to a plain number (3)
11377automatically. An interval containing no values at all (such as
11378@samp{[3 ..@: 2]} or @samp{[2 ..@: 2)}) can be represented but is not
11379guaranteed to behave well when used in arithmetic. Note that the
11380interval @samp{[3 .. inf)} represents all real numbers greater than
11381or equal to 3, and @samp{(-inf .. inf)} represents all real numbers.
11382In fact, @samp{[-inf .. inf]} represents all real numbers including
11383the real infinities.
11384
11385Intervals are entered in the notation shown here, either as algebraic
11386formulas, or using incomplete forms. (@xref{Incomplete Objects}.)
11387In algebraic formulas, multiple periods in a row are collected from
11388left to right, so that @samp{1...1e2} is interpreted as @samp{1.0 ..@: 1e2}
11389rather than @samp{1 ..@: 0.1e2}. Add spaces or zeros if you want to
11390get the other interpretation. If you omit the lower or upper limit,
11391a default of @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} (respectively) is furnished.
11392
11393Infinite mode also affects operations on intervals
11394(@pxref{Infinities}). Calc will always introduce an open infinity,
11395as in @samp{1 / (0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf)}. But closed infinities,
11396@w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf]}}, arise only in Infinite mode;
11397otherwise they are left unevaluated. Note that the ``direction'' of
11398a zero is not an issue in this case since the zero is always assumed
11399to be continuous with the rest of the interval. For intervals that
11400contain zero inside them Calc is forced to give the result,
11401@samp{1 / (-2 .. 2) = [-inf .. inf]}.
11402
11403While it may seem that intervals and error forms are similar, they are
11404based on entirely different concepts of inexact quantities. An error
11405form
11406@texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11407@infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}'
11408means a variable is random, and its value could
11409be anything but is ``probably'' within one
11410@texline @math{\sigma}
11411@infoline @var{sigma}
11412of the mean value @expr{x}. An interval
11413`@tfn{[}@var{a} @tfn{..@:} @var{b}@tfn{]}' means a
11414variable's value is unknown, but guaranteed to lie in the specified
11415range. Error forms are statistical or ``average case'' approximations;
11416interval arithmetic tends to produce ``worst case'' bounds on an
11417answer.
11418
11419Intervals may not contain complex numbers, but they may contain
11420HMS forms or date forms.
11421
11422@xref{Set Operations}, for commands that interpret interval forms
11423as subsets of the set of real numbers.
11424
11425@ignore
11426@starindex
11427@end ignore
11428@tindex intv
11429The algebraic function @samp{intv(n, a, b)} builds an interval form
11430from @samp{a} to @samp{b}; @samp{n} is an integer code which must
11431be 0 for @samp{(..)}, 1 for @samp{(..]}, 2 for @samp{[..)}, or
114323 for @samp{[..]}.
11433
11434Please note that in fully rigorous interval arithmetic, care would be
11435taken to make sure that the computation of the lower bound rounds toward
11436minus infinity, while upper bound computations round toward plus
11437infinity. Calc's arithmetic always uses a round-to-nearest mode,
11438which means that roundoff errors could creep into an interval
11439calculation to produce intervals slightly smaller than they ought to
11440be. For example, entering @samp{[1..2]} and pressing @kbd{Q 2 ^}
11441should yield the interval @samp{[1..2]} again, but in fact it yields the
11442(slightly too small) interval @samp{[1..1.9999999]} due to roundoff
11443error.
11444
11445@node Incomplete Objects, Variables, Interval Forms, Data Types
11446@section Incomplete Objects
11447
11448@noindent
11449@ignore
11450@mindex [ ]
11451@end ignore
11452@kindex [
11453@ignore
11454@mindex ( )
11455@end ignore
11456@kindex (
11457@kindex ,
11458@ignore
11459@mindex @null
11460@end ignore
11461@kindex ]
11462@ignore
11463@mindex @null
11464@end ignore
11465@kindex )
11466@cindex Incomplete vectors
11467@cindex Incomplete complex numbers
11468@cindex Incomplete interval forms
11469When @kbd{(} or @kbd{[} is typed to begin entering a complex number or
11470vector, respectively, the effect is to push an @dfn{incomplete} complex
11471number or vector onto the stack. The @kbd{,} key adds the value(s) at
11472the top of the stack onto the current incomplete object. The @kbd{)}
11473and @kbd{]} keys ``close'' the incomplete object after adding any values
11474on the top of the stack in front of the incomplete object.
11475
11476As a result, the sequence of keystrokes @kbd{[ 2 , 3 @key{RET} 2 * , 9 ]}
11477pushes the vector @samp{[2, 6, 9]} onto the stack. Likewise, @kbd{( 1 , 2 Q )}
11478pushes the complex number @samp{(1, 1.414)} (approximately).
11479
11480If several values lie on the stack in front of the incomplete object,
11481all are collected and appended to the object. Thus the @kbd{,} key
11482is redundant: @kbd{[ 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 2 * 9 ]}. Some people
11483prefer the equivalent @key{SPC} key to @key{RET}.
11484
11485As a special case, typing @kbd{,} immediately after @kbd{(}, @kbd{[}, or
11486@kbd{,} adds a zero or duplicates the preceding value in the list being
11487formed. Typing @key{DEL} during incomplete entry removes the last item
11488from the list.
11489
11490@kindex ;
11491The @kbd{;} key is used in the same way as @kbd{,} to create polar complex
11492numbers: @kbd{( 1 ; 2 )}. When entering a vector, @kbd{;} is useful for
11493creating a matrix. In particular, @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ; 3 , 4 ; 5 , 6 ] ]} is
11494equivalent to @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ] , [ 3 , 4 ] , [ 5 , 6 ] ]}.
11495
11496@kindex ..
11497@pindex calc-dots
11498Incomplete entry is also used to enter intervals. For example,
11499@kbd{[ 2 ..@: 4 )} enters a semi-open interval. Note that when you type
11500the first period, it will be interpreted as a decimal point, but when
11501you type a second period immediately afterward, it is re-interpreted as
11502part of the interval symbol. Typing @kbd{..} corresponds to executing
11503the @code{calc-dots} command.
11504
11505If you find incomplete entry distracting, you may wish to enter vectors
11506and complex numbers as algebraic formulas by pressing the apostrophe key.
11507
11508@node Variables, Formulas, Incomplete Objects, Data Types
11509@section Variables
11510
11511@noindent
11512@cindex Variables, in formulas
11513A @dfn{variable} is somewhere between a storage register on a conventional
11514calculator, and a variable in a programming language. (In fact, a Calc
11515variable is really just an Emacs Lisp variable that contains a Calc number
11516or formula.) A variable's name is normally composed of letters and digits.
11517Calc also allows apostrophes and @code{#} signs in variable names.
11518(The Calc variable @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp variable
11519@code{var-foo}, but unless you access the variable from within Emacs
11520Lisp, you don't need to worry about it. Variable names in algebraic
11521formulas implicitly have @samp{var-} prefixed to their names. The
11522@samp{#} character in variable names used in algebraic formulas
11523corresponds to a dash @samp{-} in the Lisp variable name. If the name
11524contains any dashes, the prefix @samp{var-} is @emph{not} automatically
11525added. Thus the two formulas @samp{foo + 1} and @samp{var#foo + 1} both
11526refer to the same variable.)
11527
11528In a command that takes a variable name, you can either type the full
11529name of a variable, or type a single digit to use one of the special
11530convenience variables @code{q0} through @code{q9}. For example,
11531@kbd{3 s s 2} stores the number 3 in variable @code{q2}, and
11532@w{@kbd{3 s s foo @key{RET}}} stores that number in variable
11533@code{foo}.
11534
11535To push a variable itself (as opposed to the variable's value) on the
11536stack, enter its name as an algebraic expression using the apostrophe
11537(@key{'}) key.
11538
11539@kindex =
11540@pindex calc-evaluate
11541@cindex Evaluation of variables in a formula
11542@cindex Variables, evaluation
11543@cindex Formulas, evaluation
11544The @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) key ``evaluates'' a formula by
11545replacing all variables in the formula which have been given values by a
11546@code{calc-store} or @code{calc-let} command by their stored values.
11547Other variables are left alone. Thus a variable that has not been
11548stored acts like an abstract variable in algebra; a variable that has
11549been stored acts more like a register in a traditional calculator.
11550With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{=} evaluates the top
11551@var{n} stack entries; with a negative argument, @kbd{=} evaluates
11552the @var{n}th stack entry.
11553
11554@cindex @code{e} variable
11555@cindex @code{pi} variable
11556@cindex @code{i} variable
11557@cindex @code{phi} variable
11558@cindex @code{gamma} variable
11559@vindex e
11560@vindex pi
11561@vindex i
11562@vindex phi
11563@vindex gamma
11564A few variables are called @dfn{special constants}. Their names are
11565@samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi}, and @samp{gamma}.
11566(@xref{Scientific Functions}.) When they are evaluated with @kbd{=},
11567their values are calculated if necessary according to the current precision
11568or complex polar mode. If you wish to use these symbols for other purposes,
11569simply undefine or redefine them using @code{calc-store}.
11570
11571The variables @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} stand for
11572infinite or indeterminate values. It's best not to use them as
11573regular variables, since Calc uses special algebraic rules when
11574it manipulates them. Calc displays a warning message if you store
11575a value into any of these special variables.
11576
11577@xref{Store and Recall}, for a discussion of commands dealing with variables.
11578
11579@node Formulas, , Variables, Data Types
11580@section Formulas
11581
11582@noindent
11583@cindex Formulas
11584@cindex Expressions
11585@cindex Operators in formulas
11586@cindex Precedence of operators
11587When you press the apostrophe key you may enter any expression or formula
11588in algebraic form. (Calc uses the terms ``expression'' and ``formula''
11589interchangeably.) An expression is built up of numbers, variable names,
11590and function calls, combined with various arithmetic operators.
11591Parentheses may
11592be used to indicate grouping. Spaces are ignored within formulas, except
11593that spaces are not permitted within variable names or numbers.
11594Arithmetic operators, in order from highest to lowest precedence, and
11595with their equivalent function names, are:
11596
11597@samp{_} [@code{subscr}] (subscripts);
11598
11599postfix @samp{%} [@code{percent}] (as in @samp{25% = 0.25});
11600
0edd2970 11601prefix @samp{!} [@code{lnot}] (logical ``not,'' as in @samp{!x});
4009494e
GM
11602
11603@samp{+/-} [@code{sdev}] (the standard deviation symbol) and
11604@samp{mod} [@code{makemod}] (the symbol for modulo forms);
11605
11606postfix @samp{!} [@code{fact}] (factorial, as in @samp{n!})
11607and postfix @samp{!!} [@code{dfact}] (double factorial);
11608
11609@samp{^} [@code{pow}] (raised-to-the-power-of);
11610
0edd2970
JB
11611prefix @samp{+} and @samp{-} [@code{neg}] (as in @samp{-x});
11612
4009494e
GM
11613@samp{*} [@code{mul}];
11614
11615@samp{/} [@code{div}], @samp{%} [@code{mod}] (modulo), and
11616@samp{\} [@code{idiv}] (integer division);
11617
11618infix @samp{+} [@code{add}] and @samp{-} [@code{sub}] (as in @samp{x-y});
11619
11620@samp{|} [@code{vconcat}] (vector concatenation);
11621
11622relations @samp{=} [@code{eq}], @samp{!=} [@code{neq}], @samp{<} [@code{lt}],
11623@samp{>} [@code{gt}], @samp{<=} [@code{leq}], and @samp{>=} [@code{geq}];
11624
11625@samp{&&} [@code{land}] (logical ``and'');
11626
11627@samp{||} [@code{lor}] (logical ``or'');
11628
11629the C-style ``if'' operator @samp{a?b:c} [@code{if}];
11630
11631@samp{!!!} [@code{pnot}] (rewrite pattern ``not'');
11632
11633@samp{&&&} [@code{pand}] (rewrite pattern ``and'');
11634
11635@samp{|||} [@code{por}] (rewrite pattern ``or'');
11636
11637@samp{:=} [@code{assign}] (for assignments and rewrite rules);
11638
11639@samp{::} [@code{condition}] (rewrite pattern condition);
11640
11641@samp{=>} [@code{evalto}].
11642
11643Note that, unlike in usual computer notation, multiplication binds more
11644strongly than division: @samp{a*b/c*d} is equivalent to
11645@texline @math{a b \over c d}.
11646@infoline @expr{(a*b)/(c*d)}.
11647
11648@cindex Multiplication, implicit
11649@cindex Implicit multiplication
11650The multiplication sign @samp{*} may be omitted in many cases. In particular,
11651if the righthand side is a number, variable name, or parenthesized
11652expression, the @samp{*} may be omitted. Implicit multiplication has the
11653same precedence as the explicit @samp{*} operator. The one exception to
11654the rule is that a variable name followed by a parenthesized expression,
11655as in @samp{f(x)},
11656is interpreted as a function call, not an implicit @samp{*}. In many
11657cases you must use a space if you omit the @samp{*}: @samp{2a} is the
11658same as @samp{2*a}, and @samp{a b} is the same as @samp{a*b}, but @samp{ab}
11659is a variable called @code{ab}, @emph{not} the product of @samp{a} and
11660@samp{b}! Also note that @samp{f (x)} is still a function call.
11661
11662@cindex Implicit comma in vectors
11663The rules are slightly different for vectors written with square brackets.
11664In vectors, the space character is interpreted (like the comma) as a
11665separator of elements of the vector. Thus @w{@samp{[ 2a b+c d ]}} is
11666equivalent to @samp{[2*a, b+c, d]}, whereas @samp{2a b+c d} is equivalent
11667to @samp{2*a*b + c*d}.
11668Note that spaces around the brackets, and around explicit commas, are
11669ignored. To force spaces to be interpreted as multiplication you can
11670enclose a formula in parentheses as in @samp{[(a b) 2(c d)]}, which is
11671interpreted as @samp{[a*b, 2*c*d]}. An implicit comma is also inserted
11672between @samp{][}, as in the matrix @samp{[[1 2][3 4]]}.
11673
11674Vectors that contain commas (not embedded within nested parentheses or
11675brackets) do not treat spaces specially: @samp{[a b, 2 c d]} is a vector
11676of two elements. Also, if it would be an error to treat spaces as
11677separators, but not otherwise, then Calc will ignore spaces:
11678@w{@samp{[a - b]}} is a vector of one element, but @w{@samp{[a -b]}} is
11679a vector of two elements. Finally, vectors entered with curly braces
11680instead of square brackets do not give spaces any special treatment.
11681When Calc displays a vector that does not contain any commas, it will
11682insert parentheses if necessary to make the meaning clear:
11683@w{@samp{[(a b)]}}.
11684
11685The expression @samp{5%-2} is ambiguous; is this five-percent minus two,
11686or five modulo minus-two? Calc always interprets the leftmost symbol as
11687an infix operator preferentially (modulo, in this case), so you would
11688need to write @samp{(5%)-2} to get the former interpretation.
11689
11690@cindex Function call notation
11691A function call is, e.g., @samp{sin(1+x)}. (The Calc algebraic function
11692@code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp function @code{calcFunc-foo},
11693but unless you access the function from within Emacs Lisp, you don't
11694need to worry about it.) Most mathematical Calculator commands like
11695@code{calc-sin} have function equivalents like @code{sin}.
11696If no Lisp function is defined for a function called by a formula, the
11697call is left as it is during algebraic manipulation: @samp{f(x+y)} is
11698left alone. Beware that many innocent-looking short names like @code{in}
11699and @code{re} have predefined meanings which could surprise you; however,
11700single letters or single letters followed by digits are always safe to
11701use for your own function names. @xref{Function Index}.
11702
11703In the documentation for particular commands, the notation @kbd{H S}
11704(@code{calc-sinh}) [@code{sinh}] means that the key sequence @kbd{H S}, the
11705command @kbd{M-x calc-sinh}, and the algebraic function @code{sinh(x)} all
11706represent the same operation.
11707
11708Commands that interpret (``parse'') text as algebraic formulas include
11709algebraic entry (@kbd{'}), editing commands like @kbd{`} which parse
11710the contents of the editing buffer when you finish, the @kbd{C-x * g}
11711and @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} commands, the @kbd{C-y} command, the X window system
11712``paste'' mouse operation, and Embedded mode. All of these operations
11713use the same rules for parsing formulas; in particular, language modes
11714(@pxref{Language Modes}) affect them all in the same way.
11715
11716When you read a large amount of text into the Calculator (say a vector
11717which represents a big set of rewrite rules; @pxref{Rewrite Rules}),
11718you may wish to include comments in the text. Calc's formula parser
11719ignores the symbol @samp{%%} and anything following it on a line:
11720
11721@example
11722[ a + b, %% the sum of "a" and "b"
11723 c + d,
11724 %% last line is coming up:
11725 e + f ]
11726@end example
11727
11728@noindent
11729This is parsed exactly the same as @samp{[ a + b, c + d, e + f ]}.
11730
11731@xref{Syntax Tables}, for a way to create your own operators and other
11732input notations. @xref{Compositions}, for a way to create new display
11733formats.
11734
11735@xref{Algebra}, for commands for manipulating formulas symbolically.
11736
11737@node Stack and Trail, Mode Settings, Data Types, Top
11738@chapter Stack and Trail Commands
11739
11740@noindent
11741This chapter describes the Calc commands for manipulating objects on the
11742stack and in the trail buffer. (These commands operate on objects of any
11743type, such as numbers, vectors, formulas, and incomplete objects.)
11744
11745@menu
11746* Stack Manipulation::
11747* Editing Stack Entries::
11748* Trail Commands::
11749* Keep Arguments::
11750@end menu
11751
11752@node Stack Manipulation, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail, Stack and Trail
11753@section Stack Manipulation Commands
11754
11755@noindent
11756@kindex @key{RET}
11757@kindex @key{SPC}
11758@pindex calc-enter
11759@cindex Duplicating stack entries
11760To duplicate the top object on the stack, press @key{RET} or @key{SPC}
11761(two equivalent keys for the @code{calc-enter} command).
11762Given a positive numeric prefix argument, these commands duplicate
11763several elements at the top of the stack.
11764Given a negative argument,
11765these commands duplicate the specified element of the stack.
11766Given an argument of zero, they duplicate the entire stack.
11767For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11768@key{RET} creates @samp{10 20 30 30},
11769@kbd{C-u 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20 30},
11770@kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20}, and
11771@kbd{C-u 0 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 10 20 30}.
11772
11773@kindex @key{LFD}
11774@pindex calc-over
11775The @key{LFD} (@code{calc-over}) command (on a key marked Line-Feed if you
11776have it, else on @kbd{C-j}) is like @code{calc-enter}
11777except that the sign of the numeric prefix argument is interpreted
11778oppositely. Also, with no prefix argument the default argument is 2.
11779Thus with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack, @key{LFD} and @kbd{C-u 2 @key{LFD}}
11780are both equivalent to @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}}, producing
11781@samp{10 20 30 20}.
11782
11783@kindex @key{DEL}
11784@kindex C-d
11785@pindex calc-pop
11786@cindex Removing stack entries
11787@cindex Deleting stack entries
11788To remove the top element from the stack, press @key{DEL} (@code{calc-pop}).
11789The @kbd{C-d} key is a synonym for @key{DEL}.
11790(If the top element is an incomplete object with at least one element, the
11791last element is removed from it.) Given a positive numeric prefix argument,
11792several elements are removed. Given a negative argument, the specified
11793element of the stack is deleted. Given an argument of zero, the entire
11794stack is emptied.
11795For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11796@key{DEL} leaves @samp{10 20},
11797@kbd{C-u 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10},
11798@kbd{C-u - 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10 30}, and
11799@kbd{C-u 0 @key{DEL}} leaves an empty stack.
11800
11801@kindex M-@key{DEL}
11802@pindex calc-pop-above
11803The @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} (@code{calc-pop-above}) command is to @key{DEL} what
11804@key{LFD} is to @key{RET}: It interprets the sign of the numeric
11805prefix argument in the opposite way, and the default argument is 2.
11806Thus @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} by itself removes the second-from-top stack element,
11807leaving the first, third, fourth, and so on; @kbd{M-3 M-@key{DEL}} deletes
11808the third stack element.
11809
11810@kindex @key{TAB}
11811@pindex calc-roll-down
11812To exchange the top two elements of the stack, press @key{TAB}
11813(@code{calc-roll-down}). Given a positive numeric prefix argument, the
11814specified number of elements at the top of the stack are rotated downward.
11815Given a negative argument, the entire stack is rotated downward the specified
11816number of times. Given an argument of zero, the entire stack is reversed
11817top-for-bottom.
11818For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11819@key{TAB} creates @samp{10 20 30 50 40},
11820@kbd{C-u 3 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 50 30 40},
11821@kbd{C-u - 2 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{40 50 10 20 30}, and
11822@kbd{C-u 0 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11823
11824@kindex M-@key{TAB}
11825@pindex calc-roll-up
11826The command @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{calc-roll-up}) is analogous to @key{TAB}
11827except that it rotates upward instead of downward. Also, the default
11828with no prefix argument is to rotate the top 3 elements.
11829For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11830@kbd{M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 40 50 30},
11831@kbd{C-u 4 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 30 40 50 20},
11832@kbd{C-u - 2 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{30 40 50 10 20}, and
11833@kbd{C-u 0 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11834
11835A good way to view the operation of @key{TAB} and @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} is in
11836terms of moving a particular element to a new position in the stack.
11837With a positive argument @var{n}, @key{TAB} moves the top stack
11838element down to level @var{n}, making room for it by pulling all the
11839intervening stack elements toward the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} moves the
11840element at level @var{n} up to the top. (Compare with @key{LFD},
11841which copies instead of moving the element in level @var{n}.)
11842
11843With a negative argument @mathit{-@var{n}}, @key{TAB} rotates the stack
11844to move the object in level @var{n} to the deepest place in the
11845stack, and the object in level @mathit{@var{n}+1} to the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}
5a9e3ab7 11846rotates the deepest stack element to be in level @var{n}, also
4009494e
GM
11847putting the top stack element in level @mathit{@var{n}+1}.
11848
11849@xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for a way to apply these commands to
11850any portion of a vector or formula on the stack.
11851
5a9e3ab7
JB
11852@kindex C-xC-t
11853@pindex calc-transpose-lines
11854@cindex Moving stack entries
11855The command @kbd{C-x C-t} (@code{calc-transpose-lines}) will transpose
11856the stack object determined by the point with the stack object at the
11857next higher level. For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the
11858stack and the point on the line containing @samp{30}, @kbd{C-x C-t}
11859creates @samp{10 20 40 30 50}. More generally, @kbd{C-x C-t} acts on
11860the stack objects determined by the current point (and mark) similar
11861to how the text-mode command @code{transpose-lines} acts on
11862lines. With argument @var{n}, @kbd{C-x C-t} will move the stack object
11863at the level above the current point and move it past N other objects;
11864for example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack and the point on
11865the line containing @samp{30}, @kbd{C-u 2 C-x C-t} creates
11866@samp{10 40 20 30 50}. With an argument of 0, @kbd{C-x C-t} will switch
11867the stack objects at the levels determined by the point and the mark.
11868
4009494e
GM
11869@node Editing Stack Entries, Trail Commands, Stack Manipulation, Stack and Trail
11870@section Editing Stack Entries
11871
11872@noindent
11873@kindex `
11874@pindex calc-edit
11875@pindex calc-edit-finish
11876@cindex Editing the stack with Emacs
8dc6104d
JB
11877The @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command creates a temporary buffer
11878(@samp{*Calc Edit*}) for editing the top-of-stack value using regular
11879Emacs commands. Note that @kbd{`} is a backquote, not a quote. With a
11880numeric prefix argument, it edits the specified number of stack entries
11881at once. (An argument of zero edits the entire stack; a negative
11882argument edits one specific stack entry.)
4009494e
GM
11883
11884When you are done editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish and return
11885to Calc. The @key{RET} and @key{LFD} keys also work to finish most
11886sorts of editing, though in some cases Calc leaves @key{RET} with its
11887usual meaning (``insert a newline'') if it's a situation where you
11888might want to insert new lines into the editing buffer.
11889
11890When you finish editing, the Calculator parses the lines of text in
11891the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer as numbers or formulas, replaces the
11892original stack elements in the original buffer with these new values,
11893then kills the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. The original Calculator buffer
11894continues to exist during editing, but for best results you should be
11895careful not to change it until you have finished the edit. You can
11896also cancel the edit by killing the buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
11897
11898The formula is normally reevaluated as it is put onto the stack.
11899For example, editing @samp{a + 2} to @samp{3 + 2} and pressing
11900@kbd{C-c C-c} will push 5 on the stack. If you use @key{LFD} to
11901finish, Calc will put the result on the stack without evaluating it.
11902
11903If you give a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-c},
11904Calc will not kill the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. You can switch
11905back to that buffer and continue editing if you wish. However, you
11906should understand that if you initiated the edit with @kbd{`}, the
11907@kbd{C-c C-c} operation will be programmed to replace the top of the
11908stack with the new edited value, and it will do this even if you have
11909rearranged the stack in the meanwhile. This is not so much of a problem
11910with other editing commands, though, such as @kbd{s e}
11911(@code{calc-edit-variable}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}).
11912
11913If the @code{calc-edit} command involves more than one stack entry,
11914each line of the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer is interpreted as a
11915separate formula. Otherwise, the entire buffer is interpreted as
11916one formula, with line breaks ignored. (You can use @kbd{C-o} or
11917@kbd{C-q C-j} to insert a newline in the buffer without pressing @key{RET}.)
11918
11919The @kbd{`} key also works during numeric or algebraic entry. The
11920text entered so far is moved to the @code{*Calc Edit*} buffer for
11921more extensive editing than is convenient in the minibuffer.
11922
11923@node Trail Commands, Keep Arguments, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail
11924@section Trail Commands
11925
11926@noindent
11927@cindex Trail buffer
11928The commands for manipulating the Calc Trail buffer are two-key sequences
11929beginning with the @kbd{t} prefix.
11930
11931@kindex t d
11932@pindex calc-trail-display
11933The @kbd{t d} (@code{calc-trail-display}) command turns display of the
11934trail on and off. Normally the trail display is toggled on if it was off,
11935off if it was on. With a numeric prefix of zero, this command always
11936turns the trail off; with a prefix of one, it always turns the trail on.
11937The other trail-manipulation commands described here automatically turn
11938the trail on. Note that when the trail is off values are still recorded
11939there; they are simply not displayed. To set Emacs to turn the trail
11940off by default, type @kbd{t d} and then save the mode settings with
11941@kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}).
11942
11943@kindex t i
11944@pindex calc-trail-in
11945@kindex t o
11946@pindex calc-trail-out
11947The @kbd{t i} (@code{calc-trail-in}) and @kbd{t o}
11948(@code{calc-trail-out}) commands switch the cursor into and out of the
11949Calc Trail window. In practice they are rarely used, since the commands
11950shown below are a more convenient way to move around in the
11951trail, and they work ``by remote control'' when the cursor is still
11952in the Calculator window.
11953
11954@cindex Trail pointer
11955There is a @dfn{trail pointer} which selects some entry of the trail at
11956any given time. The trail pointer looks like a @samp{>} symbol right
11957before the selected number. The following commands operate on the
11958trail pointer in various ways.
11959
11960@kindex t y
11961@pindex calc-trail-yank
11962@cindex Retrieving previous results
11963The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command reads the selected value in
11964the trail and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. It allows you to
11965re-use any previously computed value without retyping. With a numeric
11966prefix argument @var{n}, it yanks the value @var{n} lines above the current
11967trail pointer.
11968
11969@kindex t <
11970@pindex calc-trail-scroll-left
11971@kindex t >
11972@pindex calc-trail-scroll-right
11973The @kbd{t <} (@code{calc-trail-scroll-left}) and @kbd{t >}
11974(@code{calc-trail-scroll-right}) commands horizontally scroll the trail
11975window left or right by one half of its width.
11976
11977@kindex t n
11978@pindex calc-trail-next
11979@kindex t p
11980@pindex calc-trail-previous
11981@kindex t f
11982@pindex calc-trail-forward
11983@kindex t b
11984@pindex calc-trail-backward
11985The @kbd{t n} (@code{calc-trail-next}) and @kbd{t p}
11986(@code{calc-trail-previous)} commands move the trail pointer down or up
11987one line. The @kbd{t f} (@code{calc-trail-forward}) and @kbd{t b}
11988(@code{calc-trail-backward}) commands move the trail pointer down or up
11989one screenful at a time. All of these commands accept numeric prefix
11990arguments to move several lines or screenfuls at a time.
11991
11992@kindex t [
11993@pindex calc-trail-first
11994@kindex t ]
11995@pindex calc-trail-last
11996@kindex t h
11997@pindex calc-trail-here
11998The @kbd{t [} (@code{calc-trail-first}) and @kbd{t ]}
11999(@code{calc-trail-last}) commands move the trail pointer to the first or
12000last line of the trail. The @kbd{t h} (@code{calc-trail-here}) command
12001moves the trail pointer to the cursor position; unlike the other trail
12002commands, @kbd{t h} works only when Calc Trail is the selected window.
12003
12004@kindex t s
12005@pindex calc-trail-isearch-forward
12006@kindex t r
12007@pindex calc-trail-isearch-backward
12008@ifnottex
12009The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12010(@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) commands perform an incremental
12011search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12012to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12013If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12014it was when the search began.
12015@end ifnottex
12016@tex
12017The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12018(@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) com\-mands perform an incremental
12019search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12020to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12021If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12022it was when the search began.
12023@end tex
12024
12025@kindex t m
12026@pindex calc-trail-marker
12027The @kbd{t m} (@code{calc-trail-marker}) command allows you to enter a
12028line of text of your own choosing into the trail. The text is inserted
12029after the line containing the trail pointer; this usually means it is
12030added to the end of the trail. Trail markers are useful mainly as the
12031targets for later incremental searches in the trail.
12032
12033@kindex t k
12034@pindex calc-trail-kill
12035The @kbd{t k} (@code{calc-trail-kill}) command removes the selected line
12036from the trail. The line is saved in the Emacs kill ring suitable for
12037yanking into another buffer, but it is not easy to yank the text back
12038into the trail buffer. With a numeric prefix argument, this command
12039kills the @var{n} lines below or above the selected one.
12040
12041The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command is described
12042elsewhere; @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
12043
12044@node Keep Arguments, , Trail Commands, Stack and Trail
12045@section Keep Arguments
12046
12047@noindent
12048@kindex K
12049@pindex calc-keep-args
12050The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command acts like a prefix for
12051the following command. It prevents that command from removing its
12052arguments from the stack. For example, after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +},
12053the stack contains the sole number 5, but after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K +},
12054the stack contains the arguments and the result: @samp{2 3 5}.
12055
12056With the exception of keyboard macros, this works for all commands that
12057take arguments off the stack. (To avoid potentially unpleasant behavior,
12058a @kbd{K} prefix before a keyboard macro will be ignored. A @kbd{K}
12059prefix called @emph{within} the keyboard macro will still take effect.)
12060As another example, @kbd{K a s} simplifies a formula, pushing the
12061simplified version of the formula onto the stack after the original
12062formula (rather than replacing the original formula). Note that you
12063could get the same effect by typing @kbd{@key{RET} a s}, copying the
12064formula and then simplifying the copy. One difference is that for a very
12065large formula the time taken to format the intermediate copy in
12066@kbd{@key{RET} a s} could be noticeable; @kbd{K a s} would avoid this
12067extra work.
12068
12069Even stack manipulation commands are affected. @key{TAB} works by
12070popping two values and pushing them back in the opposite order,
12071so @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K @key{TAB}} produces @samp{2 3 3 2}.
12072
12073A few Calc commands provide other ways of doing the same thing.
12074For example, @kbd{' sin($)} replaces the number on the stack with
12075its sine using algebraic entry; to push the sine and keep the
12076original argument you could use either @kbd{' sin($1)} or
12077@kbd{K ' sin($)}. @xref{Algebraic Entry}. Also, the @kbd{s s}
12078command is effectively the same as @kbd{K s t}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
12079
12080If you execute a command and then decide you really wanted to keep
12081the argument, you can press @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
12082This command pushes the last arguments that were popped by any command
12083onto the stack. Note that the order of things on the stack will be
12084different than with @kbd{K}: @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + M-@key{RET}} leaves
12085@samp{5 2 3} on the stack instead of @samp{2 3 5}. @xref{Undo}.
12086
12087@node Mode Settings, Arithmetic, Stack and Trail, Top
12088@chapter Mode Settings
12089
12090@noindent
12091This chapter describes commands that set modes in the Calculator.
12092They do not affect the contents of the stack, although they may change
12093the @emph{appearance} or @emph{interpretation} of the stack's contents.
12094
12095@menu
12096* General Mode Commands::
12097* Precision::
12098* Inverse and Hyperbolic::
12099* Calculation Modes::
12100* Simplification Modes::
12101* Declarations::
12102* Display Modes::
12103* Language Modes::
12104* Modes Variable::
12105* Calc Mode Line::
12106@end menu
12107
12108@node General Mode Commands, Precision, Mode Settings, Mode Settings
12109@section General Mode Commands
12110
12111@noindent
12112@kindex m m
12113@pindex calc-save-modes
12114@cindex Continuous memory
12115@cindex Saving mode settings
12116@cindex Permanent mode settings
12117@cindex Calc init file, mode settings
4970fbfe 12118You can save all of the current mode settings in your Calc init file
4009494e 12119(the file given by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
4970fbfe
CY
12120@file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}) with the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})
12121command. This will cause Emacs to reestablish these modes each time
12122it starts up. The modes saved in the file include everything
12123controlled by the @kbd{m} and @kbd{d} prefix keys, the current
12124precision and binary word size, whether or not the trail is displayed,
12125the current height of the Calc window, and more. The current
12126interface (used when you type @kbd{C-x * *}) is also saved. If there
12127were already saved mode settings in the file, they are replaced.
12128Otherwise, the new mode information is appended to the end of the
12129file.
4009494e
GM
12130
12131@kindex m R
12132@pindex calc-mode-record-mode
12133The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command tells Calc to
12134record all the mode settings (as if by pressing @kbd{m m}) every
12135time a mode setting changes. If the modes are saved this way, then this
12136``automatic mode recording'' mode is also saved.
12137Type @kbd{m R} again to disable this method of recording the mode
12138settings. To turn it off permanently, the @kbd{m m} command will also be
12139necessary. (If Embedded mode is enabled, other options for recording
12140the modes are available; @pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
12141
12142@kindex m F
12143@pindex calc-settings-file-name
12144The @kbd{m F} (@code{calc-settings-file-name}) command allows you to
12145choose a different file than the current value of @code{calc-settings-file}
12146for @kbd{m m}, @kbd{Z P}, and similar commands to save permanent information.
12147You are prompted for a file name. All Calc modes are then reset to
12148their default values, then settings from the file you named are loaded
12149if this file exists, and this file becomes the one that Calc will
12150use in the future for commands like @kbd{m m}. The default settings
dcf7843e 12151file name is @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}. You can see the current file name by
4009494e
GM
12152giving a blank response to the @kbd{m F} prompt. See also the
12153discussion of the @code{calc-settings-file} variable; @pxref{Customizing Calc}.
12154
12155If the file name you give is your user init file (typically
12156@file{~/.emacs}), @kbd{m F} will not automatically load the new file. This
12157is because your user init file may contain other things you don't want
12158to reread. You can give
12159a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{m F} to force it to read the
12160file no matter what. Conversely, an argument of @mathit{-1} tells
12161@kbd{m F} @emph{not} to read the new file. An argument of 2 or @mathit{-2}
12162tells @kbd{m F} not to reset the modes to their defaults beforehand,
12163which is useful if you intend your new file to have a variant of the
12164modes present in the file you were using before.
12165
12166@kindex m x
12167@pindex calc-always-load-extensions
12168The @kbd{m x} (@code{calc-always-load-extensions}) command enables a mode
12169in which the first use of Calc loads the entire program, including all
12170extensions modules. Otherwise, the extensions modules will not be loaded
12171until the various advanced Calc features are used. Since this mode only
12172has effect when Calc is first loaded, @kbd{m x} is usually followed by
12173@kbd{m m} to make the mode-setting permanent. To load all of Calc just
12174once, rather than always in the future, you can press @kbd{C-x * L}.
12175
12176@kindex m S
12177@pindex calc-shift-prefix
12178The @kbd{m S} (@code{calc-shift-prefix}) command enables a mode in which
12179all of Calc's letter prefix keys may be typed shifted as well as unshifted.
12180If you are typing, say, @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) quite often
12181you might find it easier to turn this mode on so that you can type
12182@kbd{A S} instead. When this mode is enabled, the commands that used to
12183be on those single shifted letters (e.g., @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs})) can
12184now be invoked by pressing the shifted letter twice: @kbd{A A}. Note
12185that the @kbd{v} prefix key always works both shifted and unshifted, and
12186the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z} prefix keys are always distinct. Also, the @kbd{h}
12187prefix is not affected by this mode. Press @kbd{m S} again to disable
12188shifted-prefix mode.
12189
12190@node Precision, Inverse and Hyperbolic, General Mode Commands, Mode Settings
12191@section Precision
12192
12193@noindent
12194@kindex p
12195@pindex calc-precision
12196@cindex Precision of calculations
12197The @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision}) command controls the precision to
12198which floating-point calculations are carried. The precision must be
12199at least 3 digits and may be arbitrarily high, within the limits of
12200memory and time. This affects only floats: Integer and rational
12201calculations are always carried out with as many digits as necessary.
12202
12203The @kbd{p} key prompts for the current precision. If you wish you
12204can instead give the precision as a numeric prefix argument.
12205
12206Many internal calculations are carried to one or two digits higher
12207precision than normal. Results are rounded down afterward to the
12208current precision. Unless a special display mode has been selected,
12209floats are always displayed with their full stored precision, i.e.,
12210what you see is what you get. Reducing the current precision does not
12211round values already on the stack, but those values will be rounded
12212down before being used in any calculation. The @kbd{c 0} through
12213@kbd{c 9} commands (@pxref{Conversions}) can be used to round an
12214existing value to a new precision.
12215
12216@cindex Accuracy of calculations
12217It is important to distinguish the concepts of @dfn{precision} and
12218@dfn{accuracy}. In the normal usage of these words, the number
12219123.4567 has a precision of 7 digits but an accuracy of 4 digits.
12220The precision is the total number of digits not counting leading
12221or trailing zeros (regardless of the position of the decimal point).
12222The accuracy is simply the number of digits after the decimal point
12223(again not counting trailing zeros). In Calc you control the precision,
12224not the accuracy of computations. If you were to set the accuracy
12225instead, then calculations like @samp{exp(100)} would generate many
12226more digits than you would typically need, while @samp{exp(-100)} would
12227probably round to zero! In Calc, both these computations give you
12228exactly 12 (or the requested number of) significant digits.
12229
12230The only Calc features that deal with accuracy instead of precision
12231are fixed-point display mode for floats (@kbd{d f}; @pxref{Float Formats}),
12232and the rounding functions like @code{floor} and @code{round}
12233(@pxref{Integer Truncation}). Also, @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}
12234deal with both precision and accuracy depending on the magnitudes
12235of the numbers involved.
12236
12237If you need to work with a particular fixed accuracy (say, dollars and
12238cents with two digits after the decimal point), one solution is to work
12239with integers and an ``implied'' decimal point. For example, $8.99
12240divided by 6 would be entered @kbd{899 @key{RET} 6 /}, yielding 149.833
12241(actually $1.49833 with our implied decimal point); pressing @kbd{R}
12242would round this to 150 cents, i.e., $1.50.
12243
12244@xref{Floats}, for still more on floating-point precision and related
12245issues.
12246
12247@node Inverse and Hyperbolic, Calculation Modes, Precision, Mode Settings
12248@section Inverse and Hyperbolic Flags
12249
12250@noindent
12251@kindex I
12252@pindex calc-inverse
12253There is no single-key equivalent to the @code{calc-arcsin} function.
12254Instead, you must first press @kbd{I} (@code{calc-inverse}) to set
12255the @dfn{Inverse Flag}, then press @kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}).
12256The @kbd{I} key actually toggles the Inverse Flag. When this flag
12257is set, the word @samp{Inv} appears in the mode line.
12258
12259@kindex H
12260@pindex calc-hyperbolic
12261Likewise, the @kbd{H} key (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) sets or clears the
12262Hyperbolic Flag, which transforms @code{calc-sin} into @code{calc-sinh}.
12263If both of these flags are set at once, the effect will be
12264@code{calc-arcsinh}. (The Hyperbolic flag is also used by some
12265non-trigonometric commands; for example @kbd{H L} computes a base-10,
12266instead of base-@mathit{e}, logarithm.)
12267
12268Command names like @code{calc-arcsin} are provided for completeness, and
12269may be executed with @kbd{x} or @kbd{M-x}. Their effect is simply to
12270toggle the Inverse and/or Hyperbolic flags and then execute the
12271corresponding base command (@code{calc-sin} in this case).
12272
f8b91752
JB
12273@kindex O
12274@pindex calc-option
12275The @kbd{O} key (@code{calc-option}) sets another flag, the
12276@dfn{Option Flag}, which also can alter the subsequent Calc command in
12277various ways.
12278
12279The Inverse, Hyperbolic and Option flags apply only to the next
12280Calculator command, after which they are automatically cleared. (They
12281are also cleared if the next keystroke is not a Calc command.) Digits
12282you type after @kbd{I}, @kbd{H} or @kbd{O} (or @kbd{K}) are treated as
12283prefix arguments for the next command, not as numeric entries. The
12284same is true of @kbd{C-u}, but not of the minus sign (@kbd{K -} means
12285to subtract and keep arguments).
12286
12287Another Calc prefix flag, @kbd{K} (keep-arguments), is discussed
4009494e
GM
12288elsewhere. @xref{Keep Arguments}.
12289
12290@node Calculation Modes, Simplification Modes, Inverse and Hyperbolic, Mode Settings
12291@section Calculation Modes
12292
12293@noindent
12294The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with
12295the @kbd{m} prefix. (That's the letter @kbd{m}, not the @key{META} key.)
12296The @samp{m a} (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) command is described elsewhere
12297(@pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
12298
12299@menu
12300* Angular Modes::
12301* Polar Mode::
12302* Fraction Mode::
12303* Infinite Mode::
12304* Symbolic Mode::
12305* Matrix Mode::
12306* Automatic Recomputation::
12307* Working Message::
12308@end menu
12309
12310@node Angular Modes, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes, Calculation Modes
12311@subsection Angular Modes
12312
12313@noindent
12314@cindex Angular mode
12315The Calculator supports three notations for angles: radians, degrees,
12316and degrees-minutes-seconds. When a number is presented to a function
12317like @code{sin} that requires an angle, the current angular mode is
12318used to interpret the number as either radians or degrees. If an HMS
12319form is presented to @code{sin}, it is always interpreted as
12320degrees-minutes-seconds.
12321
12322Functions that compute angles produce a number in radians, a number in
12323degrees, or an HMS form depending on the current angular mode. If the
12324result is a complex number and the current mode is HMS, the number is
12325instead expressed in degrees. (Complex-number calculations would
12326normally be done in Radians mode, though. Complex numbers are converted
12327to degrees by calculating the complex result in radians and then
12328multiplying by 180 over @cpi{}.)
12329
12330@kindex m r
12331@pindex calc-radians-mode
12332@kindex m d
12333@pindex calc-degrees-mode
12334@kindex m h
12335@pindex calc-hms-mode
12336The @kbd{m r} (@code{calc-radians-mode}), @kbd{m d} (@code{calc-degrees-mode}),
12337and @kbd{m h} (@code{calc-hms-mode}) commands control the angular mode.
12338The current angular mode is displayed on the Emacs mode line.
12339The default angular mode is Degrees.
12340
12341@node Polar Mode, Fraction Mode, Angular Modes, Calculation Modes
12342@subsection Polar Mode
12343
12344@noindent
12345@cindex Polar mode
12346The Calculator normally ``prefers'' rectangular complex numbers in the
12347sense that rectangular form is used when the proper form can not be
12348decided from the input. This might happen by multiplying a rectangular
12349number by a polar one, by taking the square root of a negative real
12350number, or by entering @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )}.
12351
12352@kindex m p
12353@pindex calc-polar-mode
12354The @kbd{m p} (@code{calc-polar-mode}) command toggles complex-number
12355preference between rectangular and polar forms. In Polar mode, all
12356of the above example situations would produce polar complex numbers.
12357
12358@node Fraction Mode, Infinite Mode, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes
12359@subsection Fraction Mode
12360
12361@noindent
12362@cindex Fraction mode
12363@cindex Division of integers
12364Division of two integers normally yields a floating-point number if the
12365result cannot be expressed as an integer. In some cases you would
12366rather get an exact fractional answer. One way to accomplish this is
12367to use the @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command, which
12368divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fraction:
12369@kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 :} produces @expr{3:2} even though
12370@kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 /} produces @expr{1.5}.
12371
12372@kindex m f
12373@pindex calc-frac-mode
12374To set the Calculator to produce fractional results for normal integer
12375divisions, use the @kbd{m f} (@code{calc-frac-mode}) command.
12376For example, @expr{8/4} produces @expr{2} in either mode,
12377but @expr{6/4} produces @expr{3:2} in Fraction mode, @expr{1.5} in
12378Float mode.
12379
12380At any time you can use @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) to convert a
12381fraction to a float, or @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) to convert a
12382float to a fraction. @xref{Conversions}.
12383
12384@node Infinite Mode, Symbolic Mode, Fraction Mode, Calculation Modes
12385@subsection Infinite Mode
12386
12387@noindent
12388@cindex Infinite mode
12389The Calculator normally treats results like @expr{1 / 0} as errors;
12390formulas like this are left in unsimplified form. But Calc can be
12391put into a mode where such calculations instead produce ``infinite''
12392results.
12393
12394@kindex m i
12395@pindex calc-infinite-mode
12396The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode}) command turns this mode
12397on and off. When the mode is off, infinities do not arise except
12398in calculations that already had infinities as inputs. (One exception
12399is that infinite open intervals like @samp{[0 .. inf)} can be
12400generated; however, intervals closed at infinity (@samp{[0 .. inf]})
12401will not be generated when Infinite mode is off.)
12402
12403With Infinite mode turned on, @samp{1 / 0} will generate @code{uinf},
12404an undirected infinity. @xref{Infinities}, for a discussion of the
12405difference between @code{inf} and @code{uinf}. Also, @expr{0 / 0}
12406evaluates to @code{nan}, the ``indeterminate'' symbol. Various other
12407functions can also return infinities in this mode; for example,
12408@samp{ln(0) = -inf}, and @samp{gamma(-7) = uinf}. Once again,
12409note that @samp{exp(inf) = inf} regardless of Infinite mode because
12410this calculation has infinity as an input.
12411
12412@cindex Positive Infinite mode
12413The @kbd{m i} command with a numeric prefix argument of zero,
12414i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 m i}, turns on a Positive Infinite mode in
12415which zero is treated as positive instead of being directionless.
12416Thus, @samp{1 / 0 = inf} and @samp{-1 / 0 = -inf} in this mode.
12417Note that zero never actually has a sign in Calc; there are no
12418separate representations for @mathit{+0} and @mathit{-0}. Positive
12419Infinite mode merely changes the interpretation given to the
12420single symbol, @samp{0}. One consequence of this is that, while
12421you might expect @samp{1 / -0 = -inf}, actually @samp{1 / -0}
12422is equivalent to @samp{1 / 0}, which is equal to positive @code{inf}.
12423
12424@node Symbolic Mode, Matrix Mode, Infinite Mode, Calculation Modes
12425@subsection Symbolic Mode
12426
12427@noindent
12428@cindex Symbolic mode
12429@cindex Inexact results
12430Calculations are normally performed numerically wherever possible.
12431For example, the @code{calc-sqrt} command, or @code{sqrt} function in an
12432algebraic expression, produces a numeric answer if the argument is a
12433number or a symbolic expression if the argument is an expression:
12434@kbd{2 Q} pushes 1.4142 but @kbd{@key{'} x+1 @key{RET} Q} pushes @samp{sqrt(x+1)}.
12435
12436@kindex m s
12437@pindex calc-symbolic-mode
12438In @dfn{Symbolic mode}, controlled by the @kbd{m s} (@code{calc-symbolic-mode})
12439command, functions which would produce inexact, irrational results are
12440left in symbolic form. Thus @kbd{16 Q} pushes 4, but @kbd{2 Q} pushes
12441@samp{sqrt(2)}.
12442
12443@kindex N
12444@pindex calc-eval-num
12445The shift-@kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) command evaluates numerically
12446the expression at the top of the stack, by temporarily disabling
12447@code{calc-symbolic-mode} and executing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
12448Given a numeric prefix argument, it also
12449sets the floating-point precision to the specified value for the duration
12450of the command.
12451
12452To evaluate a formula numerically without expanding the variables it
12453contains, you can use the key sequence @kbd{m s a v m s} (this uses
12454@code{calc-alg-evaluate}, which resimplifies but doesn't evaluate
12455variables.)
12456
12457@node Matrix Mode, Automatic Recomputation, Symbolic Mode, Calculation Modes
12458@subsection Matrix and Scalar Modes
12459
12460@noindent
12461@cindex Matrix mode
12462@cindex Scalar mode
12463Calc sometimes makes assumptions during algebraic manipulation that
12464are awkward or incorrect when vectors and matrices are involved.
12465Calc has two modes, @dfn{Matrix mode} and @dfn{Scalar mode}, which
12466modify its behavior around vectors in useful ways.
12467
12468@kindex m v
12469@pindex calc-matrix-mode
12470Press @kbd{m v} (@code{calc-matrix-mode}) once to enter Matrix mode.
12471In this mode, all objects are assumed to be matrices unless provably
12472otherwise. One major effect is that Calc will no longer consider
12473multiplication to be commutative. (Recall that in matrix arithmetic,
12474@samp{A*B} is not the same as @samp{B*A}.) This assumption affects
12475rewrite rules and algebraic simplification. Another effect of this
12476mode is that calculations that would normally produce constants like
124770 and 1 (e.g., @expr{a - a} and @expr{a / a}, respectively) will now
12478produce function calls that represent ``generic'' zero or identity
12479matrices: @samp{idn(0)}, @samp{idn(1)}. The @code{idn} function
12480@samp{idn(@var{a},@var{n})} returns @var{a} times an @var{n}x@var{n}
12481identity matrix; if @var{n} is omitted, it doesn't know what
12482dimension to use and so the @code{idn} call remains in symbolic
12483form. However, if this generic identity matrix is later combined
12484with a matrix whose size is known, it will be converted into
12485a true identity matrix of the appropriate size. On the other hand,
12486if it is combined with a scalar (as in @samp{idn(1) + 2}), Calc
12487will assume it really was a scalar after all and produce, e.g., 3.
12488
12489Press @kbd{m v} a second time to get Scalar mode. Here, objects are
12490assumed @emph{not} to be vectors or matrices unless provably so.
12491For example, normally adding a variable to a vector, as in
12492@samp{[x, y, z] + a}, will leave the sum in symbolic form because
12493as far as Calc knows, @samp{a} could represent either a number or
12494another 3-vector. In Scalar mode, @samp{a} is assumed to be a
12495non-vector, and the addition is evaluated to @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]}.
12496
12497Press @kbd{m v} a third time to return to the normal mode of operation.
12498
12499If you press @kbd{m v} with a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, you
12500get a special ``dimensioned'' Matrix mode in which matrices of
12501unknown size are assumed to be @var{n}x@var{n} square matrices.
12502Then, the function call @samp{idn(1)} will expand into an actual
12503matrix rather than representing a ``generic'' matrix. Simply typing
12504@kbd{C-u m v} will get you a square Matrix mode, in which matrices of
12505unknown size are assumed to be square matrices of unspecified size.
12506
12507@cindex Declaring scalar variables
12508Of course these modes are approximations to the true state of
12509affairs, which is probably that some quantities will be matrices
12510and others will be scalars. One solution is to ``declare''
12511certain variables or functions to be scalar-valued.
12512@xref{Declarations}, to see how to make declarations in Calc.
12513
12514There is nothing stopping you from declaring a variable to be
12515scalar and then storing a matrix in it; however, if you do, the
12516results you get from Calc may not be valid. Suppose you let Calc
12517get the result @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]} shown above, and then stored
12518@samp{[1, 2, 3]} in @samp{a}. The result would not be the same as
12519for @samp{[x, y, z] + [1, 2, 3]}, but that's because you have broken
12520your earlier promise to Calc that @samp{a} would be scalar.
12521
12522Another way to mix scalars and matrices is to use selections
12523(@pxref{Selecting Subformulas}). Use Matrix mode when operating on
12524your formula normally; then, to apply Scalar mode to a certain part
12525of the formula without affecting the rest just select that part,
12526change into Scalar mode and press @kbd{=} to resimplify the part
12527under this mode, then change back to Matrix mode before deselecting.
12528
12529@node Automatic Recomputation, Working Message, Matrix Mode, Calculation Modes
12530@subsection Automatic Recomputation
12531
12532@noindent
12533The @dfn{evaluates-to} operator, @samp{=>}, has the special
12534property that any @samp{=>} formulas on the stack are recomputed
12535whenever variable values or mode settings that might affect them
12536are changed. @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}.
12537
12538@kindex m C
12539@pindex calc-auto-recompute
12540The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns this
12541automatic recomputation on and off. If you turn it off, Calc will
12542not update @samp{=>} operators on the stack (nor those in the
12543attached Embedded mode buffer, if there is one). They will not
12544be updated unless you explicitly do so by pressing @kbd{=} or until
12545you press @kbd{m C} to turn recomputation back on. (While automatic
12546recomputation is off, you can think of @kbd{m C m C} as a command
12547to update all @samp{=>} operators while leaving recomputation off.)
12548
12549To update @samp{=>} operators in an Embedded buffer while
12550automatic recomputation is off, use @w{@kbd{C-x * u}}.
12551@xref{Embedded Mode}.
12552
12553@node Working Message, , Automatic Recomputation, Calculation Modes
12554@subsection Working Messages
12555
12556@noindent
12557@cindex Performance
12558@cindex Working messages
12559Since the Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, which is not
12560designed for heavy numerical work, many operations are quite slow.
12561The Calculator normally displays the message @samp{Working...} in the
12562echo area during any command that may be slow. In addition, iterative
12563operations such as square roots and trigonometric functions display the
12564intermediate result at each step. Both of these types of messages can
12565be disabled if you find them distracting.
12566
12567@kindex m w
12568@pindex calc-working
12569Type @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) with a numeric prefix of 0 to
12570disable all ``working'' messages. Use a numeric prefix of 1 to enable
12571only the plain @samp{Working...} message. Use a numeric prefix of 2 to
12572see intermediate results as well. With no numeric prefix this displays
12573the current mode.
12574
12575While it may seem that the ``working'' messages will slow Calc down
12576considerably, experiments have shown that their impact is actually
12577quite small. But if your terminal is slow you may find that it helps
12578to turn the messages off.
12579
12580@node Simplification Modes, Declarations, Calculation Modes, Mode Settings
12581@section Simplification Modes
12582
12583@noindent
12584The current @dfn{simplification mode} controls how numbers and formulas
12585are ``normalized'' when being taken from or pushed onto the stack.
12586Some normalizations are unavoidable, such as rounding floating-point
12587results to the current precision, and reducing fractions to simplest
12588form. Others, such as simplifying a formula like @expr{a+a} (or @expr{2+3}),
12589are done by default but can be turned off when necessary.
12590
12591When you press a key like @kbd{+} when @expr{2} and @expr{3} are on the
12592stack, Calc pops these numbers, normalizes them, creates the formula
12593@expr{2+3}, normalizes it, and pushes the result. Of course the standard
12594rules for normalizing @expr{2+3} will produce the result @expr{5}.
12595
12596Simplification mode commands consist of the lower-case @kbd{m} prefix key
12597followed by a shifted letter.
12598
12599@kindex m O
12600@pindex calc-no-simplify-mode
12601The @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) command turns off all optional
12602simplifications. These would leave a formula like @expr{2+3} alone. In
12603fact, nothing except simple numbers are ever affected by normalization
12604in this mode.
12605
12606@kindex m N
12607@pindex calc-num-simplify-mode
12608The @kbd{m N} (@code{calc-num-simplify-mode}) command turns off simplification
12609of any formulas except those for which all arguments are constants. For
12610example, @expr{1+2} is simplified to @expr{3}, and @expr{a+(2-2)} is
12611simplified to @expr{a+0} but no further, since one argument of the sum
12612is not a constant. Unfortunately, @expr{(a+2)-2} is @emph{not} simplified
12613because the top-level @samp{-} operator's arguments are not both
12614constant numbers (one of them is the formula @expr{a+2}).
12615A constant is a number or other numeric object (such as a constant
12616error form or modulo form), or a vector all of whose
12617elements are constant.
12618
12619@kindex m D
12620@pindex calc-default-simplify-mode
12621The @kbd{m D} (@code{calc-default-simplify-mode}) command restores the
12622default simplifications for all formulas. This includes many easy and
12623fast algebraic simplifications such as @expr{a+0} to @expr{a}, and
12624@expr{a + 2 a} to @expr{3 a}, as well as evaluating functions like
12625@expr{@tfn{deriv}(x^2, x)} to @expr{2 x}.
12626
12627@kindex m B
12628@pindex calc-bin-simplify-mode
12629The @kbd{m B} (@code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}) mode applies the default
12630simplifications to a result and then, if the result is an integer,
12631uses the @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip}) command to clip the integer according
12632to the current binary word size. @xref{Binary Functions}. Real numbers
12633are rounded to the nearest integer and then clipped; other kinds of
12634results (after the default simplifications) are left alone.
12635
12636@kindex m A
12637@pindex calc-alg-simplify-mode
12638The @kbd{m A} (@code{calc-alg-simplify-mode}) mode does algebraic
12639simplification; it applies all the default simplifications, and also
12640the more powerful (and slower) simplifications made by @kbd{a s}
12641(@code{calc-simplify}). @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
12642
12643@kindex m E
12644@pindex calc-ext-simplify-mode
12645The @kbd{m E} (@code{calc-ext-simplify-mode}) mode does ``extended''
12646algebraic simplification, as by the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended})
12647command. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
12648
12649@kindex m U
12650@pindex calc-units-simplify-mode
12651The @kbd{m U} (@code{calc-units-simplify-mode}) mode does units
12652simplification; it applies the command @kbd{u s}
12653(@code{calc-simplify-units}), which in turn
12654is a superset of @kbd{a s}. In this mode, variable names which
12655are identifiable as unit names (like @samp{mm} for ``millimeters'')
12656are simplified with their unit definitions in mind.
12657
12658A common technique is to set the simplification mode down to the lowest
12659amount of simplification you will allow to be applied automatically, then
12660use manual commands like @kbd{a s} and @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) to
12661perform higher types of simplifications on demand. @xref{Algebraic
12662Definitions}, for another sample use of No-Simplification mode.
12663
12664@node Declarations, Display Modes, Simplification Modes, Mode Settings
12665@section Declarations
12666
12667@noindent
12668A @dfn{declaration} is a statement you make that promises you will
12669use a certain variable or function in a restricted way. This may
12670give Calc the freedom to do things that it couldn't do if it had to
12671take the fully general situation into account.
12672
12673@menu
12674* Declaration Basics::
12675* Kinds of Declarations::
12676* Functions for Declarations::
12677@end menu
12678
12679@node Declaration Basics, Kinds of Declarations, Declarations, Declarations
12680@subsection Declaration Basics
12681
12682@noindent
12683@kindex s d
12684@pindex calc-declare-variable
12685The @kbd{s d} (@code{calc-declare-variable}) command is the easiest
12686way to make a declaration for a variable. This command prompts for
12687the variable name, then prompts for the declaration. The default
12688at the declaration prompt is the previous declaration, if any.
12689You can edit this declaration, or press @kbd{C-k} to erase it and
12690type a new declaration. (Or, erase it and press @key{RET} to clear
12691the declaration, effectively ``undeclaring'' the variable.)
12692
12693A declaration is in general a vector of @dfn{type symbols} and
12694@dfn{range} values. If there is only one type symbol or range value,
12695you can write it directly rather than enclosing it in a vector.
12696For example, @kbd{s d foo @key{RET} real @key{RET}} declares @code{foo} to
12697be a real number, and @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} [int, const, [1..6]] @key{RET}}
12698declares @code{bar} to be a constant integer between 1 and 6.
12699(Actually, you can omit the outermost brackets and Calc will
12700provide them for you: @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} int, const, [1..6] @key{RET}}.)
12701
12702@cindex @code{Decls} variable
12703@vindex Decls
12704Declarations in Calc are kept in a special variable called @code{Decls}.
12705This variable encodes the set of all outstanding declarations in
12706the form of a matrix. Each row has two elements: A variable or
12707vector of variables declared by that row, and the declaration
12708specifier as described above. You can use the @kbd{s D} command to
12709edit this variable if you wish to see all the declarations at once.
12710@xref{Operations on Variables}, for a description of this command
12711and the @kbd{s p} command that allows you to save your declarations
12712permanently if you wish.
12713
12714Items being declared can also be function calls. The arguments in
12715the call are ignored; the effect is to say that this function returns
12716values of the declared type for any valid arguments. The @kbd{s d}
12717command declares only variables, so if you wish to make a function
12718declaration you will have to edit the @code{Decls} matrix yourself.
12719
12720For example, the declaration matrix
12721
12722@smallexample
12723@group
12724[ [ foo, real ]
12725 [ [j, k, n], int ]
12726 [ f(1,2,3), [0 .. inf) ] ]
12727@end group
12728@end smallexample
12729
12730@noindent
12731declares that @code{foo} represents a real number, @code{j}, @code{k}
12732and @code{n} represent integers, and the function @code{f} always
12733returns a real number in the interval shown.
12734
12735@vindex All
12736If there is a declaration for the variable @code{All}, then that
12737declaration applies to all variables that are not otherwise declared.
12738It does not apply to function names. For example, using the row
12739@samp{[All, real]} says that all your variables are real unless they
12740are explicitly declared without @code{real} in some other row.
12741The @kbd{s d} command declares @code{All} if you give a blank
12742response to the variable-name prompt.
12743
12744@node Kinds of Declarations, Functions for Declarations, Declaration Basics, Declarations
12745@subsection Kinds of Declarations
12746
12747@noindent
12748The type-specifier part of a declaration (that is, the second prompt
12749in the @kbd{s d} command) can be a type symbol, an interval, or a
12750vector consisting of zero or more type symbols followed by zero or
12751more intervals or numbers that represent the set of possible values
12752for the variable.
12753
12754@smallexample
12755@group
12756[ [ a, [1, 2, 3, 4, 5] ]
12757 [ b, [1 .. 5] ]
12758 [ c, [int, 1 .. 5] ] ]
12759@end group
12760@end smallexample
12761
12762Here @code{a} is declared to contain one of the five integers shown;
12763@code{b} is any number in the interval from 1 to 5 (any real number
12764since we haven't specified), and @code{c} is any integer in that
12765interval. Thus the declarations for @code{a} and @code{c} are
12766nearly equivalent (see below).
12767
12768The type-specifier can be the empty vector @samp{[]} to say that
12769nothing is known about a given variable's value. This is the same
12770as not declaring the variable at all except that it overrides any
12771@code{All} declaration which would otherwise apply.
12772
12773The initial value of @code{Decls} is the empty vector @samp{[]}.
12774If @code{Decls} has no stored value or if the value stored in it
12775is not valid, it is ignored and there are no declarations as far
12776as Calc is concerned. (The @kbd{s d} command will replace such a
12777malformed value with a fresh empty matrix, @samp{[]}, before recording
12778the new declaration.) Unrecognized type symbols are ignored.
12779
12780The following type symbols describe what sorts of numbers will be
12781stored in a variable:
12782
12783@table @code
12784@item int
12785Integers.
12786@item numint
12787Numerical integers. (Integers or integer-valued floats.)
12788@item frac
12789Fractions. (Rational numbers which are not integers.)
12790@item rat
12791Rational numbers. (Either integers or fractions.)
12792@item float
12793Floating-point numbers.
12794@item real
12795Real numbers. (Integers, fractions, or floats. Actually,
12796intervals and error forms with real components also count as
12797reals here.)
12798@item pos
12799Positive real numbers. (Strictly greater than zero.)
12800@item nonneg
12801Nonnegative real numbers. (Greater than or equal to zero.)
12802@item number
12803Numbers. (Real or complex.)
12804@end table
12805
12806Calc uses this information to determine when certain simplifications
12807of formulas are safe. For example, @samp{(x^y)^z} cannot be
12808simplified to @samp{x^(y z)} in general; for example,
12809@samp{((-3)^2)^1:2} is 3, but @samp{(-3)^(2*1:2) = (-3)^1} is @mathit{-3}.
12810However, this simplification @emph{is} safe if @code{z} is known
12811to be an integer, or if @code{x} is known to be a nonnegative
12812real number. If you have given declarations that allow Calc to
12813deduce either of these facts, Calc will perform this simplification
12814of the formula.
12815
12816Calc can apply a certain amount of logic when using declarations.
12817For example, @samp{(x^y)^(2n+1)} will be simplified if @code{n}
12818has been declared @code{int}; Calc knows that an integer times an
12819integer, plus an integer, must always be an integer. (In fact,
12820Calc would simplify @samp{(-x)^(2n+1)} to @samp{-(x^(2n+1))} since
12821it is able to determine that @samp{2n+1} must be an odd integer.)
12822
12823Similarly, @samp{(abs(x)^y)^z} will be simplified to @samp{abs(x)^(y z)}
12824because Calc knows that the @code{abs} function always returns a
12825nonnegative real. If you had a @code{myabs} function that also had
12826this property, you could get Calc to recognize it by adding the row
12827@samp{[myabs(), nonneg]} to the @code{Decls} matrix.
12828
12829One instance of this simplification is @samp{sqrt(x^2)} (since the
12830@code{sqrt} function is effectively a one-half power). Normally
12831Calc leaves this formula alone. After the command
12832@kbd{s d x @key{RET} real @key{RET}}, however, it can simplify the formula to
12833@samp{abs(x)}. And after @kbd{s d x @key{RET} nonneg @key{RET}}, Calc can
12834simplify this formula all the way to @samp{x}.
12835
12836If there are any intervals or real numbers in the type specifier,
12837they comprise the set of possible values that the variable or
12838function being declared can have. In particular, the type symbol
12839@code{real} is effectively the same as the range @samp{[-inf .. inf]}
12840(note that infinity is included in the range of possible values);
12841@code{pos} is the same as @samp{(0 .. inf]}, and @code{nonneg} is
12842the same as @samp{[0 .. inf]}. Saying @samp{[real, [-5 .. 5]]} is
12843redundant because the fact that the variable is real can be
12844deduced just from the interval, but @samp{[int, [-5 .. 5]]} and
12845@samp{[rat, [-5 .. 5]]} are useful combinations.
12846
12847Note that the vector of intervals or numbers is in the same format
12848used by Calc's set-manipulation commands. @xref{Set Operations}.
12849
12850The type specifier @samp{[1, 2, 3]} is equivalent to
12851@samp{[numint, 1, 2, 3]}, @emph{not} to @samp{[int, 1, 2, 3]}.
12852In other words, the range of possible values means only that
12853the variable's value must be numerically equal to a number in
12854that range, but not that it must be equal in type as well.
12855Calc's set operations act the same way; @samp{in(2, [1., 2., 3.])}
12856and @samp{in(1.5, [1:2, 3:2, 5:2])} both report ``true.''
12857
12858If you use a conflicting combination of type specifiers, the
12859results are unpredictable. An example is @samp{[pos, [0 .. 5]]},
12860where the interval does not lie in the range described by the
12861type symbol.
12862
12863``Real'' declarations mostly affect simplifications involving powers
12864like the one described above. Another case where they are used
12865is in the @kbd{a P} command which returns a list of all roots of a
12866polynomial; if the variable has been declared real, only the real
12867roots (if any) will be included in the list.
12868
12869``Integer'' declarations are used for simplifications which are valid
12870only when certain values are integers (such as @samp{(x^y)^z}
12871shown above).
12872
12873Another command that makes use of declarations is @kbd{a s}, when
12874simplifying equations and inequalities. It will cancel @code{x}
12875from both sides of @samp{a x = b x} only if it is sure @code{x}
12876is non-zero, say, because it has a @code{pos} declaration.
12877To declare specifically that @code{x} is real and non-zero,
12878use @samp{[[-inf .. 0), (0 .. inf]]}. (There is no way in the
12879current notation to say that @code{x} is nonzero but not necessarily
12880real.) The @kbd{a e} command does ``unsafe'' simplifications,
12881including cancelling @samp{x} from the equation when @samp{x} is
12882not known to be nonzero.
12883
12884Another set of type symbols distinguish between scalars and vectors.
12885
12886@table @code
12887@item scalar
12888The value is not a vector.
12889@item vector
12890The value is a vector.
12891@item matrix
12892The value is a matrix (a rectangular vector of vectors).
12893@item sqmatrix
12894The value is a square matrix.
12895@end table
12896
12897These type symbols can be combined with the other type symbols
12898described above; @samp{[int, matrix]} describes an object which
12899is a matrix of integers.
12900
12901Scalar/vector declarations are used to determine whether certain
12902algebraic operations are safe. For example, @samp{[a, b, c] + x}
12903is normally not simplified to @samp{[a + x, b + x, c + x]}, but
12904it will be if @code{x} has been declared @code{scalar}. On the
12905other hand, multiplication is usually assumed to be commutative,
12906but the terms in @samp{x y} will never be exchanged if both @code{x}
12907and @code{y} are known to be vectors or matrices. (Calc currently
12908never distinguishes between @code{vector} and @code{matrix}
12909declarations.)
12910
12911@xref{Matrix Mode}, for a discussion of Matrix mode and
12912Scalar mode, which are similar to declaring @samp{[All, matrix]}
12913or @samp{[All, scalar]} but much more convenient.
12914
12915One more type symbol that is recognized is used with the @kbd{H a d}
12916command for taking total derivatives of a formula. @xref{Calculus}.
12917
12918@table @code
12919@item const
12920The value is a constant with respect to other variables.
12921@end table
12922
12923Calc does not check the declarations for a variable when you store
12924a value in it. However, storing @mathit{-3.5} in a variable that has
12925been declared @code{pos}, @code{int}, or @code{matrix} may have
12926unexpected effects; Calc may evaluate @samp{sqrt(x^2)} to @expr{3.5}
12927if it substitutes the value first, or to @expr{-3.5} if @code{x}
12928was declared @code{pos} and the formula @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is
12929simplified to @samp{x} before the value is substituted. Before
12930using a variable for a new purpose, it is best to use @kbd{s d}
12931or @kbd{s D} to check to make sure you don't still have an old
12932declaration for the variable that will conflict with its new meaning.
12933
12934@node Functions for Declarations, , Kinds of Declarations, Declarations
12935@subsection Functions for Declarations
12936
12937@noindent
12938Calc has a set of functions for accessing the current declarations
12939in a convenient manner. These functions return 1 if the argument
12940can be shown to have the specified property, or 0 if the argument
12941can be shown @emph{not} to have that property; otherwise they are
12942left unevaluated. These functions are suitable for use with rewrite
12943rules (@pxref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}) or programming constructs
12944(@pxref{Conditionals in Macros}). They can be entered only using
12945algebraic notation. @xref{Logical Operations}, for functions
12946that perform other tests not related to declarations.
12947
12948For example, @samp{dint(17)} returns 1 because 17 is an integer, as
12949do @samp{dint(n)} and @samp{dint(2 n - 3)} if @code{n} has been declared
12950@code{int}, but @samp{dint(2.5)} and @samp{dint(n + 0.5)} return 0.
12951Calc consults knowledge of its own built-in functions as well as your
12952own declarations: @samp{dint(floor(x))} returns 1.
12953
12954@ignore
12955@starindex
12956@end ignore
12957@tindex dint
12958@ignore
12959@starindex
12960@end ignore
12961@tindex dnumint
12962@ignore
12963@starindex
12964@end ignore
12965@tindex dnatnum
12966The @code{dint} function checks if its argument is an integer.
12967The @code{dnatnum} function checks if its argument is a natural
12968number, i.e., a nonnegative integer. The @code{dnumint} function
12969checks if its argument is numerically an integer, i.e., either an
12970integer or an integer-valued float. Note that these and the other
12971data type functions also accept vectors or matrices composed of
12972suitable elements, and that real infinities @samp{inf} and @samp{-inf}
12973are considered to be integers for the purposes of these functions.
12974
12975@ignore
12976@starindex
12977@end ignore
12978@tindex drat
12979The @code{drat} function checks if its argument is rational, i.e.,
12980an integer or fraction. Infinities count as rational, but intervals
12981and error forms do not.
12982
12983@ignore
12984@starindex
12985@end ignore
12986@tindex dreal
12987The @code{dreal} function checks if its argument is real. This
12988includes integers, fractions, floats, real error forms, and intervals.
12989
12990@ignore
12991@starindex
12992@end ignore
12993@tindex dimag
12994The @code{dimag} function checks if its argument is imaginary,
12995i.e., is mathematically equal to a real number times @expr{i}.
12996
12997@ignore
12998@starindex
12999@end ignore
13000@tindex dpos
13001@ignore
13002@starindex
13003@end ignore
13004@tindex dneg
13005@ignore
13006@starindex
13007@end ignore
13008@tindex dnonneg
13009The @code{dpos} function checks for positive (but nonzero) reals.
13010The @code{dneg} function checks for negative reals. The @code{dnonneg}
13011function checks for nonnegative reals, i.e., reals greater than or
13012equal to zero. Note that the @kbd{a s} command can simplify an
13013expression like @expr{x > 0} to 1 or 0 using @code{dpos}, and that
13014@kbd{a s} is effectively applied to all conditions in rewrite rules,
13015so the actual functions @code{dpos}, @code{dneg}, and @code{dnonneg}
13016are rarely necessary.
13017
13018@ignore
13019@starindex
13020@end ignore
13021@tindex dnonzero
13022The @code{dnonzero} function checks that its argument is nonzero.
13023This includes all nonzero real or complex numbers, all intervals that
13024do not include zero, all nonzero modulo forms, vectors all of whose
13025elements are nonzero, and variables or formulas whose values can be
13026deduced to be nonzero. It does not include error forms, since they
13027represent values which could be anything including zero. (This is
13028also the set of objects considered ``true'' in conditional contexts.)
13029
13030@ignore
13031@starindex
13032@end ignore
13033@tindex deven
13034@ignore
13035@starindex
13036@end ignore
13037@tindex dodd
13038The @code{deven} function returns 1 if its argument is known to be
13039an even integer (or integer-valued float); it returns 0 if its argument
13040is known not to be even (because it is known to be odd or a non-integer).
13041The @kbd{a s} command uses this to simplify a test of the form
13042@samp{x % 2 = 0}. There is also an analogous @code{dodd} function.
13043
13044@ignore
13045@starindex
13046@end ignore
13047@tindex drange
13048The @code{drange} function returns a set (an interval or a vector
13049of intervals and/or numbers; @pxref{Set Operations}) that describes
13050the set of possible values of its argument. If the argument is
13051a variable or a function with a declaration, the range is copied
13052from the declaration. Otherwise, the possible signs of the
13053expression are determined using a method similar to @code{dpos},
13054etc., and a suitable set like @samp{[0 .. inf]} is returned. If
13055the expression is not provably real, the @code{drange} function
13056remains unevaluated.
13057
13058@ignore
13059@starindex
13060@end ignore
13061@tindex dscalar
13062The @code{dscalar} function returns 1 if its argument is provably
13063scalar, or 0 if its argument is provably non-scalar. It is left
13064unevaluated if this cannot be determined. (If Matrix mode or Scalar
13065mode is in effect, this function returns 1 or 0, respectively,
13066if it has no other information.) When Calc interprets a condition
13067(say, in a rewrite rule) it considers an unevaluated formula to be
13068``false.'' Thus, @samp{dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a} is
13069provably scalar, and @samp{!dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a}
13070is provably non-scalar; both are ``false'' if there is insufficient
13071information to tell.
13072
13073@node Display Modes, Language Modes, Declarations, Mode Settings
13074@section Display Modes
13075
13076@noindent
13077The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with the
13078@kbd{d} prefix. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) and @kbd{d b}
13079(@code{calc-line-breaking}) commands are described elsewhere;
13080@pxref{Stack Basics} and @pxref{Normal Language Modes}, respectively.
13081Display formats for vectors and matrices are also covered elsewhere;
13082@pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
13083
13084One thing all display modes have in common is their treatment of the
13085@kbd{H} prefix. This prefix causes any mode command that would normally
13086refresh the stack to leave the stack display alone. The word ``Dirty''
13087will appear in the mode line when Calc thinks the stack display may not
13088reflect the latest mode settings.
13089
13090@kindex d @key{RET}
13091@pindex calc-refresh-top
13092The @kbd{d @key{RET}} (@code{calc-refresh-top}) command reformats the
13093top stack entry according to all the current modes. Positive prefix
13094arguments reformat the top @var{n} entries; negative prefix arguments
13095reformat the specified entry, and a prefix of zero is equivalent to
13096@kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}), which reformats the entire stack.
13097For example, @kbd{H d s M-2 d @key{RET}} changes to scientific notation
13098but reformats only the top two stack entries in the new mode.
13099
13100The @kbd{I} prefix has another effect on the display modes. The mode
13101is set only temporarily; the top stack entry is reformatted according
13102to that mode, then the original mode setting is restored. In other
13103words, @kbd{I d s} is equivalent to @kbd{H d s d @key{RET} H d (@var{old mode})}.
13104
13105@menu
13106* Radix Modes::
13107* Grouping Digits::
13108* Float Formats::
13109* Complex Formats::
13110* Fraction Formats::
13111* HMS Formats::
13112* Date Formats::
13113* Truncating the Stack::
13114* Justification::
13115* Labels::
13116@end menu
13117
13118@node Radix Modes, Grouping Digits, Display Modes, Display Modes
13119@subsection Radix Modes
13120
13121@noindent
13122@cindex Radix display
13123@cindex Non-decimal numbers
13124@cindex Decimal and non-decimal numbers
13125Calc normally displays numbers in decimal (@dfn{base-10} or @dfn{radix-10})
13126notation. Calc can actually display in any radix from two (binary) to 36.
13127When the radix is above 10, the letters @code{A} to @code{Z} are used as
13128digits. When entering such a number, letter keys are interpreted as
13129potential digits rather than terminating numeric entry mode.
13130
13131@kindex d 2
13132@kindex d 8
13133@kindex d 6
13134@kindex d 0
13135@cindex Hexadecimal integers
13136@cindex Octal integers
13137The key sequences @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, @kbd{d 6}, and @kbd{d 0} select
13138binary, octal, hexadecimal, and decimal as the current display radix,
13139respectively. Numbers can always be entered in any radix, though the
13140current radix is used as a default if you press @kbd{#} without any initial
13141digits. A number entered without a @kbd{#} is @emph{always} interpreted
13142as decimal.
13143
13144@kindex d r
13145@pindex calc-radix
13146To set the radix generally, use @kbd{d r} (@code{calc-radix}) and enter
13147an integer from 2 to 36. You can specify the radix as a numeric prefix
13148argument; otherwise you will be prompted for it.
13149
13150@kindex d z
13151@pindex calc-leading-zeros
13152@cindex Leading zeros
13153Integers normally are displayed with however many digits are necessary to
13154represent the integer and no more. The @kbd{d z} (@code{calc-leading-zeros})
13155command causes integers to be padded out with leading zeros according to the
13156current binary word size. (@xref{Binary Functions}, for a discussion of
13157word size.) If the absolute value of the word size is @expr{w}, all integers
13158are displayed with at least enough digits to represent
13159@texline @math{2^w-1}
13160@infoline @expr{(2^w)-1}
13161in the current radix. (Larger integers will still be displayed in their
13162entirety.)
13163
0e983327 13164@cindex Two's complements
f8b91752
JB
13165Calc can display @expr{w}-bit integers using two's complement
13166notation, although this is most useful with the binary, octal and
13167hexadecimal display modes. This option is selected by using the
13168@kbd{O} option prefix before setting the display radix, and a negative word
13169size might be appropriate (@pxref{Binary Functions}). In two's
13170complement notation, the integers in the (nearly) symmetric interval
13171from
17291a1f
JB
13172@texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13173@infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
13174to
13175@texline @math{2^{w-1}-1}
13176@infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1}
0e983327 13177are represented by the integers from @expr{0} to @expr{2^w-1}:
5ea5dbc9 13178the integers from @expr{0} to
17291a1f
JB
13179@texline @math{2^{w-1}-1}
13180@infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1}
0e983327 13181are represented by themselves and the integers from
17291a1f
JB
13182@texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13183@infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
0e983327 13184to @expr{-1} are represented by the integers from
17291a1f
JB
13185@texline @math{2^{w-1}}
13186@infoline @expr{2^(w-1)}
0e983327
JB
13187to @expr{2^w-1} (the integer @expr{k} is represented by @expr{k+2^w}).
13188Calc will display a two's complement integer by the radix (either
13189@expr{2}, @expr{8} or @expr{16}), two @kbd{#} symbols, and then its
13190representation (including any leading zeros necessary to include all
13191@expr{w} bits). In a two's complement display mode, numbers that
13192are not displayed in two's complement notation (i.e., that aren't
13193integers from
17291a1f
JB
13194@texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13195@infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
5ea5dbc9 13196to
17291a1f
JB
13197@c (
13198@texline @math{2^{w-1}-1})
13199@infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1})
5ea5dbc9
JB
13200will be represented using Calc's usual notation (in the appropriate
13201radix).
17291a1f 13202
4009494e
GM
13203@node Grouping Digits, Float Formats, Radix Modes, Display Modes
13204@subsection Grouping Digits
13205
13206@noindent
13207@kindex d g
13208@pindex calc-group-digits
13209@cindex Grouping digits
13210@cindex Digit grouping
13211Long numbers can be hard to read if they have too many digits. For
13212example, the factorial of 30 is 33 digits long! Press @kbd{d g}
13213(@code{calc-group-digits}) to enable @dfn{Grouping} mode, in which digits
13214are displayed in clumps of 3 or 4 (depending on the current radix)
13215separated by commas.
13216
13217The @kbd{d g} command toggles grouping on and off.
13218With a numeric prefix of 0, this command displays the current state of
13219the grouping flag; with an argument of minus one it disables grouping;
13220with a positive argument @expr{N} it enables grouping on every @expr{N}
13221digits. For floating-point numbers, grouping normally occurs only
13222before the decimal point. A negative prefix argument @expr{-N} enables
13223grouping every @expr{N} digits both before and after the decimal point.
13224
13225@kindex d ,
13226@pindex calc-group-char
13227The @kbd{d ,} (@code{calc-group-char}) command allows you to choose any
13228character as the grouping separator. The default is the comma character.
13229If you find it difficult to read vectors of large integers grouped with
13230commas, you may wish to use spaces or some other character instead.
13231This command takes the next character you type, whatever it is, and
13232uses it as the digit separator. As a special case, @kbd{d , \} selects
13233@samp{\,} (@TeX{}'s thin-space symbol) as the digit separator.
13234
13235Please note that grouped numbers will not generally be parsed correctly
13236if re-read in textual form, say by the use of @kbd{C-x * y} and @kbd{C-x * g}.
13237(@xref{Kill and Yank}, for details on these commands.) One exception is
13238the @samp{\,} separator, which doesn't interfere with parsing because it
13239is ignored by @TeX{} language mode.
13240
13241@node Float Formats, Complex Formats, Grouping Digits, Display Modes
13242@subsection Float Formats
13243
13244@noindent
13245Floating-point quantities are normally displayed in standard decimal
13246form, with scientific notation used if the exponent is especially high
13247or low. All significant digits are normally displayed. The commands
13248in this section allow you to choose among several alternative display
13249formats for floats.
13250
13251@kindex d n
13252@pindex calc-normal-notation
13253The @kbd{d n} (@code{calc-normal-notation}) command selects the normal
13254display format. All significant figures in a number are displayed.
13255With a positive numeric prefix, numbers are rounded if necessary to
13256that number of significant digits. With a negative numerix prefix,
13257the specified number of significant digits less than the current
13258precision is used. (Thus @kbd{C-u -2 d n} displays 10 digits if the
13259current precision is 12.)
13260
13261@kindex d f
13262@pindex calc-fix-notation
13263The @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation}) command selects fixed-point
13264notation. The numeric argument is the number of digits after the
13265decimal point, zero or more. This format will relax into scientific
13266notation if a nonzero number would otherwise have been rounded all the
13267way to zero. Specifying a negative number of digits is the same as
13268for a positive number, except that small nonzero numbers will be rounded
13269to zero rather than switching to scientific notation.
13270
13271@kindex d s
13272@pindex calc-sci-notation
13273@cindex Scientific notation, display of
13274The @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}) command selects scientific
13275notation. A positive argument sets the number of significant figures
13276displayed, of which one will be before and the rest after the decimal
13277point. A negative argument works the same as for @kbd{d n} format.
13278The default is to display all significant digits.
13279
13280@kindex d e
13281@pindex calc-eng-notation
13282@cindex Engineering notation, display of
13283The @kbd{d e} (@code{calc-eng-notation}) command selects engineering
13284notation. This is similar to scientific notation except that the
13285exponent is rounded down to a multiple of three, with from one to three
13286digits before the decimal point. An optional numeric prefix sets the
13287number of significant digits to display, as for @kbd{d s}.
13288
13289It is important to distinguish between the current @emph{precision} and
13290the current @emph{display format}. After the commands @kbd{C-u 10 p}
13291and @kbd{C-u 6 d n} the Calculator computes all results to ten
13292significant figures but displays only six. (In fact, intermediate
13293calculations are often carried to one or two more significant figures,
13294but values placed on the stack will be rounded down to ten figures.)
13295Numbers are never actually rounded to the display precision for storage,
13296except by commands like @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-x * y} which operate on the
13297actual displayed text in the Calculator buffer.
13298
13299@kindex d .
13300@pindex calc-point-char
13301The @kbd{d .} (@code{calc-point-char}) command selects the character used
13302as a decimal point. Normally this is a period; users in some countries
13303may wish to change this to a comma. Note that this is only a display
13304style; on entry, periods must always be used to denote floating-point
13305numbers, and commas to separate elements in a list.
13306
13307@node Complex Formats, Fraction Formats, Float Formats, Display Modes
13308@subsection Complex Formats
13309
13310@noindent
13311@kindex d c
13312@pindex calc-complex-notation
13313There are three supported notations for complex numbers in rectangular
13314form. The default is as a pair of real numbers enclosed in parentheses
13315and separated by a comma: @samp{(a,b)}. The @kbd{d c}
13316(@code{calc-complex-notation}) command selects this style.
13317
13318@kindex d i
13319@pindex calc-i-notation
13320@kindex d j
13321@pindex calc-j-notation
13322The other notations are @kbd{d i} (@code{calc-i-notation}), in which
13323numbers are displayed in @samp{a+bi} form, and @kbd{d j}
13324(@code{calc-j-notation}) which displays the form @samp{a+bj} preferred
13325in some disciplines.
13326
13327@cindex @code{i} variable
13328@vindex i
13329Complex numbers are normally entered in @samp{(a,b)} format.
13330If you enter @samp{2+3i} as an algebraic formula, it will be stored as
13331the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i}. However, if you use @kbd{=} to evaluate
13332this formula and you have not changed the variable @samp{i}, the @samp{i}
13333will be interpreted as @samp{(0,1)} and the formula will be simplified
13334to @samp{(2,3)}. Other commands (like @code{calc-sin}) will @emph{not}
13335interpret the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i} as a complex number.
13336@xref{Variables}, under ``special constants.''
13337
13338@node Fraction Formats, HMS Formats, Complex Formats, Display Modes
13339@subsection Fraction Formats
13340
13341@noindent
13342@kindex d o
13343@pindex calc-over-notation
13344Display of fractional numbers is controlled by the @kbd{d o}
13345(@code{calc-over-notation}) command. By default, a number like
13346eight thirds is displayed in the form @samp{8:3}. The @kbd{d o} command
13347prompts for a one- or two-character format. If you give one character,
13348that character is used as the fraction separator. Common separators are
13349@samp{:} and @samp{/}. (During input of numbers, the @kbd{:} key must be
13350used regardless of the display format; in particular, the @kbd{/} is used
13351for RPN-style division, @emph{not} for entering fractions.)
13352
13353If you give two characters, fractions use ``integer-plus-fractional-part''
13354notation. For example, the format @samp{+/} would display eight thirds
13355as @samp{2+2/3}. If two colons are present in a number being entered,
13356the number is interpreted in this form (so that the entries @kbd{2:2:3}
13357and @kbd{8:3} are equivalent).
13358
13359It is also possible to follow the one- or two-character format with
13360a number. For example: @samp{:10} or @samp{+/3}. In this case,
13361Calc adjusts all fractions that are displayed to have the specified
13362denominator, if possible. Otherwise it adjusts the denominator to
13363be a multiple of the specified value. For example, in @samp{:6} mode
13364the fraction @expr{1:6} will be unaffected, but @expr{2:3} will be
13365displayed as @expr{4:6}, @expr{1:2} will be displayed as @expr{3:6},
13366and @expr{1:8} will be displayed as @expr{3:24}. Integers are also
13367affected by this mode: 3 is displayed as @expr{18:6}. Note that the
13368format @samp{:1} writes fractions the same as @samp{:}, but it writes
13369integers as @expr{n:1}.
13370
13371The fraction format does not affect the way fractions or integers are
13372stored, only the way they appear on the screen. The fraction format
13373never affects floats.
13374
13375@node HMS Formats, Date Formats, Fraction Formats, Display Modes
13376@subsection HMS Formats
13377
13378@noindent
13379@kindex d h
13380@pindex calc-hms-notation
13381The @kbd{d h} (@code{calc-hms-notation}) command controls the display of
13382HMS (hours-minutes-seconds) forms. It prompts for a string which
13383consists basically of an ``hours'' marker, optional punctuation, a
13384``minutes'' marker, more optional punctuation, and a ``seconds'' marker.
13385Punctuation is zero or more spaces, commas, or semicolons. The hours
13386marker is one or more non-punctuation characters. The minutes and
13387seconds markers must be single non-punctuation characters.
13388
13389The default HMS format is @samp{@@ ' "}, producing HMS values of the form
13390@samp{23@@ 30' 15.75"}. The format @samp{deg, ms} would display this same
13391value as @samp{23deg, 30m15.75s}. During numeric entry, the @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}
13392keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{@@} regardless of display format.
13393The @kbd{m} and @kbd{s} keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{'} and
13394@kbd{"}, respectively, but only if an @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}) has
13395already been typed; otherwise, they have their usual meanings
13396(@kbd{m-} prefix and @kbd{s-} prefix). Thus, @kbd{5 "}, @kbd{0 @@ 5 "}, and
13397@kbd{0 h 5 s} are some of the ways to enter the quantity ``five seconds.''
13398The @kbd{'} key is recognized as ``minutes'' only if @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or
13399@kbd{o}) has already been pressed; otherwise it means to switch to algebraic
13400entry.
13401
13402@node Date Formats, Truncating the Stack, HMS Formats, Display Modes
13403@subsection Date Formats
13404
13405@noindent
13406@kindex d d
13407@pindex calc-date-notation
13408The @kbd{d d} (@code{calc-date-notation}) command controls the display
13409of date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). It prompts for a string which
13410contains letters that represent the various parts of a date and time.
13411To show which parts should be omitted when the form represents a pure
13412date with no time, parts of the string can be enclosed in @samp{< >}
13413marks. If you don't include @samp{< >} markers in the format, Calc
13414guesses at which parts, if any, should be omitted when formatting
13415pure dates.
13416
13417The default format is: @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY}.
13418An example string in this format is @samp{3:32pm Wed Jan 9, 1991}.
13419If you enter a blank format string, this default format is
13420reestablished.
13421
13422Calc uses @samp{< >} notation for nameless functions as well as for
13423dates. @xref{Specifying Operators}. To avoid confusion with nameless
13424functions, your date formats should avoid using the @samp{#} character.
13425
13426@menu
13427* Date Formatting Codes::
13428* Free-Form Dates::
13429* Standard Date Formats::
13430@end menu
13431
13432@node Date Formatting Codes, Free-Form Dates, Date Formats, Date Formats
13433@subsubsection Date Formatting Codes
13434
13435@noindent
13436When displaying a date, the current date format is used. All
13437characters except for letters and @samp{<} and @samp{>} are
13438copied literally when dates are formatted. The portion between
13439@samp{< >} markers is omitted for pure dates, or included for
13440date/time forms. Letters are interpreted according to the table
13441below.
13442
13443When dates are read in during algebraic entry, Calc first tries to
13444match the input string to the current format either with or without
13445the time part. The punctuation characters (including spaces) must
13446match exactly; letter fields must correspond to suitable text in
13447the input. If this doesn't work, Calc checks if the input is a
13448simple number; if so, the number is interpreted as a number of days
13449since Jan 1, 1 AD. Otherwise, Calc tries a much more relaxed and
13450flexible algorithm which is described in the next section.
13451
13452Weekday names are ignored during reading.
13453
13454Two-digit year numbers are interpreted as lying in the range
13455from 1941 to 2039. Years outside that range are always
13456entered and displayed in full. Year numbers with a leading
13457@samp{+} sign are always interpreted exactly, allowing the
13458entry and display of the years 1 through 99 AD.
13459
13460Here is a complete list of the formatting codes for dates:
13461
13462@table @asis
13463@item Y
13464Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13465@item YY
13466Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``07'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13467@item BY
13468Year: ``91'' for 1991, `` 7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13469@item YYY
13470Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``23'' for 23 AD.
13471@item YYYY
13472Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13473@item aa
13474Year: ``ad'' or blank.
13475@item AA
13476Year: ``AD'' or blank.
13477@item aaa
13478Year: ``ad '' or blank. (Note trailing space.)
13479@item AAA
13480Year: ``AD '' or blank.
13481@item aaaa
13482Year: ``a.d.'' or blank.
13483@item AAAA
13484Year: ``A.D.'' or blank.
13485@item bb
13486Year: ``bc'' or blank.
13487@item BB
13488Year: ``BC'' or blank.
13489@item bbb
13490Year: `` bc'' or blank. (Note leading space.)
13491@item BBB
13492Year: `` BC'' or blank.
13493@item bbbb
13494Year: ``b.c.'' or blank.
13495@item BBBB
13496Year: ``B.C.'' or blank.
13497@item M
13498Month: ``8'' for August.
13499@item MM
13500Month: ``08'' for August.
13501@item BM
13502Month: `` 8'' for August.
13503@item MMM
13504Month: ``AUG'' for August.
13505@item Mmm
13506Month: ``Aug'' for August.
13507@item mmm
13508Month: ``aug'' for August.
13509@item MMMM
13510Month: ``AUGUST'' for August.
13511@item Mmmm
13512Month: ``August'' for August.
13513@item D
13514Day: ``7'' for 7th day of month.
13515@item DD
13516Day: ``07'' for 7th day of month.
13517@item BD
13518Day: `` 7'' for 7th day of month.
13519@item W
13520Weekday: ``0'' for Sunday, ``6'' for Saturday.
13521@item WWW
13522Weekday: ``SUN'' for Sunday.
13523@item Www
13524Weekday: ``Sun'' for Sunday.
13525@item www
13526Weekday: ``sun'' for Sunday.
13527@item WWWW
13528Weekday: ``SUNDAY'' for Sunday.
13529@item Wwww
13530Weekday: ``Sunday'' for Sunday.
13531@item d
13532Day of year: ``34'' for Feb. 3.
13533@item ddd
13534Day of year: ``034'' for Feb. 3.
13535@item bdd
13536Day of year: `` 34'' for Feb. 3.
13537@item h
13538Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13539@item hh
13540Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13541@item bh
13542Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13543@item H
13544Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13545@item HH
13546Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13547@item BH
13548Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13549@item p
13550AM/PM: ``a'' or ``p''.
13551@item P
13552AM/PM: ``A'' or ``P''.
13553@item pp
13554AM/PM: ``am'' or ``pm''.
13555@item PP
13556AM/PM: ``AM'' or ``PM''.
13557@item pppp
13558AM/PM: ``a.m.'' or ``p.m.''.
13559@item PPPP
13560AM/PM: ``A.M.'' or ``P.M.''.
13561@item m
13562Minutes: ``7'' for 7.
13563@item mm
13564Minutes: ``07'' for 7.
13565@item bm
13566Minutes: `` 7'' for 7.
13567@item s
13568Seconds: ``7'' for 7; ``7.23'' for 7.23.
13569@item ss
13570Seconds: ``07'' for 7; ``07.23'' for 7.23.
13571@item bs
13572Seconds: `` 7'' for 7; `` 7.23'' for 7.23.
13573@item SS
13574Optional seconds: ``07'' for 7; blank for 0.
13575@item BS
13576Optional seconds: `` 7'' for 7; blank for 0.
13577@item N
13578Numeric date/time: ``726842.25'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13579@item n
13580Numeric date: ``726842'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13581@item J
13582Julian date/time: ``2448265.75'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13583@item j
13584Julian date: ``2448266'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13585@item U
13586Unix time: ``663400800'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13587@item X
13588Brackets suppression. An ``X'' at the front of the format
13589causes the surrounding @w{@samp{< >}} delimiters to be omitted
13590when formatting dates. Note that the brackets are still
13591required for algebraic entry.
13592@end table
13593
13594If ``SS'' or ``BS'' (optional seconds) is preceded by a colon, the
13595colon is also omitted if the seconds part is zero.
13596
13597If ``bb,'' ``bbb'' or ``bbbb'' or their upper-case equivalents
13598appear in the format, then negative year numbers are displayed
13599without a minus sign. Note that ``aa'' and ``bb'' are mutually
13600exclusive. Some typical usages would be @samp{YYYY AABB};
13601@samp{AAAYYYYBBB}; @samp{YYYYBBB}.
13602
13603The formats ``YY,'' ``YYYY,'' ``MM,'' ``DD,'' ``ddd,'' ``hh,'' ``HH,''
13604``mm,'' ``ss,'' and ``SS'' actually match any number of digits during
13605reading unless several of these codes are strung together with no
13606punctuation in between, in which case the input must have exactly as
13607many digits as there are letters in the format.
13608
13609The ``j,'' ``J,'' and ``U'' formats do not make any time zone
13610adjustment. They effectively use @samp{julian(x,0)} and
13611@samp{unixtime(x,0)} to make the conversion; @pxref{Date Arithmetic}.
13612
13613@node Free-Form Dates, Standard Date Formats, Date Formatting Codes, Date Formats
13614@subsubsection Free-Form Dates
13615
13616@noindent
13617When reading a date form during algebraic entry, Calc falls back
13618on the algorithm described here if the input does not exactly
13619match the current date format. This algorithm generally
13620``does the right thing'' and you don't have to worry about it,
13621but it is described here in full detail for the curious.
13622
13623Calc does not distinguish between upper- and lower-case letters
13624while interpreting dates.
13625
13626First, the time portion, if present, is located somewhere in the
13627text and then removed. The remaining text is then interpreted as
13628the date.
13629
13630A time is of the form @samp{hh:mm:ss}, possibly with the seconds
13631part omitted and possibly with an AM/PM indicator added to indicate
1363212-hour time. If the AM/PM is present, the minutes may also be
13633omitted. The AM/PM part may be any of the words @samp{am},
13634@samp{pm}, @samp{noon}, or @samp{midnight}; each of these may be
13635abbreviated to one letter, and the alternate forms @samp{a.m.},
13636@samp{p.m.}, and @samp{mid} are also understood. Obviously
13637@samp{noon} and @samp{midnight} are allowed only on 12:00:00.
13638The words @samp{noon}, @samp{mid}, and @samp{midnight} are also
13639recognized with no number attached.
13640
13641If there is no AM/PM indicator, the time is interpreted in 24-hour
13642format.
13643
13644To read the date portion, all words and numbers are isolated
13645from the string; other characters are ignored. All words must
13646be either month names or day-of-week names (the latter of which
13647are ignored). Names can be written in full or as three-letter
13648abbreviations.
13649
13650Large numbers, or numbers with @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
13651are interpreted as years. If one of the other numbers is
13652greater than 12, then that must be the day and the remaining
13653number in the input is therefore the month. Otherwise, Calc
13654assumes the month, day and year are in the same order that they
13655appear in the current date format. If the year is omitted, the
13656current year is taken from the system clock.
13657
13658If there are too many or too few numbers, or any unrecognizable
13659words, then the input is rejected.
13660
13661If there are any large numbers (of five digits or more) other than
13662the year, they are ignored on the assumption that they are something
13663like Julian dates that were included along with the traditional
13664date components when the date was formatted.
13665
13666One of the words @samp{ad}, @samp{a.d.}, @samp{bc}, or @samp{b.c.}
13667may optionally be used; the latter two are equivalent to a
13668minus sign on the year value.
13669
13670If you always enter a four-digit year, and use a name instead
13671of a number for the month, there is no danger of ambiguity.
13672
13673@node Standard Date Formats, , Free-Form Dates, Date Formats
13674@subsubsection Standard Date Formats
13675
13676@noindent
13677There are actually ten standard date formats, numbered 0 through 9.
13678Entering a blank line at the @kbd{d d} command's prompt gives
13679you format number 1, Calc's usual format. You can enter any digit
13680to select the other formats.
13681
13682To create your own standard date formats, give a numeric prefix
13683argument from 0 to 9 to the @w{@kbd{d d}} command. The format you
13684enter will be recorded as the new standard format of that
13685number, as well as becoming the new current date format.
13686You can save your formats permanently with the @w{@kbd{m m}}
13687command (@pxref{Mode Settings}).
13688
13689@table @asis
13690@item 0
13691@samp{N} (Numerical format)
13692@item 1
13693@samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY} (American format)
13694@item 2
13695@samp{D Mmm YYYY<, h:mm:SS>} (European format)
13696@item 3
13697@samp{Www Mmm BD< hh:mm:ss> YYYY} (Unix written date format)
13698@item 4
13699@samp{M/D/Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American slashed format)
13700@item 5
13701@samp{D.M.Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dotted format)
13702@item 6
13703@samp{M-D-Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American dashed format)
13704@item 7
13705@samp{D-M-Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dashed format)
13706@item 8
13707@samp{j<, h:mm:ss>} (Julian day plus time)
13708@item 9
13709@samp{YYddd< hh:mm:ss>} (Year-day format)
13710@end table
13711
13712@node Truncating the Stack, Justification, Date Formats, Display Modes
13713@subsection Truncating the Stack
13714
13715@noindent
13716@kindex d t
13717@pindex calc-truncate-stack
13718@cindex Truncating the stack
13719@cindex Narrowing the stack
13720The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack}) command moves the @samp{.}@:
13721line that marks the top-of-stack up or down in the Calculator buffer.
13722The number right above that line is considered to the be at the top of
13723the stack. Any numbers below that line are ``hidden'' from all stack
13724operations (although still visible to the user). This is similar to the
13725Emacs ``narrowing'' feature, except that the values below the @samp{.}
13726are @emph{visible}, just temporarily frozen. This feature allows you to
13727keep several independent calculations running at once in different parts
13728of the stack, or to apply a certain command to an element buried deep in
13729the stack.
13730
13731Pressing @kbd{d t} by itself moves the @samp{.} to the line the cursor
13732is on. Thus, this line and all those below it become hidden. To un-hide
13733these lines, move down to the end of the buffer and press @w{@kbd{d t}}.
13734With a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{n}, @kbd{d t} hides the
13735bottom @expr{n} values in the buffer. With a negative argument, it hides
13736all but the top @expr{n} values. With an argument of zero, it hides zero
13737values, i.e., moves the @samp{.} all the way down to the bottom.
13738
13739@kindex d [
13740@pindex calc-truncate-up
13741@kindex d ]
13742@pindex calc-truncate-down
13743The @kbd{d [} (@code{calc-truncate-up}) and @kbd{d ]}
13744(@code{calc-truncate-down}) commands move the @samp{.} up or down one
13745line at a time (or several lines with a prefix argument).
13746
13747@node Justification, Labels, Truncating the Stack, Display Modes
13748@subsection Justification
13749
13750@noindent
13751@kindex d <
13752@pindex calc-left-justify
13753@kindex d =
13754@pindex calc-center-justify
13755@kindex d >
13756@pindex calc-right-justify
13757Values on the stack are normally left-justified in the window. You can
13758control this arrangement by typing @kbd{d <} (@code{calc-left-justify}),
13759@kbd{d >} (@code{calc-right-justify}), or @kbd{d =}
13760(@code{calc-center-justify}). For example, in Right-Justification mode,
13761stack entries are displayed flush-right against the right edge of the
13762window.
13763
13764If you change the width of the Calculator window you may have to type
13765@kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}) to re-align right-justified or centered
13766text.
13767
13768Right-justification is especially useful together with fixed-point
13769notation (see @code{d f}; @code{calc-fix-notation}). With these modes
13770together, the decimal points on numbers will always line up.
13771
13772With a numeric prefix argument, the justification commands give you
13773a little extra control over the display. The argument specifies the
13774horizontal ``origin'' of a display line. It is also possible to
13775specify a maximum line width using the @kbd{d b} command (@pxref{Normal
13776Language Modes}). For reference, the precise rules for formatting and
13777breaking lines are given below. Notice that the interaction between
13778origin and line width is slightly different in each justification
13779mode.
13780
13781In Left-Justified mode, the line is indented by a number of spaces
13782given by the origin (default zero). If the result is longer than the
13783maximum line width, if given, or too wide to fit in the Calc window
13784otherwise, then it is broken into lines which will fit; each broken
13785line is indented to the origin.
13786
13787In Right-Justified mode, lines are shifted right so that the rightmost
13788character is just before the origin, or just before the current
13789window width if no origin was specified. If the line is too long
13790for this, then it is broken; the current line width is used, if
13791specified, or else the origin is used as a width if that is
13792specified, or else the line is broken to fit in the window.
13793
13794In Centering mode, the origin is the column number of the center of
13795each stack entry. If a line width is specified, lines will not be
13796allowed to go past that width; Calc will either indent less or
13797break the lines if necessary. If no origin is specified, half the
13798line width or Calc window width is used.
13799
13800Note that, in each case, if line numbering is enabled the display
13801is indented an additional four spaces to make room for the line
13802number. The width of the line number is taken into account when
13803positioning according to the current Calc window width, but not
13804when positioning by explicit origins and widths. In the latter
13805case, the display is formatted as specified, and then uniformly
13806shifted over four spaces to fit the line numbers.
13807
13808@node Labels, , Justification, Display Modes
13809@subsection Labels
13810
13811@noindent
13812@kindex d @{
13813@pindex calc-left-label
13814The @kbd{d @{} (@code{calc-left-label}) command prompts for a string,
13815then displays that string to the left of every stack entry. If the
13816entries are left-justified (@pxref{Justification}), then they will
13817appear immediately after the label (unless you specified an origin
13818greater than the length of the label). If the entries are centered
13819or right-justified, the label appears on the far left and does not
13820affect the horizontal position of the stack entry.
13821
13822Give a blank string (with @kbd{d @{ @key{RET}}) to turn the label off.
13823
13824@kindex d @}
13825@pindex calc-right-label
13826The @kbd{d @}} (@code{calc-right-label}) command similarly adds a
13827label on the righthand side. It does not affect positioning of
13828the stack entries unless they are right-justified. Also, if both
13829a line width and an origin are given in Right-Justified mode, the
13830stack entry is justified to the origin and the righthand label is
13831justified to the line width.
13832
13833One application of labels would be to add equation numbers to
13834formulas you are manipulating in Calc and then copying into a
13835document (possibly using Embedded mode). The equations would
13836typically be centered, and the equation numbers would be on the
13837left or right as you prefer.
13838
13839@node Language Modes, Modes Variable, Display Modes, Mode Settings
13840@section Language Modes
13841
13842@noindent
13843The commands in this section change Calc to use a different notation for
13844entry and display of formulas, corresponding to the conventions of some
13845other common language such as Pascal or La@TeX{}. Objects displayed on the
13846stack or yanked from the Calculator to an editing buffer will be formatted
13847in the current language; objects entered in algebraic entry or yanked from
13848another buffer will be interpreted according to the current language.
13849
13850The current language has no effect on things written to or read from the
13851trail buffer, nor does it affect numeric entry. Only algebraic entry is
13852affected. You can make even algebraic entry ignore the current language
13853and use the standard notation by giving a numeric prefix, e.g., @kbd{C-u '}.
13854
13855For example, suppose the formula @samp{2*a[1] + atan(a[2])} occurs in a C
13856program; elsewhere in the program you need the derivatives of this formula
13857with respect to @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}. First, type @kbd{d C}
13858to switch to C notation. Now use @code{C-u C-x * g} to grab the formula
13859into the Calculator, @kbd{a d a[1] @key{RET}} to differentiate with respect
13860to the first variable, and @kbd{C-x * y} to yank the formula for the derivative
13861back into your C program. Press @kbd{U} to undo the differentiation and
13862repeat with @kbd{a d a[2] @key{RET}} for the other derivative.
13863
13864Without being switched into C mode first, Calc would have misinterpreted
13865the brackets in @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}, would not have known that
13866@code{atan} was equivalent to Calc's built-in @code{arctan} function,
13867and would have written the formula back with notations (like implicit
13868multiplication) which would not have been valid for a C program.
13869
13870As another example, suppose you are maintaining a C program and a La@TeX{}
13871document, each of which needs a copy of the same formula. You can grab the
13872formula from the program in C mode, switch to La@TeX{} mode, and yank the
13873formula into the document in La@TeX{} math-mode format.
13874
13875Language modes are selected by typing the letter @kbd{d} followed by a
13876shifted letter key.
13877
13878@menu
13879* Normal Language Modes::
13880* C FORTRAN Pascal::
13881* TeX and LaTeX Language Modes::
13882* Eqn Language Mode::
4e320733
JB
13883* Yacas Language Mode::
13884* Maxima Language Mode::
13885* Giac Language Mode::
4009494e
GM
13886* Mathematica Language Mode::
13887* Maple Language Mode::
13888* Compositions::
13889* Syntax Tables::
13890@end menu
13891
13892@node Normal Language Modes, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes, Language Modes
13893@subsection Normal Language Modes
13894
13895@noindent
13896@kindex d N
13897@pindex calc-normal-language
13898The @kbd{d N} (@code{calc-normal-language}) command selects the usual
13899notation for Calc formulas, as described in the rest of this manual.
13900Matrices are displayed in a multi-line tabular format, but all other
13901objects are written in linear form, as they would be typed from the
13902keyboard.
13903
13904@kindex d O
13905@pindex calc-flat-language
13906@cindex Matrix display
13907The @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) command selects a language
13908identical with the normal one, except that matrices are written in
13909one-line form along with everything else. In some applications this
13910form may be more suitable for yanking data into other buffers.
13911
13912@kindex d b
13913@pindex calc-line-breaking
13914@cindex Line breaking
13915@cindex Breaking up long lines
13916Even in one-line mode, long formulas or vectors will still be split
13917across multiple lines if they exceed the width of the Calculator window.
13918The @kbd{d b} (@code{calc-line-breaking}) command turns this line-breaking
13919feature on and off. (It works independently of the current language.)
13920If you give a numeric prefix argument of five or greater to the @kbd{d b}
13921command, that argument will specify the line width used when breaking
13922long lines.
13923
13924@kindex d B
13925@pindex calc-big-language
13926The @kbd{d B} (@code{calc-big-language}) command selects a language
13927which uses textual approximations to various mathematical notations,
13928such as powers, quotients, and square roots:
13929
13930@example
13931 ____________
13932 | a + 1 2
13933 | ----- + c
13934\| b
13935@end example
13936
13937@noindent
13938in place of @samp{sqrt((a+1)/b + c^2)}.
13939
13940Subscripts like @samp{a_i} are displayed as actual subscripts in Big
13941mode. Double subscripts, @samp{a_i_j} (@samp{subscr(subscr(a, i), j)})
13942are displayed as @samp{a} with subscripts separated by commas:
13943@samp{i, j}. They must still be entered in the usual underscore
13944notation.
13945
13946One slight ambiguity of Big notation is that
13947
13948@example
13949 3
13950- -
13951 4
13952@end example
13953
13954@noindent
13955can represent either the negative rational number @expr{-3:4}, or the
13956actual expression @samp{-(3/4)}; but the latter formula would normally
13957never be displayed because it would immediately be evaluated to
13958@expr{-3:4} or @expr{-0.75}, so this ambiguity is not a problem in
13959typical use.
13960
13961Non-decimal numbers are displayed with subscripts. Thus there is no
13962way to tell the difference between @samp{16#C2} and @samp{C2_16},
13963though generally you will know which interpretation is correct.
13964Logarithms @samp{log(x,b)} and @samp{log10(x)} also use subscripts
13965in Big mode.
13966
13967In Big mode, stack entries often take up several lines. To aid
13968readability, stack entries are separated by a blank line in this mode.
13969You may find it useful to expand the Calc window's height using
13970@kbd{C-x ^} (@code{enlarge-window}) or to make the Calc window the only
13971one on the screen with @kbd{C-x 1} (@code{delete-other-windows}).
13972
13973Long lines are currently not rearranged to fit the window width in
13974Big mode, so you may need to use the @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys
13975to scroll across a wide formula. For really big formulas, you may
13976even need to use @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} to scroll up and down.
13977
13978@kindex d U
13979@pindex calc-unformatted-language
13980The @kbd{d U} (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) command altogether disables
13981the use of operator notation in formulas. In this mode, the formula
13982shown above would be displayed:
13983
13984@example
13985sqrt(add(div(add(a, 1), b), pow(c, 2)))
13986@end example
13987
13988These four modes differ only in display format, not in the format
13989expected for algebraic entry. The standard Calc operators work in
13990all four modes, and unformatted notation works in any language mode
13991(except that Mathematica mode expects square brackets instead of
13992parentheses).
13993
13994@node C FORTRAN Pascal, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Normal Language Modes, Language Modes
13995@subsection C, FORTRAN, and Pascal Modes
13996
13997@noindent
13998@kindex d C
13999@pindex calc-c-language
14000@cindex C language
14001The @kbd{d C} (@code{calc-c-language}) command selects the conventions
14002of the C language for display and entry of formulas. This differs from
14003the normal language mode in a variety of (mostly minor) ways. In
14004particular, C language operators and operator precedences are used in
14005place of Calc's usual ones. For example, @samp{a^b} means @samp{xor(a,b)}
14006in C mode; a value raised to a power is written as a function call,
14007@samp{pow(a,b)}.
14008
14009In C mode, vectors and matrices use curly braces instead of brackets.
14010Octal and hexadecimal values are written with leading @samp{0} or @samp{0x}
14011rather than using the @samp{#} symbol. Array subscripting is
14012translated into @code{subscr} calls, so that @samp{a[i]} in C
14013mode is the same as @samp{a_i} in Normal mode. Assignments
14014turn into the @code{assign} function, which Calc normally displays
14015using the @samp{:=} symbol.
14016
14017The variables @code{pi} and @code{e} would be displayed @samp{pi}
14018and @samp{e} in Normal mode, but in C mode they are displayed as
14019@samp{M_PI} and @samp{M_E}, corresponding to the names of constants
14020typically provided in the @file{<math.h>} header. Functions whose
14021names are different in C are translated automatically for entry and
14022display purposes. For example, entering @samp{asin(x)} will push the
14023formula @samp{arcsin(x)} onto the stack; this formula will be displayed
14024as @samp{asin(x)} as long as C mode is in effect.
14025
14026@kindex d P
14027@pindex calc-pascal-language
14028@cindex Pascal language
14029The @kbd{d P} (@code{calc-pascal-language}) command selects Pascal
14030conventions. Like C mode, Pascal mode interprets array brackets and uses
14031a different table of operators. Hexadecimal numbers are entered and
14032displayed with a preceding dollar sign. (Thus the regular meaning of
14033@kbd{$2} during algebraic entry does not work in Pascal mode, though
14034@kbd{$} (and @kbd{$$}, etc.) not followed by digits works the same as
14035always.) No special provisions are made for other non-decimal numbers,
14036vectors, and so on, since there is no universally accepted standard way
14037of handling these in Pascal.
14038
14039@kindex d F
14040@pindex calc-fortran-language
14041@cindex FORTRAN language
14042The @kbd{d F} (@code{calc-fortran-language}) command selects FORTRAN
14043conventions. Various function names are transformed into FORTRAN
14044equivalents. Vectors are written as @samp{/1, 2, 3/}, and may be
14045entered this way or using square brackets. Since FORTRAN uses round
14046parentheses for both function calls and array subscripts, Calc displays
14047both in the same way; @samp{a(i)} is interpreted as a function call
14048upon reading, and subscripts must be entered as @samp{subscr(a, i)}.
702dbfd9
JB
14049If the variable @code{a} has been declared to have type
14050@code{vector} or @code{matrix}, however, then @samp{a(i)} will be
14051parsed as a subscript. (@xref{Declarations}.) Usually it doesn't
14052matter, though; if you enter the subscript expression @samp{a(i)} and
14053Calc interprets it as a function call, you'll never know the difference
14054unless you switch to another language mode or replace @code{a} with an
14055actual vector (or unless @code{a} happens to be the name of a built-in
4009494e
GM
14056function!).
14057
14058Underscores are allowed in variable and function names in all of these
14059language modes. The underscore here is equivalent to the @samp{#} in
14060Normal mode, or to hyphens in the underlying Emacs Lisp variable names.
14061
14062FORTRAN and Pascal modes normally do not adjust the case of letters in
14063formulas. Most built-in Calc names use lower-case letters. If you use a
14064positive numeric prefix argument with @kbd{d P} or @kbd{d F}, these
14065modes will use upper-case letters exclusively for display, and will
14066convert to lower-case on input. With a negative prefix, these modes
14067convert to lower-case for display and input.
14068
14069@node TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Eqn Language Mode, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes
14070@subsection @TeX{} and La@TeX{} Language Modes
14071
14072@noindent
14073@kindex d T
14074@pindex calc-tex-language
14075@cindex TeX language
14076@kindex d L
14077@pindex calc-latex-language
14078@cindex LaTeX language
14079The @kbd{d T} (@code{calc-tex-language}) command selects the conventions
14080of ``math mode'' in Donald Knuth's @TeX{} typesetting language,
14081and the @kbd{d L} (@code{calc-latex-language}) command selects the
14082conventions of ``math mode'' in La@TeX{}, a typesetting language that
14083uses @TeX{} as its formatting engine. Calc's La@TeX{} language mode can
14084read any formula that the @TeX{} language mode can, although La@TeX{}
14085mode may display it differently.
14086
14087Formulas are entered and displayed in the appropriate notation;
14088@texline @math{\sin(a/b)}
14089@infoline @expr{sin(a/b)}
0cbe9c78 14090will appear as @samp{\sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)} in @TeX{} mode and
4009494e
GM
14091@samp{\sin\left(\frac@{a@}@{b@}\right)} in La@TeX{} mode.
14092Math formulas are often enclosed by @samp{$ $} signs in @TeX{} and
14093La@TeX{}; these should be omitted when interfacing with Calc. To Calc,
14094the @samp{$} sign has the same meaning it always does in algebraic
14095formulas (a reference to an existing entry on the stack).
14096
14097Complex numbers are displayed as in @samp{3 + 4i}. Fractions and
14098quotients are written using @code{\over} in @TeX{} mode (as in
14099@code{@{a \over b@}}) and @code{\frac} in La@TeX{} mode (as in
14100@code{\frac@{a@}@{b@}}); binomial coefficients are written with
14101@code{\choose} in @TeX{} mode (as in @code{@{a \choose b@}}) and
14102@code{\binom} in La@TeX{} mode (as in @code{\binom@{a@}@{b@}}).
14103Interval forms are written with @code{\ldots}, and error forms are
14104written with @code{\pm}. Absolute values are written as in
14105@samp{|x + 1|}, and the floor and ceiling functions are written with
14106@code{\lfloor}, @code{\rfloor}, etc. The words @code{\left} and
14107@code{\right} are ignored when reading formulas in @TeX{} and La@TeX{}
14108modes. Both @code{inf} and @code{uinf} are written as @code{\infty};
14109when read, @code{\infty} always translates to @code{inf}.
14110
14111Function calls are written the usual way, with the function name followed
14112by the arguments in parentheses. However, functions for which @TeX{}
14113and La@TeX{} have special names (like @code{\sin}) will use curly braces
14114instead of parentheses for very simple arguments. During input, curly
14115braces and parentheses work equally well for grouping, but when the
14116document is formatted the curly braces will be invisible. Thus the
14117printed result is
14118@texline @math{\sin{2 x}}
14119@infoline @expr{sin 2x}
14120but
14121@texline @math{\sin(2 + x)}.
14122@infoline @expr{sin(2 + x)}.
14123
1265829e
JB
14124The @TeX{} specific unit names (@pxref{Predefined Units}) will not use
14125the @samp{tex} prefix; the unit name for a @TeX{} point will be
14126@samp{pt} instead of @samp{texpt}, for example.
14127
4009494e
GM
14128Function and variable names not treated specially by @TeX{} and La@TeX{}
14129are simply written out as-is, which will cause them to come out in
14130italic letters in the printed document. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or
14131@kbd{d L} with a positive numeric prefix argument, names of more than
14132one character will instead be enclosed in a protective commands that
14133will prevent them from being typeset in the math italics; they will be
14134written @samp{\hbox@{@var{name}@}} in @TeX{} mode and
14135@samp{\text@{@var{name}@}} in La@TeX{} mode. The
14136@samp{\hbox@{ @}} and @samp{\text@{ @}} notations are ignored during
14137reading. If you use a negative prefix argument, such function names are
14138written @samp{\@var{name}}, and function names that begin with @code{\} during
14139reading have the @code{\} removed. (Note that in this mode, long
14140variable names are still written with @code{\hbox} or @code{\text}.
14141However, you can always make an actual variable name like @code{\bar} in
14142any @TeX{} mode.)
14143
14144During reading, text of the form @samp{\matrix@{ ...@: @}} is replaced
14145by @samp{[ ...@: ]}. The same also applies to @code{\pmatrix} and
14146@code{\bmatrix}. In La@TeX{} mode this also applies to
14147@samp{\begin@{matrix@} ... \end@{matrix@}},
14148@samp{\begin@{bmatrix@} ... \end@{bmatrix@}},
14149@samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} ... \end@{pmatrix@}}, as well as
14150@samp{\begin@{smallmatrix@} ... \end@{smallmatrix@}}.
14151The symbol @samp{&} is interpreted as a comma,
14152and the symbols @samp{\cr} and @samp{\\} are interpreted as semicolons.
14153During output, matrices are displayed in @samp{\matrix@{ a & b \\ c & d@}}
14154format in @TeX{} mode and in
14155@samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} a & b \\ c & d \end@{pmatrix@}} format in
14156La@TeX{} mode; you may need to edit this afterwards to change to your
14157preferred matrix form. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or @kbd{d L} with an
14158argument of 2 or -2, then matrices will be displayed in two-dimensional
14159form, such as
14160
14161@example
14162\begin@{pmatrix@}
14163a & b \\
14164c & d
14165\end@{pmatrix@}
14166@end example
14167
14168@noindent
14169This may be convenient for isolated matrices, but could lead to
14170expressions being displayed like
14171
14172@example
14173\begin@{pmatrix@} \times x
14174a & b \\
14175c & d
14176\end@{pmatrix@}
14177@end example
14178
14179@noindent
14180While this wouldn't bother Calc, it is incorrect La@TeX{}.
14181(Similarly for @TeX{}.)
14182
14183Accents like @code{\tilde} and @code{\bar} translate into function
14184calls internally (@samp{tilde(x)}, @samp{bar(x)}). The @code{\underline}
14185sequence is treated as an accent. The @code{\vec} accent corresponds
14186to the function name @code{Vec}, because @code{vec} is the name of
14187a built-in Calc function. The following table shows the accents
14188in Calc, @TeX{}, La@TeX{} and @dfn{eqn} (described in the next section):
14189
17587b1b 14190@ignore
4009494e
GM
14191@iftex
14192@begingroup
14193@let@calcindexershow=@calcindexernoshow @c Suppress marginal notes
14194@let@calcindexersh=@calcindexernoshow
14195@end iftex
4009494e
GM
14196@starindex
14197@end ignore
14198@tindex acute
14199@ignore
14200@starindex
14201@end ignore
14202@tindex Acute
14203@ignore
14204@starindex
14205@end ignore
14206@tindex bar
14207@ignore
14208@starindex
14209@end ignore
14210@tindex Bar
14211@ignore
14212@starindex
14213@end ignore
14214@tindex breve
14215@ignore
14216@starindex
14217@end ignore
14218@tindex Breve
14219@ignore
14220@starindex
14221@end ignore
14222@tindex check
14223@ignore
14224@starindex
14225@end ignore
14226@tindex Check
14227@ignore
14228@starindex
14229@end ignore
14230@tindex dddot
14231@ignore
14232@starindex
14233@end ignore
14234@tindex ddddot
14235@ignore
14236@starindex
14237@end ignore
14238@tindex dot
14239@ignore
14240@starindex
14241@end ignore
14242@tindex Dot
14243@ignore
14244@starindex
14245@end ignore
14246@tindex dotdot
14247@ignore
14248@starindex
14249@end ignore
14250@tindex DotDot
14251@ignore
14252@starindex
14253@end ignore
14254@tindex dyad
14255@ignore
14256@starindex
14257@end ignore
14258@tindex grave
14259@ignore
14260@starindex
14261@end ignore
14262@tindex Grave
14263@ignore
14264@starindex
14265@end ignore
14266@tindex hat
14267@ignore
14268@starindex
14269@end ignore
14270@tindex Hat
14271@ignore
14272@starindex
14273@end ignore
14274@tindex Prime
14275@ignore
14276@starindex
14277@end ignore
14278@tindex tilde
14279@ignore
14280@starindex
14281@end ignore
14282@tindex Tilde
14283@ignore
14284@starindex
14285@end ignore
14286@tindex under
14287@ignore
14288@starindex
14289@end ignore
14290@tindex Vec
14291@ignore
14292@starindex
14293@end ignore
14294@tindex VEC
17587b1b 14295@ignore
4009494e
GM
14296@iftex
14297@endgroup
14298@end iftex
17587b1b 14299@end ignore
4009494e
GM
14300@example
14301Calc TeX LaTeX eqn
14302---- --- ----- ---
14303acute \acute \acute
14304Acute \Acute
14305bar \bar \bar bar
14306Bar \Bar
14307breve \breve \breve
14308Breve \Breve
14309check \check \check
14310Check \Check
14311dddot \dddot
14312ddddot \ddddot
14313dot \dot \dot dot
14314Dot \Dot
14315dotdot \ddot \ddot dotdot
14316DotDot \Ddot
14317dyad dyad
14318grave \grave \grave
14319Grave \Grave
14320hat \hat \hat hat
14321Hat \Hat
14322Prime prime
14323tilde \tilde \tilde tilde
14324Tilde \Tilde
14325under \underline \underline under
14326Vec \vec \vec vec
14327VEC \Vec
14328@end example
14329
14330The @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operator appears as a @code{\to} symbol:
14331@samp{@{@var{a} \to @var{b}@}}. @TeX{} defines @code{\to} as an
14332alias for @code{\rightarrow}. However, if the @samp{=>} is the
14333top-level expression being formatted, a slightly different notation
14334is used: @samp{\evalto @var{a} \to @var{b}}. The @code{\evalto}
14335word is ignored by Calc's input routines, and is undefined in @TeX{}.
14336You will typically want to include one of the following definitions
14337at the top of a @TeX{} file that uses @code{\evalto}:
14338
14339@example
14340\def\evalto@{@}
14341\def\evalto#1\to@{@}
14342@end example
14343
14344The first definition formats evaluates-to operators in the usual
14345way. The second causes only the @var{b} part to appear in the
14346printed document; the @var{a} part and the arrow are hidden.
14347Another definition you may wish to use is @samp{\let\to=\Rightarrow}
14348which causes @code{\to} to appear more like Calc's @samp{=>} symbol.
14349@xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a discussion of @code{evalto}.
14350
14351The complete set of @TeX{} control sequences that are ignored during
14352reading is:
14353
14354@example
14355\hbox \mbox \text \left \right
14356\, \> \: \; \! \quad \qquad \hfil \hfill
14357\displaystyle \textstyle \dsize \tsize
14358\scriptstyle \scriptscriptstyle \ssize \ssize
14359\rm \bf \it \sl \roman \bold \italic \slanted
14360\cal \mit \Cal \Bbb \frak \goth
14361\evalto
14362@end example
14363
14364Note that, because these symbols are ignored, reading a @TeX{} or
14365La@TeX{} formula into Calc and writing it back out may lose spacing and
14366font information.
14367
14368Also, the ``discretionary multiplication sign'' @samp{\*} is read
14369the same as @samp{*}.
14370
14371@ifnottex
14372The @TeX{} version of this manual includes some printed examples at the
14373end of this section.
14374@end ifnottex
14375@iftex
14376Here are some examples of how various Calc formulas are formatted in @TeX{}:
14377
14378@example
14379@group
14380sin(a^2 / b_i)
14381\sin\left( {a^2 \over b_i} \right)
14382@end group
14383@end example
14384@tex
14385$$ \sin\left( a^2 \over b_i \right) $$
14386@end tex
14387@sp 1
14388
14389@example
14390@group
14391[(3, 4), 3:4, 3 +/- 4, [3 .. inf)]
14392[3 + 4i, @{3 \over 4@}, 3 \pm 4, [3 \ldots \infty)]
14393@end group
14394@end example
14395@tex
4009494e
GM
14396$$ [3 + 4i, {3 \over 4}, 3 \pm 4, [ 3 \ldots \infty)] $$
14397@end tex
14398@sp 1
14399
14400@example
14401@group
14402[abs(a), abs(a / b), floor(a), ceil(a / b)]
14403[|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14404 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil]
14405@end group
14406@end example
14407@tex
14408$$ [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14409 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil] $$
14410@end tex
14411@sp 1
14412
14413@example
14414@group
14415[sin(a), sin(2 a), sin(2 + a), sin(a / b)]
14416[\sin@{a@}, \sin@{2 a@}, \sin(2 + a),
14417 \sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)]
14418@end group
14419@end example
14420@tex
4009494e
GM
14421$$ [\sin{a}, \sin{2 a}, \sin(2 + a), \sin\left( {a \over b} \right)] $$
14422@end tex
14423@sp 2
14424
14425First with plain @kbd{d T}, then with @kbd{C-u d T}, then finally with
14426@kbd{C-u - d T} (using the example definition
14427@samp{\def\foo#1@{\tilde F(#1)@}}:
14428
14429@example
14430@group
14431[f(a), foo(bar), sin(pi)]
14432[f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}]
14433[f(a), \hbox@{foo@}(\hbox@{bar@}), \sin@{\pi@}]
14434[f(a), \foo@{\hbox@{bar@}@}, \sin@{\pi@}]
14435@end group
14436@end example
14437@tex
14438$$ [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}] $$
14439$$ [f(a), \hbox{foo}(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14440$$ [f(a), \tilde F(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14441@end tex
14442@sp 2
14443
14444First with @samp{\def\evalto@{@}}, then with @samp{\def\evalto#1\to@{@}}:
14445
14446@example
14447@group
144482 + 3 => 5
14449\evalto 2 + 3 \to 5
14450@end group
14451@end example
14452@tex
4009494e
GM
14453$$ 2 + 3 \to 5 $$
14454$$ 5 $$
14455@end tex
14456@sp 2
14457
14458First with standard @code{\to}, then with @samp{\let\to\Rightarrow}:
14459
14460@example
14461@group
14462[2 + 3 => 5, a / 2 => (b + c) / 2]
14463[@{2 + 3 \to 5@}, @{@{a \over 2@} \to @{b + c \over 2@}@}]
14464@end group
14465@end example
14466@tex
4009494e
GM
14467$$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$
14468{\let\to\Rightarrow
14469$$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$}
14470@end tex
14471@sp 2
14472
14473Matrices normally, then changing @code{\matrix} to @code{\pmatrix}:
14474
14475@example
14476@group
14477[ [ a / b, 0 ], [ 0, 2^(x + 1) ] ]
14478\matrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14479\pmatrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14480@end group
14481@end example
14482@tex
4009494e
GM
14483$$ \matrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14484$$ \pmatrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14485@end tex
14486@sp 2
14487@end iftex
14488
702dbfd9 14489@node Eqn Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Language Modes
4009494e
GM
14490@subsection Eqn Language Mode
14491
14492@noindent
14493@kindex d E
14494@pindex calc-eqn-language
14495@dfn{Eqn} is another popular formatter for math formulas. It is
14496designed for use with the TROFF text formatter, and comes standard
14497with many versions of Unix. The @kbd{d E} (@code{calc-eqn-language})
14498command selects @dfn{eqn} notation.
14499
14500The @dfn{eqn} language's main idiosyncrasy is that whitespace plays
14501a significant part in the parsing of the language. For example,
14502@samp{sqrt x+1 + y} treats @samp{x+1} as the argument of the
14503@code{sqrt} operator. @dfn{Eqn} also understands more conventional
14504grouping using curly braces: @samp{sqrt@{x+1@} + y}. Braces are
14505required only when the argument contains spaces.
14506
14507In Calc's @dfn{eqn} mode, however, curly braces are required to
14508delimit arguments of operators like @code{sqrt}. The first of the
14509above examples would treat only the @samp{x} as the argument of
14510@code{sqrt}, and in fact @samp{sin x+1} would be interpreted as
14511@samp{sin * x + 1}, because @code{sin} is not a special operator
14512in the @dfn{eqn} language. If you always surround the argument
14513with curly braces, Calc will never misunderstand.
14514
14515Calc also understands parentheses as grouping characters. Another
14516peculiarity of @dfn{eqn}'s syntax makes it advisable to separate
14517words with spaces from any surrounding characters that aren't curly
14518braces, so Calc writes @samp{sin ( x + y )} in @dfn{eqn} mode.
14519(The spaces around @code{sin} are important to make @dfn{eqn}
14520recognize that @code{sin} should be typeset in a roman font, and
14521the spaces around @code{x} and @code{y} are a good idea just in
14522case the @dfn{eqn} document has defined special meanings for these
14523names, too.)
14524
14525Powers and subscripts are written with the @code{sub} and @code{sup}
14526operators, respectively. Note that the caret symbol @samp{^} is
14527treated the same as a space in @dfn{eqn} mode, as is the @samp{~}
14528symbol (these are used to introduce spaces of various widths into
14529the typeset output of @dfn{eqn}).
14530
14531As in La@TeX{} mode, Calc's formatter omits parentheses around the
14532arguments of functions like @code{ln} and @code{sin} if they are
14533``simple-looking''; in this case Calc surrounds the argument with
14534braces, separated by a @samp{~} from the function name: @samp{sin~@{x@}}.
14535
14536Font change codes (like @samp{roman @var{x}}) and positioning codes
14537(like @samp{~} and @samp{down @var{n} @var{x}}) are ignored by the
14538@dfn{eqn} reader. Also ignored are the words @code{left}, @code{right},
14539@code{mark}, and @code{lineup}. Quotation marks in @dfn{eqn} mode input
14540are treated the same as curly braces: @samp{sqrt "1+x"} is equivalent to
14541@samp{sqrt @{1+x@}}; this is only an approximation to the true meaning
14542of quotes in @dfn{eqn}, but it is good enough for most uses.
14543
14544Accent codes (@samp{@var{x} dot}) are handled by treating them as
14545function calls (@samp{dot(@var{x})}) internally.
14546@xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a table of these accent
14547functions. The @code{prime} accent is treated specially if it occurs on
14548a variable or function name: @samp{f prime prime @w{( x prime )}} is
14549stored internally as @samp{f'@w{'}(x')}. For example, taking the
14550derivative of @samp{f(2 x)} with @kbd{a d x} will produce @samp{2 f'(2
14551x)}, which @dfn{eqn} mode will display as @samp{2 f prime ( 2 x )}.
14552
14553Assignments are written with the @samp{<-} (left-arrow) symbol,
14554and @code{evalto} operators are written with @samp{->} or
14555@samp{evalto ... ->} (@pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a discussion
14556of this). The regular Calc symbols @samp{:=} and @samp{=>} are also
14557recognized for these operators during reading.
14558
14559Vectors in @dfn{eqn} mode use regular Calc square brackets, but
14560matrices are formatted as @samp{matrix @{ ccol @{ a above b @} ... @}}.
14561The words @code{lcol} and @code{rcol} are recognized as synonyms
14562for @code{ccol} during input, and are generated instead of @code{ccol}
14563if the matrix justification mode so specifies.
14564
702dbfd9
JB
14565@node Yacas Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Eqn Language Mode, Language Modes
14566@subsection Yacas Language Mode
14567
14568@noindent
14569@kindex d Y
14570@pindex calc-yacas-language
14571@cindex Yacas language
14572The @kbd{d Y} (@code{calc-yacas-language}) command selects the
14573conventions of Yacas, a free computer algebra system. While the
14574operators and functions in Yacas are similar to those of Calc, the names
14575of built-in functions in Yacas are capitalized. The Calc formula
14576@samp{sin(2 x)}, for example, is entered and displayed @samp{Sin(2 x)}
14577in Yacas mode, and `@samp{arcsin(x^2)} is @samp{ArcSin(x^2)} in Yacas
14578mode. Complex numbers are written are written @samp{3 + 4 I}.
14579The standard special constants are written @code{Pi}, @code{E},
14580@code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio} and @code{Gamma}. @code{Infinity}
14581represents both @code{inf} and @code{uinf}, and @code{Undefined}
14582represents @code{nan}.
14583
14584Certain operators on functions, such as @code{D} for differentiation
14585and @code{Integrate} for integration, take a prefix form in Yacas. For
14586example, the derivative of @w{@samp{e^x sin(x)}} can be computed with
14587@w{@samp{D(x) Exp(x)*Sin(x)}}.
14588
14589Other notable differences between Yacas and standard Calc expressions
14590are that vectors and matrices use curly braces in Yacas, and subscripts
14591use square brackets. If, for example, @samp{A} represents the list
14592@samp{@{a,2,c,4@}}, then @samp{A[3]} would equal @samp{c}.
14593
14594
14595@node Maxima Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, Language Modes
14596@subsection Maxima Language Mode
14597
14598@noindent
14599@kindex d X
14600@pindex calc-maxima-language
14601@cindex Maxima language
14602The @kbd{d X} (@code{calc-maxima-language}) command selects the
14603conventions of Maxima, another free computer algebra system. The
14604function names in Maxima are similar, but not always identical, to Calc.
14605For example, instead of @samp{arcsin(x)}, Maxima will use
14606@samp{asin(x)}. Complex numbers are written @samp{3 + 4 %i}. The
14607standard special constants are written @code{%pi}, @code{%e},
14608@code{%i}, @code{%phi} and @code{%gamma}. In Maxima, @code{inf} means
14609the same as in Calc, but @code{infinity} represents Calc's @code{uinf}.
14610
14611Underscores as well as percent signs are allowed in function and
14612variable names in Maxima mode. The underscore again is equivalent to
14613the @samp{#} in Normal mode, and the percent sign is equivalent to
14614@samp{o'o}.
14615
14616Maxima uses square brackets for lists and vectors, and matrices are
14617written as calls to the function @code{matrix}, given the row vectors of
14618the matrix as arguments. Square brackets are also used as subscripts.
14619
14620@node Giac Language Mode, Mathematica Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Language Modes
14621@subsection Giac Language Mode
14622
14623@noindent
14624@kindex d A
14625@pindex calc-giac-language
14626@cindex Giac language
14627The @kbd{d A} (@code{calc-giac-language}) command selects the
14628conventions of Giac, another free computer algebra system. The function
14629names in Giac are similar to Maxima. Complex numbers are written
14630@samp{3 + 4 i}. The standard special constants in Giac are the same as
14631in Calc, except that @code{infinity} represents both Calc's @code{inf}
14632and @code{uinf}.
14633
14634Underscores are allowed in function and variable names in Giac mode.
14635Brackets are used for subscripts. In Giac, indexing of lists begins at
146360, instead of 1 as in Calc. So if @samp{A} represents the list
14637@samp{[a,2,c,4]}, then @samp{A[2]} would equal @samp{c}. In general,
14638@samp{A[n]} in Giac mode corresponds to @samp{A_(n+1)} in Normal mode.
14639
14640The Giac interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} has no surrounding brackets;
14641Calc reads @samp{2 .. 3} as the closed interval @samp{[2 .. 3]} and
14642writes any kind of interval as @samp{2 .. 3}. This means you cannot see
14643the difference between an open and a closed interval while in Giac mode.
14644
14645@node Mathematica Language Mode, Maple Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Language Modes
4009494e
GM
14646@subsection Mathematica Language Mode
14647
14648@noindent
14649@kindex d M
14650@pindex calc-mathematica-language
14651@cindex Mathematica language
14652The @kbd{d M} (@code{calc-mathematica-language}) command selects the
14653conventions of Mathematica. Notable differences in Mathematica mode
14654are that the names of built-in functions are capitalized, and function
14655calls use square brackets instead of parentheses. Thus the Calc
14656formula @samp{sin(2 x)} is entered and displayed @w{@samp{Sin[2 x]}} in
14657Mathematica mode.
14658
14659Vectors and matrices use curly braces in Mathematica. Complex numbers
14660are written @samp{3 + 4 I}. The standard special constants in Calc are
14661written @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio}, @code{EulerGamma},
14662@code{Infinity}, @code{ComplexInfinity}, and @code{Indeterminate} in
14663Mathematica mode.
14664Non-decimal numbers are written, e.g., @samp{16^^7fff}. Floating-point
14665numbers in scientific notation are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14666Subscripts use double square brackets: @samp{a[[i]]}.
14667
14668@node Maple Language Mode, Compositions, Mathematica Language Mode, Language Modes
14669@subsection Maple Language Mode
14670
14671@noindent
14672@kindex d W
14673@pindex calc-maple-language
14674@cindex Maple language
14675The @kbd{d W} (@code{calc-maple-language}) command selects the
14676conventions of Maple.
14677
14678Maple's language is much like C. Underscores are allowed in symbol
14679names; square brackets are used for subscripts; explicit @samp{*}s for
14680multiplications are required. Use either @samp{^} or @samp{**} to
14681denote powers.
14682
14683Maple uses square brackets for lists and curly braces for sets. Calc
14684interprets both notations as vectors, and displays vectors with square
14685brackets. This means Maple sets will be converted to lists when they
14686pass through Calc. As a special case, matrices are written as calls
14687to the function @code{matrix}, given a list of lists as the argument,
14688and can be read in this form or with all-capitals @code{MATRIX}.
14689
702dbfd9
JB
14690The Maple interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} is like Giac's interval
14691notation, and is handled the same by Calc.
4009494e
GM
14692
14693Maple writes complex numbers as @samp{3 + 4*I}. Its special constants
14694are @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, and @code{infinity} (all three of
14695@code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} display as @code{infinity}).
14696Floating-point numbers are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14697
14698Among things not currently handled by Calc's Maple mode are the
14699various quote symbols, procedures and functional operators, and
14700inert (@samp{&}) operators.
14701
14702@node Compositions, Syntax Tables, Maple Language Mode, Language Modes
14703@subsection Compositions
14704
14705@noindent
14706@cindex Compositions
14707There are several @dfn{composition functions} which allow you to get
14708displays in a variety of formats similar to those in Big language
14709mode. Most of these functions do not evaluate to anything; they are
14710placeholders which are left in symbolic form by Calc's evaluator but
14711are recognized by Calc's display formatting routines.
14712
14713Two of these, @code{string} and @code{bstring}, are described elsewhere.
14714@xref{Strings}. For example, @samp{string("ABC")} is displayed as
14715@samp{ABC}. When viewed on the stack it will be indistinguishable from
14716the variable @code{ABC}, but internally it will be stored as
14717@samp{string([65, 66, 67])} and can still be manipulated this way; for
14718example, the selection and vector commands @kbd{j 1 v v j u} would
14719select the vector portion of this object and reverse the elements, then
14720deselect to reveal a string whose characters had been reversed.
14721
14722The composition functions do the same thing in all language modes
14723(although their components will of course be formatted in the current
14724language mode). The one exception is Unformatted mode (@kbd{d U}),
14725which does not give the composition functions any special treatment.
14726The functions are discussed here because of their relationship to
14727the language modes.
14728
14729@menu
14730* Composition Basics::
14731* Horizontal Compositions::
14732* Vertical Compositions::
14733* Other Compositions::
14734* Information about Compositions::
14735* User-Defined Compositions::
14736@end menu
14737
14738@node Composition Basics, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions, Compositions
14739@subsubsection Composition Basics
14740
14741@noindent
14742Compositions are generally formed by stacking formulas together
14743horizontally or vertically in various ways. Those formulas are
14744themselves compositions. @TeX{} users will find this analogous
14745to @TeX{}'s ``boxes.'' Each multi-line composition has a
14746@dfn{baseline}; horizontal compositions use the baselines to
14747decide how formulas should be positioned relative to one another.
14748For example, in the Big mode formula
14749
14750@example
14751@group
14752 2
14753 a + b
1475417 + ------
14755 c
14756@end group
14757@end example
14758
14759@noindent
14760the second term of the sum is four lines tall and has line three as
14761its baseline. Thus when the term is combined with 17, line three
14762is placed on the same level as the baseline of 17.
14763
14764@tex
14765\bigskip
14766@end tex
14767
14768Another important composition concept is @dfn{precedence}. This is
14769an integer that represents the binding strength of various operators.
14770For example, @samp{*} has higher precedence (195) than @samp{+} (180),
14771which means that @samp{(a * b) + c} will be formatted without the
14772parentheses, but @samp{a * (b + c)} will keep the parentheses.
14773
14774The operator table used by normal and Big language modes has the
14775following precedences:
14776
14777@example
0edd2970
JB
14778_ 1200 @r{(subscripts)}
14779% 1100 @r{(as in n}%@r{)}
14780! 1000 @r{(as in }!@r{n)}
4009494e
GM
14781mod 400
14782+/- 300
14783!! 210 @r{(as in n}!!@r{)}
14784! 210 @r{(as in n}!@r{)}
14785^ 200
0edd2970 14786- 197 @r{(as in }-@r{n)}
4009494e
GM
14787* 195 @r{(or implicit multiplication)}
14788/ % \ 190
14789+ - 180 @r{(as in a}+@r{b)}
14790| 170
14791< = 160 @r{(and other relations)}
14792&& 110
14793|| 100
14794? : 90
14795!!! 85
14796&&& 80
14797||| 75
14798:= 50
14799:: 45
14800=> 40
14801@end example
14802
14803The general rule is that if an operator with precedence @expr{n}
14804occurs as an argument to an operator with precedence @expr{m}, then
14805the argument is enclosed in parentheses if @expr{n < m}. Top-level
14806expressions and expressions which are function arguments, vector
14807components, etc., are formatted with precedence zero (so that they
14808normally never get additional parentheses).
14809
14810For binary left-associative operators like @samp{+}, the righthand
14811argument is actually formatted with one-higher precedence than shown
14812in the table. This makes sure @samp{(a + b) + c} omits the parentheses,
14813but the unnatural form @samp{a + (b + c)} keeps its parentheses.
14814Right-associative operators like @samp{^} format the lefthand argument
14815with one-higher precedence.
14816
14817@ignore
14818@starindex
14819@end ignore
14820@tindex cprec
14821The @code{cprec} function formats an expression with an arbitrary
14822precedence. For example, @samp{cprec(abc, 185)} will combine into
14823sums and products as follows: @samp{7 + abc}, @samp{7 (abc)} (because
14824this @code{cprec} form has higher precedence than addition, but lower
14825precedence than multiplication).
14826
14827@tex
14828\bigskip
14829@end tex
14830
14831A final composition issue is @dfn{line breaking}. Calc uses two
14832different strategies for ``flat'' and ``non-flat'' compositions.
14833A non-flat composition is anything that appears on multiple lines
14834(not counting line breaking). Examples would be matrices and Big
14835mode powers and quotients. Non-flat compositions are displayed
14836exactly as specified. If they come out wider than the current
14837window, you must use horizontal scrolling (@kbd{<} and @kbd{>}) to
14838view them.
14839
14840Flat compositions, on the other hand, will be broken across several
14841lines if they are too wide to fit the window. Certain points in a
14842composition are noted internally as @dfn{break points}. Calc's
14843general strategy is to fill each line as much as possible, then to
14844move down to the next line starting at the first break point that
14845didn't fit. However, the line breaker understands the hierarchical
14846structure of formulas. It will not break an ``inner'' formula if
14847it can use an earlier break point from an ``outer'' formula instead.
14848For example, a vector of sums might be formatted as:
14849
14850@example
14851@group
14852[ a + b + c, d + e + f,
14853 g + h + i, j + k + l, m ]
14854@end group
14855@end example
14856
14857@noindent
14858If the @samp{m} can fit, then so, it seems, could the @samp{g}.
14859But Calc prefers to break at the comma since the comma is part
14860of a ``more outer'' formula. Calc would break at a plus sign
14861only if it had to, say, if the very first sum in the vector had
14862itself been too large to fit.
14863
14864Of the composition functions described below, only @code{choriz}
14865generates break points. The @code{bstring} function (@pxref{Strings})
14866also generates breakable items: A break point is added after every
14867space (or group of spaces) except for spaces at the very beginning or
14868end of the string.
14869
14870Composition functions themselves count as levels in the formula
14871hierarchy, so a @code{choriz} that is a component of a larger
14872@code{choriz} will be less likely to be broken. As a special case,
14873if a @code{bstring} occurs as a component of a @code{choriz} or
14874@code{choriz}-like object (such as a vector or a list of arguments
14875in a function call), then the break points in that @code{bstring}
14876will be on the same level as the break points of the surrounding
14877object.
14878
14879@node Horizontal Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Composition Basics, Compositions
14880@subsubsection Horizontal Compositions
14881
14882@noindent
14883@ignore
14884@starindex
14885@end ignore
14886@tindex choriz
14887The @code{choriz} function takes a vector of objects and composes
14888them horizontally. For example, @samp{choriz([17, a b/c, d])} formats
14889as @w{@samp{17a b / cd}} in Normal language mode, or as
14890
14891@example
14892@group
14893 a b
1489417---d
14895 c
14896@end group
14897@end example
14898
14899@noindent
14900in Big language mode. This is actually one case of the general
14901function @samp{choriz(@var{vec}, @var{sep}, @var{prec})}, where
14902either or both of @var{sep} and @var{prec} may be omitted.
14903@var{Prec} gives the @dfn{precedence} to use when formatting
14904each of the components of @var{vec}. The default precedence is
14905the precedence from the surrounding environment.
14906
14907@var{Sep} is a string (i.e., a vector of character codes as might
14908be entered with @code{" "} notation) which should separate components
14909of the composition. Also, if @var{sep} is given, the line breaker
14910will allow lines to be broken after each occurrence of @var{sep}.
14911If @var{sep} is omitted, the composition will not be breakable
14912(unless any of its component compositions are breakable).
14913
14914For example, @samp{2 choriz([a, b c, d = e], " + ", 180)} is
14915formatted as @samp{2 a + b c + (d = e)}. To get the @code{choriz}
14916to have precedence 180 ``outwards'' as well as ``inwards,''
14917enclose it in a @code{cprec} form: @samp{2 cprec(choriz(...), 180)}
14918formats as @samp{2 (a + b c + (d = e))}.
14919
14920The baseline of a horizontal composition is the same as the
14921baselines of the component compositions, which are all aligned.
14922
14923@node Vertical Compositions, Other Compositions, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions
14924@subsubsection Vertical Compositions
14925
14926@noindent
14927@ignore
14928@starindex
14929@end ignore
14930@tindex cvert
14931The @code{cvert} function makes a vertical composition. Each
14932component of the vector is centered in a column. The baseline of
14933the result is by default the top line of the resulting composition.
14934For example, @samp{f(cvert([a, bb, ccc]), cvert([a^2 + 1, b^2]))}
14935formats in Big mode as
14936
14937@example
14938@group
14939f( a , 2 )
14940 bb a + 1
14941 ccc 2
14942 b
14943@end group
14944@end example
14945
14946@ignore
14947@starindex
14948@end ignore
14949@tindex cbase
14950There are several special composition functions that work only as
14951components of a vertical composition. The @code{cbase} function
14952controls the baseline of the vertical composition; the baseline
14953will be the same as the baseline of whatever component is enclosed
14954in @code{cbase}. Thus @samp{f(cvert([a, cbase(bb), ccc]),
14955cvert([a^2 + 1, cbase(b^2)]))} displays as
14956
14957@example
14958@group
14959 2
14960 a + 1
14961 a 2
14962f(bb , b )
14963 ccc
14964@end group
14965@end example
14966
14967@ignore
14968@starindex
14969@end ignore
14970@tindex ctbase
14971@ignore
14972@starindex
14973@end ignore
14974@tindex cbbase
14975There are also @code{ctbase} and @code{cbbase} functions which
14976make the baseline of the vertical composition equal to the top
14977or bottom line (rather than the baseline) of that component.
14978Thus @samp{cvert([cbase(a / b)]) + cvert([ctbase(a / b)]) +
14979cvert([cbbase(a / b)])} gives
14980
14981@example
14982@group
14983 a
14984a -
14985- + a + b
14986b -
14987 b
14988@end group
14989@end example
14990
14991There should be only one @code{cbase}, @code{ctbase}, or @code{cbbase}
14992function in a given vertical composition. These functions can also
14993be written with no arguments: @samp{ctbase()} is a zero-height object
14994which means the baseline is the top line of the following item, and
14995@samp{cbbase()} means the baseline is the bottom line of the preceding
14996item.
14997
14998@ignore
14999@starindex
15000@end ignore
15001@tindex crule
15002The @code{crule} function builds a ``rule,'' or horizontal line,
15003across a vertical composition. By itself @samp{crule()} uses @samp{-}
15004characters to build the rule. You can specify any other character,
15005e.g., @samp{crule("=")}. The argument must be a character code or
15006vector of exactly one character code. It is repeated to match the
15007width of the widest item in the stack. For example, a quotient
15008with a thick line is @samp{cvert([a + 1, cbase(crule("=")), b^2])}:
15009
15010@example
15011@group
15012a + 1
15013=====
15014 2
15015 b
15016@end group
15017@end example
15018
15019@ignore
15020@starindex
15021@end ignore
15022@tindex clvert
15023@ignore
15024@starindex
15025@end ignore
15026@tindex crvert
15027Finally, the functions @code{clvert} and @code{crvert} act exactly
15028like @code{cvert} except that the items are left- or right-justified
15029in the stack. Thus @samp{clvert([a, bb, ccc]) + crvert([a, bb, ccc])}
15030gives:
15031
15032@example
15033@group
15034a + a
15035bb bb
15036ccc ccc
15037@end group
15038@end example
15039
15040Like @code{choriz}, the vertical compositions accept a second argument
15041which gives the precedence to use when formatting the components.
15042Vertical compositions do not support separator strings.
15043
15044@node Other Compositions, Information about Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Compositions
15045@subsubsection Other Compositions
15046
15047@noindent
15048@ignore
15049@starindex
15050@end ignore
15051@tindex csup
15052The @code{csup} function builds a superscripted expression. For
15053example, @samp{csup(a, b)} looks the same as @samp{a^b} does in Big
15054language mode. This is essentially a horizontal composition of
15055@samp{a} and @samp{b}, where @samp{b} is shifted up so that its
15056bottom line is one above the baseline.
15057
15058@ignore
15059@starindex
15060@end ignore
15061@tindex csub
15062Likewise, the @code{csub} function builds a subscripted expression.
15063This shifts @samp{b} down so that its top line is one below the
15064bottom line of @samp{a} (note that this is not quite analogous to
15065@code{csup}). Other arrangements can be obtained by using
15066@code{choriz} and @code{cvert} directly.
15067
15068@ignore
15069@starindex
15070@end ignore
15071@tindex cflat
15072The @code{cflat} function formats its argument in ``flat'' mode,
15073as obtained by @samp{d O}, if the current language mode is normal
15074or Big. It has no effect in other language modes. For example,
15075@samp{a^(b/c)} is formatted by Big mode like @samp{csup(a, cflat(b/c))}
15076to improve its readability.
15077
15078@ignore
15079@starindex
15080@end ignore
15081@tindex cspace
15082The @code{cspace} function creates horizontal space. For example,
15083@samp{cspace(4)} is effectively the same as @samp{string(" ")}.
15084A second string (i.e., vector of characters) argument is repeated
15085instead of the space character. For example, @samp{cspace(4, "ab")}
15086looks like @samp{abababab}. If the second argument is not a string,
15087it is formatted in the normal way and then several copies of that
15088are composed together: @samp{cspace(4, a^2)} yields
15089
15090@example
15091@group
15092 2 2 2 2
15093a a a a
15094@end group
15095@end example
15096
15097@noindent
15098If the number argument is zero, this is a zero-width object.
15099
15100@ignore
15101@starindex
15102@end ignore
15103@tindex cvspace
15104The @code{cvspace} function creates vertical space, or a vertical
15105stack of copies of a certain string or formatted object. The
15106baseline is the center line of the resulting stack. A numerical
15107argument of zero will produce an object which contributes zero
15108height if used in a vertical composition.
15109
15110@ignore
15111@starindex
15112@end ignore
15113@tindex ctspace
15114@ignore
15115@starindex
15116@end ignore
15117@tindex cbspace
15118There are also @code{ctspace} and @code{cbspace} functions which
15119create vertical space with the baseline the same as the baseline
15120of the top or bottom copy, respectively, of the second argument.
15121Thus @samp{cvspace(2, a/b) + ctspace(2, a/b) + cbspace(2, a/b)}
15122displays as:
15123
15124@example
15125@group
15126 a
15127 -
15128a b
15129- a a
15130b + - + -
15131a b b
15132- a
15133b -
15134 b
15135@end group
15136@end example
15137
15138@node Information about Compositions, User-Defined Compositions, Other Compositions, Compositions
15139@subsubsection Information about Compositions
15140
15141@noindent
15142The functions in this section are actual functions; they compose their
15143arguments according to the current language and other display modes,
15144then return a certain measurement of the composition as an integer.
15145
15146@ignore
15147@starindex
15148@end ignore
15149@tindex cwidth
15150The @code{cwidth} function measures the width, in characters, of a
15151composition. For example, @samp{cwidth(a + b)} is 5, and
15152@samp{cwidth(a / b)} is 5 in Normal mode, 1 in Big mode, and 11 in
15153@TeX{} mode (for @samp{@{a \over b@}}). The argument may involve
15154the composition functions described in this section.
15155
15156@ignore
15157@starindex
15158@end ignore
15159@tindex cheight
15160The @code{cheight} function measures the height of a composition.
15161This is the total number of lines in the argument's printed form.
15162
15163@ignore
15164@starindex
15165@end ignore
15166@tindex cascent
15167@ignore
15168@starindex
15169@end ignore
15170@tindex cdescent
15171The functions @code{cascent} and @code{cdescent} measure the amount
15172of the height that is above (and including) the baseline, or below
15173the baseline, respectively. Thus @samp{cascent(@var{x}) + cdescent(@var{x})}
15174always equals @samp{cheight(@var{x})}. For a one-line formula like
15175@samp{a + b}, @code{cascent} returns 1 and @code{cdescent} returns 0.
15176For @samp{a / b} in Big mode, @code{cascent} returns 2 and @code{cdescent}
15177returns 1. The only formula for which @code{cascent} will return zero
15178is @samp{cvspace(0)} or equivalents.
15179
15180@node User-Defined Compositions, , Information about Compositions, Compositions
15181@subsubsection User-Defined Compositions
15182
15183@noindent
15184@kindex Z C
15185@pindex calc-user-define-composition
15186The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command lets you
15187define the display format for any algebraic function. You provide a
15188formula containing a certain number of argument variables on the stack.
15189Any time Calc formats a call to the specified function in the current
15190language mode and with that number of arguments, Calc effectively
15191replaces the function call with that formula with the arguments
15192replaced.
15193
15194Calc builds the default argument list by sorting all the variable names
15195that appear in the formula into alphabetical order. You can edit this
15196argument list before pressing @key{RET} if you wish. Any variables in
15197the formula that do not appear in the argument list will be displayed
15198literally; any arguments that do not appear in the formula will not
15199affect the display at all.
15200
15201You can define formats for built-in functions, for functions you have
15202defined with @kbd{Z F} (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}), or for functions
15203which have no definitions but are being used as purely syntactic objects.
15204You can define different formats for each language mode, and for each
15205number of arguments, using a succession of @kbd{Z C} commands. When
15206Calc formats a function call, it first searches for a format defined
15207for the current language mode (and number of arguments); if there is
15208none, it uses the format defined for the Normal language mode. If
15209neither format exists, Calc uses its built-in standard format for that
15210function (usually just @samp{@var{func}(@var{args})}).
15211
15212If you execute @kbd{Z C} with the number 0 on the stack instead of a
15213formula, any defined formats for the function in the current language
15214mode will be removed. The function will revert to its standard format.
15215
15216For example, the default format for the binomial coefficient function
15217@samp{choose(n, m)} in the Big language mode is
15218
15219@example
15220@group
15221 n
15222( )
15223 m
15224@end group
15225@end example
15226
15227@noindent
15228You might prefer the notation,
15229
15230@example
15231@group
15232 C
15233n m
15234@end group
15235@end example
15236
15237@noindent
15238To define this notation, first make sure you are in Big mode,
15239then put the formula
15240
15241@smallexample
15242choriz([cvert([cvspace(1), n]), C, cvert([cvspace(1), m])])
15243@end smallexample
15244
15245@noindent
15246on the stack and type @kbd{Z C}. Answer the first prompt with
15247@code{choose}. The second prompt will be the default argument list
15248of @samp{(C m n)}. Edit this list to be @samp{(n m)} and press
15249@key{RET}. Now, try it out: For example, turn simplification
15250off with @kbd{m O} and enter @samp{choose(a,b) + choose(7,3)}
15251as an algebraic entry.
15252
15253@example
15254@group
15255 C + C
15256a b 7 3
15257@end group
15258@end example
15259
15260As another example, let's define the usual notation for Stirling
15261numbers of the first kind, @samp{stir1(n, m)}. This is just like
15262the regular format for binomial coefficients but with square brackets
15263instead of parentheses.
15264
15265@smallexample
15266choriz([string("["), cvert([n, cbase(cvspace(1)), m]), string("]")])
15267@end smallexample
15268
15269Now type @kbd{Z C stir1 @key{RET}}, edit the argument list to
15270@samp{(n m)}, and type @key{RET}.
15271
15272The formula provided to @kbd{Z C} usually will involve composition
15273functions, but it doesn't have to. Putting the formula @samp{a + b + c}
15274onto the stack and typing @kbd{Z C foo @key{RET} @key{RET}} would define
15275the function @samp{foo(x,y,z)} to display like @samp{x + y + z}.
15276This ``sum'' will act exactly like a real sum for all formatting
15277purposes (it will be parenthesized the same, and so on). However
15278it will be computationally unrelated to a sum. For example, the
15279formula @samp{2 * foo(1, 2, 3)} will display as @samp{2 (1 + 2 + 3)}.
15280Operator precedences have caused the ``sum'' to be written in
15281parentheses, but the arguments have not actually been summed.
15282(Generally a display format like this would be undesirable, since
15283it can easily be confused with a real sum.)
15284
15285The special function @code{eval} can be used inside a @kbd{Z C}
15286composition formula to cause all or part of the formula to be
15287evaluated at display time. For example, if the formula is
15288@samp{a + eval(b + c)}, then @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} will be displayed
15289as @samp{1 + 5}. Evaluation will use the default simplifications,
15290regardless of the current simplification mode. There are also
15291@code{evalsimp} and @code{evalextsimp} which simplify as if by
15292@kbd{a s} and @kbd{a e} (respectively). Note that these ``functions''
15293operate only in the context of composition formulas (and also in
15294rewrite rules, where they serve a similar purpose; @pxref{Rewrite
15295Rules}). On the stack, a call to @code{eval} will be left in
15296symbolic form.
15297
15298It is not a good idea to use @code{eval} except as a last resort.
15299It can cause the display of formulas to be extremely slow. For
15300example, while @samp{eval(a + b)} might seem quite fast and simple,
15301there are several situations where it could be slow. For example,
15302@samp{a} and/or @samp{b} could be polar complex numbers, in which
15303case doing the sum requires trigonometry. Or, @samp{a} could be
15304the factorial @samp{fact(100)} which is unevaluated because you
15305have typed @kbd{m O}; @code{eval} will evaluate it anyway to
15306produce a large, unwieldy integer.
15307
15308You can save your display formats permanently using the @kbd{Z P}
15309command (@pxref{Creating User Keys}).
15310
15311@node Syntax Tables, , Compositions, Language Modes
15312@subsection Syntax Tables
15313
15314@noindent
15315@cindex Syntax tables
15316@cindex Parsing formulas, customized
15317Syntax tables do for input what compositions do for output: They
15318allow you to teach custom notations to Calc's formula parser.
15319Calc keeps a separate syntax table for each language mode.
15320
15321(Note that the Calc ``syntax tables'' discussed here are completely
15322unrelated to the syntax tables described in the Emacs manual.)
15323
15324@kindex Z S
15325@pindex calc-edit-user-syntax
15326The @kbd{Z S} (@code{calc-edit-user-syntax}) command edits the
15327syntax table for the current language mode. If you want your
15328syntax to work in any language, define it in the Normal language
15329mode. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing the syntax table, or
15330@kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @kbd{m m} command saves all
15331the syntax tables along with the other mode settings;
15332@pxref{General Mode Commands}.
15333
15334@menu
15335* Syntax Table Basics::
15336* Precedence in Syntax Tables::
15337* Advanced Syntax Patterns::
15338* Conditional Syntax Rules::
15339@end menu
15340
15341@node Syntax Table Basics, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15342@subsubsection Syntax Table Basics
15343
15344@noindent
15345@dfn{Parsing} is the process of converting a raw string of characters,
15346such as you would type in during algebraic entry, into a Calc formula.
15347Calc's parser works in two stages. First, the input is broken down
15348into @dfn{tokens}, such as words, numbers, and punctuation symbols
15349like @samp{+}, @samp{:=}, and @samp{+/-}. Space between tokens is
15350ignored (except when it serves to separate adjacent words). Next,
15351the parser matches this string of tokens against various built-in
15352syntactic patterns, such as ``an expression followed by @samp{+}
15353followed by another expression'' or ``a name followed by @samp{(},
15354zero or more expressions separated by commas, and @samp{)}.''
15355
15356A @dfn{syntax table} is a list of user-defined @dfn{syntax rules},
15357which allow you to specify new patterns to define your own
15358favorite input notations. Calc's parser always checks the syntax
15359table for the current language mode, then the table for the Normal
15360language mode, before it uses its built-in rules to parse an
15361algebraic formula you have entered. Each syntax rule should go on
15362its own line; it consists of a @dfn{pattern}, a @samp{:=} symbol,
15363and a Calc formula with an optional @dfn{condition}. (Syntax rules
15364resemble algebraic rewrite rules, but the notation for patterns is
15365completely different.)
15366
15367A syntax pattern is a list of tokens, separated by spaces.
15368Except for a few special symbols, tokens in syntax patterns are
15369matched literally, from left to right. For example, the rule,
15370
15371@example
15372foo ( ) := 2+3
15373@end example
15374
15375@noindent
15376would cause Calc to parse the formula @samp{4+foo()*5} as if it
15377were @samp{4+(2+3)*5}. Notice that the parentheses were written
15378as two separate tokens in the rule. As a result, the rule works
15379for both @samp{foo()} and @w{@samp{foo ( )}}. If we had written
15380the rule as @samp{foo () := 2+3}, then Calc would treat @samp{()}
15381as a single, indivisible token, so that @w{@samp{foo( )}} would
15382not be recognized by the rule. (It would be parsed as a regular
15383zero-argument function call instead.) In fact, this rule would
15384also make trouble for the rest of Calc's parser: An unrelated
15385formula like @samp{bar()} would now be tokenized into @samp{bar ()}
15386instead of @samp{bar ( )}, so that the standard parser for function
15387calls would no longer recognize it!
15388
15389While it is possible to make a token with a mixture of letters
15390and punctuation symbols, this is not recommended. It is better to
15391break it into several tokens, as we did with @samp{foo()} above.
15392
15393The symbol @samp{#} in a syntax pattern matches any Calc expression.
15394On the righthand side, the things that matched the @samp{#}s can
15395be referred to as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on (where @samp{#1}
15396matches the leftmost @samp{#} in the pattern). For example, these
15397rules match a user-defined function, prefix operator, infix operator,
15398and postfix operator, respectively:
15399
15400@example
15401foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15402foo # := myprefix(#1)
15403# foo # := myinfix(#1,#2)
15404# foo := mypostfix(#1)
15405@end example
15406
15407Thus @samp{foo(3)} will parse as @samp{myfunc(3)}, and @samp{2+3 foo}
15408will parse as @samp{mypostfix(2+3)}.
15409
15410It is important to write the first two rules in the order shown,
15411because Calc tries rules in order from first to last. If the
15412pattern @samp{foo #} came first, it would match anything that could
15413match the @samp{foo ( # )} rule, since an expression in parentheses
15414is itself a valid expression. Thus the @w{@samp{foo ( # )}} rule would
15415never get to match anything. Likewise, the last two rules must be
15416written in the order shown or else @samp{3 foo 4} will be parsed as
15417@samp{mypostfix(3) * 4}. (Of course, the best way to avoid these
15418ambiguities is not to use the same symbol in more than one way at
15419the same time! In case you're not convinced, try the following
15420exercise: How will the above rules parse the input @samp{foo(3,4)},
15421if at all? Work it out for yourself, then try it in Calc and see.)
15422
15423Calc is quite flexible about what sorts of patterns are allowed.
15424The only rule is that every pattern must begin with a literal
15425token (like @samp{foo} in the first two patterns above), or with
15426a @samp{#} followed by a literal token (as in the last two
15427patterns). After that, any mixture is allowed, although putting
15428two @samp{#}s in a row will not be very useful since two
15429expressions with nothing between them will be parsed as one
15430expression that uses implicit multiplication.
15431
15432As a more practical example, Maple uses the notation
15433@samp{sum(a(i), i=1..10)} for sums, which Calc's Maple mode doesn't
15434recognize at present. To handle this syntax, we simply add the
15435rule,
15436
15437@example
15438sum ( # , # = # .. # ) := sum(#1,#2,#3,#4)
15439@end example
15440
15441@noindent
15442to the Maple mode syntax table. As another example, C mode can't
15443read assignment operators like @samp{++} and @samp{*=}. We can
15444define these operators quite easily:
15445
15446@example
15447# *= # := muleq(#1,#2)
15448# ++ := postinc(#1)
15449++ # := preinc(#1)
15450@end example
15451
15452@noindent
15453To complete the job, we would use corresponding composition functions
15454and @kbd{Z C} to cause these functions to display in their respective
15455Maple and C notations. (Note that the C example ignores issues of
15456operator precedence, which are discussed in the next section.)
15457
15458You can enclose any token in quotes to prevent its usual
15459interpretation in syntax patterns:
15460
15461@example
15462# ":=" # := becomes(#1,#2)
15463@end example
15464
15465Quotes also allow you to include spaces in a token, although once
15466again it is generally better to use two tokens than one token with
15467an embedded space. To include an actual quotation mark in a quoted
15468token, precede it with a backslash. (This also works to include
15469backslashes in tokens.)
15470
15471@example
15472# "bad token" # "/\"\\" # := silly(#1,#2,#3)
15473@end example
15474
15475@noindent
15476This will parse @samp{3 bad token 4 /"\ 5} to @samp{silly(3,4,5)}.
15477
15478The token @kbd{#} has a predefined meaning in Calc's formula parser;
15479it is not valid to use @samp{"#"} in a syntax rule. However, longer
15480tokens that include the @samp{#} character are allowed. Also, while
15481@samp{"$"} and @samp{"\""} are allowed as tokens, their presence in
15482the syntax table will prevent those characters from working in their
15483usual ways (referring to stack entries and quoting strings,
15484respectively).
15485
15486Finally, the notation @samp{%%} anywhere in a syntax table causes
15487the rest of the line to be ignored as a comment.
15488
15489@node Precedence in Syntax Tables, Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Table Basics, Syntax Tables
15490@subsubsection Precedence
15491
15492@noindent
15493Different operators are generally assigned different @dfn{precedences}.
15494By default, an operator defined by a rule like
15495
15496@example
15497# foo # := foo(#1,#2)
15498@end example
15499
15500@noindent
15501will have an extremely low precedence, so that @samp{2*3+4 foo 5 == 6}
15502will be parsed as @samp{(2*3+4) foo (5 == 6)}. To change the
15503precedence of an operator, use the notation @samp{#/@var{p}} in
15504place of @samp{#}, where @var{p} is an integer precedence level.
15505For example, 185 lies between the precedences for @samp{+} and
15506@samp{*}, so if we change this rule to
15507
15508@example
15509#/185 foo #/186 := foo(#1,#2)
15510@end example
15511
15512@noindent
15513then @samp{2+3 foo 4*5} will be parsed as @samp{2+(3 foo (4*5))}.
15514Also, because we've given the righthand expression slightly higher
15515precedence, our new operator will be left-associative:
15516@samp{1 foo 2 foo 3} will be parsed as @samp{(1 foo 2) foo 3}.
15517By raising the precedence of the lefthand expression instead, we
15518can create a right-associative operator.
15519
15520@xref{Composition Basics}, for a table of precedences of the
15521standard Calc operators. For the precedences of operators in other
15522language modes, look in the Calc source file @file{calc-lang.el}.
15523
15524@node Advanced Syntax Patterns, Conditional Syntax Rules, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15525@subsubsection Advanced Syntax Patterns
15526
15527@noindent
15528To match a function with a variable number of arguments, you could
15529write
15530
15531@example
15532foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15533foo ( # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2)
15534foo ( # , # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2,#3)
15535@end example
15536
15537@noindent
15538but this isn't very elegant. To match variable numbers of items,
15539Calc uses some notations inspired regular expressions and the
15540``extended BNF'' style used by some language designers.
15541
15542@example
15543foo ( @{ # @}*, ) := apply(myfunc,#1)
15544@end example
15545
15546The token @samp{@{} introduces a repeated or optional portion.
15547One of the three tokens @samp{@}*}, @samp{@}+}, or @samp{@}?}
15548ends the portion. These will match zero or more, one or more,
15549or zero or one copies of the enclosed pattern, respectively.
15550In addition, @samp{@}*} and @samp{@}+} can be followed by a
15551separator token (with no space in between, as shown above).
15552Thus @samp{@{ # @}*,} matches nothing, or one expression, or
15553several expressions separated by commas.
15554
15555A complete @samp{@{ ... @}} item matches as a vector of the
15556items that matched inside it. For example, the above rule will
15557match @samp{foo(1,2,3)} to get @samp{apply(myfunc,[1,2,3])}.
15558The Calc @code{apply} function takes a function name and a vector
15559of arguments and builds a call to the function with those
15560arguments, so the net result is the formula @samp{myfunc(1,2,3)}.
15561
15562If the body of a @samp{@{ ... @}} contains several @samp{#}s
15563(or nested @samp{@{ ... @}} constructs), then the items will be
15564strung together into the resulting vector. If the body
15565does not contain anything but literal tokens, the result will
15566always be an empty vector.
15567
15568@example
15569foo ( @{ # , # @}+, ) := bar(#1)
15570foo ( @{ @{ # @}*, @}*; ) := matrix(#1)
15571@end example
15572
15573@noindent
15574will parse @samp{foo(1, 2, 3, 4)} as @samp{bar([1, 2, 3, 4])}, and
15575@samp{foo(1, 2; 3, 4)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2], [3, 4]])}. Also, after
15576some thought it's easy to see how this pair of rules will parse
15577@samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2, 3]])}, since the first
15578rule will only match an even number of arguments. The rule
15579
15580@example
15581foo ( # @{ , # , # @}? ) := bar(#1,#2)
15582@end example
15583
15584@noindent
15585will parse @samp{foo(2,3,4)} as @samp{bar(2,[3,4])}, and
15586@samp{foo(2)} as @samp{bar(2,[])}.
15587
15588The notation @samp{@{ ... @}?.} (note the trailing period) works
15589just the same as regular @samp{@{ ... @}?}, except that it does not
15590count as an argument; the following two rules are equivalent:
15591
15592@example
15593foo ( # , @{ also @}? # ) := bar(#1,#3)
15594foo ( # , @{ also @}?. # ) := bar(#1,#2)
15595@end example
15596
15597@noindent
15598Note that in the first case the optional text counts as @samp{#2},
15599which will always be an empty vector, but in the second case no
15600empty vector is produced.
15601
15602Another variant is @samp{@{ ... @}?$}, which means the body is
15603optional only at the end of the input formula. All built-in syntax
15604rules in Calc use this for closing delimiters, so that during
15605algebraic entry you can type @kbd{[sqrt(2), sqrt(3 @key{RET}}, omitting
15606the closing parenthesis and bracket. Calc does this automatically
15607for trailing @samp{)}, @samp{]}, and @samp{>} tokens in syntax
15608rules, but you can use @samp{@{ ... @}?$} explicitly to get
15609this effect with any token (such as @samp{"@}"} or @samp{end}).
15610Like @samp{@{ ... @}?.}, this notation does not count as an
15611argument. Conversely, you can use quotes, as in @samp{")"}, to
15612prevent a closing-delimiter token from being automatically treated
15613as optional.
15614
15615Calc's parser does not have full backtracking, which means some
15616patterns will not work as you might expect:
15617
15618@example
15619foo ( @{ # , @}? # , # ) := bar(#1,#2,#3)
15620@end example
15621
15622@noindent
15623Here we are trying to make the first argument optional, so that
15624@samp{foo(2,3)} parses as @samp{bar([],2,3)}. Unfortunately, Calc
15625first tries to match @samp{2,} against the optional part of the
15626pattern, finds a match, and so goes ahead to match the rest of the
15627pattern. Later on it will fail to match the second comma, but it
15628doesn't know how to go back and try the other alternative at that
15629point. One way to get around this would be to use two rules:
15630
15631@example
15632foo ( # , # , # ) := bar([#1],#2,#3)
15633foo ( # , # ) := bar([],#1,#2)
15634@end example
15635
15636More precisely, when Calc wants to match an optional or repeated
15637part of a pattern, it scans forward attempting to match that part.
15638If it reaches the end of the optional part without failing, it
15639``finalizes'' its choice and proceeds. If it fails, though, it
15640backs up and tries the other alternative. Thus Calc has ``partial''
15641backtracking. A fully backtracking parser would go on to make sure
15642the rest of the pattern matched before finalizing the choice.
15643
15644@node Conditional Syntax Rules, , Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Tables
15645@subsubsection Conditional Syntax Rules
15646
15647@noindent
15648It is possible to attach a @dfn{condition} to a syntax rule. For
15649example, the rules
15650
15651@example
15652foo ( # ) := ifoo(#1) :: integer(#1)
15653foo ( # ) := gfoo(#1)
15654@end example
15655
15656@noindent
15657will parse @samp{foo(3)} as @samp{ifoo(3)}, but will parse
15658@samp{foo(3.5)} and @samp{foo(x)} as calls to @code{gfoo}. Any
15659number of conditions may be attached; all must be true for the
15660rule to succeed. A condition is ``true'' if it evaluates to a
15661nonzero number. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a list of Calc
15662functions like @code{integer} that perform logical tests.
15663
15664The exact sequence of events is as follows: When Calc tries a
15665rule, it first matches the pattern as usual. It then substitutes
15666@samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, etc., in the conditions, if any. Next, the
15667conditions are simplified and evaluated in order from left to right,
15668as if by the @w{@kbd{a s}} algebra command (@pxref{Simplifying Formulas}).
15669Each result is true if it is a nonzero number, or an expression
15670that can be proven to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}). If the
15671results of all conditions are true, the expression (such as
15672@samp{ifoo(#1)}) has its @samp{#}s substituted, and that is the
15673result of the parse. If the result of any condition is false, Calc
15674goes on to try the next rule in the syntax table.
15675
15676Syntax rules also support @code{let} conditions, which operate in
15677exactly the same way as they do in algebraic rewrite rules.
15678@xref{Other Features of Rewrite Rules}, for details. A @code{let}
15679condition is always true, but as a side effect it defines a
15680variable which can be used in later conditions, and also in the
15681expression after the @samp{:=} sign:
15682
15683@example
15684foo ( # ) := hifoo(x) :: let(x := #1 + 0.5) :: dnumint(x)
15685@end example
15686
15687@noindent
15688The @code{dnumint} function tests if a value is numerically an
15689integer, i.e., either a true integer or an integer-valued float.
15690This rule will parse @code{foo} with a half-integer argument,
15691like @samp{foo(3.5)}, to a call like @samp{hifoo(4.)}.
15692
15693The lefthand side of a syntax rule @code{let} must be a simple
15694variable, not the arbitrary pattern that is allowed in rewrite
15695rules.
15696
15697The @code{matches} function is also treated specially in syntax
15698rule conditions (again, in the same way as in rewrite rules).
15699@xref{Matching Commands}. If the matching pattern contains
15700meta-variables, then those meta-variables may be used in later
15701conditions and in the result expression. The arguments to
15702@code{matches} are not evaluated in this situation.
15703
15704@example
15705sum ( # , # ) := sum(#1,a,b,c) :: matches(#2, a=[b..c])
15706@end example
15707
15708@noindent
15709This is another way to implement the Maple mode @code{sum} notation.
15710In this approach, we allow @samp{#2} to equal the whole expression
15711@samp{i=1..10}. Then, we use @code{matches} to break it apart into
15712its components. If the expression turns out not to match the pattern,
15713the syntax rule will fail. Note that @kbd{Z S} always uses Calc's
15714Normal language mode for editing expressions in syntax rules, so we
15715must use regular Calc notation for the interval @samp{[b..c]} that
15716will correspond to the Maple mode interval @samp{1..10}.
15717
15718@node Modes Variable, Calc Mode Line, Language Modes, Mode Settings
15719@section The @code{Modes} Variable
15720
15721@noindent
15722@kindex m g
15723@pindex calc-get-modes
15724The @kbd{m g} (@code{calc-get-modes}) command pushes onto the stack
15725a vector of numbers that describes the various mode settings that
15726are in effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it pushes only the
15727@var{n}th mode, i.e., the @var{n}th element of this vector. Keyboard
15728macros can use the @kbd{m g} command to modify their behavior based
15729on the current mode settings.
15730
15731@cindex @code{Modes} variable
15732@vindex Modes
15733The modes vector is also available in the special variable
15734@code{Modes}. In other words, @kbd{m g} is like @kbd{s r Modes @key{RET}}.
15735It will not work to store into this variable; in fact, if you do,
15736@code{Modes} will cease to track the current modes. (The @kbd{m g}
15737command will continue to work, however.)
15738
15739In general, each number in this vector is suitable as a numeric
15740prefix argument to the associated mode-setting command. (Recall
15741that the @kbd{~} key takes a number from the stack and gives it as
15742a numeric prefix to the next command.)
15743
15744The elements of the modes vector are as follows:
15745
15746@enumerate
15747@item
15748Current precision. Default is 12; associated command is @kbd{p}.
15749
15750@item
15751Binary word size. Default is 32; associated command is @kbd{b w}.
15752
15753@item
15754Stack size (not counting the value about to be pushed by @kbd{m g}).
15755This is zero if @kbd{m g} is executed with an empty stack.
15756
15757@item
15758Number radix. Default is 10; command is @kbd{d r}.
15759
15760@item
15761Floating-point format. This is the number of digits, plus the
15762constant 0 for normal notation, 10000 for scientific notation,
1576320000 for engineering notation, or 30000 for fixed-point notation.
15764These codes are acceptable as prefix arguments to the @kbd{d n}
15765command, but note that this may lose information: For example,
15766@kbd{d s} and @kbd{C-u 12 d s} have similar (but not quite
15767identical) effects if the current precision is 12, but they both
15768produce a code of 10012, which will be treated by @kbd{d n} as
15769@kbd{C-u 12 d s}. If the precision then changes, the float format
15770will still be frozen at 12 significant figures.
15771
15772@item
15773Angular mode. Default is 1 (degrees). Other values are 2 (radians)
15774and 3 (HMS). The @kbd{m d} command accepts these prefixes.
15775
15776@item
15777Symbolic mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m s}.
15778
15779@item
15780Fraction mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m f}.
15781
15782@item
15783Polar mode. Value is 0 (rectangular) or 1 (polar); default is 0.
15784Command is @kbd{m p}.
15785
15786@item
15787Matrix/Scalar mode. Default value is @mathit{-1}. Value is 0 for Scalar
15788mode, @mathit{-2} for Matrix mode, @mathit{-3} for square Matrix mode,
15789or @var{N} for
15790@texline @math{N\times N}
15791@infoline @var{N}x@var{N}
15792Matrix mode. Command is @kbd{m v}.
15793
15794@item
15795Simplification mode. Default is 1. Value is @mathit{-1} for off (@kbd{m O}),
157960 for @kbd{m N}, 2 for @kbd{m B}, 3 for @kbd{m A}, 4 for @kbd{m E},
15797or 5 for @w{@kbd{m U}}. The @kbd{m D} command accepts these prefixes.
15798
15799@item
15800Infinite mode. Default is @mathit{-1} (off). Value is 1 if the mode is on,
15801or 0 if the mode is on with positive zeros. Command is @kbd{m i}.
15802@end enumerate
15803
15804For example, the sequence @kbd{M-1 m g @key{RET} 2 + ~ p} increases the
15805precision by two, leaving a copy of the old precision on the stack.
15806Later, @kbd{~ p} will restore the original precision using that
15807stack value. (This sequence might be especially useful inside a
15808keyboard macro.)
15809
15810As another example, @kbd{M-3 m g 1 - ~ @key{DEL}} deletes all but the
15811oldest (bottommost) stack entry.
15812
15813Yet another example: The HP-48 ``round'' command rounds a number
15814to the current displayed precision. You could roughly emulate this
15815in Calc with the sequence @kbd{M-5 m g 10000 % ~ c c}. (This
15816would not work for fixed-point mode, but it wouldn't be hard to
15817do a full emulation with the help of the @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z ]}
15818programming commands. @xref{Conditionals in Macros}.)
15819
15820@node Calc Mode Line, , Modes Variable, Mode Settings
15821@section The Calc Mode Line
15822
15823@noindent
15824@cindex Mode line indicators
15825This section is a summary of all symbols that can appear on the
15826Calc mode line, the highlighted bar that appears under the Calc
15827stack window (or under an editing window in Embedded mode).
15828
15829The basic mode line format is:
15830
15831@example
92e15881 15832--%*-Calc: 12 Deg @var{other modes} (Calculator)
4009494e
GM
15833@end example
15834
92e15881 15835The @samp{%*} indicates that the buffer is ``read-only''; it shows that
4009494e
GM
15836regular Emacs commands are not allowed to edit the stack buffer
15837as if it were text.
15838
15839The word @samp{Calc:} changes to @samp{CalcEmbed:} if Embedded mode
15840is enabled. The words after this describe the various Calc modes
15841that are in effect.
15842
15843The first mode is always the current precision, an integer.
15844The second mode is always the angular mode, either @code{Deg},
15845@code{Rad}, or @code{Hms}.
15846
15847Here is a complete list of the remaining symbols that can appear
15848on the mode line:
15849
15850@table @code
15851@item Alg
15852Algebraic mode (@kbd{m a}; @pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
15853
15854@item Alg[(
15855Incomplete algebraic mode (@kbd{C-u m a}).
15856
15857@item Alg*
15858Total algebraic mode (@kbd{m t}).
15859
15860@item Symb
15861Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}).
15862
15863@item Matrix
15864Matrix mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15865
15866@item Matrix@var{n}
15867Dimensioned Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u @var{n} m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15868
15869@item SqMatrix
15870Square Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15871
15872@item Scalar
15873Scalar mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15874
15875@item Polar
15876Polar complex mode (@kbd{m p}; @pxref{Polar Mode}).
15877
15878@item Frac
15879Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}; @pxref{Fraction Mode}).
15880
15881@item Inf
15882Infinite mode (@kbd{m i}; @pxref{Infinite Mode}).
15883
15884@item +Inf
15885Positive Infinite mode (@kbd{C-u 0 m i}).
15886
15887@item NoSimp
15888Default simplifications off (@kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}).
15889
15890@item NumSimp
15891Default simplifications for numeric arguments only (@kbd{m N}).
15892
15893@item BinSimp@var{w}
15894Binary-integer simplification mode; word size @var{w} (@kbd{m B}, @kbd{b w}).
15895
15896@item AlgSimp
15897Algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m A}).
15898
15899@item ExtSimp
15900Extended algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m E}).
15901
15902@item UnitSimp
15903Units simplification mode (@kbd{m U}).
15904
15905@item Bin
15906Current radix is 2 (@kbd{d 2}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15907
15908@item Oct
15909Current radix is 8 (@kbd{d 8}).
15910
15911@item Hex
15912Current radix is 16 (@kbd{d 6}).
15913
15914@item Radix@var{n}
15915Current radix is @var{n} (@kbd{d r}).
15916
15917@item Zero
15918Leading zeros (@kbd{d z}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15919
15920@item Big
15921Big language mode (@kbd{d B}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15922
15923@item Flat
15924One-line normal language mode (@kbd{d O}).
15925
15926@item Unform
15927Unformatted language mode (@kbd{d U}).
15928
15929@item C
15930C language mode (@kbd{d C}; @pxref{C FORTRAN Pascal}).
15931
15932@item Pascal
15933Pascal language mode (@kbd{d P}).
15934
15935@item Fortran
15936FORTRAN language mode (@kbd{d F}).
15937
15938@item TeX
15939@TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d T}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
15940
15941@item LaTeX
15942La@TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d L}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
15943
15944@item Eqn
15945@dfn{Eqn} language mode (@kbd{d E}; @pxref{Eqn Language Mode}).
15946
15947@item Math
15948Mathematica language mode (@kbd{d M}; @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}).
15949
15950@item Maple
15951Maple language mode (@kbd{d W}; @pxref{Maple Language Mode}).
15952
15953@item Norm@var{n}
15954Normal float mode with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d n}; @pxref{Float Formats}).
15955
15956@item Fix@var{n}
15957Fixed point mode with @var{n} digits after the point (@kbd{d f}).
15958
15959@item Sci
15960Scientific notation mode (@kbd{d s}).
15961
15962@item Sci@var{n}
15963Scientific notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d s}).
15964
15965@item Eng
15966Engineering notation mode (@kbd{d e}).
15967
15968@item Eng@var{n}
15969Engineering notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d e}).
15970
15971@item Left@var{n}
15972Left-justified display indented by @var{n} (@kbd{d <}; @pxref{Justification}).
15973
15974@item Right
15975Right-justified display (@kbd{d >}).
15976
15977@item Right@var{n}
15978Right-justified display with width @var{n} (@kbd{d >}).
15979
15980@item Center
15981Centered display (@kbd{d =}).
15982
15983@item Center@var{n}
15984Centered display with center column @var{n} (@kbd{d =}).
15985
15986@item Wid@var{n}
15987Line breaking with width @var{n} (@kbd{d b}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15988
15989@item Wide
15990No line breaking (@kbd{d b}).
15991
15992@item Break
15993Selections show deep structure (@kbd{j b}; @pxref{Making Selections}).
15994
15995@item Save
dcf7843e 15996Record modes in @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el} (@kbd{m R}; @pxref{General Mode Commands}).
4009494e
GM
15997
15998@item Local
15999Record modes in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16000
16001@item LocEdit
16002Record modes as editing-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16003
16004@item LocPerm
16005Record modes as permanent-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16006
16007@item Global
16008Record modes as global in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16009
16010@item Manual
16011Automatic recomputation turned off (@kbd{m C}; @pxref{Automatic
16012Recomputation}).
16013
16014@item Graph
16015GNUPLOT process is alive in background (@pxref{Graphics}).
16016
16017@item Sel
16018Top-of-stack has a selection (Embedded only; @pxref{Making Selections}).
16019
16020@item Dirty
16021The stack display may not be up-to-date (@pxref{Display Modes}).
16022
16023@item Inv
16024``Inverse'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{I}; @pxref{Inverse and Hyperbolic}).
16025
16026@item Hyp
16027``Hyperbolic'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{H}).
16028
16029@item Keep
16030``Keep-arguments'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{K}).
16031
16032@item Narrow
16033Stack is truncated (@kbd{d t}; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}).
16034@end table
16035
16036In addition, the symbols @code{Active} and @code{~Active} can appear
16037as minor modes on an Embedded buffer's mode line. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
16038
16039@node Arithmetic, Scientific Functions, Mode Settings, Top
16040@chapter Arithmetic Functions
16041
16042@noindent
16043This chapter describes the Calc commands for doing simple calculations
16044on numbers, such as addition, absolute value, and square roots. These
16045commands work by removing the top one or two values from the stack,
16046performing the desired operation, and pushing the result back onto the
16047stack. If the operation cannot be performed, the result pushed is a
16048formula instead of a number, such as @samp{2/0} (because division by zero
16049is invalid) or @samp{sqrt(x)} (because the argument @samp{x} is a formula).
16050
16051Most of the commands described here can be invoked by a single keystroke.
16052Some of the more obscure ones are two-letter sequences beginning with
16053the @kbd{f} (``functions'') prefix key.
16054
16055@xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
16056prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
16057interpret a prefix argument.
16058
16059@menu
16060* Basic Arithmetic::
16061* Integer Truncation::
16062* Complex Number Functions::
16063* Conversions::
16064* Date Arithmetic::
16065* Financial Functions::
16066* Binary Functions::
16067@end menu
16068
16069@node Basic Arithmetic, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16070@section Basic Arithmetic
16071
16072@noindent
16073@kindex +
16074@pindex calc-plus
16075@ignore
16076@mindex @null
16077@end ignore
16078@tindex +
16079The @kbd{+} (@code{calc-plus}) command adds two numbers. The numbers may
16080be any of the standard Calc data types. The resulting sum is pushed back
16081onto the stack.
16082
16083If both arguments of @kbd{+} are vectors or matrices (of matching dimensions),
16084the result is a vector or matrix sum. If one argument is a vector and the
16085other a scalar (i.e., a non-vector), the scalar is added to each of the
16086elements of the vector to form a new vector. If the scalar is not a
16087number, the operation is left in symbolic form: Suppose you added @samp{x}
16088to the vector @samp{[1,2]}. You may want the result @samp{[1+x,2+x]}, or
16089you may plan to substitute a 2-vector for @samp{x} in the future. Since
16090the Calculator can't tell which interpretation you want, it makes the
16091safest assumption. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, for a way to add @samp{x}
16092to every element of a vector.
16093
16094If either argument of @kbd{+} is a complex number, the result will in general
16095be complex. If one argument is in rectangular form and the other polar,
16096the current Polar mode determines the form of the result. If Symbolic
16097mode is enabled, the sum may be left as a formula if the necessary
16098conversions for polar addition are non-trivial.
16099
16100If both arguments of @kbd{+} are HMS forms, the forms are added according to
16101the usual conventions of hours-minutes-seconds notation. If one argument
16102is an HMS form and the other is a number, that number is converted from
16103degrees or radians (depending on the current Angular mode) to HMS format
16104and then the two HMS forms are added.
16105
16106If one argument of @kbd{+} is a date form, the other can be either a
16107real number, which advances the date by a certain number of days, or
16108an HMS form, which advances the date by a certain amount of time.
16109Subtracting two date forms yields the number of days between them.
16110Adding two date forms is meaningless, but Calc interprets it as the
16111subtraction of one date form and the negative of the other. (The
16112negative of a date form can be understood by remembering that dates
16113are stored as the number of days before or after Jan 1, 1 AD.)
16114
16115If both arguments of @kbd{+} are error forms, the result is an error form
16116with an appropriately computed standard deviation. If one argument is an
16117error form and the other is a number, the number is taken to have zero error.
16118Error forms may have symbolic formulas as their mean and/or error parts;
16119adding these will produce a symbolic error form result. However, adding an
16120error form to a plain symbolic formula (as in @samp{(a +/- b) + c}) will not
16121work, for the same reasons just mentioned for vectors. Instead you must
16122write @samp{(a +/- b) + (c +/- 0)}.
16123
16124If both arguments of @kbd{+} are modulo forms with equal values of @expr{M},
16125or if one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number, the
16126result is a modulo form which represents the sum, modulo @expr{M}, of
16127the two values.
16128
16129If both arguments of @kbd{+} are intervals, the result is an interval
16130which describes all possible sums of the possible input values. If
16131one argument is a plain number, it is treated as the interval
16132@w{@samp{[x ..@: x]}}.
16133
16134If one argument of @kbd{+} is an infinity and the other is not, the
16135result is that same infinity. If both arguments are infinite and in
16136the same direction, the result is the same infinity, but if they are
16137infinite in different directions the result is @code{nan}.
16138
16139@kindex -
16140@pindex calc-minus
16141@ignore
16142@mindex @null
16143@end ignore
16144@tindex -
16145The @kbd{-} (@code{calc-minus}) command subtracts two values. The top
16146number on the stack is subtracted from the one behind it, so that the
16147computation @kbd{5 @key{RET} 2 -} produces 3, not @mathit{-3}. All options
16148available for @kbd{+} are available for @kbd{-} as well.
16149
16150@kindex *
16151@pindex calc-times
16152@ignore
16153@mindex @null
16154@end ignore
16155@tindex *
16156The @kbd{*} (@code{calc-times}) command multiplies two numbers. If one
16157argument is a vector and the other a scalar, the scalar is multiplied by
16158the elements of the vector to produce a new vector. If both arguments
16159are vectors, the interpretation depends on the dimensions of the
16160vectors: If both arguments are matrices, a matrix multiplication is
16161done. If one argument is a matrix and the other a plain vector, the
16162vector is interpreted as a row vector or column vector, whichever is
16163dimensionally correct. If both arguments are plain vectors, the result
16164is a single scalar number which is the dot product of the two vectors.
16165
16166If one argument of @kbd{*} is an HMS form and the other a number, the
16167HMS form is multiplied by that amount. It is an error to multiply two
16168HMS forms together, or to attempt any multiplication involving date
16169forms. Error forms, modulo forms, and intervals can be multiplied;
16170see the comments for addition of those forms. When two error forms
16171or intervals are multiplied they are considered to be statistically
16172independent; thus, @samp{[-2 ..@: 3] * [-2 ..@: 3]} is @samp{[-6 ..@: 9]},
16173whereas @w{@samp{[-2 ..@: 3] ^ 2}} is @samp{[0 ..@: 9]}.
16174
16175@kindex /
16176@pindex calc-divide
16177@ignore
16178@mindex @null
16179@end ignore
16180@tindex /
16181The @kbd{/} (@code{calc-divide}) command divides two numbers.
16182
16183When combining multiplication and division in an algebraic formula, it
16184is good style to use parentheses to distinguish between possible
16185interpretations; the expression @samp{a/b*c} should be written
16186@samp{(a/b)*c} or @samp{a/(b*c)}, as appropriate. Without the
16187parentheses, Calc will interpret @samp{a/b*c} as @samp{a/(b*c)}, since
16188in algebraic entry Calc gives division a lower precedence than
16189multiplication. (This is not standard across all computer languages, and
16190Calc may change the precedence depending on the language mode being used.
16191@xref{Language Modes}.) This default ordering can be changed by setting
16192the customizable variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} to
16193@code{nil} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}); this will give multiplication and
16194division equal precedences. Note that Calc's default choice of
16195precedence allows @samp{a b / c d} to be used as a shortcut for
16196@smallexample
16197@group
16198a b
16199---.
16200c d
16201@end group
16202@end smallexample
16203
16204When dividing a scalar @expr{B} by a square matrix @expr{A}, the
16205computation performed is @expr{B} times the inverse of @expr{A}. This
16206also occurs if @expr{B} is itself a vector or matrix, in which case the
16207effect is to solve the set of linear equations represented by @expr{B}.
16208If @expr{B} is a matrix with the same number of rows as @expr{A}, or a
16209plain vector (which is interpreted here as a column vector), then the
16210equation @expr{A X = B} is solved for the vector or matrix @expr{X}.
16211Otherwise, if @expr{B} is a non-square matrix with the same number of
16212@emph{columns} as @expr{A}, the equation @expr{X A = B} is solved. If
16213you wish a vector @expr{B} to be interpreted as a row vector to be
16214solved as @expr{X A = B}, make it into a one-row matrix with @kbd{C-u 1
16215v p} first. To force a left-handed solution with a square matrix
16216@expr{B}, transpose @expr{A} and @expr{B} before dividing, then
16217transpose the result.
16218
16219HMS forms can be divided by real numbers or by other HMS forms. Error
16220forms can be divided in any combination of ways. Modulo forms where both
16221values and the modulo are integers can be divided to get an integer modulo
16222form result. Intervals can be divided; dividing by an interval that
16223encompasses zero or has zero as a limit will result in an infinite
16224interval.
16225
16226@kindex ^
16227@pindex calc-power
16228@ignore
16229@mindex @null
16230@end ignore
16231@tindex ^
16232The @kbd{^} (@code{calc-power}) command raises a number to a power. If
16233the power is an integer, an exact result is computed using repeated
16234multiplications. For non-integer powers, Calc uses Newton's method or
16235logarithms and exponentials. Square matrices can be raised to integer
16236powers. If either argument is an error (or interval or modulo) form,
16237the result is also an error (or interval or modulo) form.
16238
16239@kindex I ^
16240@tindex nroot
16241If you press the @kbd{I} (inverse) key first, the @kbd{I ^} command
16242computes an Nth root: @kbd{125 @key{RET} 3 I ^} computes the number 5.
16243(This is entirely equivalent to @kbd{125 @key{RET} 1:3 ^}.)
16244
16245@kindex \
16246@pindex calc-idiv
16247@tindex idiv
16248@ignore
16249@mindex @null
16250@end ignore
16251@tindex \
16252The @kbd{\} (@code{calc-idiv}) command divides two numbers on the stack
16253to produce an integer result. It is equivalent to dividing with
16254@key{/}, then rounding down with @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}), only a bit
16255more convenient and efficient. Also, since it is an all-integer
16256operation when the arguments are integers, it avoids problems that
16257@kbd{/ F} would have with floating-point roundoff.
16258
16259@kindex %
16260@pindex calc-mod
16261@ignore
16262@mindex @null
16263@end ignore
16264@tindex %
16265The @kbd{%} (@code{calc-mod}) command performs a ``modulo'' (or ``remainder'')
16266operation. Mathematically, @samp{a%b = a - (a\b)*b}, and is defined
16267for all real numbers @expr{a} and @expr{b} (except @expr{b=0}). For
16268positive @expr{b}, the result will always be between 0 (inclusive) and
16269@expr{b} (exclusive). Modulo does not work for HMS forms and error forms.
16270If @expr{a} is a modulo form, its modulo is changed to @expr{b}, which
16271must be positive real number.
16272
16273@kindex :
16274@pindex calc-fdiv
16275@tindex fdiv
16276The @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command
16277divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fractional
16278result. This is a convenient shorthand for enabling Fraction mode (with
16279@kbd{m f}) temporarily and using @samp{/}. Note that during numeric entry
16280the @kbd{:} key is interpreted as a fraction separator, so to divide 8 by 6
16281you would have to type @kbd{8 @key{RET} 6 @key{RET} :}. (Of course, in
16282this case, it would be much easier simply to enter the fraction directly
16283as @kbd{8:6 @key{RET}}!)
16284
16285@kindex n
16286@pindex calc-change-sign
16287The @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the number on the top
16288of the stack. It works on numbers, vectors and matrices, HMS forms, date
16289forms, error forms, intervals, and modulo forms.
16290
16291@kindex A
16292@pindex calc-abs
16293@tindex abs
16294The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the absolute
16295value of a number. The result of @code{abs} is always a nonnegative
16296real number: With a complex argument, it computes the complex magnitude.
16297With a vector or matrix argument, it computes the Frobenius norm, i.e.,
16298the square root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
16299elements. The absolute value of an error form is defined by replacing
16300the mean part with its absolute value and leaving the error part the same.
16301The absolute value of a modulo form is undefined. The absolute value of
16302an interval is defined in the obvious way.
16303
16304@kindex f A
16305@pindex calc-abssqr
16306@tindex abssqr
16307The @kbd{f A} (@code{calc-abssqr}) [@code{abssqr}] command computes the
16308absolute value squared of a number, vector or matrix, or error form.
16309
16310@kindex f s
16311@pindex calc-sign
16312@tindex sign
16313The @kbd{f s} (@code{calc-sign}) [@code{sign}] command returns 1 if its
16314argument is positive, @mathit{-1} if its argument is negative, or 0 if its
16315argument is zero. In algebraic form, you can also write @samp{sign(a,x)}
16316which evaluates to @samp{x * sign(a)}, i.e., either @samp{x}, @samp{-x}, or
16317zero depending on the sign of @samp{a}.
16318
16319@kindex &
16320@pindex calc-inv
16321@tindex inv
16322@cindex Reciprocal
16323The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
16324reciprocal of a number, i.e., @expr{1 / x}. Operating on a square
16325matrix, it computes the inverse of that matrix.
16326
16327@kindex Q
16328@pindex calc-sqrt
16329@tindex sqrt
16330The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] command computes the square
16331root of a number. For a negative real argument, the result will be a
16332complex number whose form is determined by the current Polar mode.
16333
16334@kindex f h
16335@pindex calc-hypot
16336@tindex hypot
16337The @kbd{f h} (@code{calc-hypot}) [@code{hypot}] command computes the square
16338root of the sum of the squares of two numbers. That is, @samp{hypot(a,b)}
16339is the length of the hypotenuse of a right triangle with sides @expr{a}
16340and @expr{b}. If the arguments are complex numbers, their squared
16341magnitudes are used.
16342
16343@kindex f Q
16344@pindex calc-isqrt
16345@tindex isqrt
16346The @kbd{f Q} (@code{calc-isqrt}) [@code{isqrt}] command computes the
16347integer square root of an integer. This is the true square root of the
16348number, rounded down to an integer. For example, @samp{isqrt(10)}
16349produces 3. Note that, like @kbd{\} [@code{idiv}], this uses exact
16350integer arithmetic throughout to avoid roundoff problems. If the input
16351is a floating-point number or other non-integer value, this is exactly
16352the same as @samp{floor(sqrt(x))}.
16353
16354@kindex f n
16355@kindex f x
16356@pindex calc-min
16357@tindex min
16358@pindex calc-max
16359@tindex max
16360The @kbd{f n} (@code{calc-min}) [@code{min}] and @kbd{f x} (@code{calc-max})
16361[@code{max}] commands take the minimum or maximum of two real numbers,
16362respectively. These commands also work on HMS forms, date forms,
16363intervals, and infinities. (In algebraic expressions, these functions
16364take any number of arguments and return the maximum or minimum among
16365all the arguments.)
16366
16367@kindex f M
16368@kindex f X
16369@pindex calc-mant-part
16370@tindex mant
16371@pindex calc-xpon-part
16372@tindex xpon
16373The @kbd{f M} (@code{calc-mant-part}) [@code{mant}] function extracts
16374the ``mantissa'' part @expr{m} of its floating-point argument; @kbd{f X}
16375(@code{calc-xpon-part}) [@code{xpon}] extracts the ``exponent'' part
16376@expr{e}. The original number is equal to
16377@texline @math{m \times 10^e},
16378@infoline @expr{m * 10^e},
16379where @expr{m} is in the interval @samp{[1.0 ..@: 10.0)} except that
16380@expr{m=e=0} if the original number is zero. For integers
16381and fractions, @code{mant} returns the number unchanged and @code{xpon}
16382returns zero. The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command can also be
16383used to ``unpack'' a floating-point number; this produces an integer
16384mantissa and exponent, with the constraint that the mantissa is not
16385a multiple of ten (again except for the @expr{m=e=0} case).
16386
16387@kindex f S
16388@pindex calc-scale-float
16389@tindex scf
16390The @kbd{f S} (@code{calc-scale-float}) [@code{scf}] function scales a number
16391by a given power of ten. Thus, @samp{scf(mant(x), xpon(x)) = x} for any
16392real @samp{x}. The second argument must be an integer, but the first
16393may actually be any numeric value. For example, @samp{scf(5,-2) = 0.05}
16394or @samp{1:20} depending on the current Fraction mode.
16395
16396@kindex f [
16397@kindex f ]
16398@pindex calc-decrement
16399@pindex calc-increment
16400@tindex decr
16401@tindex incr
16402The @kbd{f [} (@code{calc-decrement}) [@code{decr}] and @kbd{f ]}
16403(@code{calc-increment}) [@code{incr}] functions decrease or increase
16404a number by one unit. For integers, the effect is obvious. For
16405floating-point numbers, the change is by one unit in the last place.
16406For example, incrementing @samp{12.3456} when the current precision
16407is 6 digits yields @samp{12.3457}. If the current precision had been
164088 digits, the result would have been @samp{12.345601}. Incrementing
16409@samp{0.0} produces
16410@texline @math{10^{-p}},
16411@infoline @expr{10^-p},
16412where @expr{p} is the current
16413precision. These operations are defined only on integers and floats.
16414With numeric prefix arguments, they change the number by @expr{n} units.
16415
16416Note that incrementing followed by decrementing, or vice-versa, will
16417almost but not quite always cancel out. Suppose the precision is
164186 digits and the number @samp{9.99999} is on the stack. Incrementing
16419will produce @samp{10.0000}; decrementing will produce @samp{9.9999}.
16420One digit has been dropped. This is an unavoidable consequence of the
16421way floating-point numbers work.
16422
16423Incrementing a date/time form adjusts it by a certain number of seconds.
16424Incrementing a pure date form adjusts it by a certain number of days.
16425
16426@node Integer Truncation, Complex Number Functions, Basic Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16427@section Integer Truncation
16428
16429@noindent
16430There are four commands for truncating a real number to an integer,
16431differing mainly in their treatment of negative numbers. All of these
16432commands have the property that if the argument is an integer, the result
16433is the same integer. An integer-valued floating-point argument is converted
16434to integer form.
16435
16436If you press @kbd{H} (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) first, the result will be
16437expressed as an integer-valued floating-point number.
16438
16439@cindex Integer part of a number
16440@kindex F
16441@pindex calc-floor
16442@tindex floor
16443@tindex ffloor
16444@ignore
16445@mindex @null
16446@end ignore
16447@kindex H F
16448The @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) [@code{floor} or @code{ffloor}] command
16449truncates a real number to the next lower integer, i.e., toward minus
16450infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 F} produces 3, but @kbd{_3.6 F} produces
16451@mathit{-4}.
16452
16453@kindex I F
16454@pindex calc-ceiling
16455@tindex ceil
16456@tindex fceil
16457@ignore
16458@mindex @null
16459@end ignore
16460@kindex H I F
16461The @kbd{I F} (@code{calc-ceiling}) [@code{ceil} or @code{fceil}]
16462command truncates toward positive infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 I F} produces
164634, and @kbd{_3.6 I F} produces @mathit{-3}.
16464
16465@kindex R
16466@pindex calc-round
16467@tindex round
16468@tindex fround
16469@ignore
16470@mindex @null
16471@end ignore
16472@kindex H R
16473The @kbd{R} (@code{calc-round}) [@code{round} or @code{fround}] command
16474rounds to the nearest integer. When the fractional part is .5 exactly,
16475this command rounds away from zero. (All other rounding in the
16476Calculator uses this convention as well.) Thus @kbd{3.5 R} produces 4
16477but @kbd{3.4 R} produces 3; @kbd{_3.5 R} produces @mathit{-4}.
16478
16479@kindex I R
16480@pindex calc-trunc
16481@tindex trunc
16482@tindex ftrunc
16483@ignore
16484@mindex @null
16485@end ignore
16486@kindex H I R
16487The @kbd{I R} (@code{calc-trunc}) [@code{trunc} or @code{ftrunc}]
16488command truncates toward zero. In other words, it ``chops off''
16489everything after the decimal point. Thus @kbd{3.6 I R} produces 3 and
16490@kbd{_3.6 I R} produces @mathit{-3}.
16491
16492These functions may not be applied meaningfully to error forms, but they
16493do work for intervals. As a convenience, applying @code{floor} to a
16494modulo form floors the value part of the form. Applied to a vector,
16495these functions operate on all elements of the vector one by one.
16496Applied to a date form, they operate on the internal numerical
16497representation of dates, converting a date/time form into a pure date.
16498
16499@ignore
16500@starindex
16501@end ignore
16502@tindex rounde
16503@ignore
16504@starindex
16505@end ignore
16506@tindex roundu
16507@ignore
16508@starindex
16509@end ignore
16510@tindex frounde
16511@ignore
16512@starindex
16513@end ignore
16514@tindex froundu
16515There are two more rounding functions which can only be entered in
16516algebraic notation. The @code{roundu} function is like @code{round}
16517except that it rounds up, toward plus infinity, when the fractional
16518part is .5. This distinction matters only for negative arguments.
16519Also, @code{rounde} rounds to an even number in the case of a tie,
16520rounding up or down as necessary. For example, @samp{rounde(3.5)} and
16521@samp{rounde(4.5)} both return 4, but @samp{rounde(5.5)} returns 6.
16522The advantage of round-to-even is that the net error due to rounding
16523after a long calculation tends to cancel out to zero. An important
16524subtle point here is that the number being fed to @code{rounde} will
16525already have been rounded to the current precision before @code{rounde}
16526begins. For example, @samp{rounde(2.500001)} with a current precision
16527of 6 will incorrectly, or at least surprisingly, yield 2 because the
16528argument will first have been rounded down to @expr{2.5} (which
16529@code{rounde} sees as an exact tie between 2 and 3).
16530
16531Each of these functions, when written in algebraic formulas, allows
16532a second argument which specifies the number of digits after the
16533decimal point to keep. For example, @samp{round(123.4567, 2)} will
16534produce the answer 123.46, and @samp{round(123.4567, -1)} will
16535produce 120 (i.e., the cutoff is one digit to the @emph{left} of
16536the decimal point). A second argument of zero is equivalent to
16537no second argument at all.
16538
16539@cindex Fractional part of a number
16540To compute the fractional part of a number (i.e., the amount which, when
16541added to `@tfn{floor(}@var{n}@tfn{)}', will produce @var{n}) just take @var{n}
16542modulo 1 using the @code{%} command.
16543
16544Note also the @kbd{\} (integer quotient), @kbd{f I} (integer logarithm),
16545and @kbd{f Q} (integer square root) commands, which are analogous to
16546@kbd{/}, @kbd{B}, and @kbd{Q}, respectively, except that they take integer
16547arguments and return the result rounded down to an integer.
16548
16549@node Complex Number Functions, Conversions, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic
16550@section Complex Number Functions
16551
16552@noindent
16553@kindex J
16554@pindex calc-conj
16555@tindex conj
16556The @kbd{J} (@code{calc-conj}) [@code{conj}] command computes the
16557complex conjugate of a number. For complex number @expr{a+bi}, the
16558complex conjugate is @expr{a-bi}. If the argument is a real number,
16559this command leaves it the same. If the argument is a vector or matrix,
16560this command replaces each element by its complex conjugate.
16561
16562@kindex G
16563@pindex calc-argument
16564@tindex arg
16565The @kbd{G} (@code{calc-argument}) [@code{arg}] command computes the
16566``argument'' or polar angle of a complex number. For a number in polar
16567notation, this is simply the second component of the pair
16568@texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'.
16569@infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'.
16570The result is expressed according to the current angular mode and will
16571be in the range @mathit{-180} degrees (exclusive) to @mathit{+180} degrees
16572(inclusive), or the equivalent range in radians.
16573
16574@pindex calc-imaginary
16575The @code{calc-imaginary} command multiplies the number on the
16576top of the stack by the imaginary number @expr{i = (0,1)}. This
16577command is not normally bound to a key in Calc, but it is available
16578on the @key{IMAG} button in Keypad mode.
16579
16580@kindex f r
16581@pindex calc-re
16582@tindex re
16583The @kbd{f r} (@code{calc-re}) [@code{re}] command replaces a complex number
16584by its real part. This command has no effect on real numbers. (As an
16585added convenience, @code{re} applied to a modulo form extracts
16586the value part.)
16587
16588@kindex f i
16589@pindex calc-im
16590@tindex im
16591The @kbd{f i} (@code{calc-im}) [@code{im}] command replaces a complex number
16592by its imaginary part; real numbers are converted to zero. With a vector
16593or matrix argument, these functions operate element-wise.
16594
16595@ignore
16596@mindex v p
16597@end ignore
16598@kindex v p (complex)
65d0154b 16599@kindex V p (complex)
4009494e
GM
16600@pindex calc-pack
16601The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) command can pack the top two numbers on
16602the stack into a composite object such as a complex number. With
16603a prefix argument of @mathit{-1}, it produces a rectangular complex number;
16604with an argument of @mathit{-2}, it produces a polar complex number.
16605(Also, @pxref{Building Vectors}.)
16606
16607@ignore
16608@mindex v u
16609@end ignore
16610@kindex v u (complex)
65d0154b 16611@kindex V u (complex)
4009494e
GM
16612@pindex calc-unpack
16613The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the complex number
16614(or other composite object) on the top of the stack and unpacks it
16615into its separate components.
16616
16617@node Conversions, Date Arithmetic, Complex Number Functions, Arithmetic
16618@section Conversions
16619
16620@noindent
16621The commands described in this section convert numbers from one form
16622to another; they are two-key sequences beginning with the letter @kbd{c}.
16623
16624@kindex c f
16625@pindex calc-float
16626@tindex pfloat
16627The @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) [@code{pfloat}] command converts the
16628number on the top of the stack to floating-point form. For example,
16629@expr{23} is converted to @expr{23.0}, @expr{3:2} is converted to
16630@expr{1.5}, and @expr{2.3} is left the same. If the value is a composite
16631object such as a complex number or vector, each of the components is
16632converted to floating-point. If the value is a formula, all numbers
16633in the formula are converted to floating-point. Note that depending
16634on the current floating-point precision, conversion to floating-point
16635format may lose information.
16636
16637As a special exception, integers which appear as powers or subscripts
16638are not floated by @kbd{c f}. If you really want to float a power,
16639you can use a @kbd{j s} command to select the power followed by @kbd{c f}.
16640Because @kbd{c f} cannot examine the formula outside of the selection,
16641it does not notice that the thing being floated is a power.
16642@xref{Selecting Subformulas}.
16643
16644The normal @kbd{c f} command is ``pervasive'' in the sense that it
16645applies to all numbers throughout the formula. The @code{pfloat}
16646algebraic function never stays around in a formula; @samp{pfloat(a + 1)}
16647changes to @samp{a + 1.0} as soon as it is evaluated.
16648
16649@kindex H c f
16650@tindex float
16651With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c f} [@code{float}] operates
16652only on the number or vector of numbers at the top level of its
16653argument. Thus, @samp{float(1)} is 1.0, but @samp{float(a + 1)}
16654is left unevaluated because its argument is not a number.
16655
16656You should use @kbd{H c f} if you wish to guarantee that the final
16657value, once all the variables have been assigned, is a float; you
16658would use @kbd{c f} if you wish to do the conversion on the numbers
16659that appear right now.
16660
16661@kindex c F
16662@pindex calc-fraction
16663@tindex pfrac
16664The @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) [@code{pfrac}] command converts a
16665floating-point number into a fractional approximation. By default, it
16666produces a fraction whose decimal representation is the same as the
16667input number, to within the current precision. You can also give a
16668numeric prefix argument to specify a tolerance, either directly, or,
16669if the prefix argument is zero, by using the number on top of the stack
16670as the tolerance. If the tolerance is a positive integer, the fraction
16671is correct to within that many significant figures. If the tolerance is
16672a non-positive integer, it specifies how many digits fewer than the current
16673precision to use. If the tolerance is a floating-point number, the
16674fraction is correct to within that absolute amount.
16675
16676@kindex H c F
16677@tindex frac
16678The @code{pfrac} function is pervasive, like @code{pfloat}.
16679There is also a non-pervasive version, @kbd{H c F} [@code{frac}],
16680which is analogous to @kbd{H c f} discussed above.
16681
16682@kindex c d
16683@pindex calc-to-degrees
16684@tindex deg
16685The @kbd{c d} (@code{calc-to-degrees}) [@code{deg}] command converts a
16686number into degrees form. The value on the top of the stack may be an
16687HMS form (interpreted as degrees-minutes-seconds), or a real number which
16688will be interpreted in radians regardless of the current angular mode.
16689
16690@kindex c r
16691@pindex calc-to-radians
16692@tindex rad
16693The @kbd{c r} (@code{calc-to-radians}) [@code{rad}] command converts an
16694HMS form or angle in degrees into an angle in radians.
16695
16696@kindex c h
16697@pindex calc-to-hms
16698@tindex hms
16699The @kbd{c h} (@code{calc-to-hms}) [@code{hms}] command converts a real
16700number, interpreted according to the current angular mode, to an HMS
16701form describing the same angle. In algebraic notation, the @code{hms}
16702function also accepts three arguments: @samp{hms(@var{h}, @var{m}, @var{s})}.
16703(The three-argument version is independent of the current angular mode.)
16704
16705@pindex calc-from-hms
16706The @code{calc-from-hms} command converts the HMS form on the top of the
16707stack into a real number according to the current angular mode.
16708
16709@kindex c p
16710@kindex I c p
16711@pindex calc-polar
16712@tindex polar
16713@tindex rect
16714The @kbd{c p} (@code{calc-polar}) command converts the complex number on
16715the top of the stack from polar to rectangular form, or from rectangular
16716to polar form, whichever is appropriate. Real numbers are left the same.
16717This command is equivalent to the @code{rect} or @code{polar}
16718functions in algebraic formulas, depending on the direction of
16719conversion. (It uses @code{polar}, except that if the argument is
16720already a polar complex number, it uses @code{rect} instead. The
16721@kbd{I c p} command always uses @code{rect}.)
16722
16723@kindex c c
16724@pindex calc-clean
16725@tindex pclean
16726The @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) [@code{pclean}] command ``cleans'' the
16727number on the top of the stack. Floating point numbers are re-rounded
16728according to the current precision. Polar numbers whose angular
16729components have strayed from the @mathit{-180} to @mathit{+180} degree range
16730are normalized. (Note that results will be undesirable if the current
16731angular mode is different from the one under which the number was
16732produced!) Integers and fractions are generally unaffected by this
16733operation. Vectors and formulas are cleaned by cleaning each component
16734number (i.e., pervasively).
16735
16736If the simplification mode is set below the default level, it is raised
16737to the default level for the purposes of this command. Thus, @kbd{c c}
16738applies the default simplifications even if their automatic application
16739is disabled. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
16740
16741@cindex Roundoff errors, correcting
16742A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{c c} sets the floating-point precision
16743to that value for the duration of the command. A positive prefix (of at
16744least 3) sets the precision to the specified value; a negative or zero
16745prefix decreases the precision by the specified amount.
16746
16747@kindex c 0-9
16748@pindex calc-clean-num
16749The keystroke sequences @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} are equivalent
16750to @kbd{c c} with the corresponding negative prefix argument. If roundoff
16751errors have changed 2.0 into 1.999999, typing @kbd{c 1} to clip off one
16752decimal place often conveniently does the trick.
16753
16754The @kbd{c c} command with a numeric prefix argument, and the @kbd{c 0}
16755through @kbd{c 9} commands, also ``clip'' very small floating-point
16756numbers to zero. If the exponent is less than or equal to the negative
16757of the specified precision, the number is changed to 0.0. For example,
16758if the current precision is 12, then @kbd{c 2} changes the vector
16759@samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 1e-10, 1e-11]} to @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 0, 0]}.
16760Numbers this small generally arise from roundoff noise.
16761
16762If the numbers you are using really are legitimately this small,
16763you should avoid using the @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} commands.
16764(The plain @kbd{c c} command rounds to the current precision but
16765does not clip small numbers.)
16766
16767One more property of @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}, and of @kbd{c c} with
16768a prefix argument, is that integer-valued floats are converted to
16769plain integers, so that @kbd{c 1} on @samp{[1., 1.5, 2., 2.5, 3.]}
16770produces @samp{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3]}. This is not done for huge
16771numbers (@samp{1e100} is technically an integer-valued float, but
16772you wouldn't want it automatically converted to a 100-digit integer).
16773
16774@kindex H c 0-9
16775@kindex H c c
16776@tindex clean
16777With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c c} and @kbd{H c 0} through @kbd{H c 9}
16778operate non-pervasively [@code{clean}].
16779
16780@node Date Arithmetic, Financial Functions, Conversions, Arithmetic
16781@section Date Arithmetic
16782
16783@noindent
16784@cindex Date arithmetic, additional functions
16785The commands described in this section perform various conversions
16786and calculations involving date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). They
16787use the @kbd{t} (for time/date) prefix key followed by shifted
16788letters.
16789
16790The simplest date arithmetic is done using the regular @kbd{+} and @kbd{-}
16791commands. In particular, adding a number to a date form advances the
16792date form by a certain number of days; adding an HMS form to a date
16793form advances the date by a certain amount of time; and subtracting two
16794date forms produces a difference measured in days. The commands
16795described here provide additional, more specialized operations on dates.
16796
16797Many of these commands accept a numeric prefix argument; if you give
16798plain @kbd{C-u} as the prefix, these commands will instead take the
16799additional argument from the top of the stack.
16800
16801@menu
16802* Date Conversions::
16803* Date Functions::
16804* Time Zones::
16805* Business Days::
16806@end menu
16807
16808@node Date Conversions, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic, Date Arithmetic
16809@subsection Date Conversions
16810
16811@noindent
16812@kindex t D
16813@pindex calc-date
16814@tindex date
16815The @kbd{t D} (@code{calc-date}) [@code{date}] command converts a
16816date form into a number, measured in days since Jan 1, 1 AD. The
16817result will be an integer if @var{date} is a pure date form, or a
16818fraction or float if @var{date} is a date/time form. Or, if its
16819argument is a number, it converts this number into a date form.
16820
16821With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{t D} takes that many objects
16822(up to six) from the top of the stack and interprets them in one
16823of the following ways:
16824
16825The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day})} function
16826builds a pure date form out of the specified year, month, and
16827day, which must all be integers. @var{Year} is a year number,
16828such as 1991 (@emph{not} the same as 91!). @var{Month} must be
16829an integer in the range 1 to 12; @var{day} must be in the range
168301 to 31. If the specified month has fewer than 31 days and
16831@var{day} is too large, the equivalent day in the following
16832month will be used.
16833
16834The @samp{date(@var{month}, @var{day})} function builds a
16835pure date form using the current year, as determined by the
16836real-time clock.
16837
16838The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hms})}
16839function builds a date/time form using an @var{hms} form.
16840
16841The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hour},
16842@var{minute}, @var{second})} function builds a date/time form.
16843@var{hour} should be an integer in the range 0 to 23;
16844@var{minute} should be an integer in the range 0 to 59;
16845@var{second} should be any real number in the range @samp{[0 .. 60)}.
16846The last two arguments default to zero if omitted.
16847
16848@kindex t J
16849@pindex calc-julian
16850@tindex julian
16851@cindex Julian day counts, conversions
16852The @kbd{t J} (@code{calc-julian}) [@code{julian}] command converts
16853a date form into a Julian day count, which is the number of days
7c1a0036
GM
16854since noon (GMT) on Jan 1, 4713 BC. A pure date is converted to an
16855integer Julian count representing noon of that day. A date/time form
16856is converted to an exact floating-point Julian count, adjusted to
4009494e
GM
16857interpret the date form in the current time zone but the Julian
16858day count in Greenwich Mean Time. A numeric prefix argument allows
16859you to specify the time zone; @pxref{Time Zones}. Use a prefix of
16860zero to suppress the time zone adjustment. Note that pure date forms
16861are never time-zone adjusted.
16862
16863This command can also do the opposite conversion, from a Julian day
16864count (either an integer day, or a floating-point day and time in
16865the GMT zone), into a pure date form or a date/time form in the
16866current or specified time zone.
16867
16868@kindex t U
16869@pindex calc-unix-time
16870@tindex unixtime
16871@cindex Unix time format, conversions
16872The @kbd{t U} (@code{calc-unix-time}) [@code{unixtime}] command
16873converts a date form into a Unix time value, which is the number of
16874seconds since midnight on Jan 1, 1970, or vice-versa. The numeric result
16875will be an integer if the current precision is 12 or less; for higher
16876precisions, the result may be a float with (@var{precision}@minus{}12)
16877digits after the decimal. Just as for @kbd{t J}, the numeric time
16878is interpreted in the GMT time zone and the date form is interpreted
16879in the current or specified zone. Some systems use Unix-like
16880numbering but with the local time zone; give a prefix of zero to
16881suppress the adjustment if so.
16882
16883@kindex t C
16884@pindex calc-convert-time-zones
16885@tindex tzconv
16886@cindex Time Zones, converting between
16887The @kbd{t C} (@code{calc-convert-time-zones}) [@code{tzconv}]
16888command converts a date form from one time zone to another. You
16889are prompted for each time zone name in turn; you can answer with
16890any suitable Calc time zone expression (@pxref{Time Zones}).
16891If you answer either prompt with a blank line, the local time
16892zone is used for that prompt. You can also answer the first
16893prompt with @kbd{$} to take the two time zone names from the
16894stack (and the date to be converted from the third stack level).
16895
16896@node Date Functions, Business Days, Date Conversions, Date Arithmetic
16897@subsection Date Functions
16898
16899@noindent
16900@kindex t N
16901@pindex calc-now
16902@tindex now
16903The @kbd{t N} (@code{calc-now}) [@code{now}] command pushes the
16904current date and time on the stack as a date form. The time is
16905reported in terms of the specified time zone; with no numeric prefix
16906argument, @kbd{t N} reports for the current time zone.
16907
16908@kindex t P
16909@pindex calc-date-part
16910The @kbd{t P} (@code{calc-date-part}) command extracts one part
16911of a date form. The prefix argument specifies the part; with no
16912argument, this command prompts for a part code from 1 to 9.
16913The various part codes are described in the following paragraphs.
16914
16915@tindex year
16916The @kbd{M-1 t P} [@code{year}] function extracts the year number
16917from a date form as an integer, e.g., 1991. This and the
16918following functions will also accept a real number for an
16919argument, which is interpreted as a standard Calc day number.
16920Note that this function will never return zero, since the year
169211 BC immediately precedes the year 1 AD.
16922
16923@tindex month
16924The @kbd{M-2 t P} [@code{month}] function extracts the month number
16925from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 12.
16926
16927@tindex day
16928The @kbd{M-3 t P} [@code{day}] function extracts the day number
16929from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 31.
16930
16931@tindex hour
16932The @kbd{M-4 t P} [@code{hour}] function extracts the hour from
16933a date form as an integer in the range 0 (midnight) to 23. Note
16934that 24-hour time is always used. This returns zero for a pure
16935date form. This function (and the following two) also accept
16936HMS forms as input.
16937
16938@tindex minute
16939The @kbd{M-5 t P} [@code{minute}] function extracts the minute
16940from a date form as an integer in the range 0 to 59.
16941
16942@tindex second
16943The @kbd{M-6 t P} [@code{second}] function extracts the second
16944from a date form. If the current precision is 12 or less,
16945the result is an integer in the range 0 to 59. For higher
16946precisions, the result may instead be a floating-point number.
16947
16948@tindex weekday
16949The @kbd{M-7 t P} [@code{weekday}] function extracts the weekday
16950number from a date form as an integer in the range 0 (Sunday)
16951to 6 (Saturday).
16952
16953@tindex yearday
16954The @kbd{M-8 t P} [@code{yearday}] function extracts the day-of-year
16955number from a date form as an integer in the range 1 (January 1)
16956to 366 (December 31 of a leap year).
16957
16958@tindex time
16959The @kbd{M-9 t P} [@code{time}] function extracts the time portion
16960of a date form as an HMS form. This returns @samp{0@@ 0' 0"}
16961for a pure date form.
16962
16963@kindex t M
16964@pindex calc-new-month
16965@tindex newmonth
16966The @kbd{t M} (@code{calc-new-month}) [@code{newmonth}] command
16967computes a new date form that represents the first day of the month
16968specified by the input date. The result is always a pure date
16969form; only the year and month numbers of the input are retained.
16970With a numeric prefix argument @var{n} in the range from 1 to 31,
16971@kbd{t M} computes the @var{n}th day of the month. (If @var{n}
16972is greater than the actual number of days in the month, or if
16973@var{n} is zero, the last day of the month is used.)
16974
16975@kindex t Y
16976@pindex calc-new-year
16977@tindex newyear
16978The @kbd{t Y} (@code{calc-new-year}) [@code{newyear}] command
16979computes a new pure date form that represents the first day of
16980the year specified by the input. The month, day, and time
16981of the input date form are lost. With a numeric prefix argument
16982@var{n} in the range from 1 to 366, @kbd{t Y} computes the
16983@var{n}th day of the year (366 is treated as 365 in non-leap
16984years). A prefix argument of 0 computes the last day of the
16985year (December 31). A negative prefix argument from @mathit{-1} to
16986@mathit{-12} computes the first day of the @var{n}th month of the year.
16987
16988@kindex t W
16989@pindex calc-new-week
16990@tindex newweek
16991The @kbd{t W} (@code{calc-new-week}) [@code{newweek}] command
16992computes a new pure date form that represents the Sunday on or before
16993the input date. With a numeric prefix argument, it can be made to
16994use any day of the week as the starting day; the argument must be in
16995the range from 0 (Sunday) to 6 (Saturday). This function always
16996subtracts between 0 and 6 days from the input date.
16997
16998Here's an example use of @code{newweek}: Find the date of the next
16999Wednesday after a given date. Using @kbd{M-3 t W} or @samp{newweek(d, 3)}
17000will give you the @emph{preceding} Wednesday, so @samp{newweek(d+7, 3)}
17001will give you the following Wednesday. A further look at the definition
17002of @code{newweek} shows that if the input date is itself a Wednesday,
17003this formula will return the Wednesday one week in the future. An
17004exercise for the reader is to modify this formula to yield the same day
17005if the input is already a Wednesday. Another interesting exercise is
17006to preserve the time-of-day portion of the input (@code{newweek} resets
17007the time to midnight; hint:@: how can @code{newweek} be defined in terms
17008of the @code{weekday} function?).
17009
17010@ignore
17011@starindex
17012@end ignore
17013@tindex pwday
17014The @samp{pwday(@var{date})} function (not on any key) computes the
17015day-of-month number of the Sunday on or before @var{date}. With
17016two arguments, @samp{pwday(@var{date}, @var{day})} computes the day
17017number of the Sunday on or before day number @var{day} of the month
17018specified by @var{date}. The @var{day} must be in the range from
170197 to 31; if the day number is greater than the actual number of days
17020in the month, the true number of days is used instead. Thus
17021@samp{pwday(@var{date}, 7)} finds the first Sunday of the month, and
17022@samp{pwday(@var{date}, 31)} finds the last Sunday of the month.
17023With a third @var{weekday} argument, @code{pwday} can be made to look
17024for any day of the week instead of Sunday.
17025
17026@kindex t I
17027@pindex calc-inc-month
17028@tindex incmonth
17029The @kbd{t I} (@code{calc-inc-month}) [@code{incmonth}] command
17030increases a date form by one month, or by an arbitrary number of
17031months specified by a numeric prefix argument. The time portion,
17032if any, of the date form stays the same. The day also stays the
17033same, except that if the new month has fewer days the day
17034number may be reduced to lie in the valid range. For example,
17035@samp{incmonth(<Jan 31, 1991>)} produces @samp{<Feb 28, 1991>}.
17036Because of this, @kbd{t I t I} and @kbd{M-2 t I} do not always give
17037the same results (@samp{<Mar 28, 1991>} versus @samp{<Mar 31, 1991>}
17038in this case).
17039
17040@ignore
17041@starindex
17042@end ignore
17043@tindex incyear
17044The @samp{incyear(@var{date}, @var{step})} function increases
17045a date form by the specified number of years, which may be
17046any positive or negative integer. Note that @samp{incyear(d, n)}
17047is equivalent to @w{@samp{incmonth(d, 12*n)}}, but these do not have
17048simple equivalents in terms of day arithmetic because
17049months and years have varying lengths. If the @var{step}
17050argument is omitted, 1 year is assumed. There is no keyboard
17051command for this function; use @kbd{C-u 12 t I} instead.
17052
17053There is no @code{newday} function at all because @kbd{F} [@code{floor}]
17054serves this purpose. Similarly, instead of @code{incday} and
17055@code{incweek} simply use @expr{d + n} or @expr{d + 7 n}.
17056
17057@xref{Basic Arithmetic}, for the @kbd{f ]} [@code{incr}] command
17058which can adjust a date/time form by a certain number of seconds.
17059
17060@node Business Days, Time Zones, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic
17061@subsection Business Days
17062
17063@noindent
17064Often time is measured in ``business days'' or ``working days,''
17065where weekends and holidays are skipped. Calc's normal date
17066arithmetic functions use calendar days, so that subtracting two
17067consecutive Mondays will yield a difference of 7 days. By contrast,
17068subtracting two consecutive Mondays would yield 5 business days
17069(assuming two-day weekends and the absence of holidays).
17070
17071@kindex t +
17072@kindex t -
17073@tindex badd
17074@tindex bsub
17075@pindex calc-business-days-plus
17076@pindex calc-business-days-minus
17077The @kbd{t +} (@code{calc-business-days-plus}) [@code{badd}]
17078and @kbd{t -} (@code{calc-business-days-minus}) [@code{bsub}]
17079commands perform arithmetic using business days. For @kbd{t +},
17080one argument must be a date form and the other must be a real
17081number (positive or negative). If the number is not an integer,
17082then a certain amount of time is added as well as a number of
17083days; for example, adding 0.5 business days to a time in Friday
17084evening will produce a time in Monday morning. It is also
17085possible to add an HMS form; adding @samp{12@@ 0' 0"} also adds
17086half a business day. For @kbd{t -}, the arguments are either a
17087date form and a number or HMS form, or two date forms, in which
17088case the result is the number of business days between the two
17089dates.
17090
17091@cindex @code{Holidays} variable
17092@vindex Holidays
17093By default, Calc considers any day that is not a Saturday or
17094Sunday to be a business day. You can define any number of
17095additional holidays by editing the variable @code{Holidays}.
17096(There is an @w{@kbd{s H}} convenience command for editing this
17097variable.) Initially, @code{Holidays} contains the vector
17098@samp{[sat, sun]}. Entries in the @code{Holidays} vector may
17099be any of the following kinds of objects:
17100
17101@itemize @bullet
17102@item
17103Date forms (pure dates, not date/time forms). These specify
17104particular days which are to be treated as holidays.
17105
17106@item
17107Intervals of date forms. These specify a range of days, all of
17108which are holidays (e.g., Christmas week). @xref{Interval Forms}.
17109
17110@item
17111Nested vectors of date forms. Each date form in the vector is
17112considered to be a holiday.
17113
17114@item
17115Any Calc formula which evaluates to one of the above three things.
17116If the formula involves the variable @expr{y}, it stands for a
17117yearly repeating holiday; @expr{y} will take on various year
17118numbers like 1992. For example, @samp{date(y, 12, 25)} specifies
17119Christmas day, and @samp{newweek(date(y, 11, 7), 4) + 21} specifies
17120Thanksgiving (which is held on the fourth Thursday of November).
17121If the formula involves the variable @expr{m}, that variable
17122takes on month numbers from 1 to 12: @samp{date(y, m, 15)} is
17123a holiday that takes place on the 15th of every month.
17124
17125@item
17126A weekday name, such as @code{sat} or @code{sun}. This is really
17127a variable whose name is a three-letter, lower-case day name.
17128
17129@item
17130An interval of year numbers (integers). This specifies the span of
17131years over which this holiday list is to be considered valid. Any
17132business-day arithmetic that goes outside this range will result
17133in an error message. Use this if you are including an explicit
17134list of holidays, rather than a formula to generate them, and you
17135want to make sure you don't accidentally go beyond the last point
17136where the holidays you entered are complete. If there is no
17137limiting interval in the @code{Holidays} vector, the default
17138@samp{[1 .. 2737]} is used. (This is the absolute range of years
17139for which Calc's business-day algorithms will operate.)
17140
17141@item
17142An interval of HMS forms. This specifies the span of hours that
17143are to be considered one business day. For example, if this
17144range is @samp{[9@@ 0' 0" .. 17@@ 0' 0"]} (i.e., 9am to 5pm), then
17145the business day is only eight hours long, so that @kbd{1.5 t +}
17146on @samp{<4:00pm Fri Dec 13, 1991>} will add one business day and
17147four business hours to produce @samp{<12:00pm Tue Dec 17, 1991>}.
17148Likewise, @kbd{t -} will now express differences in time as
17149fractions of an eight-hour day. Times before 9am will be treated
17150as 9am by business date arithmetic, and times at or after 5pm will
17151be treated as 4:59:59pm. If there is no HMS interval in @code{Holidays},
17152the full 24-hour day @samp{[0@ 0' 0" .. 24@ 0' 0"]} is assumed.
17153(Regardless of the type of bounds you specify, the interval is
17154treated as inclusive on the low end and exclusive on the high end,
17155so that the work day goes from 9am up to, but not including, 5pm.)
17156@end itemize
17157
17158If the @code{Holidays} vector is empty, then @kbd{t +} and
17159@kbd{t -} will act just like @kbd{+} and @kbd{-} because there will
17160then be no difference between business days and calendar days.
17161
17162Calc expands the intervals and formulas you give into a complete
17163list of holidays for internal use. This is done mainly to make
17164sure it can detect multiple holidays. (For example,
17165@samp{<Jan 1, 1989>} is both New Year's Day and a Sunday, but
17166Calc's algorithms take care to count it only once when figuring
17167the number of holidays between two dates.)
17168
17169Since the complete list of holidays for all the years from 1 to
171702737 would be huge, Calc actually computes only the part of the
17171list between the smallest and largest years that have been involved
17172in business-day calculations so far. Normally, you won't have to
17173worry about this. Keep in mind, however, that if you do one
17174calculation for 1992, and another for 1792, even if both involve
17175only a small range of years, Calc will still work out all the
17176holidays that fall in that 200-year span.
17177
17178If you add a (positive) number of days to a date form that falls on a
17179weekend or holiday, the date form is treated as if it were the most
17180recent business day. (Thus adding one business day to a Friday,
17181Saturday, or Sunday will all yield the following Monday.) If you
17182subtract a number of days from a weekend or holiday, the date is
17183effectively on the following business day. (So subtracting one business
17184day from Saturday, Sunday, or Monday yields the preceding Friday.) The
17185difference between two dates one or both of which fall on holidays
17186equals the number of actual business days between them. These
17187conventions are consistent in the sense that, if you add @var{n}
17188business days to any date, the difference between the result and the
17189original date will come out to @var{n} business days. (It can't be
17190completely consistent though; a subtraction followed by an addition
17191might come out a bit differently, since @kbd{t +} is incapable of
17192producing a date that falls on a weekend or holiday.)
17193
17194@ignore
17195@starindex
17196@end ignore
17197@tindex holiday
17198There is a @code{holiday} function, not on any keys, that takes
17199any date form and returns 1 if that date falls on a weekend or
17200holiday, as defined in @code{Holidays}, or 0 if the date is a
17201business day.
17202
17203@node Time Zones, , Business Days, Date Arithmetic
17204@subsection Time Zones
17205
17206@noindent
17207@cindex Time zones
17208@cindex Daylight saving time
17209Time zones and daylight saving time are a complicated business.
17210The conversions to and from Julian and Unix-style dates automatically
17211compute the correct time zone and daylight saving adjustment to use,
17212provided they can figure out this information. This section describes
17213Calc's time zone adjustment algorithm in detail, in case you want to
17214do conversions in different time zones or in case Calc's algorithms
17215can't determine the right correction to use.
17216
17217Adjustments for time zones and daylight saving time are done by
17218@kbd{t U}, @kbd{t J}, @kbd{t N}, and @kbd{t C}, but not by any other
17219commands. In particular, @samp{<may 1 1991> - <apr 1 1991>} evaluates
17220to exactly 30 days even though there is a daylight-saving
17221transition in between. This is also true for Julian pure dates:
17222@samp{julian(<may 1 1991>) - julian(<apr 1 1991>)}. But Julian
17223and Unix date/times will adjust for daylight saving time: using Calc's
17224default daylight saving time rule (see the explanation below),
17225@samp{julian(<12am may 1 1991>) - julian(<12am apr 1 1991>)}
17226evaluates to @samp{29.95833} (that's 29 days and 23 hours)
17227because one hour was lost when daylight saving commenced on
17228April 7, 1991.
17229
17230In brief, the idiom @samp{julian(@var{date1}) - julian(@var{date2})}
17231computes the actual number of 24-hour periods between two dates, whereas
17232@samp{@var{date1} - @var{date2}} computes the number of calendar
17233days between two dates without taking daylight saving into account.
17234
17235@pindex calc-time-zone
17236@ignore
17237@starindex
17238@end ignore
17239@tindex tzone
17240The @code{calc-time-zone} [@code{tzone}] command converts the time
17241zone specified by its numeric prefix argument into a number of
17242seconds difference from Greenwich mean time (GMT). If the argument
17243is a number, the result is simply that value multiplied by 3600.
17244Typical arguments for North America are 5 (Eastern) or 8 (Pacific). If
17245Daylight Saving time is in effect, one hour should be subtracted from
17246the normal difference.
17247
17248If you give a prefix of plain @kbd{C-u}, @code{calc-time-zone} (like other
17249date arithmetic commands that include a time zone argument) takes the
17250zone argument from the top of the stack. (In the case of @kbd{t J}
17251and @kbd{t U}, the normal argument is then taken from the second-to-top
17252stack position.) This allows you to give a non-integer time zone
17253adjustment. The time-zone argument can also be an HMS form, or
17254it can be a variable which is a time zone name in upper- or lower-case.
17255For example @samp{tzone(PST) = tzone(8)} and @samp{tzone(pdt) = tzone(7)}
17256(for Pacific standard and daylight saving times, respectively).
17257
17258North American and European time zone names are defined as follows;
17259note that for each time zone there is one name for standard time,
17260another for daylight saving time, and a third for ``generalized'' time
17261in which the daylight saving adjustment is computed from context.
17262
17263@smallexample
17264@group
17265YST PST MST CST EST AST NST GMT WET MET MEZ
17266 9 8 7 6 5 4 3.5 0 -1 -2 -2
17267
17268YDT PDT MDT CDT EDT ADT NDT BST WETDST METDST MESZ
17269 8 7 6 5 4 3 2.5 -1 -2 -3 -3
17270
17271YGT PGT MGT CGT EGT AGT NGT BGT WEGT MEGT MEGZ
172729/8 8/7 7/6 6/5 5/4 4/3 3.5/2.5 0/-1 -1/-2 -2/-3 -2/-3
17273@end group
17274@end smallexample
17275
17276@vindex math-tzone-names
17277To define time zone names that do not appear in the above table,
17278you must modify the Lisp variable @code{math-tzone-names}. This
17279is a list of lists describing the different time zone names; its
17280structure is best explained by an example. The three entries for
17281Pacific Time look like this:
17282
17283@smallexample
17284@group
17285( ( "PST" 8 0 ) ; Name as an upper-case string, then standard
17286 ( "PDT" 8 -1 ) ; adjustment, then daylight saving adjustment.
17287 ( "PGT" 8 "PST" "PDT" ) ) ; Generalized time zone.
17288@end group
17289@end smallexample
17290
17291@cindex @code{TimeZone} variable
17292@vindex TimeZone
17293With no arguments, @code{calc-time-zone} or @samp{tzone()} will by
17294default get the time zone and daylight saving information from the
17295calendar (@pxref{Daylight Saving,Calendar/Diary,The Calendar and the Diary,
17296emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual}). To use a different time zone, or if the
17297calendar does not give the desired result, you can set the Calc variable
17298@code{TimeZone} (which is by default @code{nil}) to an appropriate
17299time zone name. (The easiest way to do this is to edit the
17300@code{TimeZone} variable using Calc's @kbd{s T} command, then use the
17301@kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save the value of
17302@code{TimeZone} permanently.)
17303If the time zone given by @code{TimeZone} is a generalized time zone,
17304e.g., @code{EGT}, Calc examines the date being converted to tell whether
17305to use standard or daylight saving time. But if the current time zone
17306is explicit, e.g., @code{EST} or @code{EDT}, then that adjustment is
17307used exactly and Calc's daylight saving algorithm is not consulted.
17308The special time zone name @code{local}
17309is equivalent to no argument; i.e., it uses the information obtained
17310from the calendar.
17311
17312The @kbd{t J} and @code{t U} commands with no numeric prefix
17313arguments do the same thing as @samp{tzone()}; namely, use the
17314information from the calendar if @code{TimeZone} is @code{nil},
17315otherwise use the time zone given by @code{TimeZone}.
17316
17317@vindex math-daylight-savings-hook
17318@findex math-std-daylight-savings
17319When Calc computes the daylight saving information itself (i.e., when
17320the @code{TimeZone} variable is set), it will by default consider
17321daylight saving time to begin at 2 a.m.@: on the second Sunday of March
17322(for years from 2007 on) or on the last Sunday in April (for years
17323before 2007), and to end at 2 a.m.@: on the first Sunday of
17324November. (for years from 2007 on) or the last Sunday in October (for
17325years before 2007). These are the rules that have been in effect in
17326much of North America since 1966 and take into account the rule change
17327that began in 2007. If you are in a country that uses different rules
17328for computing daylight saving time, you have two choices: Write your own
17329daylight saving hook, or control time zones explicitly by setting the
17330@code{TimeZone} variable and/or always giving a time-zone argument for
17331the conversion functions.
17332
17333The Lisp variable @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} holds the
17334name of a function that is used to compute the daylight saving
17335adjustment for a given date. The default is
17336@code{math-std-daylight-savings}, which computes an adjustment
17337(either 0 or @mathit{-1}) using the North American rules given above.
17338
17339The daylight saving hook function is called with four arguments:
17340The date, as a floating-point number in standard Calc format;
17341a six-element list of the date decomposed into year, month, day,
17342hour, minute, and second, respectively; a string which contains
17343the generalized time zone name in upper-case, e.g., @code{"WEGT"};
17344and a special adjustment to be applied to the hour value when
17345converting into a generalized time zone (see below).
17346
17347@findex math-prev-weekday-in-month
17348The Lisp function @code{math-prev-weekday-in-month} is useful for
17349daylight saving computations. This is an internal version of
17350the user-level @code{pwday} function described in the previous
17351section. It takes four arguments: The floating-point date value,
17352the corresponding six-element date list, the day-of-month number,
17353and the weekday number (0-6).
17354
17355The default daylight saving hook ignores the time zone name, but a
17356more sophisticated hook could use different algorithms for different
17357time zones. It would also be possible to use different algorithms
17358depending on the year number, but the default hook always uses the
17359algorithm for 1987 and later. Here is a listing of the default
17360daylight saving hook:
17361
17362@smallexample
17363(defun math-std-daylight-savings (date dt zone bump)
17364 (cond ((< (nth 1 dt) 4) 0)
17365 ((= (nth 1 dt) 4)
17366 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 7 0)))
17367 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) 0)
17368 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17369 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 3 bump)) -1 0))
17370 (t -1))))
17371 ((< (nth 1 dt) 10) -1)
17372 ((= (nth 1 dt) 10)
17373 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 31 0)))
17374 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) -1)
17375 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17376 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 2 bump)) 0 -1))
17377 (t 0))))
17378 (t 0))
17379)
17380@end smallexample
17381
17382@noindent
17383The @code{bump} parameter is equal to zero when Calc is converting
17384from a date form in a generalized time zone into a GMT date value.
17385It is @mathit{-1} when Calc is converting in the other direction. The
17386adjustments shown above ensure that the conversion behaves correctly
17387and reasonably around the 2 a.m.@: transition in each direction.
17388
17389There is a ``missing'' hour between 2 a.m.@: and 3 a.m.@: at the
17390beginning of daylight saving time; converting a date/time form that
17391falls in this hour results in a time value for the following hour,
17392from 3 a.m.@: to 4 a.m. At the end of daylight saving time, the
17393hour from 1 a.m.@: to 2 a.m.@: repeats itself; converting a date/time
17394form that falls in this hour results in a time value for the first
17395manifestation of that time (@emph{not} the one that occurs one hour
17396later).
17397
17398If @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} is @code{nil}, then the
17399daylight saving adjustment is always taken to be zero.
17400
17401In algebraic formulas, @samp{tzone(@var{zone}, @var{date})}
17402computes the time zone adjustment for a given zone name at a
17403given date. The @var{date} is ignored unless @var{zone} is a
17404generalized time zone. If @var{date} is a date form, the
17405daylight saving computation is applied to it as it appears.
17406If @var{date} is a numeric date value, it is adjusted for the
17407daylight-saving version of @var{zone} before being given to
17408the daylight saving hook. This odd-sounding rule ensures
17409that the daylight-saving computation is always done in
17410local time, not in the GMT time that a numeric @var{date}
17411is typically represented in.
17412
17413@ignore
17414@starindex
17415@end ignore
17416@tindex dsadj
17417The @samp{dsadj(@var{date}, @var{zone})} function computes the
17418daylight saving adjustment that is appropriate for @var{date} in
17419time zone @var{zone}. If @var{zone} is explicitly in or not in
17420daylight saving time (e.g., @code{PDT} or @code{PST}) the
17421@var{date} is ignored. If @var{zone} is a generalized time zone,
17422the algorithms described above are used. If @var{zone} is omitted,
17423the computation is done for the current time zone.
17424
4009494e
GM
17425@node Financial Functions, Binary Functions, Date Arithmetic, Arithmetic
17426@section Financial Functions
17427
17428@noindent
17429Calc's financial or business functions use the @kbd{b} prefix
17430key followed by a shifted letter. (The @kbd{b} prefix followed by
17431a lower-case letter is used for operations on binary numbers.)
17432
17433Note that the rate and the number of intervals given to these
17434functions must be on the same time scale, e.g., both months or
17435both years. Mixing an annual interest rate with a time expressed
17436in months will give you very wrong answers!
17437
17438It is wise to compute these functions to a higher precision than
17439you really need, just to make sure your answer is correct to the
17440last penny; also, you may wish to check the definitions at the end
17441of this section to make sure the functions have the meaning you expect.
17442
17443@menu
17444* Percentages::
17445* Future Value::
17446* Present Value::
17447* Related Financial Functions::
17448* Depreciation Functions::
17449* Definitions of Financial Functions::
17450@end menu
17451
17452@node Percentages, Future Value, Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17453@subsection Percentages
17454
17455@kindex M-%
17456@pindex calc-percent
17457@tindex %
17458@tindex percent
17459The @kbd{M-%} (@code{calc-percent}) command takes a percentage value,
17460say 5.4, and converts it to an equivalent actual number. For example,
17461@kbd{5.4 M-%} enters 0.054 on the stack. (That's the @key{META} or
17462@key{ESC} key combined with @kbd{%}.)
17463
17464Actually, @kbd{M-%} creates a formula of the form @samp{5.4%}.
17465You can enter @samp{5.4%} yourself during algebraic entry. The
17466@samp{%} operator simply means, ``the preceding value divided by
17467100.'' The @samp{%} operator has very high precedence, so that
17468@samp{1+8%} is interpreted as @samp{1+(8%)}, not as @samp{(1+8)%}.
17469(The @samp{%} operator is just a postfix notation for the
17470@code{percent} function, just like @samp{20!} is the notation for
17471@samp{fact(20)}, or twenty-factorial.)
17472
17473The formula @samp{5.4%} would normally evaluate immediately to
174740.054, but the @kbd{M-%} command suppresses evaluation as it puts
17475the formula onto the stack. However, the next Calc command that
17476uses the formula @samp{5.4%} will evaluate it as its first step.
17477The net effect is that you get to look at @samp{5.4%} on the stack,
17478but Calc commands see it as @samp{0.054}, which is what they expect.
17479
17480In particular, @samp{5.4%} and @samp{0.054} are suitable values
17481for the @var{rate} arguments of the various financial functions,
17482but the number @samp{5.4} is probably @emph{not} suitable---it
17483represents a rate of 540 percent!
17484
17485The key sequence @kbd{M-% *} effectively means ``percent-of.''
17486For example, @kbd{68 @key{RET} 25 M-% *} computes 17, which is 25% of
1748768 (and also 68% of 25, which comes out to the same thing).
17488
17489@kindex c %
17490@pindex calc-convert-percent
17491The @kbd{c %} (@code{calc-convert-percent}) command converts the
17492value on the top of the stack from numeric to percentage form.
17493For example, if 0.08 is on the stack, @kbd{c %} converts it to
17494@samp{8%}. The quantity is the same, it's just represented
17495differently. (Contrast this with @kbd{M-%}, which would convert
17496this number to @samp{0.08%}.) The @kbd{=} key is a convenient way
17497to convert a formula like @samp{8%} back to numeric form, 0.08.
17498
17499To compute what percentage one quantity is of another quantity,
17500use @kbd{/ c %}. For example, @w{@kbd{17 @key{RET} 68 / c %}} displays
17501@samp{25%}.
17502
17503@kindex b %
17504@pindex calc-percent-change
17505@tindex relch
17506The @kbd{b %} (@code{calc-percent-change}) [@code{relch}] command
17507calculates the percentage change from one number to another.
17508For example, @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} produces the answer @samp{25%},
17509since 50 is 25% larger than 40. A negative result represents a
17510decrease: @kbd{50 @key{RET} 40 b %} produces @samp{-20%}, since 40 is
1751120% smaller than 50. (The answers are different in magnitude
17512because, in the first case, we're increasing by 25% of 40, but
17513in the second case, we're decreasing by 20% of 50.) The effect
17514of @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} is to compute @expr{(50-40)/40}, converting
17515the answer to percentage form as if by @kbd{c %}.
17516
17517@node Future Value, Present Value, Percentages, Financial Functions
17518@subsection Future Value
17519
17520@noindent
17521@kindex b F
17522@pindex calc-fin-fv
17523@tindex fv
17524The @kbd{b F} (@code{calc-fin-fv}) [@code{fv}] command computes
17525the future value of an investment. It takes three arguments
17526from the stack: @samp{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17527If you give payments of @var{payment} every year for @var{n}
17528years, and the money you have paid earns interest at @var{rate} per
17529year, then this function tells you what your investment would be
17530worth at the end of the period. (The actual interval doesn't
17531have to be years, as long as @var{n} and @var{rate} are expressed
17532in terms of the same intervals.) This function assumes payments
17533occur at the @emph{end} of each interval.
17534
17535@kindex I b F
17536@tindex fvb
17537The @kbd{I b F} [@code{fvb}] command does the same computation,
17538but assuming your payments are at the beginning of each interval.
17539Suppose you plan to deposit $1000 per year in a savings account
17540earning 5.4% interest, starting right now. How much will be
17541in the account after five years? @code{fvb(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5870.73}.
17542Thus you will have earned $870 worth of interest over the years.
17543Using the stack, this calculation would have been
17544@kbd{5.4 M-% 5 @key{RET} 1000 I b F}. Note that the rate is expressed
17545as a number between 0 and 1, @emph{not} as a percentage.
17546
17547@kindex H b F
17548@tindex fvl
17549The @kbd{H b F} [@code{fvl}] command computes the future value
17550of an initial lump sum investment. Suppose you could deposit
17551those five thousand dollars in the bank right now; how much would
17552they be worth in five years? @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 5000) = 6503.89}.
17553
17554The algebraic functions @code{fv} and @code{fvb} accept an optional
17555fourth argument, which is used as an initial lump sum in the sense
17556of @code{fvl}. In other words, @code{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17557@var{payment}, @var{initial}) = fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})
17558+ fvl(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{initial})}.
17559
17560To illustrate the relationships between these functions, we could
17561do the @code{fvb} calculation ``by hand'' using @code{fvl}. The
17562final balance will be the sum of the contributions of our five
17563deposits at various times. The first deposit earns interest for
17564five years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 1300.78}. The second
17565deposit only earns interest for four years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 4, 1000) =
175661234.13}. And so on down to the last deposit, which earns one
17567year's interest: @code{fvl(5.4%, 1, 1000) = 1054.00}. The sum of
17568these five values is, sure enough, $5870.73, just as was computed
17569by @code{fvb} directly.
17570
17571What does @code{fv(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5569.96} mean? The payments
17572are now at the ends of the periods. The end of one year is the same
17573as the beginning of the next, so what this really means is that we've
17574lost the payment at year zero (which contributed $1300.78), but we're
17575now counting the payment at year five (which, since it didn't have
17576a chance to earn interest, counts as $1000). Indeed, @expr{5569.96 =
175775870.73 - 1300.78 + 1000} (give or take a bit of roundoff error).
17578
17579@node Present Value, Related Financial Functions, Future Value, Financial Functions
17580@subsection Present Value
17581
17582@noindent
17583@kindex b P
17584@pindex calc-fin-pv
17585@tindex pv
17586The @kbd{b P} (@code{calc-fin-pv}) [@code{pv}] command computes
17587the present value of an investment. Like @code{fv}, it takes
17588three arguments: @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17589It computes the present value of a series of regular payments.
17590Suppose you have the chance to make an investment that will
17591pay $2000 per year over the next four years; as you receive
17592these payments you can put them in the bank at 9% interest.
17593You want to know whether it is better to make the investment, or
17594to keep the money in the bank where it earns 9% interest right
17595from the start. The calculation @code{pv(9%, 4, 2000)} gives the
17596result 6479.44. If your initial investment must be less than this,
17597say, $6000, then the investment is worthwhile. But if you had to
17598put up $7000, then it would be better just to leave it in the bank.
17599
17600Here is the interpretation of the result of @code{pv}: You are
17601trying to compare the return from the investment you are
17602considering, which is @code{fv(9%, 4, 2000) = 9146.26}, with
17603the return from leaving the money in the bank, which is
17604@code{fvl(9%, 4, @var{x})} where @var{x} is the amount of money
17605you would have to put up in advance. The @code{pv} function
17606finds the break-even point, @expr{x = 6479.44}, at which
17607@code{fvl(9%, 4, 6479.44)} is also equal to 9146.26. This is
17608the largest amount you should be willing to invest.
17609
17610@kindex I b P
17611@tindex pvb
17612The @kbd{I b P} [@code{pvb}] command solves the same problem,
17613but with payments occurring at the beginning of each interval.
17614It has the same relationship to @code{fvb} as @code{pv} has
17615to @code{fv}. For example @code{pvb(9%, 4, 2000) = 7062.59},
17616a larger number than @code{pv} produced because we get to start
17617earning interest on the return from our investment sooner.
17618
17619@kindex H b P
17620@tindex pvl
17621The @kbd{H b P} [@code{pvl}] command computes the present value of
17622an investment that will pay off in one lump sum at the end of the
17623period. For example, if we get our $8000 all at the end of the
17624four years, @code{pvl(9%, 4, 8000) = 5667.40}. This is much
17625less than @code{pv} reported, because we don't earn any interest
17626on the return from this investment. Note that @code{pvl} and
17627@code{fvl} are simple inverses: @code{fvl(9%, 4, 5667.40) = 8000}.
17628
17629You can give an optional fourth lump-sum argument to @code{pv}
17630and @code{pvb}; this is handled in exactly the same way as the
17631fourth argument for @code{fv} and @code{fvb}.
17632
17633@kindex b N
17634@pindex calc-fin-npv
17635@tindex npv
17636The @kbd{b N} (@code{calc-fin-npv}) [@code{npv}] command computes
17637the net present value of a series of irregular investments.
17638The first argument is the interest rate. The second argument is
17639a vector which represents the expected return from the investment
17640at the end of each interval. For example, if the rate represents
17641a yearly interest rate, then the vector elements are the return
17642from the first year, second year, and so on.
17643
17644Thus, @code{npv(9%, [2000,2000,2000,2000]) = pv(9%, 4, 2000) = 6479.44}.
17645Obviously this function is more interesting when the payments are
17646not all the same!
17647
17648The @code{npv} function can actually have two or more arguments.
17649Multiple arguments are interpreted in the same way as for the
17650vector statistical functions like @code{vsum}.
17651@xref{Single-Variable Statistics}. Basically, if there are several
17652payment arguments, each either a vector or a plain number, all these
17653values are collected left-to-right into the complete list of payments.
17654A numeric prefix argument on the @kbd{b N} command says how many
17655payment values or vectors to take from the stack.
17656
17657@kindex I b N
17658@tindex npvb
17659The @kbd{I b N} [@code{npvb}] command computes the net present
17660value where payments occur at the beginning of each interval
17661rather than at the end.
17662
17663@node Related Financial Functions, Depreciation Functions, Present Value, Financial Functions
17664@subsection Related Financial Functions
17665
17666@noindent
17667The functions in this section are basically inverses of the
17668present value functions with respect to the various arguments.
17669
17670@kindex b M
17671@pindex calc-fin-pmt
17672@tindex pmt
17673The @kbd{b M} (@code{calc-fin-pmt}) [@code{pmt}] command computes
17674the amount of periodic payment necessary to amortize a loan.
17675Thus @code{pmt(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{amount})} equals the
17676value of @var{payment} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17677@var{payment}) = @var{amount}}.
17678
17679@kindex I b M
17680@tindex pmtb
17681The @kbd{I b M} [@code{pmtb}] command does the same computation
17682but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. Like @code{pv} and
17683@code{pvb}, these functions can also take a fourth argument which
17684represents an initial lump-sum investment.
17685
17686@kindex H b M
17687The @kbd{H b M} key just invokes the @code{fvl} function, which is
17688the inverse of @code{pvl}. There is no explicit @code{pmtl} function.
17689
17690@kindex b #
17691@pindex calc-fin-nper
17692@tindex nper
17693The @kbd{b #} (@code{calc-fin-nper}) [@code{nper}] command computes
17694the number of regular payments necessary to amortize a loan.
17695Thus @code{nper(@var{rate}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} equals
17696the value of @var{n} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17697@var{payment}) = @var{amount}}. If @var{payment} is too small
17698ever to amortize a loan for @var{amount} at interest rate @var{rate},
17699the @code{nper} function is left in symbolic form.
17700
17701@kindex I b #
17702@tindex nperb
17703The @kbd{I b #} [@code{nperb}] command does the same computation
17704but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. You can give a fourth
17705lump-sum argument to these functions, but the computation will be
17706rather slow in the four-argument case.
17707
17708@kindex H b #
17709@tindex nperl
17710The @kbd{H b #} [@code{nperl}] command does the same computation
17711using @code{pvl}. By exchanging @var{payment} and @var{amount} you
17712can also get the solution for @code{fvl}. For example,
17713@code{nperl(8%, 2000, 1000) = 9.006}, so if you place $1000 in a
17714bank account earning 8%, it will take nine years to grow to $2000.
17715
17716@kindex b T
17717@pindex calc-fin-rate
17718@tindex rate
17719The @kbd{b T} (@code{calc-fin-rate}) [@code{rate}] command computes
17720the rate of return on an investment. This is also an inverse of @code{pv}:
17721@code{rate(@var{n}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} computes the value of
17722@var{rate} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment}) =
17723@var{amount}}. The result is expressed as a formula like @samp{6.3%}.
17724
17725@kindex I b T
17726@kindex H b T
17727@tindex rateb
17728@tindex ratel
17729The @kbd{I b T} [@code{rateb}] and @kbd{H b T} [@code{ratel}]
17730commands solve the analogous equations with @code{pvb} or @code{pvl}
17731in place of @code{pv}. Also, @code{rate} and @code{rateb} can
17732accept an optional fourth argument just like @code{pv} and @code{pvb}.
17733To redo the above example from a different perspective,
17734@code{ratel(9, 2000, 1000) = 8.00597%}, which says you will need an
17735interest rate of 8% in order to double your account in nine years.
17736
17737@kindex b I
17738@pindex calc-fin-irr
17739@tindex irr
17740The @kbd{b I} (@code{calc-fin-irr}) [@code{irr}] command is the
17741analogous function to @code{rate} but for net present value.
17742Its argument is a vector of payments. Thus @code{irr(@var{payments})}
17743computes the @var{rate} such that @code{npv(@var{rate}, @var{payments}) = 0};
17744this rate is known as the @dfn{internal rate of return}.
17745
17746@kindex I b I
17747@tindex irrb
17748The @kbd{I b I} [@code{irrb}] command computes the internal rate of
17749return assuming payments occur at the beginning of each period.
17750
17751@node Depreciation Functions, Definitions of Financial Functions, Related Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17752@subsection Depreciation Functions
17753
17754@noindent
17755The functions in this section calculate @dfn{depreciation}, which is
17756the amount of value that a possession loses over time. These functions
17757are characterized by three parameters: @var{cost}, the original cost
17758of the asset; @var{salvage}, the value the asset will have at the end
17759of its expected ``useful life''; and @var{life}, the number of years
17760(or other periods) of the expected useful life.
17761
17762There are several methods for calculating depreciation that differ in
17763the way they spread the depreciation over the lifetime of the asset.
17764
17765@kindex b S
17766@pindex calc-fin-sln
17767@tindex sln
17768The @kbd{b S} (@code{calc-fin-sln}) [@code{sln}] command computes the
17769``straight-line'' depreciation. In this method, the asset depreciates
17770by the same amount every year (or period). For example,
17771@samp{sln(12000, 2000, 5)} returns 2000. The asset costs $12000
17772initially and will be worth $2000 after five years; it loses $2000
17773per year.
17774
17775@kindex b Y
17776@pindex calc-fin-syd
17777@tindex syd
17778The @kbd{b Y} (@code{calc-fin-syd}) [@code{syd}] command computes the
17779accelerated ``sum-of-years'-digits'' depreciation. Here the depreciation
17780is higher during the early years of the asset's life. Since the
17781depreciation is different each year, @kbd{b Y} takes a fourth @var{period}
17782parameter which specifies which year is requested, from 1 to @var{life}.
17783If @var{period} is outside this range, the @code{syd} function will
17784return zero.
17785
17786@kindex b D
17787@pindex calc-fin-ddb
17788@tindex ddb
17789The @kbd{b D} (@code{calc-fin-ddb}) [@code{ddb}] command computes an
17790accelerated depreciation using the double-declining balance method.
17791It also takes a fourth @var{period} parameter.
17792
17793For symmetry, the @code{sln} function will accept a @var{period}
17794parameter as well, although it will ignore its value except that the
17795return value will as usual be zero if @var{period} is out of range.
17796
17797For example, pushing the vector @expr{[1,2,3,4,5]} (perhaps with @kbd{v x 5})
17798and then mapping @kbd{V M ' [sln(12000,2000,5,$), syd(12000,2000,5,$),
17799ddb(12000,2000,5,$)] @key{RET}} produces a matrix that allows us to compare
17800the three depreciation methods:
17801
17802@example
17803@group
17804[ [ 2000, 3333, 4800 ]
17805 [ 2000, 2667, 2880 ]
17806 [ 2000, 2000, 1728 ]
17807 [ 2000, 1333, 592 ]
17808 [ 2000, 667, 0 ] ]
17809@end group
17810@end example
17811
17812@noindent
17813(Values have been rounded to nearest integers in this figure.)
17814We see that @code{sln} depreciates by the same amount each year,
17815@kbd{syd} depreciates more at the beginning and less at the end,
17816and @kbd{ddb} weights the depreciation even more toward the beginning.
17817
17818Summing columns with @kbd{V R : +} yields @expr{[10000, 10000, 10000]};
17819the total depreciation in any method is (by definition) the
17820difference between the cost and the salvage value.
17821
17822@node Definitions of Financial Functions, , Depreciation Functions, Financial Functions
17823@subsection Definitions
17824
17825@noindent
17826For your reference, here are the actual formulas used to compute
17827Calc's financial functions.
17828
17829Calc will not evaluate a financial function unless the @var{rate} or
17830@var{n} argument is known. However, @var{payment} or @var{amount} can
17831be a variable. Calc expands these functions according to the
17832formulas below for symbolic arguments only when you use the @kbd{a "}
17833(@code{calc-expand-formula}) command, or when taking derivatives or
17834integrals or solving equations involving the functions.
17835
17836@ifnottex
17837These formulas are shown using the conventions of Big display
17838mode (@kbd{d B}); for example, the formula for @code{fv} written
17839linearly is @samp{pmt * ((1 + rate)^n) - 1) / rate}.
17840
17841@example
17842 n
17843 (1 + rate) - 1
17844fv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ---------------
17845 rate
17846
17847 n
17848 ((1 + rate) - 1) (1 + rate)
17849fvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------------------
17850 rate
17851
17852 n
17853fvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17854
17855 -n
17856 1 - (1 + rate)
17857pv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------
17858 rate
17859
17860 -n
17861 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17862pvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * -----------------------------
17863 rate
17864
17865 -n
17866pvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17867
17868 -1 -2 -3
17869npv(rate, [a, b, c]) = a*(1 + rate) + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17870
17871 -1 -2
17872npvb(rate, [a, b, c]) = a + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17873
17874 -n
17875 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17876pmt(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17877 -n
17878 1 - (1 + rate)
17879
17880 -n
17881 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17882pmtb(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17883 -n
17884 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17885
17886 amt * rate
17887nper(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ------------, 1 + rate)
17888 pmt
17889
17890 amt * rate
17891nperb(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ---------------, 1 + rate)
17892 pmt * (1 + rate)
17893
17894 amt
17895nperl(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(---, 1 + rate)
17896 pmt
17897
17898 1/n
17899 pmt
17900ratel(n, pmt, amt) = ------ - 1
17901 1/n
17902 amt
17903
17904 cost - salv
17905sln(cost, salv, life) = -----------
17906 life
17907
17908 (cost - salv) * (life - per + 1)
17909syd(cost, salv, life, per) = --------------------------------
17910 life * (life + 1) / 2
17911
17912 book * 2
17913ddb(cost, salv, life, per) = --------, book = cost - depreciation so far
17914 life
17915@end example
17916@end ifnottex
17917@tex
4009494e
GM
17918$$ \code{fv}(r, n, p) = p { (1 + r)^n - 1 \over r } $$
17919$$ \code{fvb}(r, n, p) = p { ((1 + r)^n - 1) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17920$$ \code{fvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^n $$
17921$$ \code{pv}(r, n, p) = p { 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} \over r } $$
17922$$ \code{pvb}(r, n, p) = p { (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17923$$ \code{pvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^{-n} $$
17924$$ \code{npv}(r, [a,b,c]) = a (1 + r)^{-1} + b (1 + r)^{-2} + c (1 + r)^{-3} $$
17925$$ \code{npvb}(r, [a,b,c]) = a + b (1 + r)^{-1} + c (1 + r)^{-2} $$
17926$$ \code{pmt}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} }$$
17927$$ \code{pmtb}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over
17928 (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) } $$
17929$$ \code{nper}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p }, 1 + r) $$
17930$$ \code{nperb}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p (1 + r) }, 1 + r) $$
17931$$ \code{nperl}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}({a \over p}, 1 + r) $$
17932$$ \code{ratel}(n, p, a) = { p^{1/n} \over a^{1/n} } - 1 $$
17933$$ \code{sln}(c, s, l) = { c - s \over l } $$
17934$$ \code{syd}(c, s, l, p) = { (c - s) (l - p + 1) \over l (l+1) / 2 } $$
17935$$ \code{ddb}(c, s, l, p) = { 2 (c - \hbox{depreciation so far}) \over l } $$
17936@end tex
17937
17938@noindent
17939In @code{pmt} and @code{pmtb}, @expr{x=0} if omitted.
17940
17941These functions accept any numeric objects, including error forms,
17942intervals, and even (though not very usefully) complex numbers. The
17943above formulas specify exactly the behavior of these functions with
17944all sorts of inputs.
17945
17946Note that if the first argument to the @code{log} in @code{nper} is
17947negative, @code{nper} leaves itself in symbolic form rather than
17948returning a (financially meaningless) complex number.
17949
17950@samp{rate(num, pmt, amt)} solves the equation
17951@samp{pv(rate, num, pmt) = amt} for @samp{rate} using @kbd{H a R}
17952(@code{calc-find-root}), with the interval @samp{[.01% .. 100%]}
17953for an initial guess. The @code{rateb} function is the same except
17954that it uses @code{pvb}. Note that @code{ratel} can be solved
17955directly; its formula is shown in the above list.
17956
17957Similarly, @samp{irr(pmts)} solves the equation @samp{npv(rate, pmts) = 0}
17958for @samp{rate}.
17959
17960If you give a fourth argument to @code{nper} or @code{nperb}, Calc
17961will also use @kbd{H a R} to solve the equation using an initial
17962guess interval of @samp{[0 .. 100]}.
17963
17964A fourth argument to @code{fv} simply sums the two components
17965calculated from the above formulas for @code{fv} and @code{fvl}.
17966The same is true of @code{fvb}, @code{pv}, and @code{pvb}.
17967
17968The @kbd{ddb} function is computed iteratively; the ``book'' value
17969starts out equal to @var{cost}, and decreases according to the above
17970formula for the specified number of periods. If the book value
17971would decrease below @var{salvage}, it only decreases to @var{salvage}
17972and the depreciation is zero for all subsequent periods. The @code{ddb}
17973function returns the amount the book value decreased in the specified
17974period.
17975
17976@node Binary Functions, , Financial Functions, Arithmetic
17977@section Binary Number Functions
17978
17979@noindent
17980The commands in this chapter all use two-letter sequences beginning with
17981the @kbd{b} prefix.
17982
17983@cindex Binary numbers
17984The ``binary'' operations actually work regardless of the currently
17985displayed radix, although their results make the most sense in a radix
17986like 2, 8, or 16 (as obtained by the @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, or @w{@kbd{d 6}}
17987commands, respectively). You may also wish to enable display of leading
17988zeros with @kbd{d z}. @xref{Radix Modes}.
17989
17990@cindex Word size for binary operations
17991The Calculator maintains a current @dfn{word size} @expr{w}, an
17992arbitrary positive or negative integer. For a positive word size, all
17993of the binary operations described here operate modulo @expr{2^w}. In
17994particular, negative arguments are converted to positive integers modulo
17995@expr{2^w} by all binary functions.
17996
17291a1f 17997If the word size is negative, binary operations produce twos-complement
4009494e
GM
17998integers from
17999@texline @math{-2^{-w-1}}
18000@infoline @expr{-(2^(-w-1))}
18001to
18002@texline @math{2^{-w-1}-1}
18003@infoline @expr{2^(-w-1)-1}
18004inclusive. Either mode accepts inputs in any range; the sign of
18005@expr{w} affects only the results produced.
18006
18007@kindex b c
18008@pindex calc-clip
18009@tindex clip
18010The @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip})
18011[@code{clip}] command can be used to clip a number by reducing it modulo
18012@expr{2^w}. The commands described in this chapter automatically clip
18013their results to the current word size. Note that other operations like
18014addition do not use the current word size, since integer addition
18015generally is not ``binary.'' (However, @pxref{Simplification Modes},
18016@code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}.) For example, with a word size of 8
18017bits @kbd{b c} converts a number to the range 0 to 255; with a word
18018size of @mathit{-8} @kbd{b c} converts to the range @mathit{-128} to 127.
18019
18020@kindex b w
18021@pindex calc-word-size
18022The default word size is 32 bits. All operations except the shifts and
18023rotates allow you to specify a different word size for that one
18024operation by giving a numeric prefix argument: @kbd{C-u 8 b c} clips the
18025top of stack to the range 0 to 255 regardless of the current word size.
18026To set the word size permanently, use @kbd{b w} (@code{calc-word-size}).
18027This command displays a prompt with the current word size; press @key{RET}
18028immediately to keep this word size, or type a new word size at the prompt.
18029
18030When the binary operations are written in symbolic form, they take an
18031optional second (or third) word-size parameter. When a formula like
18032@samp{and(a,b)} is finally evaluated, the word size current at that time
18033will be used, but when @samp{and(a,b,-8)} is evaluated, a word size of
18034@mathit{-8} will always be used. A symbolic binary function will be left
18035in symbolic form unless the all of its argument(s) are integers or
18036integer-valued floats.
18037
18038If either or both arguments are modulo forms for which @expr{M} is a
18039power of two, that power of two is taken as the word size unless a
18040numeric prefix argument overrides it. The current word size is never
18041consulted when modulo-power-of-two forms are involved.
18042
18043@kindex b a
18044@pindex calc-and
18045@tindex and
18046The @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}) [@code{and}] command computes the bitwise
18047AND of the two numbers on the top of the stack. In other words, for each
18048of the @expr{w} binary digits of the two numbers (pairwise), the corresponding
18049bit of the result is 1 if and only if both input bits are 1:
18050@samp{and(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1000}.
18051
18052@kindex b o
18053@pindex calc-or
18054@tindex or
18055The @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}) [@code{or}] command computes the bitwise
18056inclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if either of the input bits, or
18057both, are 1: @samp{or(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1110}.
18058
18059@kindex b x
18060@pindex calc-xor
18061@tindex xor
18062The @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}) [@code{xor}] command computes the bitwise
18063exclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if exactly one of the input bits
18064is 1: @samp{xor(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0110}.
18065
18066@kindex b d
18067@pindex calc-diff
18068@tindex diff
18069The @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}) [@code{diff}] command computes the bitwise
18070difference of two numbers; this is defined by @samp{diff(a,b) = and(a,not(b))},
18071so that @samp{diff(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0100}.
18072
18073@kindex b n
18074@pindex calc-not
18075@tindex not
18076The @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}) [@code{not}] command computes the bitwise
18077NOT of a number. A bit is 1 if the input bit is 0 and vice-versa.
18078
18079@kindex b l
18080@pindex calc-lshift-binary
18081@tindex lsh
18082The @kbd{b l} (@code{calc-lshift-binary}) [@code{lsh}] command shifts a
18083number left by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18084prefix argument. A negative prefix argument performs a logical right shift,
18085in which zeros are shifted in on the left. In symbolic form, @samp{lsh(a)}
18086is short for @samp{lsh(a,1)}, which in turn is short for @samp{lsh(a,n,w)}.
18087Bits shifted ``off the end,'' according to the current word size, are lost.
18088
18089@kindex H b l
18090@kindex H b r
18091@ignore
18092@mindex @idots
18093@end ignore
18094@kindex H b L
18095@ignore
18096@mindex @null
18097@end ignore
18098@kindex H b R
18099@ignore
18100@mindex @null
18101@end ignore
18102@kindex H b t
18103The @kbd{H b l} command also does a left shift, but it takes two arguments
18104from the stack (the value to shift, and, at top-of-stack, the number of
18105bits to shift). This version interprets the prefix argument just like
18106the regular binary operations, i.e., as a word size. The Hyperbolic flag
18107has a similar effect on the rest of the binary shift and rotate commands.
18108
18109@kindex b r
18110@pindex calc-rshift-binary
18111@tindex rsh
18112The @kbd{b r} (@code{calc-rshift-binary}) [@code{rsh}] command shifts a
18113number right by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18114prefix argument: @samp{rsh(a,n) = lsh(a,-n)}.
18115
18116@kindex b L
18117@pindex calc-lshift-arith
18118@tindex ash
18119The @kbd{b L} (@code{calc-lshift-arith}) [@code{ash}] command shifts a
18120number left. It is analogous to @code{lsh}, except that if the shift
18121is rightward (the prefix argument is negative), an arithmetic shift
18122is performed as described below.
18123
18124@kindex b R
18125@pindex calc-rshift-arith
18126@tindex rash
18127The @kbd{b R} (@code{calc-rshift-arith}) [@code{rash}] command performs
18128an ``arithmetic'' shift to the right, in which the leftmost bit (according
18129to the current word size) is duplicated rather than shifting in zeros.
18130This corresponds to dividing by a power of two where the input is interpreted
18131as a signed, twos-complement number. (The distinction between the @samp{rsh}
18132and @samp{rash} operations is totally independent from whether the word
18133size is positive or negative.) With a negative prefix argument, this
18134performs a standard left shift.
18135
18136@kindex b t
18137@pindex calc-rotate-binary
18138@tindex rot
18139The @kbd{b t} (@code{calc-rotate-binary}) [@code{rot}] command rotates a
18140number one bit to the left. The leftmost bit (according to the current
18141word size) is dropped off the left and shifted in on the right. With a
18142numeric prefix argument, the number is rotated that many bits to the left
18143or right.
18144
18145@xref{Set Operations}, for the @kbd{b p} and @kbd{b u} commands that
18146pack and unpack binary integers into sets. (For example, @kbd{b u}
18147unpacks the number @samp{2#11001} to the set of bit-numbers
18148@samp{[0, 3, 4]}.) Type @kbd{b u V #} to count the number of ``1''
18149bits in a binary integer.
18150
18151Another interesting use of the set representation of binary integers
18152is to reverse the bits in, say, a 32-bit integer. Type @kbd{b u} to
18153unpack; type @kbd{31 @key{TAB} -} to replace each bit-number in the set
18154with 31 minus that bit-number; type @kbd{b p} to pack the set back
18155into a binary integer.
18156
18157@node Scientific Functions, Matrix Functions, Arithmetic, Top
18158@chapter Scientific Functions
18159
18160@noindent
18161The functions described here perform trigonometric and other transcendental
18162calculations. They generally produce floating-point answers correct to the
18163full current precision. The @kbd{H} (Hyperbolic) and @kbd{I} (Inverse)
18164flag keys must be used to get some of these functions from the keyboard.
18165
18166@kindex P
18167@pindex calc-pi
18168@cindex @code{pi} variable
18169@vindex pi
18170@kindex H P
18171@cindex @code{e} variable
18172@vindex e
18173@kindex I P
18174@cindex @code{gamma} variable
18175@vindex gamma
18176@cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
18177@cindex Euler's gamma constant
18178@kindex H I P
18179@cindex @code{phi} variable
18180@cindex Phi, golden ratio
18181@cindex Golden ratio
18182One miscellaneous command is shift-@kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}), which pushes
18183the value of @cpi{} (at the current precision) onto the stack. With the
18184Hyperbolic flag, it pushes the value @expr{e}, the base of natural logarithms.
18185With the Inverse flag, it pushes Euler's constant
18186@texline @math{\gamma}
18187@infoline @expr{gamma}
18188(about 0.5772). With both Inverse and Hyperbolic, it
18189pushes the ``golden ratio''
18190@texline @math{\phi}
18191@infoline @expr{phi}
18192(about 1.618). (At present, Euler's constant is not available
18193to unlimited precision; Calc knows only the first 100 digits.)
18194In Symbolic mode, these commands push the
18195actual variables @samp{pi}, @samp{e}, @samp{gamma}, and @samp{phi},
18196respectively, instead of their values; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}.
18197
18198@ignore
18199@mindex Q
18200@end ignore
18201@ignore
18202@mindex I Q
18203@end ignore
18204@kindex I Q
18205@tindex sqr
18206The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] function is described elsewhere;
18207@pxref{Basic Arithmetic}. With the Inverse flag [@code{sqr}], this command
18208computes the square of the argument.
18209
18210@xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
18211prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
18212interpret a prefix argument.
18213
18214@menu
18215* Logarithmic Functions::
18216* Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions::
18217* Advanced Math Functions::
18218* Branch Cuts::
18219* Random Numbers::
18220* Combinatorial Functions::
18221* Probability Distribution Functions::
18222@end menu
18223
18224@node Logarithmic Functions, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions, Scientific Functions
18225@section Logarithmic Functions
18226
18227@noindent
18228@kindex L
18229@pindex calc-ln
18230@tindex ln
18231@ignore
18232@mindex @null
18233@end ignore
18234@kindex I E
18235The shift-@kbd{L} (@code{calc-ln}) [@code{ln}] command computes the natural
18236logarithm of the real or complex number on the top of the stack. With
18237the Inverse flag it computes the exponential function instead, although
18238this is redundant with the @kbd{E} command.
18239
18240@kindex E
18241@pindex calc-exp
18242@tindex exp
18243@ignore
18244@mindex @null
18245@end ignore
18246@kindex I L
18247The shift-@kbd{E} (@code{calc-exp}) [@code{exp}] command computes the
18248exponential, i.e., @expr{e} raised to the power of the number on the stack.
18249The meanings of the Inverse and Hyperbolic flags follow from those for
18250the @code{calc-ln} command.
18251
18252@kindex H L
18253@kindex H E
18254@pindex calc-log10
18255@tindex log10
18256@tindex exp10
18257@ignore
18258@mindex @null
18259@end ignore
18260@kindex H I L
18261@ignore
18262@mindex @null
18263@end ignore
18264@kindex H I E
18265The @kbd{H L} (@code{calc-log10}) [@code{log10}] command computes the common
18266(base-10) logarithm of a number. (With the Inverse flag [@code{exp10}],
18267it raises ten to a given power.) Note that the common logarithm of a
18268complex number is computed by taking the natural logarithm and dividing
18269by
18270@texline @math{\ln10}.
18271@infoline @expr{ln(10)}.
18272
18273@kindex B
18274@kindex I B
18275@pindex calc-log
18276@tindex log
18277@tindex alog
18278The @kbd{B} (@code{calc-log}) [@code{log}] command computes a logarithm
18279to any base. For example, @kbd{1024 @key{RET} 2 B} produces 10, since
18280@texline @math{2^{10} = 1024}.
18281@infoline @expr{2^10 = 1024}.
18282In certain cases like @samp{log(3,9)}, the result
18283will be either @expr{1:2} or @expr{0.5} depending on the current Fraction
18284mode setting. With the Inverse flag [@code{alog}], this command is
18285similar to @kbd{^} except that the order of the arguments is reversed.
18286
18287@kindex f I
18288@pindex calc-ilog
18289@tindex ilog
18290The @kbd{f I} (@code{calc-ilog}) [@code{ilog}] command computes the
18291integer logarithm of a number to any base. The number and the base must
18292themselves be positive integers. This is the true logarithm, rounded
18293down to an integer. Thus @kbd{ilog(x,10)} is 3 for all @expr{x} in the
18294range from 1000 to 9999. If both arguments are positive integers, exact
18295integer arithmetic is used; otherwise, this is equivalent to
18296@samp{floor(log(x,b))}.
18297
18298@kindex f E
18299@pindex calc-expm1
18300@tindex expm1
18301The @kbd{f E} (@code{calc-expm1}) [@code{expm1}] command computes
18302@texline @math{e^x - 1},
18303@infoline @expr{exp(x)-1},
18304but using an algorithm that produces a more accurate
18305answer when the result is close to zero, i.e., when
18306@texline @math{e^x}
18307@infoline @expr{exp(x)}
18308is close to one.
18309
18310@kindex f L
18311@pindex calc-lnp1
18312@tindex lnp1
18313The @kbd{f L} (@code{calc-lnp1}) [@code{lnp1}] command computes
18314@texline @math{\ln(x+1)},
18315@infoline @expr{ln(x+1)},
18316producing a more accurate answer when @expr{x} is close to zero.
18317
18318@node Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Advanced Math Functions, Logarithmic Functions, Scientific Functions
18319@section Trigonometric/Hyperbolic Functions
18320
18321@noindent
18322@kindex S
18323@pindex calc-sin
18324@tindex sin
18325The shift-@kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}) [@code{sin}] command computes the sine
18326of an angle or complex number. If the input is an HMS form, it is interpreted
18327as degrees-minutes-seconds; otherwise, the input is interpreted according
18328to the current angular mode. It is best to use Radians mode when operating
18329on complex numbers.
18330
18331Calc's ``units'' mechanism includes angular units like @code{deg},
18332@code{rad}, and @code{grad}. While @samp{sin(45 deg)} is not evaluated
18333all the time, the @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command will
18334simplify @samp{sin(45 deg)} by taking the sine of 45 degrees, regardless
18335of the current angular mode. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
18336
18337Also, the symbolic variable @code{pi} is not ordinarily recognized in
18338arguments to trigonometric functions, as in @samp{sin(3 pi / 4)}, but
18339the @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) command recognizes many such
18340formulas when the current angular mode is Radians @emph{and} Symbolic
18341mode is enabled; this example would be replaced by @samp{sqrt(2) / 2}.
18342@xref{Symbolic Mode}. Beware, this simplification occurs even if you
18343have stored a different value in the variable @samp{pi}; this is one
18344reason why changing built-in variables is a bad idea. Arguments of
18345the form @expr{x} plus a multiple of @cpiover{2} are also simplified.
18346Calc includes similar formulas for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
18347
18348The @kbd{a s} command knows all angles which are integer multiples of
18349@cpiover{12}, @cpiover{10}, or @cpiover{8} radians. In Degrees mode,
18350analogous simplifications occur for integer multiples of 15 or 18
18351degrees, and for arguments plus multiples of 90 degrees.
18352
18353@kindex I S
18354@pindex calc-arcsin
18355@tindex arcsin
18356With the Inverse flag, @code{calc-sin} computes an arcsine. This is also
18357available as the @code{calc-arcsin} command or @code{arcsin} algebraic
18358function. The returned argument is converted to degrees, radians, or HMS
18359notation depending on the current angular mode.
18360
18361@kindex H S
18362@pindex calc-sinh
18363@tindex sinh
18364@kindex H I S
18365@pindex calc-arcsinh
18366@tindex arcsinh
18367With the Hyperbolic flag, @code{calc-sin} computes the hyperbolic
18368sine, also available as @code{calc-sinh} [@code{sinh}]. With the
18369Hyperbolic and Inverse flags, it computes the hyperbolic arcsine
18370(@code{calc-arcsinh}) [@code{arcsinh}].
18371
18372@kindex C
18373@pindex calc-cos
18374@tindex cos
18375@ignore
18376@mindex @idots
18377@end ignore
18378@kindex I C
18379@pindex calc-arccos
18380@ignore
18381@mindex @null
18382@end ignore
18383@tindex arccos
18384@ignore
18385@mindex @null
18386@end ignore
18387@kindex H C
18388@pindex calc-cosh
18389@ignore
18390@mindex @null
18391@end ignore
18392@tindex cosh
18393@ignore
18394@mindex @null
18395@end ignore
18396@kindex H I C
18397@pindex calc-arccosh
18398@ignore
18399@mindex @null
18400@end ignore
18401@tindex arccosh
18402@ignore
18403@mindex @null
18404@end ignore
18405@kindex T
18406@pindex calc-tan
18407@ignore
18408@mindex @null
18409@end ignore
18410@tindex tan
18411@ignore
18412@mindex @null
18413@end ignore
18414@kindex I T
18415@pindex calc-arctan
18416@ignore
18417@mindex @null
18418@end ignore
18419@tindex arctan
18420@ignore
18421@mindex @null
18422@end ignore
18423@kindex H T
18424@pindex calc-tanh
18425@ignore
18426@mindex @null
18427@end ignore
18428@tindex tanh
18429@ignore
18430@mindex @null
18431@end ignore
18432@kindex H I T
18433@pindex calc-arctanh
18434@ignore
18435@mindex @null
18436@end ignore
18437@tindex arctanh
18438The shift-@kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}] command computes the cosine
18439of an angle or complex number, and shift-@kbd{T} (@code{calc-tan}) [@code{tan}]
18440computes the tangent, along with all the various inverse and hyperbolic
18441variants of these functions.
18442
18443@kindex f T
18444@pindex calc-arctan2
18445@tindex arctan2
18446The @kbd{f T} (@code{calc-arctan2}) [@code{arctan2}] command takes two
18447numbers from the stack and computes the arc tangent of their ratio. The
18448result is in the full range from @mathit{-180} (exclusive) to @mathit{+180}
18449(inclusive) degrees, or the analogous range in radians. A similar
18450result would be obtained with @kbd{/} followed by @kbd{I T}, but the
18451value would only be in the range from @mathit{-90} to @mathit{+90} degrees
18452since the division loses information about the signs of the two
18453components, and an error might result from an explicit division by zero
18454which @code{arctan2} would avoid. By (arbitrary) definition,
18455@samp{arctan2(0,0)=0}.
18456
18457@pindex calc-sincos
18458@ignore
18459@starindex
18460@end ignore
18461@tindex sincos
18462@ignore
18463@starindex
18464@end ignore
18465@ignore
18466@mindex arc@idots
18467@end ignore
18468@tindex arcsincos
18469The @code{calc-sincos} [@code{sincos}] command computes the sine and
18470cosine of a number, returning them as a vector of the form
18471@samp{[@var{cos}, @var{sin}]}.
18472With the Inverse flag [@code{arcsincos}], this command takes a two-element
18473vector as an argument and computes @code{arctan2} of the elements.
18474(This command does not accept the Hyperbolic flag.)
18475
18476@pindex calc-sec
18477@tindex sec
18478@pindex calc-csc
18479@tindex csc
18480@pindex calc-cot
18481@tindex cot
18482@pindex calc-sech
18483@tindex sech
18484@pindex calc-csch
18485@tindex csch
18486@pindex calc-coth
18487@tindex coth
18488The remaining trigonometric functions, @code{calc-sec} [@code{sec}],
4bb49b43 18489@code{calc-csc} [@code{csc}] and @code{calc-cot} [@code{cot}], are also
4009494e
GM
18490available. With the Hyperbolic flag, these compute their hyperbolic
18491counterparts, which are also available separately as @code{calc-sech}
4bb49b43 18492[@code{sech}], @code{calc-csch} [@code{csch}] and @code{calc-coth}
9c264403 18493[@code{coth}]. (These commands do not accept the Inverse flag.)
4009494e
GM
18494
18495@node Advanced Math Functions, Branch Cuts, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions
18496@section Advanced Mathematical Functions
18497
18498@noindent
18499Calc can compute a variety of less common functions that arise in
18500various branches of mathematics. All of the functions described in
18501this section allow arbitrary complex arguments and, except as noted,
18502will work to arbitrarily large precisions. They can not at present
18503handle error forms or intervals as arguments.
18504
18505NOTE: These functions are still experimental. In particular, their
18506accuracy is not guaranteed in all domains. It is advisable to set the
18507current precision comfortably higher than you actually need when
18508using these functions. Also, these functions may be impractically
18509slow for some values of the arguments.
18510
18511@kindex f g
18512@pindex calc-gamma
18513@tindex gamma
18514The @kbd{f g} (@code{calc-gamma}) [@code{gamma}] command computes the Euler
18515gamma function. For positive integer arguments, this is related to the
18516factorial function: @samp{gamma(n+1) = fact(n)}. For general complex
18517arguments the gamma function can be defined by the following definite
18518integral:
18519@texline @math{\Gamma(a) = \int_0^\infty t^{a-1} e^t dt}.
18520@infoline @expr{gamma(a) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, inf)}.
18521(The actual implementation uses far more efficient computational methods.)
18522
18523@kindex f G
18524@tindex gammaP
18525@ignore
18526@mindex @idots
18527@end ignore
18528@kindex I f G
18529@ignore
18530@mindex @null
18531@end ignore
18532@kindex H f G
18533@ignore
18534@mindex @null
18535@end ignore
18536@kindex H I f G
18537@pindex calc-inc-gamma
18538@ignore
18539@mindex @null
18540@end ignore
18541@tindex gammaQ
18542@ignore
18543@mindex @null
18544@end ignore
18545@tindex gammag
18546@ignore
18547@mindex @null
18548@end ignore
18549@tindex gammaG
18550The @kbd{f G} (@code{calc-inc-gamma}) [@code{gammaP}] command computes
18551the incomplete gamma function, denoted @samp{P(a,x)}. This is defined by
18552the integral,
18553@texline @math{P(a,x) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} e^t dt \right) / \Gamma(a)}.
18554@infoline @expr{gammaP(a,x) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, x) / gamma(a)}.
18555This implies that @samp{gammaP(a,inf) = 1} for any @expr{a} (see the
18556definition of the normal gamma function).
18557
18558Several other varieties of incomplete gamma function are defined.
18559The complement of @expr{P(a,x)}, called @expr{Q(a,x) = 1-P(a,x)} by
18560some authors, is computed by the @kbd{I f G} [@code{gammaQ}] command.
18561You can think of this as taking the other half of the integral, from
18562@expr{x} to infinity.
18563
18564@ifnottex
18565The functions corresponding to the integrals that define @expr{P(a,x)}
18566and @expr{Q(a,x)} but without the normalizing @expr{1/gamma(a)}
18567factor are called @expr{g(a,x)} and @expr{G(a,x)}, respectively
18568(where @expr{g} and @expr{G} represent the lower- and upper-case Greek
18569letter gamma). You can obtain these using the @kbd{H f G} [@code{gammag}]
18570and @kbd{H I f G} [@code{gammaG}] commands.
18571@end ifnottex
18572@tex
4009494e
GM
18573The functions corresponding to the integrals that define $P(a,x)$
18574and $Q(a,x)$ but without the normalizing $1/\Gamma(a)$
18575factor are called $\gamma(a,x)$ and $\Gamma(a,x)$, respectively.
18576You can obtain these using the \kbd{H f G} [\code{gammag}] and
18577\kbd{I H f G} [\code{gammaG}] commands.
18578@end tex
18579
18580@kindex f b
18581@pindex calc-beta
18582@tindex beta
18583The @kbd{f b} (@code{calc-beta}) [@code{beta}] command computes the
18584Euler beta function, which is defined in terms of the gamma function as
18585@texline @math{B(a,b) = \Gamma(a) \Gamma(b) / \Gamma(a+b)},
18586@infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = gamma(a) gamma(b) / gamma(a+b)},
18587or by
18588@texline @math{B(a,b) = \int_0^1 t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt}.
18589@infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, 1)}.
18590
18591@kindex f B
18592@kindex H f B
18593@pindex calc-inc-beta
18594@tindex betaI
18595@tindex betaB
18596The @kbd{f B} (@code{calc-inc-beta}) [@code{betaI}] command computes
18597the incomplete beta function @expr{I(x,a,b)}. It is defined by
18598@texline @math{I(x,a,b) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt \right) / B(a,b)}.
18599@infoline @expr{betaI(x,a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, x) / beta(a,b)}.
18600Once again, the @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix gives the corresponding
18601un-normalized version [@code{betaB}].
18602
18603@kindex f e
18604@kindex I f e
18605@pindex calc-erf
18606@tindex erf
18607@tindex erfc
18608The @kbd{f e} (@code{calc-erf}) [@code{erf}] command computes the
18609error function
18610@texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) = {2 \over \sqrt{\pi}} \int_0^x e^{-t^2} dt}.
18611@infoline @expr{erf(x) = 2 integ(exp(-(t^2)), t, 0, x) / sqrt(pi)}.
18612The complementary error function @kbd{I f e} (@code{calc-erfc}) [@code{erfc}]
18613is the corresponding integral from @samp{x} to infinity; the sum
18614@texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) + \hbox{erfc}(x) = 1}.
18615@infoline @expr{erf(x) + erfc(x) = 1}.
18616
18617@kindex f j
18618@kindex f y
18619@pindex calc-bessel-J
18620@pindex calc-bessel-Y
18621@tindex besJ
18622@tindex besY
18623The @kbd{f j} (@code{calc-bessel-J}) [@code{besJ}] and @kbd{f y}
18624(@code{calc-bessel-Y}) [@code{besY}] commands compute the Bessel
18625functions of the first and second kinds, respectively.
18626In @samp{besJ(n,x)} and @samp{besY(n,x)} the ``order'' parameter
18627@expr{n} is often an integer, but is not required to be one.
18628Calc's implementation of the Bessel functions currently limits the
18629precision to 8 digits, and may not be exact even to that precision.
18630Use with care!
18631
18632@node Branch Cuts, Random Numbers, Advanced Math Functions, Scientific Functions
18633@section Branch Cuts and Principal Values
18634
18635@noindent
18636@cindex Branch cuts
18637@cindex Principal values
18638All of the logarithmic, trigonometric, and other scientific functions are
18639defined for complex numbers as well as for reals.
18640This section describes the values
18641returned in cases where the general result is a family of possible values.
18642Calc follows section 12.5.3 of Steele's @dfn{Common Lisp, the Language},
18643second edition, in these matters. This section will describe each
18644function briefly; for a more detailed discussion (including some nifty
18645diagrams), consult Steele's book.
18646
18647Note that the branch cuts for @code{arctan} and @code{arctanh} were
5a83c46e
JB
18648changed between the first and second editions of Steele. Recent
18649versions of Calc follow the second edition.
4009494e
GM
18650
18651The new branch cuts exactly match those of the HP-28/48 calculators.
18652They also match those of Mathematica 1.2, except that Mathematica's
18653@code{arctan} cut is always in the right half of the complex plane,
18654and its @code{arctanh} cut is always in the top half of the plane.
18655Calc's cuts are continuous with quadrants I and III for @code{arctan},
18656or II and IV for @code{arctanh}.
18657
18658Note: The current implementations of these functions with complex arguments
18659are designed with proper behavior around the branch cuts in mind, @emph{not}
18660efficiency or accuracy. You may need to increase the floating precision
18661and wait a while to get suitable answers from them.
18662
18663For @samp{sqrt(a+bi)}: When @expr{a<0} and @expr{b} is small but positive
18664or zero, the result is close to the @expr{+i} axis. For @expr{b} small and
18665negative, the result is close to the @expr{-i} axis. The result always lies
18666in the right half of the complex plane.
18667
18668For @samp{ln(a+bi)}: The real part is defined as @samp{ln(abs(a+bi))}.
18669The imaginary part is defined as @samp{arg(a+bi) = arctan2(b,a)}.
18670Thus the branch cuts for @code{sqrt} and @code{ln} both lie on the
18671negative real axis.
18672
18673The following table describes these branch cuts in another way.
18674If the real and imaginary parts of @expr{z} are as shown, then
18675the real and imaginary parts of @expr{f(z)} will be as shown.
18676Here @code{eps} stands for a small positive value; each
18677occurrence of @code{eps} may stand for a different small value.
18678
18679@smallexample
18680 z sqrt(z) ln(z)
18681----------------------------------------
18682 +, 0 +, 0 any, 0
18683 -, 0 0, + any, pi
18684 -, +eps +eps, + +eps, +
18685 -, -eps +eps, - +eps, -
18686@end smallexample
18687
18688For @samp{z1^z2}: This is defined by @samp{exp(ln(z1)*z2)}.
18689One interesting consequence of this is that @samp{(-8)^1:3} does
18690not evaluate to @mathit{-2} as you might expect, but to the complex
18691number @expr{(1., 1.732)}. Both of these are valid cube roots
18692of @mathit{-8} (as is @expr{(1., -1.732)}); Calc chooses a perhaps
18693less-obvious root for the sake of mathematical consistency.
18694
18695For @samp{arcsin(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(i*z + sqrt(1-z^2))}.
18696The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18697
18698For @samp{arccos(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(z + i*sqrt(1-z^2))},
18699or equivalently by @samp{pi/2 - arcsin(z)}. The branch cuts are on
18700the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18701
18702For @samp{arctan(z)}: This is defined by
18703@samp{(ln(1+i*z) - ln(1-i*z)) / (2*i)}. The branch cuts are on the
18704imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and above @expr{i}.
18705
18706For @samp{arcsinh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{ln(z + sqrt(1+z^2))}.
18707The branch cuts are on the imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and
18708above @expr{i}.
18709
18710For @samp{arccosh(z)}: This is defined by
18711@samp{ln(z + (z+1)*sqrt((z-1)/(z+1)))}. The branch cut is on the
18712real axis less than 1.
18713
18714For @samp{arctanh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{(ln(1+z) - ln(1-z)) / 2}.
18715The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18716
18717The following tables for @code{arcsin}, @code{arccos}, and
18718@code{arctan} assume the current angular mode is Radians. The
18719hyperbolic functions operate independently of the angular mode.
18720
18721@smallexample
18722 z arcsin(z) arccos(z)
18723-------------------------------------------------------
18724 (-1..1), 0 (-pi/2..pi/2), 0 (0..pi), 0
18725 (-1..1), +eps (-pi/2..pi/2), +eps (0..pi), -eps
18726 (-1..1), -eps (-pi/2..pi/2), -eps (0..pi), +eps
18727 <-1, 0 -pi/2, + pi, -
18728 <-1, +eps -pi/2 + eps, + pi - eps, -
18729 <-1, -eps -pi/2 + eps, - pi - eps, +
18730 >1, 0 pi/2, - 0, +
18731 >1, +eps pi/2 - eps, + +eps, -
18732 >1, -eps pi/2 - eps, - +eps, +
18733@end smallexample
18734
18735@smallexample
18736 z arccosh(z) arctanh(z)
18737-----------------------------------------------------
18738 (-1..1), 0 0, (0..pi) any, 0
18739 (-1..1), +eps +eps, (0..pi) any, +eps
18740 (-1..1), -eps +eps, (-pi..0) any, -eps
18741 <-1, 0 +, pi -, pi/2
18742 <-1, +eps +, pi - eps -, pi/2 - eps
18743 <-1, -eps +, -pi + eps -, -pi/2 + eps
18744 >1, 0 +, 0 +, -pi/2
18745 >1, +eps +, +eps +, pi/2 - eps
18746 >1, -eps +, -eps +, -pi/2 + eps
18747@end smallexample
18748
18749@smallexample
18750 z arcsinh(z) arctan(z)
18751-----------------------------------------------------
18752 0, (-1..1) 0, (-pi/2..pi/2) 0, any
18753 0, <-1 -, -pi/2 -pi/2, -
18754 +eps, <-1 +, -pi/2 + eps pi/2 - eps, -
18755 -eps, <-1 -, -pi/2 + eps -pi/2 + eps, -
18756 0, >1 +, pi/2 pi/2, +
18757 +eps, >1 +, pi/2 - eps pi/2 - eps, +
18758 -eps, >1 -, pi/2 - eps -pi/2 + eps, +
18759@end smallexample
18760
18761Finally, the following identities help to illustrate the relationship
18762between the complex trigonometric and hyperbolic functions. They
18763are valid everywhere, including on the branch cuts.
18764
18765@smallexample
18766sin(i*z) = i*sinh(z) arcsin(i*z) = i*arcsinh(z)
18767cos(i*z) = cosh(z) arcsinh(i*z) = i*arcsin(z)
18768tan(i*z) = i*tanh(z) arctan(i*z) = i*arctanh(z)
18769sinh(i*z) = i*sin(z) cosh(i*z) = cos(z)
18770@end smallexample
18771
18772The ``advanced math'' functions (gamma, Bessel, etc.@:) are also defined
18773for general complex arguments, but their branch cuts and principal values
18774are not rigorously specified at present.
18775
18776@node Random Numbers, Combinatorial Functions, Branch Cuts, Scientific Functions
18777@section Random Numbers
18778
18779@noindent
18780@kindex k r
18781@pindex calc-random
18782@tindex random
18783The @kbd{k r} (@code{calc-random}) [@code{random}] command produces
18784random numbers of various sorts.
18785
18786Given a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{M}, it produces a random
18787integer @expr{N} in the range
18788@texline @math{0 \le N < M}.
18789@infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}.
f10d0e80 18790Each possible value @expr{N} appears with equal probability.
4009494e
GM
18791
18792With no numeric prefix argument, the @kbd{k r} command takes its argument
18793from the stack instead. Once again, if this is a positive integer @expr{M}
18794the result is a random integer less than @expr{M}. However, note that
18795while numeric prefix arguments are limited to six digits or so, an @expr{M}
18796taken from the stack can be arbitrarily large. If @expr{M} is negative,
18797the result is a random integer in the range
18798@texline @math{M < N \le 0}.
18799@infoline @expr{M < N <= 0}.
18800
18801If the value on the stack is a floating-point number @expr{M}, the result
18802is a random floating-point number @expr{N} in the range
18803@texline @math{0 \le N < M}
18804@infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}
18805or
18806@texline @math{M < N \le 0},
18807@infoline @expr{M < N <= 0},
18808according to the sign of @expr{M}.
18809
18810If @expr{M} is zero, the result is a Gaussian-distributed random real
18811number; the distribution has a mean of zero and a standard deviation
18812of one. The algorithm used generates random numbers in pairs; thus,
18813every other call to this function will be especially fast.
18814
18815If @expr{M} is an error form
18816@texline @math{m} @code{+/-} @math{\sigma}
18817@infoline @samp{m +/- s}
18818where @var{m} and
18819@texline @math{\sigma}
18820@infoline @var{s}
18821are both real numbers, the result uses a Gaussian distribution with mean
18822@var{m} and standard deviation
18823@texline @math{\sigma}.
18824@infoline @var{s}.
18825
18826If @expr{M} is an interval form, the lower and upper bounds specify the
18827acceptable limits of the random numbers. If both bounds are integers,
18828the result is a random integer in the specified range. If either bound
18829is floating-point, the result is a random real number in the specified
18830range. If the interval is open at either end, the result will be sure
18831not to equal that end value. (This makes a big difference for integer
18832intervals, but for floating-point intervals it's relatively minor:
18833with a precision of 6, @samp{random([1.0..2.0))} will return any of one
18834million numbers from 1.00000 to 1.99999; @samp{random([1.0..2.0])} may
18835additionally return 2.00000, but the probability of this happening is
18836extremely small.)
18837
18838If @expr{M} is a vector, the result is one element taken at random from
18839the vector. All elements of the vector are given equal probabilities.
18840
18841@vindex RandSeed
18842The sequence of numbers produced by @kbd{k r} is completely random by
18843default, i.e., the sequence is seeded each time you start Calc using
18844the current time and other information. You can get a reproducible
18845sequence by storing a particular ``seed value'' in the Calc variable
18846@code{RandSeed}. Any integer will do for a seed; integers of from 1
18847to 12 digits are good. If you later store a different integer into
18848@code{RandSeed}, Calc will switch to a different pseudo-random
18849sequence. If you ``unstore'' @code{RandSeed}, Calc will re-seed itself
18850from the current time. If you store the same integer that you used
18851before back into @code{RandSeed}, you will get the exact same sequence
18852of random numbers as before.
18853
18854@pindex calc-rrandom
18855The @code{calc-rrandom} command (not on any key) produces a random real
18856number between zero and one. It is equivalent to @samp{random(1.0)}.
18857
18858@kindex k a
18859@pindex calc-random-again
18860The @kbd{k a} (@code{calc-random-again}) command produces another random
18861number, re-using the most recent value of @expr{M}. With a numeric
18862prefix argument @var{n}, it produces @var{n} more random numbers using
18863that value of @expr{M}.
18864
18865@kindex k h
18866@pindex calc-shuffle
18867@tindex shuffle
18868The @kbd{k h} (@code{calc-shuffle}) command produces a vector of several
18869random values with no duplicates. The value on the top of the stack
18870specifies the set from which the random values are drawn, and may be any
18871of the @expr{M} formats described above. The numeric prefix argument
18872gives the length of the desired list. (If you do not provide a numeric
18873prefix argument, the length of the list is taken from the top of the
18874stack, and @expr{M} from second-to-top.)
18875
18876If @expr{M} is a floating-point number, zero, or an error form (so
18877that the random values are being drawn from the set of real numbers)
18878there is little practical difference between using @kbd{k h} and using
18879@kbd{k r} several times. But if the set of possible values consists
18880of just a few integers, or the elements of a vector, then there is
18881a very real chance that multiple @kbd{k r}'s will produce the same
18882number more than once. The @kbd{k h} command produces a vector whose
18883elements are always distinct. (Actually, there is a slight exception:
18884If @expr{M} is a vector, no given vector element will be drawn more
18885than once, but if several elements of @expr{M} are equal, they may
18886each make it into the result vector.)
18887
18888One use of @kbd{k h} is to rearrange a list at random. This happens
18889if the prefix argument is equal to the number of values in the list:
18890@kbd{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3] 5 k h} might produce the permuted list
18891@samp{[2.5, 1, 1.5, 3, 2]}. As a convenient feature, if the argument
18892@var{n} is negative it is replaced by the size of the set represented
18893by @expr{M}. Naturally, this is allowed only when @expr{M} specifies
18894a small discrete set of possibilities.
18895
18896To do the equivalent of @kbd{k h} but with duplications allowed,
18897given @expr{M} on the stack and with @var{n} just entered as a numeric
18898prefix, use @kbd{v b} to build a vector of copies of @expr{M}, then use
18899@kbd{V M k r} to ``map'' the normal @kbd{k r} function over the
18900elements of this vector. @xref{Matrix Functions}.
18901
18902@menu
18903* Random Number Generator:: (Complete description of Calc's algorithm)
18904@end menu
18905
18906@node Random Number Generator, , Random Numbers, Random Numbers
18907@subsection Random Number Generator
18908
18909Calc's random number generator uses several methods to ensure that
18910the numbers it produces are highly random. Knuth's @emph{Art of
18911Computer Programming}, Volume II, contains a thorough description
18912of the theory of random number generators and their measurement and
18913characterization.
18914
18915If @code{RandSeed} has no stored value, Calc calls Emacs' built-in
18916@code{random} function to get a stream of random numbers, which it
18917then treats in various ways to avoid problems inherent in the simple
18918random number generators that many systems use to implement @code{random}.
18919
18920When Calc's random number generator is first invoked, it ``seeds''
18921the low-level random sequence using the time of day, so that the
18922random number sequence will be different every time you use Calc.
18923
18924Since Emacs Lisp doesn't specify the range of values that will be
18925returned by its @code{random} function, Calc exercises the function
18926several times to estimate the range. When Calc subsequently uses
18927the @code{random} function, it takes only 10 bits of the result
18928near the most-significant end. (It avoids at least the bottom
18929four bits, preferably more, and also tries to avoid the top two
18930bits.) This strategy works well with the linear congruential
18931generators that are typically used to implement @code{random}.
18932
18933If @code{RandSeed} contains an integer, Calc uses this integer to
18934seed an ``additive congruential'' method (Knuth's algorithm 3.2.2A,
18935computing
18936@texline @math{X_{n-55} - X_{n-24}}.
18937@infoline @expr{X_n-55 - X_n-24}).
18938This method expands the seed
18939value into a large table which is maintained internally; the variable
18940@code{RandSeed} is changed from, e.g., 42 to the vector @expr{[42]}
18941to indicate that the seed has been absorbed into this table. When
18942@code{RandSeed} contains a vector, @kbd{k r} and related commands
18943continue to use the same internal table as last time. There is no
18944way to extract the complete state of the random number generator
18945so that you can restart it from any point; you can only restart it
18946from the same initial seed value. A simple way to restart from the
18947same seed is to type @kbd{s r RandSeed} to get the seed vector,
18948@kbd{v u} to unpack it back into a number, then @kbd{s t RandSeed}
18949to reseed the generator with that number.
18950
18951Calc uses a ``shuffling'' method as described in algorithm 3.2.2B
18952of Knuth. It fills a table with 13 random 10-bit numbers. Then,
18953to generate a new random number, it uses the previous number to
18954index into the table, picks the value it finds there as the new
18955random number, then replaces that table entry with a new value
18956obtained from a call to the base random number generator (either
18957the additive congruential generator or the @code{random} function
18958supplied by the system). If there are any flaws in the base
18959generator, shuffling will tend to even them out. But if the system
18960provides an excellent @code{random} function, shuffling will not
18961damage its randomness.
18962
18963To create a random integer of a certain number of digits, Calc
18964builds the integer three decimal digits at a time. For each group
18965of three digits, Calc calls its 10-bit shuffling random number generator
18966(which returns a value from 0 to 1023); if the random value is 1000
18967or more, Calc throws it out and tries again until it gets a suitable
18968value.
18969
18970To create a random floating-point number with precision @var{p}, Calc
18971simply creates a random @var{p}-digit integer and multiplies by
18972@texline @math{10^{-p}}.
18973@infoline @expr{10^-p}.
18974The resulting random numbers should be very clean, but note
18975that relatively small numbers will have few significant random digits.
18976In other words, with a precision of 12, you will occasionally get
18977numbers on the order of
18978@texline @math{10^{-9}}
18979@infoline @expr{10^-9}
18980or
18981@texline @math{10^{-10}},
18982@infoline @expr{10^-10},
18983but those numbers will only have two or three random digits since they
18984correspond to small integers times
18985@texline @math{10^{-12}}.
18986@infoline @expr{10^-12}.
18987
18988To create a random integer in the interval @samp{[0 .. @var{m})}, Calc
18989counts the digits in @var{m}, creates a random integer with three
18990additional digits, then reduces modulo @var{m}. Unless @var{m} is a
18991power of ten the resulting values will be very slightly biased toward
18992the lower numbers, but this bias will be less than 0.1%. (For example,
18993if @var{m} is 42, Calc will reduce a random integer less than 100000
18994modulo 42 to get a result less than 42. It is easy to show that the
18995numbers 40 and 41 will be only 2380/2381 as likely to result from this
18996modulo operation as numbers 39 and below.) If @var{m} is a power of
18997ten, however, the numbers should be completely unbiased.
18998
18999The Gaussian random numbers generated by @samp{random(0.0)} use the
19000``polar'' method described in Knuth section 3.4.1C. This method
19001generates a pair of Gaussian random numbers at a time, so only every
19002other call to @samp{random(0.0)} will require significant calculations.
19003
19004@node Combinatorial Functions, Probability Distribution Functions, Random Numbers, Scientific Functions
19005@section Combinatorial Functions
19006
19007@noindent
19008Commands relating to combinatorics and number theory begin with the
19009@kbd{k} key prefix.
19010
19011@kindex k g
19012@pindex calc-gcd
19013@tindex gcd
19014The @kbd{k g} (@code{calc-gcd}) [@code{gcd}] command computes the
19015Greatest Common Divisor of two integers. It also accepts fractions;
19016the GCD of two fractions is defined by taking the GCD of the
19017numerators, and the LCM of the denominators. This definition is
19018consistent with the idea that @samp{a / gcd(a,x)} should yield an
19019integer for any @samp{a} and @samp{x}. For other types of arguments,
19020the operation is left in symbolic form.
19021
19022@kindex k l
19023@pindex calc-lcm
19024@tindex lcm
19025The @kbd{k l} (@code{calc-lcm}) [@code{lcm}] command computes the
19026Least Common Multiple of two integers or fractions. The product of
19027the LCM and GCD of two numbers is equal to the product of the
19028numbers.
19029
19030@kindex k E
19031@pindex calc-extended-gcd
19032@tindex egcd
19033The @kbd{k E} (@code{calc-extended-gcd}) [@code{egcd}] command computes
19034the GCD of two integers @expr{x} and @expr{y} and returns a vector
19035@expr{[g, a, b]} where
19036@texline @math{g = \gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
19037@infoline @expr{g = gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
19038
19039@kindex !
19040@pindex calc-factorial
19041@tindex fact
19042@ignore
19043@mindex @null
19044@end ignore
19045@tindex !
19046The @kbd{!} (@code{calc-factorial}) [@code{fact}] command computes the
19047factorial of the number at the top of the stack. If the number is an
19048integer, the result is an exact integer. If the number is an
19049integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point approximation. If
19050the number is a non-integral real number, the generalized factorial is used,
19051as defined by the Euler Gamma function. Please note that computation of
19052large factorials can be slow; using floating-point format will help
19053since fewer digits must be maintained. The same is true of many of
19054the commands in this section.
19055
19056@kindex k d
19057@pindex calc-double-factorial
19058@tindex dfact
19059@ignore
19060@mindex @null
19061@end ignore
19062@tindex !!
19063The @kbd{k d} (@code{calc-double-factorial}) [@code{dfact}] command
19064computes the ``double factorial'' of an integer. For an even integer,
19065this is the product of even integers from 2 to @expr{N}. For an odd
19066integer, this is the product of odd integers from 3 to @expr{N}. If
19067the argument is an integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point
19068approximation. This function is undefined for negative even integers.
19069The notation @expr{N!!} is also recognized for double factorials.
19070
19071@kindex k c
19072@pindex calc-choose
19073@tindex choose
19074The @kbd{k c} (@code{calc-choose}) [@code{choose}] command computes the
19075binomial coefficient @expr{N}-choose-@expr{M}, where @expr{M} is the number
19076on the top of the stack and @expr{N} is second-to-top. If both arguments
19077are integers, the result is an exact integer. Otherwise, the result is a
19078floating-point approximation. The binomial coefficient is defined for all
19079real numbers by
19080@texline @math{N! \over M! (N-M)!\,}.
19081@infoline @expr{N! / M! (N-M)!}.
19082
19083@kindex H k c
19084@pindex calc-perm
19085@tindex perm
19086@ifnottex
19087The @kbd{H k c} (@code{calc-perm}) [@code{perm}] command computes the
19088number-of-permutations function @expr{N! / (N-M)!}.
19089@end ifnottex
19090@tex
19091The \kbd{H k c} (\code{calc-perm}) [\code{perm}] command computes the
19092number-of-perm\-utations function $N! \over (N-M)!\,$.
19093@end tex
19094
19095@kindex k b
19096@kindex H k b
19097@pindex calc-bernoulli-number
19098@tindex bern
19099The @kbd{k b} (@code{calc-bernoulli-number}) [@code{bern}] command
19100computes a given Bernoulli number. The value at the top of the stack
19101is a nonnegative integer @expr{n} that specifies which Bernoulli number
19102is desired. The @kbd{H k b} command computes a Bernoulli polynomial,
19103taking @expr{n} from the second-to-top position and @expr{x} from the
19104top of the stack. If @expr{x} is a variable or formula the result is
19105a polynomial in @expr{x}; if @expr{x} is a number the result is a number.
19106
19107@kindex k e
19108@kindex H k e
19109@pindex calc-euler-number
19110@tindex euler
19111The @kbd{k e} (@code{calc-euler-number}) [@code{euler}] command similarly
19112computes an Euler number, and @w{@kbd{H k e}} computes an Euler polynomial.
19113Bernoulli and Euler numbers occur in the Taylor expansions of several
19114functions.
19115
19116@kindex k s
19117@kindex H k s
19118@pindex calc-stirling-number
19119@tindex stir1
19120@tindex stir2
19121The @kbd{k s} (@code{calc-stirling-number}) [@code{stir1}] command
19122computes a Stirling number of the first
19123@texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brack m},
19124@infoline kind,
19125given two integers @expr{n} and @expr{m} on the stack. The @kbd{H k s}
19126[@code{stir2}] command computes a Stirling number of the second
19127@texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brace m}.
19128@infoline kind.
19129These are the number of @expr{m}-cycle permutations of @expr{n} objects,
19130and the number of ways to partition @expr{n} objects into @expr{m}
19131non-empty sets, respectively.
19132
19133@kindex k p
19134@pindex calc-prime-test
19135@cindex Primes
19136The @kbd{k p} (@code{calc-prime-test}) command checks if the integer on
19137the top of the stack is prime. For integers less than eight million, the
19138answer is always exact and reasonably fast. For larger integers, a
19139probabilistic method is used (see Knuth vol. II, section 4.5.4, algorithm P).
19140The number is first checked against small prime factors (up to 13). Then,
19141any number of iterations of the algorithm are performed. Each step either
19142discovers that the number is non-prime, or substantially increases the
19143certainty that the number is prime. After a few steps, the chance that
19144a number was mistakenly described as prime will be less than one percent.
19145(Indeed, this is a worst-case estimate of the probability; in practice
19146even a single iteration is quite reliable.) After the @kbd{k p} command,
19147the number will be reported as definitely prime or non-prime if possible,
19148or otherwise ``probably'' prime with a certain probability of error.
19149
19150@ignore
19151@starindex
19152@end ignore
19153@tindex prime
19154The normal @kbd{k p} command performs one iteration of the primality
19155test. Pressing @kbd{k p} repeatedly for the same integer will perform
19156additional iterations. Also, @kbd{k p} with a numeric prefix performs
19157the specified number of iterations. There is also an algebraic function
19158@samp{prime(n)} or @samp{prime(n,iters)} which returns 1 if @expr{n}
19159is (probably) prime and 0 if not.
19160
19161@kindex k f
19162@pindex calc-prime-factors
19163@tindex prfac
19164The @kbd{k f} (@code{calc-prime-factors}) [@code{prfac}] command
19165attempts to decompose an integer into its prime factors. For numbers up
19166to 25 million, the answer is exact although it may take some time. The
19167result is a vector of the prime factors in increasing order. For larger
19168inputs, prime factors above 5000 may not be found, in which case the
19169last number in the vector will be an unfactored integer greater than 25
19170million (with a warning message). For negative integers, the first
19171element of the list will be @mathit{-1}. For inputs @mathit{-1}, @mathit{0}, and
19172@mathit{1}, the result is a list of the same number.
19173
19174@kindex k n
19175@pindex calc-next-prime
19176@ignore
19177@mindex nextpr@idots
19178@end ignore
19179@tindex nextprime
19180The @kbd{k n} (@code{calc-next-prime}) [@code{nextprime}] command finds
19181the next prime above a given number. Essentially, it searches by calling
19182@code{calc-prime-test} on successive integers until it finds one that
19183passes the test. This is quite fast for integers less than eight million,
19184but once the probabilistic test comes into play the search may be rather
19185slow. Ordinarily this command stops for any prime that passes one iteration
19186of the primality test. With a numeric prefix argument, a number must pass
19187the specified number of iterations before the search stops. (This only
19188matters when searching above eight million.) You can always use additional
19189@kbd{k p} commands to increase your certainty that the number is indeed
19190prime.
19191
19192@kindex I k n
19193@pindex calc-prev-prime
19194@ignore
19195@mindex prevpr@idots
19196@end ignore
19197@tindex prevprime
19198The @kbd{I k n} (@code{calc-prev-prime}) [@code{prevprime}] command
19199analogously finds the next prime less than a given number.
19200
19201@kindex k t
19202@pindex calc-totient
19203@tindex totient
19204The @kbd{k t} (@code{calc-totient}) [@code{totient}] command computes the
19205Euler ``totient''
19206@texline function@tie{}@math{\phi(n)},
19207@infoline function,
19208the number of integers less than @expr{n} which
19209are relatively prime to @expr{n}.
19210
19211@kindex k m
19212@pindex calc-moebius
19213@tindex moebius
19214The @kbd{k m} (@code{calc-moebius}) [@code{moebius}] command computes the
19215@texline M@"obius @math{\mu}
19216@infoline Moebius ``mu''
19217function. If the input number is a product of @expr{k}
19218distinct factors, this is @expr{(-1)^k}. If the input number has any
19219duplicate factors (i.e., can be divided by the same prime more than once),
19220the result is zero.
19221
19222@node Probability Distribution Functions, , Combinatorial Functions, Scientific Functions
19223@section Probability Distribution Functions
19224
19225@noindent
19226The functions in this section compute various probability distributions.
19227For continuous distributions, this is the integral of the probability
19228density function from @expr{x} to infinity. (These are the ``upper
19229tail'' distribution functions; there are also corresponding ``lower
19230tail'' functions which integrate from minus infinity to @expr{x}.)
19231For discrete distributions, the upper tail function gives the sum
19232from @expr{x} to infinity; the lower tail function gives the sum
19233from minus infinity up to, but not including,@w{ }@expr{x}.
19234
19235To integrate from @expr{x} to @expr{y}, just use the distribution
19236function twice and subtract. For example, the probability that a
19237Gaussian random variable with mean 2 and standard deviation 1 will
19238lie in the range from 2.5 to 2.8 is @samp{utpn(2.5,2,1) - utpn(2.8,2,1)}
19239(``the probability that it is greater than 2.5, but not greater than 2.8''),
19240or equivalently @samp{ltpn(2.8,2,1) - ltpn(2.5,2,1)}.
19241
19242@kindex k B
19243@kindex I k B
19244@pindex calc-utpb
19245@tindex utpb
19246@tindex ltpb
19247The @kbd{k B} (@code{calc-utpb}) [@code{utpb}] function uses the
19248binomial distribution. Push the parameters @var{n}, @var{p}, and
19249then @var{x} onto the stack; the result (@samp{utpb(x,n,p)}) is the
19250probability that an event will occur @var{x} or more times out
19251of @var{n} trials, if its probability of occurring in any given
19252trial is @var{p}. The @kbd{I k B} [@code{ltpb}] function is
19253the probability that the event will occur fewer than @var{x} times.
19254
19255The other probability distribution functions similarly take the
19256form @kbd{k @var{X}} (@code{calc-utp@var{x}}) [@code{utp@var{x}}]
19257and @kbd{I k @var{X}} [@code{ltp@var{x}}], for various letters
19258@var{x}. The arguments to the algebraic functions are the value of
19259the random variable first, then whatever other parameters define the
19260distribution. Note these are among the few Calc functions where the
19261order of the arguments in algebraic form differs from the order of
19262arguments as found on the stack. (The random variable comes last on
19263the stack, so that you can type, e.g., @kbd{2 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 2.5
19264k N M-@key{RET} @key{DEL} 2.8 k N -}, using @kbd{M-@key{RET} @key{DEL}} to
19265recover the original arguments but substitute a new value for @expr{x}.)
19266
19267@kindex k C
19268@pindex calc-utpc
19269@tindex utpc
19270@ignore
19271@mindex @idots
19272@end ignore
19273@kindex I k C
19274@ignore
19275@mindex @null
19276@end ignore
19277@tindex ltpc
19278The @samp{utpc(x,v)} function uses the chi-square distribution with
19279@texline @math{\nu}
19280@infoline @expr{v}
19281degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a model is
19282correct if its chi-square statistic is @expr{x}.
19283
19284@kindex k F
19285@pindex calc-utpf
19286@tindex utpf
19287@ignore
19288@mindex @idots
19289@end ignore
19290@kindex I k F
19291@ignore
19292@mindex @null
19293@end ignore
19294@tindex ltpf
19295The @samp{utpf(F,v1,v2)} function uses the F distribution, used in
19296various statistical tests. The parameters
19297@texline @math{\nu_1}
19298@infoline @expr{v1}
19299and
19300@texline @math{\nu_2}
19301@infoline @expr{v2}
19302are the degrees of freedom in the numerator and denominator,
19303respectively, used in computing the statistic @expr{F}.
19304
19305@kindex k N
19306@pindex calc-utpn
19307@tindex utpn
19308@ignore
19309@mindex @idots
19310@end ignore
19311@kindex I k N
19312@ignore
19313@mindex @null
19314@end ignore
19315@tindex ltpn
19316The @samp{utpn(x,m,s)} function uses a normal (Gaussian) distribution
19317with mean @expr{m} and standard deviation
19318@texline @math{\sigma}.
19319@infoline @expr{s}.
19320It is the probability that such a normal-distributed random variable
19321would exceed @expr{x}.
19322
19323@kindex k P
19324@pindex calc-utpp
19325@tindex utpp
19326@ignore
19327@mindex @idots
19328@end ignore
19329@kindex I k P
19330@ignore
19331@mindex @null
19332@end ignore
19333@tindex ltpp
19334The @samp{utpp(n,x)} function uses a Poisson distribution with
19335mean @expr{x}. It is the probability that @expr{n} or more such
19336Poisson random events will occur.
19337
19338@kindex k T
19339@pindex calc-ltpt
19340@tindex utpt
19341@ignore
19342@mindex @idots
19343@end ignore
19344@kindex I k T
19345@ignore
19346@mindex @null
19347@end ignore
19348@tindex ltpt
19349The @samp{utpt(t,v)} function uses the Student's ``t'' distribution
19350with
19351@texline @math{\nu}
19352@infoline @expr{v}
19353degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a
19354t-distributed random variable will be greater than @expr{t}.
19355(Note: This computes the distribution function
19356@texline @math{A(t|\nu)}
19357@infoline @expr{A(t|v)}
19358where
19359@texline @math{A(0|\nu) = 1}
19360@infoline @expr{A(0|v) = 1}
19361and
19362@texline @math{A(\infty|\nu) \to 0}.
19363@infoline @expr{A(inf|v) -> 0}.
19364The @code{UTPT} operation on the HP-48 uses a different definition which
19365returns half of Calc's value: @samp{UTPT(t,v) = .5*utpt(t,v)}.)
19366
19367While Calc does not provide inverses of the probability distribution
19368functions, the @kbd{a R} command can be used to solve for the inverse.
19369Since the distribution functions are monotonic, @kbd{a R} is guaranteed
19370to be able to find a solution given any initial guess.
19371@xref{Numerical Solutions}.
19372
19373@node Matrix Functions, Algebra, Scientific Functions, Top
19374@chapter Vector/Matrix Functions
19375
19376@noindent
19377Many of the commands described here begin with the @kbd{v} prefix.
19378(For convenience, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix is equivalent to @kbd{v}.)
19379The commands usually apply to both plain vectors and matrices; some
19380apply only to matrices or only to square matrices. If the argument
19381has the wrong dimensions the operation is left in symbolic form.
19382
19383Vectors are entered and displayed using @samp{[a,b,c]} notation.
19384Matrices are vectors of which all elements are vectors of equal length.
19385(Though none of the standard Calc commands use this concept, a
19386three-dimensional matrix or rank-3 tensor could be defined as a
19387vector of matrices, and so on.)
19388
19389@menu
19390* Packing and Unpacking::
19391* Building Vectors::
19392* Extracting Elements::
19393* Manipulating Vectors::
19394* Vector and Matrix Arithmetic::
19395* Set Operations::
19396* Statistical Operations::
19397* Reducing and Mapping::
19398* Vector and Matrix Formats::
19399@end menu
19400
19401@node Packing and Unpacking, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions, Matrix Functions
19402@section Packing and Unpacking
19403
19404@noindent
19405Calc's ``pack'' and ``unpack'' commands collect stack entries to build
19406composite objects such as vectors and complex numbers. They are
19407described in this chapter because they are most often used to build
19408vectors.
19409
19410@kindex v p
65d0154b 19411@kindex V p
4009494e
GM
19412@pindex calc-pack
19413The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) [@code{pack}] command collects several
19414elements from the stack into a matrix, complex number, HMS form, error
19415form, etc. It uses a numeric prefix argument to specify the kind of
19416object to be built; this argument is referred to as the ``packing mode.''
19417If the packing mode is a nonnegative integer, a vector of that
19418length is created. For example, @kbd{C-u 5 v p} will pop the top
19419five stack elements and push back a single vector of those five
19420elements. (@kbd{C-u 0 v p} simply creates an empty vector.)
19421
19422The same effect can be had by pressing @kbd{[} to push an incomplete
19423vector on the stack, using @key{TAB} (@code{calc-roll-down}) to sneak
19424the incomplete object up past a certain number of elements, and
19425then pressing @kbd{]} to complete the vector.
19426
19427Negative packing modes create other kinds of composite objects:
19428
19429@table @cite
19430@item -1
19431Two values are collected to build a complex number. For example,
19432@kbd{5 @key{RET} 7 C-u -1 v p} creates the complex number
19433@expr{(5, 7)}. The result is always a rectangular complex
19434number. The two input values must both be real numbers,
19435i.e., integers, fractions, or floats. If they are not, Calc
19436will instead build a formula like @samp{a + (0, 1) b}. (The
19437other packing modes also create a symbolic answer if the
19438components are not suitable.)
19439
19440@item -2
19441Two values are collected to build a polar complex number.
19442The first is the magnitude; the second is the phase expressed
19443in either degrees or radians according to the current angular
19444mode.
19445
19446@item -3
19447Three values are collected into an HMS form. The first
19448two values (hours and minutes) must be integers or
19449integer-valued floats. The third value may be any real
19450number.
19451
19452@item -4
19453Two values are collected into an error form. The inputs
19454may be real numbers or formulas.
19455
19456@item -5
19457Two values are collected into a modulo form. The inputs
19458must be real numbers.
19459
19460@item -6
19461Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b]}.
19462The inputs may be real numbers, HMS or date forms, or formulas.
19463
19464@item -7
19465Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b)}.
19466
19467@item -8
19468Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b]}.
19469
19470@item -9
19471Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b)}.
19472
19473@item -10
19474Two integer values are collected into a fraction.
19475
19476@item -11
19477Two values are collected into a floating-point number.
19478The first is the mantissa; the second, which must be an
19479integer, is the exponent. The result is the mantissa
19480times ten to the power of the exponent.
19481
19482@item -12
19483This is treated the same as @mathit{-11} by the @kbd{v p} command.
19484When unpacking, @mathit{-12} specifies that a floating-point mantissa
19485is desired.
19486
19487@item -13
19488A real number is converted into a date form.
19489
19490@item -14
19491Three numbers (year, month, day) are packed into a pure date form.
19492
19493@item -15
19494Six numbers are packed into a date/time form.
19495@end table
19496
19497With any of the two-input negative packing modes, either or both
19498of the inputs may be vectors. If both are vectors of the same
19499length, the result is another vector made by packing corresponding
19500elements of the input vectors. If one input is a vector and the
19501other is a plain number, the number is packed along with each vector
19502element to produce a new vector. For example, @kbd{C-u -4 v p}
19503could be used to convert a vector of numbers and a vector of errors
19504into a single vector of error forms; @kbd{C-u -5 v p} could convert
19505a vector of numbers and a single number @var{M} into a vector of
19506numbers modulo @var{M}.
19507
19508If you don't give a prefix argument to @kbd{v p}, it takes
19509the packing mode from the top of the stack. The elements to
19510be packed then begin at stack level 2. Thus
19511@kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 4 n v p} is another way to
19512enter the error form @samp{1 +/- 2}.
19513
19514If the packing mode taken from the stack is a vector, the result is a
19515matrix with the dimensions specified by the elements of the vector,
19516which must each be integers. For example, if the packing mode is
19517@samp{[2, 3]}, then six numbers will be taken from the stack and
19518returned in the form @samp{[@w{[a, b, c]}, [d, e, f]]}.
19519
19520If any elements of the vector are negative, other kinds of
19521packing are done at that level as described above. For
19522example, @samp{[2, 3, -4]} takes 12 objects and creates a
19523@texline @math{2\times3}
19524@infoline 2x3
19525matrix of error forms: @samp{[[a +/- b, c +/- d ... ]]}.
19526Also, @samp{[-4, -10]} will convert four integers into an
19527error form consisting of two fractions: @samp{a:b +/- c:d}.
19528
19529@ignore
19530@starindex
19531@end ignore
19532@tindex pack
19533There is an equivalent algebraic function,
19534@samp{pack(@var{mode}, @var{items})} where @var{mode} is a
19535packing mode (an integer or a vector of integers) and @var{items}
19536is a vector of objects to be packed (re-packed, really) according
19537to that mode. For example, @samp{pack([3, -4], [a,b,c,d,e,f])}
19538yields @samp{[a +/- b, @w{c +/- d}, e +/- f]}. The function is
19539left in symbolic form if the packing mode is invalid, or if the
19540number of data items does not match the number of items required
19541by the mode.
19542
19543@kindex v u
65d0154b 19544@kindex V u
4009494e
GM
19545@pindex calc-unpack
19546The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the vector, complex
19547number, HMS form, or other composite object on the top of the stack and
19548``unpacks'' it, pushing each of its elements onto the stack as separate
19549objects. Thus, it is the ``inverse'' of @kbd{v p}. If the value
19550at the top of the stack is a formula, @kbd{v u} unpacks it by pushing
19551each of the arguments of the top-level operator onto the stack.
19552
19553You can optionally give a numeric prefix argument to @kbd{v u}
19554to specify an explicit (un)packing mode. If the packing mode is
19555negative and the input is actually a vector or matrix, the result
19556will be two or more similar vectors or matrices of the elements.
19557For example, given the vector @samp{[@w{a +/- b}, c^2, d +/- 7]},
19558the result of @kbd{C-u -4 v u} will be the two vectors
19559@samp{[a, c^2, d]} and @w{@samp{[b, 0, 7]}}.
19560
19561Note that the prefix argument can have an effect even when the input is
19562not a vector. For example, if the input is the number @mathit{-5}, then
19563@kbd{c-u -1 v u} yields @mathit{-5} and 0 (the components of @mathit{-5}
19564when viewed as a rectangular complex number); @kbd{C-u -2 v u} yields 5
19565and 180 (assuming Degrees mode); and @kbd{C-u -10 v u} yields @mathit{-5}
19566and 1 (the numerator and denominator of @mathit{-5}, viewed as a rational
19567number). Plain @kbd{v u} with this input would complain that the input
19568is not a composite object.
19569
19570Unpacking mode @mathit{-11} converts a float into an integer mantissa and
19571an integer exponent, where the mantissa is not divisible by 10
19572(except that 0.0 is represented by a mantissa and exponent of 0).
19573Unpacking mode @mathit{-12} converts a float into a floating-point mantissa
19574and integer exponent, where the mantissa (for non-zero numbers)
19575is guaranteed to lie in the range [1 .. 10). In both cases,
19576the mantissa is shifted left or right (and the exponent adjusted
19577to compensate) in order to satisfy these constraints.
19578
19579Positive unpacking modes are treated differently than for @kbd{v p}.
19580A mode of 1 is much like plain @kbd{v u} with no prefix argument,
19581except that in addition to the components of the input object,
19582a suitable packing mode to re-pack the object is also pushed.
19583Thus, @kbd{C-u 1 v u} followed by @kbd{v p} will re-build the
19584original object.
19585
19586A mode of 2 unpacks two levels of the object; the resulting
19587re-packing mode will be a vector of length 2. This might be used
19588to unpack a matrix, say, or a vector of error forms. Higher
19589unpacking modes unpack the input even more deeply.
19590
19591@ignore
19592@starindex
19593@end ignore
19594@tindex unpack
19595There are two algebraic functions analogous to @kbd{v u}.
19596The @samp{unpack(@var{mode}, @var{item})} function unpacks the
19597@var{item} using the given @var{mode}, returning the result as
19598a vector of components. Here the @var{mode} must be an
19599integer, not a vector. For example, @samp{unpack(-4, a +/- b)}
19600returns @samp{[a, b]}, as does @samp{unpack(1, a +/- b)}.
19601
19602@ignore
19603@starindex
19604@end ignore
19605@tindex unpackt
19606The @code{unpackt} function is like @code{unpack} but instead
19607of returning a simple vector of items, it returns a vector of
19608two things: The mode, and the vector of items. For example,
19609@samp{unpackt(1, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[-4, [2:3, 1:4]]},
19610and @samp{unpackt(2, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[[-4, -10], [2, 3, 1, 4]]}.
19611The identity for re-building the original object is
19612@samp{apply(pack, unpackt(@var{n}, @var{x})) = @var{x}}. (The
19613@code{apply} function builds a function call given the function
19614name and a vector of arguments.)
19615
19616@cindex Numerator of a fraction, extracting
19617Subscript notation is a useful way to extract a particular part
19618of an object. For example, to get the numerator of a rational
19619number, you can use @samp{unpack(-10, @var{x})_1}.
19620
19621@node Building Vectors, Extracting Elements, Packing and Unpacking, Matrix Functions
19622@section Building Vectors
19623
19624@noindent
19625Vectors and matrices can be added,
19626subtracted, multiplied, and divided; @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}.
19627
19628@kindex |
19629@pindex calc-concat
19630@ignore
19631@mindex @null
19632@end ignore
19633@tindex |
19634The @kbd{|} (@code{calc-concat}) [@code{vconcat}] command ``concatenates'' two vectors
19635into one. For example, after @kbd{@w{[ 1 , 2 ]} [ 3 , 4 ] |}, the stack
19636will contain the single vector @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]}. If the arguments
19637are matrices, the rows of the first matrix are concatenated with the
19638rows of the second. (In other words, two matrices are just two vectors
19639of row-vectors as far as @kbd{|} is concerned.)
19640
19641If either argument to @kbd{|} is a scalar (a non-vector), it is treated
19642like a one-element vector for purposes of concatenation: @kbd{1 [ 2 , 3 ] |}
19643produces the vector @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Likewise, if one argument is a
19644matrix and the other is a plain vector, the vector is treated as a
19645one-row matrix.
19646
19647@kindex H |
19648@tindex append
19649The @kbd{H |} (@code{calc-append}) [@code{append}] command concatenates
19650two vectors without any special cases. Both inputs must be vectors.
19651Whether or not they are matrices is not taken into account. If either
19652argument is a scalar, the @code{append} function is left in symbolic form.
19653See also @code{cons} and @code{rcons} below.
19654
19655@kindex I |
19656@kindex H I |
19657The @kbd{I |} and @kbd{H I |} commands are similar, but they use their
19658two stack arguments in the opposite order. Thus @kbd{I |} is equivalent
19659to @kbd{@key{TAB} |}, but possibly more convenient and also a bit faster.
19660
19661@kindex v d
65d0154b 19662@kindex V d
4009494e
GM
19663@pindex calc-diag
19664@tindex diag
19665The @kbd{v d} (@code{calc-diag}) [@code{diag}] function builds a diagonal
19666square matrix. The optional numeric prefix gives the number of rows
19667and columns in the matrix. If the value at the top of the stack is a
19668vector, the elements of the vector are used as the diagonal elements; the
19669prefix, if specified, must match the size of the vector. If the value on
19670the stack is a scalar, it is used for each element on the diagonal, and
19671the prefix argument is required.
19672
19673To build a constant square matrix, e.g., a
19674@texline @math{3\times3}
19675@infoline 3x3
19676matrix filled with ones, use @kbd{0 M-3 v d 1 +}, i.e., build a zero
19677matrix first and then add a constant value to that matrix. (Another
19678alternative would be to use @kbd{v b} and @kbd{v a}; see below.)
19679
19680@kindex v i
65d0154b 19681@kindex V i
4009494e
GM
19682@pindex calc-ident
19683@tindex idn
19684The @kbd{v i} (@code{calc-ident}) [@code{idn}] function builds an identity
19685matrix of the specified size. It is a convenient form of @kbd{v d}
19686where the diagonal element is always one. If no prefix argument is given,
19687this command prompts for one.
19688
19689In algebraic notation, @samp{idn(a,n)} acts much like @samp{diag(a,n)},
19690except that @expr{a} is required to be a scalar (non-vector) quantity.
19691If @expr{n} is omitted, @samp{idn(a)} represents @expr{a} times an
19692identity matrix of unknown size. Calc can operate algebraically on
19693such generic identity matrices, and if one is combined with a matrix
19694whose size is known, it is converted automatically to an identity
19695matrix of a suitable matching size. The @kbd{v i} command with an
19696argument of zero creates a generic identity matrix, @samp{idn(1)}.
19697Note that in dimensioned Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), generic
19698identity matrices are immediately expanded to the current default
19699dimensions.
19700
19701@kindex v x
65d0154b 19702@kindex V x
4009494e
GM
19703@pindex calc-index
19704@tindex index
19705The @kbd{v x} (@code{calc-index}) [@code{index}] function builds a vector
19706of consecutive integers from 1 to @var{n}, where @var{n} is the numeric
19707prefix argument. If you do not provide a prefix argument, you will be
19708prompted to enter a suitable number. If @var{n} is negative, the result
19709is a vector of negative integers from @var{n} to @mathit{-1}.
19710
19711With a prefix argument of just @kbd{C-u}, the @kbd{v x} command takes
19712three values from the stack: @var{n}, @var{start}, and @var{incr} (with
19713@var{incr} at top-of-stack). Counting starts at @var{start} and increases
19714by @var{incr} for successive vector elements. If @var{start} or @var{n}
19715is in floating-point format, the resulting vector elements will also be
19716floats. Note that @var{start} and @var{incr} may in fact be any kind
19717of numbers or formulas.
19718
19719When @var{start} and @var{incr} are specified, a negative @var{n} has a
19720different interpretation: It causes a geometric instead of arithmetic
19721sequence to be generated. For example, @samp{index(-3, a, b)} produces
19722@samp{[a, a b, a b^2]}. If you omit @var{incr} in the algebraic form,
19723@samp{index(@var{n}, @var{start})}, the default value for @var{incr}
19724is one for positive @var{n} or two for negative @var{n}.
19725
19726@kindex v b
65d0154b 19727@kindex V b
4009494e
GM
19728@pindex calc-build-vector
19729@tindex cvec
19730The @kbd{v b} (@code{calc-build-vector}) [@code{cvec}] function builds a
19731vector of @var{n} copies of the value on the top of the stack, where @var{n}
19732is the numeric prefix argument. In algebraic formulas, @samp{cvec(x,n,m)}
19733can also be used to build an @var{n}-by-@var{m} matrix of copies of @var{x}.
19734(Interactively, just use @kbd{v b} twice: once to build a row, then again
19735to build a matrix of copies of that row.)
19736
19737@kindex v h
65d0154b 19738@kindex V h
4009494e 19739@kindex I v h
65d0154b 19740@kindex I V h
4009494e
GM
19741@pindex calc-head
19742@pindex calc-tail
19743@tindex head
19744@tindex tail
19745The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) [@code{head}] function returns the first
19746element of a vector. The @kbd{I v h} (@code{calc-tail}) [@code{tail}]
19747function returns the vector with its first element removed. In both
19748cases, the argument must be a non-empty vector.
19749
19750@kindex v k
65d0154b 19751@kindex V k
4009494e
GM
19752@pindex calc-cons
19753@tindex cons
19754The @kbd{v k} (@code{calc-cons}) [@code{cons}] function takes a value @var{h}
19755and a vector @var{t} from the stack, and produces the vector whose head is
19756@var{h} and whose tail is @var{t}. This is similar to @kbd{|}, except
19757if @var{h} is itself a vector, @kbd{|} will concatenate the two vectors
19758whereas @code{cons} will insert @var{h} at the front of the vector @var{t}.
19759
19760@kindex H v h
65d0154b 19761@kindex H V h
4009494e
GM
19762@tindex rhead
19763@ignore
19764@mindex @idots
19765@end ignore
19766@kindex H I v h
65d0154b 19767@kindex H I V h
4009494e
GM
19768@ignore
19769@mindex @null
19770@end ignore
19771@kindex H v k
65d0154b 19772@kindex H V k
4009494e
GM
19773@ignore
19774@mindex @null
19775@end ignore
19776@tindex rtail
19777@ignore
19778@mindex @null
19779@end ignore
19780@tindex rcons
19781Each of these three functions also accepts the Hyperbolic flag [@code{rhead},
19782@code{rtail}, @code{rcons}] in which case @var{t} instead represents
19783the @emph{last} single element of the vector, with @var{h}
19784representing the remainder of the vector. Thus the vector
19785@samp{[a, b, c, d] = cons(a, [b, c, d]) = rcons([a, b, c], d)}.
19786Also, @samp{head([a, b, c, d]) = a}, @samp{tail([a, b, c, d]) = [b, c, d]},
19787@samp{rhead([a, b, c, d]) = [a, b, c]}, and @samp{rtail([a, b, c, d]) = d}.
19788
19789@node Extracting Elements, Manipulating Vectors, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions
19790@section Extracting Vector Elements
19791
19792@noindent
19793@kindex v r
65d0154b 19794@kindex V r
4009494e
GM
19795@pindex calc-mrow
19796@tindex mrow
19797The @kbd{v r} (@code{calc-mrow}) [@code{mrow}] command extracts one row of
19798the matrix on the top of the stack, or one element of the plain vector on
19799the top of the stack. The row or element is specified by the numeric
19800prefix argument; the default is to prompt for the row or element number.
19801The matrix or vector is replaced by the specified row or element in the
19802form of a vector or scalar, respectively.
19803
19804@cindex Permutations, applying
19805With a prefix argument of @kbd{C-u} only, @kbd{v r} takes the index of
19806the element or row from the top of the stack, and the vector or matrix
19807from the second-to-top position. If the index is itself a vector of
19808integers, the result is a vector of the corresponding elements of the
19809input vector, or a matrix of the corresponding rows of the input matrix.
19810This command can be used to obtain any permutation of a vector.
19811
19812With @kbd{C-u}, if the index is an interval form with integer components,
19813it is interpreted as a range of indices and the corresponding subvector or
19814submatrix is returned.
19815
19816@cindex Subscript notation
19817@kindex a _
19818@pindex calc-subscript
19819@tindex subscr
19820@tindex _
19821Subscript notation in algebraic formulas (@samp{a_b}) stands for the
19822Calc function @code{subscr}, which is synonymous with @code{mrow}.
19823Thus, @samp{[x, y, z]_k} produces @expr{x}, @expr{y}, or @expr{z} if
19824@expr{k} is one, two, or three, respectively. A double subscript
19825(@samp{M_i_j}, equivalent to @samp{subscr(subscr(M, i), j)}) will
19826access the element at row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of a matrix.
19827The @kbd{a _} (@code{calc-subscript}) command creates a subscript
19828formula @samp{a_b} out of two stack entries. (It is on the @kbd{a}
19829``algebra'' prefix because subscripted variables are often used
19830purely as an algebraic notation.)
19831
19832@tindex mrrow
19833Given a negative prefix argument, @kbd{v r} instead deletes one row or
19834element from the matrix or vector on the top of the stack. Thus
19835@kbd{C-u 2 v r} replaces a matrix with its second row, but @kbd{C-u -2 v r}
19836replaces the matrix with the same matrix with its second row removed.
19837In algebraic form this function is called @code{mrrow}.
19838
19839@tindex getdiag
19840Given a prefix argument of zero, @kbd{v r} extracts the diagonal elements
19841of a square matrix in the form of a vector. In algebraic form this
19842function is called @code{getdiag}.
19843
19844@kindex v c
65d0154b 19845@kindex V c
4009494e
GM
19846@pindex calc-mcol
19847@tindex mcol
19848@tindex mrcol
19849The @kbd{v c} (@code{calc-mcol}) [@code{mcol} or @code{mrcol}] command is
19850the analogous operation on columns of a matrix. Given a plain vector
19851it extracts (or removes) one element, just like @kbd{v r}. If the
19852index in @kbd{C-u v c} is an interval or vector and the argument is a
19853matrix, the result is a submatrix with only the specified columns
19854retained (and possibly permuted in the case of a vector index).
19855
19856To extract a matrix element at a given row and column, use @kbd{v r} to
19857extract the row as a vector, then @kbd{v c} to extract the column element
19858from that vector. In algebraic formulas, it is often more convenient to
19859use subscript notation: @samp{m_i_j} gives row @expr{i}, column @expr{j}
19860of matrix @expr{m}.
19861
19862@kindex v s
65d0154b 19863@kindex V s
4009494e
GM
19864@pindex calc-subvector
19865@tindex subvec
19866The @kbd{v s} (@code{calc-subvector}) [@code{subvec}] command extracts
19867a subvector of a vector. The arguments are the vector, the starting
19868index, and the ending index, with the ending index in the top-of-stack
19869position. The starting index indicates the first element of the vector
19870to take. The ending index indicates the first element @emph{past} the
19871range to be taken. Thus, @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)} produces
19872the subvector @samp{[b, c]}. You could get the same result using
19873@samp{mrow([a, b, c, d, e], @w{[2 .. 4)})}.
19874
19875If either the start or the end index is zero or negative, it is
19876interpreted as relative to the end of the vector. Thus
19877@samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, -2)} also produces @samp{[b, c]}. In
19878the algebraic form, the end index can be omitted in which case it
19879is taken as zero, i.e., elements from the starting element to the
19880end of the vector are used. The infinity symbol, @code{inf}, also
19881has this effect when used as the ending index.
19882
19883@kindex I v s
65d0154b 19884@kindex I V s
4009494e
GM
19885@tindex rsubvec
19886With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I v s} [@code{rsubvec}] removes a subvector
19887from a vector. The arguments are interpreted the same as for the
19888normal @kbd{v s} command. Thus, @samp{rsubvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)}
19889produces @samp{[a, d, e]}. It is always true that @code{subvec} and
19890@code{rsubvec} return complementary parts of the input vector.
19891
19892@xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for an alternative way to operate on
19893vectors one element at a time.
19894
19895@node Manipulating Vectors, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Extracting Elements, Matrix Functions
19896@section Manipulating Vectors
19897
19898@noindent
19899@kindex v l
65d0154b 19900@kindex V l
4009494e
GM
19901@pindex calc-vlength
19902@tindex vlen
19903The @kbd{v l} (@code{calc-vlength}) [@code{vlen}] command computes the
19904length of a vector. The length of a non-vector is considered to be zero.
19905Note that matrices are just vectors of vectors for the purposes of this
19906command.
19907
19908@kindex H v l
65d0154b 19909@kindex H V l
4009494e
GM
19910@tindex mdims
19911With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v l} [@code{mdims}] computes a vector
19912of the dimensions of a vector, matrix, or higher-order object. For
19913example, @samp{mdims([[a,b,c],[d,e,f]])} returns @samp{[2, 3]} since
19914its argument is a
19915@texline @math{2\times3}
19916@infoline 2x3
19917matrix.
19918
19919@kindex v f
65d0154b 19920@kindex V f
4009494e
GM
19921@pindex calc-vector-find
19922@tindex find
19923The @kbd{v f} (@code{calc-vector-find}) [@code{find}] command searches
19924along a vector for the first element equal to a given target. The target
19925is on the top of the stack; the vector is in the second-to-top position.
19926If a match is found, the result is the index of the matching element.
19927Otherwise, the result is zero. The numeric prefix argument, if given,
19928allows you to select any starting index for the search.
19929
19930@kindex v a
65d0154b 19931@kindex V a
4009494e
GM
19932@pindex calc-arrange-vector
19933@tindex arrange
19934@cindex Arranging a matrix
19935@cindex Reshaping a matrix
19936@cindex Flattening a matrix
19937The @kbd{v a} (@code{calc-arrange-vector}) [@code{arrange}] command
19938rearranges a vector to have a certain number of columns and rows. The
19939numeric prefix argument specifies the number of columns; if you do not
19940provide an argument, you will be prompted for the number of columns.
19941The vector or matrix on the top of the stack is @dfn{flattened} into a
19942plain vector. If the number of columns is nonzero, this vector is
19943then formed into a matrix by taking successive groups of @var{n} elements.
19944If the number of columns does not evenly divide the number of elements
19945in the vector, the last row will be short and the result will not be
19946suitable for use as a matrix. For example, with the matrix
19947@samp{[[1, 2], @w{[3, 4]}]} on the stack, @kbd{v a 4} produces
19948@samp{[[1, 2, 3, 4]]} (a
19949@texline @math{1\times4}
19950@infoline 1x4
19951matrix), @kbd{v a 1} produces @samp{[[1], [2], [3], [4]]} (a
19952@texline @math{4\times1}
19953@infoline 4x1
19954matrix), @kbd{v a 2} produces @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4]]} (the original
19955@texline @math{2\times2}
19956@infoline 2x2
19957matrix), @w{@kbd{v a 3}} produces @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4]]} (not a
19958matrix), and @kbd{v a 0} produces the flattened list
19959@samp{[1, 2, @w{3, 4}]}.
19960
19961@cindex Sorting data
65d0154b 19962@kindex v S
4009494e 19963@kindex V S
65d0154b 19964@kindex I v S
4009494e
GM
19965@kindex I V S
19966@pindex calc-sort
19967@tindex sort
19968@tindex rsort
19969The @kbd{V S} (@code{calc-sort}) [@code{sort}] command sorts the elements of
19970a vector into increasing order. Real numbers, real infinities, and
19971constant interval forms come first in this ordering; next come other
19972kinds of numbers, then variables (in alphabetical order), then finally
19973come formulas and other kinds of objects; these are sorted according
19974to a kind of lexicographic ordering with the useful property that
19975one vector is less or greater than another if the first corresponding
19976unequal elements are less or greater, respectively. Since quoted strings
19977are stored by Calc internally as vectors of ASCII character codes
19978(@pxref{Strings}), this means vectors of strings are also sorted into
19979alphabetical order by this command.
19980
19981The @kbd{I V S} [@code{rsort}] command sorts a vector into decreasing order.
19982
19983@cindex Permutation, inverse of
19984@cindex Inverse of permutation
19985@cindex Index tables
19986@cindex Rank tables
65d0154b 19987@kindex v G
4009494e 19988@kindex V G
65d0154b 19989@kindex I v G
4009494e
GM
19990@kindex I V G
19991@pindex calc-grade
19992@tindex grade
19993@tindex rgrade
19994The @kbd{V G} (@code{calc-grade}) [@code{grade}, @code{rgrade}] command
19995produces an index table or permutation vector which, if applied to the
19996input vector (as the index of @kbd{C-u v r}, say), would sort the vector.
19997A permutation vector is just a vector of integers from 1 to @var{n}, where
19998each integer occurs exactly once. One application of this is to sort a
19999matrix of data rows using one column as the sort key; extract that column,
20000grade it with @kbd{V G}, then use the result to reorder the original matrix
20001with @kbd{C-u v r}. Another interesting property of the @code{V G} command
20002is that, if the input is itself a permutation vector, the result will
20003be the inverse of the permutation. The inverse of an index table is
20004a rank table, whose @var{k}th element says where the @var{k}th original
20005vector element will rest when the vector is sorted. To get a rank
20006table, just use @kbd{V G V G}.
20007
20008With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I V G} produces an index table that would
20009sort the input into decreasing order. Note that @kbd{V S} and @kbd{V G}
20010use a ``stable'' sorting algorithm, i.e., any two elements which are equal
20011will not be moved out of their original order. Generally there is no way
20012to tell with @kbd{V S}, since two elements which are equal look the same,
20013but with @kbd{V G} this can be an important issue. In the matrix-of-rows
20014example, suppose you have names and telephone numbers as two columns and
20015you wish to sort by phone number primarily, and by name when the numbers
20016are equal. You can sort the data matrix by names first, and then again
20017by phone numbers. Because the sort is stable, any two rows with equal
20018phone numbers will remain sorted by name even after the second sort.
20019
20020@cindex Histograms
65d0154b 20021@kindex v H
4009494e
GM
20022@kindex V H
20023@pindex calc-histogram
20024@ignore
20025@mindex histo@idots
20026@end ignore
20027@tindex histogram
20028The @kbd{V H} (@code{calc-histogram}) [@code{histogram}] command builds a
20029histogram of a vector of numbers. Vector elements are assumed to be
20030integers or real numbers in the range [0..@var{n}) for some ``number of
20031bins'' @var{n}, which is the numeric prefix argument given to the
20032command. The result is a vector of @var{n} counts of how many times
20033each value appeared in the original vector. Non-integers in the input
20034are rounded down to integers. Any vector elements outside the specified
20035range are ignored. (You can tell if elements have been ignored by noting
20036that the counts in the result vector don't add up to the length of the
20037input vector.)
20038
597517ef
JB
20039If no prefix is given, then you will be prompted for a vector which
20040will be used to determine the bins. (If a positive integer is given at
20041this prompt, it will be still treated as if it were given as a
20042prefix.) Each bin will consist of the interval of numbers closest to
20043the corresponding number of this new vector; if the vector
20044@expr{[a, b, c, ...]} is entered at the prompt, the bins will be
20045@expr{(-inf, (a+b)/2]}, @expr{((a+b)/2, (b+c)/2]}, etc. The result of
20046this command will be a vector counting how many elements of the
20047original vector are in each bin.
20048
20049The result will then be a vector with the same length as this new vector;
20050each element of the new vector will be replaced by the number of
20051elements of the original vector which are closest to it.
20052
65d0154b 20053@kindex H v H
4009494e
GM
20054@kindex H V H
20055With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H V H} pulls two vectors from the stack.
20056The second-to-top vector is the list of numbers as before. The top
20057vector is an equal-sized list of ``weights'' to attach to the elements
20058of the data vector. For example, if the first data element is 4.2 and
20059the first weight is 10, then 10 will be added to bin 4 of the result
20060vector. Without the hyperbolic flag, every element has a weight of one.
20061
20062@kindex v t
65d0154b 20063@kindex V t
4009494e
GM
20064@pindex calc-transpose
20065@tindex trn
20066The @kbd{v t} (@code{calc-transpose}) [@code{trn}] command computes
20067the transpose of the matrix at the top of the stack. If the argument
20068is a plain vector, it is treated as a row vector and transposed into
20069a one-column matrix.
20070
20071@kindex v v
65d0154b 20072@kindex V v
4009494e
GM
20073@pindex calc-reverse-vector
20074@tindex rev
20075The @kbd{v v} (@code{calc-reverse-vector}) [@code{rev}] command reverses
20076a vector end-for-end. Given a matrix, it reverses the order of the rows.
20077(To reverse the columns instead, just use @kbd{v t v v v t}. The same
20078principle can be used to apply other vector commands to the columns of
20079a matrix.)
20080
20081@kindex v m
65d0154b 20082@kindex V m
4009494e
GM
20083@pindex calc-mask-vector
20084@tindex vmask
20085The @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector}) [@code{vmask}] command uses
20086one vector as a mask to extract elements of another vector. The mask
20087is in the second-to-top position; the target vector is on the top of
20088the stack. These vectors must have the same length. The result is
20089the same as the target vector, but with all elements which correspond
20090to zeros in the mask vector deleted. Thus, for example,
20091@samp{vmask([1, 0, 1, 0, 1], [a, b, c, d, e])} produces @samp{[a, c, e]}.
20092@xref{Logical Operations}.
20093
20094@kindex v e
65d0154b 20095@kindex V e
4009494e
GM
20096@pindex calc-expand-vector
20097@tindex vexp
20098The @kbd{v e} (@code{calc-expand-vector}) [@code{vexp}] command
20099expands a vector according to another mask vector. The result is a
20100vector the same length as the mask, but with nonzero elements replaced
20101by successive elements from the target vector. The length of the target
20102vector is normally the number of nonzero elements in the mask. If the
20103target vector is longer, its last few elements are lost. If the target
20104vector is shorter, the last few nonzero mask elements are left
20105unreplaced in the result. Thus @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b])}
20106produces @samp{[a, 0, b, 0, 7]}.
20107
20108@kindex H v e
65d0154b 20109@kindex H V e
4009494e
GM
20110With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v e} takes a filler value from the
20111top of the stack; the mask and target vectors come from the third and
20112second elements of the stack. This filler is used where the mask is
20113zero: @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b], z)} produces
20114@samp{[a, z, c, z, 7]}. If the filler value is itself a vector,
20115then successive values are taken from it, so that the effect is to
20116interleave two vectors according to the mask:
20117@samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 7, 0, 0], [a, b], [x, y])} produces
20118@samp{[a, x, b, 7, y, 0]}.
20119
20120Another variation on the masking idea is to combine @samp{[a, b, c, d, e]}
20121with the mask @samp{[1, 0, 1, 0, 1]} to produce @samp{[a, 0, c, 0, e]}.
20122You can accomplish this with @kbd{V M a &}, mapping the logical ``and''
20123operation across the two vectors. @xref{Logical Operations}. Note that
20124the @code{? :} operation also discussed there allows other types of
20125masking using vectors.
20126
20127@node Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Set Operations, Manipulating Vectors, Matrix Functions
20128@section Vector and Matrix Arithmetic
20129
20130@noindent
20131Basic arithmetic operations like addition and multiplication are defined
20132for vectors and matrices as well as for numbers. Division of matrices, in
20133the sense of multiplying by the inverse, is supported. (Division by a
20134matrix actually uses LU-decomposition for greater accuracy and speed.)
20135@xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
20136
20137The following functions are applied element-wise if their arguments are
20138vectors or matrices: @code{change-sign}, @code{conj}, @code{arg},
20139@code{re}, @code{im}, @code{polar}, @code{rect}, @code{clean},
20140@code{float}, @code{frac}. @xref{Function Index}.
20141
65d0154b 20142@kindex v J
4009494e
GM
20143@kindex V J
20144@pindex calc-conj-transpose
20145@tindex ctrn
20146The @kbd{V J} (@code{calc-conj-transpose}) [@code{ctrn}] command computes
20147the conjugate transpose of its argument, i.e., @samp{conj(trn(x))}.
20148
20149@ignore
20150@mindex A
20151@end ignore
20152@kindex A (vectors)
20153@pindex calc-abs (vectors)
20154@ignore
20155@mindex abs
20156@end ignore
20157@tindex abs (vectors)
20158The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the
20159Frobenius norm of a vector or matrix argument. This is the square
20160root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
20161elements of the vector or matrix. If the vector is interpreted as
20162a point in two- or three-dimensional space, this is the distance
20163from that point to the origin.
20164
20165@kindex v n
65d0154b 20166@kindex V n
4009494e
GM
20167@pindex calc-rnorm
20168@tindex rnorm
a8b14149
JB
20169The @kbd{v n} (@code{calc-rnorm}) [@code{rnorm}] command computes the
20170infinity-norm of a vector, or the row norm of a matrix. For a plain
20171vector, this is the maximum of the absolute values of the elements. For
20172a matrix, this is the maximum of the row-absolute-value-sums, i.e., of
20173the sums of the absolute values of the elements along the various rows.
4009494e 20174
65d0154b 20175@kindex v N
4009494e
GM
20176@kindex V N
20177@pindex calc-cnorm
20178@tindex cnorm
20179The @kbd{V N} (@code{calc-cnorm}) [@code{cnorm}] command computes
a8b14149 20180the one-norm of a vector, or column norm of a matrix. For a plain
4009494e
GM
20181vector, this is the sum of the absolute values of the elements.
20182For a matrix, this is the maximum of the column-absolute-value-sums.
20183General @expr{k}-norms for @expr{k} other than one or infinity are
a8b14149
JB
20184not provided. However, the 2-norm (or Frobenius norm) is provided for
20185vectors by the @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) command.
4009494e 20186
65d0154b 20187@kindex v C
4009494e
GM
20188@kindex V C
20189@pindex calc-cross
20190@tindex cross
20191The @kbd{V C} (@code{calc-cross}) [@code{cross}] command computes the
20192right-handed cross product of two vectors, each of which must have
20193exactly three elements.
20194
20195@ignore
20196@mindex &
20197@end ignore
20198@kindex & (matrices)
20199@pindex calc-inv (matrices)
20200@ignore
20201@mindex inv
20202@end ignore
20203@tindex inv (matrices)
20204The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
20205inverse of a square matrix. If the matrix is singular, the inverse
20206operation is left in symbolic form. Matrix inverses are recorded so
20207that once an inverse (or determinant) of a particular matrix has been
20208computed, the inverse and determinant of the matrix can be recomputed
20209quickly in the future.
20210
20211If the argument to @kbd{&} is a plain number @expr{x}, this
20212command simply computes @expr{1/x}. This is okay, because the
20213@samp{/} operator also does a matrix inversion when dividing one
20214by a matrix.
20215
65d0154b 20216@kindex v D
4009494e
GM
20217@kindex V D
20218@pindex calc-mdet
20219@tindex det
20220The @kbd{V D} (@code{calc-mdet}) [@code{det}] command computes the
20221determinant of a square matrix.
20222
65d0154b 20223@kindex v L
4009494e
GM
20224@kindex V L
20225@pindex calc-mlud
20226@tindex lud
20227The @kbd{V L} (@code{calc-mlud}) [@code{lud}] command computes the
20228LU decomposition of a matrix. The result is a list of three matrices
20229which, when multiplied together left-to-right, form the original matrix.
20230The first is a permutation matrix that arises from pivoting in the
20231algorithm, the second is lower-triangular with ones on the diagonal,
20232and the third is upper-triangular.
20233
65d0154b 20234@kindex v T
4009494e
GM
20235@kindex V T
20236@pindex calc-mtrace
20237@tindex tr
20238The @kbd{V T} (@code{calc-mtrace}) [@code{tr}] command computes the
20239trace of a square matrix. This is defined as the sum of the diagonal
20240elements of the matrix.
20241
65d0154b 20242@kindex v K
629f618d
JB
20243@kindex V K
20244@pindex calc-kron
20245@tindex kron
20246The @kbd{V K} (@code{calc-kron}) [@code{kron}] command computes
20247the Kronecker product of two matrices.
20248
4009494e
GM
20249@node Set Operations, Statistical Operations, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Matrix Functions
20250@section Set Operations using Vectors
20251
20252@noindent
20253@cindex Sets, as vectors
20254Calc includes several commands which interpret vectors as @dfn{sets} of
20255objects. A set is a collection of objects; any given object can appear
20256only once in the set. Calc stores sets as vectors of objects in
20257sorted order. Objects in a Calc set can be any of the usual things,
20258such as numbers, variables, or formulas. Two set elements are considered
20259equal if they are identical, except that numerically equal numbers like
20260the integer 4 and the float 4.0 are considered equal even though they
20261are not ``identical.'' Variables are treated like plain symbols without
20262attached values by the set operations; subtracting the set @samp{[b]}
20263from @samp{[a, b]} always yields the set @samp{[a]} even though if
20264the variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} both equaled 17, you might
20265expect the answer @samp{[]}.
20266
20267If a set contains interval forms, then it is assumed to be a set of
20268real numbers. In this case, all set operations require the elements
20269of the set to be only things that are allowed in intervals: Real
20270numbers, plus and minus infinity, HMS forms, and date forms. If
20271there are variables or other non-real objects present in a real set,
20272all set operations on it will be left in unevaluated form.
20273
20274If the input to a set operation is a plain number or interval form
20275@var{a}, it is treated like the one-element vector @samp{[@var{a}]}.
20276The result is always a vector, except that if the set consists of a
20277single interval, the interval itself is returned instead.
20278
20279@xref{Logical Operations}, for the @code{in} function which tests if
20280a certain value is a member of a given set. To test if the set @expr{A}
20281is a subset of the set @expr{B}, use @samp{vdiff(A, B) = []}.
20282
65d0154b 20283@kindex v +
4009494e
GM
20284@kindex V +
20285@pindex calc-remove-duplicates
20286@tindex rdup
20287The @kbd{V +} (@code{calc-remove-duplicates}) [@code{rdup}] command
20288converts an arbitrary vector into set notation. It works by sorting
20289the vector as if by @kbd{V S}, then removing duplicates. (For example,
20290@kbd{[a, 5, 4, a, 4.0]} is sorted to @samp{[4, 4.0, 5, a, a]} and then
20291reduced to @samp{[4, 5, a]}). Overlapping intervals are merged as
20292necessary. You rarely need to use @kbd{V +} explicitly, since all the
20293other set-based commands apply @kbd{V +} to their inputs before using
20294them.
20295
65d0154b 20296@kindex v V
4009494e
GM
20297@kindex V V
20298@pindex calc-set-union
20299@tindex vunion
20300The @kbd{V V} (@code{calc-set-union}) [@code{vunion}] command computes
20301the union of two sets. An object is in the union of two sets if and
20302only if it is in either (or both) of the input sets. (You could
20303accomplish the same thing by concatenating the sets with @kbd{|},
20304then using @kbd{V +}.)
20305
65d0154b 20306@kindex v ^
4009494e
GM
20307@kindex V ^
20308@pindex calc-set-intersect
20309@tindex vint
20310The @kbd{V ^} (@code{calc-set-intersect}) [@code{vint}] command computes
20311the intersection of two sets. An object is in the intersection if
20312and only if it is in both of the input sets. Thus if the input
20313sets are disjoint, i.e., if they share no common elements, the result
20314will be the empty vector @samp{[]}. Note that the characters @kbd{V}
20315and @kbd{^} were chosen to be close to the conventional mathematical
20316notation for set
20317@texline union@tie{}(@math{A \cup B})
20318@infoline union
20319and
20320@texline intersection@tie{}(@math{A \cap B}).
20321@infoline intersection.
20322
65d0154b 20323@kindex v -
4009494e
GM
20324@kindex V -
20325@pindex calc-set-difference
20326@tindex vdiff
20327The @kbd{V -} (@code{calc-set-difference}) [@code{vdiff}] command computes
20328the difference between two sets. An object is in the difference
20329@expr{A - B} if and only if it is in @expr{A} but not in @expr{B}.
20330Thus subtracting @samp{[y,z]} from a set will remove the elements
20331@samp{y} and @samp{z} if they are present. You can also think of this
20332as a general @dfn{set complement} operator; if @expr{A} is the set of
20333all possible values, then @expr{A - B} is the ``complement'' of @expr{B}.
20334Obviously this is only practical if the set of all possible values in
20335your problem is small enough to list in a Calc vector (or simple
20336enough to express in a few intervals).
20337
65d0154b 20338@kindex v X
4009494e
GM
20339@kindex V X
20340@pindex calc-set-xor
20341@tindex vxor
20342The @kbd{V X} (@code{calc-set-xor}) [@code{vxor}] command computes
20343the ``exclusive-or,'' or ``symmetric difference'' of two sets.
20344An object is in the symmetric difference of two sets if and only
20345if it is in one, but @emph{not} both, of the sets. Objects that
20346occur in both sets ``cancel out.''
20347
65d0154b 20348@kindex v ~
4009494e
GM
20349@kindex V ~
20350@pindex calc-set-complement
20351@tindex vcompl
20352The @kbd{V ~} (@code{calc-set-complement}) [@code{vcompl}] command
20353computes the complement of a set with respect to the real numbers.
20354Thus @samp{vcompl(x)} is equivalent to @samp{vdiff([-inf .. inf], x)}.
20355For example, @samp{vcompl([2, (3 .. 4]])} evaluates to
20356@samp{[[-inf .. 2), (2 .. 3], (4 .. inf]]}.
20357
65d0154b 20358@kindex v F
4009494e
GM
20359@kindex V F
20360@pindex calc-set-floor
20361@tindex vfloor
20362The @kbd{V F} (@code{calc-set-floor}) [@code{vfloor}] command
20363reinterprets a set as a set of integers. Any non-integer values,
20364and intervals that do not enclose any integers, are removed. Open
20365intervals are converted to equivalent closed intervals. Successive
20366integers are converted into intervals of integers. For example, the
20367complement of the set @samp{[2, 6, 7, 8]} is messy, but if you wanted
20368the complement with respect to the set of integers you could type
20369@kbd{V ~ V F} to get @samp{[[-inf .. 1], [3 .. 5], [9 .. inf]]}.
20370
65d0154b 20371@kindex v E
4009494e
GM
20372@kindex V E
20373@pindex calc-set-enumerate
20374@tindex venum
20375The @kbd{V E} (@code{calc-set-enumerate}) [@code{venum}] command
20376converts a set of integers into an explicit vector. Intervals in
20377the set are expanded out to lists of all integers encompassed by
20378the intervals. This only works for finite sets (i.e., sets which
20379do not involve @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf}).
20380
65d0154b 20381@kindex v :
4009494e
GM
20382@kindex V :
20383@pindex calc-set-span
20384@tindex vspan
20385The @kbd{V :} (@code{calc-set-span}) [@code{vspan}] command converts any
20386set of reals into an interval form that encompasses all its elements.
20387The lower limit will be the smallest element in the set; the upper
20388limit will be the largest element. For an empty set, @samp{vspan([])}
20389returns the empty interval @w{@samp{[0 .. 0)}}.
20390
65d0154b 20391@kindex v #
4009494e
GM
20392@kindex V #
20393@pindex calc-set-cardinality
20394@tindex vcard
20395The @kbd{V #} (@code{calc-set-cardinality}) [@code{vcard}] command counts
20396the number of integers in a set. The result is the length of the vector
20397that would be produced by @kbd{V E}, although the computation is much
20398more efficient than actually producing that vector.
20399
20400@cindex Sets, as binary numbers
20401Another representation for sets that may be more appropriate in some
20402cases is binary numbers. If you are dealing with sets of integers
20403in the range 0 to 49, you can use a 50-bit binary number where a
20404particular bit is 1 if the corresponding element is in the set.
20405@xref{Binary Functions}, for a list of commands that operate on
20406binary numbers. Note that many of the above set operations have
20407direct equivalents in binary arithmetic: @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}),
20408@kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}), @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}),
20409@kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}), and @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}),
20410respectively. You can use whatever representation for sets is most
20411convenient to you.
20412
20413@kindex b p
20414@kindex b u
20415@pindex calc-pack-bits
20416@pindex calc-unpack-bits
20417@tindex vpack
20418@tindex vunpack
20419The @kbd{b u} (@code{calc-unpack-bits}) [@code{vunpack}] command
20420converts an integer that represents a set in binary into a set
20421in vector/interval notation. For example, @samp{vunpack(67)}
20422returns @samp{[[0 .. 1], 6]}. If the input is negative, the set
20423it represents is semi-infinite: @samp{vunpack(-4) = [2 .. inf)}.
20424Use @kbd{V E} afterwards to expand intervals to individual
20425values if you wish. Note that this command uses the @kbd{b}
20426(binary) prefix key.
20427
20428The @kbd{b p} (@code{calc-pack-bits}) [@code{vpack}] command
20429converts the other way, from a vector or interval representing
20430a set of nonnegative integers into a binary integer describing
20431the same set. The set may include positive infinity, but must
20432not include any negative numbers. The input is interpreted as a
20433set of integers in the sense of @kbd{V F} (@code{vfloor}). Beware
20434that a simple input like @samp{[100]} can result in a huge integer
20435representation
20436@texline (@math{2^{100}}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20437@infoline (@expr{2^100}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20438
20439@node Statistical Operations, Reducing and Mapping, Set Operations, Matrix Functions
20440@section Statistical Operations on Vectors
20441
20442@noindent
20443@cindex Statistical functions
20444The commands in this section take vectors as arguments and compute
20445various statistical measures on the data stored in the vectors. The
20446references used in the definitions of these functions are Bevington's
20447@emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis for the Physical Sciences},
20448and @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky and
20449Vetterling.
20450
20451The statistical commands use the @kbd{u} prefix key followed by
20452a shifted letter or other character.
20453
20454@xref{Manipulating Vectors}, for a description of @kbd{V H}
20455(@code{calc-histogram}).
20456
20457@xref{Curve Fitting}, for the @kbd{a F} command for doing
20458least-squares fits to statistical data.
20459
20460@xref{Probability Distribution Functions}, for several common
20461probability distribution functions.
20462
20463@menu
20464* Single-Variable Statistics::
20465* Paired-Sample Statistics::
20466@end menu
20467
20468@node Single-Variable Statistics, Paired-Sample Statistics, Statistical Operations, Statistical Operations
20469@subsection Single-Variable Statistics
20470
20471@noindent
20472These functions do various statistical computations on single
20473vectors. Given a numeric prefix argument, they actually pop
20474@var{n} objects from the stack and combine them into a data
20475vector. Each object may be either a number or a vector; if a
20476vector, any sub-vectors inside it are ``flattened'' as if by
20477@kbd{v a 0}; @pxref{Manipulating Vectors}. By default one object
20478is popped, which (in order to be useful) is usually a vector.
20479
20480If an argument is a variable name, and the value stored in that
20481variable is a vector, then the stored vector is used. This method
20482has the advantage that if your data vector is large, you can avoid
20483the slow process of manipulating it directly on the stack.
20484
20485These functions are left in symbolic form if any of their arguments
20486are not numbers or vectors, e.g., if an argument is a formula, or
20487a non-vector variable. However, formulas embedded within vector
20488arguments are accepted; the result is a symbolic representation
20489of the computation, based on the assumption that the formula does
20490not itself represent a vector. All varieties of numbers such as
20491error forms and interval forms are acceptable.
20492
20493Some of the functions in this section also accept a single error form
20494or interval as an argument. They then describe a property of the
20495normal or uniform (respectively) statistical distribution described
20496by the argument. The arguments are interpreted in the same way as
20497the @var{M} argument of the random number function @kbd{k r}. In
20498particular, an interval with integer limits is considered an integer
20499distribution, so that @samp{[2 .. 6)} is the same as @samp{[2 .. 5]}.
20500An interval with at least one floating-point limit is a continuous
20501distribution: @samp{[2.0 .. 6.0)} is @emph{not} the same as
20502@samp{[2.0 .. 5.0]}!
20503
20504@kindex u #
20505@pindex calc-vector-count
20506@tindex vcount
20507The @kbd{u #} (@code{calc-vector-count}) [@code{vcount}] command
20508computes the number of data values represented by the inputs.
20509For example, @samp{vcount(1, [2, 3], [[4, 5], [], x, y])} returns 7.
20510If the argument is a single vector with no sub-vectors, this
20511simply computes the length of the vector.
20512
20513@kindex u +
20514@kindex u *
20515@pindex calc-vector-sum
20516@pindex calc-vector-prod
20517@tindex vsum
20518@tindex vprod
20519@cindex Summations (statistical)
20520The @kbd{u +} (@code{calc-vector-sum}) [@code{vsum}] command
20521computes the sum of the data values. The @kbd{u *}
20522(@code{calc-vector-prod}) [@code{vprod}] command computes the
20523product of the data values. If the input is a single flat vector,
20524these are the same as @kbd{V R +} and @kbd{V R *}
20525(@pxref{Reducing and Mapping}).
20526
20527@kindex u X
20528@kindex u N
20529@pindex calc-vector-max
20530@pindex calc-vector-min
20531@tindex vmax
20532@tindex vmin
20533The @kbd{u X} (@code{calc-vector-max}) [@code{vmax}] command
20534computes the maximum of the data values, and the @kbd{u N}
20535(@code{calc-vector-min}) [@code{vmin}] command computes the minimum.
20536If the argument is an interval, this finds the minimum or maximum
20537value in the interval. (Note that @samp{vmax([2..6)) = 5} as
20538described above.) If the argument is an error form, this returns
20539plus or minus infinity.
20540
20541@kindex u M
20542@pindex calc-vector-mean
20543@tindex vmean
20544@cindex Mean of data values
20545The @kbd{u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean}) [@code{vmean}] command
20546computes the average (arithmetic mean) of the data values.
20547If the inputs are error forms
20548@texline @math{x \pm \sigma},
20549@infoline @samp{x +/- s},
20550this is the weighted mean of the @expr{x} values with weights
20551@texline @math{1 /\sigma^2}.
20552@infoline @expr{1 / s^2}.
20553@tex
4009494e
GM
20554$$ \mu = { \displaystyle \sum { x_i \over \sigma_i^2 } \over
20555 \displaystyle \sum { 1 \over \sigma_i^2 } } $$
20556@end tex
20557If the inputs are not error forms, this is simply the sum of the
20558values divided by the count of the values.
20559
20560Note that a plain number can be considered an error form with
20561error
20562@texline @math{\sigma = 0}.
20563@infoline @expr{s = 0}.
20564If the input to @kbd{u M} is a mixture of
20565plain numbers and error forms, the result is the mean of the
20566plain numbers, ignoring all values with non-zero errors. (By the
20567above definitions it's clear that a plain number effectively
20568has an infinite weight, next to which an error form with a finite
20569weight is completely negligible.)
20570
20571This function also works for distributions (error forms or
20572intervals). The mean of an error form `@var{a} @tfn{+/-} @var{b}' is simply
20573@expr{a}. The mean of an interval is the mean of the minimum
20574and maximum values of the interval.
20575
20576@kindex I u M
20577@pindex calc-vector-mean-error
20578@tindex vmeane
20579The @kbd{I u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean-error}) [@code{vmeane}]
20580command computes the mean of the data points expressed as an
20581error form. This includes the estimated error associated with
20582the mean. If the inputs are error forms, the error is the square
20583root of the reciprocal of the sum of the reciprocals of the squares
20584of the input errors. (I.e., the variance is the reciprocal of the
20585sum of the reciprocals of the variances.)
20586@tex
4009494e
GM
20587$$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {1 \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}} $$
20588@end tex
20589If the inputs are plain
20590numbers, the error is equal to the standard deviation of the values
20591divided by the square root of the number of values. (This works
20592out to be equivalent to calculating the standard deviation and
20593then assuming each value's error is equal to this standard
20594deviation.)
20595@tex
4009494e
GM
20596$$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {\sigma^2 \over N} $$
20597@end tex
20598
20599@kindex H u M
20600@pindex calc-vector-median
20601@tindex vmedian
20602@cindex Median of data values
20603The @kbd{H u M} (@code{calc-vector-median}) [@code{vmedian}]
20604command computes the median of the data values. The values are
20605first sorted into numerical order; the median is the middle
20606value after sorting. (If the number of data values is even,
20607the median is taken to be the average of the two middle values.)
20608The median function is different from the other functions in
20609this section in that the arguments must all be real numbers;
20610variables are not accepted even when nested inside vectors.
20611(Otherwise it is not possible to sort the data values.) If
20612any of the input values are error forms, their error parts are
20613ignored.
20614
20615The median function also accepts distributions. For both normal
20616(error form) and uniform (interval) distributions, the median is
20617the same as the mean.
20618
20619@kindex H I u M
20620@pindex calc-vector-harmonic-mean
20621@tindex vhmean
20622@cindex Harmonic mean
20623The @kbd{H I u M} (@code{calc-vector-harmonic-mean}) [@code{vhmean}]
20624command computes the harmonic mean of the data values. This is
20625defined as the reciprocal of the arithmetic mean of the reciprocals
20626of the values.
20627@tex
4009494e
GM
20628$$ { N \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over x_i} } $$
20629@end tex
20630
20631@kindex u G
20632@pindex calc-vector-geometric-mean
20633@tindex vgmean
20634@cindex Geometric mean
20635The @kbd{u G} (@code{calc-vector-geometric-mean}) [@code{vgmean}]
20636command computes the geometric mean of the data values. This
20637is the @var{n}th root of the product of the values. This is also
20638equal to the @code{exp} of the arithmetic mean of the logarithms
20639of the data values.
20640@tex
4009494e
GM
20641$$ \exp \left ( \sum { \ln x_i } \right ) =
20642 \left ( \prod { x_i } \right)^{1 / N} $$
20643@end tex
20644
20645@kindex H u G
20646@tindex agmean
20647The @kbd{H u G} [@code{agmean}] command computes the ``arithmetic-geometric
20648mean'' of two numbers taken from the stack. This is computed by
20649replacing the two numbers with their arithmetic mean and geometric
20650mean, then repeating until the two values converge.
20651@tex
4009494e
GM
20652$$ a_{i+1} = { a_i + b_i \over 2 } , \qquad b_{i+1} = \sqrt{a_i b_i} $$
20653@end tex
20654
20655@cindex Root-mean-square
20656Another commonly used mean, the RMS (root-mean-square), can be computed
20657for a vector of numbers simply by using the @kbd{A} command.
20658
20659@kindex u S
20660@pindex calc-vector-sdev
20661@tindex vsdev
20662@cindex Standard deviation
20663@cindex Sample statistics
20664The @kbd{u S} (@code{calc-vector-sdev}) [@code{vsdev}] command
20665computes the standard
20666@texline deviation@tie{}@math{\sigma}
20667@infoline deviation
20668of the data values. If the values are error forms, the errors are used
20669as weights just as for @kbd{u M}. This is the @emph{sample} standard
20670deviation, whose value is the square root of the sum of the squares of
20671the differences between the values and the mean of the @expr{N} values,
20672divided by @expr{N-1}.
20673@tex
4009494e
GM
20674$$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N - 1} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20675@end tex
20676
20677This function also applies to distributions. The standard deviation
20678of a single error form is simply the error part. The standard deviation
20679of a continuous interval happens to equal the difference between the
20680limits, divided by
20681@texline @math{\sqrt{12}}.
20682@infoline @expr{sqrt(12)}.
20683The standard deviation of an integer interval is the same as the
20684standard deviation of a vector of those integers.
20685
20686@kindex I u S
20687@pindex calc-vector-pop-sdev
20688@tindex vpsdev
20689@cindex Population statistics
20690The @kbd{I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-sdev}) [@code{vpsdev}]
20691command computes the @emph{population} standard deviation.
20692It is defined by the same formula as above but dividing
20693by @expr{N} instead of by @expr{N-1}. The population standard
20694deviation is used when the input represents the entire set of
20695data values in the distribution; the sample standard deviation
20696is used when the input represents a sample of the set of all
20697data values, so that the mean computed from the input is itself
20698only an estimate of the true mean.
20699@tex
4009494e
GM
20700$$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20701@end tex
20702
20703For error forms and continuous intervals, @code{vpsdev} works
20704exactly like @code{vsdev}. For integer intervals, it computes the
20705population standard deviation of the equivalent vector of integers.
20706
20707@kindex H u S
20708@kindex H I u S
20709@pindex calc-vector-variance
20710@pindex calc-vector-pop-variance
20711@tindex vvar
20712@tindex vpvar
20713@cindex Variance of data values
20714The @kbd{H u S} (@code{calc-vector-variance}) [@code{vvar}] and
20715@kbd{H I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-variance}) [@code{vpvar}]
20716commands compute the variance of the data values. The variance
20717is the
20718@texline square@tie{}@math{\sigma^2}
20719@infoline square
20720of the standard deviation, i.e., the sum of the
20721squares of the deviations of the data values from the mean.
20722(This definition also applies when the argument is a distribution.)
20723
20724@ignore
20725@starindex
20726@end ignore
20727@tindex vflat
20728The @code{vflat} algebraic function returns a vector of its
20729arguments, interpreted in the same way as the other functions
20730in this section. For example, @samp{vflat(1, [2, [3, 4]], 5)}
20731returns @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
20732
20733@node Paired-Sample Statistics, , Single-Variable Statistics, Statistical Operations
20734@subsection Paired-Sample Statistics
20735
20736@noindent
20737The functions in this section take two arguments, which must be
20738vectors of equal size. The vectors are each flattened in the same
20739way as by the single-variable statistical functions. Given a numeric
20740prefix argument of 1, these functions instead take one object from
20741the stack, which must be an
20742@texline @math{N\times2}
20743@infoline Nx2
20744matrix of data values. Once again, variable names can be used in place
20745of actual vectors and matrices.
20746
20747@kindex u C
20748@pindex calc-vector-covariance
20749@tindex vcov
20750@cindex Covariance
20751The @kbd{u C} (@code{calc-vector-covariance}) [@code{vcov}] command
20752computes the sample covariance of two vectors. The covariance
20753of vectors @var{x} and @var{y} is the sum of the products of the
20754differences between the elements of @var{x} and the mean of @var{x}
20755times the differences between the corresponding elements of @var{y}
20756and the mean of @var{y}, all divided by @expr{N-1}. Note that
20757the variance of a vector is just the covariance of the vector
20758with itself. Once again, if the inputs are error forms the
20759errors are used as weight factors. If both @var{x} and @var{y}
20760are composed of error forms, the error for a given data point
20761is taken as the square root of the sum of the squares of the two
20762input errors.
20763@tex
4009494e
GM
20764$$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 = {1 \over N-1} \sum (x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) $$
20765$$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 =
20766 {\displaystyle {1 \over N-1}
20767 \sum {(x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) \over \sigma_i^2}
20768 \over \displaystyle {1 \over N} \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}}
20769$$
20770@end tex
20771
20772@kindex I u C
20773@pindex calc-vector-pop-covariance
20774@tindex vpcov
20775The @kbd{I u C} (@code{calc-vector-pop-covariance}) [@code{vpcov}]
20776command computes the population covariance, which is the same as the
20777sample covariance computed by @kbd{u C} except dividing by @expr{N}
20778instead of @expr{N-1}.
20779
20780@kindex H u C
20781@pindex calc-vector-correlation
20782@tindex vcorr
20783@cindex Correlation coefficient
20784@cindex Linear correlation
20785The @kbd{H u C} (@code{calc-vector-correlation}) [@code{vcorr}]
20786command computes the linear correlation coefficient of two vectors.
20787This is defined by the covariance of the vectors divided by the
20788product of their standard deviations. (There is no difference
20789between sample or population statistics here.)
20790@tex
4009494e
GM
20791$$ r_{x\!y} = { \sigma_{x\!y}^2 \over \sigma_x^2 \sigma_y^2 } $$
20792@end tex
20793
20794@node Reducing and Mapping, Vector and Matrix Formats, Statistical Operations, Matrix Functions
20795@section Reducing and Mapping Vectors
20796
20797@noindent
20798The commands in this section allow for more general operations on the
20799elements of vectors.
20800
65d0154b 20801@kindex v A
4009494e
GM
20802@kindex V A
20803@pindex calc-apply
20804@tindex apply
20805The simplest of these operations is @kbd{V A} (@code{calc-apply})
20806[@code{apply}], which applies a given operator to the elements of a vector.
20807For example, applying the hypothetical function @code{f} to the vector
20808@w{@samp{[1, 2, 3]}} would produce the function call @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20809Applying the @code{+} function to the vector @samp{[a, b]} gives
20810@samp{a + b}. Applying @code{+} to the vector @samp{[a, b, c]} is an
20811error, since the @code{+} function expects exactly two arguments.
20812
20813While @kbd{V A} is useful in some cases, you will usually find that either
20814@kbd{V R} or @kbd{V M}, described below, is closer to what you want.
20815
20816@menu
20817* Specifying Operators::
20818* Mapping::
20819* Reducing::
20820* Nesting and Fixed Points::
20821* Generalized Products::
20822@end menu
20823
20824@node Specifying Operators, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
20825@subsection Specifying Operators
20826
20827@noindent
20828Commands in this section (like @kbd{V A}) prompt you to press the key
20829corresponding to the desired operator. Press @kbd{?} for a partial
20830list of the available operators. Generally, an operator is any key or
20831sequence of keys that would normally take one or more arguments from
20832the stack and replace them with a result. For example, @kbd{V A H C}
20833uses the hyperbolic cosine operator, @code{cosh}. (Since @code{cosh}
20834expects one argument, @kbd{V A H C} requires a vector with a single
20835element as its argument.)
20836
20837You can press @kbd{x} at the operator prompt to select any algebraic
20838function by name to use as the operator. This includes functions you
20839have defined yourself using the @kbd{Z F} command. (@xref{Algebraic
20840Definitions}.) If you give a name for which no function has been
20841defined, the result is left in symbolic form, as in @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20842Calc will prompt for the number of arguments the function takes if it
20843can't figure it out on its own (say, because you named a function that
20844is currently undefined). It is also possible to type a digit key before
20845the function name to specify the number of arguments, e.g.,
20846@kbd{V M 3 x f @key{RET}} calls @code{f} with three arguments even if it
20847looks like it ought to have only two. This technique may be necessary
20848if the function allows a variable number of arguments. For example,
20849the @kbd{v e} [@code{vexp}] function accepts two or three arguments;
20850if you want to map with the three-argument version, you will have to
20851type @kbd{V M 3 v e}.
20852
20853It is also possible to apply any formula to a vector by treating that
20854formula as a function. When prompted for the operator to use, press
20855@kbd{'} (the apostrophe) and type your formula as an algebraic entry.
20856You will then be prompted for the argument list, which defaults to a
20857list of all variables that appear in the formula, sorted into alphabetic
20858order. For example, suppose you enter the formula @w{@samp{x + 2y^x}}.
20859The default argument list would be @samp{(x y)}, which means that if
20860this function is applied to the arguments @samp{[3, 10]} the result will
20861be @samp{3 + 2*10^3}. (If you plan to use a certain formula in this
20862way often, you might consider defining it as a function with @kbd{Z F}.)
20863
20864Another way to specify the arguments to the formula you enter is with
20865@kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on. For example, @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$}
20866has the same effect as the previous example. The argument list is
20867automatically taken to be @samp{($$ $)}. (The order of the arguments
20868may seem backwards, but it is analogous to the way normal algebraic
20869entry interacts with the stack.)
20870
20871If you press @kbd{$} at the operator prompt, the effect is similar to
20872the apostrophe except that the relevant formula is taken from top-of-stack
20873instead. The actual vector arguments of the @kbd{V A $} or related command
20874then start at the second-to-top stack position. You will still be
20875prompted for an argument list.
20876
20877@cindex Nameless functions
20878@cindex Generic functions
20879A function can be written without a name using the notation @samp{<#1 - #2>},
20880which means ``a function of two arguments that computes the first
20881argument minus the second argument.'' The symbols @samp{#1} and @samp{#2}
20882are placeholders for the arguments. You can use any names for these
20883placeholders if you wish, by including an argument list followed by a
20884colon: @samp{<x, y : x - y>}. When you type @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$ @key{RET}},
20885Calc builds the nameless function @samp{<#1 + 2 #2^#1>} as the function
20886to map across the vectors. When you type @kbd{V A ' x + 2y^x @key{RET} @key{RET}},
20887Calc builds the nameless function @w{@samp{<x, y : x + 2 y^x>}}. In both
20888cases, Calc also writes the nameless function to the Trail so that you
20889can get it back later if you wish.
20890
20891If there is only one argument, you can write @samp{#} in place of @samp{#1}.
20892(Note that @samp{< >} notation is also used for date forms. Calc tells
20893that @samp{<@var{stuff}>} is a nameless function by the presence of
20894@samp{#} signs inside @var{stuff}, or by the fact that @var{stuff}
20895begins with a list of variables followed by a colon.)
20896
20897You can type a nameless function directly to @kbd{V A '}, or put one on
20898the stack and use it with @w{@kbd{V A $}}. Calc will not prompt for an
20899argument list in this case, since the nameless function specifies the
20900argument list as well as the function itself. In @kbd{V A '}, you can
20901omit the @samp{< >} marks if you use @samp{#} notation for the arguments,
20902so that @kbd{V A ' #1+#2 @key{RET}} is the same as @kbd{V A ' <#1+#2> @key{RET}},
20903which in turn is the same as @kbd{V A ' $$+$ @key{RET}}.
20904
20905@cindex Lambda expressions
20906@ignore
20907@starindex
20908@end ignore
20909@tindex lambda
20910The internal format for @samp{<x, y : x + y>} is @samp{lambda(x, y, x + y)}.
20911(The word @code{lambda} derives from Lisp notation and the theory of
20912functions.) The internal format for @samp{<#1 + #2>} is @samp{lambda(ArgA,
20913ArgB, ArgA + ArgB)}. Note that there is no actual Calc function called
20914@code{lambda}; the whole point is that the @code{lambda} expression is
20915used in its symbolic form, not evaluated for an answer until it is applied
20916to specific arguments by a command like @kbd{V A} or @kbd{V M}.
20917
20918(Actually, @code{lambda} does have one special property: Its arguments
20919are never evaluated; for example, putting @samp{<(2/3) #>} on the stack
20920will not simplify the @samp{2/3} until the nameless function is actually
20921called.)
20922
20923@tindex add
20924@tindex sub
20925@ignore
20926@mindex @idots
20927@end ignore
20928@tindex mul
20929@ignore
20930@mindex @null
20931@end ignore
20932@tindex div
20933@ignore
20934@mindex @null
20935@end ignore
20936@tindex pow
20937@ignore
20938@mindex @null
20939@end ignore
20940@tindex neg
20941@ignore
20942@mindex @null
20943@end ignore
20944@tindex mod
20945@ignore
20946@mindex @null
20947@end ignore
20948@tindex vconcat
20949As usual, commands like @kbd{V A} have algebraic function name equivalents.
20950For example, @kbd{V A k g} with an argument of @samp{v} is equivalent to
20951@samp{apply(gcd, v)}. The first argument specifies the operator name,
20952and is either a variable whose name is the same as the function name,
20953or a nameless function like @samp{<#^3+1>}. Operators that are normally
20954written as algebraic symbols have the names @code{add}, @code{sub},
20955@code{mul}, @code{div}, @code{pow}, @code{neg}, @code{mod}, and
20956@code{vconcat}.
20957
20958@ignore
20959@starindex
20960@end ignore
20961@tindex call
20962The @code{call} function builds a function call out of several arguments:
20963@samp{call(gcd, x, y)} is the same as @samp{apply(gcd, [x, y])}, which
20964in turn is the same as @samp{gcd(x, y)}. The first argument of @code{call},
20965like the other functions described here, may be either a variable naming a
20966function, or a nameless function (@samp{call(<#1+2#2>, x, y)} is the same
20967as @samp{x + 2y}).
20968
20969(Experts will notice that it's not quite proper to use a variable to name
20970a function, since the name @code{gcd} corresponds to the Lisp variable
20971@code{var-gcd} but to the Lisp function @code{calcFunc-gcd}. Calc
20972automatically makes this translation, so you don't have to worry
20973about it.)
20974
20975@node Mapping, Reducing, Specifying Operators, Reducing and Mapping
20976@subsection Mapping
20977
20978@noindent
65d0154b 20979@kindex v M
4009494e
GM
20980@kindex V M
20981@pindex calc-map
20982@tindex map
20983The @kbd{V M} (@code{calc-map}) [@code{map}] command applies a given
20984operator elementwise to one or more vectors. For example, mapping
20985@code{A} [@code{abs}] produces a vector of the absolute values of the
20986elements in the input vector. Mapping @code{+} pops two vectors from
20987the stack, which must be of equal length, and produces a vector of the
20988pairwise sums of the elements. If either argument is a non-vector, it
20989is duplicated for each element of the other vector. For example,
20990@kbd{[1,2,3] 2 V M ^} squares the elements of the specified vector.
20991With the 2 listed first, it would have computed a vector of powers of
20992two. Mapping a user-defined function pops as many arguments from the
20993stack as the function requires. If you give an undefined name, you will
20994be prompted for the number of arguments to use.
20995
20996If any argument to @kbd{V M} is a matrix, the operator is normally mapped
20997across all elements of the matrix. For example, given the matrix
20998@expr{[[1, -2, 3], [-4, 5, -6]]}, @kbd{V M A} takes six absolute values to
20999produce another
21000@texline @math{3\times2}
21001@infoline 3x2
21002matrix, @expr{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}.
21003
21004@tindex mapr
21005The command @kbd{V M _} [@code{mapr}] (i.e., type an underscore at the
21006operator prompt) maps by rows instead. For example, @kbd{V M _ A} views
21007the above matrix as a vector of two 3-element row vectors. It produces
21008a new vector which contains the absolute values of those row vectors,
21009namely @expr{[3.74, 8.77]}. (Recall, the absolute value of a vector is
21010defined as the square root of the sum of the squares of the elements.)
21011Some operators accept vectors and return new vectors; for example,
21012@kbd{v v} reverses a vector, so @kbd{V M _ v v} would reverse each row
21013of the matrix to get a new matrix, @expr{[[3, -2, 1], [-6, 5, -4]]}.
21014
21015Sometimes a vector of vectors (representing, say, strings, sets, or lists)
21016happens to look like a matrix. If so, remember to use @kbd{V M _} if you
21017want to map a function across the whole strings or sets rather than across
21018their individual elements.
21019
21020@tindex mapc
21021The command @kbd{V M :} [@code{mapc}] maps by columns. Basically, it
21022transposes the input matrix, maps by rows, and then, if the result is a
21023matrix, transposes again. For example, @kbd{V M : A} takes the absolute
21024values of the three columns of the matrix, treating each as a 2-vector,
21025and @kbd{V M : v v} reverses the columns to get the matrix
21026@expr{[[-4, 5, -6], [1, -2, 3]]}.
21027
21028(The symbols @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} were chosen because they had row-like
21029and column-like appearances, and were not already taken by useful
21030operators. Also, they appear shifted on most keyboards so they are easy
21031to type after @kbd{V M}.)
21032
21033The @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} modifiers have no effect on arguments that are
21034not matrices (so if none of the arguments are matrices, they have no
21035effect at all). If some of the arguments are matrices and others are
21036plain numbers, the plain numbers are held constant for all rows of the
21037matrix (so that @kbd{2 V M _ ^} squares every row of a matrix; squaring
21038a vector takes a dot product of the vector with itself).
21039
21040If some of the arguments are vectors with the same lengths as the
21041rows (for @kbd{V M _}) or columns (for @kbd{V M :}) of the matrix
21042arguments, those vectors are also held constant for every row or
21043column.
21044
21045Sometimes it is useful to specify another mapping command as the operator
21046to use with @kbd{V M}. For example, @kbd{V M _ V A +} applies @kbd{V A +}
21047to each row of the input matrix, which in turn adds the two values on that
21048row. If you give another vector-operator command as the operator for
21049@kbd{V M}, it automatically uses map-by-rows mode if you don't specify
21050otherwise; thus @kbd{V M V A +} is equivalent to @kbd{V M _ V A +}. (If
21051you really want to map-by-elements another mapping command, you can use
21052a triple-nested mapping command: @kbd{V M V M V A +} means to map
21053@kbd{V M V A +} over the rows of the matrix; in turn, @kbd{V A +} is
21054mapped over the elements of each row.)
21055
21056@tindex mapa
21057@tindex mapd
21058Previous versions of Calc had ``map across'' and ``map down'' modes
21059that are now considered obsolete; the old ``map across'' is now simply
21060@kbd{V M V A}, and ``map down'' is now @kbd{V M : V A}. The algebraic
21061functions @code{mapa} and @code{mapd} are still supported, though.
21062Note also that, while the old mapping modes were persistent (once you
21063set the mode, it would apply to later mapping commands until you reset
21064it), the new @kbd{:} and @kbd{_} modifiers apply only to the current
21065mapping command. The default @kbd{V M} always means map-by-elements.
21066
21067@xref{Algebraic Manipulation}, for the @kbd{a M} command, which is like
21068@kbd{V M} but for equations and inequalities instead of vectors.
21069@xref{Storing Variables}, for the @kbd{s m} command which modifies a
21070variable's stored value using a @kbd{V M}-like operator.
21071
21072@node Reducing, Nesting and Fixed Points, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
21073@subsection Reducing
21074
21075@noindent
65d0154b 21076@kindex v R
4009494e
GM
21077@kindex V R
21078@pindex calc-reduce
21079@tindex reduce
21080The @kbd{V R} (@code{calc-reduce}) [@code{reduce}] command applies a given
21081binary operator across all the elements of a vector. A binary operator is
21082a function such as @code{+} or @code{max} which takes two arguments. For
21083example, reducing @code{+} over a vector computes the sum of the elements
21084of the vector. Reducing @code{-} computes the first element minus each of
21085the remaining elements. Reducing @code{max} computes the maximum element
21086and so on. In general, reducing @code{f} over the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]}
21087produces @samp{f(f(f(a, b), c), d)}.
21088
65d0154b 21089@kindex I v R
4009494e
GM
21090@kindex I V R
21091@tindex rreduce
21092The @kbd{I V R} [@code{rreduce}] command is similar to @kbd{V R} except
21093that works from right to left through the vector. For example, plain
21094@kbd{V R -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces @samp{a - b - c - d}
21095but @kbd{I V R -} on the same vector produces @samp{a - (b - (c - d))},
21096or @samp{a - b + c - d}. This ``alternating sum'' occurs frequently
21097in power series expansions.
21098
65d0154b 21099@kindex v U
4009494e
GM
21100@kindex V U
21101@tindex accum
21102The @kbd{V U} (@code{calc-accumulate}) [@code{accum}] command does an
21103accumulation operation. Here Calc does the corresponding reduction
21104operation, but instead of producing only the final result, it produces
21105a vector of all the intermediate results. Accumulating @code{+} over
21106the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the vector
21107@samp{[a, a + b, a + b + c, a + b + c + d]}.
21108
65d0154b 21109@kindex I v U
4009494e
GM
21110@kindex I V U
21111@tindex raccum
21112The @kbd{I V U} [@code{raccum}] command does a right-to-left accumulation.
21113For example, @kbd{I V U -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the
21114vector @samp{[a - b + c - d, b - c + d, c - d, d]}.
21115
21116@tindex reducea
21117@tindex rreducea
21118@tindex reduced
21119@tindex rreduced
21120As for @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R} normally reduces a matrix elementwise. For
21121example, given the matrix @expr{[[a, b, c], [d, e, f]]}, @kbd{V R +} will
21122compute @expr{a + b + c + d + e + f}. You can type @kbd{V R _} or
21123@kbd{V R :} to modify this behavior. The @kbd{V R _} [@code{reducea}]
21124command reduces ``across'' the matrix; it reduces each row of the matrix
21125as a vector, then collects the results. Thus @kbd{V R _ +} of this
21126matrix would produce @expr{[a + b + c, d + e + f]}. Similarly, @kbd{V R :}
21127[@code{reduced}] reduces down; @kbd{V R : +} would produce @expr{[a + d,
21128b + e, c + f]}.
21129
21130@tindex reducer
21131@tindex rreducer
21132There is a third ``by rows'' mode for reduction that is occasionally
21133useful; @kbd{V R =} [@code{reducer}] simply reduces the operator over
21134the rows of the matrix themselves. Thus @kbd{V R = +} on the above
21135matrix would get the same result as @kbd{V R : +}, since adding two
21136row vectors is equivalent to adding their elements. But @kbd{V R = *}
21137would multiply the two rows (to get a single number, their dot product),
21138while @kbd{V R : *} would produce a vector of the products of the columns.
21139
21140These three matrix reduction modes work with @kbd{V R} and @kbd{I V R},
21141but they are not currently supported with @kbd{V U} or @kbd{I V U}.
21142
21143@tindex reducec
21144@tindex rreducec
21145The obsolete reduce-by-columns function, @code{reducec}, is still
21146supported but there is no way to get it through the @kbd{V R} command.
21147
21148The commands @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are equivalent to typing
21149@kbd{C-x * r} to grab a rectangle of data into Calc, and then typing
21150@kbd{V R : +} or @kbd{V R _ +}, respectively, to sum the columns or
21151rows of the matrix. @xref{Grabbing From Buffers}.
21152
21153@node Nesting and Fixed Points, Generalized Products, Reducing, Reducing and Mapping
21154@subsection Nesting and Fixed Points
21155
21156@noindent
65d0154b 21157@kindex H v R
4009494e
GM
21158@kindex H V R
21159@tindex nest
21160The @kbd{H V R} [@code{nest}] command applies a function to a given
21161argument repeatedly. It takes two values, @samp{a} and @samp{n}, from
21162the stack, where @samp{n} must be an integer. It then applies the
21163function nested @samp{n} times; if the function is @samp{f} and @samp{n}
21164is 3, the result is @samp{f(f(f(a)))}. The number @samp{n} may be
21165negative if Calc knows an inverse for the function @samp{f}; for
21166example, @samp{nest(sin, a, -2)} returns @samp{arcsin(arcsin(a))}.
21167
65d0154b 21168@kindex H v U
4009494e
GM
21169@kindex H V U
21170@tindex anest
21171The @kbd{H V U} [@code{anest}] command is an accumulating version of
21172@code{nest}: It returns a vector of @samp{n+1} values, e.g.,
21173@samp{[a, f(a), f(f(a)), f(f(f(a)))]}. If @samp{n} is negative and
21174@samp{F} is the inverse of @samp{f}, then the result is of the
21175form @samp{[a, F(a), F(F(a)), F(F(F(a)))]}.
21176
65d0154b 21177@kindex H I v R
4009494e
GM
21178@kindex H I V R
21179@tindex fixp
21180@cindex Fixed points
21181The @kbd{H I V R} [@code{fixp}] command is like @kbd{H V R}, except
21182that it takes only an @samp{a} value from the stack; the function is
21183applied until it reaches a ``fixed point,'' i.e., until the result
21184no longer changes.
21185
65d0154b 21186@kindex H I v U
4009494e
GM
21187@kindex H I V U
21188@tindex afixp
21189The @kbd{H I V U} [@code{afixp}] command is an accumulating @code{fixp}.
21190The first element of the return vector will be the initial value @samp{a};
21191the last element will be the final result that would have been returned
21192by @code{fixp}.
21193
21194For example, 0.739085 is a fixed point of the cosine function (in radians):
21195@samp{cos(0.739085) = 0.739085}. You can find this value by putting, say,
211961.0 on the stack and typing @kbd{H I V U C}. (We use the accumulating
21197version so we can see the intermediate results: @samp{[1, 0.540302, 0.857553,
211980.65329, ...]}. With a precision of six, this command will take 36 steps
21199to converge to 0.739085.)
21200
21201Newton's method for finding roots is a classic example of iteration
21202to a fixed point. To find the square root of five starting with an
21203initial guess, Newton's method would look for a fixed point of the
21204function @samp{(x + 5/x) / 2}. Putting a guess of 1 on the stack
21205and typing @kbd{H I V R ' ($ + 5/$)/2 @key{RET}} quickly yields the result
212062.23607. This is equivalent to using the @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root})
21207command to find a root of the equation @samp{x^2 = 5}.
21208
21209These examples used numbers for @samp{a} values. Calc keeps applying
21210the function until two successive results are equal to within the
21211current precision. For complex numbers, both the real parts and the
21212imaginary parts must be equal to within the current precision. If
21213@samp{a} is a formula (say, a variable name), then the function is
21214applied until two successive results are exactly the same formula.
21215It is up to you to ensure that the function will eventually converge;
21216if it doesn't, you may have to press @kbd{C-g} to stop the Calculator.
21217
21218The algebraic @code{fixp} function takes two optional arguments, @samp{n}
21219and @samp{tol}. The first is the maximum number of steps to be allowed,
21220and must be either an integer or the symbol @samp{inf} (infinity, the
21221default). The second is a convergence tolerance. If a tolerance is
21222specified, all results during the calculation must be numbers, not
21223formulas, and the iteration stops when the magnitude of the difference
21224between two successive results is less than or equal to the tolerance.
21225(This implies that a tolerance of zero iterates until the results are
21226exactly equal.)
21227
21228Putting it all together, @samp{fixp(<(# + A/#)/2>, B, 20, 1e-10)}
21229computes the square root of @samp{A} given the initial guess @samp{B},
21230stopping when the result is correct within the specified tolerance, or
21231when 20 steps have been taken, whichever is sooner.
21232
21233@node Generalized Products, , Nesting and Fixed Points, Reducing and Mapping
21234@subsection Generalized Products
21235
65d0154b 21236@kindex v O
4009494e
GM
21237@kindex V O
21238@pindex calc-outer-product
21239@tindex outer
21240The @kbd{V O} (@code{calc-outer-product}) [@code{outer}] command applies
21241a given binary operator to all possible pairs of elements from two
21242vectors, to produce a matrix. For example, @kbd{V O *} with @samp{[a, b]}
21243and @samp{[x, y, z]} on the stack produces a multiplication table:
21244@samp{[[a x, a y, a z], [b x, b y, b z]]}. Element @var{r},@var{c} of
21245the result matrix is obtained by applying the operator to element @var{r}
21246of the lefthand vector and element @var{c} of the righthand vector.
21247
65d0154b 21248@kindex v I
4009494e
GM
21249@kindex V I
21250@pindex calc-inner-product
21251@tindex inner
21252The @kbd{V I} (@code{calc-inner-product}) [@code{inner}] command computes
21253the generalized inner product of two vectors or matrices, given a
21254``multiplicative'' operator and an ``additive'' operator. These can each
21255actually be any binary operators; if they are @samp{*} and @samp{+},
21256respectively, the result is a standard matrix multiplication. Element
21257@var{r},@var{c} of the result matrix is obtained by mapping the
21258multiplicative operator across row @var{r} of the lefthand matrix and
21259column @var{c} of the righthand matrix, and then reducing with the additive
21260operator. Just as for the standard @kbd{*} command, this can also do a
21261vector-matrix or matrix-vector inner product, or a vector-vector
21262generalized dot product.
21263
21264Since @kbd{V I} requires two operators, it prompts twice. In each case,
21265you can use any of the usual methods for entering the operator. If you
21266use @kbd{$} twice to take both operator formulas from the stack, the
21267first (multiplicative) operator is taken from the top of the stack
21268and the second (additive) operator is taken from second-to-top.
21269
21270@node Vector and Matrix Formats, , Reducing and Mapping, Matrix Functions
21271@section Vector and Matrix Display Formats
21272
21273@noindent
21274Commands for controlling vector and matrix display use the @kbd{v} prefix
21275instead of the usual @kbd{d} prefix. But they are display modes; in
21276particular, they are influenced by the @kbd{I} and @kbd{H} prefix keys
21277in the same way (@pxref{Display Modes}). Matrix display is also
21278influenced by the @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) mode;
21279@pxref{Normal Language Modes}.
21280
65d0154b 21281@kindex v <
4009494e
GM
21282@kindex V <
21283@pindex calc-matrix-left-justify
65d0154b 21284@kindex v =
4009494e
GM
21285@kindex V =
21286@pindex calc-matrix-center-justify
65d0154b 21287@kindex v >
4009494e
GM
21288@kindex V >
21289@pindex calc-matrix-right-justify
21290The commands @kbd{v <} (@code{calc-matrix-left-justify}), @kbd{v >}
21291(@code{calc-matrix-right-justify}), and @w{@kbd{v =}}
21292(@code{calc-matrix-center-justify}) control whether matrix elements
21293are justified to the left, right, or center of their columns.
21294
65d0154b 21295@kindex v [
4009494e
GM
21296@kindex V [
21297@pindex calc-vector-brackets
65d0154b 21298@kindex v @{
4009494e
GM
21299@kindex V @{
21300@pindex calc-vector-braces
65d0154b 21301@kindex v (
4009494e
GM
21302@kindex V (
21303@pindex calc-vector-parens
21304The @kbd{v [} (@code{calc-vector-brackets}) command turns the square
21305brackets that surround vectors and matrices displayed in the stack on
21306and off. The @kbd{v @{} (@code{calc-vector-braces}) and @kbd{v (}
21307(@code{calc-vector-parens}) commands use curly braces or parentheses,
21308respectively, instead of square brackets. For example, @kbd{v @{} might
21309be used in preparation for yanking a matrix into a buffer running
21310Mathematica. (In fact, the Mathematica language mode uses this mode;
21311@pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}.) Note that, regardless of the
21312display mode, either brackets or braces may be used to enter vectors,
21313and parentheses may never be used for this purpose.
21314
21315@kindex V ]
65d0154b
JB
21316@kindex v ]
21317@kindex V )
21318@kindex v )
21319@kindex V @}
21320@kindex v @}
4009494e
GM
21321@pindex calc-matrix-brackets
21322The @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) command controls the
65d0154b
JB
21323``big'' style display of matrices, for matrices which have more than
21324one row. It prompts for a string of code letters; currently
21325implemented letters are @code{R}, which enables brackets on each row
21326of the matrix; @code{O}, which enables outer brackets in opposite
21327corners of the matrix; and @code{C}, which enables commas or
21328semicolons at the ends of all rows but the last. The default format
21329is @samp{RO}. (Before Calc 2.00, the format was fixed at @samp{ROC}.)
21330Here are some example matrices:
4009494e
GM
21331
21332@example
21333@group
21334[ [ 123, 0, 0 ] [ [ 123, 0, 0 ],
21335 [ 0, 123, 0 ] [ 0, 123, 0 ],
21336 [ 0, 0, 123 ] ] [ 0, 0, 123 ] ]
21337
21338 RO ROC
21339
21340@end group
21341@end example
21342@noindent
21343@example
21344@group
21345 [ 123, 0, 0 [ 123, 0, 0 ;
21346 0, 123, 0 0, 123, 0 ;
21347 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123 ]
21348
21349 O OC
21350
21351@end group
21352@end example
21353@noindent
21354@example
21355@group
21356 [ 123, 0, 0 ] 123, 0, 0
21357 [ 0, 123, 0 ] 0, 123, 0
21358 [ 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123
21359
21360 R @r{blank}
21361@end group
21362@end example
21363
21364@noindent
21365Note that of the formats shown here, @samp{RO}, @samp{ROC}, and
21366@samp{OC} are all recognized as matrices during reading, while
21367the others are useful for display only.
21368
65d0154b 21369@kindex v ,
4009494e
GM
21370@kindex V ,
21371@pindex calc-vector-commas
21372The @kbd{v ,} (@code{calc-vector-commas}) command turns commas on and
21373off in vector and matrix display.
21374
21375In vectors of length one, and in all vectors when commas have been
21376turned off, Calc adds extra parentheses around formulas that might
21377otherwise be ambiguous. For example, @samp{[a b]} could be a vector
21378of the one formula @samp{a b}, or it could be a vector of two
21379variables with commas turned off. Calc will display the former
21380case as @samp{[(a b)]}. You can disable these extra parentheses
21381(to make the output less cluttered at the expense of allowing some
21382ambiguity) by adding the letter @code{P} to the control string you
21383give to @kbd{v ]} (as described above).
21384
65d0154b 21385@kindex v .
4009494e
GM
21386@kindex V .
21387@pindex calc-full-vectors
21388The @kbd{v .} (@code{calc-full-vectors}) command turns abbreviated
21389display of long vectors on and off. In this mode, vectors of six
21390or more elements, or matrices of six or more rows or columns, will
21391be displayed in an abbreviated form that displays only the first
21392three elements and the last element: @samp{[a, b, c, ..., z]}.
21393When very large vectors are involved this will substantially
21394improve Calc's display speed.
21395
21396@kindex t .
21397@pindex calc-full-trail-vectors
21398The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command controls a
21399similar mode for recording vectors in the Trail. If you turn on
21400this mode, vectors of six or more elements and matrices of six or
21401more rows or columns will be abbreviated when they are put in the
21402Trail. The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command will be
21403unable to recover those vectors. If you are working with very
21404large vectors, this mode will improve the speed of all operations
21405that involve the trail.
21406
65d0154b 21407@kindex v /
4009494e
GM
21408@kindex V /
21409@pindex calc-break-vectors
21410The @kbd{v /} (@code{calc-break-vectors}) command turns multi-line
21411vector display on and off. Normally, matrices are displayed with one
21412row per line but all other types of vectors are displayed in a single
21413line. This mode causes all vectors, whether matrices or not, to be
21414displayed with a single element per line. Sub-vectors within the
21415vectors will still use the normal linear form.
21416
21417@node Algebra, Units, Matrix Functions, Top
21418@chapter Algebra
21419
21420@noindent
21421This section covers the Calc features that help you work with
21422algebraic formulas. First, the general sub-formula selection
21423mechanism is described; this works in conjunction with any Calc
21424commands. Then, commands for specific algebraic operations are
21425described. Finally, the flexible @dfn{rewrite rule} mechanism
21426is discussed.
21427
21428The algebraic commands use the @kbd{a} key prefix; selection
21429commands use the @kbd{j} (for ``just a letter that wasn't used
21430for anything else'') prefix.
21431
21432@xref{Editing Stack Entries}, to see how to manipulate formulas
21433using regular Emacs editing commands.
21434
21435When doing algebraic work, you may find several of the Calculator's
21436modes to be helpful, including Algebraic Simplification mode (@kbd{m A})
21437or No-Simplification mode (@kbd{m O}),
21438Algebraic entry mode (@kbd{m a}), Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}), and
21439Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}). @xref{Mode Settings}, for discussions
21440of these modes. You may also wish to select Big display mode (@kbd{d B}).
21441@xref{Normal Language Modes}.
21442
21443@menu
21444* Selecting Subformulas::
21445* Algebraic Manipulation::
21446* Simplifying Formulas::
21447* Polynomials::
21448* Calculus::
21449* Solving Equations::
21450* Numerical Solutions::
21451* Curve Fitting::
21452* Summations::
21453* Logical Operations::
21454* Rewrite Rules::
21455@end menu
21456
21457@node Selecting Subformulas, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra, Algebra
21458@section Selecting Sub-Formulas
21459
21460@noindent
21461@cindex Selections
21462@cindex Sub-formulas
21463@cindex Parts of formulas
21464When working with an algebraic formula it is often necessary to
21465manipulate a portion of the formula rather than the formula as a
21466whole. Calc allows you to ``select'' a portion of any formula on
21467the stack. Commands which would normally operate on that stack
21468entry will now operate only on the sub-formula, leaving the
21469surrounding part of the stack entry alone.
21470
21471One common non-algebraic use for selection involves vectors. To work
21472on one element of a vector in-place, simply select that element as a
21473``sub-formula'' of the vector.
21474
21475@menu
21476* Making Selections::
21477* Changing Selections::
21478* Displaying Selections::
21479* Operating on Selections::
21480* Rearranging with Selections::
21481@end menu
21482
21483@node Making Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas, Selecting Subformulas
21484@subsection Making Selections
21485
21486@noindent
21487@kindex j s
21488@pindex calc-select-here
21489To select a sub-formula, move the Emacs cursor to any character in that
21490sub-formula, and press @w{@kbd{j s}} (@code{calc-select-here}). Calc will
21491highlight the smallest portion of the formula that contains that
21492character. By default the sub-formula is highlighted by blanking out
21493all of the rest of the formula with dots. Selection works in any
21494display mode but is perhaps easiest in Big mode (@kbd{d B}).
21495Suppose you enter the following formula:
21496
21497@smallexample
21498@group
21499 3 ___
21500 (a + b) + V c
215011: ---------------
21502 2 x + 1
21503@end group
21504@end smallexample
21505
21506@noindent
21507(by typing @kbd{' ((a+b)^3 + sqrt(c)) / (2x+1)}). If you move the
21508cursor to the letter @samp{b} and press @w{@kbd{j s}}, the display changes
21509to
21510
21511@smallexample
21512@group
21513 . ...
21514 .. . b. . . .
215151* ...............
21516 . . . .
21517@end group
21518@end smallexample
21519
21520@noindent
21521Every character not part of the sub-formula @samp{b} has been changed
2c695727
JB
21522to a dot. (If the customizable variable
21523@code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is non-nil, then the characters
21524not part of the sub-formula are de-emphasized by using a less
21525noticeable face instead of using dots. @pxref{Displaying Selections}.)
21526The @samp{*} next to the line number is to remind you that
4009494e
GM
21527the formula has a portion of it selected. (In this case, it's very
21528obvious, but it might not always be. If Embedded mode is enabled,
21529the word @samp{Sel} also appears in the mode line because the stack
21530may not be visible. @pxref{Embedded Mode}.)
21531
21532If you had instead placed the cursor on the parenthesis immediately to
21533the right of the @samp{b}, the selection would have been:
21534
21535@smallexample
21536@group
21537 . ...
21538 (a + b) . . .
215391* ...............
21540 . . . .
21541@end group
21542@end smallexample
21543
21544@noindent
21545The portion selected is always large enough to be considered a complete
21546formula all by itself, so selecting the parenthesis selects the whole
21547formula that it encloses. Putting the cursor on the @samp{+} sign
21548would have had the same effect.
21549
21550(Strictly speaking, the Emacs cursor is really the manifestation of
21551the Emacs ``point,'' which is a position @emph{between} two characters
21552in the buffer. So purists would say that Calc selects the smallest
21553sub-formula which contains the character to the right of ``point.'')
21554
21555If you supply a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, the selection is
21556expanded to the @var{n}th enclosing sub-formula. Thus, positioning
21557the cursor on the @samp{b} and typing @kbd{C-u 1 j s} will select
21558@samp{a + b}; typing @kbd{C-u 2 j s} will select @samp{(a + b)^3},
21559and so on.
21560
21561If the cursor is not on any part of the formula, or if you give a
21562numeric prefix that is too large, the entire formula is selected.
21563
21564If the cursor is on the @samp{.} line that marks the top of the stack
21565(i.e., its normal ``rest position''), this command selects the entire
21566formula at stack level 1. Most selection commands similarly operate
21567on the formula at the top of the stack if you haven't positioned the
21568cursor on any stack entry.
21569
21570@kindex j a
21571@pindex calc-select-additional
21572The @kbd{j a} (@code{calc-select-additional}) command enlarges the
21573current selection to encompass the cursor. To select the smallest
21574sub-formula defined by two different points, move to the first and
21575press @kbd{j s}, then move to the other and press @kbd{j a}. This
21576is roughly analogous to using @kbd{C-@@} (@code{set-mark-command}) to
21577select the two ends of a region of text during normal Emacs editing.
21578
21579@kindex j o
21580@pindex calc-select-once
21581The @kbd{j o} (@code{calc-select-once}) command selects a formula in
21582exactly the same way as @kbd{j s}, except that the selection will
21583last only as long as the next command that uses it. For example,
21584@kbd{j o 1 +} is a handy way to add one to the sub-formula indicated
21585by the cursor.
21586
21587(A somewhat more precise definition: The @kbd{j o} command sets a flag
21588such that the next command involving selected stack entries will clear
21589the selections on those stack entries afterwards. All other selection
21590commands except @kbd{j a} and @kbd{j O} clear this flag.)
21591
21592@kindex j S
21593@kindex j O
21594@pindex calc-select-here-maybe
21595@pindex calc-select-once-maybe
21596The @kbd{j S} (@code{calc-select-here-maybe}) and @kbd{j O}
21597(@code{calc-select-once-maybe}) commands are equivalent to @kbd{j s}
21598and @kbd{j o}, respectively, except that if the formula already
21599has a selection they have no effect. This is analogous to the
21600behavior of some commands such as @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection};
21601@pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}) and is mainly intended to be
21602used in keyboard macros that implement your own selection-oriented
21603commands.
21604
21605Selection of sub-formulas normally treats associative terms like
21606@samp{a + b - c + d} and @samp{x * y * z} as single levels of the formula.
21607If you place the cursor anywhere inside @samp{a + b - c + d} except
21608on one of the variable names and use @kbd{j s}, you will select the
21609entire four-term sum.
21610
21611@kindex j b
21612@pindex calc-break-selections
21613The @kbd{j b} (@code{calc-break-selections}) command controls a mode
21614in which the ``deep structure'' of these associative formulas shows
45b778a6
JB
21615through. Calc actually stores the above formulas as
21616@samp{((a + b) - c) + d} and @samp{x * (y * z)}. (Note that for certain
21617obscure reasons, by default Calc treats multiplication as
21618right-associative.) Once you have enabled @kbd{j b} mode, selecting
21619with the cursor on the @samp{-} sign would only select the @samp{a + b -
21620c} portion, which makes sense when the deep structure of the sum is
21621considered. There is no way to select the @samp{b - c + d} portion;
21622although this might initially look like just as legitimate a sub-formula
21623as @samp{a + b - c}, the deep structure shows that it isn't. The @kbd{d
21624U} command can be used to view the deep structure of any formula
21625(@pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
4009494e
GM
21626
21627When @kbd{j b} mode has not been enabled, the deep structure is
21628generally hidden by the selection commands---what you see is what
21629you get.
21630
21631@kindex j u
21632@pindex calc-unselect
21633The @kbd{j u} (@code{calc-unselect}) command unselects the formula
21634that the cursor is on. If there was no selection in the formula,
21635this command has no effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it
21636unselects the @var{n}th stack element rather than using the cursor
21637position.
21638
21639@kindex j c
21640@pindex calc-clear-selections
21641The @kbd{j c} (@code{calc-clear-selections}) command unselects all
21642stack elements.
21643
21644@node Changing Selections, Displaying Selections, Making Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21645@subsection Changing Selections
21646
21647@noindent
21648@kindex j m
21649@pindex calc-select-more
21650Once you have selected a sub-formula, you can expand it using the
21651@w{@kbd{j m}} (@code{calc-select-more}) command. If @samp{a + b} is
21652selected, pressing @w{@kbd{j m}} repeatedly works as follows:
21653
21654@smallexample
21655@group
21656 3 ... 3 ___ 3 ___
21657 (a + b) . . . (a + b) + V c (a + b) + V c
216581* ............... 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21659 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21660@end group
21661@end smallexample
21662
21663@noindent
21664In the last example, the entire formula is selected. This is roughly
21665the same as having no selection at all, but because there are subtle
21666differences the @samp{*} character is still there on the line number.
21667
21668With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, @kbd{j m} expands @var{n}
21669times (or until the entire formula is selected). Note that @kbd{j s}
21670with argument @var{n} is equivalent to plain @kbd{j s} followed by
21671@kbd{j m} with argument @var{n}. If @w{@kbd{j m}} is used when there
21672is no current selection, it is equivalent to @w{@kbd{j s}}.
21673
21674Even though @kbd{j m} does not explicitly use the location of the
21675cursor within the formula, it nevertheless uses the cursor to determine
21676which stack element to operate on. As usual, @kbd{j m} when the cursor
21677is not on any stack element operates on the top stack element.
21678
21679@kindex j l
21680@pindex calc-select-less
21681The @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) command reduces the current
21682selection around the cursor position. That is, it selects the
21683immediate sub-formula of the current selection which contains the
21684cursor, the opposite of @kbd{j m}. If the cursor is not inside the
21685current selection, the command de-selects the formula.
21686
21687@kindex j 1-9
21688@pindex calc-select-part
21689The @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} (@code{calc-select-part}) commands
21690select the @var{n}th sub-formula of the current selection. They are
21691like @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) except they use counting
21692rather than the cursor position to decide which sub-formula to select.
21693For example, if the current selection is @kbd{a + b + c} or
21694@kbd{f(a, b, c)} or @kbd{[a, b, c]}, then @kbd{j 1} selects @samp{a},
21695@kbd{j 2} selects @samp{b}, and @kbd{j 3} selects @samp{c}; in each of
21696these cases, @kbd{j 4} through @kbd{j 9} would be errors.
21697
21698If there is no current selection, @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} select
21699the @var{n}th top-level sub-formula. (In other words, they act as if
21700the entire stack entry were selected first.) To select the @var{n}th
21701sub-formula where @var{n} is greater than nine, you must instead invoke
21702@w{@kbd{j 1}} with @var{n} as a numeric prefix argument.
21703
21704@kindex j n
21705@kindex j p
21706@pindex calc-select-next
21707@pindex calc-select-previous
21708The @kbd{j n} (@code{calc-select-next}) and @kbd{j p}
21709(@code{calc-select-previous}) commands change the current selection
21710to the next or previous sub-formula at the same level. For example,
21711if @samp{b} is selected in @w{@samp{2 + a*b*c + x}}, then @kbd{j n}
21712selects @samp{c}. Further @kbd{j n} commands would be in error because,
21713even though there is something to the right of @samp{c} (namely, @samp{x}),
21714it is not at the same level; in this case, it is not a term of the
21715same product as @samp{b} and @samp{c}. However, @kbd{j m} (to select
21716the whole product @samp{a*b*c} as a term of the sum) followed by
21717@w{@kbd{j n}} would successfully select the @samp{x}.
21718
21719Similarly, @kbd{j p} moves the selection from the @samp{b} in this
21720sample formula to the @samp{a}. Both commands accept numeric prefix
21721arguments to move several steps at a time.
21722
21723It is interesting to compare Calc's selection commands with the
21724Emacs Info system's commands for navigating through hierarchically
21725organized documentation. Calc's @kbd{j n} command is completely
21726analogous to Info's @kbd{n} command. Likewise, @kbd{j p} maps to
21727@kbd{p}, @kbd{j 2} maps to @kbd{2}, and Info's @kbd{u} is like @kbd{j m}.
21728(Note that @kbd{j u} stands for @code{calc-unselect}, not ``up''.)
21729The Info @kbd{m} command is somewhat similar to Calc's @kbd{j s} and
21730@kbd{j l}; in each case, you can jump directly to a sub-component
21731of the hierarchy simply by pointing to it with the cursor.
21732
21733@node Displaying Selections, Operating on Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21734@subsection Displaying Selections
21735
21736@noindent
21737@kindex j d
21738@pindex calc-show-selections
2c695727
JB
21739@vindex calc-highlight-selections-with-faces
21740@vindex calc-selected-face
21741@vindex calc-nonselected-face
4009494e
GM
21742The @kbd{j d} (@code{calc-show-selections}) command controls how
21743selected sub-formulas are displayed. One of the alternatives is
21744illustrated in the above examples; if we press @kbd{j d} we switch
21745to the other style in which the selected portion itself is obscured
21746by @samp{#} signs:
21747
21748@smallexample
21749@group
21750 3 ... # ___
21751 (a + b) . . . ## # ## + V c
217521* ............... 1* ---------------
21753 . . . . 2 x + 1
21754@end group
21755@end smallexample
2c695727
JB
21756If the customizable variable
21757@code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is non-nil, then the
21758non-selected portion of the formula will be de-emphasized by using a
21759less noticeable face (@code{calc-nonselected-face}) instead of dots
21760and the selected sub-formula will be highlighted by using a more
21761noticeable face (@code{calc-selected-face}) instead of @samp{#}
21762signs. (@pxref{Customizing Calc}.)
4009494e
GM
21763
21764@node Operating on Selections, Rearranging with Selections, Displaying Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21765@subsection Operating on Selections
21766
21767@noindent
21768Once a selection is made, all Calc commands that manipulate items
21769on the stack will operate on the selected portions of the items
21770instead. (Note that several stack elements may have selections
21771at once, though there can be only one selection at a time in any
21772given stack element.)
21773
21774@kindex j e
21775@pindex calc-enable-selections
21776The @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command disables the
21777effect that selections have on Calc commands. The current selections
21778still exist, but Calc commands operate on whole stack elements anyway.
21779This mode can be identified by the fact that the @samp{*} markers on
21780the line numbers are gone, even though selections are visible. To
21781reactivate the selections, press @kbd{j e} again.
21782
21783To extract a sub-formula as a new formula, simply select the
21784sub-formula and press @key{RET}. This normally duplicates the top
21785stack element; here it duplicates only the selected portion of that
21786element.
21787
21788To replace a sub-formula with something different, you can enter the
21789new value onto the stack and press @key{TAB}. This normally exchanges
21790the top two stack elements; here it swaps the value you entered into
21791the selected portion of the formula, returning the old selected
21792portion to the top of the stack.
21793
21794@smallexample
21795@group
21796 3 ... ... ___
21797 (a + b) . . . 17 x y . . . 17 x y + V c
217982* ............... 2* ............. 2: -------------
21799 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21800
21801 3 3
218021: 17 x y 1: (a + b) 1: (a + b)
21803@end group
21804@end smallexample
21805
21806In this example we select a sub-formula of our original example,
21807enter a new formula, @key{TAB} it into place, then deselect to see
21808the complete, edited formula.
21809
21810If you want to swap whole formulas around even though they contain
21811selections, just use @kbd{j e} before and after.
21812
21813@kindex j '
21814@pindex calc-enter-selection
21815The @kbd{j '} (@code{calc-enter-selection}) command is another way
21816to replace a selected sub-formula. This command does an algebraic
21817entry just like the regular @kbd{'} key. When you press @key{RET},
21818the formula you type replaces the original selection. You can use
21819the @samp{$} symbol in the formula to refer to the original
21820selection. If there is no selection in the formula under the cursor,
21821the cursor is used to make a temporary selection for the purposes of
21822the command. Thus, to change a term of a formula, all you have to
21823do is move the Emacs cursor to that term and press @kbd{j '}.
21824
21825@kindex j `
21826@pindex calc-edit-selection
21827The @kbd{j `} (@code{calc-edit-selection}) command is a similar
21828analogue of the @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command. It edits the
21829selected sub-formula in a separate buffer. If there is no
21830selection, it edits the sub-formula indicated by the cursor.
21831
21832To delete a sub-formula, press @key{DEL}. This generally replaces
21833the sub-formula with the constant zero, but in a few suitable contexts
21834it uses the constant one instead. The @key{DEL} key automatically
21835deselects and re-simplifies the entire formula afterwards. Thus:
21836
21837@smallexample
21838@group
21839 ###
21840 17 x y + # # 17 x y 17 # y 17 y
218411* ------------- 1: ------- 1* ------- 1: -------
21842 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1
21843@end group
21844@end smallexample
21845
21846In this example, we first delete the @samp{sqrt(c)} term; Calc
21847accomplishes this by replacing @samp{sqrt(c)} with zero and
21848resimplifying. We then delete the @kbd{x} in the numerator;
21849since this is part of a product, Calc replaces it with @samp{1}
21850and resimplifies.
21851
21852If you select an element of a vector and press @key{DEL}, that
21853element is deleted from the vector. If you delete one side of
21854an equation or inequality, only the opposite side remains.
21855
21856@kindex j @key{DEL}
21857@pindex calc-del-selection
21858The @kbd{j @key{DEL}} (@code{calc-del-selection}) command is like
21859@key{DEL} but with the auto-selecting behavior of @kbd{j '} and
21860@kbd{j `}. It deletes the selected portion of the formula
21861indicated by the cursor, or, in the absence of a selection, it
21862deletes the sub-formula indicated by the cursor position.
21863
21864@kindex j @key{RET}
21865@pindex calc-grab-selection
21866(There is also an auto-selecting @kbd{j @key{RET}} (@code{calc-copy-selection})
21867command.)
21868
21869Normal arithmetic operations also apply to sub-formulas. Here we
21870select the denominator, press @kbd{5 -} to subtract five from the
21871denominator, press @kbd{n} to negate the denominator, then
21872press @kbd{Q} to take the square root.
21873
21874@smallexample
21875@group
21876 .. . .. . .. . .. .
218771* ....... 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ..........
21878 2 x + 1 2 x - 4 4 - 2 x _________
21879 V 4 - 2 x
21880@end group
21881@end smallexample
21882
21883Certain types of operations on selections are not allowed. For
21884example, for an arithmetic function like @kbd{-} no more than one of
21885the arguments may be a selected sub-formula. (As the above example
21886shows, the result of the subtraction is spliced back into the argument
21887which had the selection; if there were more than one selection involved,
21888this would not be well-defined.) If you try to subtract two selections,
21889the command will abort with an error message.
21890
21891Operations on sub-formulas sometimes leave the formula as a whole
21892in an ``un-natural'' state. Consider negating the @samp{2 x} term
21893of our sample formula by selecting it and pressing @kbd{n}
21894(@code{calc-change-sign}).
21895
21896@smallexample
21897@group
21898 .. . .. .
218991* .......... 1* ...........
21900 ......... ..........
21901 . . . 2 x . . . -2 x
21902@end group
21903@end smallexample
21904
21905Unselecting the sub-formula reveals that the minus sign, which would
21906normally have cancelled out with the subtraction automatically, has
21907not been able to do so because the subtraction was not part of the
21908selected portion. Pressing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) or doing
21909any other mathematical operation on the whole formula will cause it
21910to be simplified.
21911
21912@smallexample
21913@group
21914 17 y 17 y
219151: ----------- 1: ----------
21916 __________ _________
21917 V 4 - -2 x V 4 + 2 x
21918@end group
21919@end smallexample
21920
21921@node Rearranging with Selections, , Operating on Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21922@subsection Rearranging Formulas using Selections
21923
21924@noindent
21925@kindex j R
21926@pindex calc-commute-right
21927The @kbd{j R} (@code{calc-commute-right}) command moves the selected
21928sub-formula to the right in its surrounding formula. Generally the
21929selection is one term of a sum or product; the sum or product is
21930rearranged according to the commutative laws of algebra.
21931
21932As with @kbd{j '} and @kbd{j @key{DEL}}, the term under the cursor is used
21933if there is no selection in the current formula. All commands described
21934in this section share this property. In this example, we place the
21935cursor on the @samp{a} and type @kbd{j R}, then repeat.
21936
21937@smallexample
219381: a + b - c 1: b + a - c 1: b - c + a
21939@end smallexample
21940
21941@noindent
21942Note that in the final step above, the @samp{a} is switched with
21943the @samp{c} but the signs are adjusted accordingly. When moving
21944terms of sums and products, @kbd{j R} will never change the
21945mathematical meaning of the formula.
21946
21947The selected term may also be an element of a vector or an argument
21948of a function. The term is exchanged with the one to its right.
21949In this case, the ``meaning'' of the vector or function may of
21950course be drastically changed.
21951
21952@smallexample
219531: [a, b, c] 1: [b, a, c] 1: [b, c, a]
21954
219551: f(a, b, c) 1: f(b, a, c) 1: f(b, c, a)
21956@end smallexample
21957
21958@kindex j L
21959@pindex calc-commute-left
21960The @kbd{j L} (@code{calc-commute-left}) command is like @kbd{j R}
21961except that it swaps the selected term with the one to its left.
21962
21963With numeric prefix arguments, these commands move the selected
21964term several steps at a time. It is an error to try to move a
21965term left or right past the end of its enclosing formula.
21966With numeric prefix arguments of zero, these commands move the
21967selected term as far as possible in the given direction.
21968
21969@kindex j D
21970@pindex calc-sel-distribute
21971The @kbd{j D} (@code{calc-sel-distribute}) command mixes the selected
21972sum or product into the surrounding formula using the distributive
21973law. For example, in @samp{a * (b - c)} with the @samp{b - c}
21974selected, the result is @samp{a b - a c}. This also distributes
21975products or quotients into surrounding powers, and can also do
21976transformations like @samp{exp(a + b)} to @samp{exp(a) exp(b)},
21977where @samp{a + b} is the selected term, and @samp{ln(a ^ b)}
21978to @samp{ln(a) b}, where @samp{a ^ b} is the selected term.
21979
21980For multiple-term sums or products, @kbd{j D} takes off one term
21981at a time: @samp{a * (b + c - d)} goes to @samp{a * (c - d) + a b}
21982with the @samp{c - d} selected so that you can type @kbd{j D}
21983repeatedly to expand completely. The @kbd{j D} command allows a
21984numeric prefix argument which specifies the maximum number of
21985times to expand at once; the default is one time only.
21986
21987@vindex DistribRules
21988The @kbd{j D} command is implemented using rewrite rules.
21989@xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}. The rules are stored in
21990the Calc variable @code{DistribRules}. A convenient way to view
21991these rules is to use @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) which
21992displays and edits the stored value of a variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c}
21993to return from editing mode; be careful not to make any actual changes
21994or else you will affect the behavior of future @kbd{j D} commands!
21995
21996To extend @kbd{j D} to handle new cases, just edit @code{DistribRules}
21997as described above. You can then use the @kbd{s p} command to save
21998this variable's value permanently for future Calc sessions.
21999@xref{Operations on Variables}.
22000
22001@kindex j M
22002@pindex calc-sel-merge
22003@vindex MergeRules
22004The @kbd{j M} (@code{calc-sel-merge}) command is the complement
22005of @kbd{j D}; given @samp{a b - a c} with either @samp{a b} or
22006@samp{a c} selected, the result is @samp{a * (b - c)}. Once
22007again, @kbd{j M} can also merge calls to functions like @code{exp}
22008and @code{ln}; examine the variable @code{MergeRules} to see all
22009the relevant rules.
22010
22011@kindex j C
22012@pindex calc-sel-commute
22013@vindex CommuteRules
22014The @kbd{j C} (@code{calc-sel-commute}) command swaps the arguments
22015of the selected sum, product, or equation. It always behaves as
22016if @kbd{j b} mode were in effect, i.e., the sum @samp{a + b + c} is
22017treated as the nested sums @samp{(a + b) + c} by this command.
22018If you put the cursor on the first @samp{+}, the result is
22019@samp{(b + a) + c}; if you put the cursor on the second @samp{+}, the
22020result is @samp{c + (a + b)} (which the default simplifications
22021will rearrange to @samp{(c + a) + b}). The relevant rules are stored
22022in the variable @code{CommuteRules}.
22023
22024You may need to turn default simplifications off (with the @kbd{m O}
22025command) in order to get the full benefit of @kbd{j C}. For example,
22026commuting @samp{a - b} produces @samp{-b + a}, but the default
22027simplifications will ``simplify'' this right back to @samp{a - b} if
22028you don't turn them off. The same is true of some of the other
22029manipulations described in this section.
22030
22031@kindex j N
22032@pindex calc-sel-negate
22033@vindex NegateRules
22034The @kbd{j N} (@code{calc-sel-negate}) command replaces the selected
22035term with the negative of that term, then adjusts the surrounding
22036formula in order to preserve the meaning. For example, given
22037@samp{exp(a - b)} where @samp{a - b} is selected, the result is
22038@samp{1 / exp(b - a)}. By contrast, selecting a term and using the
22039regular @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the
22040term without adjusting the surroundings, thus changing the meaning
22041of the formula as a whole. The rules variable is @code{NegateRules}.
22042
22043@kindex j &
22044@pindex calc-sel-invert
22045@vindex InvertRules
22046The @kbd{j &} (@code{calc-sel-invert}) command is similar to @kbd{j N}
22047except it takes the reciprocal of the selected term. For example,
22048given @samp{a - ln(b)} with @samp{b} selected, the result is
22049@samp{a + ln(1/b)}. The rules variable is @code{InvertRules}.
22050
22051@kindex j E
22052@pindex calc-sel-jump-equals
22053@vindex JumpRules
22054The @kbd{j E} (@code{calc-sel-jump-equals}) command moves the
22055selected term from one side of an equation to the other. Given
22056@samp{a + b = c + d} with @samp{c} selected, the result is
22057@samp{a + b - c = d}. This command also works if the selected
22058term is part of a @samp{*}, @samp{/}, or @samp{^} formula. The
22059relevant rules variable is @code{JumpRules}.
22060
22061@kindex j I
22062@kindex H j I
22063@pindex calc-sel-isolate
22064The @kbd{j I} (@code{calc-sel-isolate}) command isolates the
22065selected term on its side of an equation. It uses the @kbd{a S}
22066(@code{calc-solve-for}) command to solve the equation, and the
22067Hyperbolic flag affects it in the same way. @xref{Solving Equations}.
22068When it applies, @kbd{j I} is often easier to use than @kbd{j E}.
22069It understands more rules of algebra, and works for inequalities
22070as well as equations.
22071
22072@kindex j *
22073@kindex j /
22074@pindex calc-sel-mult-both-sides
22075@pindex calc-sel-div-both-sides
22076The @kbd{j *} (@code{calc-sel-mult-both-sides}) command prompts for a
22077formula using algebraic entry, then multiplies both sides of the
22078selected quotient or equation by that formula. It simplifies each
22079side with @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) before re-forming the
22080quotient or equation. You can suppress this simplification by
5fafc247 22081providing a prefix argument: @kbd{C-u j *}. There is also a @kbd{j /}
4009494e
GM
22082(@code{calc-sel-div-both-sides}) which is similar to @kbd{j *} but
22083dividing instead of multiplying by the factor you enter.
22084
5fafc247
JB
22085If the selection is a quotient with numerator 1, then Calc's default
22086simplifications would normally cancel the new factors. To prevent
22087this, when the @kbd{j *} command is used on a selection whose numerator is
220881 or -1, the denominator is expanded at the top level using the
22089distributive law (as if using the @kbd{C-u 1 a x} command). Suppose the
22090formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (a + 1)} and you wish to multiplying the
22091top and bottom by @samp{a - 1}. Calc's default simplifications would
22092normally change the result @samp{(a - 1) /(a + 1) (a - 1)} back
22093to the original form by cancellation; when @kbd{j *} is used, Calc
22094expands the denominator to @samp{a (a - 1) + a - 1} to prevent this.
22095
22096If you wish the @kbd{j *} command to completely expand the denominator
22097of a quotient you can call it with a zero prefix: @kbd{C-u 0 j *}. For
22098example, if the formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (sqrt(a) + 1)}, you may
22099wish to eliminate the square root in the denominator by multiplying
22100the top and bottom by @samp{sqrt(a) - 1}. If you did this simply by using
22101a simple @kbd{j *} command, you would get
22102@samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/ (sqrt(a) (sqrt(a) - 1) + sqrt(a) - 1)}. Instead,
22103you would probably want to use @kbd{C-u 0 j *}, which would expand the
22104bottom and give you the desired result @samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/(a-1)}. More
22105generally, if @kbd{j *} is called with an argument of a positive
22106integer @var{n}, then the denominator of the expression will be
22107expanded @var{n} times (as if with the @kbd{C-u @var{n} a x} command).
4009494e
GM
22108
22109If the selection is an inequality, @kbd{j *} and @kbd{j /} will
22110accept any factor, but will warn unless they can prove the factor
22111is either positive or negative. (In the latter case the direction
22112of the inequality will be switched appropriately.) @xref{Declarations},
22113for ways to inform Calc that a given variable is positive or
22114negative. If Calc can't tell for sure what the sign of the factor
22115will be, it will assume it is positive and display a warning
22116message.
22117
22118For selections that are not quotients, equations, or inequalities,
22119these commands pull out a multiplicative factor: They divide (or
22120multiply) by the entered formula, simplify, then multiply (or divide)
22121back by the formula.
22122
22123@kindex j +
22124@kindex j -
22125@pindex calc-sel-add-both-sides
22126@pindex calc-sel-sub-both-sides
22127The @kbd{j +} (@code{calc-sel-add-both-sides}) and @kbd{j -}
22128(@code{calc-sel-sub-both-sides}) commands analogously add to or
22129subtract from both sides of an equation or inequality. For other
22130types of selections, they extract an additive factor. A numeric
22131prefix argument suppresses simplification of the intermediate
22132results.
22133
22134@kindex j U
22135@pindex calc-sel-unpack
22136The @kbd{j U} (@code{calc-sel-unpack}) command replaces the
22137selected function call with its argument. For example, given
22138@samp{a + sin(x^2)} with @samp{sin(x^2)} selected, the result
22139is @samp{a + x^2}. (The @samp{x^2} will remain selected; if you
22140wanted to change the @code{sin} to @code{cos}, just press @kbd{C}
22141now to take the cosine of the selected part.)
22142
22143@kindex j v
22144@pindex calc-sel-evaluate
22145The @kbd{j v} (@code{calc-sel-evaluate}) command performs the
22146normal default simplifications on the selected sub-formula.
22147These are the simplifications that are normally done automatically
22148on all results, but which may have been partially inhibited by
22149previous selection-related operations, or turned off altogether
22150by the @kbd{m O} command. This command is just an auto-selecting
22151version of the @w{@kbd{a v}} command (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}).
22152
22153With a numeric prefix argument of 2, @kbd{C-u 2 j v} applies
22154the @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) command to the selected
22155sub-formula. With a prefix argument of 3 or more, e.g., @kbd{C-u j v}
22156applies the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) command.
22157@xref{Simplifying Formulas}. With a negative prefix argument
22158it simplifies at the top level only, just as with @kbd{a v}.
22159Here the ``top'' level refers to the top level of the selected
22160sub-formula.
22161
22162@kindex j "
22163@pindex calc-sel-expand-formula
22164The @kbd{j "} (@code{calc-sel-expand-formula}) command is to @kbd{a "}
22165(@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}) what @kbd{j v} is to @kbd{a v}.
22166
22167You can use the @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command
22168to define other algebraic operations on sub-formulas. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22169
22170@node Algebraic Manipulation, Simplifying Formulas, Selecting Subformulas, Algebra
22171@section Algebraic Manipulation
22172
22173@noindent
22174The commands in this section perform general-purpose algebraic
22175manipulations. They work on the whole formula at the top of the
22176stack (unless, of course, you have made a selection in that
22177formula).
22178
22179Many algebra commands prompt for a variable name or formula. If you
22180answer the prompt with a blank line, the variable or formula is taken
22181from top-of-stack, and the normal argument for the command is taken
22182from the second-to-top stack level.
22183
22184@kindex a v
22185@pindex calc-alg-evaluate
22186The @kbd{a v} (@code{calc-alg-evaluate}) command performs the normal
22187default simplifications on a formula; for example, @samp{a - -b} is
22188changed to @samp{a + b}. These simplifications are normally done
22189automatically on all Calc results, so this command is useful only if
22190you have turned default simplifications off with an @kbd{m O}
22191command. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
22192
22193It is often more convenient to type @kbd{=}, which is like @kbd{a v}
22194but which also substitutes stored values for variables in the formula.
22195Use @kbd{a v} if you want the variables to ignore their stored values.
22196
22197If you give a numeric prefix argument of 2 to @kbd{a v}, it simplifies
22198as if in Algebraic Simplification mode. This is equivalent to typing
22199@kbd{a s}; @pxref{Simplifying Formulas}. If you give a numeric prefix
22200of 3 or more, it uses Extended Simplification mode (@kbd{a e}).
22201
22202If you give a negative prefix argument @mathit{-1}, @mathit{-2}, or @mathit{-3},
22203it simplifies in the corresponding mode but only works on the top-level
22204function call of the formula. For example, @samp{(2 + 3) * (2 + 3)} will
22205simplify to @samp{(2 + 3)^2}, without simplifying the sub-formulas
22206@samp{2 + 3}. As another example, typing @kbd{V R +} to sum the vector
22207@samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]} produces the formula @samp{reduce(add, [1, 2, 3, 4])}
22208in No-Simplify mode. Using @kbd{a v} will evaluate this all the way to
2220910; using @kbd{C-u - a v} will evaluate it only to @samp{1 + 2 + 3 + 4}.
22210(@xref{Reducing and Mapping}.)
22211
22212@tindex evalv
22213@tindex evalvn
22214The @kbd{=} command corresponds to the @code{evalv} function, and
22215the related @kbd{N} command, which is like @kbd{=} but temporarily
22216disables Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}) during the evaluation, corresponds
22217to the @code{evalvn} function. (These commands interpret their prefix
22218arguments differently than @kbd{a v}; @kbd{=} treats the prefix as
22219the number of stack elements to evaluate at once, and @kbd{N} treats
22220it as a temporary different working precision.)
22221
22222The @code{evalvn} function can take an alternate working precision
22223as an optional second argument. This argument can be either an
22224integer, to set the precision absolutely, or a vector containing
22225a single integer, to adjust the precision relative to the current
22226precision. Note that @code{evalvn} with a larger than current
22227precision will do the calculation at this higher precision, but the
22228result will as usual be rounded back down to the current precision
22229afterward. For example, @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415)} at a precision
22230of 12 will return @samp{9.265359e-5}; @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, 30)}
22231will return @samp{9.26535897932e-5} (computing a 25-digit result which
22232is then rounded down to 12); and @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, [-2])}
22233will return @samp{9.2654e-5}.
22234
22235@kindex a "
22236@pindex calc-expand-formula
22237The @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command expands functions
22238into their defining formulas wherever possible. For example,
22239@samp{deg(x^2)} is changed to @samp{180 x^2 / pi}. Most functions,
22240like @code{sin} and @code{gcd}, are not defined by simple formulas
22241and so are unaffected by this command. One important class of
22242functions which @emph{can} be expanded is the user-defined functions
22243created by the @kbd{Z F} command. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
22244Other functions which @kbd{a "} can expand include the probability
22245distribution functions, most of the financial functions, and the
22246hyperbolic and inverse hyperbolic functions. A numeric prefix argument
22247affects @kbd{a "} in the same way as it does @kbd{a v}: A positive
22248argument expands all functions in the formula and then simplifies in
22249various ways; a negative argument expands and simplifies only the
22250top-level function call.
22251
22252@kindex a M
22253@pindex calc-map-equation
22254@tindex mapeq
22255The @kbd{a M} (@code{calc-map-equation}) [@code{mapeq}] command applies
22256a given function or operator to one or more equations. It is analogous
22257to @kbd{V M}, which operates on vectors instead of equations.
22258@pxref{Reducing and Mapping}. For example, @kbd{a M S} changes
22259@samp{x = y+1} to @samp{sin(x) = sin(y+1)}, and @kbd{a M +} with
22260@samp{x = y+1} and @expr{6} on the stack produces @samp{x+6 = y+7}.
22261With two equations on the stack, @kbd{a M +} would add the lefthand
22262sides together and the righthand sides together to get the two
22263respective sides of a new equation.
22264
22265Mapping also works on inequalities. Mapping two similar inequalities
22266produces another inequality of the same type. Mapping an inequality
22267with an equation produces an inequality of the same type. Mapping a
22268@samp{<=} with a @samp{<} or @samp{!=} (not-equal) produces a @samp{<}.
22269If inequalities with opposite direction (e.g., @samp{<} and @samp{>})
22270are mapped, the direction of the second inequality is reversed to
22271match the first: Using @kbd{a M +} on @samp{a < b} and @samp{a > 2}
22272reverses the latter to get @samp{2 < a}, which then allows the
22273combination @samp{a + 2 < b + a}, which the @kbd{a s} command can
22274then simplify to get @samp{2 < b}.
22275
22276Using @kbd{a M *}, @kbd{a M /}, @kbd{a M n}, or @kbd{a M &} to negate
22277or invert an inequality will reverse the direction of the inequality.
22278Other adjustments to inequalities are @emph{not} done automatically;
22279@kbd{a M S} will change @w{@samp{x < y}} to @samp{sin(x) < sin(y)} even
22280though this is not true for all values of the variables.
22281
22282@kindex H a M
22283@tindex mapeqp
22284With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a M} [@code{mapeqp}] does a plain
22285mapping operation without reversing the direction of any inequalities.
22286Thus, @kbd{H a M &} would change @kbd{x > 2} to @kbd{1/x > 0.5}.
22287(This change is mathematically incorrect, but perhaps you were
22288fixing an inequality which was already incorrect.)
22289
22290@kindex I a M
22291@tindex mapeqr
22292With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a M} [@code{mapeqr}] always reverses
22293the direction of the inequality. You might use @kbd{I a M C} to
22294change @samp{x < y} to @samp{cos(x) > cos(y)} if you know you are
22295working with small positive angles.
22296
22297@kindex a b
22298@pindex calc-substitute
22299@tindex subst
22300The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) [@code{subst}] command substitutes
22301all occurrences
22302of some variable or sub-expression of an expression with a new
22303sub-expression. For example, substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(y)}
22304in @samp{2 sin(x)^2 + x sin(x) + sin(2 x)} produces
22305@samp{2 cos(y)^2 + x cos(y) + @w{sin(2 x)}}.
22306Note that this is a purely structural substitution; the lone @samp{x} and
22307the @samp{sin(2 x)} stayed the same because they did not look like
22308@samp{sin(x)}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a more general method for
22309doing substitutions.
22310
22311The @kbd{a b} command normally prompts for two formulas, the old
22312one and the new one. If you enter a blank line for the first
22313prompt, all three arguments are taken from the stack (new, then old,
22314then target expression). If you type an old formula but then enter a
22315blank line for the new one, the new formula is taken from top-of-stack
22316and the target from second-to-top. If you answer both prompts, the
22317target is taken from top-of-stack as usual.
22318
22319Note that @kbd{a b} has no understanding of commutativity or
22320associativity. The pattern @samp{x+y} will not match the formula
22321@samp{y+x}. Also, @samp{y+z} will not match inside the formula @samp{x+y+z}
22322because the @samp{+} operator is left-associative, so the ``deep
22323structure'' of that formula is @samp{(x+y) + z}. Use @kbd{d U}
22324(@code{calc-unformatted-language}) mode to see the true structure of
22325a formula. The rewrite rule mechanism, discussed later, does not have
22326these limitations.
22327
22328As an algebraic function, @code{subst} takes three arguments:
22329Target expression, old, new. Note that @code{subst} is always
22330evaluated immediately, even if its arguments are variables, so if
22331you wish to put a call to @code{subst} onto the stack you must
22332turn the default simplifications off first (with @kbd{m O}).
22333
22334@node Simplifying Formulas, Polynomials, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra
22335@section Simplifying Formulas
22336
22337@noindent
22338@kindex a s
0ff2d6c2
JB
22339@kindex I a s
22340@kindex H a s
4009494e
GM
22341@pindex calc-simplify
22342@tindex simplify
22343The @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) [@code{simplify}] command applies
22344various algebraic rules to simplify a formula. This includes rules which
22345are not part of the default simplifications because they may be too slow
22346to apply all the time, or may not be desirable all of the time. For
22347example, non-adjacent terms of sums are combined, as in @samp{a + b + 2 a}
22348to @samp{b + 3 a}, and some formulas like @samp{sin(arcsin(x))} are
22349simplified to @samp{x}.
22350
22351The sections below describe all the various kinds of algebraic
22352simplifications Calc provides in full detail. None of Calc's
22353simplification commands are designed to pull rabbits out of hats;
22354they simply apply certain specific rules to put formulas into
22355less redundant or more pleasing forms. Serious algebra in Calc
22356must be done manually, usually with a combination of selections
22357and rewrite rules. @xref{Rearranging with Selections}.
22358@xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22359
22360@xref{Simplification Modes}, for commands to control what level of
22361simplification occurs automatically. Normally only the ``default
22362simplifications'' occur.
22363
0ff2d6c2
JB
22364There are some simplifications that, while sometimes useful, are never
22365done automatically. For example, the @kbd{I} prefix can be given to
22366@kbd{a s}; the @kbd{I a s} command will change any trigonometric
22367function to the appropriate combination of @samp{sin}s and @samp{cos}s
22368before simplifying. This can be useful in simplifying even mildly
22369complicated trigonometric expressions. For example, while @kbd{a s}
22370can reduce @samp{sin(x) csc(x)} to @samp{1}, it will not simplify
22371@samp{sin(x)^2 csc(x)}. The command @kbd{I a s} can be used to
22372simplify this latter expression; it will transform @samp{sin(x)^2
744256cf
JB
22373csc(x)} into @samp{sin(x)}. However, @kbd{I a s} will also perform
22374some ``simplifications'' which may not be desired; for example, it
22375will transform @samp{tan(x)^2} into @samp{sin(x)^2 / cos(x)^2}. The
22376Hyperbolic prefix @kbd{H} can be used similarly; the @kbd{H a s} will
0ff2d6c2
JB
22377replace any hyperbolic functions in the formula with the appropriate
22378combinations of @samp{sinh}s and @samp{cosh}s before simplifying.
22379
22380
4009494e
GM
22381@menu
22382* Default Simplifications::
22383* Algebraic Simplifications::
22384* Unsafe Simplifications::
22385* Simplification of Units::
22386@end menu
22387
22388@node Default Simplifications, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas, Simplifying Formulas
22389@subsection Default Simplifications
22390
22391@noindent
22392@cindex Default simplifications
22393This section describes the ``default simplifications,'' those which are
22394normally applied to all results. For example, if you enter the variable
22395@expr{x} on the stack twice and push @kbd{+}, Calc's default
22396simplifications automatically change @expr{x + x} to @expr{2 x}.
22397
22398The @kbd{m O} command turns off the default simplifications, so that
22399@expr{x + x} will remain in this form unless you give an explicit
22400``simplify'' command like @kbd{=} or @kbd{a v}. @xref{Algebraic
22401Manipulation}. The @kbd{m D} command turns the default simplifications
22402back on.
22403
22404The most basic default simplification is the evaluation of functions.
22405For example, @expr{2 + 3} is evaluated to @expr{5}, and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)}
22406is evaluated to @expr{3}. Evaluation does not occur if the arguments
22407to a function are somehow of the wrong type @expr{@tfn{tan}([2,3,4])}),
22408range (@expr{@tfn{tan}(90)}), or number (@expr{@tfn{tan}(3,5)}),
22409or if the function name is not recognized (@expr{@tfn{f}(5)}), or if
22410Symbolic mode (@pxref{Symbolic Mode}) prevents evaluation
22411(@expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2)}).
22412
22413Calc simplifies (evaluates) the arguments to a function before it
22414simplifies the function itself. Thus @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(5+4)} is
22415simplified to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)} before the @code{sqrt} function
22416itself is applied. There are very few exceptions to this rule:
22417@code{quote}, @code{lambda}, and @code{condition} (the @code{::}
22418operator) do not evaluate their arguments, @code{if} (the @code{? :}
22419operator) does not evaluate all of its arguments, and @code{evalto}
22420does not evaluate its lefthand argument.
22421
22422Most commands apply the default simplifications to all arguments they
22423take from the stack, perform a particular operation, then simplify
22424the result before pushing it back on the stack. In the common special
22425case of regular arithmetic commands like @kbd{+} and @kbd{Q} [@code{sqrt}],
22426the arguments are simply popped from the stack and collected into a
22427suitable function call, which is then simplified (the arguments being
22428simplified first as part of the process, as described above).
22429
22430The default simplifications are too numerous to describe completely
22431here, but this section will describe the ones that apply to the
22432major arithmetic operators. This list will be rather technical in
22433nature, and will probably be interesting to you only if you are
22434a serious user of Calc's algebra facilities.
22435
22436@tex
22437\bigskip
22438@end tex
22439
22440As well as the simplifications described here, if you have stored
22441any rewrite rules in the variable @code{EvalRules} then these rules
22442will also be applied before any built-in default simplifications.
22443@xref{Automatic Rewrites}, for details.
22444
22445@tex
22446\bigskip
22447@end tex
22448
22449And now, on with the default simplifications:
22450
22451Arithmetic operators like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} always take two
22452arguments in Calc's internal form. Sums and products of three or
22453more terms are arranged by the associative law of algebra into
22454a left-associative form for sums, @expr{((a + b) + c) + d}, and
45b778a6
JB
22455(by default) a right-associative form for products,
22456@expr{a * (b * (c * d))}. Formulas like @expr{(a + b) + (c + d)} are
22457rearranged to left-associative form, though this rarely matters since
22458Calc's algebra commands are designed to hide the inner structure of sums
22459and products as much as possible. Sums and products in their proper
22460associative form will be written without parentheses in the examples
22461below.
4009494e
GM
22462
22463Sums and products are @emph{not} rearranged according to the
22464commutative law (@expr{a + b} to @expr{b + a}) except in a few
22465special cases described below. Some algebra programs always
22466rearrange terms into a canonical order, which enables them to
22467see that @expr{a b + b a} can be simplified to @expr{2 a b}.
22468Calc assumes you have put the terms into the order you want
22469and generally leaves that order alone, with the consequence
22470that formulas like the above will only be simplified if you
22471explicitly give the @kbd{a s} command. @xref{Algebraic
22472Simplifications}.
22473
22474Differences @expr{a - b} are treated like sums @expr{a + (-b)}
22475for purposes of simplification; one of the default simplifications
22476is to rewrite @expr{a + (-b)} or @expr{(-b) + a}, where @expr{-b}
22477represents a ``negative-looking'' term, into @expr{a - b} form.
22478``Negative-looking'' means negative numbers, negated formulas like
22479@expr{-x}, and products or quotients in which either term is
22480negative-looking.
22481
22482Other simplifications involving negation are @expr{-(-x)} to @expr{x};
22483@expr{-(a b)} or @expr{-(a/b)} where either @expr{a} or @expr{b} is
22484negative-looking, simplified by negating that term, or else where
22485@expr{a} or @expr{b} is any number, by negating that number;
22486@expr{-(a + b)} to @expr{-a - b}, and @expr{-(b - a)} to @expr{a - b}.
22487(This, and rewriting @expr{(-b) + a} to @expr{a - b}, are the only
22488cases where the order of terms in a sum is changed by the default
22489simplifications.)
22490
22491The distributive law is used to simplify sums in some cases:
22492@expr{a x + b x} to @expr{(a + b) x}, where @expr{a} represents
22493a number or an implicit 1 or @mathit{-1} (as in @expr{x} or @expr{-x})
22494and similarly for @expr{b}. Use the @kbd{a c}, @w{@kbd{a f}}, or
22495@kbd{j M} commands to merge sums with non-numeric coefficients
22496using the distributive law.
22497
22498The distributive law is only used for sums of two terms, or
22499for adjacent terms in a larger sum. Thus @expr{a + b + b + c}
22500is simplified to @expr{a + 2 b + c}, but @expr{a + b + c + b}
22501is not simplified. The reason is that comparing all terms of a
22502sum with one another would require time proportional to the
22503square of the number of terms; Calc relegates potentially slow
22504operations like this to commands that have to be invoked
22505explicitly, like @kbd{a s}.
22506
22507Finally, @expr{a + 0} and @expr{0 + a} are simplified to @expr{a}.
22508A consequence of the above rules is that @expr{0 - a} is simplified
22509to @expr{-a}.
22510
22511@tex
22512\bigskip
22513@end tex
22514
22515The products @expr{1 a} and @expr{a 1} are simplified to @expr{a};
22516@expr{(-1) a} and @expr{a (-1)} are simplified to @expr{-a};
22517@expr{0 a} and @expr{a 0} are simplified to @expr{0}, except that
22518in Matrix mode where @expr{a} is not provably scalar the result
22519is the generic zero matrix @samp{idn(0)}, and that if @expr{a} is
22520infinite the result is @samp{nan}.
22521
22522Also, @expr{(-a) b} and @expr{a (-b)} are simplified to @expr{-(a b)},
22523where this occurs for negated formulas but not for regular negative
22524numbers.
22525
22526Products are commuted only to move numbers to the front:
22527@expr{a b 2} is commuted to @expr{2 a b}.
22528
22529The product @expr{a (b + c)} is distributed over the sum only if
22530@expr{a} and at least one of @expr{b} and @expr{c} are numbers:
22531@expr{2 (x + 3)} goes to @expr{2 x + 6}. The formula
22532@expr{(-a) (b - c)}, where @expr{-a} is a negative number, is
22533rewritten to @expr{a (c - b)}.
22534
22535The distributive law of products and powers is used for adjacent
22536terms of the product: @expr{x^a x^b} goes to
22537@texline @math{x^{a+b}}
22538@infoline @expr{x^(a+b)}
22539where @expr{a} is a number, or an implicit 1 (as in @expr{x}),
22540or the implicit one-half of @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)}, and similarly for
22541@expr{b}. The result is written using @samp{sqrt} or @samp{1/sqrt}
22542if the sum of the powers is @expr{1/2} or @expr{-1/2}, respectively.
22543If the sum of the powers is zero, the product is simplified to
22544@expr{1} or to @samp{idn(1)} if Matrix mode is enabled.
22545
22546The product of a negative power times anything but another negative
22547power is changed to use division:
22548@texline @math{x^{-2} y}
22549@infoline @expr{x^(-2) y}
22550goes to @expr{y / x^2} unless Matrix mode is
22551in effect and neither @expr{x} nor @expr{y} are scalar (in which
22552case it is considered unsafe to rearrange the order of the terms).
22553
22554Finally, @expr{a (b/c)} is rewritten to @expr{(a b)/c}, and also
22555@expr{(a/b) c} is changed to @expr{(a c)/b} unless in Matrix mode.
22556
22557@tex
22558\bigskip
22559@end tex
22560
22561Simplifications for quotients are analogous to those for products.
22562The quotient @expr{0 / x} is simplified to @expr{0}, with the same
22563exceptions that were noted for @expr{0 x}. Likewise, @expr{x / 1}
22564and @expr{x / (-1)} are simplified to @expr{x} and @expr{-x},
22565respectively.
22566
22567The quotient @expr{x / 0} is left unsimplified or changed to an
22568infinite quantity, as directed by the current infinite mode.
22569@xref{Infinite Mode}.
22570
22571The expression
22572@texline @math{a / b^{-c}}
22573@infoline @expr{a / b^(-c)}
22574is changed to @expr{a b^c}, where @expr{-c} is any negative-looking
22575power. Also, @expr{1 / b^c} is changed to
22576@texline @math{b^{-c}}
22577@infoline @expr{b^(-c)}
22578for any power @expr{c}.
22579
22580Also, @expr{(-a) / b} and @expr{a / (-b)} go to @expr{-(a/b)};
22581@expr{(a/b) / c} goes to @expr{a / (b c)}; and @expr{a / (b/c)}
22582goes to @expr{(a c) / b} unless Matrix mode prevents this
22583rearrangement. Similarly, @expr{a / (b:c)} is simplified to
22584@expr{(c:b) a} for any fraction @expr{b:c}.
22585
22586The distributive law is applied to @expr{(a + b) / c} only if
22587@expr{c} and at least one of @expr{a} and @expr{b} are numbers.
22588Quotients of powers and square roots are distributed just as
22589described for multiplication.
22590
22591Quotients of products cancel only in the leading terms of the
22592numerator and denominator. In other words, @expr{a x b / a y b}
22593is cancelled to @expr{x b / y b} but not to @expr{x / y}. Once
22594again this is because full cancellation can be slow; use @kbd{a s}
22595to cancel all terms of the quotient.
22596
22597Quotients of negative-looking values are simplified according
22598to @expr{(-a) / (-b)} to @expr{a / b}, @expr{(-a) / (b - c)}
22599to @expr{a / (c - b)}, and @expr{(a - b) / (-c)} to @expr{(b - a) / c}.
22600
22601@tex
22602\bigskip
22603@end tex
22604
22605The formula @expr{x^0} is simplified to @expr{1}, or to @samp{idn(1)}
22606in Matrix mode. The formula @expr{0^x} is simplified to @expr{0}
22607unless @expr{x} is a negative number, complex number or zero.
22608If @expr{x} is negative, complex or @expr{0.0}, @expr{0^x} is an
22609infinity or an unsimplified formula according to the current infinite
22610mode. The expression @expr{0^0} is simplified to @expr{1}.
22611
22612Powers of products or quotients @expr{(a b)^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c}
22613are distributed to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{a^c / b^c} only if @expr{c}
22614is an integer, or if either @expr{a} or @expr{b} are nonnegative
22615real numbers. Powers of powers @expr{(a^b)^c} are simplified to
22616@texline @math{a^{b c}}
22617@infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
22618only when @expr{c} is an integer and @expr{b c} also
22619evaluates to an integer. Without these restrictions these simplifications
22620would not be safe because of problems with principal values.
22621(In other words,
22622@texline @math{((-3)^{1/2})^2}
22623@infoline @expr{((-3)^1:2)^2}
22624is safe to simplify, but
22625@texline @math{((-3)^2)^{1/2}}
22626@infoline @expr{((-3)^2)^1:2}
22627is not.) @xref{Declarations}, for ways to inform Calc that your
22628variables satisfy these requirements.
22629
22630As a special case of this rule, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^n} is simplified to
22631@texline @math{x^{n/2}}
22632@infoline @expr{x^(n/2)}
22633only for even integers @expr{n}.
22634
22635If @expr{a} is known to be real, @expr{b} is an even integer, and
22636@expr{c} is a half- or quarter-integer, then @expr{(a^b)^c} is
22637simplified to @expr{@tfn{abs}(a^(b c))}.
22638
22639Also, @expr{(-a)^b} is simplified to @expr{a^b} if @expr{b} is an
22640even integer, or to @expr{-(a^b)} if @expr{b} is an odd integer,
22641for any negative-looking expression @expr{-a}.
22642
22643Square roots @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)} generally act like one-half powers
22644@texline @math{x^{1:2}}
22645@infoline @expr{x^1:2}
22646for the purposes of the above-listed simplifications.
22647
22648Also, note that
22649@texline @math{1 / x^{1:2}}
22650@infoline @expr{1 / x^1:2}
22651is changed to
22652@texline @math{x^{-1:2}},
22653@infoline @expr{x^(-1:2)},
22654but @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(x)} is left alone.
22655
22656@tex
22657\bigskip
22658@end tex
22659
22660Generic identity matrices (@pxref{Matrix Mode}) are simplified by the
22661following rules: @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + b} to @expr{a + b} if @expr{b}
22662is provably scalar, or expanded out if @expr{b} is a matrix;
22663@expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + @tfn{idn}(b)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a + b)};
22664@expr{-@tfn{idn}(a)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(-a)}; @expr{a @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22665@expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)} if @expr{a} is provably scalar, or to @expr{a b}
22666if @expr{a} is provably non-scalar; @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22667@expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)}; analogous simplifications for quotients involving
22668@code{idn}; and @expr{@tfn{idn}(a)^n} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a^n)} where
22669@expr{n} is an integer.
22670
22671@tex
22672\bigskip
22673@end tex
22674
22675The @code{floor} function and other integer truncation functions
22676vanish if the argument is provably integer-valued, so that
22677@expr{@tfn{floor}(@tfn{round}(x))} simplifies to @expr{@tfn{round}(x)}.
22678Also, combinations of @code{float}, @code{floor} and its friends,
22679and @code{ffloor} and its friends, are simplified in appropriate
22680ways. @xref{Integer Truncation}.
22681
22682The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(-x)} changes to @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}.
22683The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(@tfn{abs}(x))} changes to
22684@expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}; in fact, @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)} changes to @expr{x} or
22685@expr{-x} if @expr{x} is provably nonnegative or nonpositive
22686(@pxref{Declarations}).
22687
22688While most functions do not recognize the variable @code{i} as an
22689imaginary number, the @code{arg} function does handle the two cases
22690@expr{@tfn{arg}(@tfn{i})} and @expr{@tfn{arg}(-@tfn{i})} just for convenience.
22691
22692The expression @expr{@tfn{conj}(@tfn{conj}(x))} simplifies to @expr{x}.
22693Various other expressions involving @code{conj}, @code{re}, and
22694@code{im} are simplified, especially if some of the arguments are
22695provably real or involve the constant @code{i}. For example,
22696@expr{@tfn{conj}(a + b i)} is changed to
22697@expr{@tfn{conj}(a) - @tfn{conj}(b) i}, or to @expr{a - b i} if @expr{a}
22698and @expr{b} are known to be real.
22699
22700Functions like @code{sin} and @code{arctan} generally don't have
22701any default simplifications beyond simply evaluating the functions
22702for suitable numeric arguments and infinity. The @kbd{a s} command
22703described in the next section does provide some simplifications for
22704these functions, though.
22705
22706One important simplification that does occur is that
22707@expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e})} is simplified to 1, and @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)} is
22708simplified to @expr{x} for any @expr{x}. This occurs even if you have
22709stored a different value in the Calc variable @samp{e}; but this would
22710be a bad idea in any case if you were also using natural logarithms!
22711
22712Among the logical functions, @tfn{!(@var{a} <= @var{b})} changes to
22713@tfn{@var{a} > @var{b}} and so on. Equations and inequalities where both sides
22714are either negative-looking or zero are simplified by negating both sides
22715and reversing the inequality. While it might seem reasonable to simplify
22716@expr{!!x} to @expr{x}, this would not be valid in general because
22717@expr{!!2} is 1, not 2.
22718
22719Most other Calc functions have few if any default simplifications
22720defined, aside of course from evaluation when the arguments are
22721suitable numbers.
22722
22723@node Algebraic Simplifications, Unsafe Simplifications, Default Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22724@subsection Algebraic Simplifications
22725
22726@noindent
22727@cindex Algebraic simplifications
22728The @kbd{a s} command makes simplifications that may be too slow to
22729do all the time, or that may not be desirable all of the time.
22730If you find these simplifications are worthwhile, you can type
22731@kbd{m A} to have Calc apply them automatically.
22732
22733This section describes all simplifications that are performed by
22734the @kbd{a s} command. Note that these occur in addition to the
22735default simplifications; even if the default simplifications have
22736been turned off by an @kbd{m O} command, @kbd{a s} will turn them
22737back on temporarily while it simplifies the formula.
22738
22739There is a variable, @code{AlgSimpRules}, in which you can put rewrites
22740to be applied by @kbd{a s}. Its use is analogous to @code{EvalRules},
22741but without the special restrictions. Basically, the simplifier does
22742@samp{@w{a r} AlgSimpRules} with an infinite repeat count on the whole
22743expression being simplified, then it traverses the expression applying
22744the built-in rules described below. If the result is different from
22745the original expression, the process repeats with the default
22746simplifications (including @code{EvalRules}), then @code{AlgSimpRules},
22747then the built-in simplifications, and so on.
22748
22749@tex
22750\bigskip
22751@end tex
22752
22753Sums are simplified in two ways. Constant terms are commuted to the
22754end of the sum, so that @expr{a + 2 + b} changes to @expr{a + b + 2}.
22755The only exception is that a constant will not be commuted away
22756from the first position of a difference, i.e., @expr{2 - x} is not
22757commuted to @expr{-x + 2}.
22758
22759Also, terms of sums are combined by the distributive law, as in
22760@expr{x + y + 2 x} to @expr{y + 3 x}. This always occurs for
22761adjacent terms, but @kbd{a s} compares all pairs of terms including
22762non-adjacent ones.
22763
22764@tex
22765\bigskip
22766@end tex
22767
22768Products are sorted into a canonical order using the commutative
22769law. For example, @expr{b c a} is commuted to @expr{a b c}.
22770This allows easier comparison of products; for example, the default
22771simplifications will not change @expr{x y + y x} to @expr{2 x y},
22772but @kbd{a s} will; it first rewrites the sum to @expr{x y + x y},
22773and then the default simplifications are able to recognize a sum
22774of identical terms.
22775
22776The canonical ordering used to sort terms of products has the
22777property that real-valued numbers, interval forms and infinities
22778come first, and are sorted into increasing order. The @kbd{V S}
22779command uses the same ordering when sorting a vector.
22780
22781Sorting of terms of products is inhibited when Matrix mode is
22782turned on; in this case, Calc will never exchange the order of
22783two terms unless it knows at least one of the terms is a scalar.
22784
22785Products of powers are distributed by comparing all pairs of
22786terms, using the same method that the default simplifications
22787use for adjacent terms of products.
22788
22789Even though sums are not sorted, the commutative law is still
22790taken into account when terms of a product are being compared.
22791Thus @expr{(x + y) (y + x)} will be simplified to @expr{(x + y)^2}.
22792A subtle point is that @expr{(x - y) (y - x)} will @emph{not}
22793be simplified to @expr{-(x - y)^2}; Calc does not notice that
22794one term can be written as a constant times the other, even if
22795that constant is @mathit{-1}.
22796
22797A fraction times any expression, @expr{(a:b) x}, is changed to
22798a quotient involving integers: @expr{a x / b}. This is not
22799done for floating-point numbers like @expr{0.5}, however. This
22800is one reason why you may find it convenient to turn Fraction mode
22801on while doing algebra; @pxref{Fraction Mode}.
22802
22803@tex
22804\bigskip
22805@end tex
22806
22807Quotients are simplified by comparing all terms in the numerator
22808with all terms in the denominator for possible cancellation using
22809the distributive law. For example, @expr{a x^2 b / c x^3 d} will
22810cancel @expr{x^2} from the top and bottom to get @expr{a b / c x d}.
22811(The terms in the denominator will then be rearranged to @expr{c d x}
22812as described above.) If there is any common integer or fractional
22813factor in the numerator and denominator, it is cancelled out;
22814for example, @expr{(4 x + 6) / 8 x} simplifies to @expr{(2 x + 3) / 4 x}.
22815
22816Non-constant common factors are not found even by @kbd{a s}. To
22817cancel the factor @expr{a} in @expr{(a x + a) / a^2} you could first
22818use @kbd{j M} on the product @expr{a x} to Merge the numerator to
22819@expr{a (1+x)}, which can then be simplified successfully.
22820
22821@tex
22822\bigskip
22823@end tex
22824
22825Integer powers of the variable @code{i} are simplified according
22826to the identity @expr{i^2 = -1}. If you store a new value other
22827than the complex number @expr{(0,1)} in @code{i}, this simplification
22828will no longer occur. This is done by @kbd{a s} instead of by default
22829in case someone (unwisely) uses the name @code{i} for a variable
22830unrelated to complex numbers; it would be unfortunate if Calc
22831quietly and automatically changed this formula for reasons the
22832user might not have been thinking of.
22833
22834Square roots of integer or rational arguments are simplified in
22835several ways. (Note that these will be left unevaluated only in
22836Symbolic mode.) First, square integer or rational factors are
22837pulled out so that @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(8)} is rewritten as
22838@texline @math{2\,@tfn{sqrt}(2)}.
22839@infoline @expr{2 sqrt(2)}.
22840Conceptually speaking this implies factoring the argument into primes
22841and moving pairs of primes out of the square root, but for reasons of
22842efficiency Calc only looks for primes up to 29.
22843
22844Square roots in the denominator of a quotient are moved to the
22845numerator: @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(3) / 3}.
22846The same effect occurs for the square root of a fraction:
22847@expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2:3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(6) / 3}.
22848
22849@tex
22850\bigskip
22851@end tex
22852
22853The @code{%} (modulo) operator is simplified in several ways
22854when the modulus @expr{M} is a positive real number. First, if
22855the argument is of the form @expr{x + n} for some real number
22856@expr{n}, then @expr{n} is itself reduced modulo @expr{M}. For
22857example, @samp{(x - 23) % 10} is simplified to @samp{(x + 7) % 10}.
22858
22859If the argument is multiplied by a constant, and this constant
22860has a common integer divisor with the modulus, then this factor is
22861cancelled out. For example, @samp{12 x % 15} is changed to
22862@samp{3 (4 x % 5)} by factoring out 3. Also, @samp{(12 x + 1) % 15}
22863is changed to @samp{3 ((4 x + 1:3) % 5)}. While these forms may
22864not seem ``simpler,'' they allow Calc to discover useful information
22865about modulo forms in the presence of declarations.
22866
22867If the modulus is 1, then Calc can use @code{int} declarations to
22868evaluate the expression. For example, the idiom @samp{x % 2} is
22869often used to check whether a number is odd or even. As described
22870above, @w{@samp{2 n % 2}} and @samp{(2 n + 1) % 2} are simplified to
22871@samp{2 (n % 1)} and @samp{2 ((n + 1:2) % 1)}, respectively; Calc
22872can simplify these to 0 and 1 (respectively) if @code{n} has been
22873declared to be an integer.
22874
22875@tex
22876\bigskip
22877@end tex
22878
22879Trigonometric functions are simplified in several ways. Whenever a
22880products of two trigonometric functions can be replaced by a single
22881function, the replacement is made; for example,
22882@expr{@tfn{tan}(x) @tfn{cos}(x)} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{sin}(x)}.
22883Reciprocals of trigonometric functions are replaced by their reciprocal
22884function; for example, @expr{1/@tfn{sec}(x)} is simplified to
22885@expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. The corresponding simplifications for the
22886hyperbolic functions are also handled.
22887
22888Trigonometric functions of their inverse functions are
22889simplified. The expression @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arcsin}(x))} is
22890simplified to @expr{x}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22891Trigonometric functions of inverses of different trigonometric
22892functions can also be simplified, as in @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arccos}(x))}
22893to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - x^2)}.
22894
22895If the argument to @code{sin} is negative-looking, it is simplified to
22896@expr{-@tfn{sin}(x)}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22897Finally, certain special values of the argument are recognized;
22898@pxref{Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions}.
22899
22900Hyperbolic functions of their inverses and of negative-looking
22901arguments are also handled, as are exponentials of inverse
22902hyperbolic functions.
22903
22904No simplifications for inverse trigonometric and hyperbolic
22905functions are known, except for negative arguments of @code{arcsin},
22906@code{arctan}, @code{arcsinh}, and @code{arctanh}. Note that
22907@expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} can @emph{not} safely change to
22908@expr{x}, since this only correct within an integer multiple of
22909@texline @math{2 \pi}
22910@infoline @expr{2 pi}
22911radians or 360 degrees. However, @expr{@tfn{arcsinh}(@tfn{sinh}(x))} is
22912simplified to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22913
22914Several simplifications that apply to logarithms and exponentials
22915are that @expr{@tfn{exp}(@tfn{ln}(x))},
22916@texline @tfn{e}@math{^{\ln(x)}},
22917@infoline @expr{e^@tfn{ln}(x)},
22918and
22919@texline @math{10^{{\rm log10}(x)}}
22920@infoline @expr{10^@tfn{log10}(x)}
22921all reduce to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))}, etc., can
22922reduce to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is provably real. The form
22923@expr{@tfn{exp}(x)^y} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{exp}(x y)}. If @expr{x}
22924is a suitable multiple of
22925@texline @math{\pi i}
22926@infoline @expr{pi i}
22927(as described above for the trigonometric functions), then
22928@expr{@tfn{exp}(x)} or @expr{e^x} will be expanded. Finally,
22929@expr{@tfn{ln}(x)} is simplified to a form involving @code{pi} and
22930@code{i} where @expr{x} is provably negative, positive imaginary, or
22931negative imaginary.
22932
22933The error functions @code{erf} and @code{erfc} are simplified when
22934their arguments are negative-looking or are calls to the @code{conj}
22935function.
22936
22937@tex
22938\bigskip
22939@end tex
22940
22941Equations and inequalities are simplified by cancelling factors
22942of products, quotients, or sums on both sides. Inequalities
22943change sign if a negative multiplicative factor is cancelled.
22944Non-constant multiplicative factors as in @expr{a b = a c} are
22945cancelled from equations only if they are provably nonzero (generally
22946because they were declared so; @pxref{Declarations}). Factors
22947are cancelled from inequalities only if they are nonzero and their
22948sign is known.
22949
22950Simplification also replaces an equation or inequality with
229511 or 0 (``true'' or ``false'') if it can through the use of
22952declarations. If @expr{x} is declared to be an integer greater
22953than 5, then @expr{x < 3}, @expr{x = 3}, and @expr{x = 7.5} are
22954all simplified to 0, but @expr{x > 3} is simplified to 1.
22955By a similar analysis, @expr{abs(x) >= 0} is simplified to 1,
22956as is @expr{x^2 >= 0} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22957
22958@node Unsafe Simplifications, Simplification of Units, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22959@subsection ``Unsafe'' Simplifications
22960
22961@noindent
22962@cindex Unsafe simplifications
22963@cindex Extended simplification
22964@kindex a e
22965@pindex calc-simplify-extended
22966@ignore
22967@mindex esimpl@idots
22968@end ignore
22969@tindex esimplify
22970The @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) [@code{esimplify}] command
22971is like @kbd{a s}
22972except that it applies some additional simplifications which are not
22973``safe'' in all cases. Use this only if you know the values in your
22974formula lie in the restricted ranges for which these simplifications
22975are valid. The symbolic integrator uses @kbd{a e};
22976one effect of this is that the integrator's results must be used with
22977caution. Where an integral table will often attach conditions like
22978``for positive @expr{a} only,'' Calc (like most other symbolic
22979integration programs) will simply produce an unqualified result.
22980
22981Because @kbd{a e}'s simplifications are unsafe, it is sometimes better
22982to type @kbd{C-u -3 a v}, which does extended simplification only
22983on the top level of the formula without affecting the sub-formulas.
22984In fact, @kbd{C-u -3 j v} allows you to target extended simplification
22985to any specific part of a formula.
22986
22987The variable @code{ExtSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
22988the @kbd{a e} command. These are applied in addition to
22989@code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. (The @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
22990step described above is simply followed by an @kbd{a r ExtSimpRules} step.)
22991
22992Following is a complete list of ``unsafe'' simplifications performed
22993by @kbd{a e}.
22994
22995@tex
22996\bigskip
22997@end tex
22998
22999Inverse trigonometric or hyperbolic functions, called with their
23000corresponding non-inverse functions as arguments, are simplified
23001by @kbd{a e}. For example, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} changes
23002to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{cos}(x))} and
23003@expr{@tfn{arccos}(@tfn{sin}(x))} both change to @expr{@tfn{pi}/2 - x}.
23004These simplifications are unsafe because they are valid only for
23005values of @expr{x} in a certain range; outside that range, values
23006are folded down to the 360-degree range that the inverse trigonometric
23007functions always produce.
23008
23009Powers of powers @expr{(x^a)^b} are simplified to
23010@texline @math{x^{a b}}
23011@infoline @expr{x^(a b)}
23012for all @expr{a} and @expr{b}. These results will be valid only
23013in a restricted range of @expr{x}; for example, in
23014@texline @math{(x^2)^{1:2}}
23015@infoline @expr{(x^2)^1:2}
23016the powers cancel to get @expr{x}, which is valid for positive values
23017of @expr{x} but not for negative or complex values.
23018
23019Similarly, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x^a)} and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^a} are both
23020simplified (possibly unsafely) to
23021@texline @math{x^{a/2}}.
23022@infoline @expr{x^(a/2)}.
23023
23024Forms like @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - sin(x)^2)} are simplified to, e.g.,
23025@expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. Calc has identities of this sort for @code{sin},
23026@code{cos}, @code{tan}, @code{sinh}, and @code{cosh}.
23027
23028Arguments of square roots are partially factored to look for
23029squared terms that can be extracted. For example,
23030@expr{@tfn{sqrt}(a^2 b^3 + a^3 b^2)} simplifies to
23031@expr{a b @tfn{sqrt}(a+b)}.
23032
23033The simplifications of @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))},
23034@expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)}, and @expr{@tfn{log10}(10^x)} to @expr{x} are also
23035unsafe because of problems with principal values (although these
23036simplifications are safe if @expr{x} is known to be real).
23037
23038Common factors are cancelled from products on both sides of an
23039equation, even if those factors may be zero: @expr{a x / b x}
23040to @expr{a / b}. Such factors are never cancelled from
23041inequalities: Even @kbd{a e} is not bold enough to reduce
23042@expr{a x < b x} to @expr{a < b} (or @expr{a > b}, depending
23043on whether you believe @expr{x} is positive or negative).
23044The @kbd{a M /} command can be used to divide a factor out of
23045both sides of an inequality.
23046
23047@node Simplification of Units, , Unsafe Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
23048@subsection Simplification of Units
23049
23050@noindent
23051The simplifications described in this section are applied by the
23052@kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command. These are in addition
23053to the regular @kbd{a s} (but not @kbd{a e}) simplifications described
23054earlier. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
23055
23056The variable @code{UnitSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
23057the @kbd{u s} command. These are applied in addition to @code{EvalRules}
23058and @code{AlgSimpRules}.
23059
23060Scalar mode is automatically put into effect when simplifying units.
23061@xref{Matrix Mode}.
23062
23063Sums @expr{a + b} involving units are simplified by extracting the
23064units of @expr{a} as if by the @kbd{u x} command (call the result
23065@expr{u_a}), then simplifying the expression @expr{b / u_a}
23066using @kbd{u b} and @kbd{u s}. If the result has units then the sum
23067is inconsistent and is left alone. Otherwise, it is rewritten
23068in terms of the units @expr{u_a}.
23069
23070If units auto-ranging mode is enabled, products or quotients in
23071which the first argument is a number which is out of range for the
23072leading unit are modified accordingly.
23073
23074When cancelling and combining units in products and quotients,
23075Calc accounts for unit names that differ only in the prefix letter.
23076For example, @samp{2 km m} is simplified to @samp{2000 m^2}.
23077However, compatible but different units like @code{ft} and @code{in}
23078are not combined in this way.
23079
23080Quotients @expr{a / b} are simplified in three additional ways. First,
23081if @expr{b} is a number or a product beginning with a number, Calc
23082computes the reciprocal of this number and moves it to the numerator.
23083
23084Second, for each pair of unit names from the numerator and denominator
23085of a quotient, if the units are compatible (e.g., they are both
23086units of area) then they are replaced by the ratio between those
23087units. For example, in @samp{3 s in N / kg cm} the units
23088@samp{in / cm} will be replaced by @expr{2.54}.
23089
23090Third, if the units in the quotient exactly cancel out, so that
23091a @kbd{u b} command on the quotient would produce a dimensionless
23092number for an answer, then the quotient simplifies to that number.
23093
23094For powers and square roots, the ``unsafe'' simplifications
23095@expr{(a b)^c} to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c} to @expr{a^c / b^c},
23096and @expr{(a^b)^c} to
23097@texline @math{a^{b c}}
23098@infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
23099are done if the powers are real numbers. (These are safe in the context
23100of units because all numbers involved can reasonably be assumed to be
23101real.)
23102
23103Also, if a unit name is raised to a fractional power, and the
23104base units in that unit name all occur to powers which are a
23105multiple of the denominator of the power, then the unit name
23106is expanded out into its base units, which can then be simplified
23107according to the previous paragraph. For example, @samp{acre^1.5}
23108is simplified by noting that @expr{1.5 = 3:2}, that @samp{acre}
23109is defined in terms of @samp{m^2}, and that the 2 in the power of
23110@code{m} is a multiple of 2 in @expr{3:2}. Thus, @code{acre^1.5} is
23111replaced by approximately
23112@texline @math{(4046 m^2)^{1.5}}
23113@infoline @expr{(4046 m^2)^1.5},
23114which is then changed to
23115@texline @math{4046^{1.5} \, (m^2)^{1.5}},
23116@infoline @expr{4046^1.5 (m^2)^1.5},
23117then to @expr{257440 m^3}.
23118
23119The functions @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{clean}, @code{abs},
23120as well as @code{floor} and the other integer truncation functions,
23121applied to unit names or products or quotients involving units, are
23122simplified. For example, @samp{round(1.6 in)} is changed to
23123@samp{round(1.6) round(in)}; the lefthand term evaluates to 2,
23124and the righthand term simplifies to @code{in}.
23125
23126The functions @code{sin}, @code{cos}, and @code{tan} with arguments
23127that have angular units like @code{rad} or @code{arcmin} are
23128simplified by converting to base units (radians), then evaluating
23129with the angular mode temporarily set to radians.
23130
23131@node Polynomials, Calculus, Simplifying Formulas, Algebra
23132@section Polynomials
23133
23134A @dfn{polynomial} is a sum of terms which are coefficients times
23135various powers of a ``base'' variable. For example, @expr{2 x^2 + 3 x - 4}
23136is a polynomial in @expr{x}. Some formulas can be considered
23137polynomials in several different variables: @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2}
23138is a polynomial in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}. Polynomial coefficients
23139are often numbers, but they may in general be any formulas not
23140involving the base variable.
23141
23142@kindex a f
23143@pindex calc-factor
23144@tindex factor
23145The @kbd{a f} (@code{calc-factor}) [@code{factor}] command factors a
23146polynomial into a product of terms. For example, the polynomial
23147@expr{x^3 + 2 x^2 + x} is factored into @samp{x*(x+1)^2}. As another
23148example, @expr{a c + b d + b c + a d} is factored into the product
23149@expr{(a + b) (c + d)}.
23150
23151Calc currently has three algorithms for factoring. Formulas which are
23152linear in several variables, such as the second example above, are
23153merged according to the distributive law. Formulas which are
23154polynomials in a single variable, with constant integer or fractional
23155coefficients, are factored into irreducible linear and/or quadratic
23156terms. The first example above factors into three linear terms
23157(@expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, and @expr{x+1} again). Finally, formulas
23158which do not fit the above criteria are handled by the algebraic
23159rewrite mechanism.
23160
23161Calc's polynomial factorization algorithm works by using the general
23162root-finding command (@w{@kbd{a P}}) to solve for the roots of the
23163polynomial. It then looks for roots which are rational numbers
23164or complex-conjugate pairs, and converts these into linear and
23165quadratic terms, respectively. Because it uses floating-point
23166arithmetic, it may be unable to find terms that involve large
23167integers (whose number of digits approaches the current precision).
23168Also, irreducible factors of degree higher than quadratic are not
23169found, and polynomials in more than one variable are not treated.
23170(A more robust factorization algorithm may be included in a future
23171version of Calc.)
23172
23173@vindex FactorRules
23174@ignore
23175@starindex
23176@end ignore
23177@tindex thecoefs
23178@ignore
23179@starindex
23180@end ignore
23181@ignore
23182@mindex @idots
23183@end ignore
23184@tindex thefactors
23185The rewrite-based factorization method uses rules stored in the variable
23186@code{FactorRules}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of the
23187operation of rewrite rules. The default @code{FactorRules} are able
23188to factor quadratic forms symbolically into two linear terms,
23189@expr{(a x + b) (c x + d)}. You can edit these rules to include other
23190cases if you wish. To use the rules, Calc builds the formula
23191@samp{thecoefs(x, [a, b, c, ...])} where @code{x} is the polynomial
23192base variable and @code{a}, @code{b}, etc., are polynomial coefficients
23193(which may be numbers or formulas). The constant term is written first,
23194i.e., in the @code{a} position. When the rules complete, they should have
23195changed the formula into the form @samp{thefactors(x, [f1, f2, f3, ...])}
23196where each @code{fi} should be a factored term, e.g., @samp{x - ai}.
23197Calc then multiplies these terms together to get the complete
23198factored form of the polynomial. If the rules do not change the
23199@code{thecoefs} call to a @code{thefactors} call, @kbd{a f} leaves the
23200polynomial alone on the assumption that it is unfactorable. (Note that
23201the function names @code{thecoefs} and @code{thefactors} are used only
23202as placeholders; there are no actual Calc functions by those names.)
23203
23204@kindex H a f
23205@tindex factors
23206The @kbd{H a f} [@code{factors}] command also factors a polynomial,
23207but it returns a list of factors instead of an expression which is the
23208product of the factors. Each factor is represented by a sub-vector
23209of the factor, and the power with which it appears. For example,
23210@expr{x^5 + x^4 - 33 x^3 + 63 x^2} factors to @expr{(x + 7) x^2 (x - 3)^2}
23211in @kbd{a f}, or to @expr{[ [x, 2], [x+7, 1], [x-3, 2] ]} in @kbd{H a f}.
23212If there is an overall numeric factor, it always comes first in the list.
23213The functions @code{factor} and @code{factors} allow a second argument
23214when written in algebraic form; @samp{factor(x,v)} factors @expr{x} with
23215respect to the specific variable @expr{v}. The default is to factor with
23216respect to all the variables that appear in @expr{x}.
23217
23218@kindex a c
23219@pindex calc-collect
23220@tindex collect
23221The @kbd{a c} (@code{calc-collect}) [@code{collect}] command rearranges a
23222formula as a
23223polynomial in a given variable, ordered in decreasing powers of that
23224variable. For example, given @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2} on
23225the stack, @kbd{a c x} would produce @expr{(2 + 4 y^2) x + (1 + 3 y)},
23226and @kbd{a c y} would produce @expr{(4 x) y^2 + 3 y + (1 + 2 x)}.
23227The polynomial will be expanded out using the distributive law as
23228necessary: Collecting @expr{x} in @expr{(x - 1)^3} produces
23229@expr{x^3 - 3 x^2 + 3 x - 1}. Terms not involving @expr{x} will
23230not be expanded.
23231
23232The ``variable'' you specify at the prompt can actually be any
23233expression: @kbd{a c ln(x+1)} will collect together all terms multiplied
23234by @samp{ln(x+1)} or integer powers thereof. If @samp{x} also appears
23235in the formula in a context other than @samp{ln(x+1)}, @kbd{a c} will
23236treat those occurrences as unrelated to @samp{ln(x+1)}, i.e., as constants.
23237
23238@kindex a x
23239@pindex calc-expand
23240@tindex expand
23241The @kbd{a x} (@code{calc-expand}) [@code{expand}] command expands an
23242expression by applying the distributive law everywhere. It applies to
23243products, quotients, and powers involving sums. By default, it fully
23244distributes all parts of the expression. With a numeric prefix argument,
23245the distributive law is applied only the specified number of times, then
23246the partially expanded expression is left on the stack.
23247
23248The @kbd{a x} and @kbd{j D} commands are somewhat redundant. Use
23249@kbd{a x} if you want to expand all products of sums in your formula.
23250Use @kbd{j D} if you want to expand a particular specified term of
23251the formula. There is an exactly analogous correspondence between
23252@kbd{a f} and @kbd{j M}. (The @kbd{j D} and @kbd{j M} commands
23253also know many other kinds of expansions, such as
23254@samp{exp(a + b) = exp(a) exp(b)}, which @kbd{a x} and @kbd{a f}
23255do not do.)
23256
23257Calc's automatic simplifications will sometimes reverse a partial
23258expansion. For example, the first step in expanding @expr{(x+1)^3} is
23259to write @expr{(x+1) (x+1)^2}. If @kbd{a x} stops there and tries
23260to put this formula onto the stack, though, Calc will automatically
23261simplify it back to @expr{(x+1)^3} form. The solution is to turn
23262simplification off first (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), or to run
23263@kbd{a x} without a numeric prefix argument so that it expands all
23264the way in one step.
23265
23266@kindex a a
23267@pindex calc-apart
23268@tindex apart
23269The @kbd{a a} (@code{calc-apart}) [@code{apart}] command expands a
23270rational function by partial fractions. A rational function is the
23271quotient of two polynomials; @code{apart} pulls this apart into a
23272sum of rational functions with simple denominators. In algebraic
23273notation, the @code{apart} function allows a second argument that
23274specifies which variable to use as the ``base''; by default, Calc
23275chooses the base variable automatically.
23276
23277@kindex a n
23278@pindex calc-normalize-rat
23279@tindex nrat
23280The @kbd{a n} (@code{calc-normalize-rat}) [@code{nrat}] command
23281attempts to arrange a formula into a quotient of two polynomials.
23282For example, given @expr{1 + (a + b/c) / d}, the result would be
23283@expr{(b + a c + c d) / c d}. The quotient is reduced, so that
23284@kbd{a n} will simplify @expr{(x^2 + 2x + 1) / (x^2 - 1)} by dividing
23285out the common factor @expr{x + 1}, yielding @expr{(x + 1) / (x - 1)}.
23286
23287@kindex a \
23288@pindex calc-poly-div
23289@tindex pdiv
23290The @kbd{a \} (@code{calc-poly-div}) [@code{pdiv}] command divides
23291two polynomials @expr{u} and @expr{v}, yielding a new polynomial
23292@expr{q}. If several variables occur in the inputs, the inputs are
23293considered multivariate polynomials. (Calc divides by the variable
23294with the largest power in @expr{u} first, or, in the case of equal
23295powers, chooses the variables in alphabetical order.) For example,
23296dividing @expr{x^2 + 3 x + 2} by @expr{x + 2} yields @expr{x + 1}.
23297The remainder from the division, if any, is reported at the bottom
23298of the screen and is also placed in the Trail along with the quotient.
23299
23300Using @code{pdiv} in algebraic notation, you can specify the particular
23301variable to be used as the base: @code{pdiv(@var{a},@var{b},@var{x})}.
23302If @code{pdiv} is given only two arguments (as is always the case with
23303the @kbd{a \} command), then it does a multivariate division as outlined
23304above.
23305
23306@kindex a %
23307@pindex calc-poly-rem
23308@tindex prem
23309The @kbd{a %} (@code{calc-poly-rem}) [@code{prem}] command divides
23310two polynomials and keeps the remainder @expr{r}. The quotient
23311@expr{q} is discarded. For any formulas @expr{a} and @expr{b}, the
23312results of @kbd{a \} and @kbd{a %} satisfy @expr{a = q b + r}.
23313(This is analogous to plain @kbd{\} and @kbd{%}, which compute the
23314integer quotient and remainder from dividing two numbers.)
23315
23316@kindex a /
23317@kindex H a /
23318@pindex calc-poly-div-rem
23319@tindex pdivrem
23320@tindex pdivide
23321The @kbd{a /} (@code{calc-poly-div-rem}) [@code{pdivrem}] command
23322divides two polynomials and reports both the quotient and the
23323remainder as a vector @expr{[q, r]}. The @kbd{H a /} [@code{pdivide}]
23324command divides two polynomials and constructs the formula
23325@expr{q + r/b} on the stack. (Naturally if the remainder is zero,
23326this will immediately simplify to @expr{q}.)
23327
23328@kindex a g
23329@pindex calc-poly-gcd
23330@tindex pgcd
23331The @kbd{a g} (@code{calc-poly-gcd}) [@code{pgcd}] command computes
23332the greatest common divisor of two polynomials. (The GCD actually
23333is unique only to within a constant multiplier; Calc attempts to
23334choose a GCD which will be unsurprising.) For example, the @kbd{a n}
23335command uses @kbd{a g} to take the GCD of the numerator and denominator
23336of a quotient, then divides each by the result using @kbd{a \}. (The
23337definition of GCD ensures that this division can take place without
23338leaving a remainder.)
23339
23340While the polynomials used in operations like @kbd{a /} and @kbd{a g}
23341often have integer coefficients, this is not required. Calc can also
23342deal with polynomials over the rationals or floating-point reals.
23343Polynomials with modulo-form coefficients are also useful in many
23344applications; if you enter @samp{(x^2 + 3 x - 1) mod 5}, Calc
23345automatically transforms this into a polynomial over the field of
23346integers mod 5: @samp{(1 mod 5) x^2 + (3 mod 5) x + (4 mod 5)}.
23347
23348Congratulations and thanks go to Ove Ewerlid
23349(@code{ewerlid@@mizar.DoCS.UU.SE}), who contributed many of the
23350polynomial routines used in the above commands.
23351
23352@xref{Decomposing Polynomials}, for several useful functions for
23353extracting the individual coefficients of a polynomial.
23354
23355@node Calculus, Solving Equations, Polynomials, Algebra
23356@section Calculus
23357
23358@noindent
23359The following calculus commands do not automatically simplify their
23360inputs or outputs using @code{calc-simplify}. You may find it helps
23361to do this by hand by typing @kbd{a s} or @kbd{a e}. It may also help
23362to use @kbd{a x} and/or @kbd{a c} to arrange a result in the most
23363readable way.
23364
23365@menu
23366* Differentiation::
23367* Integration::
23368* Customizing the Integrator::
23369* Numerical Integration::
23370* Taylor Series::
23371@end menu
23372
23373@node Differentiation, Integration, Calculus, Calculus
23374@subsection Differentiation
23375
23376@noindent
23377@kindex a d
23378@kindex H a d
23379@pindex calc-derivative
23380@tindex deriv
23381@tindex tderiv
23382The @kbd{a d} (@code{calc-derivative}) [@code{deriv}] command computes
23383the derivative of the expression on the top of the stack with respect to
23384some variable, which it will prompt you to enter. Normally, variables
23385in the formula other than the specified differentiation variable are
23386considered constant, i.e., @samp{deriv(y,x)} is reduced to zero. With
23387the Hyperbolic flag, the @code{tderiv} (total derivative) operation is used
23388instead, in which derivatives of variables are not reduced to zero
23389unless those variables are known to be ``constant,'' i.e., independent
23390of any other variables. (The built-in special variables like @code{pi}
23391are considered constant, as are variables that have been declared
23392@code{const}; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23393
23394With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, this command computes the
23395@var{n}th derivative.
23396
23397When working with trigonometric functions, it is best to switch to
23398Radians mode first (with @w{@kbd{m r}}). The derivative of @samp{sin(x)}
23399in degrees is @samp{(pi/180) cos(x)}, probably not the expected
23400answer!
23401
23402If you use the @code{deriv} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23403you can write @samp{deriv(f,x,x0)} which represents the derivative
23404of @expr{f} with respect to @expr{x}, evaluated at the point
23405@texline @math{x=x_0}.
23406@infoline @expr{x=x0}.
23407
23408If the formula being differentiated contains functions which Calc does
23409not know, the derivatives of those functions are produced by adding
23410primes (apostrophe characters). For example, @samp{deriv(f(2x), x)}
23411produces @samp{2 f'(2 x)}, where the function @code{f'} represents the
23412derivative of @code{f}.
23413
23414For functions you have defined with the @kbd{Z F} command, Calc expands
23415the functions according to their defining formulas unless you have
23416also defined @code{f'} suitably. For example, suppose we define
23417@samp{sinc(x) = sin(x)/x} using @kbd{Z F}. If we then differentiate
23418the formula @samp{sinc(2 x)}, the formula will be expanded to
23419@samp{sin(2 x) / (2 x)} and differentiated. However, if we also
23420define @samp{sinc'(x) = dsinc(x)}, say, then Calc will write the
23421result as @samp{2 dsinc(2 x)}. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
23422
23423For multi-argument functions @samp{f(x,y,z)}, the derivative with respect
23424to the first argument is written @samp{f'(x,y,z)}; derivatives with
23425respect to the other arguments are @samp{f'2(x,y,z)} and @samp{f'3(x,y,z)}.
23426Various higher-order derivatives can be formed in the obvious way, e.g.,
23427@samp{f'@var{}'(x)} (the second derivative of @code{f}) or
23428@samp{f'@var{}'2'3(x,y,z)} (@code{f} differentiated with respect to each
23429argument once).
23430
23431@node Integration, Customizing the Integrator, Differentiation, Calculus
23432@subsection Integration
23433
23434@noindent
23435@kindex a i
23436@pindex calc-integral
23437@tindex integ
23438The @kbd{a i} (@code{calc-integral}) [@code{integ}] command computes the
23439indefinite integral of the expression on the top of the stack with
23440respect to a prompted-for variable. The integrator is not guaranteed to
23441work for all integrable functions, but it is able to integrate several
23442large classes of formulas. In particular, any polynomial or rational
23443function (a polynomial divided by a polynomial) is acceptable.
23444(Rational functions don't have to be in explicit quotient form, however;
23445@texline @math{x/(1+x^{-2})}
23446@infoline @expr{x/(1+x^-2)}
23447is not strictly a quotient of polynomials, but it is equivalent to
23448@expr{x^3/(x^2+1)}, which is.) Also, square roots of terms involving
23449@expr{x} and @expr{x^2} may appear in rational functions being
23450integrated. Finally, rational functions involving trigonometric or
23451hyperbolic functions can be integrated.
23452
23453With an argument (@kbd{C-u a i}), this command will compute the definite
23454integral of the expression on top of the stack. In this case, the
23455command will again prompt for an integration variable, then prompt for a
23456lower limit and an upper limit.
23457
23458@ifnottex
23459If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23460you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23461indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23462With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23463integral from @code{a} to @code{b}.
23464@end ifnottex
23465@tex
23466If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23467you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23468indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23469With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23470integral $\int_a^b f(x) \, dx$.
23471@end tex
23472
23473Please note that the current implementation of Calc's integrator sometimes
23474produces results that are significantly more complex than they need to
23475be. For example, the integral Calc finds for
23476@texline @math{1/(x+\sqrt{x^2+1})}
23477@infoline @expr{1/(x+sqrt(x^2+1))}
23478is several times more complicated than the answer Mathematica
23479returns for the same input, although the two forms are numerically
23480equivalent. Also, any indefinite integral should be considered to have
23481an arbitrary constant of integration added to it, although Calc does not
23482write an explicit constant of integration in its result. For example,
23483Calc's solution for
23484@texline @math{1/(1+\tan x)}
23485@infoline @expr{1/(1+tan(x))}
23486differs from the solution given in the @emph{CRC Math Tables} by a
23487constant factor of
23488@texline @math{\pi i / 2}
23489@infoline @expr{pi i / 2},
23490due to a different choice of constant of integration.
23491
23492The Calculator remembers all the integrals it has done. If conditions
23493change in a way that would invalidate the old integrals, say, a switch
23494from Degrees to Radians mode, then they will be thrown out. If you
23495suspect this is not happening when it should, use the
23496@code{calc-flush-caches} command; @pxref{Caches}.
23497
23498@vindex IntegLimit
23499Calc normally will pursue integration by substitution or integration by
23500parts up to 3 nested times before abandoning an approach as fruitless.
23501If the integrator is taking too long, you can lower this limit by storing
23502a number (like 2) in the variable @code{IntegLimit}. (The @kbd{s I}
23503command is a convenient way to edit @code{IntegLimit}.) If this variable
23504has no stored value or does not contain a nonnegative integer, a limit
23505of 3 is used. The lower this limit is, the greater the chance that Calc
23506will be unable to integrate a function it could otherwise handle. Raising
23507this limit allows the Calculator to solve more integrals, though the time
23508it takes may grow exponentially. You can monitor the integrator's actions
23509by creating an Emacs buffer called @code{*Trace*}. If such a buffer
23510exists, the @kbd{a i} command will write a log of its actions there.
23511
23512If you want to manipulate integrals in a purely symbolic way, you can
23513set the integration nesting limit to 0 to prevent all but fast
23514table-lookup solutions of integrals. You might then wish to define
23515rewrite rules for integration by parts, various kinds of substitutions,
23516and so on. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
23517
23518@node Customizing the Integrator, Numerical Integration, Integration, Calculus
23519@subsection Customizing the Integrator
23520
23521@noindent
23522@vindex IntegRules
23523Calc has two built-in rewrite rules called @code{IntegRules} and
23524@code{IntegAfterRules} which you can edit to define new integration
23525methods. @xref{Rewrite Rules}. At each step of the integration process,
23526Calc wraps the current integrand in a call to the fictitious function
23527@samp{integtry(@var{expr},@var{var})}, where @var{expr} is the
23528integrand and @var{var} is the integration variable. If your rules
23529rewrite this to be a plain formula (not a call to @code{integtry}), then
23530Calc will use this formula as the integral of @var{expr}. For example,
23531the rule @samp{integtry(mysin(x),x) := -mycos(x)} would define a rule to
23532integrate a function @code{mysin} that acts like the sine function.
23533Then, putting @samp{4 mysin(2y+1)} on the stack and typing @kbd{a i y}
23534will produce the integral @samp{-2 mycos(2y+1)}. Note that Calc has
23535automatically made various transformations on the integral to allow it
23536to use your rule; integral tables generally give rules for
23537@samp{mysin(a x + b)}, but you don't need to use this much generality
23538in your @code{IntegRules}.
23539
23540@cindex Exponential integral Ei(x)
23541@ignore
23542@starindex
23543@end ignore
23544@tindex Ei
23545As a more serious example, the expression @samp{exp(x)/x} cannot be
23546integrated in terms of the standard functions, so the ``exponential
23547integral'' function
23548@texline @math{{\rm Ei}(x)}
23549@infoline @expr{Ei(x)}
23550was invented to describe it.
23551We can get Calc to do this integral in terms of a made-up @code{Ei}
23552function by adding the rule @samp{[integtry(exp(x)/x, x) := Ei(x)]}
23553to @code{IntegRules}. Now entering @samp{exp(2x)/x} on the stack
23554and typing @kbd{a i x} yields @samp{Ei(2 x)}. This new rule will
23555work with Calc's various built-in integration methods (such as
23556integration by substitution) to solve a variety of other problems
23557involving @code{Ei}: For example, now Calc will also be able to
23558integrate @samp{exp(exp(x))} and @samp{ln(ln(x))} (to get @samp{Ei(exp(x))}
23559and @samp{x ln(ln(x)) - Ei(ln(x))}, respectively).
23560
23561Your rule may do further integration by calling @code{integ}. For
23562example, @samp{integtry(twice(u),x) := twice(integ(u))} allows Calc
23563to integrate @samp{twice(sin(x))} to get @samp{twice(-cos(x))}.
23564Note that @code{integ} was called with only one argument. This notation
23565is allowed only within @code{IntegRules}; it means ``integrate this
23566with respect to the same integration variable.'' If Calc is unable
23567to integrate @code{u}, the integration that invoked @code{IntegRules}
23568also fails. Thus integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} fails, returning the
23569unevaluated integral @samp{integ(twice(f(x)), x)}. It is still valid
23570to call @code{integ} with two or more arguments, however; in this case,
23571if @code{u} is not integrable, @code{twice} itself will still be
23572integrated: If the above rule is changed to @samp{... := twice(integ(u,x))},
23573then integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} will yield @samp{twice(integ(f(x),x))}.
23574
23575If a rule instead produces the formula @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr},
23576@var{svar})}, either replacing the top-level @code{integtry} call or
23577nested anywhere inside the expression, then Calc will apply the
23578substitution @samp{@var{u} = @var{sexpr}(@var{svar})} to try to
23579integrate the original @var{expr}. For example, the rule
23580@samp{sqrt(a) := integsubst(sqrt(x),x)} says that if Calc ever finds
23581a square root in the integrand, it should attempt the substitution
23582@samp{u = sqrt(x)}. (This particular rule is unnecessary because
23583Calc always tries ``obvious'' substitutions where @var{sexpr} actually
23584appears in the integrand.) The variable @var{svar} may be the same
23585as the @var{var} that appeared in the call to @code{integtry}, but
23586it need not be.
23587
23588When integrating according to an @code{integsubst}, Calc uses the
23589equation solver to find the inverse of @var{sexpr} (if the integrand
23590refers to @var{var} anywhere except in subexpressions that exactly
23591match @var{sexpr}). It uses the differentiator to find the derivative
23592of @var{sexpr} and/or its inverse (it has two methods that use one
23593derivative or the other). You can also specify these items by adding
23594extra arguments to the @code{integsubst} your rules construct; the
23595general form is @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr}, @var{svar}, @var{sinv},
23596@var{sprime})}, where @var{sinv} is the inverse of @var{sexpr} (still
23597written as a function of @var{svar}), and @var{sprime} is the
23598derivative of @var{sexpr} with respect to @var{svar}. If you don't
23599specify these things, and Calc is not able to work them out on its
23600own with the information it knows, then your substitution rule will
23601work only in very specific, simple cases.
23602
23603Calc applies @code{IntegRules} as if by @kbd{C-u 1 a r IntegRules};
23604in other words, Calc stops rewriting as soon as any rule in your rule
23605set succeeds. (If it weren't for this, the @samp{integsubst(sqrt(x),x)}
23606example above would keep on adding layers of @code{integsubst} calls
23607forever!)
23608
23609@vindex IntegSimpRules
23610Another set of rules, stored in @code{IntegSimpRules}, are applied
23611every time the integrator uses @kbd{a s} to simplify an intermediate
23612result. For example, putting the rule @samp{twice(x) := 2 x} into
23613@code{IntegSimpRules} would tell Calc to convert the @code{twice}
23614function into a form it knows whenever integration is attempted.
23615
23616One more way to influence the integrator is to define a function with
23617the @kbd{Z F} command (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}). Calc's
23618integrator automatically expands such functions according to their
23619defining formulas, even if you originally asked for the function to
23620be left unevaluated for symbolic arguments. (Certain other Calc
23621systems, such as the differentiator and the equation solver, also
23622do this.)
23623
23624@vindex IntegAfterRules
23625Sometimes Calc is able to find a solution to your integral, but it
23626expresses the result in a way that is unnecessarily complicated. If
23627this happens, you can either use @code{integsubst} as described
23628above to try to hint at a more direct path to the desired result, or
23629you can use @code{IntegAfterRules}. This is an extra rule set that
23630runs after the main integrator returns its result; basically, Calc does
23631an @kbd{a r IntegAfterRules} on the result before showing it to you.
23632(It also does an @kbd{a s}, without @code{IntegSimpRules}, after that
23633to further simplify the result.) For example, Calc's integrator
23634sometimes produces expressions of the form @samp{ln(1+x) - ln(1-x)};
23635the default @code{IntegAfterRules} rewrite this into the more readable
23636form @samp{2 arctanh(x)}. Note that, unlike @code{IntegRules},
23637@code{IntegSimpRules} and @code{IntegAfterRules} are applied any number
23638of times until no further changes are possible. Rewriting by
23639@code{IntegAfterRules} occurs only after the main integrator has
23640finished, not at every step as for @code{IntegRules} and
23641@code{IntegSimpRules}.
23642
23643@node Numerical Integration, Taylor Series, Customizing the Integrator, Calculus
23644@subsection Numerical Integration
23645
23646@noindent
23647@kindex a I
23648@pindex calc-num-integral
23649@tindex ninteg
23650If you want a purely numerical answer to an integration problem, you can
23651use the @kbd{a I} (@code{calc-num-integral}) [@code{ninteg}] command. This
23652command prompts for an integration variable, a lower limit, and an
23653upper limit. Except for the integration variable, all other variables
23654that appear in the integrand formula must have stored values. (A stored
23655value, if any, for the integration variable itself is ignored.)
23656
23657Numerical integration works by evaluating your formula at many points in
23658the specified interval. Calc uses an ``open Romberg'' method; this means
23659that it does not evaluate the formula actually at the endpoints (so that
23660it is safe to integrate @samp{sin(x)/x} from zero, for example). Also,
23661the Romberg method works especially well when the function being
23662integrated is fairly smooth. If the function is not smooth, Calc will
23663have to evaluate it at quite a few points before it can accurately
23664determine the value of the integral.
23665
23666Integration is much faster when the current precision is small. It is
23667best to set the precision to the smallest acceptable number of digits
23668before you use @kbd{a I}. If Calc appears to be taking too long, press
23669@kbd{C-g} to halt it and try a lower precision. If Calc still appears
23670to need hundreds of evaluations, check to make sure your function is
23671well-behaved in the specified interval.
23672
23673It is possible for the lower integration limit to be @samp{-inf} (minus
23674infinity). Likewise, the upper limit may be plus infinity. Calc
23675internally transforms the integral into an equivalent one with finite
23676limits. However, integration to or across singularities is not supported:
23677The integral of @samp{1/sqrt(x)} from 0 to 1 exists (it can be found
23678by Calc's symbolic integrator, for example), but @kbd{a I} will fail
23679because the integrand goes to infinity at one of the endpoints.
23680
23681@node Taylor Series, , Numerical Integration, Calculus
23682@subsection Taylor Series
23683
23684@noindent
23685@kindex a t
23686@pindex calc-taylor
23687@tindex taylor
23688The @kbd{a t} (@code{calc-taylor}) [@code{taylor}] command computes a
23689power series expansion or Taylor series of a function. You specify the
23690variable and the desired number of terms. You may give an expression of
23691the form @samp{@var{var} = @var{a}} or @samp{@var{var} - @var{a}} instead
23692of just a variable to produce a Taylor expansion about the point @var{a}.
23693You may specify the number of terms with a numeric prefix argument;
23694otherwise the command will prompt you for the number of terms. Note that
23695many series expansions have coefficients of zero for some terms, so you
23696may appear to get fewer terms than you asked for.
23697
23698If the @kbd{a i} command is unable to find a symbolic integral for a
23699function, you can get an approximation by integrating the function's
23700Taylor series.
23701
23702@node Solving Equations, Numerical Solutions, Calculus, Algebra
23703@section Solving Equations
23704
23705@noindent
23706@kindex a S
23707@pindex calc-solve-for
23708@tindex solve
23709@cindex Equations, solving
23710@cindex Solving equations
23711The @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) [@code{solve}] command rearranges
23712an equation to solve for a specific variable. An equation is an
23713expression of the form @expr{L = R}. For example, the command @kbd{a S x}
23714will rearrange @expr{y = 3x + 6} to the form, @expr{x = y/3 - 2}. If the
23715input is not an equation, it is treated like an equation of the
23716form @expr{X = 0}.
23717
23718This command also works for inequalities, as in @expr{y < 3x + 6}.
23719Some inequalities cannot be solved where the analogous equation could
23720be; for example, solving
23721@texline @math{a < b \, c}
23722@infoline @expr{a < b c}
23723for @expr{b} is impossible
23724without knowing the sign of @expr{c}. In this case, @kbd{a S} will
23725produce the result
23726@texline @math{b \mathbin{\hbox{\code{!=}}} a/c}
23727@infoline @expr{b != a/c}
23728(using the not-equal-to operator) to signify that the direction of the
23729inequality is now unknown. The inequality
23730@texline @math{a \le b \, c}
23731@infoline @expr{a <= b c}
23732is not even partially solved. @xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell
23733Calc that the signs of the variables in a formula are in fact known.
23734
23735Two useful commands for working with the result of @kbd{a S} are
23736@kbd{a .} (@pxref{Logical Operations}), which converts @expr{x = y/3 - 2}
23737to @expr{y/3 - 2}, and @kbd{s l} (@pxref{Let Command}) which evaluates
23738another formula with @expr{x} set equal to @expr{y/3 - 2}.
23739
23740@menu
23741* Multiple Solutions::
23742* Solving Systems of Equations::
23743* Decomposing Polynomials::
23744@end menu
23745
23746@node Multiple Solutions, Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations, Solving Equations
23747@subsection Multiple Solutions
23748
23749@noindent
23750@kindex H a S
23751@tindex fsolve
23752Some equations have more than one solution. The Hyperbolic flag
23753(@code{H a S}) [@code{fsolve}] tells the solver to report the fully
23754general family of solutions. It will invent variables @code{n1},
23755@code{n2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary integers, and
23756@code{s1}, @code{s2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary
23757signs (either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}). If you don't use the Hyperbolic
23758flag, Calc will use zero in place of all arbitrary integers, and plus
23759one in place of all arbitrary signs. Note that variables like @code{n1}
23760and @code{s1} are not given any special interpretation in Calc except by
23761the equation solver itself. As usual, you can use the @w{@kbd{s l}}
23762(@code{calc-let}) command to obtain solutions for various actual values
23763of these variables.
23764
23765For example, @kbd{' x^2 = y @key{RET} H a S x @key{RET}} solves to
23766get @samp{x = s1 sqrt(y)}, indicating that the two solutions to the
23767equation are @samp{sqrt(y)} and @samp{-sqrt(y)}. Another way to
23768think about it is that the square-root operation is really a
23769two-valued function; since every Calc function must return a
23770single result, @code{sqrt} chooses to return the positive result.
23771Then @kbd{H a S} doctors this result using @code{s1} to indicate
23772the full set of possible values of the mathematical square-root.
23773
23774There is a similar phenomenon going the other direction: Suppose
23775we solve @samp{sqrt(y) = x} for @code{y}. Calc squares both sides
23776to get @samp{y = x^2}. This is correct, except that it introduces
23777some dubious solutions. Consider solving @samp{sqrt(y) = -3}:
23778Calc will report @expr{y = 9} as a valid solution, which is true
23779in the mathematical sense of square-root, but false (there is no
23780solution) for the actual Calc positive-valued @code{sqrt}. This
23781happens for both @kbd{a S} and @kbd{H a S}.
23782
23783@cindex @code{GenCount} variable
23784@vindex GenCount
23785@ignore
23786@starindex
23787@end ignore
23788@tindex an
23789@ignore
23790@starindex
23791@end ignore
23792@tindex as
23793If you store a positive integer in the Calc variable @code{GenCount},
23794then Calc will generate formulas of the form @samp{as(@var{n})} for
23795arbitrary signs, and @samp{an(@var{n})} for arbitrary integers,
23796where @var{n} represents successive values taken by incrementing
23797@code{GenCount} by one. While the normal arbitrary sign and
23798integer symbols start over at @code{s1} and @code{n1} with each
23799new Calc command, the @code{GenCount} approach will give each
23800arbitrary value a name that is unique throughout the entire Calc
23801session. Also, the arbitrary values are function calls instead
23802of variables, which is advantageous in some cases. For example,
23803you can make a rewrite rule that recognizes all arbitrary signs
23804using a pattern like @samp{as(n)}. The @kbd{s l} command only works
23805on variables, but you can use the @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
23806command to substitute actual values for function calls like @samp{as(3)}.
23807
23808The @kbd{s G} (@code{calc-edit-GenCount}) command is a convenient
23809way to create or edit this variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish.
23810
23811If you have not stored a value in @code{GenCount}, or if the value
23812in that variable is not a positive integer, the regular
23813@code{s1}/@code{n1} notation is used.
23814
23815@kindex I a S
23816@kindex H I a S
23817@tindex finv
23818@tindex ffinv
23819With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a S} [@code{finv}] treats the expression
23820on top of the stack as a function of the specified variable and solves
23821to find the inverse function, written in terms of the same variable.
23822For example, @kbd{I a S x} inverts @expr{2x + 6} to @expr{x/2 - 3}.
23823You can use both Inverse and Hyperbolic [@code{ffinv}] to obtain a
23824fully general inverse, as described above.
23825
23826@kindex a P
23827@pindex calc-poly-roots
23828@tindex roots
23829Some equations, specifically polynomials, have a known, finite number
23830of solutions. The @kbd{a P} (@code{calc-poly-roots}) [@code{roots}]
23831command uses @kbd{H a S} to solve an equation in general form, then, for
23832all arbitrary-sign variables like @code{s1}, and all arbitrary-integer
23833variables like @code{n1} for which @code{n1} only usefully varies over
23834a finite range, it expands these variables out to all their possible
23835values. The results are collected into a vector, which is returned.
23836For example, @samp{roots(x^4 = 1, x)} returns the four solutions
23837@samp{[1, -1, (0, 1), (0, -1)]}. Generally an @var{n}th degree
23838polynomial will always have @var{n} roots on the complex plane.
23839(If you have given a @code{real} declaration for the solution
23840variable, then only the real-valued solutions, if any, will be
23841reported; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23842
23843Note that because @kbd{a P} uses @kbd{H a S}, it is able to deliver
23844symbolic solutions if the polynomial has symbolic coefficients. Also
23845note that Calc's solver is not able to get exact symbolic solutions
23846to all polynomials. Polynomials containing powers up to @expr{x^4}
23847can always be solved exactly; polynomials of higher degree sometimes
23848can be: @expr{x^6 + x^3 + 1} is converted to @expr{(x^3)^2 + (x^3) + 1},
23849which can be solved for @expr{x^3} using the quadratic equation, and then
23850for @expr{x} by taking cube roots. But in many cases, like
23851@expr{x^6 + x + 1}, Calc does not know how to rewrite the polynomial
23852into a form it can solve. The @kbd{a P} command can still deliver a
23853list of numerical roots, however, provided that Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s})
23854is not turned on. (If you work with Symbolic mode on, recall that the
23855@kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) key is a handy way to reevaluate the
23856formula on the stack with Symbolic mode temporarily off.) Naturally,
23857@kbd{a P} can only provide numerical roots if the polynomial coefficients
23858are all numbers (real or complex).
23859
23860@node Solving Systems of Equations, Decomposing Polynomials, Multiple Solutions, Solving Equations
23861@subsection Solving Systems of Equations
23862
23863@noindent
23864@cindex Systems of equations, symbolic
23865You can also use the commands described above to solve systems of
23866simultaneous equations. Just create a vector of equations, then
23867specify a vector of variables for which to solve. (You can omit
23868the surrounding brackets when entering the vector of variables
23869at the prompt.)
23870
23871For example, putting @samp{[x + y = a, x - y = b]} on the stack
23872and typing @kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}} produces the vector of solutions
23873@samp{[x = a - (a-b)/2, y = (a-b)/2]}. The result vector will
23874have the same length as the variables vector, and the variables
23875will be listed in the same order there. Note that the solutions
23876are not always simplified as far as possible; the solution for
23877@expr{x} here could be improved by an application of the @kbd{a n}
23878command.
23879
23880Calc's algorithm works by trying to eliminate one variable at a
23881time by solving one of the equations for that variable and then
23882substituting into the other equations. Calc will try all the
23883possibilities, but you can speed things up by noting that Calc
23884first tries to eliminate the first variable with the first
23885equation, then the second variable with the second equation,
23886and so on. It also helps to put the simpler (e.g., more linear)
23887equations toward the front of the list. Calc's algorithm will
23888solve any system of linear equations, and also many kinds of
23889nonlinear systems.
23890
23891@ignore
23892@starindex
23893@end ignore
23894@tindex elim
23895Normally there will be as many variables as equations. If you
23896give fewer variables than equations (an ``over-determined'' system
23897of equations), Calc will find a partial solution. For example,
23898typing @kbd{a S y @key{RET}} with the above system of equations
23899would produce @samp{[y = a - x]}. There are now several ways to
23900express this solution in terms of the original variables; Calc uses
23901the first one that it finds. You can control the choice by adding
23902variable specifiers of the form @samp{elim(@var{v})} to the
23903variables list. This says that @var{v} should be eliminated from
23904the equations; the variable will not appear at all in the solution.
23905For example, typing @kbd{a S y,elim(x)} would yield
23906@samp{[y = a - (b+a)/2]}.
23907
23908If the variables list contains only @code{elim} specifiers,
23909Calc simply eliminates those variables from the equations
23910and then returns the resulting set of equations. For example,
23911@kbd{a S elim(x)} produces @samp{[a - 2 y = b]}. Every variable
23912eliminated will reduce the number of equations in the system
23913by one.
23914
23915Again, @kbd{a S} gives you one solution to the system of
23916equations. If there are several solutions, you can use @kbd{H a S}
23917to get a general family of solutions, or, if there is a finite
23918number of solutions, you can use @kbd{a P} to get a list. (In
23919the latter case, the result will take the form of a matrix where
23920the rows are different solutions and the columns correspond to the
23921variables you requested.)
23922
23923Another way to deal with certain kinds of overdetermined systems of
23924equations is the @kbd{a F} command, which does least-squares fitting
23925to satisfy the equations. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
23926
23927@node Decomposing Polynomials, , Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations
23928@subsection Decomposing Polynomials
23929
23930@noindent
23931@ignore
23932@starindex
23933@end ignore
23934@tindex poly
23935The @code{poly} function takes a polynomial and a variable as
23936arguments, and returns a vector of polynomial coefficients (constant
23937coefficient first). For example, @samp{poly(x^3 + 2 x, x)} returns
23938@expr{[0, 2, 0, 1]}. If the input is not a polynomial in @expr{x},
23939the call to @code{poly} is left in symbolic form. If the input does
23940not involve the variable @expr{x}, the input is returned in a list
23941of length one, representing a polynomial with only a constant
23942coefficient. The call @samp{poly(x, x)} returns the vector @expr{[0, 1]}.
23943The last element of the returned vector is guaranteed to be nonzero;
23944note that @samp{poly(0, x)} returns the empty vector @expr{[]}.
23945Note also that @expr{x} may actually be any formula; for example,
23946@samp{poly(sin(x)^2 - sin(x) + 3, sin(x))} returns @expr{[3, -1, 1]}.
23947
23948@cindex Coefficients of polynomial
23949@cindex Degree of polynomial
23950To get the @expr{x^k} coefficient of polynomial @expr{p}, use
23951@samp{poly(p, x)_(k+1)}. To get the degree of polynomial @expr{p},
23952use @samp{vlen(poly(p, x)) - 1}. For example, @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)}
23953returns @samp{[1, 4, 6, 4, 1]}, so @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)_(2+1)}
23954gives the @expr{x^2} coefficient of this polynomial, 6.
23955
23956@ignore
23957@starindex
23958@end ignore
23959@tindex gpoly
23960One important feature of the solver is its ability to recognize
23961formulas which are ``essentially'' polynomials. This ability is
23962made available to the user through the @code{gpoly} function, which
23963is used just like @code{poly}: @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var})}.
23964If @var{expr} is a polynomial in some term which includes @var{var}, then
23965this function will return a vector @samp{[@var{x}, @var{c}, @var{a}]}
23966where @var{x} is the term that depends on @var{var}, @var{c} is a
23967vector of polynomial coefficients (like the one returned by @code{poly}),
23968and @var{a} is a multiplier which is usually 1. Basically,
23969@samp{@var{expr} = @var{a}*(@var{c}_1 + @var{c}_2 @var{x} +
23970@var{c}_3 @var{x}^2 + ...)}. The last element of @var{c} is
23971guaranteed to be non-zero, and @var{c} will not equal @samp{[1]}
23972(i.e., the trivial decomposition @var{expr} = @var{x} is not
23973considered a polynomial). One side effect is that @samp{gpoly(x, x)}
23974and @samp{gpoly(6, x)}, both of which might be expected to recognize
23975their arguments as polynomials, will not because the decomposition
23976is considered trivial.
23977
23978For example, @samp{gpoly((x-2)^2, x)} returns @samp{[x, [4, -4, 1], 1]},
23979since the expanded form of this polynomial is @expr{4 - 4 x + x^2}.
23980
23981The term @var{x} may itself be a polynomial in @var{var}. This is
23982done to reduce the size of the @var{c} vector. For example,
23983@samp{gpoly(x^4 + x^2 - 1, x)} returns @samp{[x^2, [-1, 1, 1], 1]},
23984since a quadratic polynomial in @expr{x^2} is easier to solve than
23985a quartic polynomial in @expr{x}.
23986
23987A few more examples of the kinds of polynomials @code{gpoly} can
23988discover:
23989
23990@smallexample
23991sin(x) - 1 [sin(x), [-1, 1], 1]
23992x + 1/x - 1 [x, [1, -1, 1], 1/x]
23993x + 1/x [x^2, [1, 1], 1/x]
23994x^3 + 2 x [x^2, [2, 1], x]
23995x + x^2:3 + sqrt(x) [x^1:6, [1, 1, 0, 1], x^1:2]
23996x^(2a) + 2 x^a + 5 [x^a, [5, 2, 1], 1]
23997(exp(-x) + exp(x)) / 2 [e^(2 x), [0.5, 0.5], e^-x]
23998@end smallexample
23999
24000The @code{poly} and @code{gpoly} functions accept a third integer argument
24001which specifies the largest degree of polynomial that is acceptable.
24002If this is @expr{n}, then only @var{c} vectors of length @expr{n+1}
24003or less will be returned. Otherwise, the @code{poly} or @code{gpoly}
24004call will remain in symbolic form. For example, the equation solver
24005can handle quartics and smaller polynomials, so it calls
24006@samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var}, 4)} to discover whether @var{expr}
24007can be treated by its linear, quadratic, cubic, or quartic formulas.
24008
24009@ignore
24010@starindex
24011@end ignore
24012@tindex pdeg
24013The @code{pdeg} function computes the degree of a polynomial;
24014@samp{pdeg(p,x)} is the highest power of @code{x} that appears in
24015@code{p}. This is the same as @samp{vlen(poly(p,x))-1}, but is
24016much more efficient. If @code{p} is constant with respect to @code{x},
24017then @samp{pdeg(p,x) = 0}. If @code{p} is not a polynomial in @code{x}
24018(e.g., @samp{pdeg(2 cos(x), x)}, the function remains unevaluated.
24019It is possible to omit the second argument @code{x}, in which case
24020@samp{pdeg(p)} returns the highest total degree of any term of the
24021polynomial, counting all variables that appear in @code{p}. Note
24022that @code{pdeg(c) = pdeg(c,x) = 0} for any nonzero constant @code{c};
24023the degree of the constant zero is considered to be @code{-inf}
24024(minus infinity).
24025
24026@ignore
24027@starindex
24028@end ignore
24029@tindex plead
24030The @code{plead} function finds the leading term of a polynomial.
24031Thus @samp{plead(p,x)} is equivalent to @samp{poly(p,x)_vlen(poly(p,x))},
24032though again more efficient. In particular, @samp{plead((2x+1)^10, x)}
24033returns 1024 without expanding out the list of coefficients. The
24034value of @code{plead(p,x)} will be zero only if @expr{p = 0}.
24035
24036@ignore
24037@starindex
24038@end ignore
24039@tindex pcont
24040The @code{pcont} function finds the @dfn{content} of a polynomial. This
24041is the greatest common divisor of all the coefficients of the polynomial.
24042With two arguments, @code{pcont(p,x)} effectively uses @samp{poly(p,x)}
24043to get a list of coefficients, then uses @code{pgcd} (the polynomial
24044GCD function) to combine these into an answer. For example,
24045@samp{pcont(4 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y, x)} is @samp{2 y}. The content is
24046basically the ``biggest'' polynomial that can be divided into @code{p}
24047exactly. The sign of the content is the same as the sign of the leading
24048coefficient.
24049
24050With only one argument, @samp{pcont(p)} computes the numerical
24051content of the polynomial, i.e., the @code{gcd} of the numerical
24052coefficients of all the terms in the formula. Note that @code{gcd}
24053is defined on rational numbers as well as integers; it computes
24054the @code{gcd} of the numerators and the @code{lcm} of the
24055denominators. Thus @samp{pcont(4:3 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y)} returns 2:3.
24056Dividing the polynomial by this number will clear all the
24057denominators, as well as dividing by any common content in the
24058numerators. The numerical content of a polynomial is negative only
24059if all the coefficients in the polynomial are negative.
24060
24061@ignore
24062@starindex
24063@end ignore
24064@tindex pprim
24065The @code{pprim} function finds the @dfn{primitive part} of a
24066polynomial, which is simply the polynomial divided (using @code{pdiv}
24067if necessary) by its content. If the input polynomial has rational
24068coefficients, the result will have integer coefficients in simplest
24069terms.
24070
24071@node Numerical Solutions, Curve Fitting, Solving Equations, Algebra
24072@section Numerical Solutions
24073
24074@noindent
24075Not all equations can be solved symbolically. The commands in this
24076section use numerical algorithms that can find a solution to a specific
24077instance of an equation to any desired accuracy. Note that the
24078numerical commands are slower than their algebraic cousins; it is a
24079good idea to try @kbd{a S} before resorting to these commands.
24080
24081(@xref{Curve Fitting}, for some other, more specialized, operations
24082on numerical data.)
24083
24084@menu
24085* Root Finding::
24086* Minimization::
24087* Numerical Systems of Equations::
24088@end menu
24089
24090@node Root Finding, Minimization, Numerical Solutions, Numerical Solutions
24091@subsection Root Finding
24092
24093@noindent
24094@kindex a R
24095@pindex calc-find-root
24096@tindex root
24097@cindex Newton's method
24098@cindex Roots of equations
24099@cindex Numerical root-finding
24100The @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}) [@code{root}] command finds a
24101numerical solution (or @dfn{root}) of an equation. (This command treats
24102inequalities the same as equations. If the input is any other kind
24103of formula, it is interpreted as an equation of the form @expr{X = 0}.)
24104
24105The @kbd{a R} command requires an initial guess on the top of the
24106stack, and a formula in the second-to-top position. It prompts for a
24107solution variable, which must appear in the formula. All other variables
24108that appear in the formula must have assigned values, i.e., when
24109a value is assigned to the solution variable and the formula is
24110evaluated with @kbd{=}, it should evaluate to a number. Any assigned
24111value for the solution variable itself is ignored and unaffected by
24112this command.
24113
24114When the command completes, the initial guess is replaced on the stack
24115by a vector of two numbers: The value of the solution variable that
24116solves the equation, and the difference between the lefthand and
24117righthand sides of the equation at that value. Ordinarily, the second
24118number will be zero or very nearly zero. (Note that Calc uses a
24119slightly higher precision while finding the root, and thus the second
24120number may be slightly different from the value you would compute from
24121the equation yourself.)
24122
24123The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) command is a handy way to extract
24124the first element of the result vector, discarding the error term.
24125
24126The initial guess can be a real number, in which case Calc searches
24127for a real solution near that number, or a complex number, in which
24128case Calc searches the whole complex plane near that number for a
24129solution, or it can be an interval form which restricts the search
24130to real numbers inside that interval.
24131
24132Calc tries to use @kbd{a d} to take the derivative of the equation.
24133If this succeeds, it uses Newton's method. If the equation is not
24134differentiable Calc uses a bisection method. (If Newton's method
24135appears to be going astray, Calc switches over to bisection if it
24136can, or otherwise gives up. In this case it may help to try again
24137with a slightly different initial guess.) If the initial guess is a
24138complex number, the function must be differentiable.
24139
24140If the formula (or the difference between the sides of an equation)
24141is negative at one end of the interval you specify and positive at
24142the other end, the root finder is guaranteed to find a root.
24143Otherwise, Calc subdivides the interval into small parts looking for
24144positive and negative values to bracket the root. When your guess is
24145an interval, Calc will not look outside that interval for a root.
24146
24147@kindex H a R
24148@tindex wroot
24149The @kbd{H a R} [@code{wroot}] command is similar to @kbd{a R}, except
24150that if the initial guess is an interval for which the function has
24151the same sign at both ends, then rather than subdividing the interval
24152Calc attempts to widen it to enclose a root. Use this mode if
24153you are not sure if the function has a root in your interval.
24154
24155If the function is not differentiable, and you give a simple number
24156instead of an interval as your initial guess, Calc uses this widening
24157process even if you did not type the Hyperbolic flag. (If the function
24158@emph{is} differentiable, Calc uses Newton's method which does not
24159require a bounding interval in order to work.)
24160
24161If Calc leaves the @code{root} or @code{wroot} function in symbolic
24162form on the stack, it will normally display an explanation for why
24163no root was found. If you miss this explanation, press @kbd{w}
24164(@code{calc-why}) to get it back.
24165
24166@node Minimization, Numerical Systems of Equations, Root Finding, Numerical Solutions
24167@subsection Minimization
24168
24169@noindent
24170@kindex a N
24171@kindex H a N
24172@kindex a X
24173@kindex H a X
24174@pindex calc-find-minimum
24175@pindex calc-find-maximum
24176@tindex minimize
24177@tindex maximize
24178@cindex Minimization, numerical
24179The @kbd{a N} (@code{calc-find-minimum}) [@code{minimize}] command
24180finds a minimum value for a formula. It is very similar in operation
24181to @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}): You give the formula and an initial
24182guess on the stack, and are prompted for the name of a variable. The guess
24183may be either a number near the desired minimum, or an interval enclosing
24184the desired minimum. The function returns a vector containing the
24185value of the variable which minimizes the formula's value, along
24186with the minimum value itself.
24187
24188Note that this command looks for a @emph{local} minimum. Many functions
24189have more than one minimum; some, like
24190@texline @math{x \sin x},
24191@infoline @expr{x sin(x)},
24192have infinitely many. In fact, there is no easy way to define the
24193``global'' minimum of
24194@texline @math{x \sin x}
24195@infoline @expr{x sin(x)}
24196but Calc can still locate any particular local minimum
24197for you. Calc basically goes downhill from the initial guess until it
24198finds a point at which the function's value is greater both to the left
24199and to the right. Calc does not use derivatives when minimizing a function.
24200
24201If your initial guess is an interval and it looks like the minimum
24202occurs at one or the other endpoint of the interval, Calc will return
24203that endpoint only if that endpoint is closed; thus, minimizing @expr{17 x}
24204over @expr{[2..3]} will return @expr{[2, 38]}, but minimizing over
24205@expr{(2..3]} would report no minimum found. In general, you should
24206use closed intervals to find literally the minimum value in that
24207range of @expr{x}, or open intervals to find the local minimum, if
24208any, that happens to lie in that range.
24209
24210Most functions are smooth and flat near their minimum values. Because
24211of this flatness, if the current precision is, say, 12 digits, the
24212variable can only be determined meaningfully to about six digits. Thus
24213you should set the precision to twice as many digits as you need in your
24214answer.
24215
24216@ignore
24217@mindex wmin@idots
24218@end ignore
24219@tindex wminimize
24220@ignore
24221@mindex wmax@idots
24222@end ignore
24223@tindex wmaximize
24224The @kbd{H a N} [@code{wminimize}] command, analogously to @kbd{H a R},
24225expands the guess interval to enclose a minimum rather than requiring
24226that the minimum lie inside the interval you supply.
24227
24228The @kbd{a X} (@code{calc-find-maximum}) [@code{maximize}] and
24229@kbd{H a X} [@code{wmaximize}] commands effectively minimize the
24230negative of the formula you supply.
24231
24232The formula must evaluate to a real number at all points inside the
24233interval (or near the initial guess if the guess is a number). If
24234the initial guess is a complex number the variable will be minimized
24235over the complex numbers; if it is real or an interval it will
24236be minimized over the reals.
24237
24238@node Numerical Systems of Equations, , Minimization, Numerical Solutions
24239@subsection Systems of Equations
24240
24241@noindent
24242@cindex Systems of equations, numerical
24243The @kbd{a R} command can also solve systems of equations. In this
24244case, the equation should instead be a vector of equations, the
24245guess should instead be a vector of numbers (intervals are not
24246supported), and the variable should be a vector of variables. You
24247can omit the brackets while entering the list of variables. Each
24248equation must be differentiable by each variable for this mode to
24249work. The result will be a vector of two vectors: The variable
24250values that solved the system of equations, and the differences
24251between the sides of the equations with those variable values.
24252There must be the same number of equations as variables. Since
24253only plain numbers are allowed as guesses, the Hyperbolic flag has
24254no effect when solving a system of equations.
24255
24256It is also possible to minimize over many variables with @kbd{a N}
24257(or maximize with @kbd{a X}). Once again the variable name should
24258be replaced by a vector of variables, and the initial guess should
24259be an equal-sized vector of initial guesses. But, unlike the case of
24260multidimensional @kbd{a R}, the formula being minimized should
24261still be a single formula, @emph{not} a vector. Beware that
24262multidimensional minimization is currently @emph{very} slow.
24263
24264@node Curve Fitting, Summations, Numerical Solutions, Algebra
24265@section Curve Fitting
24266
24267@noindent
24268The @kbd{a F} command fits a set of data to a @dfn{model formula},
24269such as @expr{y = m x + b} where @expr{m} and @expr{b} are parameters
24270to be determined. For a typical set of measured data there will be
24271no single @expr{m} and @expr{b} that exactly fit the data; in this
24272case, Calc chooses values of the parameters that provide the closest
24273possible fit. The model formula can be entered in various ways after
24274the key sequence @kbd{a F} is pressed.
24275
24276If the letter @kbd{P} is pressed after @kbd{a F} but before the model
24277description is entered, the data as well as the model formula will be
24278plotted after the formula is determined. This will be indicated by a
24279``P'' in the minibuffer after the help message.
24280
24281@menu
24282* Linear Fits::
24283* Polynomial and Multilinear Fits::
24284* Error Estimates for Fits::
24285* Standard Nonlinear Models::
24286* Curve Fitting Details::
24287* Interpolation::
24288@end menu
24289
24290@node Linear Fits, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting, Curve Fitting
24291@subsection Linear Fits
24292
24293@noindent
24294@kindex a F
24295@pindex calc-curve-fit
24296@tindex fit
24297@cindex Linear regression
24298@cindex Least-squares fits
24299The @kbd{a F} (@code{calc-curve-fit}) [@code{fit}] command attempts
24300to fit a set of data (@expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers) to a
24301straight line, polynomial, or other function of @expr{x}. For the
24302moment we will consider only the case of fitting to a line, and we
24303will ignore the issue of whether or not the model was in fact a good
24304fit for the data.
24305
24306In a standard linear least-squares fit, we have a set of @expr{(x,y)}
24307data points that we wish to fit to the model @expr{y = m x + b}
24308by adjusting the parameters @expr{m} and @expr{b} to make the @expr{y}
24309values calculated from the formula be as close as possible to the actual
24310@expr{y} values in the data set. (In a polynomial fit, the model is
24311instead, say, @expr{y = a x^3 + b x^2 + c x + d}. In a multilinear fit,
24312we have data points of the form @expr{(x_1,x_2,x_3,y)} and our model is
24313@expr{y = a x_1 + b x_2 + c x_3 + d}. These will be discussed later.)
24314
24315In the model formula, variables like @expr{x} and @expr{x_2} are called
24316the @dfn{independent variables}, and @expr{y} is the @dfn{dependent
24317variable}. Variables like @expr{m}, @expr{a}, and @expr{b} are called
24318the @dfn{parameters} of the model.
24319
24320The @kbd{a F} command takes the data set to be fitted from the stack.
24321By default, it expects the data in the form of a matrix. For example,
24322for a linear or polynomial fit, this would be a
24323@texline @math{2\times N}
24324@infoline 2xN
24325matrix where the first row is a list of @expr{x} values and the second
24326row has the corresponding @expr{y} values. For the multilinear fit
24327shown above, the matrix would have four rows (@expr{x_1}, @expr{x_2},
24328@expr{x_3}, and @expr{y}, respectively).
24329
24330If you happen to have an
24331@texline @math{N\times2}
24332@infoline Nx2
24333matrix instead of a
24334@texline @math{2\times N}
24335@infoline 2xN
24336matrix, just press @kbd{v t} first to transpose the matrix.
24337
24338After you type @kbd{a F}, Calc prompts you to select a model. For a
24339linear fit, press the digit @kbd{1}.
24340
24341Calc then prompts for you to name the variables. By default it chooses
24342high letters like @expr{x} and @expr{y} for independent variables and
24343low letters like @expr{a} and @expr{b} for parameters. (The dependent
24344variable doesn't need a name.) The two kinds of variables are separated
24345by a semicolon. Since you generally care more about the names of the
24346independent variables than of the parameters, Calc also allows you to
24347name only those and let the parameters use default names.
24348
24349For example, suppose the data matrix
24350
24351@ifnottex
24352@example
24353@group
24354[ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24355 [ 5, 7, 9, 11, 13 ] ]
24356@end group
24357@end example
24358@end ifnottex
24359@tex
4009494e
GM
24360\beforedisplay
24361$$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 & 4 & 5 \cr
24362 5 & 7 & 9 & 11 & 13 }
24363$$
24364\afterdisplay
24365@end tex
24366
24367@noindent
24368is on the stack and we wish to do a simple linear fit. Type
24369@kbd{a F}, then @kbd{1} for the model, then @key{RET} to use
24370the default names. The result will be the formula @expr{3. + 2. x}
24371on the stack. Calc has created the model expression @kbd{a + b x},
24372then found the optimal values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} to fit the
24373data. (In this case, it was able to find an exact fit.) Calc then
24374substituted those values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} in the model
24375formula.
24376
24377The @kbd{a F} command puts two entries in the trail. One is, as
24378always, a copy of the result that went to the stack; the other is
24379a vector of the actual parameter values, written as equations:
24380@expr{[a = 3, b = 2]}, in case you'd rather read them in a list
24381than pick them out of the formula. (You can type @kbd{t y}
24382to move this vector to the stack; see @ref{Trail Commands}.
24383
24384Specifying a different independent variable name will affect the
24385resulting formula: @kbd{a F 1 k @key{RET}} produces @kbd{3 + 2 k}.
24386Changing the parameter names (say, @kbd{a F 1 k;b,m @key{RET}}) will affect
24387the equations that go into the trail.
24388
24389@tex
24390\bigskip
24391@end tex
24392
24393To see what happens when the fit is not exact, we could change
24394the number 13 in the data matrix to 14 and try the fit again.
24395The result is:
24396
24397@example
243982.6 + 2.2 x
24399@end example
24400
24401Evaluating this formula, say with @kbd{v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}}, shows
24402a reasonably close match to the y-values in the data.
24403
24404@example
24405[4.8, 7., 9.2, 11.4, 13.6]
24406@end example
24407
24408Since there is no line which passes through all the @var{n} data points,
24409Calc has chosen a line that best approximates the data points using
24410the method of least squares. The idea is to define the @dfn{chi-square}
24411error measure
24412
24413@ifnottex
24414@example
24415chi^2 = sum((y_i - (a + b x_i))^2, i, 1, N)
24416@end example
24417@end ifnottex
24418@tex
4009494e
GM
24419\beforedisplay
24420$$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N (y_i - (a + b x_i))^2 $$
24421\afterdisplay
24422@end tex
24423
24424@noindent
24425which is clearly zero if @expr{a + b x} exactly fits all data points,
24426and increases as various @expr{a + b x_i} values fail to match the
24427corresponding @expr{y_i} values. There are several reasons why the
24428summand is squared, one of them being to ensure that
24429@texline @math{\chi^2 \ge 0}.
24430@infoline @expr{chi^2 >= 0}.
24431Least-squares fitting simply chooses the values of @expr{a} and @expr{b}
24432for which the error
24433@texline @math{\chi^2}
24434@infoline @expr{chi^2}
24435is as small as possible.
24436
24437Other kinds of models do the same thing but with a different model
24438formula in place of @expr{a + b x_i}.
24439
24440@tex
24441\bigskip
24442@end tex
24443
24444A numeric prefix argument causes the @kbd{a F} command to take the
24445data in some other form than one big matrix. A positive argument @var{n}
24446will take @var{N} items from the stack, corresponding to the @var{n} rows
24447of a data matrix. In the linear case, @var{n} must be 2 since there
24448is always one independent variable and one dependent variable.
24449
24450A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} is a compromise; Calc takes two
24451items from the stack, an @var{n}-row matrix of @expr{x} values, and a
24452vector of @expr{y} values. If there is only one independent variable,
24453the @expr{x} values can be either a one-row matrix or a plain vector,
24454in which case the @kbd{C-u} prefix is the same as a @w{@kbd{C-u 2}} prefix.
24455
24456@node Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Error Estimates for Fits, Linear Fits, Curve Fitting
24457@subsection Polynomial and Multilinear Fits
24458
24459@noindent
24460To fit the data to higher-order polynomials, just type one of the
24461digits @kbd{2} through @kbd{9} when prompted for a model. For example,
24462we could fit the original data matrix from the previous section
24463(with 13, not 14) to a parabola instead of a line by typing
24464@kbd{a F 2 @key{RET}}.
24465
24466@example
244672.00000000001 x - 1.5e-12 x^2 + 2.99999999999
24468@end example
24469
24470Note that since the constant and linear terms are enough to fit the
24471data exactly, it's no surprise that Calc chose a tiny contribution
24472for @expr{x^2}. (The fact that it's not exactly zero is due only
24473to roundoff error. Since our data are exact integers, we could get
24474an exact answer by typing @kbd{m f} first to get Fraction mode.
24475Then the @expr{x^2} term would vanish altogether. Usually, though,
24476the data being fitted will be approximate floats so Fraction mode
24477won't help.)
24478
24479Doing the @kbd{a F 2} fit on the data set with 14 instead of 13
24480gives a much larger @expr{x^2} contribution, as Calc bends the
24481line slightly to improve the fit.
24482
24483@example
244840.142857142855 x^2 + 1.34285714287 x + 3.59999999998
24485@end example
24486
24487An important result from the theory of polynomial fitting is that it
24488is always possible to fit @var{n} data points exactly using a polynomial
24489of degree @mathit{@var{n}-1}, sometimes called an @dfn{interpolating polynomial}.
24490Using the modified (14) data matrix, a model number of 4 gives
24491a polynomial that exactly matches all five data points:
24492
24493@example
244940.04167 x^4 - 0.4167 x^3 + 1.458 x^2 - 0.08333 x + 4.
24495@end example
24496
24497The actual coefficients we get with a precision of 12, like
24498@expr{0.0416666663588}, clearly suffer from loss of precision.
24499It is a good idea to increase the working precision to several
24500digits beyond what you need when you do a fitting operation.
24501Or, if your data are exact, use Fraction mode to get exact
24502results.
24503
24504You can type @kbd{i} instead of a digit at the model prompt to fit
24505the data exactly to a polynomial. This just counts the number of
24506columns of the data matrix to choose the degree of the polynomial
24507automatically.
24508
24509Fitting data ``exactly'' to high-degree polynomials is not always
24510a good idea, though. High-degree polynomials have a tendency to
24511wiggle uncontrollably in between the fitting data points. Also,
24512if the exact-fit polynomial is going to be used to interpolate or
24513extrapolate the data, it is numerically better to use the @kbd{a p}
24514command described below. @xref{Interpolation}.
24515
24516@tex
24517\bigskip
24518@end tex
24519
24520Another generalization of the linear model is to assume the
24521@expr{y} values are a sum of linear contributions from several
24522@expr{x} values. This is a @dfn{multilinear} fit, and it is also
24523selected by the @kbd{1} digit key. (Calc decides whether the fit
24524is linear or multilinear by counting the rows in the data matrix.)
24525
24526Given the data matrix,
24527
24528@example
24529@group
24530[ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24531 [ 7, 2, 3, 5, 2 ]
24532 [ 14.5, 15, 18.5, 22.5, 24 ] ]
24533@end group
24534@end example
24535
24536@noindent
24537the command @kbd{a F 1 @key{RET}} will call the first row @expr{x} and the
24538second row @expr{y}, and will fit the values in the third row to the
24539model @expr{a + b x + c y}.
24540
24541@example
245428. + 3. x + 0.5 y
24543@end example
24544
24545Calc can do multilinear fits with any number of independent variables
24546(i.e., with any number of data rows).
24547
24548@tex
24549\bigskip
24550@end tex
24551
24552Yet another variation is @dfn{homogeneous} linear models, in which
24553the constant term is known to be zero. In the linear case, this
24554means the model formula is simply @expr{a x}; in the multilinear
24555case, the model might be @expr{a x + b y + c z}; and in the polynomial
24556case, the model could be @expr{a x + b x^2 + c x^3}. You can get
24557a homogeneous linear or multilinear model by pressing the letter
24558@kbd{h} followed by a regular model key, like @kbd{1} or @kbd{2}.
24559This will be indicated by an ``h'' in the minibuffer after the help
24560message.
24561
24562It is certainly possible to have other constrained linear models,
24563like @expr{2.3 + a x} or @expr{a - 4 x}. While there is no single
24564key to select models like these, a later section shows how to enter
24565any desired model by hand. In the first case, for example, you
24566would enter @kbd{a F ' 2.3 + a x}.
24567
24568Another class of models that will work but must be entered by hand
24569are multinomial fits, e.g., @expr{a + b x + c y + d x^2 + e y^2 + f x y}.
24570
24571@node Error Estimates for Fits, Standard Nonlinear Models, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting
24572@subsection Error Estimates for Fits
24573
24574@noindent
24575@kindex H a F
24576@tindex efit
24577With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a F} [@code{efit}] performs the same
24578fitting operation as @kbd{a F}, but reports the coefficients as error
24579forms instead of plain numbers. Fitting our two data matrices (first
24580with 13, then with 14) to a line with @kbd{H a F} gives the results,
24581
24582@example
245833. + 2. x
245842.6 +/- 0.382970843103 + 2.2 +/- 0.115470053838 x
24585@end example
24586
24587In the first case the estimated errors are zero because the linear
24588fit is perfect. In the second case, the errors are nonzero but
24589moderately small, because the data are still very close to linear.
24590
24591It is also possible for the @emph{input} to a fitting operation to
24592contain error forms. The data values must either all include errors
24593or all be plain numbers. Error forms can go anywhere but generally
24594go on the numbers in the last row of the data matrix. If the last
24595row contains error forms
24596@texline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@math{\sigma_i}',
24597@infoline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@var{sigma_i}',
24598then the
24599@texline @math{\chi^2}
24600@infoline @expr{chi^2}
24601statistic is now,
24602
24603@ifnottex
24604@example
24605chi^2 = sum(((y_i - (a + b x_i)) / sigma_i)^2, i, 1, N)
24606@end example
24607@end ifnottex
24608@tex
4009494e
GM
24609\beforedisplay
24610$$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N \left(y_i - (a + b x_i) \over \sigma_i\right)^2 $$
24611\afterdisplay
24612@end tex
24613
24614@noindent
24615so that data points with larger error estimates contribute less to
24616the fitting operation.
24617
24618If there are error forms on other rows of the data matrix, all the
24619errors for a given data point are combined; the square root of the
24620sum of the squares of the errors forms the
24621@texline @math{\sigma_i}
24622@infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24623used for the data point.
24624
24625Both @kbd{a F} and @kbd{H a F} can accept error forms in the input
24626matrix, although if you are concerned about error analysis you will
24627probably use @kbd{H a F} so that the output also contains error
24628estimates.
24629
24630If the input contains error forms but all the
24631@texline @math{\sigma_i}
24632@infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24633values are the same, it is easy to see that the resulting fitted model
24634will be the same as if the input did not have error forms at all
24635@texline (@math{\chi^2}
24636@infoline (@expr{chi^2}
24637is simply scaled uniformly by
24638@texline @math{1 / \sigma^2},
24639@infoline @expr{1 / sigma^2},
24640which doesn't affect where it has a minimum). But there @emph{will} be
24641a difference in the estimated errors of the coefficients reported by
24642@kbd{H a F}.
24643
24644Consult any text on statistical modeling of data for a discussion
24645of where these error estimates come from and how they should be
24646interpreted.
24647
24648@tex
24649\bigskip
24650@end tex
24651
24652@kindex I a F
24653@tindex xfit
24654With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] produces even more
24655information. The result is a vector of six items:
24656
24657@enumerate
24658@item
24659The model formula with error forms for its coefficients or
24660parameters. This is the result that @kbd{H a F} would have
24661produced.
24662
24663@item
24664A vector of ``raw'' parameter values for the model. These are the
24665polynomial coefficients or other parameters as plain numbers, in the
24666same order as the parameters appeared in the final prompt of the
24667@kbd{I a F} command. For polynomials of degree @expr{d}, this vector
24668will have length @expr{M = d+1} with the constant term first.
24669
24670@item
24671The covariance matrix @expr{C} computed from the fit. This is
24672an @var{m}x@var{m} symmetric matrix; the diagonal elements
24673@texline @math{C_{jj}}
24674@infoline @expr{C_j_j}
24675are the variances
24676@texline @math{\sigma_j^2}
24677@infoline @expr{sigma_j^2}
24678of the parameters. The other elements are covariances
24679@texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2}
24680@infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2}
24681that describe the correlation between pairs of parameters. (A related
24682set of numbers, the @dfn{linear correlation coefficients}
24683@texline @math{r_{ij}},
24684@infoline @expr{r_i_j},
24685are defined as
24686@texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2 / \sigma_i \, \sigma_j}.)
24687@infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2 / sigma_i sigma_j}.)
24688
24689@item
24690A vector of @expr{M} ``parameter filter'' functions whose
24691meanings are described below. If no filters are necessary this
24692will instead be an empty vector; this is always the case for the
24693polynomial and multilinear fits described so far.
24694
24695@item
24696The value of
24697@texline @math{\chi^2}
24698@infoline @expr{chi^2}
24699for the fit, calculated by the formulas shown above. This gives a
24700measure of the quality of the fit; statisticians consider
24701@texline @math{\chi^2 \approx N - M}
24702@infoline @expr{chi^2 = N - M}
24703to indicate a moderately good fit (where again @expr{N} is the number of
24704data points and @expr{M} is the number of parameters).
24705
24706@item
24707A measure of goodness of fit expressed as a probability @expr{Q}.
24708This is computed from the @code{utpc} probability distribution
24709function using
24710@texline @math{\chi^2}
24711@infoline @expr{chi^2}
24712with @expr{N - M} degrees of freedom. A
24713value of 0.5 implies a good fit; some texts recommend that often
24714@expr{Q = 0.1} or even 0.001 can signify an acceptable fit. In
24715particular,
24716@texline @math{\chi^2}
24717@infoline @expr{chi^2}
24718statistics assume the errors in your inputs
24719follow a normal (Gaussian) distribution; if they don't, you may
24720have to accept smaller values of @expr{Q}.
24721
24722The @expr{Q} value is computed only if the input included error
24723estimates. Otherwise, Calc will report the symbol @code{nan}
24724for @expr{Q}. The reason is that in this case the
24725@texline @math{\chi^2}
24726@infoline @expr{chi^2}
24727value has effectively been used to estimate the original errors
24728in the input, and thus there is no redundant information left
24729over to use for a confidence test.
24730@end enumerate
24731
24732@node Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting Details, Error Estimates for Fits, Curve Fitting
24733@subsection Standard Nonlinear Models
24734
24735@noindent
24736The @kbd{a F} command also accepts other kinds of models besides
24737lines and polynomials. Some common models have quick single-key
24738abbreviations; others must be entered by hand as algebraic formulas.
24739
24740Here is a complete list of the standard models recognized by @kbd{a F}:
24741
24742@table @kbd
24743@item 1
24744Linear or multilinear. @mathit{a + b x + c y + d z}.
24745@item 2-9
24746Polynomials. @mathit{a + b x + c x^2 + d x^3}.
24747@item e
24748Exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(c y)}.
24749@item E
24750Base-10 exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(c y)}.
24751@item x
24752Exponential (alternate notation). @tfn{exp}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24753@item X
24754Base-10 exponential (alternate). @tfn{10^}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24755@item l
24756Logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(y)}.
24757@item L
24758Base-10 logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(y)}.
24759@item ^
24760General exponential. @mathit{a b^x c^y}.
24761@item p
24762Power law. @mathit{a x^b y^c}.
24763@item q
24764Quadratic. @mathit{a + b (x-c)^2 + d (x-e)^2}.
24765@item g
24766Gaussian.
24767@texline @math{{a \over b \sqrt{2 \pi}} \exp\left( -{1 \over 2} \left( x - c \over b \right)^2 \right)}.
24768@infoline @mathit{(a / b sqrt(2 pi)) exp(-0.5*((x-c)/b)^2)}.
24769@item s
24770Logistic @emph{s} curve.
24771@texline @math{a/(1+e^{b(x-c)})}.
24772@infoline @mathit{a/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))}.
24773@item b
24774Logistic bell curve.
24775@texline @math{ae^{b(x-c)}/(1+e^{b(x-c)})^2}.
24776@infoline @mathit{a exp(b (x - c))/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))^2}.
24777@item o
24778Hubbert linearization.
24779@texline @math{{y \over x} = a(1-x/b)}.
24780@infoline @mathit{(y/x) = a (1 - x/b)}.
24781@end table
24782
24783All of these models are used in the usual way; just press the appropriate
24784letter at the model prompt, and choose variable names if you wish. The
24785result will be a formula as shown in the above table, with the best-fit
24786values of the parameters substituted. (You may find it easier to read
24787the parameter values from the vector that is placed in the trail.)
24788
24789All models except Gaussian, logistics, Hubbert and polynomials can
24790generalize as shown to any number of independent variables. Also, all
24791the built-in models except for the logistic and Hubbert curves have an
24792additive or multiplicative parameter shown as @expr{a} in the above table
24793which can be replaced by zero or one, as appropriate, by typing @kbd{h}
24794before the model key.
24795
24796Note that many of these models are essentially equivalent, but express
24797the parameters slightly differently. For example, @expr{a b^x} and
24798the other two exponential models are all algebraic rearrangements of
24799each other. Also, the ``quadratic'' model is just a degree-2 polynomial
24800with the parameters expressed differently. Use whichever form best
24801matches the problem.
24802
24803The HP-28/48 calculators support four different models for curve
24804fitting, called @code{LIN}, @code{LOG}, @code{EXP}, and @code{PWR}.
24805These correspond to Calc models @samp{a + b x}, @samp{a + b ln(x)},
24806@samp{a exp(b x)}, and @samp{a x^b}, respectively. In each case,
24807@expr{a} is what the HP-48 identifies as the ``intercept,'' and
24808@expr{b} is what it calls the ``slope.''
24809
24810@tex
24811\bigskip
24812@end tex
24813
24814If the model you want doesn't appear on this list, press @kbd{'}
24815(the apostrophe key) at the model prompt to enter any algebraic
24816formula, such as @kbd{m x - b}, as the model. (Not all models
24817will work, though---see the next section for details.)
24818
24819The model can also be an equation like @expr{y = m x + b}.
24820In this case, Calc thinks of all the rows of the data matrix on
24821equal terms; this model effectively has two parameters
24822(@expr{m} and @expr{b}) and two independent variables (@expr{x}
24823and @expr{y}), with no ``dependent'' variables. Model equations
24824do not need to take this @expr{y =} form. For example, the
24825implicit line equation @expr{a x + b y = 1} works fine as a
24826model.
24827
24828When you enter a model, Calc makes an alphabetical list of all
24829the variables that appear in the model. These are used for the
24830default parameters, independent variables, and dependent variable
24831(in that order). If you enter a plain formula (not an equation),
24832Calc assumes the dependent variable does not appear in the formula
24833and thus does not need a name.
24834
24835For example, if the model formula has the variables @expr{a,mu,sigma,t,x},
24836and the data matrix has three rows (meaning two independent variables),
24837Calc will use @expr{a,mu,sigma} as the default parameters, and the
24838data rows will be named @expr{t} and @expr{x}, respectively. If you
24839enter an equation instead of a plain formula, Calc will use @expr{a,mu}
24840as the parameters, and @expr{sigma,t,x} as the three independent
24841variables.
24842
24843You can, of course, override these choices by entering something
24844different at the prompt. If you leave some variables out of the list,
24845those variables must have stored values and those stored values will
24846be used as constants in the model. (Stored values for the parameters
24847and independent variables are ignored by the @kbd{a F} command.)
24848If you list only independent variables, all the remaining variables
24849in the model formula will become parameters.
24850
24851If there are @kbd{$} signs in the model you type, they will stand
24852for parameters and all other variables (in alphabetical order)
24853will be independent. Use @kbd{$} for one parameter, @kbd{$$} for
24854another, and so on. Thus @kbd{$ x + $$} is another way to describe
24855a linear model.
24856
24857If you type a @kbd{$} instead of @kbd{'} at the model prompt itself,
24858Calc will take the model formula from the stack. (The data must then
24859appear at the second stack level.) The same conventions are used to
24860choose which variables in the formula are independent by default and
24861which are parameters.
24862
24863Models taken from the stack can also be expressed as vectors of
24864two or three elements, @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}]} or
24865@expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}]}. Each of @var{vars}
24866and @var{params} may be either a variable or a vector of variables.
24867(If @var{params} is omitted, all variables in @var{model} except
24868those listed as @var{vars} are parameters.)
24869
24870When you enter a model manually with @kbd{'}, Calc puts a 3-vector
24871describing the model in the trail so you can get it back if you wish.
24872
24873@tex
24874\bigskip
24875@end tex
24876
24877@vindex Model1
24878@vindex Model2
24879Finally, you can store a model in one of the Calc variables
24880@code{Model1} or @code{Model2}, then use this model by typing
24881@kbd{a F u} or @kbd{a F U} (respectively). The value stored in
24882the variable can be any of the formats that @kbd{a F $} would
24883accept for a model on the stack.
24884
24885@tex
24886\bigskip
24887@end tex
24888
24889Calc uses the principal values of inverse functions like @code{ln}
24890and @code{arcsin} when doing fits. For example, when you enter
24891the model @samp{y = sin(a t + b)} Calc actually uses the easier
24892form @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b}. The @code{arcsin} function always
24893returns results in the range from @mathit{-90} to 90 degrees (or the
24894equivalent range in radians). Suppose you had data that you
24895believed to represent roughly three oscillations of a sine wave,
24896so that the argument of the sine might go from zero to
24897@texline @math{3\times360}
24898@infoline @mathit{3*360}
24899degrees.
24900The above model would appear to be a good way to determine the
24901true frequency and phase of the sine wave, but in practice it
24902would fail utterly. The righthand side of the actual model
24903@samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b} will grow smoothly with @expr{t}, but
24904the lefthand side will bounce back and forth between @mathit{-90} and 90.
24905No values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} can make the two sides match,
24906even approximately.
24907
24908There is no good solution to this problem at present. You could
24909restrict your data to small enough ranges so that the above problem
24910doesn't occur (i.e., not straddling any peaks in the sine wave).
24911Or, in this case, you could use a totally different method such as
24912Fourier analysis, which is beyond the scope of the @kbd{a F} command.
24913(Unfortunately, Calc does not currently have any facilities for
24914taking Fourier and related transforms.)
24915
24916@node Curve Fitting Details, Interpolation, Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting
24917@subsection Curve Fitting Details
24918
24919@noindent
24920Calc's internal least-squares fitter can only handle multilinear
24921models. More precisely, it can handle any model of the form
24922@expr{a f(x,y,z) + b g(x,y,z) + c h(x,y,z)}, where @expr{a,b,c}
24923are the parameters and @expr{x,y,z} are the independent variables
24924(of course there can be any number of each, not just three).
24925
24926In a simple multilinear or polynomial fit, it is easy to see how
24927to convert the model into this form. For example, if the model
24928is @expr{a + b x + c x^2}, then @expr{f(x) = 1}, @expr{g(x) = x},
24929and @expr{h(x) = x^2} are suitable functions.
24930
24931For most other models, Calc uses a variety of algebraic manipulations
24932to try to put the problem into the form
24933
24934@smallexample
24935Y(x,y,z) = A(a,b,c) F(x,y,z) + B(a,b,c) G(x,y,z) + C(a,b,c) H(x,y,z)
24936@end smallexample
24937
24938@noindent
24939where @expr{Y,A,B,C,F,G,H} are arbitrary functions. It computes
24940@expr{Y}, @expr{F}, @expr{G}, and @expr{H} for all the data points,
24941does a standard linear fit to find the values of @expr{A}, @expr{B},
24942and @expr{C}, then uses the equation solver to solve for @expr{a,b,c}
24943in terms of @expr{A,B,C}.
24944
24945A remarkable number of models can be cast into this general form.
24946We'll look at two examples here to see how it works. The power-law
24947model @expr{y = a x^b} with two independent variables and two parameters
24948can be rewritten as follows:
24949
24950@example
24951y = a x^b
24952y = a exp(b ln(x))
24953y = exp(ln(a) + b ln(x))
24954ln(y) = ln(a) + b ln(x)
24955@end example
24956
24957@noindent
24958which matches the desired form with
24959@texline @math{Y = \ln(y)},
24960@infoline @expr{Y = ln(y)},
24961@texline @math{A = \ln(a)},
24962@infoline @expr{A = ln(a)},
24963@expr{F = 1}, @expr{B = b}, and
24964@texline @math{G = \ln(x)}.
24965@infoline @expr{G = ln(x)}.
24966Calc thus computes the logarithms of your @expr{y} and @expr{x} values,
24967does a linear fit for @expr{A} and @expr{B}, then solves to get
24968@texline @math{a = \exp(A)}
24969@infoline @expr{a = exp(A)}
24970and @expr{b = B}.
24971
24972Another interesting example is the ``quadratic'' model, which can
24973be handled by expanding according to the distributive law.
24974
24975@example
24976y = a + b*(x - c)^2
24977y = a + b c^2 - 2 b c x + b x^2
24978@end example
24979
24980@noindent
24981which matches with @expr{Y = y}, @expr{A = a + b c^2}, @expr{F = 1},
24982@expr{B = -2 b c}, @expr{G = x} (the @mathit{-2} factor could just as easily
24983have been put into @expr{G} instead of @expr{B}), @expr{C = b}, and
24984@expr{H = x^2}.
24985
24986The Gaussian model looks quite complicated, but a closer examination
24987shows that it's actually similar to the quadratic model but with an
24988exponential that can be brought to the top and moved into @expr{Y}.
24989
24990The logistic models cannot be put into general linear form. For these
24991models, and the Hubbert linearization, Calc computes a rough
24992approximation for the parameters, then uses the Levenberg-Marquardt
24993iterative method to refine the approximations.
24994
24995Another model that cannot be put into general linear
24996form is a Gaussian with a constant background added on, i.e.,
24997@expr{d} + the regular Gaussian formula. If you have a model like
24998this, your best bet is to replace enough of your parameters with
24999constants to make the model linearizable, then adjust the constants
25000manually by doing a series of fits. You can compare the fits by
25001graphing them, by examining the goodness-of-fit measures returned by
25002@kbd{I a F}, or by some other method suitable to your application.
25003Note that some models can be linearized in several ways. The
25004Gaussian-plus-@var{d} model can be linearized by setting @expr{d}
25005(the background) to a constant, or by setting @expr{b} (the standard
25006deviation) and @expr{c} (the mean) to constants.
25007
25008To fit a model with constants substituted for some parameters, just
25009store suitable values in those parameter variables, then omit them
25010from the list of parameters when you answer the variables prompt.
25011
25012@tex
25013\bigskip
25014@end tex
25015
25016A last desperate step would be to use the general-purpose
25017@code{minimize} function rather than @code{fit}. After all, both
25018functions solve the problem of minimizing an expression (the
25019@texline @math{\chi^2}
25020@infoline @expr{chi^2}
25021sum) by adjusting certain parameters in the expression. The @kbd{a F}
25022command is able to use a vastly more efficient algorithm due to its
25023special knowledge about linear chi-square sums, but the @kbd{a N}
25024command can do the same thing by brute force.
25025
25026A compromise would be to pick out a few parameters without which the
25027fit is linearizable, and use @code{minimize} on a call to @code{fit}
25028which efficiently takes care of the rest of the parameters. The thing
25029to be minimized would be the value of
25030@texline @math{\chi^2}
25031@infoline @expr{chi^2}
25032returned as the fifth result of the @code{xfit} function:
25033
25034@smallexample
25035minimize(xfit(gaus(a,b,c,d,x), x, [a,b,c], data)_5, d, guess)
25036@end smallexample
25037
25038@noindent
25039where @code{gaus} represents the Gaussian model with background,
25040@code{data} represents the data matrix, and @code{guess} represents
25041the initial guess for @expr{d} that @code{minimize} requires.
25042This operation will only be, shall we say, extraordinarily slow
25043rather than astronomically slow (as would be the case if @code{minimize}
25044were used by itself to solve the problem).
25045
25046@tex
25047\bigskip
25048@end tex
25049
25050The @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] command is somewhat trickier when
25051nonlinear models are used. The second item in the result is the
25052vector of ``raw'' parameters @expr{A}, @expr{B}, @expr{C}. The
25053covariance matrix is written in terms of those raw parameters.
25054The fifth item is a vector of @dfn{filter} expressions. This
25055is the empty vector @samp{[]} if the raw parameters were the same
25056as the requested parameters, i.e., if @expr{A = a}, @expr{B = b},
25057and so on (which is always true if the model is already linear
25058in the parameters as written, e.g., for polynomial fits). If the
25059parameters had to be rearranged, the fifth item is instead a vector
25060of one formula per parameter in the original model. The raw
25061parameters are expressed in these ``filter'' formulas as
25062@samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)} for @expr{B},
25063and so on.
25064
25065When Calc needs to modify the model to return the result, it replaces
25066@samp{fitdummy(1)} in all the filters with the first item in the raw
25067parameters list, and so on for the other raw parameters, then
25068evaluates the resulting filter formulas to get the actual parameter
25069values to be substituted into the original model. In the case of
25070@kbd{H a F} and @kbd{I a F} where the parameters must be error forms,
25071Calc uses the square roots of the diagonal entries of the covariance
25072matrix as error values for the raw parameters, then lets Calc's
25073standard error-form arithmetic take it from there.
25074
25075If you use @kbd{I a F} with a nonlinear model, be sure to remember
25076that the covariance matrix is in terms of the raw parameters,
25077@emph{not} the actual requested parameters. It's up to you to
25078figure out how to interpret the covariances in the presence of
25079nontrivial filter functions.
25080
25081Things are also complicated when the input contains error forms.
25082Suppose there are three independent and dependent variables, @expr{x},
25083@expr{y}, and @expr{z}, one or more of which are error forms in the
25084data. Calc combines all the error values by taking the square root
25085of the sum of the squares of the errors. It then changes @expr{x}
25086and @expr{y} to be plain numbers, and makes @expr{z} into an error
25087form with this combined error. The @expr{Y(x,y,z)} part of the
25088linearized model is evaluated, and the result should be an error
25089form. The error part of that result is used for
25090@texline @math{\sigma_i}
25091@infoline @expr{sigma_i}
25092for the data point. If for some reason @expr{Y(x,y,z)} does not return
25093an error form, the combined error from @expr{z} is used directly for
25094@texline @math{\sigma_i}.
25095@infoline @expr{sigma_i}.
25096Finally, @expr{z} is also stripped of its error
25097for use in computing @expr{F(x,y,z)}, @expr{G(x,y,z)} and so on;
25098the righthand side of the linearized model is computed in regular
25099arithmetic with no error forms.
25100
25101(While these rules may seem complicated, they are designed to do
25102the most reasonable thing in the typical case that @expr{Y(x,y,z)}
25103depends only on the dependent variable @expr{z}, and in fact is
25104often simply equal to @expr{z}. For common cases like polynomials
25105and multilinear models, the combined error is simply used as the
25106@texline @math{\sigma}
25107@infoline @expr{sigma}
25108for the data point with no further ado.)
25109
25110@tex
25111\bigskip
25112@end tex
25113
25114@vindex FitRules
25115It may be the case that the model you wish to use is linearizable,
25116but Calc's built-in rules are unable to figure it out. Calc uses
25117its algebraic rewrite mechanism to linearize a model. The rewrite
25118rules are kept in the variable @code{FitRules}. You can edit this
25119variable using the @kbd{s e FitRules} command; in fact, there is
25120a special @kbd{s F} command just for editing @code{FitRules}.
25121@xref{Operations on Variables}.
25122
25123@xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of rewrite rules.
25124
25125@ignore
25126@starindex
25127@end ignore
25128@tindex fitvar
25129@ignore
25130@starindex
25131@end ignore
25132@ignore
25133@mindex @idots
25134@end ignore
25135@tindex fitparam
25136@ignore
25137@starindex
25138@end ignore
25139@ignore
25140@mindex @null
25141@end ignore
25142@tindex fitmodel
25143@ignore
25144@starindex
25145@end ignore
25146@ignore
25147@mindex @null
25148@end ignore
25149@tindex fitsystem
25150@ignore
25151@starindex
25152@end ignore
25153@ignore
25154@mindex @null
25155@end ignore
25156@tindex fitdummy
25157Calc uses @code{FitRules} as follows. First, it converts the model
25158to an equation if necessary and encloses the model equation in a
25159call to the function @code{fitmodel} (which is not actually a defined
25160function in Calc; it is only used as a placeholder by the rewrite rules).
25161Parameter variables are renamed to function calls @samp{fitparam(1)},
25162@samp{fitparam(2)}, and so on, and independent variables are renamed
25163to @samp{fitvar(1)}, @samp{fitvar(2)}, etc. The dependent variable
25164is the highest-numbered @code{fitvar}. For example, the power law
25165model @expr{a x^b} is converted to @expr{y = a x^b}, then to
25166
25167@smallexample
25168@group
25169fitmodel(fitvar(2) = fitparam(1) fitvar(1)^fitparam(2))
25170@end group
25171@end smallexample
25172
25173Calc then applies the rewrites as if by @samp{C-u 0 a r FitRules}.
25174(The zero prefix means that rewriting should continue until no further
25175changes are possible.)
25176
25177When rewriting is complete, the @code{fitmodel} call should have
25178been replaced by a @code{fitsystem} call that looks like this:
25179
25180@example
25181fitsystem(@var{Y}, @var{FGH}, @var{abc})
25182@end example
25183
25184@noindent
25185where @var{Y} is a formula that describes the function @expr{Y(x,y,z)},
25186@var{FGH} is the vector of formulas @expr{[F(x,y,z), G(x,y,z), H(x,y,z)]},
25187and @var{abc} is the vector of parameter filters which refer to the
25188raw parameters as @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)}
25189for @expr{B}, etc. While the number of raw parameters (the length of
25190the @var{FGH} vector) is usually the same as the number of original
25191parameters (the length of the @var{abc} vector), this is not required.
25192
25193The power law model eventually boils down to
25194
25195@smallexample
25196@group
25197fitsystem(ln(fitvar(2)),
25198 [1, ln(fitvar(1))],
25199 [exp(fitdummy(1)), fitdummy(2)])
25200@end group
25201@end smallexample
25202
25203The actual implementation of @code{FitRules} is complicated; it
25204proceeds in four phases. First, common rearrangements are done
25205to try to bring linear terms together and to isolate functions like
25206@code{exp} and @code{ln} either all the way ``out'' (so that they
25207can be put into @var{Y}) or all the way ``in'' (so that they can
25208be put into @var{abc} or @var{FGH}). In particular, all
25209non-constant powers are converted to logs-and-exponentials form,
25210and the distributive law is used to expand products of sums.
25211Quotients are rewritten to use the @samp{fitinv} function, where
25212@samp{fitinv(x)} represents @expr{1/x} while the @code{FitRules}
25213are operating. (The use of @code{fitinv} makes recognition of
25214linear-looking forms easier.) If you modify @code{FitRules}, you
25215will probably only need to modify the rules for this phase.
25216
25217Phase two, whose rules can actually also apply during phases one
25218and three, first rewrites @code{fitmodel} to a two-argument
25219form @samp{fitmodel(@var{Y}, @var{model})}, where @var{Y} is
25220initially zero and @var{model} has been changed from @expr{a=b}
25221to @expr{a-b} form. It then tries to peel off invertible functions
25222from the outside of @var{model} and put them into @var{Y} instead,
25223calling the equation solver to invert the functions. Finally, when
25224this is no longer possible, the @code{fitmodel} is changed to a
25225four-argument @code{fitsystem}, where the fourth argument is
25226@var{model} and the @var{FGH} and @var{abc} vectors are initially
25227empty. (The last vector is really @var{ABC}, corresponding to
25228raw parameters, for now.)
25229
25230Phase three converts a sum of items in the @var{model} to a sum
25231of @samp{fitpart(@var{a}, @var{b}, @var{c})} terms which represent
25232terms @samp{@var{a}*@var{b}*@var{c}} of the sum, where @var{a}
25233is all factors that do not involve any variables, @var{b} is all
25234factors that involve only parameters, and @var{c} is the factors
25235that involve only independent variables. (If this decomposition
25236is not possible, the rule set will not complete and Calc will
25237complain that the model is too complex.) Then @code{fitpart}s
25238with equal @var{b} or @var{c} components are merged back together
25239using the distributive law in order to minimize the number of
25240raw parameters needed.
25241
25242Phase four moves the @code{fitpart} terms into the @var{FGH} and
25243@var{ABC} vectors. Also, some of the algebraic expansions that
25244were done in phase 1 are undone now to make the formulas more
25245computationally efficient. Finally, it calls the solver one more
25246time to convert the @var{ABC} vector to an @var{abc} vector, and
25247removes the fourth @var{model} argument (which by now will be zero)
25248to obtain the three-argument @code{fitsystem} that the linear
25249least-squares solver wants to see.
25250
25251@ignore
25252@starindex
25253@end ignore
25254@ignore
25255@mindex hasfit@idots
25256@end ignore
25257@tindex hasfitparams
25258@ignore
25259@starindex
25260@end ignore
25261@ignore
25262@mindex @null
25263@end ignore
25264@tindex hasfitvars
25265Two functions which are useful in connection with @code{FitRules}
25266are @samp{hasfitparams(x)} and @samp{hasfitvars(x)}, which check
25267whether @expr{x} refers to any parameters or independent variables,
25268respectively. Specifically, these functions return ``true'' if the
25269argument contains any @code{fitparam} (or @code{fitvar}) function
25270calls, and ``false'' otherwise. (Recall that ``true'' means a
25271nonzero number, and ``false'' means zero. The actual nonzero number
25272returned is the largest @var{n} from all the @samp{fitparam(@var{n})}s
25273or @samp{fitvar(@var{n})}s, respectively, that appear in the formula.)
25274
25275@tex
25276\bigskip
25277@end tex
25278
25279The @code{fit} function in algebraic notation normally takes four
25280arguments, @samp{fit(@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}, @var{data})},
25281where @var{model} is the model formula as it would be typed after
25282@kbd{a F '}, @var{vars} is the independent variable or a vector of
25283independent variables, @var{params} likewise gives the parameter(s),
25284and @var{data} is the data matrix. Note that the length of @var{vars}
25285must be equal to the number of rows in @var{data} if @var{model} is
25286an equation, or one less than the number of rows if @var{model} is
25287a plain formula. (Actually, a name for the dependent variable is
25288allowed but will be ignored in the plain-formula case.)
25289
25290If @var{params} is omitted, the parameters are all variables in
25291@var{model} except those that appear in @var{vars}. If @var{vars}
25292is also omitted, Calc sorts all the variables that appear in
25293@var{model} alphabetically and uses the higher ones for @var{vars}
25294and the lower ones for @var{params}.
25295
25296Alternatively, @samp{fit(@var{modelvec}, @var{data})} is allowed
25297where @var{modelvec} is a 2- or 3-vector describing the model
25298and variables, as discussed previously.
25299
25300If Calc is unable to do the fit, the @code{fit} function is left
25301in symbolic form, ordinarily with an explanatory message. The
25302message will be ``Model expression is too complex'' if the
25303linearizer was unable to put the model into the required form.
25304
25305The @code{efit} (corresponding to @kbd{H a F}) and @code{xfit}
25306(for @kbd{I a F}) functions are completely analogous.
25307
25308@node Interpolation, , Curve Fitting Details, Curve Fitting
25309@subsection Polynomial Interpolation
25310
25311@kindex a p
25312@pindex calc-poly-interp
25313@tindex polint
25314The @kbd{a p} (@code{calc-poly-interp}) [@code{polint}] command does
25315a polynomial interpolation at a particular @expr{x} value. It takes
25316two arguments from the stack: A data matrix of the sort used by
25317@kbd{a F}, and a single number which represents the desired @expr{x}
25318value. Calc effectively does an exact polynomial fit as if by @kbd{a F i},
25319then substitutes the @expr{x} value into the result in order to get an
25320approximate @expr{y} value based on the fit. (Calc does not actually
25321use @kbd{a F i}, however; it uses a direct method which is both more
25322efficient and more numerically stable.)
25323
25324The result of @kbd{a p} is actually a vector of two values: The @expr{y}
25325value approximation, and an error measure @expr{dy} that reflects Calc's
25326estimation of the probable error of the approximation at that value of
25327@expr{x}. If the input @expr{x} is equal to any of the @expr{x} values
25328in the data matrix, the output @expr{y} will be the corresponding @expr{y}
25329value from the matrix, and the output @expr{dy} will be exactly zero.
25330
25331A prefix argument of 2 causes @kbd{a p} to take separate x- and
25332y-vectors from the stack instead of one data matrix.
25333
25334If @expr{x} is a vector of numbers, @kbd{a p} will return a matrix of
25335interpolated results for each of those @expr{x} values. (The matrix will
25336have two columns, the @expr{y} values and the @expr{dy} values.)
25337If @expr{x} is a formula instead of a number, the @code{polint} function
25338remains in symbolic form; use the @kbd{a "} command to expand it out to
25339a formula that describes the fit in symbolic terms.
25340
25341In all cases, the @kbd{a p} command leaves the data vectors or matrix
25342on the stack. Only the @expr{x} value is replaced by the result.
25343
25344@kindex H a p
25345@tindex ratint
25346The @kbd{H a p} [@code{ratint}] command does a rational function
25347interpolation. It is used exactly like @kbd{a p}, except that it
25348uses as its model the quotient of two polynomials. If there are
25349@expr{N} data points, the numerator and denominator polynomials will
25350each have degree @expr{N/2} (if @expr{N} is odd, the denominator will
25351have degree one higher than the numerator).
25352
25353Rational approximations have the advantage that they can accurately
25354describe functions that have poles (points at which the function's value
25355goes to infinity, so that the denominator polynomial of the approximation
25356goes to zero). If @expr{x} corresponds to a pole of the fitted rational
25357function, then the result will be a division by zero. If Infinite mode
25358is enabled, the result will be @samp{[uinf, uinf]}.
25359
25360There is no way to get the actual coefficients of the rational function
25361used by @kbd{H a p}. (The algorithm never generates these coefficients
25362explicitly, and quotients of polynomials are beyond @w{@kbd{a F}}'s
25363capabilities to fit.)
25364
25365@node Summations, Logical Operations, Curve Fitting, Algebra
25366@section Summations
25367
25368@noindent
25369@cindex Summation of a series
25370@kindex a +
25371@pindex calc-summation
25372@tindex sum
25373The @kbd{a +} (@code{calc-summation}) [@code{sum}] command computes
25374the sum of a formula over a certain range of index values. The formula
25375is taken from the top of the stack; the command prompts for the
25376name of the summation index variable, the lower limit of the
25377sum (any formula), and the upper limit of the sum. If you
25378enter a blank line at any of these prompts, that prompt and
25379any later ones are answered by reading additional elements from
25380the stack. Thus, @kbd{' k^2 @key{RET} ' k @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 5 @key{RET} a + @key{RET}}
25381produces the result 55.
25382@tex
4009494e
GM
25383$$ \sum_{k=1}^5 k^2 = 55 $$
25384@end tex
25385
25386The choice of index variable is arbitrary, but it's best not to
25387use a variable with a stored value. In particular, while
25388@code{i} is often a favorite index variable, it should be avoided
25389in Calc because @code{i} has the imaginary constant @expr{(0, 1)}
25390as a value. If you pressed @kbd{=} on a sum over @code{i}, it would
25391be changed to a nonsensical sum over the ``variable'' @expr{(0, 1)}!
25392If you really want to use @code{i} as an index variable, use
25393@w{@kbd{s u i @key{RET}}} first to ``unstore'' this variable.
25394(@xref{Storing Variables}.)
25395
25396A numeric prefix argument steps the index by that amount rather
25397than by one. Thus @kbd{' a_k @key{RET} C-u -2 a + k @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 0 @key{RET}}
25398yields @samp{a_10 + a_8 + a_6 + a_4 + a_2 + a_0}. A prefix
25399argument of plain @kbd{C-u} causes @kbd{a +} to prompt for the
25400step value, in which case you can enter any formula or enter
25401a blank line to take the step value from the stack. With the
25402@kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{a +} can take up to five arguments from
25403the stack: The formula, the variable, the lower limit, the
25404upper limit, and (at the top of the stack), the step value.
25405
25406Calc knows how to do certain sums in closed form. For example,
25407@samp{sum(6 k^2, k, 1, n) = @w{2 n^3} + 3 n^2 + n}. In particular,
25408this is possible if the formula being summed is polynomial or
25409exponential in the index variable. Sums of logarithms are
25410transformed into logarithms of products. Sums of trigonometric
25411and hyperbolic functions are transformed to sums of exponentials
25412and then done in closed form. Also, of course, sums in which the
25413lower and upper limits are both numbers can always be evaluated
25414just by grinding them out, although Calc will use closed forms
25415whenever it can for the sake of efficiency.
25416
25417The notation for sums in algebraic formulas is
25418@samp{sum(@var{expr}, @var{var}, @var{low}, @var{high}, @var{step})}.
25419If @var{step} is omitted, it defaults to one. If @var{high} is
25420omitted, @var{low} is actually the upper limit and the lower limit
25421is one. If @var{low} is also omitted, the limits are @samp{-inf}
25422and @samp{inf}, respectively.
25423
25424Infinite sums can sometimes be evaluated: @samp{sum(.5^k, k, 1, inf)}
25425returns @expr{1}. This is done by evaluating the sum in closed
25426form (to @samp{1. - 0.5^n} in this case), then evaluating this
25427formula with @code{n} set to @code{inf}. Calc's usual rules
25428for ``infinite'' arithmetic can find the answer from there. If
25429infinite arithmetic yields a @samp{nan}, or if the sum cannot be
25430solved in closed form, Calc leaves the @code{sum} function in
25431symbolic form. @xref{Infinities}.
25432
25433As a special feature, if the limits are infinite (or omitted, as
25434described above) but the formula includes vectors subscripted by
25435expressions that involve the iteration variable, Calc narrows
25436the limits to include only the range of integers which result in
25437valid subscripts for the vector. For example, the sum
25438@samp{sum(k [a,b,c,d,e,f,g]_(2k),k)} evaluates to @samp{b + 2 d + 3 f}.
25439
25440The limits of a sum do not need to be integers. For example,
25441@samp{sum(a_k, k, 0, 2 n, n)} produces @samp{a_0 + a_n + a_(2 n)}.
25442Calc computes the number of iterations using the formula
25443@samp{1 + (@var{high} - @var{low}) / @var{step}}, which must,
25444after simplification as if by @kbd{a s}, evaluate to an integer.
25445
25446If the number of iterations according to the above formula does
25447not come out to an integer, the sum is invalid and will be left
25448in symbolic form. However, closed forms are still supplied, and
25449you are on your honor not to misuse the resulting formulas by
25450substituting mismatched bounds into them. For example,
25451@samp{sum(k, k, 1, 10, 2)} is invalid, but Calc will go ahead and
25452evaluate the closed form solution for the limits 1 and 10 to get
25453the rather dubious answer, 29.25.
25454
25455If the lower limit is greater than the upper limit (assuming a
25456positive step size), the result is generally zero. However,
25457Calc only guarantees a zero result when the upper limit is
25458exactly one step less than the lower limit, i.e., if the number
25459of iterations is @mathit{-1}. Thus @samp{sum(f(k), k, n, n-1)} is zero
25460but the sum from @samp{n} to @samp{n-2} may report a nonzero value
25461if Calc used a closed form solution.
25462
25463Calc's logical predicates like @expr{a < b} return 1 for ``true''
25464and 0 for ``false.'' @xref{Logical Operations}. This can be
25465used to advantage for building conditional sums. For example,
25466@samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k, 1, 20)} is the sum of the squares of all
25467prime numbers from 1 to 20; the @code{prime} predicate returns 1 if
25468its argument is prime and 0 otherwise. You can read this expression
25469as ``the sum of @expr{k^2}, where @expr{k} is prime.'' Indeed,
25470@samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k)} would represent the sum of @emph{all} primes
25471squared, since the limits default to plus and minus infinity, but
25472there are no such sums that Calc's built-in rules can do in
25473closed form.
25474
25475As another example, @samp{sum((k != k_0) * f(k), k, 1, n)} is the
25476sum of @expr{f(k)} for all @expr{k} from 1 to @expr{n}, excluding
25477one value @expr{k_0}. Slightly more tricky is the summand
25478@samp{(k != k_0) / (k - k_0)}, which is an attempt to describe
25479the sum of all @expr{1/(k-k_0)} except at @expr{k = k_0}, where
25480this would be a division by zero. But at @expr{k = k_0}, this
25481formula works out to the indeterminate form @expr{0 / 0}, which
25482Calc will not assume is zero. Better would be to use
25483@samp{(k != k_0) ? 1/(k-k_0) : 0}; the @samp{? :} operator does
25484an ``if-then-else'' test: This expression says, ``if
25485@texline @math{k \ne k_0},
25486@infoline @expr{k != k_0},
25487then @expr{1/(k-k_0)}, else zero.'' Now the formula @expr{1/(k-k_0)}
25488will not even be evaluated by Calc when @expr{k = k_0}.
25489
25490@cindex Alternating sums
25491@kindex a -
25492@pindex calc-alt-summation
25493@tindex asum
25494The @kbd{a -} (@code{calc-alt-summation}) [@code{asum}] command
25495computes an alternating sum. Successive terms of the sequence
25496are given alternating signs, with the first term (corresponding
25497to the lower index value) being positive. Alternating sums
25498are converted to normal sums with an extra term of the form
25499@samp{(-1)^(k-@var{low})}. This formula is adjusted appropriately
25500if the step value is other than one. For example, the Taylor
25501series for the sine function is @samp{asum(x^k / k!, k, 1, inf, 2)}.
25502(Calc cannot evaluate this infinite series, but it can approximate
25503it if you replace @code{inf} with any particular odd number.)
25504Calc converts this series to a regular sum with a step of one,
25505namely @samp{sum((-1)^k x^(2k+1) / (2k+1)!, k, 0, inf)}.
25506
25507@cindex Product of a sequence
25508@kindex a *
25509@pindex calc-product
25510@tindex prod
25511The @kbd{a *} (@code{calc-product}) [@code{prod}] command is
25512the analogous way to take a product of many terms. Calc also knows
25513some closed forms for products, such as @samp{prod(k, k, 1, n) = n!}.
25514Conditional products can be written @samp{prod(k^prime(k), k, 1, n)}
25515or @samp{prod(prime(k) ? k : 1, k, 1, n)}.
25516
25517@kindex a T
25518@pindex calc-tabulate
25519@tindex table
25520The @kbd{a T} (@code{calc-tabulate}) [@code{table}] command
25521evaluates a formula at a series of iterated index values, just
25522like @code{sum} and @code{prod}, but its result is simply a
25523vector of the results. For example, @samp{table(a_i, i, 1, 7, 2)}
25524produces @samp{[a_1, a_3, a_5, a_7]}.
25525
25526@node Logical Operations, Rewrite Rules, Summations, Algebra
25527@section Logical Operations
25528
25529@noindent
25530The following commands and algebraic functions return true/false values,
25531where 1 represents ``true'' and 0 represents ``false.'' In cases where
25532a truth value is required (such as for the condition part of a rewrite
25533rule, or as the condition for a @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} control structure), any
25534nonzero value is accepted to mean ``true.'' (Specifically, anything
25535for which @code{dnonzero} returns 1 is ``true,'' and anything for
25536which @code{dnonzero} returns 0 or cannot decide is assumed ``false.''
25537Note that this means that @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} will execute the ``then''
25538portion if its condition is provably true, but it will execute the
25539``else'' portion for any condition like @expr{a = b} that is not
25540provably true, even if it might be true. Algebraic functions that
25541have conditions as arguments, like @code{? :} and @code{&&}, remain
25542unevaluated if the condition is neither provably true nor provably
25543false. @xref{Declarations}.)
25544
25545@kindex a =
25546@pindex calc-equal-to
25547@tindex eq
25548@tindex =
25549@tindex ==
25550The @kbd{a =} (@code{calc-equal-to}) command, or @samp{eq(a,b)} function
25551(which can also be written @samp{a = b} or @samp{a == b} in an algebraic
25552formula) is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are equal, either because they
25553are identical expressions, or because they are numbers which are
25554numerically equal. (Thus the integer 1 is considered equal to the float
255551.0.) If the equality of @expr{a} and @expr{b} cannot be determined,
25556the comparison is left in symbolic form. Note that as a command, this
25557operation pops two values from the stack and pushes back either a 1 or
25558a 0, or a formula @samp{a = b} if the values' equality cannot be determined.
25559
25560Many Calc commands use @samp{=} formulas to represent @dfn{equations}.
25561For example, the @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) command rearranges
25562an equation to solve for a given variable. The @kbd{a M}
25563(@code{calc-map-equation}) command can be used to apply any
25564function to both sides of an equation; for example, @kbd{2 a M *}
25565multiplies both sides of the equation by two. Note that just
25566@kbd{2 *} would not do the same thing; it would produce the formula
25567@samp{2 (a = b)} which represents 2 if the equality is true or
25568zero if not.
25569
25570The @code{eq} function with more than two arguments (e.g., @kbd{C-u 3 a =}
25571or @samp{a = b = c}) tests if all of its arguments are equal. In
25572algebraic notation, the @samp{=} operator is unusual in that it is
25573neither left- nor right-associative: @samp{a = b = c} is not the
25574same as @samp{(a = b) = c} or @samp{a = (b = c)} (which each compare
25575one variable with the 1 or 0 that results from comparing two other
25576variables).
25577
25578@kindex a #
25579@pindex calc-not-equal-to
25580@tindex neq
25581@tindex !=
25582The @kbd{a #} (@code{calc-not-equal-to}) command, or @samp{neq(a,b)} or
25583@samp{a != b} function, is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are not equal.
25584This also works with more than two arguments; @samp{a != b != c != d}
25585tests that all four of @expr{a}, @expr{b}, @expr{c}, and @expr{d} are
25586distinct numbers.
25587
25588@kindex a <
25589@tindex lt
25590@ignore
25591@mindex @idots
25592@end ignore
25593@kindex a >
25594@ignore
25595@mindex @null
25596@end ignore
25597@kindex a [
25598@ignore
25599@mindex @null
25600@end ignore
25601@kindex a ]
25602@pindex calc-less-than
25603@pindex calc-greater-than
25604@pindex calc-less-equal
25605@pindex calc-greater-equal
25606@ignore
25607@mindex @null
25608@end ignore
25609@tindex gt
25610@ignore
25611@mindex @null
25612@end ignore
25613@tindex leq
25614@ignore
25615@mindex @null
25616@end ignore
25617@tindex geq
25618@ignore
25619@mindex @null
25620@end ignore
25621@tindex <
25622@ignore
25623@mindex @null
25624@end ignore
25625@tindex >
25626@ignore
25627@mindex @null
25628@end ignore
25629@tindex <=
25630@ignore
25631@mindex @null
25632@end ignore
25633@tindex >=
25634The @kbd{a <} (@code{calc-less-than}) [@samp{lt(a,b)} or @samp{a < b}]
25635operation is true if @expr{a} is less than @expr{b}. Similar functions
25636are @kbd{a >} (@code{calc-greater-than}) [@samp{gt(a,b)} or @samp{a > b}],
25637@kbd{a [} (@code{calc-less-equal}) [@samp{leq(a,b)} or @samp{a <= b}], and
25638@kbd{a ]} (@code{calc-greater-equal}) [@samp{geq(a,b)} or @samp{a >= b}].
25639
25640While the inequality functions like @code{lt} do not accept more
25641than two arguments, the syntax @w{@samp{a <= b < c}} is translated to an
25642equivalent expression involving intervals: @samp{b in [a .. c)}.
25643(See the description of @code{in} below.) All four combinations
25644of @samp{<} and @samp{<=} are allowed, or any of the four combinations
25645of @samp{>} and @samp{>=}. Four-argument constructions like
25646@samp{a < b < c < d}, and mixtures like @w{@samp{a < b = c}} that
25647involve both equalities and inequalities, are not allowed.
25648
25649@kindex a .
25650@pindex calc-remove-equal
25651@tindex rmeq
25652The @kbd{a .} (@code{calc-remove-equal}) [@code{rmeq}] command extracts
25653the righthand side of the equation or inequality on the top of the
25654stack. It also works elementwise on vectors. For example, if
25655@samp{[x = 2.34, y = z / 2]} is on the stack, then @kbd{a .} produces
25656@samp{[2.34, z / 2]}. As a special case, if the righthand side is a
25657variable and the lefthand side is a number (as in @samp{2.34 = x}), then
25658Calc keeps the lefthand side instead. Finally, this command works with
25659assignments @samp{x := 2.34} as well as equations, always taking the
25660righthand side, and for @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operators, always
25661taking the lefthand side.
25662
25663@kindex a &
25664@pindex calc-logical-and
25665@tindex land
25666@tindex &&
25667The @kbd{a &} (@code{calc-logical-and}) [@samp{land(a,b)} or @samp{a && b}]
25668function is true if both of its arguments are true, i.e., are
25669non-zero numbers. In this case, the result will be either @expr{a} or
25670@expr{b}, chosen arbitrarily. If either argument is zero, the result is
25671zero. Otherwise, the formula is left in symbolic form.
25672
25673@kindex a |
25674@pindex calc-logical-or
25675@tindex lor
25676@tindex ||
25677The @kbd{a |} (@code{calc-logical-or}) [@samp{lor(a,b)} or @samp{a || b}]
25678function is true if either or both of its arguments are true (nonzero).
25679The result is whichever argument was nonzero, choosing arbitrarily if both
25680are nonzero. If both @expr{a} and @expr{b} are zero, the result is
25681zero.
25682
25683@kindex a !
25684@pindex calc-logical-not
25685@tindex lnot
25686@tindex !
25687The @kbd{a !} (@code{calc-logical-not}) [@samp{lnot(a)} or @samp{!@: a}]
25688function is true if @expr{a} is false (zero), or false if @expr{a} is
25689true (nonzero). It is left in symbolic form if @expr{a} is not a
25690number.
25691
25692@kindex a :
25693@pindex calc-logical-if
25694@tindex if
25695@ignore
25696@mindex ? :
25697@end ignore
25698@tindex ?
25699@ignore
25700@mindex @null
25701@end ignore
25702@tindex :
25703@cindex Arguments, not evaluated
25704The @kbd{a :} (@code{calc-logical-if}) [@samp{if(a,b,c)} or @samp{a ? b :@: c}]
25705function is equal to either @expr{b} or @expr{c} if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25706number or zero, respectively. If @expr{a} is not a number, the test is
25707left in symbolic form and neither @expr{b} nor @expr{c} is evaluated in
25708any way. In algebraic formulas, this is one of the few Calc functions
25709whose arguments are not automatically evaluated when the function itself
25710is evaluated. The others are @code{lambda}, @code{quote}, and
25711@code{condition}.
25712
25713One minor surprise to watch out for is that the formula @samp{a?3:4}
25714will not work because the @samp{3:4} is parsed as a fraction instead of
25715as three separate symbols. Type something like @samp{a ? 3 : 4} or
25716@samp{a?(3):4} instead.
25717
25718As a special case, if @expr{a} evaluates to a vector, then both @expr{b}
25719and @expr{c} are evaluated; the result is a vector of the same length
25720as @expr{a} whose elements are chosen from corresponding elements of
25721@expr{b} and @expr{c} according to whether each element of @expr{a}
25722is zero or nonzero. Each of @expr{b} and @expr{c} must be either a
25723vector of the same length as @expr{a}, or a non-vector which is matched
25724with all elements of @expr{a}.
25725
25726@kindex a @{
25727@pindex calc-in-set
25728@tindex in
25729The @kbd{a @{} (@code{calc-in-set}) [@samp{in(a,b)}] function is true if
25730the number @expr{a} is in the set of numbers represented by @expr{b}.
25731If @expr{b} is an interval form, @expr{a} must be one of the values
25732encompassed by the interval. If @expr{b} is a vector, @expr{a} must be
25733equal to one of the elements of the vector. (If any vector elements are
25734intervals, @expr{a} must be in any of the intervals.) If @expr{b} is a
25735plain number, @expr{a} must be numerically equal to @expr{b}.
25736@xref{Set Operations}, for a group of commands that manipulate sets
25737of this sort.
25738
25739@ignore
25740@starindex
25741@end ignore
25742@tindex typeof
25743The @samp{typeof(a)} function produces an integer or variable which
25744characterizes @expr{a}. If @expr{a} is a number, vector, or variable,
25745the result will be one of the following numbers:
25746
25747@example
25748 1 Integer
25749 2 Fraction
25750 3 Floating-point number
25751 4 HMS form
25752 5 Rectangular complex number
25753 6 Polar complex number
25754 7 Error form
25755 8 Interval form
25756 9 Modulo form
2575710 Date-only form
2575811 Date/time form
2575912 Infinity (inf, uinf, or nan)
25760100 Variable
25761101 Vector (but not a matrix)
25762102 Matrix
25763@end example
25764
25765Otherwise, @expr{a} is a formula, and the result is a variable which
25766represents the name of the top-level function call.
25767
25768@ignore
25769@starindex
25770@end ignore
25771@tindex integer
25772@ignore
25773@starindex
25774@end ignore
25775@tindex real
25776@ignore
25777@starindex
25778@end ignore
25779@tindex constant
25780The @samp{integer(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is an integer.
25781The @samp{real(a)} function
25782is true if @expr{a} is a real number, either integer, fraction, or
25783float. The @samp{constant(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is
25784any of the objects for which @code{typeof} would produce an integer
25785code result except for variables, and provided that the components of
25786an object like a vector or error form are themselves constant.
25787Note that infinities do not satisfy any of these tests, nor do
25788special constants like @code{pi} and @code{e}.
25789
25790@xref{Declarations}, for a set of similar functions that recognize
25791formulas as well as actual numbers. For example, @samp{dint(floor(x))}
25792is true because @samp{floor(x)} is provably integer-valued, but
25793@samp{integer(floor(x))} does not because @samp{floor(x)} is not
25794literally an integer constant.
25795
25796@ignore
25797@starindex
25798@end ignore
25799@tindex refers
25800The @samp{refers(a,b)} function is true if the variable (or sub-expression)
25801@expr{b} appears in @expr{a}, or false otherwise. Unlike the other
25802tests described here, this function returns a definite ``no'' answer
25803even if its arguments are still in symbolic form. The only case where
25804@code{refers} will be left unevaluated is if @expr{a} is a plain
25805variable (different from @expr{b}).
25806
25807@ignore
25808@starindex
25809@end ignore
25810@tindex negative
25811The @samp{negative(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} ``looks'' negative,
25812because it is a negative number, because it is of the form @expr{-x},
25813or because it is a product or quotient with a term that looks negative.
25814This is most useful in rewrite rules. Beware that @samp{negative(a)}
25815evaluates to 1 or 0 for @emph{any} argument @expr{a}, so it can only
25816be stored in a formula if the default simplifications are turned off
25817first with @kbd{m O} (or if it appears in an unevaluated context such
25818as a rewrite rule condition).
25819
25820@ignore
25821@starindex
25822@end ignore
25823@tindex variable
25824The @samp{variable(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a variable,
25825or false if not. If @expr{a} is a function call, this test is left
25826in symbolic form. Built-in variables like @code{pi} and @code{inf}
25827are considered variables like any others by this test.
25828
25829@ignore
25830@starindex
25831@end ignore
25832@tindex nonvar
25833The @samp{nonvar(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a non-variable.
25834If its argument is a variable it is left unsimplified; it never
25835actually returns zero. However, since Calc's condition-testing
25836commands consider ``false'' anything not provably true, this is
25837often good enough.
25838
25839@ignore
25840@starindex
25841@end ignore
25842@tindex lin
25843@ignore
25844@starindex
25845@end ignore
25846@tindex linnt
25847@ignore
25848@starindex
25849@end ignore
25850@tindex islin
25851@ignore
25852@starindex
25853@end ignore
25854@tindex islinnt
25855@cindex Linearity testing
25856The functions @code{lin}, @code{linnt}, @code{islin}, and @code{islinnt}
25857check if an expression is ``linear,'' i.e., can be written in the form
25858@expr{a + b x} for some constants @expr{a} and @expr{b}, and some
25859variable or subformula @expr{x}. The function @samp{islin(f,x)} checks
25860if formula @expr{f} is linear in @expr{x}, returning 1 if so. For
25861example, @samp{islin(x,x)}, @samp{islin(-x,x)}, @samp{islin(3,x)}, and
25862@samp{islin(x y / 3 - 2, x)} all return 1. The @samp{lin(f,x)} function
25863is similar, except that instead of returning 1 it returns the vector
25864@expr{[a, b, x]}. For the above examples, this vector would be
25865@expr{[0, 1, x]}, @expr{[0, -1, x]}, @expr{[3, 0, x]}, and
25866@expr{[-2, y/3, x]}, respectively. Both @code{lin} and @code{islin}
25867generally remain unevaluated for expressions which are not linear,
25868e.g., @samp{lin(2 x^2, x)} and @samp{lin(sin(x), x)}. The second
25869argument can also be a formula; @samp{islin(2 + 3 sin(x), sin(x))}
25870returns true.
25871
25872The @code{linnt} and @code{islinnt} functions perform a similar check,
25873but require a ``non-trivial'' linear form, which means that the
25874@expr{b} coefficient must be non-zero. For example, @samp{lin(2,x)}
25875returns @expr{[2, 0, x]} and @samp{lin(y,x)} returns @expr{[y, 0, x]},
25876but @samp{linnt(2,x)} and @samp{linnt(y,x)} are left unevaluated
25877(in other words, these formulas are considered to be only ``trivially''
25878linear in @expr{x}).
25879
25880All four linearity-testing functions allow you to omit the second
25881argument, in which case the input may be linear in any non-constant
25882formula. Here, the @expr{a=0}, @expr{b=1} case is also considered
25883trivial, and only constant values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} are
25884recognized. Thus, @samp{lin(2 x y)} returns @expr{[0, 2, x y]},
25885@samp{lin(2 - x y)} returns @expr{[2, -1, x y]}, and @samp{lin(x y)}
25886returns @expr{[0, 1, x y]}. The @code{linnt} function would allow the
25887first two cases but not the third. Also, neither @code{lin} nor
25888@code{linnt} accept plain constants as linear in the one-argument
25889case: @samp{islin(2,x)} is true, but @samp{islin(2)} is false.
25890
25891@ignore
25892@starindex
25893@end ignore
25894@tindex istrue
25895The @samp{istrue(a)} function returns 1 if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25896number or provably nonzero formula, or 0 if @expr{a} is anything else.
25897Calls to @code{istrue} can only be manipulated if @kbd{m O} mode is
25898used to make sure they are not evaluated prematurely. (Note that
25899declarations are used when deciding whether a formula is true;
25900@code{istrue} returns 1 when @code{dnonzero} would return 1, and
25901it returns 0 when @code{dnonzero} would return 0 or leave itself
25902in symbolic form.)
25903
25904@node Rewrite Rules, , Logical Operations, Algebra
25905@section Rewrite Rules
25906
25907@noindent
25908@cindex Rewrite rules
25909@cindex Transformations
25910@cindex Pattern matching
25911@kindex a r
25912@pindex calc-rewrite
25913@tindex rewrite
25914The @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) [@code{rewrite}] command makes
25915substitutions in a formula according to a specified pattern or patterns
25916known as @dfn{rewrite rules}. Whereas @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
25917matches literally, so that substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(x)}
25918matches only the @code{sin} function applied to the variable @code{x},
25919rewrite rules match general kinds of formulas; rewriting using the rule
25920@samp{sin(x) := cos(x)} matches @code{sin} of any argument and replaces
25921it with @code{cos} of that same argument. The only significance of the
25922name @code{x} is that the same name is used on both sides of the rule.
25923
25924Rewrite rules rearrange formulas already in Calc's memory.
25925@xref{Syntax Tables}, to read about @dfn{syntax rules}, which are
25926similar to algebraic rewrite rules but operate when new algebraic
25927entries are being parsed, converting strings of characters into
25928Calc formulas.
25929
25930@menu
25931* Entering Rewrite Rules::
25932* Basic Rewrite Rules::
25933* Conditional Rewrite Rules::
25934* Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules::
25935* Other Features of Rewrite Rules::
25936* Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules::
25937* Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules::
25938* Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules::
25939* Selections with Rewrite Rules::
25940* Matching Commands::
25941* Automatic Rewrites::
25942* Debugging Rewrites::
25943* Examples of Rewrite Rules::
25944@end menu
25945
25946@node Entering Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25947@subsection Entering Rewrite Rules
25948
25949@noindent
25950Rewrite rules normally use the ``assignment'' operator
25951@samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}.
25952This operator is equivalent to the function call @samp{assign(old, new)}.
25953The @code{assign} function is undefined by itself in Calc, so an
25954assignment formula such as a rewrite rule will be left alone by ordinary
25955Calc commands. But certain commands, like the rewrite system, interpret
25956assignments in special ways.
25957
25958For example, the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1-cos(x)^2} says to replace
25959every occurrence of the sine of something, squared, with one minus the
25960square of the cosine of that same thing. All by itself as a formula
25961on the stack it does nothing, but when given to the @kbd{a r} command
25962it turns that command into a sine-squared-to-cosine-squared converter.
25963
25964To specify a set of rules to be applied all at once, make a vector of
25965rules.
25966
25967When @kbd{a r} prompts you to enter the rewrite rules, you can answer
25968in several ways:
25969
25970@enumerate
25971@item
25972With a rule: @kbd{f(x) := g(x) @key{RET}}.
25973@item
25974With a vector of rules: @kbd{[f1(x) := g1(x), f2(x) := g2(x)] @key{RET}}.
25975(You can omit the enclosing square brackets if you wish.)
25976@item
25977With the name of a variable that contains the rule or rules vector:
25978@kbd{myrules @key{RET}}.
25979@item
25980With any formula except a rule, a vector, or a variable name; this
25981will be interpreted as the @var{old} half of a rewrite rule,
25982and you will be prompted a second time for the @var{new} half:
25983@kbd{f(x) @key{RET} g(x) @key{RET}}.
25984@item
25985With a blank line, in which case the rule, rules vector, or variable
25986will be taken from the top of the stack (and the formula to be
25987rewritten will come from the second-to-top position).
25988@end enumerate
25989
25990If you enter the rules directly (as opposed to using rules stored
25991in a variable), those rules will be put into the Trail so that you
25992can retrieve them later. @xref{Trail Commands}.
25993
25994It is most convenient to store rules you use often in a variable and
25995invoke them by giving the variable name. The @kbd{s e}
25996(@code{calc-edit-variable}) command is an easy way to create or edit a
25997rule set stored in a variable. You may also wish to use @kbd{s p}
25998(@code{calc-permanent-variable}) to save your rules permanently;
25999@pxref{Operations on Variables}.
26000
26001Rewrite rules are compiled into a special internal form for faster
26002matching. If you enter a rule set directly it must be recompiled
26003every time. If you store the rules in a variable and refer to them
26004through that variable, they will be compiled once and saved away
26005along with the variable for later reference. This is another good
26006reason to store your rules in a variable.
26007
26008Calc also accepts an obsolete notation for rules, as vectors
26009@samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}]}. But because it is easily confused with a
26010vector of two rules, the use of this notation is no longer recommended.
26011
26012@node Basic Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Entering Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26013@subsection Basic Rewrite Rules
26014
26015@noindent
26016To match a particular formula @expr{x} with a particular rewrite rule
26017@samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}, Calc compares the structure of @expr{x} with
26018the structure of @var{old}. Variables that appear in @var{old} are
26019treated as @dfn{meta-variables}; the corresponding positions in @expr{x}
26020may contain any sub-formulas. For example, the pattern @samp{f(x,y)}
26021would match the expression @samp{f(12, a+1)} with the meta-variable
26022@samp{x} corresponding to 12 and with @samp{y} corresponding to
26023@samp{a+1}. However, this pattern would not match @samp{f(12)} or
26024@samp{g(12, a+1)}, since there is no assignment of the meta-variables
26025that will make the pattern match these expressions. Notice that if
26026the pattern is a single meta-variable, it will match any expression.
26027
26028If a given meta-variable appears more than once in @var{old}, the
26029corresponding sub-formulas of @expr{x} must be identical. Thus
26030the pattern @samp{f(x,x)} would match @samp{f(12, 12)} and
26031@samp{f(a+1, a+1)} but not @samp{f(12, a+1)} or @samp{f(a+b, b+a)}.
26032(@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for a way to match the latter.)
26033
26034Things other than variables must match exactly between the pattern
26035and the target formula. To match a particular variable exactly, use
26036the pseudo-function @samp{quote(v)} in the pattern. For example, the
26037pattern @samp{x+quote(y)} matches @samp{x+y}, @samp{2+y}, or
26038@samp{sin(a)+y}.
26039
26040The special variable names @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi},
26041@samp{gamma}, @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} always match
26042literally. Thus the pattern @samp{sin(d + e + f)} acts exactly like
26043@samp{sin(d + quote(e) + f)}.
26044
26045If the @var{old} pattern is found to match a given formula, that
26046formula is replaced by @var{new}, where any occurrences in @var{new}
26047of meta-variables from the pattern are replaced with the sub-formulas
26048that they matched. Thus, applying the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x)}
26049to @samp{f(12, a+1)} would produce @samp{g(a+13, 12)}.
26050
26051The normal @kbd{a r} command applies rewrite rules over and over
26052throughout the target formula until no further changes are possible
26053(up to a limit of 100 times). Use @kbd{C-u 1 a r} to make only one
26054change at a time.
26055
26056@node Conditional Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26057@subsection Conditional Rewrite Rules
26058
26059@noindent
26060A rewrite rule can also be @dfn{conditional}, written in the form
26061@samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}}. (There is also the obsolete
26062form @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}, @var{cond}]}.) If a @var{cond} part
26063is present in the
26064rule, this is an additional condition that must be satisfied before
26065the rule is accepted. Once @var{old} has been successfully matched
26066to the target expression, @var{cond} is evaluated (with all the
26067meta-variables substituted for the values they matched) and simplified
26068with @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}). If the result is a nonzero
26069number or any other object known to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}),
26070the rule is accepted. If the result is zero or if it is a symbolic
26071formula that is not known to be nonzero, the rule is rejected.
26072@xref{Logical Operations}, for a number of functions that return
260731 or 0 according to the results of various tests.
26074
26075For example, the formula @samp{n > 0} simplifies to 1 or 0 if @expr{n}
26076is replaced by a positive or nonpositive number, respectively (or if
26077@expr{n} has been declared to be positive or nonpositive). Thus,
26078the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x) :: x+y > 0} would apply to
26079@samp{f(0, 4)} but not to @samp{f(-3, 2)} or @samp{f(12, a+1)}
26080(assuming no outstanding declarations for @expr{a}). In the case of
26081@samp{f(-3, 2)}, the condition can be shown not to be satisfied; in
26082the case of @samp{f(12, a+1)}, the condition merely cannot be shown
26083to be satisfied, but that is enough to reject the rule.
26084
26085While Calc will use declarations to reason about variables in the
26086formula being rewritten, declarations do not apply to meta-variables.
26087For example, the rule @samp{f(a) := g(a+1)} will match for any values
26088of @samp{a}, such as complex numbers, vectors, or formulas, even if
26089@samp{a} has been declared to be real or scalar. If you want the
26090meta-variable @samp{a} to match only literal real numbers, use
26091@samp{f(a) := g(a+1) :: real(a)}. If you want @samp{a} to match only
26092reals and formulas which are provably real, use @samp{dreal(a)} as
26093the condition.
26094
26095The @samp{::} operator is a shorthand for the @code{condition}
26096function; @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}} is equivalent to
26097the formula @samp{condition(assign(@var{old}, @var{new}), @var{cond})}.
26098
26099If you have several conditions, you can use @samp{... :: c1 :: c2 :: c3}
26100or @samp{... :: c1 && c2 && c3}. The two are entirely equivalent.
26101
26102It is also possible to embed conditions inside the pattern:
26103@samp{f(x :: x>0, y) := g(y+x, x)}. This is purely a notational
26104convenience, though; where a condition appears in a rule has no
26105effect on when it is tested. The rewrite-rule compiler automatically
26106decides when it is best to test each condition while a rule is being
26107matched.
26108
26109Certain conditions are handled as special cases by the rewrite rule
26110system and are tested very efficiently: Where @expr{x} is any
26111meta-variable, these conditions are @samp{integer(x)}, @samp{real(x)},
26112@samp{constant(x)}, @samp{negative(x)}, @samp{x >= y} where @expr{y}
26113is either a constant or another meta-variable and @samp{>=} may be
26114replaced by any of the six relational operators, and @samp{x % a = b}
26115where @expr{a} and @expr{b} are constants. Other conditions, like
26116@samp{x >= y+1} or @samp{dreal(x)}, will be less efficient to check
26117since Calc must bring the whole evaluator and simplifier into play.
26118
26119An interesting property of @samp{::} is that neither of its arguments
26120will be touched by Calc's default simplifications. This is important
26121because conditions often are expressions that cannot safely be
26122evaluated early. For example, the @code{typeof} function never
26123remains in symbolic form; entering @samp{typeof(a)} will put the
26124number 100 (the type code for variables like @samp{a}) on the stack.
26125But putting the condition @samp{... :: typeof(a) = 6} on the stack
26126is safe since @samp{::} prevents the @code{typeof} from being
26127evaluated until the condition is actually used by the rewrite system.
26128
26129Since @samp{::} protects its lefthand side, too, you can use a dummy
26130condition to protect a rule that must itself not evaluate early.
26131For example, it's not safe to put @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x])} on
26132the stack because it will immediately evaluate to @samp{a(f,x) := f(x)},
26133where the meta-variable-ness of @code{f} on the righthand side has been
26134lost. But @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x]) :: 1} is safe, and of course
26135the condition @samp{1} is always true (nonzero) so it has no effect on
26136the functioning of the rule. (The rewrite compiler will ensure that
26137it doesn't even impact the speed of matching the rule.)
26138
26139@node Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26140@subsection Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules
26141
26142@noindent
26143The rewrite mechanism understands the algebraic properties of functions
26144like @samp{+} and @samp{*}. In particular, pattern matching takes
26145the associativity and commutativity of the following functions into
26146account:
26147
26148@smallexample
26149+ - * = != && || and or xor vint vunion vxor gcd lcm max min beta
26150@end smallexample
26151
26152For example, the rewrite rule:
26153
26154@example
26155a x + b x := (a + b) x
26156@end example
26157
26158@noindent
26159will match formulas of the form,
26160
26161@example
26162a x + b x, x a + x b, a x + x b, x a + b x
26163@end example
26164
26165Rewrites also understand the relationship between the @samp{+} and @samp{-}
26166operators. The above rewrite rule will also match the formulas,
26167
26168@example
26169a x - b x, x a - x b, a x - x b, x a - b x
26170@end example
26171
26172@noindent
26173by matching @samp{b} in the pattern to @samp{-b} from the formula.
26174
26175Applied to a sum of many terms like @samp{r + a x + s + b x + t}, this
26176pattern will check all pairs of terms for possible matches. The rewrite
26177will take whichever suitable pair it discovers first.
26178
26179In general, a pattern using an associative operator like @samp{a + b}
26180will try @var{2 n} different ways to match a sum of @var{n} terms
26181like @samp{x + y + z - w}. First, @samp{a} is matched against each
26182of @samp{x}, @samp{y}, @samp{z}, and @samp{-w} in turn, with @samp{b}
26183being matched to the remainders @samp{y + z - w}, @samp{x + z - w}, etc.
26184If none of these succeed, then @samp{b} is matched against each of the
26185four terms with @samp{a} matching the remainder. Half-and-half matches,
26186like @samp{(x + y) + (z - w)}, are not tried.
26187
26188Note that @samp{*} is not commutative when applied to matrices, but
26189rewrite rules pretend that it is. If you type @kbd{m v} to enable
26190Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), rewrite rules will match @samp{*}
26191literally, ignoring its usual commutativity property. (In the
26192current implementation, the associativity also vanishes---it is as
26193if the pattern had been enclosed in a @code{plain} marker; see below.)
26194If you are applying rewrites to formulas with matrices, it's best to
26195enable Matrix mode first to prevent algebraically incorrect rewrites
26196from occurring.
26197
26198The pattern @samp{-x} will actually match any expression. For example,
26199the rule
26200
26201@example
26202f(-x) := -f(x)
26203@end example
26204
26205@noindent
26206will rewrite @samp{f(a)} to @samp{-f(-a)}. To avoid this, either use
26207a @code{plain} marker as described below, or add a @samp{negative(x)}
26208condition. The @code{negative} function is true if its argument
26209``looks'' negative, for example, because it is a negative number or
26210because it is a formula like @samp{-x}. The new rule using this
26211condition is:
26212
26213@example
26214f(x) := -f(-x) :: negative(x) @r{or, equivalently,}
26215f(-x) := -f(x) :: negative(-x)
26216@end example
26217
26218In the same way, the pattern @samp{x - y} will match the sum @samp{a + b}
26219by matching @samp{y} to @samp{-b}.
26220
26221The pattern @samp{a b} will also match the formula @samp{x/y} if
26222@samp{y} is a number. Thus the rule @samp{a x + @w{b x} := (a+b) x}
26223will also convert @samp{a x + x / 2} to @samp{(a + 0.5) x} (or
26224@samp{(a + 1:2) x}, depending on the current fraction mode).
26225
26226Calc will @emph{not} take other liberties with @samp{*}, @samp{/}, and
26227@samp{^}. For example, the pattern @samp{f(a b)} will not match
26228@samp{f(x^2)}, and @samp{f(a + b)} will not match @samp{f(2 x)}, even
26229though conceivably these patterns could match with @samp{a = b = x}.
26230Nor will @samp{f(a b)} match @samp{f(x / y)} if @samp{y} is not a
26231constant, even though it could be considered to match with @samp{a = x}
26232and @samp{b = 1/y}. The reasons are partly for efficiency, and partly
26233because while few mathematical operations are substantively different
26234for addition and subtraction, often it is preferable to treat the cases
26235of multiplication, division, and integer powers separately.
26236
26237Even more subtle is the rule set
26238
26239@example
26240[ f(a) + f(b) := f(a + b), -f(a) := f(-a) ]
26241@end example
26242
26243@noindent
26244attempting to match @samp{f(x) - f(y)}. You might think that Calc
26245will view this subtraction as @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))} and then apply
26246the above two rules in turn, but actually this will not work because
26247Calc only does this when considering rules for @samp{+} (like the
26248first rule in this set). So it will see first that @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))}
26249does not match @samp{f(a) + f(b)} for any assignments of the
26250meta-variables, and then it will see that @samp{f(x) - f(y)} does
26251not match @samp{-f(a)} for any assignment of @samp{a}. Because Calc
26252tries only one rule at a time, it will not be able to rewrite
26253@samp{f(x) - f(y)} with this rule set. An explicit @samp{f(a) - f(b)}
26254rule will have to be added.
26255
26256Another thing patterns will @emph{not} do is break up complex numbers.
26257The pattern @samp{myconj(a + @w{b i)} := a - b i} will work for formulas
26258involving the special constant @samp{i} (such as @samp{3 - 4 i}), but
26259it will not match actual complex numbers like @samp{(3, -4)}. A version
26260of the above rule for complex numbers would be
26261
26262@example
26263myconj(a) := re(a) - im(a) (0,1) :: im(a) != 0
26264@end example
26265
26266@noindent
26267(Because the @code{re} and @code{im} functions understand the properties
26268of the special constant @samp{i}, this rule will also work for
26269@samp{3 - 4 i}. In fact, this particular rule would probably be better
26270without the @samp{im(a) != 0} condition, since if @samp{im(a) = 0} the
26271righthand side of the rule will still give the correct answer for the
26272conjugate of a real number.)
26273
26274It is also possible to specify optional arguments in patterns. The rule
26275
26276@example
26277opt(a) x + opt(b) (x^opt(c) + opt(d)) := f(a, b, c, d)
26278@end example
26279
26280@noindent
26281will match the formula
26282
26283@example
262845 (x^2 - 4) + 3 x
26285@end example
26286
26287@noindent
26288in a fairly straightforward manner, but it will also match reduced
26289formulas like
26290
26291@example
26292x + x^2, 2(x + 1) - x, x + x
26293@end example
26294
26295@noindent
26296producing, respectively,
26297
26298@example
26299f(1, 1, 2, 0), f(-1, 2, 1, 1), f(1, 1, 1, 0)
26300@end example
26301
26302(The latter two formulas can be entered only if default simplifications
26303have been turned off with @kbd{m O}.)
26304
26305The default value for a term of a sum is zero. The default value
26306for a part of a product, for a power, or for the denominator of a
26307quotient, is one. Also, @samp{-x} matches the pattern @samp{opt(a) b}
26308with @samp{a = -1}.
26309
26310In particular, the distributive-law rule can be refined to
26311
26312@example
26313opt(a) x + opt(b) x := (a + b) x
26314@end example
26315
26316@noindent
26317so that it will convert, e.g., @samp{a x - x}, to @samp{(a - 1) x}.
26318
26319The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x} matches almost any formulas which
26320are linear in @samp{x}. You can also use the @code{lin} and @code{islin}
26321functions with rewrite conditions to test for this; @pxref{Logical
26322Operations}. These functions are not as convenient to use in rewrite
26323rules, but they recognize more kinds of formulas as linear:
26324@samp{x/z} is considered linear with @expr{b = 1/z} by @code{lin},
26325but it will not match the above pattern because that pattern calls
26326for a multiplication, not a division.
26327
26328As another example, the obvious rule to replace @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2}
26329by 1,
26330
26331@example
26332sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 := 1
26333@end example
26334
26335@noindent
26336misses many cases because the sine and cosine may both be multiplied by
26337an equal factor. Here's a more successful rule:
26338
26339@example
26340opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a
26341@end example
26342
26343Note that this rule will @emph{not} match @samp{sin(x)^2 + 6 cos(x)^2}
26344because one @expr{a} would have ``matched'' 1 while the other matched 6.
26345
26346Calc automatically converts a rule like
26347
26348@example
26349f(x-1, x) := g(x)
26350@end example
26351
26352@noindent
26353into the form
26354
26355@example
26356f(temp, x) := g(x) :: temp = x-1
26357@end example
26358
26359@noindent
26360(where @code{temp} stands for a new, invented meta-variable that
26361doesn't actually have a name). This modified rule will successfully
26362match @samp{f(6, 7)}, binding @samp{temp} and @samp{x} to 6 and 7,
26363respectively, then verifying that they differ by one even though
26364@samp{6} does not superficially look like @samp{x-1}.
26365
26366However, Calc does not solve equations to interpret a rule. The
26367following rule,
26368
26369@example
26370f(x-1, x+1) := g(x)
26371@end example
26372
26373@noindent
26374will not work. That is, it will match @samp{f(a - 1 + b, a + 1 + b)}
26375but not @samp{f(6, 8)}. Calc always interprets at least one occurrence
26376of a variable by literal matching. If the variable appears ``isolated''
26377then Calc is smart enough to use it for literal matching. But in this
26378last example, Calc is forced to rewrite the rule to @samp{f(x-1, temp)
26379:= g(x) :: temp = x+1} where the @samp{x-1} term must correspond to an
26380actual ``something-minus-one'' in the target formula.
26381
26382A successful way to write this would be @samp{f(x, x+2) := g(x+1)}.
26383You could make this resemble the original form more closely by using
26384@code{let} notation, which is described in the next section:
26385
26386@example
26387f(xm1, x+1) := g(x) :: let(x := xm1+1)
26388@end example
26389
26390Calc does this rewriting or ``conditionalizing'' for any sub-pattern
26391which involves only the functions in the following list, operating
26392only on constants and meta-variables which have already been matched
26393elsewhere in the pattern. When matching a function call, Calc is
26394careful to match arguments which are plain variables before arguments
26395which are calls to any of the functions below, so that a pattern like
26396@samp{f(x-1, x)} can be conditionalized even though the isolated
26397@samp{x} comes after the @samp{x-1}.
26398
26399@smallexample
26400+ - * / \ % ^ abs sign round rounde roundu trunc floor ceil
26401max min re im conj arg
26402@end smallexample
26403
26404You can suppress all of the special treatments described in this
26405section by surrounding a function call with a @code{plain} marker.
26406This marker causes the function call which is its argument to be
26407matched literally, without regard to commutativity, associativity,
26408negation, or conditionalization. When you use @code{plain}, the
26409``deep structure'' of the formula being matched can show through.
26410For example,
26411
26412@example
26413plain(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26414@end example
26415
26416@noindent
26417will match only literal subtractions. However, the @code{plain}
26418marker does not affect its arguments' arguments. In this case,
26419commutativity and associativity is still considered while matching
26420the @w{@samp{a b}} sub-pattern, so the whole pattern will match
26421@samp{x - y x} as well as @samp{x - x y}. We could go still
26422further and use
26423
26424@example
26425plain(a - plain(a b)) := f(a, b)
26426@end example
26427
26428@noindent
26429which would do a completely strict match for the pattern.
26430
26431By contrast, the @code{quote} marker means that not only the
26432function name but also the arguments must be literally the same.
26433The above pattern will match @samp{x - x y} but
26434
26435@example
26436quote(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26437@end example
26438
26439@noindent
26440will match only the single formula @samp{a - a b}. Also,
26441
26442@example
26443quote(a - quote(a b)) := f(a, b)
26444@end example
26445
26446@noindent
26447will match only @samp{a - quote(a b)}---probably not the desired
26448effect!
26449
26450A certain amount of algebra is also done when substituting the
26451meta-variables on the righthand side of a rule. For example,
26452in the rule
26453
26454@example
26455a + f(b) := f(a + b)
26456@end example
26457
26458@noindent
26459matching @samp{f(x) - y} would produce @samp{f((-y) + x)} if
26460taken literally, but the rewrite mechanism will simplify the
26461righthand side to @samp{f(x - y)} automatically. (Of course,
26462the default simplifications would do this anyway, so this
26463special simplification is only noticeable if you have turned the
26464default simplifications off.) This rewriting is done only when
26465a meta-variable expands to a ``negative-looking'' expression.
26466If this simplification is not desirable, you can use a @code{plain}
26467marker on the righthand side:
26468
26469@example
26470a + f(b) := f(plain(a + b))
26471@end example
26472
26473@noindent
26474In this example, we are still allowing the pattern-matcher to
26475use all the algebra it can muster, but the righthand side will
26476always simplify to a literal addition like @samp{f((-y) + x)}.
26477
26478@node Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26479@subsection Other Features of Rewrite Rules
26480
26481@noindent
26482Certain ``function names'' serve as markers in rewrite rules.
26483Here is a complete list of these markers. First are listed the
26484markers that work inside a pattern; then come the markers that
26485work in the righthand side of a rule.
26486
26487@ignore
26488@starindex
26489@end ignore
26490@tindex import
26491One kind of marker, @samp{import(x)}, takes the place of a whole
26492rule. Here @expr{x} is the name of a variable containing another
26493rule set; those rules are ``spliced into'' the rule set that
26494imports them. For example, if @samp{[f(a+b) := f(a) + f(b),
26495f(a b) := a f(b) :: real(a)]} is stored in variable @samp{linearF},
26496then the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 0, import(linearF)]} will apply
26497all three rules. It is possible to modify the imported rules
26498slightly: @samp{import(x, v1, x1, v2, x2, @dots{})} imports
26499the rule set @expr{x} with all occurrences of
26500@texline @math{v_1},
26501@infoline @expr{v1},
26502as either a variable name or a function name, replaced with
26503@texline @math{x_1}
26504@infoline @expr{x1}
26505and so on. (If
26506@texline @math{v_1}
26507@infoline @expr{v1}
26508is used as a function name, then
26509@texline @math{x_1}
26510@infoline @expr{x1}
26511must be either a function name itself or a @w{@samp{< >}} nameless
26512function; @pxref{Specifying Operators}.) For example, @samp{[g(0) := 0,
26513import(linearF, f, g)]} applies the linearity rules to the function
26514@samp{g} instead of @samp{f}. Imports can be nested, but the
26515import-with-renaming feature may fail to rename sub-imports properly.
26516
26517The special functions allowed in patterns are:
26518
26519@table @samp
26520@item quote(x)
26521@ignore
26522@starindex
26523@end ignore
26524@tindex quote
26525This pattern matches exactly @expr{x}; variable names in @expr{x} are
26526not interpreted as meta-variables. The only flexibility is that
26527numbers are compared for numeric equality, so that the pattern
26528@samp{f(quote(12))} will match both @samp{f(12)} and @samp{f(12.0)}.
26529(Numbers are always treated this way by the rewrite mechanism:
26530The rule @samp{f(x,x) := g(x)} will match @samp{f(12, 12.0)}.
26531The rewrite may produce either @samp{g(12)} or @samp{g(12.0)}
26532as a result in this case.)
26533
26534@item plain(x)
26535@ignore
26536@starindex
26537@end ignore
26538@tindex plain
26539Here @expr{x} must be a function call @samp{f(x1,x2,@dots{})}. This
26540pattern matches a call to function @expr{f} with the specified
26541argument patterns. No special knowledge of the properties of the
26542function @expr{f} is used in this case; @samp{+} is not commutative or
26543associative. Unlike @code{quote}, the arguments @samp{x1,x2,@dots{}}
26544are treated as patterns. If you wish them to be treated ``plainly''
26545as well, you must enclose them with more @code{plain} markers:
26546@samp{plain(plain(@w{-a}) + plain(b c))}.
26547
26548@item opt(x,def)
26549@ignore
26550@starindex
26551@end ignore
26552@tindex opt
26553Here @expr{x} must be a variable name. This must appear as an
26554argument to a function or an element of a vector; it specifies that
26555the argument or element is optional.
26556As an argument to @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*}, @samp{&&}, or @samp{||},
26557or as the second argument to @samp{/} or @samp{^}, the value @var{def}
26558may be omitted. The pattern @samp{x + opt(y)} matches a sum by
26559binding one summand to @expr{x} and the other to @expr{y}, and it
26560matches anything else by binding the whole expression to @expr{x} and
26561zero to @expr{y}. The other operators above work similarly.
26562
26563For general miscellaneous functions, the default value @code{def}
26564must be specified. Optional arguments are dropped starting with
26565the rightmost one during matching. For example, the pattern
26566@samp{f(opt(a,0), b, opt(c,b))} will match @samp{f(b)}, @samp{f(a,b)},
26567or @samp{f(a,b,c)}. Default values of zero and @expr{b} are
26568supplied in this example for the omitted arguments. Note that
26569the literal variable @expr{b} will be the default in the latter
26570case, @emph{not} the value that matched the meta-variable @expr{b}.
26571In other words, the default @var{def} is effectively quoted.
26572
26573@item condition(x,c)
26574@ignore
26575@starindex
26576@end ignore
26577@tindex condition
26578@tindex ::
26579This matches the pattern @expr{x}, with the attached condition
26580@expr{c}. It is the same as @samp{x :: c}.
26581
26582@item pand(x,y)
26583@ignore
26584@starindex
26585@end ignore
26586@tindex pand
26587@tindex &&&
26588This matches anything that matches both pattern @expr{x} and
26589pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @samp{x &&& y}.
26590@pxref{Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules}.
26591
26592@item por(x,y)
26593@ignore
26594@starindex
26595@end ignore
26596@tindex por
26597@tindex |||
26598This matches anything that matches either pattern @expr{x} or
26599pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @w{@samp{x ||| y}}.
26600
26601@item pnot(x)
26602@ignore
26603@starindex
26604@end ignore
26605@tindex pnot
26606@tindex !!!
26607This matches anything that does not match pattern @expr{x}.
26608It is the same as @samp{!!! x}.
26609
26610@item cons(h,t)
26611@ignore
26612@mindex cons
26613@end ignore
26614@tindex cons (rewrites)
26615This matches any vector of one or more elements. The first
26616element is matched to @expr{h}; a vector of the remaining
26617elements is matched to @expr{t}. Note that vectors of fixed
26618length can also be matched as actual vectors: The rule
26619@samp{cons(a,cons(b,[])) := cons(a+b,[])} is equivalent
26620to the rule @samp{[a,b] := [a+b]}.
26621
26622@item rcons(t,h)
26623@ignore
26624@mindex rcons
26625@end ignore
26626@tindex rcons (rewrites)
26627This is like @code{cons}, except that the @emph{last} element
26628is matched to @expr{h}, with the remaining elements matched
26629to @expr{t}.
26630
26631@item apply(f,args)
26632@ignore
26633@mindex apply
26634@end ignore
26635@tindex apply (rewrites)
26636This matches any function call. The name of the function, in
26637the form of a variable, is matched to @expr{f}. The arguments
26638of the function, as a vector of zero or more objects, are
26639matched to @samp{args}. Constants, variables, and vectors
26640do @emph{not} match an @code{apply} pattern. For example,
26641@samp{apply(f,x)} matches any function call, @samp{apply(quote(f),x)}
26642matches any call to the function @samp{f}, @samp{apply(f,[a,b])}
26643matches any function call with exactly two arguments, and
26644@samp{apply(quote(f), cons(a,cons(b,x)))} matches any call
26645to the function @samp{f} with two or more arguments. Another
26646way to implement the latter, if the rest of the rule does not
26647need to refer to the first two arguments of @samp{f} by name,
26648would be @samp{apply(quote(f), x :: vlen(x) >= 2)}.
26649Here's a more interesting sample use of @code{apply}:
26650
26651@example
26652apply(f,[x+n]) := n + apply(f,[x])
26653 :: in(f, [floor,ceil,round,trunc]) :: integer(n)
26654@end example
26655
26656Note, however, that this will be slower to match than a rule
26657set with four separate rules. The reason is that Calc sorts
26658the rules of a rule set according to top-level function name;
26659if the top-level function is @code{apply}, Calc must try the
26660rule for every single formula and sub-formula. If the top-level
26661function in the pattern is, say, @code{floor}, then Calc invokes
26662the rule only for sub-formulas which are calls to @code{floor}.
26663
26664Formulas normally written with operators like @code{+} are still
26665considered function calls: @code{apply(f,x)} matches @samp{a+b}
26666with @samp{f = add}, @samp{x = [a,b]}.
26667
26668You must use @code{apply} for meta-variables with function names
26669on both sides of a rewrite rule: @samp{apply(f, [x]) := f(x+1)}
26670is @emph{not} correct, because it rewrites @samp{spam(6)} into
26671@samp{f(7)}. The righthand side should be @samp{apply(f, [x+1])}.
26672Also note that you will have to use No-Simplify mode (@kbd{m O})
26673when entering this rule so that the @code{apply} isn't
26674evaluated immediately to get the new rule @samp{f(x) := f(x+1)}.
26675Or, use @kbd{s e} to enter the rule without going through the stack,
26676or enter the rule as @samp{apply(f, [x]) := apply(f, [x+1]) @w{:: 1}}.
26677@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}.
26678
26679@item select(x)
26680@ignore
26681@starindex
26682@end ignore
26683@tindex select
26684This is used for applying rules to formulas with selections;
26685@pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26686@end table
26687
26688Special functions for the righthand sides of rules are:
26689
26690@table @samp
26691@item quote(x)
26692The notation @samp{quote(x)} is changed to @samp{x} when the
26693righthand side is used. As far as the rewrite rule is concerned,
26694@code{quote} is invisible. However, @code{quote} has the special
26695property in Calc that its argument is not evaluated. Thus,
26696while it will not work to put the rule @samp{t(a) := typeof(a)}
26697on the stack because @samp{typeof(a)} is evaluated immediately
26698to produce @samp{t(a) := 100}, you can use @code{quote} to
26699protect the righthand side: @samp{t(a) := quote(typeof(a))}.
26700(@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for another trick for
26701protecting rules from evaluation.)
26702
26703@item plain(x)
26704Special properties of and simplifications for the function call
26705@expr{x} are not used. One interesting case where @code{plain}
26706is useful is the rule, @samp{q(x) := quote(x)}, trying to expand a
26707shorthand notation for the @code{quote} function. This rule will
26708not work as shown; instead of replacing @samp{q(foo)} with
26709@samp{quote(foo)}, it will replace it with @samp{foo}! The correct
26710rule would be @samp{q(x) := plain(quote(x))}.
26711
26712@item cons(h,t)
26713Where @expr{t} is a vector, this is converted into an expanded
26714vector during rewrite processing. Note that @code{cons} is a regular
26715Calc function which normally does this anyway; the only way @code{cons}
26716is treated specially by rewrites is that @code{cons} on the righthand
26717side of a rule will be evaluated even if default simplifications
26718have been turned off.
26719
26720@item rcons(t,h)
26721Analogous to @code{cons} except putting @expr{h} at the @emph{end} of
26722the vector @expr{t}.
26723
26724@item apply(f,args)
26725Where @expr{f} is a variable and @var{args} is a vector, this
26726is converted to a function call. Once again, note that @code{apply}
26727is also a regular Calc function.
26728
26729@item eval(x)
26730@ignore
26731@starindex
26732@end ignore
26733@tindex eval
26734The formula @expr{x} is handled in the usual way, then the
26735default simplifications are applied to it even if they have
26736been turned off normally. This allows you to treat any function
26737similarly to the way @code{cons} and @code{apply} are always
26738treated. However, there is a slight difference: @samp{cons(2+3, [])}
26739with default simplifications off will be converted to @samp{[2+3]},
26740whereas @samp{eval(cons(2+3, []))} will be converted to @samp{[5]}.
26741
26742@item evalsimp(x)
26743@ignore
26744@starindex
26745@end ignore
26746@tindex evalsimp
26747The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the usual
26748way, then algebraically simplified as if by the @kbd{a s} command.
26749
26750@item evalextsimp(x)
26751@ignore
26752@starindex
26753@end ignore
26754@tindex evalextsimp
26755The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the normal
26756way, then ``extendedly'' simplified as if by the @kbd{a e} command.
26757
26758@item select(x)
26759@xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26760@end table
26761
26762There are also some special functions you can use in conditions.
26763
26764@table @samp
26765@item let(v := x)
26766@ignore
26767@starindex
26768@end ignore
26769@tindex let
26770The expression @expr{x} is evaluated with meta-variables substituted.
26771The @kbd{a s} command's simplifications are @emph{not} applied by
26772default, but @expr{x} can include calls to @code{evalsimp} or
26773@code{evalextsimp} as described above to invoke higher levels
26774of simplification. The
26775result of @expr{x} is then bound to the meta-variable @expr{v}. As
26776usual, if this meta-variable has already been matched to something
26777else the two values must be equal; if the meta-variable is new then
26778it is bound to the result of the expression. This variable can then
26779appear in later conditions, and on the righthand side of the rule.
26780In fact, @expr{v} may be any pattern in which case the result of
26781evaluating @expr{x} is matched to that pattern, binding any
26782meta-variables that appear in that pattern. Note that @code{let}
26783can only appear by itself as a condition, or as one term of an
26784@samp{&&} which is a whole condition: It cannot be inside
26785an @samp{||} term or otherwise buried.
26786
26787The alternate, equivalent form @samp{let(v, x)} is also recognized.
26788Note that the use of @samp{:=} by @code{let}, while still being
26789assignment-like in character, is unrelated to the use of @samp{:=}
26790in the main part of a rewrite rule.
26791
26792As an example, @samp{f(a) := g(ia) :: let(ia := 1/a) :: constant(ia)}
26793replaces @samp{f(a)} with @samp{g} of the inverse of @samp{a}, if
26794that inverse exists and is constant. For example, if @samp{a} is a
26795singular matrix the operation @samp{1/a} is left unsimplified and
26796@samp{constant(ia)} fails, but if @samp{a} is an invertible matrix
26797then the rule succeeds. Without @code{let} there would be no way
26798to express this rule that didn't have to invert the matrix twice.
26799Note that, because the meta-variable @samp{ia} is otherwise unbound
26800in this rule, the @code{let} condition itself always ``succeeds''
26801because no matter what @samp{1/a} evaluates to, it can successfully
26802be bound to @code{ia}.
26803
26804Here's another example, for integrating cosines of linear
26805terms: @samp{myint(cos(y),x) := sin(y)/b :: let([a,b,x] := lin(y,x))}.
26806The @code{lin} function returns a 3-vector if its argument is linear,
26807or leaves itself unevaluated if not. But an unevaluated @code{lin}
26808call will not match the 3-vector on the lefthand side of the @code{let},
26809so this @code{let} both verifies that @code{y} is linear, and binds
26810the coefficients @code{a} and @code{b} for use elsewhere in the rule.
26811(It would have been possible to use @samp{sin(a x + b)/b} for the
26812righthand side instead, but using @samp{sin(y)/b} avoids gratuitous
26813rearrangement of the argument of the sine.)
26814
26815@ignore
26816@starindex
26817@end ignore
26818@tindex ierf
26819Similarly, here is a rule that implements an inverse-@code{erf}
26820function. It uses @code{root} to search for a solution. If
26821@code{root} succeeds, it will return a vector of two numbers
26822where the first number is the desired solution. If no solution
26823is found, @code{root} remains in symbolic form. So we use
26824@code{let} to check that the result was indeed a vector.
26825
26826@example
26827ierf(x) := y :: let([y,z] := root(erf(a) = x, a, .5))
26828@end example
26829
26830@item matches(v,p)
26831The meta-variable @var{v}, which must already have been matched
26832to something elsewhere in the rule, is compared against pattern
26833@var{p}. Since @code{matches} is a standard Calc function, it
26834can appear anywhere in a condition. But if it appears alone or
26835as a term of a top-level @samp{&&}, then you get the special
26836extra feature that meta-variables which are bound to things
26837inside @var{p} can be used elsewhere in the surrounding rewrite
26838rule.
26839
26840The only real difference between @samp{let(p := v)} and
26841@samp{matches(v, p)} is that the former evaluates @samp{v} using
26842the default simplifications, while the latter does not.
26843
26844@item remember
26845@vindex remember
26846This is actually a variable, not a function. If @code{remember}
26847appears as a condition in a rule, then when that rule succeeds
26848the original expression and rewritten expression are added to the
26849front of the rule set that contained the rule. If the rule set
26850was not stored in a variable, @code{remember} is ignored. The
26851lefthand side is enclosed in @code{quote} in the added rule if it
26852contains any variables.
26853
26854For example, the rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: remember} applied
26855to @samp{f(7)} will add the rule @samp{f(7) := 7 f(6)} to the front
26856of the rule set. The rule set @code{EvalRules} works slightly
26857differently: There, the evaluation of @samp{f(6)} will complete before
26858the result is added to the rule set, in this case as @samp{f(7) := 5040}.
26859Thus @code{remember} is most useful inside @code{EvalRules}.
26860
26861It is up to you to ensure that the optimization performed by
26862@code{remember} is safe. For example, the rule @samp{foo(n) := n
26863:: evalv(eatfoo) > 0 :: remember} is a bad idea (@code{evalv} is
26864the function equivalent of the @kbd{=} command); if the variable
26865@code{eatfoo} ever contains 1, rules like @samp{foo(7) := 7} will
26866be added to the rule set and will continue to operate even if
26867@code{eatfoo} is later changed to 0.
26868
26869@item remember(c)
26870@ignore
26871@starindex
26872@end ignore
26873@tindex remember
26874Remember the match as described above, but only if condition @expr{c}
26875is true. For example, @samp{remember(n % 4 = 0)} in the above factorial
26876rule remembers only every fourth result. Note that @samp{remember(1)}
26877is equivalent to @samp{remember}, and @samp{remember(0)} has no effect.
26878@end table
26879
26880@node Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26881@subsection Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules
26882
26883@noindent
26884There are three operators, @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!},
26885that combine rewrite patterns to make larger patterns. The
26886combinations are ``and,'' ``or,'' and ``not,'' respectively, and
26887these operators are the pattern equivalents of @samp{&&}, @samp{||}
26888and @samp{!} (which operate on zero-or-nonzero logical values).
26889
26890Note that @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!} are left in symbolic
26891form by all regular Calc features; they have special meaning only in
26892the context of rewrite rule patterns.
26893
26894The pattern @samp{@var{p1} &&& @var{p2}} matches anything that
26895matches both @var{p1} and @var{p2}. One especially useful case is
26896when one of @var{p1} or @var{p2} is a meta-variable. For example,
26897here is a rule that operates on error forms:
26898
26899@example
26900f(x &&& a +/- b, x) := g(x)
26901@end example
26902
26903This does the same thing, but is arguably simpler than, the rule
26904
26905@example
26906f(a +/- b, a +/- b) := g(a +/- b)
26907@end example
26908
26909@ignore
26910@starindex
26911@end ignore
26912@tindex ends
26913Here's another interesting example:
26914
26915@example
26916ends(cons(a, x) &&& rcons(y, b)) := [a, b]
26917@end example
26918
26919@noindent
26920which effectively clips out the middle of a vector leaving just
26921the first and last elements. This rule will change a one-element
26922vector @samp{[a]} to @samp{[a, a]}. The similar rule
26923
26924@example
26925ends(cons(a, rcons(y, b))) := [a, b]
26926@end example
26927
26928@noindent
26929would do the same thing except that it would fail to match a
26930one-element vector.
26931
26932@tex
26933\bigskip
26934@end tex
26935
26936The pattern @samp{@var{p1} ||| @var{p2}} matches anything that
26937matches either @var{p1} or @var{p2}. Calc first tries matching
26938against @var{p1}; if that fails, it goes on to try @var{p2}.
26939
26940@ignore
26941@starindex
26942@end ignore
26943@tindex curve
26944A simple example of @samp{|||} is
26945
26946@example
26947curve(inf ||| -inf) := 0
26948@end example
26949
26950@noindent
26951which converts both @samp{curve(inf)} and @samp{curve(-inf)} to zero.
26952
26953Here is a larger example:
26954
26955@example
26956log(a, b) ||| (ln(a) :: let(b := e)) := mylog(a, b)
26957@end example
26958
26959This matches both generalized and natural logarithms in a single rule.
26960Note that the @samp{::} term must be enclosed in parentheses because
26961that operator has lower precedence than @samp{|||} or @samp{:=}.
26962
26963(In practice this rule would probably include a third alternative,
26964omitted here for brevity, to take care of @code{log10}.)
26965
26966While Calc generally treats interior conditions exactly the same as
26967conditions on the outside of a rule, it does guarantee that if all the
26968variables in the condition are special names like @code{e}, or already
26969bound in the pattern to which the condition is attached (say, if
26970@samp{a} had appeared in this condition), then Calc will process this
26971condition right after matching the pattern to the left of the @samp{::}.
26972Thus, we know that @samp{b} will be bound to @samp{e} only if the
26973@code{ln} branch of the @samp{|||} was taken.
26974
26975Note that this rule was careful to bind the same set of meta-variables
26976on both sides of the @samp{|||}. Calc does not check this, but if
26977you bind a certain meta-variable only in one branch and then use that
26978meta-variable elsewhere in the rule, results are unpredictable:
26979
26980@example
26981f(a,b) ||| g(b) := h(a,b)
26982@end example
26983
26984Here if the pattern matches @samp{g(17)}, Calc makes no promises about
26985the value that will be substituted for @samp{a} on the righthand side.
26986
26987@tex
26988\bigskip
26989@end tex
26990
26991The pattern @samp{!!! @var{pat}} matches anything that does not
26992match @var{pat}. Any meta-variables that are bound while matching
26993@var{pat} remain unbound outside of @var{pat}.
26994
26995For example,
26996
26997@example
26998f(x &&& !!! a +/- b, !!![]) := g(x)
26999@end example
27000
27001@noindent
27002converts @code{f} whose first argument is anything @emph{except} an
27003error form, and whose second argument is not the empty vector, into
27004a similar call to @code{g} (but without the second argument).
27005
27006If we know that the second argument will be a vector (empty or not),
27007then an equivalent rule would be:
27008
27009@example
27010f(x, y) := g(x) :: typeof(x) != 7 :: vlen(y) > 0
27011@end example
27012
27013@noindent
27014where of course 7 is the @code{typeof} code for error forms.
27015Another final condition, that works for any kind of @samp{y},
27016would be @samp{!istrue(y == [])}. (The @code{istrue} function
27017returns an explicit 0 if its argument was left in symbolic form;
27018plain @samp{!(y == [])} or @samp{y != []} would not work to replace
27019@samp{!!![]} since these would be left unsimplified, and thus cause
27020the rule to fail, if @samp{y} was something like a variable name.)
27021
27022It is possible for a @samp{!!!} to refer to meta-variables bound
27023elsewhere in the pattern. For example,
27024
27025@example
27026f(a, !!!a) := g(a)
27027@end example
27028
27029@noindent
27030matches any call to @code{f} with different arguments, changing
27031this to @code{g} with only the first argument.
27032
27033If a function call is to be matched and one of the argument patterns
27034contains a @samp{!!!} somewhere inside it, that argument will be
27035matched last. Thus
27036
27037@example
27038f(!!!a, a) := g(a)
27039@end example
27040
27041@noindent
27042will be careful to bind @samp{a} to the second argument of @code{f}
27043before testing the first argument. If Calc had tried to match the
27044first argument of @code{f} first, the results would have been
27045disastrous: since @code{a} was unbound so far, the pattern @samp{a}
27046would have matched anything at all, and the pattern @samp{!!!a}
27047therefore would @emph{not} have matched anything at all!
27048
27049@node Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27050@subsection Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules
27051
27052@noindent
27053When @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) is used, it takes an expression from
27054the top of the stack and attempts to match any of the specified rules
27055to any part of the expression, starting with the whole expression
27056and then, if that fails, trying deeper and deeper sub-expressions.
27057For each part of the expression, the rules are tried in the order
27058they appear in the rules vector. The first rule to match the first
27059sub-expression wins; it replaces the matched sub-expression according
27060to the @var{new} part of the rule.
27061
27062Often, the rule set will match and change the formula several times.
27063The top-level formula is first matched and substituted repeatedly until
27064it no longer matches the pattern; then, sub-formulas are tried, and
27065so on. Once every part of the formula has gotten its chance, the
27066rewrite mechanism starts over again with the top-level formula
27067(in case a substitution of one of its arguments has caused it again
27068to match). This continues until no further matches can be made
27069anywhere in the formula.
27070
27071It is possible for a rule set to get into an infinite loop. The
27072most obvious case, replacing a formula with itself, is not a problem
27073because a rule is not considered to ``succeed'' unless the righthand
27074side actually comes out to something different than the original
27075formula or sub-formula that was matched. But if you accidentally
27076had both @samp{ln(a b) := ln(a) + ln(b)} and the reverse
27077@samp{ln(a) + ln(b) := ln(a b)} in your rule set, Calc would
27078run forever switching a formula back and forth between the two
27079forms.
27080
27081To avoid disaster, Calc normally stops after 100 changes have been
27082made to the formula. This will be enough for most multiple rewrites,
27083but it will keep an endless loop of rewrites from locking up the
27084computer forever. (On most systems, you can also type @kbd{C-g} to
27085halt any Emacs command prematurely.)
27086
27087To change this limit, give a positive numeric prefix argument.
27088In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} applies only one rewrite at a time,
27089useful when you are first testing your rule (or just if repeated
27090rewriting is not what is called for by your application).
27091
27092@ignore
27093@starindex
27094@end ignore
27095@ignore
27096@mindex iter@idots
27097@end ignore
27098@tindex iterations
27099You can also put a ``function call'' @samp{iterations(@var{n})}
27100in place of a rule anywhere in your rules vector (but usually at
27101the top). Then, @var{n} will be used instead of 100 as the default
27102number of iterations for this rule set. You can use
27103@samp{iterations(inf)} if you want no iteration limit by default.
27104A prefix argument will override the @code{iterations} limit in the
27105rule set.
27106
27107@example
27108[ iterations(1),
27109 f(x) := f(x+1) ]
27110@end example
27111
27112More precisely, the limit controls the number of ``iterations,''
27113where each iteration is a successful matching of a rule pattern whose
27114righthand side, after substituting meta-variables and applying the
27115default simplifications, is different from the original sub-formula
27116that was matched.
27117
27118A prefix argument of zero sets the limit to infinity. Use with caution!
27119
27120Given a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{a r} will match and
27121substitute the top-level expression up to that many times, but
27122will not attempt to match the rules to any sub-expressions.
27123
27124In a formula, @code{rewrite(@var{expr}, @var{rules}, @var{n})}
27125does a rewriting operation. Here @var{expr} is the expression
27126being rewritten, @var{rules} is the rule, vector of rules, or
27127variable containing the rules, and @var{n} is the optional
27128iteration limit, which may be a positive integer, a negative
27129integer, or @samp{inf} or @samp{-inf}. If @var{n} is omitted
27130the @code{iterations} value from the rule set is used; if both
27131are omitted, 100 is used.
27132
27133@node Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27134@subsection Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules
27135
27136@noindent
27137It is possible to separate a rewrite rule set into several @dfn{phases}.
27138During each phase, certain rules will be enabled while certain others
27139will be disabled. A @dfn{phase schedule} controls the order in which
27140phases occur during the rewriting process.
27141
27142@ignore
27143@starindex
27144@end ignore
27145@tindex phase
27146@vindex all
27147If a call to the marker function @code{phase} appears in the rules
27148vector in place of a rule, all rules following that point will be
27149members of the phase(s) identified in the arguments to @code{phase}.
27150Phases are given integer numbers. The markers @samp{phase()} and
27151@samp{phase(all)} both mean the following rules belong to all phases;
27152this is the default at the start of the rule set.
27153
27154If you do not explicitly schedule the phases, Calc sorts all phase
27155numbers that appear in the rule set and executes the phases in
27156ascending order. For example, the rule set
27157
27158@example
27159@group
27160[ f0(x) := g0(x),
27161 phase(1),
27162 f1(x) := g1(x),
27163 phase(2),
27164 f2(x) := g2(x),
27165 phase(3),
27166 f3(x) := g3(x),
27167 phase(1,2),
27168 f4(x) := g4(x) ]
27169@end group
27170@end example
27171
27172@noindent
27173has three phases, 1 through 3. Phase 1 consists of the @code{f0},
27174@code{f1}, and @code{f4} rules (in that order). Phase 2 consists of
27175@code{f0}, @code{f2}, and @code{f4}. Phase 3 consists of @code{f0}
27176and @code{f3}.
27177
27178When Calc rewrites a formula using this rule set, it first rewrites
27179the formula using only the phase 1 rules until no further changes are
27180possible. Then it switches to the phase 2 rule set and continues
27181until no further changes occur, then finally rewrites with phase 3.
27182When no more phase 3 rules apply, rewriting finishes. (This is
27183assuming @kbd{a r} with a large enough prefix argument to allow the
27184rewriting to run to completion; the sequence just described stops
27185early if the number of iterations specified in the prefix argument,
27186100 by default, is reached.)
27187
27188During each phase, Calc descends through the nested levels of the
27189formula as described previously. (@xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite
27190Rules}.) Rewriting starts at the top of the formula, then works its
27191way down to the parts, then goes back to the top and works down again.
27192The phase 2 rules do not begin until no phase 1 rules apply anywhere
27193in the formula.
27194
27195@ignore
27196@starindex
27197@end ignore
27198@tindex schedule
27199A @code{schedule} marker appearing in the rule set (anywhere, but
27200conventionally at the top) changes the default schedule of phases.
27201In the simplest case, @code{schedule} has a sequence of phase numbers
27202for arguments; each phase number is invoked in turn until the
27203arguments to @code{schedule} are exhausted. Thus adding
27204@samp{schedule(3,2,1)} at the top of the above rule set would
27205reverse the order of the phases; @samp{schedule(1,2,3)} would have
27206no effect since this is the default schedule; and @samp{schedule(1,2,1,3)}
27207would give phase 1 a second chance after phase 2 has completed, before
27208moving on to phase 3.
27209
27210Any argument to @code{schedule} can instead be a vector of phase
27211numbers (or even of sub-vectors). Then the sub-sequence of phases
27212described by the vector are tried repeatedly until no change occurs
27213in any phase in the sequence. For example, @samp{schedule([1, 2], 3)}
27214tries phase 1, then phase 2, then, if either phase made any changes
27215to the formula, repeats these two phases until they can make no
27216further progress. Finally, it goes on to phase 3 for finishing
27217touches.
27218
27219Also, items in @code{schedule} can be variable names as well as
27220numbers. A variable name is interpreted as the name of a function
27221to call on the whole formula. For example, @samp{schedule(1, simplify)}
27222says to apply the phase-1 rules (presumably, all of them), then to
27223call @code{simplify} which is the function name equivalent of @kbd{a s}.
27224Likewise, @samp{schedule([1, simplify])} says to alternate between
27225phase 1 and @kbd{a s} until no further changes occur.
27226
27227Phases can be used purely to improve efficiency; if it is known that
27228a certain group of rules will apply only at the beginning of rewriting,
27229and a certain other group will apply only at the end, then rewriting
27230will be faster if these groups are identified as separate phases.
27231Once the phase 1 rules are done, Calc can put them aside and no longer
27232spend any time on them while it works on phase 2.
27233
27234There are also some problems that can only be solved with several
27235rewrite phases. For a real-world example of a multi-phase rule set,
27236examine the set @code{FitRules}, which is used by the curve-fitting
27237command to convert a model expression to linear form.
27238@xref{Curve Fitting Details}. This set is divided into four phases.
27239The first phase rewrites certain kinds of expressions to be more
27240easily linearizable, but less computationally efficient. After the
27241linear components have been picked out, the final phase includes the
27242opposite rewrites to put each component back into an efficient form.
27243If both sets of rules were included in one big phase, Calc could get
27244into an infinite loop going back and forth between the two forms.
27245
27246Elsewhere in @code{FitRules}, the components are first isolated,
27247then recombined where possible to reduce the complexity of the linear
27248fit, then finally packaged one component at a time into vectors.
27249If the packaging rules were allowed to begin before the recombining
27250rules were finished, some components might be put away into vectors
27251before they had a chance to recombine. By putting these rules in
27252two separate phases, this problem is neatly avoided.
27253
27254@node Selections with Rewrite Rules, Matching Commands, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27255@subsection Selections with Rewrite Rules
27256
27257@noindent
27258If a sub-formula of the current formula is selected (as by @kbd{j s};
27259@pxref{Selecting Subformulas}), the @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite})
27260command applies only to that sub-formula. Together with a negative
27261prefix argument, you can use this fact to apply a rewrite to one
27262specific part of a formula without affecting any other parts.
27263
27264@kindex j r
27265@pindex calc-rewrite-selection
27266The @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command allows more
27267sophisticated operations on selections. This command prompts for
27268the rules in the same way as @kbd{a r}, but it then applies those
27269rules to the whole formula in question even though a sub-formula
27270of it has been selected. However, the selected sub-formula will
27271first have been surrounded by a @samp{select( )} function call.
27272(Calc's evaluator does not understand the function name @code{select};
27273this is only a tag used by the @kbd{j r} command.)
27274
27275For example, suppose the formula on the stack is @samp{2 (a + b)^2}
27276and the sub-formula @samp{a + b} is selected. This formula will
27277be rewritten to @samp{2 select(a + b)^2} and then the rewrite
27278rules will be applied in the usual way. The rewrite rules can
27279include references to @code{select} to tell where in the pattern
27280the selected sub-formula should appear.
27281
27282If there is still exactly one @samp{select( )} function call in
27283the formula after rewriting is done, it indicates which part of
27284the formula should be selected afterwards. Otherwise, the
27285formula will be unselected.
27286
27287You can make @kbd{j r} act much like @kbd{a r} by enclosing both parts
27288of the rewrite rule with @samp{select()}. However, @kbd{j r}
27289allows you to use the current selection in more flexible ways.
27290Suppose you wished to make a rule which removed the exponent from
27291the selected term; the rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} would
27292work. In the above example, it would rewrite @samp{2 select(a + b)^2}
27293to @samp{2 select(a + b)}. This would then be returned to the
27294stack as @samp{2 (a + b)} with the @samp{a + b} selected.
27295
27296The @kbd{j r} command uses one iteration by default, unlike
27297@kbd{a r} which defaults to 100 iterations. A numeric prefix
27298argument affects @kbd{j r} in the same way as @kbd{a r}.
27299@xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.
27300
27301As with other selection commands, @kbd{j r} operates on the stack
27302entry that contains the cursor. (If the cursor is on the top-of-stack
27303@samp{.} marker, it works as if the cursor were on the formula
27304at stack level 1.)
27305
27306If you don't specify a set of rules, the rules are taken from the
27307top of the stack, just as with @kbd{a r}. In this case, the
27308cursor must indicate stack entry 2 or above as the formula to be
27309rewritten (otherwise the same formula would be used as both the
27310target and the rewrite rules).
27311
27312If the indicated formula has no selection, the cursor position within
27313the formula temporarily selects a sub-formula for the purposes of this
27314command. If the cursor is not on any sub-formula (e.g., it is in
27315the line-number area to the left of the formula), the @samp{select( )}
27316markers are ignored by the rewrite mechanism and the rules are allowed
27317to apply anywhere in the formula.
27318
27319As a special feature, the normal @kbd{a r} command also ignores
27320@samp{select( )} calls in rewrite rules. For example, if you used the
27321above rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} with @kbd{a r}, it would apply
27322the rule as if it were @samp{a^x := a}. Thus, you can write general
27323purpose rules with @samp{select( )} hints inside them so that they
27324will ``do the right thing'' in both @kbd{a r} and @kbd{j r},
27325both with and without selections.
27326
27327@node Matching Commands, Automatic Rewrites, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27328@subsection Matching Commands
27329
27330@noindent
27331@kindex a m
27332@pindex calc-match
27333@tindex match
27334The @kbd{a m} (@code{calc-match}) [@code{match}] function takes a
27335vector of formulas and a rewrite-rule-style pattern, and produces
27336a vector of all formulas which match the pattern. The command
27337prompts you to enter the pattern; as for @kbd{a r}, you can enter
27338a single pattern (i.e., a formula with meta-variables), or a
27339vector of patterns, or a variable which contains patterns, or
27340you can give a blank response in which case the patterns are taken
27341from the top of the stack. The pattern set will be compiled once
27342and saved if it is stored in a variable. If there are several
27343patterns in the set, vector elements are kept if they match any
27344of the patterns.
27345
27346For example, @samp{match(a+b, [x, x+y, x-y, 7, x+y+z])}
27347will return @samp{[x+y, x-y, x+y+z]}.
27348
27349The @code{import} mechanism is not available for pattern sets.
27350
27351The @kbd{a m} command can also be used to extract all vector elements
27352which satisfy any condition: The pattern @samp{x :: x>0} will select
27353all the positive vector elements.
27354
27355@kindex I a m
27356@tindex matchnot
27357With the Inverse flag [@code{matchnot}], this command extracts all
27358vector elements which do @emph{not} match the given pattern.
27359
27360@ignore
27361@starindex
27362@end ignore
27363@tindex matches
27364There is also a function @samp{matches(@var{x}, @var{p})} which
27365evaluates to 1 if expression @var{x} matches pattern @var{p}, or
27366to 0 otherwise. This is sometimes useful for including into the
27367conditional clauses of other rewrite rules.
27368
27369@ignore
27370@starindex
27371@end ignore
27372@tindex vmatches
27373The function @code{vmatches} is just like @code{matches}, except
27374that if the match succeeds it returns a vector of assignments to
27375the meta-variables instead of the number 1. For example,
27376@samp{vmatches(f(1,2), f(a,b))} returns @samp{[a := 1, b := 2]}.
27377If the match fails, the function returns the number 0.
27378
27379@node Automatic Rewrites, Debugging Rewrites, Matching Commands, Rewrite Rules
27380@subsection Automatic Rewrites
27381
27382@noindent
27383@cindex @code{EvalRules} variable
27384@vindex EvalRules
27385It is possible to get Calc to apply a set of rewrite rules on all
27386results, effectively adding to the built-in set of default
27387simplifications. To do this, simply store your rule set in the
27388variable @code{EvalRules}. There is a convenient @kbd{s E} command
27389for editing @code{EvalRules}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
27390
27391For example, suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out
27392to @samp{sin(b) cos(a) + cos(b) sin(a)} wherever it appears, and
27393similarly for @samp{cos(a + b)}. The corresponding rewrite rule
27394set would be,
27395
27396@smallexample
27397@group
27398[ sin(a + b) := cos(a) sin(b) + sin(a) cos(b),
27399 cos(a + b) := cos(a) cos(b) - sin(a) sin(b) ]
27400@end group
27401@end smallexample
27402
27403To apply these manually, you could put them in a variable called
27404@code{trigexp} and then use @kbd{a r trigexp} every time you wanted
27405to expand trig functions. But if instead you store them in the
27406variable @code{EvalRules}, they will automatically be applied to all
27407sines and cosines of sums. Then, with @samp{2 x} and @samp{45} on
27408the stack, typing @kbd{+ S} will (assuming Degrees mode) result in
27409@samp{0.7071 sin(2 x) + 0.7071 cos(2 x)} automatically.
27410
27411As each level of a formula is evaluated, the rules from
27412@code{EvalRules} are applied before the default simplifications.
27413Rewriting continues until no further @code{EvalRules} apply.
27414Note that this is different from the usual order of application of
27415rewrite rules: @code{EvalRules} works from the bottom up, simplifying
27416the arguments to a function before the function itself, while @kbd{a r}
27417applies rules from the top down.
27418
27419Because the @code{EvalRules} are tried first, you can use them to
27420override the normal behavior of any built-in Calc function.
27421
27422It is important not to write a rule that will get into an infinite
27423loop. For example, the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 1, f(n) := n f(n-1)]}
27424appears to be a good definition of a factorial function, but it is
27425unsafe. Imagine what happens if @samp{f(2.5)} is simplified. Calc
27426will continue to subtract 1 from this argument forever without reaching
27427zero. A safer second rule would be @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0}.
27428Another dangerous rule is @samp{g(x, y) := g(y, x)}. Rewriting
27429@samp{g(2, 4)}, this would bounce back and forth between that and
27430@samp{g(4, 2)} forever. If an infinite loop in @code{EvalRules}
27431occurs, Emacs will eventually stop with a ``Computation got stuck
27432or ran too long'' message.
27433
27434Another subtle difference between @code{EvalRules} and regular rewrites
27435concerns rules that rewrite a formula into an identical formula. For
27436example, @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} ``fails to match'' when @expr{n} is
27437already an integer. But in @code{EvalRules} this case is detected only
27438if the righthand side literally becomes the original formula before any
27439further simplification. This means that @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} will
27440get into an infinite loop if it occurs in @code{EvalRules}. Calc will
27441replace @samp{f(6)} with @samp{f(floor(6))}, which is different from
27442@samp{f(6)}, so it will consider the rule to have matched and will
27443continue simplifying that formula; first the argument is simplified
27444to get @samp{f(6)}, then the rule matches again to get @samp{f(floor(6))}
27445again, ad infinitum. A much safer rule would check its argument first,
27446say, with @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n)) :: !dint(n)}.
27447
27448(What really happens is that the rewrite mechanism substitutes the
27449meta-variables in the righthand side of a rule, compares to see if the
27450result is the same as the original formula and fails if so, then uses
27451the default simplifications to simplify the result and compares again
27452(and again fails if the formula has simplified back to its original
27453form). The only special wrinkle for the @code{EvalRules} is that the
27454same rules will come back into play when the default simplifications
27455are used. What Calc wants to do is build @samp{f(floor(6))}, see that
27456this is different from the original formula, simplify to @samp{f(6)},
27457see that this is the same as the original formula, and thus halt the
27458rewriting. But while simplifying, @samp{f(6)} will again trigger
27459the same @code{EvalRules} rule and Calc will get into a loop inside
27460the rewrite mechanism itself.)
27461
27462The @code{phase}, @code{schedule}, and @code{iterations} markers do
27463not work in @code{EvalRules}. If the rule set is divided into phases,
27464only the phase 1 rules are applied, and the schedule is ignored.
27465The rules are always repeated as many times as possible.
27466
27467The @code{EvalRules} are applied to all function calls in a formula,
27468but not to numbers (and other number-like objects like error forms),
27469nor to vectors or individual variable names. (Though they will apply
27470to @emph{components} of vectors and error forms when appropriate.) You
27471might try to make a variable @code{phihat} which automatically expands
27472to its definition without the need to press @kbd{=} by writing the
27473rule @samp{quote(phihat) := (1-sqrt(5))/2}, but unfortunately this rule
27474will not work as part of @code{EvalRules}.
27475
27476Finally, another limitation is that Calc sometimes calls its built-in
27477functions directly rather than going through the default simplifications.
27478When it does this, @code{EvalRules} will not be able to override those
27479functions. For example, when you take the absolute value of the complex
27480number @expr{(2, 3)}, Calc computes @samp{sqrt(2*2 + 3*3)} by calling
27481the multiplication, addition, and square root functions directly rather
27482than applying the default simplifications to this formula. So an
27483@code{EvalRules} rule that (perversely) rewrites @samp{sqrt(13) := 6}
27484would not apply. (However, if you put Calc into Symbolic mode so that
27485@samp{sqrt(13)} will be left in symbolic form by the built-in square
27486root function, your rule will be able to apply. But if the complex
27487number were @expr{(3,4)}, so that @samp{sqrt(25)} must be calculated,
27488then Symbolic mode will not help because @samp{sqrt(25)} can be
27489evaluated exactly to 5.)
27490
27491One subtle restriction that normally only manifests itself with
27492@code{EvalRules} is that while a given rewrite rule is in the process
27493of being checked, that same rule cannot be recursively applied. Calc
27494effectively removes the rule from its rule set while checking the rule,
27495then puts it back once the match succeeds or fails. (The technical
27496reason for this is that compiled pattern programs are not reentrant.)
27497For example, consider the rule @samp{foo(x) := x :: foo(x/2) > 0}
27498attempting to match @samp{foo(8)}. This rule will be inactive while
27499the condition @samp{foo(4) > 0} is checked, even though it might be
27500an integral part of evaluating that condition. Note that this is not
27501a problem for the more usual recursive type of rule, such as
27502@samp{foo(x) := foo(x/2)}, because there the rule has succeeded and
27503been reactivated by the time the righthand side is evaluated.
27504
27505If @code{EvalRules} has no stored value (its default state), or if
27506anything but a vector is stored in it, then it is ignored.
27507
27508Even though Calc's rewrite mechanism is designed to compare rewrite
27509rules to formulas as quickly as possible, storing rules in
27510@code{EvalRules} may make Calc run substantially slower. This is
27511particularly true of rules where the top-level call is a commonly used
27512function, or is not fixed. The rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0} will
27513only activate the rewrite mechanism for calls to the function @code{f},
27514but @samp{lg(n) + lg(m) := lg(n m)} will check every @samp{+} operator.
27515
27516@smallexample
27517apply(f, [a*b]) := apply(f, [a]) + apply(f, [b]) :: in(f, [ln, log10])
27518@end smallexample
27519
27520@noindent
27521may seem more ``efficient'' than two separate rules for @code{ln} and
27522@code{log10}, but actually it is vastly less efficient because rules
27523with @code{apply} as the top-level pattern must be tested against
27524@emph{every} function call that is simplified.
27525
27526@cindex @code{AlgSimpRules} variable
27527@vindex AlgSimpRules
27528Suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out not all the time,
27529but only when @kbd{a s} is used to simplify the formula. The variable
27530@code{AlgSimpRules} holds rules for this purpose. The @kbd{a s} command
27531will apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules} to the formula, as
27532well as all of its built-in simplifications.
27533
27534Most of the special limitations for @code{EvalRules} don't apply to
27535@code{AlgSimpRules}. Calc simply does an @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
27536command with an infinite repeat count as the first step of @kbd{a s}.
27537It then applies its own built-in simplifications throughout the
27538formula, and then repeats these two steps (along with applying the
27539default simplifications) until no further changes are possible.
27540
27541@cindex @code{ExtSimpRules} variable
27542@cindex @code{UnitSimpRules} variable
27543@vindex ExtSimpRules
27544@vindex UnitSimpRules
27545There are also @code{ExtSimpRules} and @code{UnitSimpRules} variables
27546that are used by @kbd{a e} and @kbd{u s}, respectively; these commands
27547also apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. The variable
27548@code{IntegSimpRules} contains simplification rules that are used
27549only during integration by @kbd{a i}.
27550
27551@node Debugging Rewrites, Examples of Rewrite Rules, Automatic Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27552@subsection Debugging Rewrites
27553
27554@noindent
27555If a buffer named @samp{*Trace*} exists, the rewrite mechanism will
27556record some useful information there as it operates. The original
27557formula is written there, as is the result of each successful rewrite,
27558and the final result of the rewriting. All phase changes are also
27559noted.
27560
27561Calc always appends to @samp{*Trace*}. You must empty this buffer
27562yourself periodically if it is in danger of growing unwieldy.
27563
27564Note that the rewriting mechanism is substantially slower when the
27565@samp{*Trace*} buffer exists, even if the buffer is not visible on
27566the screen. Once you are done, you will probably want to kill this
27567buffer (with @kbd{C-x k *Trace* @key{RET}}). If you leave it in
27568existence and forget about it, all your future rewrite commands will
27569be needlessly slow.
27570
27571@node Examples of Rewrite Rules, , Debugging Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27572@subsection Examples of Rewrite Rules
27573
27574@noindent
27575Returning to the example of substituting the pattern
27576@samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2} with 1, we saw that the rule
27577@samp{opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a} does a good job of
27578finding suitable cases. Another solution would be to use the rule
27579@samp{cos(x)^2 := 1 - sin(x)^2}, followed by algebraic simplification
27580if necessary. This rule will be the most effective way to do the job,
27581but at the expense of making some changes that you might not desire.
27582
27583Another algebraic rewrite rule is @samp{exp(x+y) := exp(x) exp(y)}.
27584To make this work with the @w{@kbd{j r}} command so that it can be
27585easily targeted to a particular exponential in a large formula,
27586you might wish to write the rule as @samp{select(exp(x+y)) :=
27587select(exp(x) exp(y))}. The @samp{select} markers will be
27588ignored by the regular @kbd{a r} command
27589(@pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}).
27590
27591A surprisingly useful rewrite rule is @samp{a/(b-c) := a*(b+c)/(b^2-c^2)}.
27592This will simplify the formula whenever @expr{b} and/or @expr{c} can
27593be made simpler by squaring. For example, applying this rule to
27594@samp{2 / (sqrt(2) + 3)} yields @samp{6:7 - 2:7 sqrt(2)} (assuming
27595Symbolic mode has been enabled to keep the square root from being
27596evaluated to a floating-point approximation). This rule is also
27597useful when working with symbolic complex numbers, e.g.,
27598@samp{(a + b i) / (c + d i)}.
27599
27600As another example, we could define our own ``triangular numbers'' function
27601with the rules @samp{[tri(0) := 0, tri(n) := n + tri(n-1) :: n>0]}. Enter
27602this vector and store it in a variable: @kbd{@w{s t} trirules}. Now, given
27603a suitable formula like @samp{tri(5)} on the stack, type @samp{a r trirules}
27604to apply these rules repeatedly. After six applications, @kbd{a r} will
27605stop with 15 on the stack. Once these rules are debugged, it would probably
27606be most useful to add them to @code{EvalRules} so that Calc will evaluate
27607the new @code{tri} function automatically. We could then use @kbd{Z K} on
27608the keyboard macro @kbd{' tri($) @key{RET}} to make a command that applies
27609@code{tri} to the value on the top of the stack. @xref{Programming}.
27610
27611@cindex Quaternions
27612The following rule set, contributed by
27613@texline Fran\c cois
27614@infoline Francois
27615Pinard, implements @dfn{quaternions}, a generalization of the concept of
27616complex numbers. Quaternions have four components, and are here
27617represented by function calls @samp{quat(@var{w}, [@var{x}, @var{y},
27618@var{z}])} with ``real part'' @var{w} and the three ``imaginary'' parts
27619collected into a vector. Various arithmetical operations on quaternions
27620are supported. To use these rules, either add them to @code{EvalRules},
27621or create a command based on @kbd{a r} for simplifying quaternion
27622formulas. A convenient way to enter quaternions would be a command
27623defined by a keyboard macro containing: @kbd{' quat($$$$, [$$$, $$, $])
27624@key{RET}}.
27625
27626@smallexample
27627[ quat(w, x, y, z) := quat(w, [x, y, z]),
27628 quat(w, [0, 0, 0]) := w,
27629 abs(quat(w, v)) := hypot(w, v),
27630 -quat(w, v) := quat(-w, -v),
27631 r + quat(w, v) := quat(r + w, v) :: real(r),
27632 r - quat(w, v) := quat(r - w, -v) :: real(r),
27633 quat(w1, v1) + quat(w2, v2) := quat(w1 + w2, v1 + v2),
27634 r * quat(w, v) := quat(r * w, r * v) :: real(r),
27635 plain(quat(w1, v1) * quat(w2, v2))
27636 := quat(w1 * w2 - v1 * v2, w1 * v2 + w2 * v1 + cross(v1, v2)),
27637 quat(w1, v1) / r := quat(w1 / r, v1 / r) :: real(r),
27638 z / quat(w, v) := z * quatinv(quat(w, v)),
27639 quatinv(quat(w, v)) := quat(w, -v) / (w^2 + v^2),
27640 quatsqr(quat(w, v)) := quat(w^2 - v^2, 2 * w * v),
27641 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^(k / 2))
27642 :: integer(k) :: k > 0 :: k % 2 = 0,
27643 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^((k - 1) / 2)) * quat(w, v)
27644 :: integer(k) :: k > 2,
27645 quat(w, v)^-k := quatinv(quat(w, v)^k) :: integer(k) :: k > 0 ]
27646@end smallexample
27647
27648Quaternions, like matrices, have non-commutative multiplication.
27649In other words, @expr{q1 * q2 = q2 * q1} is not necessarily true if
27650@expr{q1} and @expr{q2} are @code{quat} forms. The @samp{quat*quat}
27651rule above uses @code{plain} to prevent Calc from rearranging the
27652product. It may also be wise to add the line @samp{[quat(), matrix]}
27653to the @code{Decls} matrix, to ensure that Calc's other algebraic
27654operations will not rearrange a quaternion product. @xref{Declarations}.
27655
27656These rules also accept a four-argument @code{quat} form, converting
27657it to the preferred form in the first rule. If you would rather see
27658results in the four-argument form, just append the two items
27659@samp{phase(2), quat(w, [x, y, z]) := quat(w, x, y, z)} to the end
27660of the rule set. (But remember that multi-phase rule sets don't work
27661in @code{EvalRules}.)
27662
27663@node Units, Store and Recall, Algebra, Top
27664@chapter Operating on Units
27665
27666@noindent
27667One special interpretation of algebraic formulas is as numbers with units.
27668For example, the formula @samp{5 m / s^2} can be read ``five meters
27669per second squared.'' The commands in this chapter help you
27670manipulate units expressions in this form. Units-related commands
27671begin with the @kbd{u} prefix key.
27672
27673@menu
27674* Basic Operations on Units::
27675* The Units Table::
27676* Predefined Units::
27677* User-Defined Units::
2e78df6b 27678* Logarithmic Units::
4009494e
GM
27679@end menu
27680
27681@node Basic Operations on Units, The Units Table, Units, Units
27682@section Basic Operations on Units
27683
27684@noindent
27685A @dfn{units expression} is a formula which is basically a number
27686multiplied and/or divided by one or more @dfn{unit names}, which may
27687optionally be raised to integer powers. Actually, the value part need not
27688be a number; any product or quotient involving unit names is a units
27689expression. Many of the units commands will also accept any formula,
27690where the command applies to all units expressions which appear in the
27691formula.
27692
27693A unit name is a variable whose name appears in the @dfn{unit table},
27694or a variable whose name is a prefix character like @samp{k} (for ``kilo'')
27695or @samp{u} (for ``micro'') followed by a name in the unit table.
27696A substantial table of built-in units is provided with Calc;
27697@pxref{Predefined Units}. You can also define your own unit names;
27698@pxref{User-Defined Units}.
27699
27700Note that if the value part of a units expression is exactly @samp{1},
27701it will be removed by the Calculator's automatic algebra routines: The
27702formula @samp{1 mm} is ``simplified'' to @samp{mm}. This is only a
27703display anomaly, however; @samp{mm} will work just fine as a
27704representation of one millimeter.
27705
27706You may find that Algebraic mode (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}) makes working
27707with units expressions easier. Otherwise, you will have to remember
27708to hit the apostrophe key every time you wish to enter units.
27709
27710@kindex u s
27711@pindex calc-simplify-units
27712@ignore
27713@mindex usimpl@idots
27714@end ignore
27715@tindex usimplify
27716The @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) [@code{usimplify}] command
27717simplifies a units
27718expression. It uses @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) to simplify the
27719expression first as a regular algebraic formula; it then looks for
27720features that can be further simplified by converting one object's units
27721to be compatible with another's. For example, @samp{5 m + 23 mm} will
27722simplify to @samp{5.023 m}. When different but compatible units are
27723added, the righthand term's units are converted to match those of the
27724lefthand term. @xref{Simplification Modes}, for a way to have this done
27725automatically at all times.
27726
27727Units simplification also handles quotients of two units with the same
27728dimensionality, as in @w{@samp{2 in s/L cm}} to @samp{5.08 s/L}; fractional
27729powers of unit expressions, as in @samp{sqrt(9 mm^2)} to @samp{3 mm} and
27730@samp{sqrt(9 acre)} to a quantity in meters; and @code{floor},
27731@code{ceil}, @code{round}, @code{rounde}, @code{roundu}, @code{trunc},
27732@code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{abs}, and @code{clean}
27733applied to units expressions, in which case
27734the operation in question is applied only to the numeric part of the
27735expression. Finally, trigonometric functions of quantities with units
27736of angle are evaluated, regardless of the current angular mode.
27737
27738@kindex u c
27739@pindex calc-convert-units
27740The @kbd{u c} (@code{calc-convert-units}) command converts a units
27741expression to new, compatible units. For example, given the units
27742expression @samp{55 mph}, typing @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces
27743@samp{24.5872 m/s}. If you have previously converted a units expression
27744with the same type of units (in this case, distance over time), you will
27745be offered the previous choice of new units as a default. Continuing
27746the above example, entering the units expression @samp{100 km/hr} and
27747typing @kbd{u c @key{RET}} (without specifying new units) produces
27748@samp{27.7777777778 m/s}.
27749
27750While many of Calc's conversion factors are exact, some are necessarily
27751approximate. If Calc is in fraction mode (@pxref{Fraction Mode}), then
27752unit conversions will try to give exact, rational conversions, but it
27753isn't always possible. Given @samp{55 mph} in fraction mode, typing
27754@kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces @samp{15367:625 m/s}, for example,
27755while typing @kbd{u c au/yr @key{RET}} produces
27756@samp{5.18665819999e-3 au/yr}.
27757
27758If the units you request are inconsistent with the original units, the
27759number will be converted into your units times whatever ``remainder''
27760units are left over. For example, converting @samp{55 mph} into acres
27761produces @samp{6.08e-3 acre / m s}. (Recall that multiplication binds
27762more strongly than division in Calc formulas, so the units here are
27763acres per meter-second.) Remainder units are expressed in terms of
27764``fundamental'' units like @samp{m} and @samp{s}, regardless of the
27765input units.
27766
27767One special exception is that if you specify a single unit name, and
27768a compatible unit appears somewhere in the units expression, then
27769that compatible unit will be converted to the new unit and the
27770remaining units in the expression will be left alone. For example,
27771given the input @samp{980 cm/s^2}, the command @kbd{u c ms} will
27772change the @samp{s} to @samp{ms} to get @samp{9.8e-4 cm/ms^2}.
27773The ``remainder unit'' @samp{cm} is left alone rather than being
27774changed to the base unit @samp{m}.
27775
27776You can use explicit unit conversion instead of the @kbd{u s} command
27777to gain more control over the units of the result of an expression.
27778For example, given @samp{5 m + 23 mm}, you can type @kbd{u c m} or
27779@kbd{u c mm} to express the result in either meters or millimeters.
27780(For that matter, you could type @kbd{u c fath} to express the result
27781in fathoms, if you preferred!)
27782
27783In place of a specific set of units, you can also enter one of the
27784units system names @code{si}, @code{mks} (equivalent), or @code{cgs}.
27785For example, @kbd{u c si @key{RET}} converts the expression into
27786International System of Units (SI) base units. Also, @kbd{u c base}
27787converts to Calc's base units, which are the same as @code{si} units
27788except that @code{base} uses @samp{g} as the fundamental unit of mass
27789whereas @code{si} uses @samp{kg}.
27790
27791@cindex Composite units
27792The @kbd{u c} command also accepts @dfn{composite units}, which
27793are expressed as the sum of several compatible unit names. For
27794example, converting @samp{30.5 in} to units @samp{mi+ft+in} (miles,
27795feet, and inches) produces @samp{2 ft + 6.5 in}. Calc first
27796sorts the unit names into order of decreasing relative size.
27797It then accounts for as much of the input quantity as it can
27798using an integer number times the largest unit, then moves on
27799to the next smaller unit, and so on. Only the smallest unit
27800may have a non-integer amount attached in the result. A few
27801standard unit names exist for common combinations, such as
27802@code{mfi} for @samp{mi+ft+in}, and @code{tpo} for @samp{ton+lb+oz}.
27803Composite units are expanded as if by @kbd{a x}, so that
27804@samp{(ft+in)/hr} is first converted to @samp{ft/hr+in/hr}.
27805
27806If the value on the stack does not contain any units, @kbd{u c} will
27807prompt first for the old units which this value should be considered
27808to have, then for the new units. Assuming the old and new units you
27809give are consistent with each other, the result also will not contain
285f0d3a
JB
27810any units. For example, @kbd{@w{u c} cm @key{RET} in @key{RET}}
27811converts the number 2 on the stack to 5.08.
4009494e
GM
27812
27813@kindex u b
27814@pindex calc-base-units
27815The @kbd{u b} (@code{calc-base-units}) command is shorthand for
27816@kbd{u c base}; it converts the units expression on the top of the
27817stack into @code{base} units. If @kbd{u s} does not simplify a
27818units expression as far as you would like, try @kbd{u b}.
27819
27820The @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u b} commands treat temperature units (like
27821@samp{degC} and @samp{K}) as relative temperatures. For example,
27822@kbd{u c} converts @samp{10 degC} to @samp{18 degF}: A change of 10
27823degrees Celsius corresponds to a change of 18 degrees Fahrenheit.
27824
27825@kindex u t
27826@pindex calc-convert-temperature
27827@cindex Temperature conversion
27828The @kbd{u t} (@code{calc-convert-temperature}) command converts
27829absolute temperatures. The value on the stack must be a simple units
27830expression with units of temperature only. This command would convert
27831@samp{10 degC} to @samp{50 degF}, the equivalent temperature on the
27832Fahrenheit scale.
27833
27834@kindex u r
27835@pindex calc-remove-units
27836@kindex u x
27837@pindex calc-extract-units
27838The @kbd{u r} (@code{calc-remove-units}) command removes units from the
27839formula at the top of the stack. The @kbd{u x}
27840(@code{calc-extract-units}) command extracts only the units portion of a
27841formula. These commands essentially replace every term of the formula
27842that does or doesn't (respectively) look like a unit name by the
27843constant 1, then resimplify the formula.
27844
27845@kindex u a
27846@pindex calc-autorange-units
27847The @kbd{u a} (@code{calc-autorange-units}) command turns on and off a
27848mode in which unit prefixes like @code{k} (``kilo'') are automatically
27849applied to keep the numeric part of a units expression in a reasonable
27850range. This mode affects @kbd{u s} and all units conversion commands
27851except @kbd{u b}. For example, with autoranging on, @samp{12345 Hz}
27852will be simplified to @samp{12.345 kHz}. Autoranging is useful for
27853some kinds of units (like @code{Hz} and @code{m}), but is probably
27854undesirable for non-metric units like @code{ft} and @code{tbsp}.
27855(Composite units are more appropriate for those; see above.)
27856
27857Autoranging always applies the prefix to the leftmost unit name.
27858Calc chooses the largest prefix that causes the number to be greater
27859than or equal to 1.0. Thus an increasing sequence of adjusted times
27860would be @samp{1 ms, 10 ms, 100 ms, 1 s, 10 s, 100 s, 1 ks}.
27861Generally the rule of thumb is that the number will be adjusted
27862to be in the interval @samp{[1 .. 1000)}, although there are several
27863exceptions to this rule. First, if the unit has a power then this
27864is not possible; @samp{0.1 s^2} simplifies to @samp{100000 ms^2}.
27865Second, the ``centi-'' prefix is allowed to form @code{cm} (centimeters),
27866but will not apply to other units. The ``deci-,'' ``deka-,'' and
27867``hecto-'' prefixes are never used. Thus the allowable interval is
27868@samp{[1 .. 10)} for millimeters and @samp{[1 .. 100)} for centimeters.
27869Finally, a prefix will not be added to a unit if the resulting name
27870is also the actual name of another unit; @samp{1e-15 t} would normally
27871be considered a ``femto-ton,'' but it is written as @samp{1000 at}
27872(1000 atto-tons) instead because @code{ft} would be confused with feet.
27873
27874@node The Units Table, Predefined Units, Basic Operations on Units, Units
27875@section The Units Table
27876
27877@noindent
27878@kindex u v
27879@pindex calc-enter-units-table
27880The @kbd{u v} (@code{calc-enter-units-table}) command displays the units table
27881in another buffer called @code{*Units Table*}. Each entry in this table
27882gives the unit name as it would appear in an expression, the definition
27883of the unit in terms of simpler units, and a full name or description of
27884the unit. Fundamental units are defined as themselves; these are the
27885units produced by the @kbd{u b} command. The fundamental units are
27886meters, seconds, grams, kelvins, amperes, candelas, moles, radians,
27887and steradians.
27888
27889The Units Table buffer also displays the Unit Prefix Table. Note that
27890two prefixes, ``kilo'' and ``hecto,'' accept either upper- or lower-case
27891prefix letters. @samp{Meg} is also accepted as a synonym for the @samp{M}
27892prefix. Whenever a unit name can be interpreted as either a built-in name
27893or a prefix followed by another built-in name, the former interpretation
27894wins. For example, @samp{2 pt} means two pints, not two pico-tons.
27895
27896The Units Table buffer, once created, is not rebuilt unless you define
27897new units. To force the buffer to be rebuilt, give any numeric prefix
27898argument to @kbd{u v}.
27899
27900@kindex u V
27901@pindex calc-view-units-table
27902The @kbd{u V} (@code{calc-view-units-table}) command is like @kbd{u v} except
27903that the cursor is not moved into the Units Table buffer. You can
27904type @kbd{u V} again to remove the Units Table from the display. To
27905return from the Units Table buffer after a @kbd{u v}, type @kbd{C-x * c}
27906again or use the regular Emacs @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window})
27907command. You can also kill the buffer with @kbd{C-x k} if you wish;
27908the actual units table is safely stored inside the Calculator.
27909
27910@kindex u g
27911@pindex calc-get-unit-definition
27912The @kbd{u g} (@code{calc-get-unit-definition}) command retrieves a unit's
27913defining expression and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. For example,
27914@kbd{u g in} will produce the expression @samp{2.54 cm}. This is the
27915same definition for the unit that would appear in the Units Table buffer.
27916Note that this command works only for actual unit names; @kbd{u g km}
27917will report that no such unit exists, for example, because @code{km} is
27918really the unit @code{m} with a @code{k} (``kilo'') prefix. To see a
27919definition of a unit in terms of base units, it is easier to push the
27920unit name on the stack and then reduce it to base units with @kbd{u b}.
27921
27922@kindex u e
27923@pindex calc-explain-units
27924The @kbd{u e} (@code{calc-explain-units}) command displays an English
27925description of the units of the expression on the stack. For example,
27926for the expression @samp{62 km^2 g / s^2 mol K}, the description is
27927``Square-Kilometer Gram per (Second-squared Mole Degree-Kelvin).'' This
27928command uses the English descriptions that appear in the righthand
27929column of the Units Table.
27930
27931@node Predefined Units, User-Defined Units, The Units Table, Units
27932@section Predefined Units
27933
27934@noindent
285f0d3a
JB
27935The definitions of many units have changed over the years. For example,
27936the meter was originally defined in 1791 as one ten-millionth of the
27937distance from the equator to the north pole. In order to be more
27938precise, the definition was adjusted several times, and now a meter is
27939defined as the distance that light will travel in a vacuum in
279401/299792458 of a second; consequently, the speed of light in a
27941vacuum is exactly 299792458 m/s. Many other units have been
27942redefined in terms of fundamental physical processes; a second, for
27943example, is currently defined as 9192631770 periods of a certain
27944radiation related to the cesium-133 atom. The only SI unit that is not
27945based on a fundamental physical process (although there are efforts to
27946change this) is the kilogram, which was originally defined as the mass
27947of one liter of water, but is now defined as the mass of the
27948International Prototype Kilogram (IPK), a cylinder of platinum-iridium
27949kept at the Bureau International des Poids et Mesures in S@`evres,
27950France. (There are several copies of the IPK throughout the world.)
27951The British imperial units, once defined in terms of physical objects,
27952were redefined in 1963 in terms of SI units. The US customary units,
27953which were the same as British units until the British imperial system
27954was created in 1824, were also defined in terms of the SI units in 1893.
27955Because of these redefinitions, conversions between metric, British
27956Imperial, and US customary units can often be done precisely.
27957
4009494e
GM
27958Since the exact definitions of many kinds of units have evolved over the
27959years, and since certain countries sometimes have local differences in
27960their definitions, it is a good idea to examine Calc's definition of a
27961unit before depending on its exact value. For example, there are three
27962different units for gallons, corresponding to the US (@code{gal}),
27963Canadian (@code{galC}), and British (@code{galUK}) definitions. Also,
27964note that @code{oz} is a standard ounce of mass, @code{ozt} is a Troy
27965ounce, and @code{ozfl} is a fluid ounce.
27966
27967The temperature units corresponding to degrees Kelvin and Centigrade
27968(Celsius) are the same in this table, since most units commands treat
27969temperatures as being relative. The @code{calc-convert-temperature}
27970command has special rules for handling the different absolute magnitudes
27971of the various temperature scales.
27972
27973The unit of volume ``liters'' can be referred to by either the lower-case
27974@code{l} or the upper-case @code{L}.
27975
27976The unit @code{A} stands for Amperes; the name @code{Ang} is used
27977@tex
27978for \AA ngstroms.
27979@end tex
27980@ifnottex
27981for Angstroms.
27982@end ifnottex
27983
27984The unit @code{pt} stands for pints; the name @code{point} stands for
27985a typographical point, defined by @samp{72 point = 1 in}. This is
27986slightly different than the point defined by the American Typefounder's
27987Association in 1886, but the point used by Calc has become standard
27988largely due to its use by the PostScript page description language.
27989There is also @code{texpt}, which stands for a printer's point as
27990defined by the @TeX{} typesetting system: @samp{72.27 texpt = 1 in}.
27991Other units used by @TeX{} are available; they are @code{texpc} (a pica),
27992@code{texbp} (a ``big point'', equal to a standard point which is larger
27993than the point used by @TeX{}), @code{texdd} (a Didot point),
27994@code{texcc} (a Cicero) and @code{texsp} (a scaled @TeX{} point,
27995all dimensions representable in @TeX{} are multiples of this value).
27996
1265829e
JB
27997When Calc is using the @TeX{} or La@TeX{} language mode (@pxref{TeX
27998and LaTeX Language Modes}), the @TeX{} specific unit names will not
27999use the @samp{tex} prefix; the unit name for a @TeX{} point will be
28000@samp{pt} instead of @samp{texpt}, for example. To avoid conflicts,
28001the unit names for pint and parsec will simply be @samp{pint} and
28002@samp{parsec} instead of @samp{pt} and @samp{pc}.
28003
28004
4009494e
GM
28005The unit @code{e} stands for the elementary (electron) unit of charge;
28006because algebra command could mistake this for the special constant
28007@expr{e}, Calc provides the alternate unit name @code{ech} which is
28008preferable to @code{e}.
28009
28010The name @code{g} stands for one gram of mass; there is also @code{gf},
28011one gram of force. (Likewise for @kbd{lb}, pounds, and @kbd{lbf}.)
28012Meanwhile, one ``@expr{g}'' of acceleration is denoted @code{ga}.
28013
28014The unit @code{ton} is a U.S. ton of @samp{2000 lb}, and @code{t} is
28015a metric ton of @samp{1000 kg}.
28016
28017The names @code{s} (or @code{sec}) and @code{min} refer to units of
28018time; @code{arcsec} and @code{arcmin} are units of angle.
28019
28020Some ``units'' are really physical constants; for example, @code{c}
28021represents the speed of light, and @code{h} represents Planck's
28022constant. You can use these just like other units: converting
28023@samp{.5 c} to @samp{m/s} expresses one-half the speed of light in
28024meters per second. You can also use this merely as a handy reference;
28025the @kbd{u g} command gets the definition of one of these constants
28026in its normal terms, and @kbd{u b} expresses the definition in base
28027units.
28028
28029Two units, @code{pi} and @code{alpha} (the fine structure constant,
28030approximately @mathit{1/137}) are dimensionless. The units simplification
28031commands simply treat these names as equivalent to their corresponding
28032values. However you can, for example, use @kbd{u c} to convert a pure
28033number into multiples of the fine structure constant, or @kbd{u b} to
28034convert this back into a pure number. (When @kbd{u c} prompts for the
28035``old units,'' just enter a blank line to signify that the value
28036really is unitless.)
28037
28038@c Describe angular units, luminosity vs. steradians problem.
28039
2e78df6b 28040@node User-Defined Units, Logarithmic Units, Predefined Units, Units
4009494e
GM
28041@section User-Defined Units
28042
28043@noindent
28044Calc provides ways to get quick access to your selected ``favorite''
28045units, as well as ways to define your own new units.
28046
28047@kindex u 0-9
28048@pindex calc-quick-units
28049@vindex Units
28050@cindex @code{Units} variable
28051@cindex Quick units
28052To select your favorite units, store a vector of unit names or
28053expressions in the Calc variable @code{Units}. The @kbd{u 1}
28054through @kbd{u 9} commands (@code{calc-quick-units}) provide access
28055to these units. If the value on the top of the stack is a plain
28056number (with no units attached), then @kbd{u 1} gives it the
28057specified units. (Basically, it multiplies the number by the
28058first item in the @code{Units} vector.) If the number on the
28059stack @emph{does} have units, then @kbd{u 1} converts that number
28060to the new units. For example, suppose the vector @samp{[in, ft]}
28061is stored in @code{Units}. Then @kbd{30 u 1} will create the
28062expression @samp{30 in}, and @kbd{u 2} will convert that expression
28063to @samp{2.5 ft}.
28064
28065The @kbd{u 0} command accesses the tenth element of @code{Units}.
28066Only ten quick units may be defined at a time. If the @code{Units}
28067variable has no stored value (the default), or if its value is not
28068a vector, then the quick-units commands will not function. The
28069@kbd{s U} command is a convenient way to edit the @code{Units}
28070variable; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
28071
28072@kindex u d
28073@pindex calc-define-unit
28074@cindex User-defined units
28075The @kbd{u d} (@code{calc-define-unit}) command records the units
28076expression on the top of the stack as the definition for a new,
28077user-defined unit. For example, putting @samp{16.5 ft} on the stack and
28078typing @kbd{u d rod} defines the new unit @samp{rod} to be equivalent to
2807916.5 feet. The unit conversion and simplification commands will now
28080treat @code{rod} just like any other unit of length. You will also be
28081prompted for an optional English description of the unit, which will
4043c194
JB
28082appear in the Units Table. If you wish the definition of this unit to
28083be displayed in a special way in the Units Table buffer (such as with an
28084asterisk to indicate an approximate value), then you can call this
28085command with an argument, @kbd{C-u u d}; you will then also be prompted
28086for a string that will be used to display the definition.
4009494e
GM
28087
28088@kindex u u
28089@pindex calc-undefine-unit
28090The @kbd{u u} (@code{calc-undefine-unit}) command removes a user-defined
28091unit. It is not possible to remove one of the predefined units,
28092however.
28093
28094If you define a unit with an existing unit name, your new definition
28095will replace the original definition of that unit. If the unit was a
28096predefined unit, the old definition will not be replaced, only
28097``shadowed.'' The built-in definition will reappear if you later use
28098@kbd{u u} to remove the shadowing definition.
28099
28100To create a new fundamental unit, use either 1 or the unit name itself
28101as the defining expression. Otherwise the expression can involve any
28102other units that you like (except for composite units like @samp{mfi}).
28103You can create a new composite unit with a sum of other units as the
28104defining expression. The next unit operation like @kbd{u c} or @kbd{u v}
28105will rebuild the internal unit table incorporating your modifications.
28106Note that erroneous definitions (such as two units defined in terms of
28107each other) will not be detected until the unit table is next rebuilt;
28108@kbd{u v} is a convenient way to force this to happen.
28109
28110Temperature units are treated specially inside the Calculator; it is not
28111possible to create user-defined temperature units.
28112
28113@kindex u p
28114@pindex calc-permanent-units
28115@cindex Calc init file, user-defined units
28116The @kbd{u p} (@code{calc-permanent-units}) command stores the user-defined
28117units in your Calc init file (the file given by the variable
dcf7843e 28118@code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), so that the
4009494e
GM
28119units will still be available in subsequent Emacs sessions. If there
28120was already a set of user-defined units in your Calc init file, it
28121is replaced by the new set. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to
28122tell Calc to use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28123
2e78df6b
JB
28124@node Logarithmic Units, , User-Defined Units, Units
28125@section Logarithmic Units
28126
28127The units @code{dB} (decibels) and @code{Np} (nepers) are logarithmic
28128units which are typically manipulated differently than standard units.
28129Calc provides commands to work with these logarithmic units.
28130
28131Decibels and nepers are used to measure power quantities as well as
28132field quantities (quantities whose squares are proportional to power).
28133The decibel and neper values of a quantity are relative to
28134a reference quantity; for example, the decibel value of a sound
28135pressure level of
28136@infoline @math{60 uPa}
28137@texline @math{60 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28138relative to
28139@infoline @math{20 uPa}
28140@texline @math{20 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28141(the threshhold of human hearing) is
28142@infoline @math{20 log10(60 uPa/ 20 uPa) dB = 20 log10(3) dB},
28143@texline @math{20 \log_{10}(60 \mu{\rm Pa}/20 \mu{\rm Pa}) {\rm dB} =
2814420 \log_{10}(3) {\rm dB}},
28145which is about
28146@infoline @math{9.54 dB}.
28147@texline @math{9.54 {\rm dB}}.
28148Note that in taking the ratio, the original units cancel and so these
28149logarithmic units are dimensionless.
28150
28151@vindex calc-logunits-power-reference
28152@vindex calc-logunits-field-reference
28153The Calc commands for the logarithmic units assume that power quantities
28154are being used unless the @kbd{H} prefix is used, in which case they assume that
28155field quantities are being used. For power quantities, Calc uses
28156@infoline @math{1 mW}
28157@texline @math{1 {\rm mW}}
28158as the default reference quantity; this default can be changed by changing
28159the value of the customizable variable
28160@code{calc-logunits-power-reference} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
28161For field quantities, Calc uses
28162@infoline @math{20 uPa}
28163@texline @math{20 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28164as the default reference quantity; this is the value used in acoustics
28165which is where decibels are commonly encountered. This default can be
28166changed by changing the value of the customizable variable
28167@code{calc-logunits-field-reference} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}). A
28168non-default reference quantity will be read from the stack if the
28169capital @kbd{O} prefix is used.
28170
28171The decibel level of a power
28172@infoline @math{P1},
28173@texline @math{P_1},
28174relative to a reference power
28175@infoline @math{P0},
28176@texline @math{P_0},
28177is defined to be
28178@infoline @math{10 log10(P1/P0) dB}.
28179@texline @math{10 \log_{10}(P_{1}/P_{0}) {\rm dB}}.
28180(The factor of 10 is because a decibel, as its name implies, is
28181one-tenth of a bel. The bel, named after Alexander Graham Bell, was
28182considered to be too large of a unit and was effectively replaced by
28183the decibel.) If @math{F} is a field quantity with power
28184@math{P=k F^2}, then a reference quantity of
28185@infoline @math{F0}
28186@texline @math{F_0}
28187would correspond to a power of
28188@infoline @math{P0=k F0^2}.
28189@texline @math{P_{0}=kF_{0}^2}.
28190If
28191@infoline @math{P1=k F1^2},
28192@texline @math{P_{1}=kF_{1}^2},
28193then
28194
28195@ifnottex
28196@example
2819710 log10(P1/P0) = 10 log10(F1^2/F0^2) = 20 log10(F1/F0).
28198@end example
28199@end ifnottex
28200@tex
28201$$ 10 \log_{10}(P_1/P_0) = 10 \log_{10}(F_1^2/F_0^2) = 20
28202\log_{10}(F_1/F_0)$$
28203@end tex
28204
28205@noindent
28206In order to get the same decibel level regardless of whether a field
28207quantity or the corresponding power quantity is used, the decibel
28208level of a field quantity
28209@infoline @math{F1},
28210@texline @math{F_1},
28211relative to a reference
28212@infoline @math{F0},
28213@texline @math{F_0},
28214is defined as
28215@infoline @math{20 log10(F1/F0) dB}.
28216@texline @math{20 \log_{10}(F_{1}/F_{0}) {\rm dB}}.
28217
28218Nepers (named after John Napier, who is credited with inventing the
28219logarithm) are similar to bels except they use natural logarithms instead
28220of common logarithms. The neper level of a power
28221@infoline @math{P1},
28222@texline @math{P_1},
28223relative to a reference power
28224@infoline @math{P0},
28225@texline @math{P_0},
28226is
28227@infoline @math{(1/2) ln(P1/P0) Np}.
28228@texline @math{(1/2) \ln(P_1/P_0) {\rm Np}}.
28229The neper level of a field
28230@infoline @math{F1},
28231@texline @math{F_1},
28232relative to a reference field
28233@infoline @math{F0},
28234@texline @math{F_0},
28235is
28236@infoline @math{ln(F1/F0) Np}.
28237@texline @math{\ln(F_1/F_0) {\rm Np}}.
28238
28239@kindex l q
28240@pindex calc-logunits-quantity
28241@tindex powerquant
28242@tindex fieldquant
28243The @kbd{l q} (@code{calc-logunits-quantity}) [@code{powerquant}]
28244command computes the power quantity corresponding to a given number of
28245logarithmic units. With the capital @kbd{O} prefix, @kbd{O l q}, the
28246reference level will be read from the top of the stack. (In an
28247algebraic formula, @code{powerquant} can be given an optional second
28248argument which will be used for the reference level.) For example,
28249@code{20 dB @key{RET} l q} will return @code{100 mW};
28250@code{20 dB @key{RET} 4 W @key{RET} O l q} will return @code{400 W}.
28251The @kbd{H l q} [@code{fieldquant}] command behaves like @kbd{l q} but
28252computes field quantities instead of power quantities.
28253
28254@kindex l d
28255@pindex calc-logunits-dblevel
28256@tindex dbpowerlevel
28257@tindex dbfieldlevel
28258@kindex l n
28259@pindex calc-logunits-nplevel
28260@tindex nppowerlevel
28261@tindex npfieldlevel
28262The @kbd{l d} (@code{calc-logunits-dblevel}) [@code{dbpowerlevel}]
28263command will compute the decibel level of a power quantity using the
28264default reference level; @kbd{H l d} [@code{dbfieldlevel}] will
28265compute the decibel level of a field quantity. The commands @kbd{l n}
28266(@code{calc-logunits-nplevel}) [@code{nppowerlevel}] and @kbd{H l n}
28267[@code{npfieldlevel}] will similarly compute neper levels. With the
28268capital @kbd{O} prefix these commands will read a reference level
28269from the stack; in an algebraic formula the reference level can be
28270given as an optional second argument.
28271
28272@kindex l +
28273@pindex calc-logunits-add
28274@tindex lupoweradd
28275@tindex lufieldadd
28276@kindex l -
28277@pindex calc-logunits-sub
28278@tindex lupowersub
28279@tindex lufieldsub
28280@kindex l *
28281@pindex calc-logunits-mul
28282@tindex lupowermul
28283@tindex lufieldmul
28284@kindex l /
28285@pindex calc-logunits-div
28286@tindex lupowerdiv
28287@tindex lufielddiv
28288The sum of two power or field quantities doesn't correspond to the sum
28289of the corresponding decibel or neper levels. If the powers
28290corresponding to decibel levels
28291@infoline @math{D1}
28292@texline @math{D_1}
28293and
28294@infoline @math{D2}
28295@texline @math{D_2}
28296are added, the corresponding decibel level ``sum'' will be
28297
28298@ifnottex
28299@example
28300 10 log10(10^(D1/10) + 10^(D2/10)) dB.
28301@end example
28302@end ifnottex
28303@tex
28304$$ 10 \log_{10}(10^{D_1/10} + 10^{D_2/10}) {\rm dB}.$$
28305@end tex
28306
28307@noindent
28308When field quantities are combined, it often means the
28309corresponding powers are added and so the above formula might be used.
28310In acoustics, for example, the decibel sound pressure level is defined
28311using the field formula but the sound pressure levels are combined
28312as the sound power levels, and so the above formula should be used. If
28313two field quantities themselves are added, the new decibel level will be
28314
28315
28316@ifnottex
28317@example
28318 20 log10(10^(D1/20) + 10^(D2/20)) dB.
28319@end example
28320@end ifnottex
28321@tex
28322$$ 20 \log_{10}(10^{D_1/20} + 10^{D_2/20}) {\rm dB}.$$
28323@end tex
28324
28325@noindent
28326If the power corresponding to @math{D} dB is multiplied by a number @math{N},
28327then the corresponding decibel level will be
28328
28329@ifnottex
28330@example
28331 D + 10 log10(N) dB,
28332@end example
28333@end ifnottex
28334@tex
28335$$ D + 10 \log_{10}(N) {\rm dB},$$
28336@end tex
28337
28338@noindent
28339if a field quantity is multiplied by @math{N} the corresponding decibel level
28340will be
28341
28342@ifnottex
28343@example
28344 D + 20 log10(N) dB.
28345@end example
28346@end ifnottex
28347@tex
28348$$ D + 20 \log_{10}(N) {\rm dB}.$$
28349@end tex
28350
28351@noindent
28352There are similar formulas for combining nepers.
28353The @kbd{l +} (@code{calc-logunits-add}) [@code{lupoweradd}] command
28354will ``add'' two logarithmic unit power levels this way; with the
28355@kbd{H} prefix, @kbd{H l +} [@code{lufieldadd}] will add logarithmic
28356unit field levels. Similarly, logarithmic units can be
28357``subtracted'' with @kbd{l -} (@code{calc-logunits-sub})
28358[@code{lupowersub}] or @kbd{H l -} [@code{lufieldsub}].
28359The @kbd{l *} (@code{calc-logunits-mul}) [@code{lupowermul}]
28360and @kbd{H l *} [@code{lufieldmul}] commands will ``multiply''
28361a logarithmic unit by a number; the @kbd{l /}
28362(@code{calc-logunits-divide}) [@code{lupowerdiv}] and
28363@kbd{H l /} [@code{lufielddiv}] commands will ``divide'' a
28364logarithmic unit by a number. Note that the reference quantities don't
28365play a role in this arithmetic.
28366
4009494e
GM
28367@node Store and Recall, Graphics, Units, Top
28368@chapter Storing and Recalling
28369
28370@noindent
28371Calculator variables are really just Lisp variables that contain numbers
28372or formulas in a form that Calc can understand. The commands in this
28373section allow you to manipulate variables conveniently. Commands related
28374to variables use the @kbd{s} prefix key.
28375
28376@menu
28377* Storing Variables::
28378* Recalling Variables::
28379* Operations on Variables::
28380* Let Command::
28381* Evaluates-To Operator::
28382@end menu
28383
28384@node Storing Variables, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall, Store and Recall
28385@section Storing Variables
28386
28387@noindent
28388@kindex s s
28389@pindex calc-store
28390@cindex Storing variables
28391@cindex Quick variables
28392@vindex q0
28393@vindex q9
28394The @kbd{s s} (@code{calc-store}) command stores the value at the top of
28395the stack into a specified variable. It prompts you to enter the
28396name of the variable. If you press a single digit, the value is stored
28397immediately in one of the ``quick'' variables @code{q0} through
28398@code{q9}. Or you can enter any variable name.
28399
28400@kindex s t
28401@pindex calc-store-into
28402The @kbd{s s} command leaves the stored value on the stack. There is
28403also an @kbd{s t} (@code{calc-store-into}) command, which removes a
28404value from the stack and stores it in a variable.
28405
28406If the top of stack value is an equation @samp{a = 7} or assignment
28407@samp{a := 7} with a variable on the lefthand side, then Calc will
28408assign that variable with that value by default, i.e., if you type
28409@kbd{s s @key{RET}} or @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. In this example, the
28410value 7 would be stored in the variable @samp{a}. (If you do type
28411a variable name at the prompt, the top-of-stack value is stored in
28412its entirety, even if it is an equation: @samp{s s b @key{RET}}
28413with @samp{a := 7} on the stack stores @samp{a := 7} in @code{b}.)
28414
28415In fact, the top of stack value can be a vector of equations or
28416assignments with different variables on their lefthand sides; the
28417default will be to store all the variables with their corresponding
28418righthand sides simultaneously.
28419
28420It is also possible to type an equation or assignment directly at
28421the prompt for the @kbd{s s} or @kbd{s t} command: @kbd{s s foo = 7}.
28422In this case the expression to the right of the @kbd{=} or @kbd{:=}
28423symbol is evaluated as if by the @kbd{=} command, and that value is
28424stored in the variable. No value is taken from the stack; @kbd{s s}
28425and @kbd{s t} are equivalent when used in this way.
28426
28427@kindex s 0-9
28428@kindex t 0-9
28429The prefix keys @kbd{s} and @kbd{t} may be followed immediately by a
28430digit; @kbd{s 9} is equivalent to @kbd{s s 9}, and @kbd{t 9} is
28431equivalent to @kbd{s t 9}. (The @kbd{t} prefix is otherwise used
28432for trail and time/date commands.)
28433
28434@kindex s +
28435@kindex s -
28436@ignore
28437@mindex @idots
28438@end ignore
28439@kindex s *
28440@ignore
28441@mindex @null
28442@end ignore
28443@kindex s /
28444@ignore
28445@mindex @null
28446@end ignore
28447@kindex s ^
28448@ignore
28449@mindex @null
28450@end ignore
28451@kindex s |
28452@ignore
28453@mindex @null
28454@end ignore
28455@kindex s n
28456@ignore
28457@mindex @null
28458@end ignore
28459@kindex s &
28460@ignore
28461@mindex @null
28462@end ignore
28463@kindex s [
28464@ignore
28465@mindex @null
28466@end ignore
28467@kindex s ]
28468@pindex calc-store-plus
28469@pindex calc-store-minus
28470@pindex calc-store-times
28471@pindex calc-store-div
28472@pindex calc-store-power
28473@pindex calc-store-concat
28474@pindex calc-store-neg
28475@pindex calc-store-inv
28476@pindex calc-store-decr
28477@pindex calc-store-incr
28478There are also several ``arithmetic store'' commands. For example,
28479@kbd{s +} removes a value from the stack and adds it to the specified
28480variable. The other arithmetic stores are @kbd{s -}, @kbd{s *}, @kbd{s /},
28481@kbd{s ^}, and @w{@kbd{s |}} (vector concatenation), plus @kbd{s n} and
28482@kbd{s &} which negate or invert the value in a variable, and @w{@kbd{s [}}
28483and @kbd{s ]} which decrease or increase a variable by one.
28484
28485All the arithmetic stores accept the Inverse prefix to reverse the
28486order of the operands. If @expr{v} represents the contents of the
28487variable, and @expr{a} is the value drawn from the stack, then regular
28488@w{@kbd{s -}} assigns
28489@texline @math{v \coloneq v - a},
28490@infoline @expr{v := v - a},
28491but @kbd{I s -} assigns
28492@texline @math{v \coloneq a - v}.
28493@infoline @expr{v := a - v}.
28494While @kbd{I s *} might seem pointless, it is
28495useful if matrix multiplication is involved. Actually, all the
28496arithmetic stores use formulas designed to behave usefully both
28497forwards and backwards:
28498
28499@example
28500@group
28501s + v := v + a v := a + v
28502s - v := v - a v := a - v
28503s * v := v * a v := a * v
28504s / v := v / a v := a / v
28505s ^ v := v ^ a v := a ^ v
28506s | v := v | a v := a | v
28507s n v := v / (-1) v := (-1) / v
28508s & v := v ^ (-1) v := (-1) ^ v
28509s [ v := v - 1 v := 1 - v
28510s ] v := v - (-1) v := (-1) - v
28511@end group
28512@end example
28513
28514In the last four cases, a numeric prefix argument will be used in
28515place of the number one. (For example, @kbd{M-2 s ]} increases
28516a variable by 2, and @kbd{M-2 I s ]} replaces a variable by
28517minus-two minus the variable.
28518
28519The first six arithmetic stores can also be typed @kbd{s t +}, @kbd{s t -},
28520etc. The commands @kbd{s s +}, @kbd{s s -}, and so on are analogous
28521arithmetic stores that don't remove the value @expr{a} from the stack.
28522
28523All arithmetic stores report the new value of the variable in the
28524Trail for your information. They signal an error if the variable
28525previously had no stored value. If default simplifications have been
28526turned off, the arithmetic stores temporarily turn them on for numeric
28527arguments only (i.e., they temporarily do an @kbd{m N} command).
28528@xref{Simplification Modes}. Large vectors put in the trail by
28529these commands always use abbreviated (@kbd{t .}) mode.
28530
28531@kindex s m
28532@pindex calc-store-map
28533The @kbd{s m} command is a general way to adjust a variable's value
28534using any Calc function. It is a ``mapping'' command analogous to
28535@kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R}, etc. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, to see
28536how to specify a function for a mapping command. Basically,
28537all you do is type the Calc command key that would invoke that
28538function normally. For example, @kbd{s m n} applies the @kbd{n}
28539key to negate the contents of the variable, so @kbd{s m n} is
28540equivalent to @kbd{s n}. Also, @kbd{s m Q} takes the square root
28541of the value stored in a variable, @kbd{s m v v} uses @kbd{v v} to
28542reverse the vector stored in the variable, and @kbd{s m H I S}
28543takes the hyperbolic arcsine of the variable contents.
28544
28545If the mapping function takes two or more arguments, the additional
28546arguments are taken from the stack; the old value of the variable
28547is provided as the first argument. Thus @kbd{s m -} with @expr{a}
28548on the stack computes @expr{v - a}, just like @kbd{s -}. With the
28549Inverse prefix, the variable's original value becomes the @emph{last}
28550argument instead of the first. Thus @kbd{I s m -} is also
28551equivalent to @kbd{I s -}.
28552
28553@kindex s x
28554@pindex calc-store-exchange
28555The @kbd{s x} (@code{calc-store-exchange}) command exchanges the value
28556of a variable with the value on the top of the stack. Naturally, the
28557variable must already have a stored value for this to work.
28558
28559You can type an equation or assignment at the @kbd{s x} prompt. The
28560command @kbd{s x a=6} takes no values from the stack; instead, it
28561pushes the old value of @samp{a} on the stack and stores @samp{a = 6}.
28562
28563@kindex s u
28564@pindex calc-unstore
28565@cindex Void variables
28566@cindex Un-storing variables
28567Until you store something in them, most variables are ``void,'' that is,
28568they contain no value at all. If they appear in an algebraic formula
28569they will be left alone even if you press @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
28570The @kbd{s u} (@code{calc-unstore}) command returns a variable to the
28571void state.
28572
28573@kindex s c
28574@pindex calc-copy-variable
28575The @kbd{s c} (@code{calc-copy-variable}) command copies the stored
28576value of one variable to another. One way it differs from a simple
28577@kbd{s r} followed by an @kbd{s t} (aside from saving keystrokes) is
28578that the value never goes on the stack and thus is never rounded,
28579evaluated, or simplified in any way; it is not even rounded down to the
28580current precision.
28581
28582The only variables with predefined values are the ``special constants''
28583@code{pi}, @code{e}, @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}. You are free
28584to unstore these variables or to store new values into them if you like,
28585although some of the algebraic-manipulation functions may assume these
28586variables represent their standard values. Calc displays a warning if
28587you change the value of one of these variables, or of one of the other
28588special variables @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} (which are
28589normally void).
28590
28591Note that @code{pi} doesn't actually have 3.14159265359 stored in it,
28592but rather a special magic value that evaluates to @cpi{} at the current
28593precision. Likewise @code{e}, @code{i}, and @code{phi} evaluate
28594according to the current precision or polar mode. If you recall a value
28595from @code{pi} and store it back, this magic property will be lost. The
28596magic property is preserved, however, when a variable is copied with
28597@kbd{s c}.
28598
28599@kindex s k
28600@pindex calc-copy-special-constant
28601If one of the ``special constants'' is redefined (or undefined) so that
28602it no longer has its magic property, the property can be restored with
28603@kbd{s k} (@code{calc-copy-special-constant}). This command will prompt
28604for a special constant and a variable to store it in, and so a special
28605constant can be stored in any variable. Here, the special constant that
28606you enter doesn't depend on the value of the corresponding variable;
28607@code{pi} will represent 3.14159@dots{} regardless of what is currently
28608stored in the Calc variable @code{pi}. If one of the other special
28609variables, @code{inf}, @code{uinf} or @code{nan}, is given a value, its
28610original behavior can be restored by voiding it with @kbd{s u}.
28611
28612@node Recalling Variables, Operations on Variables, Storing Variables, Store and Recall
28613@section Recalling Variables
28614
28615@noindent
28616@kindex s r
28617@pindex calc-recall
28618@cindex Recalling variables
28619The most straightforward way to extract the stored value from a variable
28620is to use the @kbd{s r} (@code{calc-recall}) command. This command prompts
28621for a variable name (similarly to @code{calc-store}), looks up the value
28622of the specified variable, and pushes that value onto the stack. It is
28623an error to try to recall a void variable.
28624
28625It is also possible to recall the value from a variable by evaluating a
28626formula containing that variable. For example, @kbd{' a @key{RET} =} is
28627the same as @kbd{s r a @key{RET}} except that if the variable is void, the
28628former will simply leave the formula @samp{a} on the stack whereas the
28629latter will produce an error message.
28630
28631@kindex r 0-9
28632The @kbd{r} prefix may be followed by a digit, so that @kbd{r 9} is
538c2573 28633equivalent to @kbd{s r 9}.
4009494e
GM
28634
28635@node Operations on Variables, Let Command, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall
28636@section Other Operations on Variables
28637
28638@noindent
28639@kindex s e
28640@pindex calc-edit-variable
28641The @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command edits the stored
28642value of a variable without ever putting that value on the stack
28643or simplifying or evaluating the value. It prompts for the name of
28644the variable to edit. If the variable has no stored value, the
28645editing buffer will start out empty. If the editing buffer is
28646empty when you press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish, the variable will
28647be made void. @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, for a general
28648description of editing.
28649
28650The @kbd{s e} command is especially useful for creating and editing
28651rewrite rules which are stored in variables. Sometimes these rules
28652contain formulas which must not be evaluated until the rules are
28653actually used. (For example, they may refer to @samp{deriv(x,y)},
28654where @code{x} will someday become some expression involving @code{y};
28655if you let Calc evaluate the rule while you are defining it, Calc will
28656replace @samp{deriv(x,y)} with 0 because the formula @code{x} does
28657not itself refer to @code{y}.) By contrast, recalling the variable,
28658editing with @kbd{`}, and storing will evaluate the variable's value
28659as a side effect of putting the value on the stack.
28660
28661@kindex s A
28662@kindex s D
28663@ignore
28664@mindex @idots
28665@end ignore
28666@kindex s E
28667@ignore
28668@mindex @null
28669@end ignore
28670@kindex s F
28671@ignore
28672@mindex @null
28673@end ignore
28674@kindex s G
28675@ignore
28676@mindex @null
28677@end ignore
28678@kindex s H
28679@ignore
28680@mindex @null
28681@end ignore
28682@kindex s I
28683@ignore
28684@mindex @null
28685@end ignore
28686@kindex s L
28687@ignore
28688@mindex @null
28689@end ignore
28690@kindex s P
28691@ignore
28692@mindex @null
28693@end ignore
28694@kindex s R
28695@ignore
28696@mindex @null
28697@end ignore
28698@kindex s T
28699@ignore
28700@mindex @null
28701@end ignore
28702@kindex s U
28703@ignore
28704@mindex @null
28705@end ignore
28706@kindex s X
28707@pindex calc-store-AlgSimpRules
28708@pindex calc-store-Decls
28709@pindex calc-store-EvalRules
28710@pindex calc-store-FitRules
28711@pindex calc-store-GenCount
28712@pindex calc-store-Holidays
28713@pindex calc-store-IntegLimit
28714@pindex calc-store-LineStyles
28715@pindex calc-store-PointStyles
28716@pindex calc-store-PlotRejects
28717@pindex calc-store-TimeZone
28718@pindex calc-store-Units
28719@pindex calc-store-ExtSimpRules
28720There are several special-purpose variable-editing commands that
28721use the @kbd{s} prefix followed by a shifted letter:
28722
28723@table @kbd
28724@item s A
28725Edit @code{AlgSimpRules}. @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
28726@item s D
28727Edit @code{Decls}. @xref{Declarations}.
28728@item s E
28729Edit @code{EvalRules}. @xref{Default Simplifications}.
28730@item s F
28731Edit @code{FitRules}. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
28732@item s G
28733Edit @code{GenCount}. @xref{Solving Equations}.
28734@item s H
28735Edit @code{Holidays}. @xref{Business Days}.
28736@item s I
28737Edit @code{IntegLimit}. @xref{Calculus}.
28738@item s L
28739Edit @code{LineStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28740@item s P
28741Edit @code{PointStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28742@item s R
28743Edit @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Graphics}.
28744@item s T
28745Edit @code{TimeZone}. @xref{Time Zones}.
28746@item s U
28747Edit @code{Units}. @xref{User-Defined Units}.
28748@item s X
28749Edit @code{ExtSimpRules}. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
28750@end table
28751
28752These commands are just versions of @kbd{s e} that use fixed variable
28753names rather than prompting for the variable name.
28754
28755@kindex s p
28756@pindex calc-permanent-variable
28757@cindex Storing variables
28758@cindex Permanent variables
28759@cindex Calc init file, variables
28760The @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command saves a
28761variable's value permanently in your Calc init file (the file given by
dcf7843e 28762the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), so
4009494e
GM
28763that its value will still be available in future Emacs sessions. You
28764can re-execute @w{@kbd{s p}} later on to update the saved value, but the
28765only way to remove a saved variable is to edit your calc init file
28766by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
28767use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28768
28769If you do not specify the name of a variable to save (i.e.,
28770@kbd{s p @key{RET}}), all Calc variables with defined values
28771are saved except for the special constants @code{pi}, @code{e},
28772@code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}; the variables @code{TimeZone}
28773and @code{PlotRejects};
28774@code{FitRules}, @code{DistribRules}, and other built-in rewrite
28775rules; and @code{PlotData@var{n}} variables generated
28776by the graphics commands. (You can still save these variables by
28777explicitly naming them in an @kbd{s p} command.)
28778
28779@kindex s i
28780@pindex calc-insert-variables
28781The @kbd{s i} (@code{calc-insert-variables}) command writes
28782the values of all Calc variables into a specified buffer.
28783The variables are written with the prefix @code{var-} in the form of
28784Lisp @code{setq} commands
28785which store the values in string form. You can place these commands
28786in your Calc init file (or @file{.emacs}) if you wish, though in this case it
28787would be easier to use @kbd{s p @key{RET}}. (Note that @kbd{s i}
28788omits the same set of variables as @w{@kbd{s p @key{RET}}}; the difference
28789is that @kbd{s i} will store the variables in any buffer, and it also
28790stores in a more human-readable format.)
28791
28792@node Let Command, Evaluates-To Operator, Operations on Variables, Store and Recall
28793@section The Let Command
28794
28795@noindent
28796@kindex s l
28797@pindex calc-let
28798@cindex Variables, temporary assignment
28799@cindex Temporary assignment to variables
28800If you have an expression like @samp{a+b^2} on the stack and you wish to
28801compute its value where @expr{b=3}, you can simply store 3 in @expr{b} and
28802then press @kbd{=} to reevaluate the formula. This has the side-effect
28803of leaving the stored value of 3 in @expr{b} for future operations.
28804
28805The @kbd{s l} (@code{calc-let}) command evaluates a formula under a
28806@emph{temporary} assignment of a variable. It stores the value on the
28807top of the stack into the specified variable, then evaluates the
28808second-to-top stack entry, then restores the original value (or lack of one)
28809in the variable. Thus after @kbd{'@w{ }a+b^2 @key{RET} 3 s l b @key{RET}},
28810the stack will contain the formula @samp{a + 9}. The subsequent command
28811@kbd{@w{5 s l a} @key{RET}} will replace this formula with the number 14.
28812The variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} are not permanently affected in any way
28813by these commands.
28814
28815The value on the top of the stack may be an equation or assignment, or
28816a vector of equations or assignments, in which case the default will be
28817analogous to the case of @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
28818
28819Also, you can answer the variable-name prompt with an equation or
28820assignment: @kbd{s l b=3 @key{RET}} is the same as storing 3 on the stack
28821and typing @kbd{s l b @key{RET}}.
28822
28823The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) command is another way to substitute
28824a variable with a value in a formula. It does an actual substitution
28825rather than temporarily assigning the variable and evaluating. For
28826example, letting @expr{n=2} in @samp{f(n pi)} with @kbd{a b} will
28827produce @samp{f(2 pi)}, whereas @kbd{s l} would give @samp{f(6.28)}
28828since the evaluation step will also evaluate @code{pi}.
28829
28830@node Evaluates-To Operator, , Let Command, Store and Recall
28831@section The Evaluates-To Operator
28832
28833@noindent
28834@tindex evalto
28835@tindex =>
28836@cindex Evaluates-to operator
28837@cindex @samp{=>} operator
28838The special algebraic symbol @samp{=>} is known as the @dfn{evaluates-to
28839operator}. (It will show up as an @code{evalto} function call in
28840other language modes like Pascal and La@TeX{}.) This is a binary
28841operator, that is, it has a lefthand and a righthand argument,
28842although it can be entered with the righthand argument omitted.
28843
28844A formula like @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}} is evaluated by Calc as
28845follows: First, @var{a} is not simplified or modified in any
28846way. The previous value of argument @var{b} is thrown away; the
28847formula @var{a} is then copied and evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
28848command according to all current modes and stored variable values,
28849and the result is installed as the new value of @var{b}.
28850
28851For example, suppose you enter the algebraic formula @samp{2 + 3 => 17}.
28852The number 17 is ignored, and the lefthand argument is left in its
28853unevaluated form; the result is the formula @samp{2 + 3 => 5}.
28854
28855@kindex s =
28856@pindex calc-evalto
28857You can enter an @samp{=>} formula either directly using algebraic
28858entry (in which case the righthand side may be omitted since it is
28859going to be replaced right away anyhow), or by using the @kbd{s =}
28860(@code{calc-evalto}) command, which takes @var{a} from the stack
28861and replaces it with @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}}.
28862
28863Calc keeps track of all @samp{=>} operators on the stack, and
28864recomputes them whenever anything changes that might affect their
28865values, i.e., a mode setting or variable value. This occurs only
28866if the @samp{=>} operator is at the top level of the formula, or
28867if it is part of a top-level vector. In other words, pushing
28868@samp{2 + (a => 17)} will change the 17 to the actual value of
28869@samp{a} when you enter the formula, but the result will not be
28870dynamically updated when @samp{a} is changed later because the
28871@samp{=>} operator is buried inside a sum. However, a vector
28872of @samp{=>} operators will be recomputed, since it is convenient
28873to push a vector like @samp{[a =>, b =>, c =>]} on the stack to
28874make a concise display of all the variables in your problem.
28875(Another way to do this would be to use @samp{[a, b, c] =>},
28876which provides a slightly different format of display. You
28877can use whichever you find easiest to read.)
28878
28879@kindex m C
28880@pindex calc-auto-recompute
28881The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command allows you to
28882turn this automatic recomputation on or off. If you turn
28883recomputation off, you must explicitly recompute an @samp{=>}
28884operator on the stack in one of the usual ways, such as by
28885pressing @kbd{=}. Turning recomputation off temporarily can save
28886a lot of time if you will be changing several modes or variables
28887before you look at the @samp{=>} entries again.
28888
28889Most commands are not especially useful with @samp{=>} operators
28890as arguments. For example, given @samp{x + 2 => 17}, it won't
28891work to type @kbd{1 +} to get @samp{x + 3 => 18}. If you want
28892to operate on the lefthand side of the @samp{=>} operator on
28893the top of the stack, type @kbd{j 1} (that's the digit ``one'')
28894to select the lefthand side, execute your commands, then type
28895@kbd{j u} to unselect.
28896
28897All current modes apply when an @samp{=>} operator is computed,
28898including the current simplification mode. Recall that the
28899formula @samp{x + y + x} is not handled by Calc's default
28900simplifications, but the @kbd{a s} command will reduce it to
28901the simpler form @samp{y + 2 x}. You can also type @kbd{m A}
28902to enable an Algebraic Simplification mode in which the
28903equivalent of @kbd{a s} is used on all of Calc's results.
28904If you enter @samp{x + y + x =>} normally, the result will
28905be @samp{x + y + x => x + y + x}. If you change to
28906Algebraic Simplification mode, the result will be
28907@samp{x + y + x => y + 2 x}. However, just pressing @kbd{a s}
28908once will have no effect on @samp{x + y + x => x + y + x},
28909because the righthand side depends only on the lefthand side
28910and the current mode settings, and the lefthand side is not
28911affected by commands like @kbd{a s}.
28912
28913The ``let'' command (@kbd{s l}) has an interesting interaction
28914with the @samp{=>} operator. The @kbd{s l} command evaluates the
28915second-to-top stack entry with the top stack entry supplying
28916a temporary value for a given variable. As you might expect,
28917if that stack entry is an @samp{=>} operator its righthand
28918side will temporarily show this value for the variable. In
28919fact, all @samp{=>}s on the stack will be updated if they refer
28920to that variable. But this change is temporary in the sense
28921that the next command that causes Calc to look at those stack
28922entries will make them revert to the old variable value.
28923
28924@smallexample
28925@group
289262: a => a 2: a => 17 2: a => a
289271: a + 1 => a + 1 1: a + 1 => 18 1: a + 1 => a + 1
28928 . . .
28929
28930 17 s l a @key{RET} p 8 @key{RET}
28931@end group
28932@end smallexample
28933
28934Here the @kbd{p 8} command changes the current precision,
28935thus causing the @samp{=>} forms to be recomputed after the
28936influence of the ``let'' is gone. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command
28937(@code{calc-refresh}) is a handy way to force the @samp{=>}
28938operators on the stack to be recomputed without any other
28939side effects.
28940
28941@kindex s :
28942@pindex calc-assign
28943@tindex assign
28944@tindex :=
28945Embedded mode also uses @samp{=>} operators. In Embedded mode,
28946the lefthand side of an @samp{=>} operator can refer to variables
28947assigned elsewhere in the file by @samp{:=} operators. The
28948assignment operator @samp{a := 17} does not actually do anything
28949by itself. But Embedded mode recognizes it and marks it as a sort
28950of file-local definition of the variable. You can enter @samp{:=}
28951operators in Algebraic mode, or by using the @kbd{s :}
28952(@code{calc-assign}) [@code{assign}] command which takes a variable
28953and value from the stack and replaces them with an assignment.
28954
28955@xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for the way @samp{=>} appears in
28956@TeX{} language output. The @dfn{eqn} mode gives similar
28957treatment to @samp{=>}.
28958
28959@node Graphics, Kill and Yank, Store and Recall, Top
28960@chapter Graphics
28961
28962@noindent
28963The commands for graphing data begin with the @kbd{g} prefix key. Calc
28964uses GNUPLOT 2.0 or later to do graphics. These commands will only work
28965if GNUPLOT is available on your system. (While GNUPLOT sounds like
28966a relative of GNU Emacs, it is actually completely unrelated.
28967However, it is free software. It can be obtained from
28968@samp{http://www.gnuplot.info}.)
28969
28970@vindex calc-gnuplot-name
28971If you have GNUPLOT installed on your system but Calc is unable to
66783bb4
EZ
28972find it, you may need to set the @code{calc-gnuplot-name} variable in
28973your Calc init file or @file{.emacs}. You may also need to set some
28974Lisp variables to show Calc how to run GNUPLOT on your system; these
28975are described under @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} below. If you are using
28976the X window system or MS-Windows, Calc will configure GNUPLOT for you
28977automatically. If you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later and you are using a
28978Unix or GNU system without X, Calc will configure GNUPLOT to display
28979graphs using simple character graphics that will work on any
28980Posix-compatible terminal.
4009494e
GM
28981
28982@menu
28983* Basic Graphics::
28984* Three Dimensional Graphics::
28985* Managing Curves::
28986* Graphics Options::
28987* Devices::
28988@end menu
28989
28990@node Basic Graphics, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics, Graphics
28991@section Basic Graphics
28992
28993@noindent
28994@kindex g f
28995@pindex calc-graph-fast
28996The easiest graphics command is @kbd{g f} (@code{calc-graph-fast}).
28997This command takes two vectors of equal length from the stack.
28998The vector at the top of the stack represents the ``y'' values of
28999the various data points. The vector in the second-to-top position
29000represents the corresponding ``x'' values. This command runs
29001GNUPLOT (if it has not already been started by previous graphing
29002commands) and displays the set of data points. The points will
29003be connected by lines, and there will also be some kind of symbol
29004to indicate the points themselves.
29005
29006The ``x'' entry may instead be an interval form, in which case suitable
29007``x'' values are interpolated between the minimum and maximum values of
29008the interval (whether the interval is open or closed is ignored).
29009
29010The ``x'' entry may also be a number, in which case Calc uses the
29011sequence of ``x'' values @expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, @expr{x+2}, etc.
29012(Generally the number 0 or 1 would be used for @expr{x} in this case.)
29013
29014The ``y'' entry may be any formula instead of a vector. Calc effectively
29015uses @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) to evaluate variables in the formula;
29016the result of this must be a formula in a single (unassigned) variable.
29017The formula is plotted with this variable taking on the various ``x''
29018values. Graphs of formulas by default use lines without symbols at the
29019computed data points. Note that if neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is a vector,
29020Calc guesses at a reasonable number of data points to use. See the
29021@kbd{g N} command below. (The ``x'' values must be either a vector
29022or an interval if ``y'' is a formula.)
29023
29024@ignore
29025@starindex
29026@end ignore
29027@tindex xy
29028If ``y'' is (or evaluates to) a formula of the form
29029@samp{xy(@var{x}, @var{y})} then the result is a
29030parametric plot. The two arguments of the fictitious @code{xy} function
29031are used as the ``x'' and ``y'' coordinates of the curve, respectively.
29032In this case the ``x'' vector or interval you specified is not directly
29033visible in the graph. For example, if ``x'' is the interval @samp{[0..360]}
29034and ``y'' is the formula @samp{xy(sin(t), cos(t))}, the resulting graph
29035will be a circle.
29036
29037Also, ``x'' and ``y'' may each be variable names, in which case Calc
29038looks for suitable vectors, intervals, or formulas stored in those
29039variables.
29040
29041The ``x'' and ``y'' values for the data points (as pulled from the vectors,
29042calculated from the formulas, or interpolated from the intervals) should
29043be real numbers (integers, fractions, or floats). One exception to this
29044is that the ``y'' entry can consist of a vector of numbers combined with
29045error forms, in which case the points will be plotted with the
29046appropriate error bars. Other than this, if either the ``x''
29047value or the ``y'' value of a given data point is not a real number, that
29048data point will be omitted from the graph. The points on either side
29049of the invalid point will @emph{not} be connected by a line.
29050
29051See the documentation for @kbd{g a} below for a description of the way
29052numeric prefix arguments affect @kbd{g f}.
29053
29054@cindex @code{PlotRejects} variable
29055@vindex PlotRejects
29056If you store an empty vector in the variable @code{PlotRejects}
29057(i.e., @kbd{[ ] s t PlotRejects}), Calc will append information to
29058this vector for every data point which was rejected because its
29059``x'' or ``y'' values were not real numbers. The result will be
29060a matrix where each row holds the curve number, data point number,
29061``x'' value, and ``y'' value for a rejected data point.
29062@xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a handy way to keep tabs on the
29063current value of @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Operations on Variables},
29064for the @kbd{s R} command which is another easy way to examine
29065@code{PlotRejects}.
29066
29067@kindex g c
29068@pindex calc-graph-clear
29069To clear the graphics display, type @kbd{g c} (@code{calc-graph-clear}).
29070If the GNUPLOT output device is an X window, the window will go away.
29071Effects on other kinds of output devices will vary. You don't need
29072to use @kbd{g c} if you don't want to---if you give another @kbd{g f}
29073or @kbd{g p} command later on, it will reuse the existing graphics
29074window if there is one.
29075
29076@node Three Dimensional Graphics, Managing Curves, Basic Graphics, Graphics
29077@section Three-Dimensional Graphics
29078
29079@kindex g F
29080@pindex calc-graph-fast-3d
29081The @kbd{g F} (@code{calc-graph-fast-3d}) command makes a three-dimensional
29082graph. It works only if you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later; with GNUPLOT 2.0,
29083you will see a GNUPLOT error message if you try this command.
29084
29085The @kbd{g F} command takes three values from the stack, called ``x'',
29086``y'', and ``z'', respectively. As was the case for 2D graphs, there
29087are several options for these values.
29088
29089In the first case, ``x'' and ``y'' are each vectors (not necessarily of
29090the same length); either or both may instead be interval forms. The
29091``z'' value must be a matrix with the same number of rows as elements
29092in ``x'', and the same number of columns as elements in ``y''. The
29093result is a surface plot where
29094@texline @math{z_{ij}}
29095@infoline @expr{z_ij}
29096is the height of the point
29097at coordinate @expr{(x_i, y_j)} on the surface. The 3D graph will
29098be displayed from a certain default viewpoint; you can change this
29099viewpoint by adding a @samp{set view} to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29100buffer as described later. See the GNUPLOT documentation for a
29101description of the @samp{set view} command.
29102
29103Each point in the matrix will be displayed as a dot in the graph,
29104and these points will be connected by a grid of lines (@dfn{isolines}).
29105
29106In the second case, ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' are all vectors of equal
29107length. The resulting graph displays a 3D line instead of a surface,
29108where the coordinates of points along the line are successive triplets
29109of values from the input vectors.
29110
29111In the third case, ``x'' and ``y'' are vectors or interval forms, and
29112``z'' is any formula involving two variables (not counting variables
29113with assigned values). These variables are sorted into alphabetical
29114order; the first takes on values from ``x'' and the second takes on
29115values from ``y'' to form a matrix of results that are graphed as a
291163D surface.
29117
29118@ignore
29119@starindex
29120@end ignore
29121@tindex xyz
29122If the ``z'' formula evaluates to a call to the fictitious function
29123@samp{xyz(@var{x}, @var{y}, @var{z})}, then the result is a
29124``parametric surface.'' In this case, the axes of the graph are
29125taken from the @var{x} and @var{y} values in these calls, and the
29126``x'' and ``y'' values from the input vectors or intervals are used only
29127to specify the range of inputs to the formula. For example, plotting
29128@samp{[0..360], [0..180], xyz(sin(x)*sin(y), cos(x)*sin(y), cos(y))}
29129will draw a sphere. (Since the default resolution for 3D plots is
291305 steps in each of ``x'' and ``y'', this will draw a very crude
29131sphere. You could use the @kbd{g N} command, described below, to
29132increase this resolution, or specify the ``x'' and ``y'' values as
29133vectors with more than 5 elements.
29134
29135It is also possible to have a function in a regular @kbd{g f} plot
29136evaluate to an @code{xyz} call. Since @kbd{g f} plots a line, not
29137a surface, the result will be a 3D parametric line. For example,
29138@samp{[[0..720], xyz(sin(x), cos(x), x)]} will plot two turns of a
29139helix (a three-dimensional spiral).
29140
29141As for @kbd{g f}, each of ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' may instead be
29142variables containing the relevant data.
29143
29144@node Managing Curves, Graphics Options, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics
29145@section Managing Curves
29146
29147@noindent
29148The @kbd{g f} command is really shorthand for the following commands:
29149@kbd{C-u g d g a g p}. Likewise, @w{@kbd{g F}} is shorthand for
29150@kbd{C-u g d g A g p}. You can gain more control over your graph
29151by using these commands directly.
29152
29153@kindex g a
29154@pindex calc-graph-add
29155The @kbd{g a} (@code{calc-graph-add}) command adds the ``curve''
29156represented by the two values on the top of the stack to the current
29157graph. You can have any number of curves in the same graph. When
29158you give the @kbd{g p} command, all the curves will be drawn superimposed
29159on the same axes.
29160
29161The @kbd{g a} command (and many others that affect the current graph)
29162will cause a special buffer, @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}, to be displayed
29163in another window. This buffer is a template of the commands that will
29164be sent to GNUPLOT when it is time to draw the graph. The first
29165@kbd{g a} command adds a @code{plot} command to this buffer. Succeeding
29166@kbd{g a} commands add extra curves onto that @code{plot} command.
29167Other graph-related commands put other GNUPLOT commands into this
29168buffer. In normal usage you never need to work with this buffer
29169directly, but you can if you wish. The only constraint is that there
29170must be only one @code{plot} command, and it must be the last command
29171in the buffer. If you want to save and later restore a complete graph
29172configuration, you can use regular Emacs commands to save and restore
29173the contents of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29174
29175@vindex PlotData1
29176@vindex PlotData2
29177If the values on the stack are not variable names, @kbd{g a} will invent
29178variable names for them (of the form @samp{PlotData@var{n}}) and store
29179the values in those variables. The ``x'' and ``y'' variables are what
29180go into the @code{plot} command in the template. If you add a curve
29181that uses a certain variable and then later change that variable, you
29182can replot the graph without having to delete and re-add the curve.
29183That's because the variable name, not the vector, interval or formula
29184itself, is what was added by @kbd{g a}.
29185
29186A numeric prefix argument on @kbd{g a} or @kbd{g f} changes the way
29187stack entries are interpreted as curves. With a positive prefix
29188argument @expr{n}, the top @expr{n} stack entries are ``y'' values
29189for @expr{n} different curves which share a common ``x'' value in
29190the @expr{n+1}st stack entry. (Thus @kbd{g a} with no prefix
29191argument is equivalent to @kbd{C-u 1 g a}.)
29192
29193A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} means to take two stack entries,
29194``x'' and ``y'' as usual, but to interpret ``y'' as a vector of
29195``y'' values for several curves that share a common ``x''.
29196
29197A negative prefix argument tells Calc to read @expr{n} vectors from
29198the stack; each vector @expr{[x, y]} describes an independent curve.
29199This is the only form of @kbd{g a} that creates several curves at once
29200that don't have common ``x'' values. (Of course, the range of ``x''
29201values covered by all the curves ought to be roughly the same if
29202they are to look nice on the same graph.)
29203
29204For example, to plot
29205@texline @math{\sin n x}
29206@infoline @expr{sin(n x)}
29207for integers @expr{n}
29208from 1 to 5, you could use @kbd{v x} to create a vector of integers
29209(@expr{n}), then @kbd{V M '} or @kbd{V M $} to map @samp{sin(n x)}
29210across this vector. The resulting vector of formulas is suitable
29211for use as the ``y'' argument to a @kbd{C-u g a} or @kbd{C-u g f}
29212command.
29213
29214@kindex g A
29215@pindex calc-graph-add-3d
29216The @kbd{g A} (@code{calc-graph-add-3d}) command adds a 3D curve
29217to the graph. It is not valid to intermix 2D and 3D curves in a
29218single graph. This command takes three arguments, ``x'', ``y'',
29219and ``z'', from the stack. With a positive prefix @expr{n}, it
29220takes @expr{n+2} arguments (common ``x'' and ``y'', plus @expr{n}
29221separate ``z''s). With a zero prefix, it takes three stack entries
29222but the ``z'' entry is a vector of curve values. With a negative
29223prefix @expr{-n}, it takes @expr{n} vectors of the form @expr{[x, y, z]}.
29224The @kbd{g A} command works by adding a @code{splot} (surface-plot)
29225command to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29226
29227(Although @kbd{g a} adds a 2D @code{plot} command to the
29228@samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer, Calc changes this to @code{splot}
29229before sending it to GNUPLOT if it notices that the data points are
29230evaluating to @code{xyz} calls. It will not work to mix 2D and 3D
29231@kbd{g a} curves in a single graph, although Calc does not currently
29232check for this.)
29233
29234@kindex g d
29235@pindex calc-graph-delete
29236The @kbd{g d} (@code{calc-graph-delete}) command deletes the most
29237recently added curve from the graph. It has no effect if there are
29238no curves in the graph. With a numeric prefix argument of any kind,
29239it deletes all of the curves from the graph.
29240
29241@kindex g H
29242@pindex calc-graph-hide
29243The @kbd{g H} (@code{calc-graph-hide}) command ``hides'' or ``unhides''
29244the most recently added curve. A hidden curve will not appear in
29245the actual plot, but information about it such as its name and line and
29246point styles will be retained.
29247
29248@kindex g j
29249@pindex calc-graph-juggle
29250The @kbd{g j} (@code{calc-graph-juggle}) command moves the curve
29251at the end of the list (the ``most recently added curve'') to the
29252front of the list. The next-most-recent curve is thus exposed for
29253@w{@kbd{g d}} or similar commands to use. With @kbd{g j} you can work
29254with any curve in the graph even though curve-related commands only
29255affect the last curve in the list.
29256
29257@kindex g p
29258@pindex calc-graph-plot
29259The @kbd{g p} (@code{calc-graph-plot}) command uses GNUPLOT to draw
29260the graph described in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Any
29261GNUPLOT parameters which are not defined by commands in this buffer
29262are reset to their default values. The variables named in the @code{plot}
29263command are written to a temporary data file and the variable names
29264are then replaced by the file name in the template. The resulting
29265plotting commands are fed to the GNUPLOT program. See the documentation
29266for the GNUPLOT program for more specific information. All temporary
29267files are removed when Emacs or GNUPLOT exits.
29268
29269If you give a formula for ``y'', Calc will remember all the values that
29270it calculates for the formula so that later plots can reuse these values.
29271Calc throws out these saved values when you change any circumstances
29272that may affect the data, such as switching from Degrees to Radians
29273mode, or changing the value of a parameter in the formula. You can
29274force Calc to recompute the data from scratch by giving a negative
29275numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}.
29276
29277Calc uses a fairly rough step size when graphing formulas over intervals.
29278This is to ensure quick response. You can ``refine'' a plot by giving
29279a positive numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}. Calc goes through
29280the data points it has computed and saved from previous plots of the
29281function, and computes and inserts a new data point midway between
29282each of the existing points. You can refine a plot any number of times,
29283but beware that the amount of calculation involved doubles each time.
29284
29285Calc does not remember computed values for 3D graphs. This means the
29286numerix prefix argument, if any, to @kbd{g p} is effectively ignored if
29287the current graph is three-dimensional.
29288
29289@kindex g P
29290@pindex calc-graph-print
29291The @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}) command is like @kbd{g p},
29292except that it sends the output to a printer instead of to the
29293screen. More precisely, @kbd{g p} looks for @samp{set terminal}
29294or @samp{set output} commands in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer;
29295lacking these it uses the default settings. However, @kbd{g P}
29296ignores @samp{set terminal} and @samp{set output} commands and
29297uses a different set of default values. All of these values are
29298controlled by the @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} commands discussed below.
29299Provided everything is set up properly, @kbd{g p} will plot to
29300the screen unless you have specified otherwise and @kbd{g P} will
29301always plot to the printer.
29302
29303@node Graphics Options, Devices, Managing Curves, Graphics
29304@section Graphics Options
29305
29306@noindent
29307@kindex g g
29308@pindex calc-graph-grid
29309The @kbd{g g} (@code{calc-graph-grid}) command turns the ``grid''
29310on and off. It is off by default; tick marks appear only at the
29311edges of the graph. With the grid turned on, dotted lines appear
29312across the graph at each tick mark. Note that this command only
29313changes the setting in @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}; to see the effects
29314of the change you must give another @kbd{g p} command.
29315
29316@kindex g b
29317@pindex calc-graph-border
29318The @kbd{g b} (@code{calc-graph-border}) command turns the border
29319(the box that surrounds the graph) on and off. It is on by default.
29320This command will only work with GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
29321
29322@kindex g k
29323@pindex calc-graph-key
29324The @kbd{g k} (@code{calc-graph-key}) command turns the ``key''
29325on and off. The key is a chart in the corner of the graph that
29326shows the correspondence between curves and line styles. It is
29327off by default, and is only really useful if you have several
29328curves on the same graph.
29329
29330@kindex g N
29331@pindex calc-graph-num-points
29332The @kbd{g N} (@code{calc-graph-num-points}) command allows you
29333to select the number of data points in the graph. This only affects
29334curves where neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is specified as a vector.
29335Enter a blank line to revert to the default value (initially 15).
29336With no prefix argument, this command affects only the current graph.
29337With a positive prefix argument this command changes or, if you enter
29338a blank line, displays the default number of points used for all
29339graphs created by @kbd{g a} that don't specify the resolution explicitly.
29340With a negative prefix argument, this command changes or displays
29341the default value (initially 5) used for 3D graphs created by @kbd{g A}.
29342Note that a 3D setting of 5 means that a total of @expr{5^2 = 25} points
29343will be computed for the surface.
29344
29345Data values in the graph of a function are normally computed to a
29346precision of five digits, regardless of the current precision at the
29347time. This is usually more than adequate, but there are cases where
29348it will not be. For example, plotting @expr{1 + x} with @expr{x} in the
29349interval @samp{[0 ..@: 1e-6]} will round all the data points down
29350to 1.0! Putting the command @samp{set precision @var{n}} in the
29351@samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer will cause the data to be computed
29352at precision @var{n} instead of 5. Since this is such a rare case,
29353there is no keystroke-based command to set the precision.
29354
29355@kindex g h
29356@pindex calc-graph-header
29357The @kbd{g h} (@code{calc-graph-header}) command sets the title
29358for the graph. This will show up centered above the graph.
29359The default title is blank (no title).
29360
29361@kindex g n
29362@pindex calc-graph-name
29363The @kbd{g n} (@code{calc-graph-name}) command sets the title of an
29364individual curve. Like the other curve-manipulating commands, it
29365affects the most recently added curve, i.e., the last curve on the
29366list in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. To set the title of
29367the other curves you must first juggle them to the end of the list
29368with @kbd{g j}, or edit the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer by hand.
29369Curve titles appear in the key; if the key is turned off they are
29370not used.
29371
29372@kindex g t
29373@kindex g T
29374@pindex calc-graph-title-x
29375@pindex calc-graph-title-y
29376The @kbd{g t} (@code{calc-graph-title-x}) and @kbd{g T}
29377(@code{calc-graph-title-y}) commands set the titles on the ``x''
29378and ``y'' axes, respectively. These titles appear next to the
29379tick marks on the left and bottom edges of the graph, respectively.
29380Calc does not have commands to control the tick marks themselves,
29381but you can edit them into the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer if
29382you wish. See the GNUPLOT documentation for details.
29383
29384@kindex g r
29385@kindex g R
29386@pindex calc-graph-range-x
29387@pindex calc-graph-range-y
29388The @kbd{g r} (@code{calc-graph-range-x}) and @kbd{g R}
29389(@code{calc-graph-range-y}) commands set the range of values on the
29390``x'' and ``y'' axes, respectively. You are prompted to enter a
29391suitable range. This should be either a pair of numbers of the
29392form, @samp{@var{min}:@var{max}}, or a blank line to revert to the
29393default behavior of setting the range based on the range of values
29394in the data, or @samp{$} to take the range from the top of the stack.
29395Ranges on the stack can be represented as either interval forms or
29396vectors: @samp{[@var{min} ..@: @var{max}]} or @samp{[@var{min}, @var{max}]}.
29397
29398@kindex g l
29399@kindex g L
29400@pindex calc-graph-log-x
29401@pindex calc-graph-log-y
29402The @kbd{g l} (@code{calc-graph-log-x}) and @kbd{g L} (@code{calc-graph-log-y})
29403commands allow you to set either or both of the axes of the graph to
29404be logarithmic instead of linear.
29405
29406@kindex g C-l
29407@kindex g C-r
29408@kindex g C-t
29409@pindex calc-graph-log-z
29410@pindex calc-graph-range-z
29411@pindex calc-graph-title-z
29412For 3D plots, @kbd{g C-t}, @kbd{g C-r}, and @kbd{g C-l} (those are
29413letters with the Control key held down) are the corresponding commands
29414for the ``z'' axis.
29415
29416@kindex g z
29417@kindex g Z
29418@pindex calc-graph-zero-x
29419@pindex calc-graph-zero-y
29420The @kbd{g z} (@code{calc-graph-zero-x}) and @kbd{g Z}
29421(@code{calc-graph-zero-y}) commands control whether a dotted line is
29422drawn to indicate the ``x'' and/or ``y'' zero axes. (These are the same
29423dotted lines that would be drawn there anyway if you used @kbd{g g} to
29424turn the ``grid'' feature on.) Zero-axis lines are on by default, and
29425may be turned off only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions. They are
29426not available for 3D plots.
29427
29428@kindex g s
29429@pindex calc-graph-line-style
29430The @kbd{g s} (@code{calc-graph-line-style}) command turns the connecting
29431lines on or off for the most recently added curve, and optionally selects
29432the style of lines to be used for that curve. Plain @kbd{g s} simply
29433toggles the lines on and off. With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g s}
29434turns lines on and sets a particular line style. Line style numbers
29435start at one and their meanings vary depending on the output device.
29436GNUPLOT guarantees that there will be at least six different line styles
29437available for any device.
29438
29439@kindex g S
29440@pindex calc-graph-point-style
29441The @kbd{g S} (@code{calc-graph-point-style}) command similarly turns
29442the symbols at the data points on or off, or sets the point style.
29443If you turn both lines and points off, the data points will show as
29444tiny dots. If the ``y'' values being plotted contain error forms and
29445the connecting lines are turned off, then this command will also turn
29446the error bars on or off.
29447
29448@cindex @code{LineStyles} variable
29449@cindex @code{PointStyles} variable
29450@vindex LineStyles
29451@vindex PointStyles
29452Another way to specify curve styles is with the @code{LineStyles} and
29453@code{PointStyles} variables. These variables initially have no stored
29454values, but if you store a vector of integers in one of these variables,
29455the @kbd{g a} and @kbd{g f} commands will use those style numbers
29456instead of the defaults for new curves that are added to the graph.
29457An entry should be a positive integer for a specific style, or 0 to let
29458the style be chosen automatically, or @mathit{-1} to turn off lines or points
29459altogether. If there are more curves than elements in the vector, the
29460last few curves will continue to have the default styles. Of course,
29461you can later use @kbd{g s} and @kbd{g S} to change any of these styles.
29462
29463For example, @kbd{'[2 -1 3] @key{RET} s t LineStyles} causes the first curve
29464to have lines in style number 2, the second curve to have no connecting
29465lines, and the third curve to have lines in style 3. Point styles will
29466still be assigned automatically, but you could store another vector in
29467@code{PointStyles} to define them, too.
29468
29469@node Devices, , Graphics Options, Graphics
29470@section Graphical Devices
29471
29472@noindent
29473@kindex g D
29474@pindex calc-graph-device
29475The @kbd{g D} (@code{calc-graph-device}) command sets the device name
29476(or ``terminal name'' in GNUPLOT lingo) to be used by @kbd{g p} commands
29477on this graph. It does not affect the permanent default device name.
29478If you enter a blank name, the device name reverts to the default.
29479Enter @samp{?} to see a list of supported devices.
29480
29481With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} instead sets
29482the default device name, used by all plots in the future which do
29483not override it with a plain @kbd{g D} command. If you enter a
29484blank line this command shows you the current default. The special
29485name @code{default} signifies that Calc should choose @code{x11} if
29486the X window system is in use (as indicated by the presence of a
66783bb4
EZ
29487@code{DISPLAY} environment variable), @code{windows} on MS-Windows, or
29488otherwise @code{dumb} under GNUPLOT 3.0 and later, or
29489@code{postscript} under GNUPLOT 2.0. This is the initial default
29490value.
4009494e
GM
29491
29492The @code{dumb} device is an interface to ``dumb terminals,'' i.e.,
29493terminals with no special graphics facilities. It writes a crude
29494picture of the graph composed of characters like @code{-} and @code{|}
29495to a buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}, which Calc then displays.
29496The graph is made the same size as the Emacs screen, which on most
29497dumb terminals will be
29498@texline @math{80\times24}
29499@infoline 80x24
29500characters. The graph is displayed in
29501an Emacs ``recursive edit''; type @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-c C-c} to exit
29502the recursive edit and return to Calc. Note that the @code{dumb}
29503device is present only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
29504
29505The word @code{dumb} may be followed by two numbers separated by
29506spaces. These are the desired width and height of the graph in
29507characters. Also, the device name @code{big} is like @code{dumb}
29508but creates a graph four times the width and height of the Emacs
29509screen. You will then have to scroll around to view the entire
29510graph. In the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer, @key{SPC}, @key{DEL},
29511@kbd{<}, and @kbd{>} are defined to scroll by one screenful in each
29512of the four directions.
29513
29514With a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} sets or displays
29515the device name used by @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}). This
29516is initially @code{postscript}. If you don't have a PostScript
29517printer, you may decide once again to use @code{dumb} to create a
29518plot on any text-only printer.
29519
29520@kindex g O
29521@pindex calc-graph-output
66783bb4
EZ
29522The @kbd{g O} (@code{calc-graph-output}) command sets the name of the
29523output file used by GNUPLOT. For some devices, notably @code{x11} and
29524@code{windows}, there is no output file and this information is not
29525used. Many other ``devices'' are really file formats like
29526@code{postscript}; in these cases the output in the desired format
29527goes into the file you name with @kbd{g O}. Type @kbd{g O stdout
29528@key{RET}} to set GNUPLOT to write to its standard output stream,
29529i.e., to @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}. This is the default setting.
4009494e
GM
29530
29531Another special output name is @code{tty}, which means that GNUPLOT
29532is going to write graphics commands directly to its standard output,
29533which you wish Emacs to pass through to your terminal. Tektronix
29534graphics terminals, among other devices, operate this way. Calc does
29535this by telling GNUPLOT to write to a temporary file, then running a
29536sub-shell executing the command @samp{cat tempfile >/dev/tty}. On
29537typical Unix systems, this will copy the temporary file directly to
29538the terminal, bypassing Emacs entirely. You will have to type @kbd{C-l}
29539to Emacs afterwards to refresh the screen.
29540
29541Once again, @kbd{g O} with a positive or negative prefix argument
29542sets the default or printer output file names, respectively. In each
29543case you can specify @code{auto}, which causes Calc to invent a temporary
29544file name for each @kbd{g p} (or @kbd{g P}) command. This temporary file
29545will be deleted once it has been displayed or printed. If the output file
29546name is not @code{auto}, the file is not automatically deleted.
29547
29548The default and printer devices and output files can be saved
29549permanently by the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command. The
29550default number of data points (see @kbd{g N}) and the X geometry
29551(see @kbd{g X}) are also saved. Other graph information is @emph{not}
29552saved; you can save a graph's configuration simply by saving the contents
29553of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29554
29555@vindex calc-gnuplot-plot-command
29556@vindex calc-gnuplot-default-device
29557@vindex calc-gnuplot-default-output
29558@vindex calc-gnuplot-print-command
29559@vindex calc-gnuplot-print-device
29560@vindex calc-gnuplot-print-output
29561You may wish to configure the default and
29562printer devices and output files for the whole system. The relevant
29563Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-default-device} and @code{-output},
29564and @code{calc-gnuplot-print-device} and @code{-output}. The output
29565file names must be either strings as described above, or Lisp
29566expressions which are evaluated on the fly to get the output file names.
29567
29568Other important Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
29569@code{calc-gnuplot-print-command}, which give the system commands to
29570display or print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
29571@code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
29572@samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
29573Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
29574to display or print the output. These variables are customizable
29575(@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
29576
29577@kindex g x
29578@pindex calc-graph-display
29579The @kbd{g x} (@code{calc-graph-display}) command lets you specify
29580on which X window system display your graphs should be drawn. Enter
29581a blank line to see the current display name. This command has no
29582effect unless the current device is @code{x11}.
29583
29584@kindex g X
29585@pindex calc-graph-geometry
29586The @kbd{g X} (@code{calc-graph-geometry}) command is a similar
29587command for specifying the position and size of the X window.
29588The normal value is @code{default}, which generally means your
29589window manager will let you place the window interactively.
29590Entering @samp{800x500+0+0} would create an 800-by-500 pixel
66783bb4
EZ
29591window in the upper-left corner of the screen. This command has no
29592effect if the current device is @code{windows}.
4009494e
GM
29593
29594The buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} holds a transcript of the
29595session with GNUPLOT. This shows the commands Calc has ``typed'' to
29596GNUPLOT and the responses it has received. Calc tries to notice when an
29597error message has appeared here and display the buffer for you when
29598this happens. You can check this buffer yourself if you suspect
66783bb4
EZ
29599something has gone wrong@footnote{
29600On MS-Windows, due to the peculiarities of how the Windows version of
29601GNUPLOT (called @command{wgnuplot}) works, the GNUPLOT responses are
29602not communicated back to Calc. Instead, you need to look them up in
29603the GNUPLOT command window that is displayed as in normal interactive
29604usage of GNUPLOT.
29605}.
4009494e
GM
29606
29607@kindex g C
29608@pindex calc-graph-command
29609The @kbd{g C} (@code{calc-graph-command}) command prompts you to
29610enter any line of text, then simply sends that line to the current
29611GNUPLOT process. The @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer looks deceptively
29612like a Shell buffer but you can't type commands in it yourself.
29613Instead, you must use @kbd{g C} for this purpose.
29614
29615@kindex g v
29616@kindex g V
29617@pindex calc-graph-view-commands
29618@pindex calc-graph-view-trail
29619The @kbd{g v} (@code{calc-graph-view-commands}) and @kbd{g V}
29620(@code{calc-graph-view-trail}) commands display the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29621and @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffers, respectively, in another window.
29622This happens automatically when Calc thinks there is something you
29623will want to see in either of these buffers. If you type @kbd{g v}
29624or @kbd{g V} when the relevant buffer is already displayed, the
66783bb4
EZ
29625buffer is hidden again. (Note that on MS-Windows, the @samp{*Gnuplot
29626Trail*} buffer will usually show nothing of interest, because
29627GNUPLOT's responses are not communicated back to Calc.)
4009494e
GM
29628
29629One reason to use @kbd{g v} is to add your own commands to the
29630@samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Press @kbd{g v}, then use
29631@kbd{C-x o} to switch into that window. For example, GNUPLOT has
29632@samp{set label} and @samp{set arrow} commands that allow you to
29633annotate your plots. Since Calc doesn't understand these commands,
29634you have to add them to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer
29635yourself, then use @w{@kbd{g p}} to replot using these new commands. Note
29636that your commands must appear @emph{before} the @code{plot} command.
29637To get help on any GNUPLOT feature, type, e.g., @kbd{g C help set label}.
29638You may have to type @kbd{g C @key{RET}} a few times to clear the
29639``press return for more'' or ``subtopic of @dots{}'' requests.
29640Note that Calc always sends commands (like @samp{set nolabel}) to
29641reset all plotting parameters to the defaults before each plot, so
29642to delete a label all you need to do is delete the @samp{set label}
29643line you added (or comment it out with @samp{#}) and then replot
29644with @kbd{g p}.
29645
29646@kindex g q
29647@pindex calc-graph-quit
29648You can use @kbd{g q} (@code{calc-graph-quit}) to kill the GNUPLOT
29649process that is running. The next graphing command you give will
29650start a fresh GNUPLOT process. The word @samp{Graph} appears in
29651the Calc window's mode line whenever a GNUPLOT process is currently
29652running. The GNUPLOT process is automatically killed when you
29653exit Emacs if you haven't killed it manually by then.
29654
29655@kindex g K
29656@pindex calc-graph-kill
29657The @kbd{g K} (@code{calc-graph-kill}) command is like @kbd{g q}
29658except that it also views the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer so that
29659you can see the process being killed. This is better if you are
29660killing GNUPLOT because you think it has gotten stuck.
29661
29662@node Kill and Yank, Keypad Mode, Graphics, Top
29663@chapter Kill and Yank Functions
29664
29665@noindent
29666The commands in this chapter move information between the Calculator and
29667other Emacs editing buffers.
29668
29669In many cases Embedded mode is an easier and more natural way to
29670work with Calc from a regular editing buffer. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
29671
29672@menu
29673* Killing From Stack::
29674* Yanking Into Stack::
538c2573
JB
29675* Saving Into Registers::
29676* Inserting From Registers::
4009494e
GM
29677* Grabbing From Buffers::
29678* Yanking Into Buffers::
29679* X Cut and Paste::
29680@end menu
29681
29682@node Killing From Stack, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank, Kill and Yank
29683@section Killing from the Stack
29684
29685@noindent
29686@kindex C-k
29687@pindex calc-kill
29688@kindex M-k
29689@pindex calc-copy-as-kill
29690@kindex C-w
29691@pindex calc-kill-region
29692@kindex M-w
29693@pindex calc-copy-region-as-kill
aee08080 29694@kindex M-C-w
4009494e 29695@cindex Kill ring
aee08080
JB
29696@dfn{Kill} commands are Emacs commands that insert text into the ``kill
29697ring,'' from which it can later be ``yanked'' by a @kbd{C-y} command.
29698Three common kill commands in normal Emacs are @kbd{C-k}, which kills
29699one line, @kbd{C-w}, which kills the region between mark and point, and
29700@kbd{M-w}, which puts the region into the kill ring without actually
29701deleting it. All of these commands work in the Calculator, too,
29702although in the Calculator they operate on whole stack entries, so they
29703``round up'' the specified region to encompass full lines. (To copy
29704only parts of lines, the @kbd{M-C-w} command in the Calculator will copy
29705the region to the kill ring without any ``rounding up'', just like the
29706@kbd{M-w} command in normal Emacs.) Also, @kbd{M-k} has been provided
29707to complete the set; it puts the current line into the kill ring without
29708deleting anything.
4009494e
GM
29709
29710The kill commands are unusual in that they pay attention to the location
aee08080
JB
29711of the cursor in the Calculator buffer. If the cursor is on or below
29712the bottom line, the kill commands operate on the top of the stack.
29713Otherwise, they operate on whatever stack element the cursor is on. The
29714text is copied into the kill ring exactly as it appears on the screen,
29715including line numbers if they are enabled.
4009494e
GM
29716
29717A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{C-k} or @kbd{M-k} affects the number
29718of lines killed. A positive argument kills the current line and @expr{n-1}
29719lines below it. A negative argument kills the @expr{-n} lines above the
29720current line. Again this mirrors the behavior of the standard Emacs
29721@kbd{C-k} command. Although a whole line is always deleted, @kbd{C-k}
29722with no argument copies only the number itself into the kill ring, whereas
29723@kbd{C-k} with a prefix argument of 1 copies the number with its trailing
29724newline.
29725
538c2573 29726@node Yanking Into Stack, Saving Into Registers, Killing From Stack, Kill and Yank
4009494e
GM
29727@section Yanking into the Stack
29728
29729@noindent
29730@kindex C-y
29731@pindex calc-yank
29732The @kbd{C-y} command yanks the most recently killed text back into the
29733Calculator. It pushes this value onto the top of the stack regardless of
29734the cursor position. In general it re-parses the killed text as a number
29735or formula (or a list of these separated by commas or newlines). However if
29736the thing being yanked is something that was just killed from the Calculator
29737itself, its full internal structure is yanked. For example, if you have
29738set the floating-point display mode to show only four significant digits,
29739then killing and re-yanking 3.14159 (which displays as 3.142) will yank the
29740full 3.14159, even though yanking it into any other buffer would yank the
29741number in its displayed form, 3.142. (Since the default display modes
29742show all objects to their full precision, this feature normally makes no
29743difference.)
29744
538c2573
JB
29745@node Saving Into Registers, Inserting From Registers, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank
29746@section Saving into Registers
29747
29748@noindent
29749@kindex r s
29750@pindex calc-copy-to-register
29751@pindex calc-prepend-to-register
29752@pindex calc-append-to-register
29753@cindex Registers
29754An alternative to killing and yanking stack entries is using
29755registers in Calc. Saving stack entries in registers is like
29756saving text in normal Emacs registers; although, like Calc's kill
29757commands, register commands always operate on whole stack
29758entries.
29759
29760Registers in Calc are places to store stack entries for later use;
29761each register is indexed by a single character. To store the current
29762region (rounded up, of course, to include full stack entries) into a
29763register, use the command @kbd{r s} (@code{calc-copy-to-register}).
29764You will then be prompted for a register to use, the next character
29765you type will be the index for the register. To store the region in
29766register @var{r}, the full command will be @kbd{r s @var{r}}. With an
29767argument, @kbd{C-u r s @var{r}}, the region being copied to the
29768register will be deleted from the Calc buffer.
29769
29770It is possible to add additional stack entries to a register. The
29771command @kbd{M-x calc-append-to-register} will prompt for a register,
29772then add the stack entries in the region to the end of the register
29773contents. The command @kbd{M-x calc-prepend-to-register} will
29774similarly prompt for a register and add the stack entries in the
29775region to the beginning of the register contents. Both commands take
29776@kbd{C-u} arguments, which will cause the region to be deleted after being
29777added to the register.
29778
29779@node Inserting From Registers, Grabbing From Buffers, Saving Into Registers, Kill and Yank
29780@section Inserting from Registers
29781@noindent
29782@kindex r i
29783@pindex calc-insert-register
29784The command @kbd{r i} (@code{calc-insert-register}) will prompt for a
29785register, then insert the contents of that register into the
29786Calculator. If the contents of the register were placed there from
29787within Calc, then the full internal structure of the contents will be
29788inserted into the Calculator, otherwise whatever text is in the
29789register is reparsed and then inserted into the Calculator.
29790
29791@node Grabbing From Buffers, Yanking Into Buffers, Inserting From Registers, Kill and Yank
4009494e
GM
29792@section Grabbing from Other Buffers
29793
29794@noindent
29795@kindex C-x * g
29796@pindex calc-grab-region
29797The @kbd{C-x * g} (@code{calc-grab-region}) command takes the text between
29798point and mark in the current buffer and attempts to parse it as a
29799vector of values. Basically, it wraps the text in vector brackets
29800@samp{[ ]} unless the text already is enclosed in vector brackets,
29801then reads the text as if it were an algebraic entry. The contents
29802of the vector may be numbers, formulas, or any other Calc objects.
29803If the @kbd{C-x * g} command works successfully, it does an automatic
29804@kbd{C-x * c} to enter the Calculator buffer.
29805
29806A numeric prefix argument grabs the specified number of lines around
29807point, ignoring the mark. A positive prefix grabs from point to the
29808@expr{n}th following newline (so that @kbd{M-1 C-x * g} grabs from point
29809to the end of the current line); a negative prefix grabs from point
29810back to the @expr{n+1}st preceding newline. In these cases the text
29811that is grabbed is exactly the same as the text that @kbd{C-k} would
29812delete given that prefix argument.
29813
29814A prefix of zero grabs the current line; point may be anywhere on the
29815line.
29816
29817A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix interprets the region between point and mark
29818as a single number or formula rather than a vector. For example,
29819@kbd{C-x * g} on the text @samp{2 a b} produces the vector of three
29820values @samp{[2, a, b]}, but @kbd{C-u C-x * g} on the same region
29821reads a formula which is a product of three things: @samp{2 a b}.
29822(The text @samp{a + b}, on the other hand, will be grabbed as a
29823vector of one element by plain @kbd{C-x * g} because the interpretation
29824@samp{[a, +, b]} would be a syntax error.)
29825
29826If a different language has been specified (@pxref{Language Modes}),
29827the grabbed text will be interpreted according to that language.
29828
29829@kindex C-x * r
29830@pindex calc-grab-rectangle
29831The @kbd{C-x * r} (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) command takes the text between
29832point and mark and attempts to parse it as a matrix. If point and mark
29833are both in the leftmost column, the lines in between are parsed in their
29834entirety. Otherwise, point and mark define the corners of a rectangle
29835whose contents are parsed.
29836
29837Each line of the grabbed area becomes a row of the matrix. The result
29838will actually be a vector of vectors, which Calc will treat as a matrix
29839only if every row contains the same number of values.
29840
29841If a line contains a portion surrounded by square brackets (or curly
29842braces), that portion is interpreted as a vector which becomes a row
29843of the matrix. Any text surrounding the bracketed portion on the line
29844is ignored.
29845
29846Otherwise, the entire line is interpreted as a row vector as if it
29847were surrounded by square brackets. Leading line numbers (in the
29848format used in the Calc stack buffer) are ignored. If you wish to
29849force this interpretation (even if the line contains bracketed
29850portions), give a negative numeric prefix argument to the
29851@kbd{C-x * r} command.
29852
29853If you give a numeric prefix argument of zero or plain @kbd{C-u}, each
29854line is instead interpreted as a single formula which is converted into
29855a one-element vector. Thus the result of @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will be a
29856one-column matrix. For example, suppose one line of the data is the
29857expression @samp{2 a}. A plain @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} will interpret this as
29858@samp{[2 a]}, which in turn is read as a two-element vector that forms
29859one row of the matrix. But a @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will interpret this row
29860as @samp{[2*a]}.
29861
29862If you give a positive numeric prefix argument @var{n}, then each line
29863will be split up into columns of width @var{n}; each column is parsed
29864separately as a matrix element. If a line contained
29865@w{@samp{2 +/- 3 4 +/- 5}}, then grabbing with a prefix argument of 8
29866would correctly split the line into two error forms.
29867
29868@xref{Matrix Functions}, to see how to pull the matrix apart into its
29869constituent rows and columns. (If it is a
29870@texline @math{1\times1}
29871@infoline 1x1
29872matrix, just hit @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) twice.)
29873
29874@kindex C-x * :
29875@kindex C-x * _
29876@pindex calc-grab-sum-across
29877@pindex calc-grab-sum-down
29878@cindex Summing rows and columns of data
29879The @kbd{C-x * :} (@code{calc-grab-sum-down}) command is a handy way to
29880grab a rectangle of data and sum its columns. It is equivalent to
29881typing @kbd{C-x * r}, followed by @kbd{V R : +} (the vector reduction
29882command that sums the columns of a matrix; @pxref{Reducing}). The
29883result of the command will be a vector of numbers, one for each column
29884in the input data. The @kbd{C-x * _} (@code{calc-grab-sum-across}) command
29885similarly grabs a rectangle and sums its rows by executing @w{@kbd{V R _ +}}.
29886
29887As well as being more convenient, @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are also
29888much faster because they don't actually place the grabbed vector on
29889the stack. In a @kbd{C-x * r V R : +} sequence, formatting the vector
29890for display on the stack takes a large fraction of the total time
29891(unless you have planned ahead and used @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} modes).
29892
29893For example, suppose we have a column of numbers in a file which we
29894wish to sum. Go to one corner of the column and press @kbd{C-@@} to
29895set the mark; go to the other corner and type @kbd{C-x * :}. Since there
29896is only one column, the result will be a vector of one number, the sum.
29897(You can type @kbd{v u} to unpack this vector into a plain number if
29898you want to do further arithmetic with it.)
29899
29900To compute the product of the column of numbers, we would have to do
29901it ``by hand'' since there's no special grab-and-multiply command.
29902Use @kbd{C-x * r} to grab the column of numbers into the calculator in
29903the form of a column matrix. The statistics command @kbd{u *} is a
29904handy way to find the product of a vector or matrix of numbers.
29905@xref{Statistical Operations}. Another approach would be to use
29906an explicit column reduction command, @kbd{V R : *}.
29907
29908@node Yanking Into Buffers, X Cut and Paste, Grabbing From Buffers, Kill and Yank
29909@section Yanking into Other Buffers
29910
29911@noindent
29912@kindex y
29913@pindex calc-copy-to-buffer
29914The plain @kbd{y} (@code{calc-copy-to-buffer}) command inserts the number
29915at the top of the stack into the most recently used normal editing buffer.
29916(More specifically, this is the most recently used buffer which is displayed
29917in a window and whose name does not begin with @samp{*}. If there is no
29918such buffer, this is the most recently used buffer except for Calculator
29919and Calc Trail buffers.) The number is inserted exactly as it appears and
29920without a newline. (If line-numbering is enabled, the line number is
29921normally not included.) The number is @emph{not} removed from the stack.
29922
29923With a prefix argument, @kbd{y} inserts several numbers, one per line.
29924A positive argument inserts the specified number of values from the top
29925of the stack. A negative argument inserts the @expr{n}th value from the
29926top of the stack. An argument of zero inserts the entire stack. Note
29927that @kbd{y} with an argument of 1 is slightly different from @kbd{y}
29928with no argument; the former always copies full lines, whereas the
29929latter strips off the trailing newline.
29930
29931With a lone @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, @kbd{y} @emph{replaces} the
29932region in the other buffer with the yanked text, then quits the
29933Calculator, leaving you in that buffer. A typical use would be to use
29934@kbd{C-x * g} to read a region of data into the Calculator, operate on the
29935data to produce a new matrix, then type @kbd{C-u y} to replace the
29936original data with the new data. One might wish to alter the matrix
29937display style (@pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}) or change the current
29938display language (@pxref{Language Modes}) before doing this. Also, note
29939that this command replaces a linear region of text (as grabbed by
29940@kbd{C-x * g}), not a rectangle (as grabbed by @kbd{C-x * r}).
29941
29942If the editing buffer is in overwrite (as opposed to insert) mode,
29943and the @kbd{C-u} prefix was not used, then the yanked number will
29944overwrite the characters following point rather than being inserted
29945before those characters. The usual conventions of overwrite mode
29946are observed; for example, characters will be inserted at the end of
29947a line rather than overflowing onto the next line. Yanking a multi-line
29948object such as a matrix in overwrite mode overwrites the next @var{n}
29949lines in the buffer, lengthening or shortening each line as necessary.
29950Finally, if the thing being yanked is a simple integer or floating-point
29951number (like @samp{-1.2345e-3}) and the characters following point also
29952make up such a number, then Calc will replace that number with the new
29953number, lengthening or shortening as necessary. The concept of
29954``overwrite mode'' has thus been generalized from overwriting characters
29955to overwriting one complete number with another.
29956
29957@kindex C-x * y
29958The @kbd{C-x * y} key sequence is equivalent to @kbd{y} except that
29959it can be typed anywhere, not just in Calc. This provides an easy
29960way to guarantee that Calc knows which editing buffer you want to use!
29961
29962@node X Cut and Paste, , Yanking Into Buffers, Kill and Yank
29963@section X Cut and Paste
29964
29965@noindent
29966If you are using Emacs with the X window system, there is an easier
29967way to move small amounts of data into and out of the calculator:
29968Use the mouse-oriented cut and paste facilities of X.
29969
29970The default bindings for a three-button mouse cause the left button
29971to move the Emacs cursor to the given place, the right button to
29972select the text between the cursor and the clicked location, and
29973the middle button to yank the selection into the buffer at the
29974clicked location. So, if you have a Calc window and an editing
29975window on your Emacs screen, you can use left-click/right-click
29976to select a number, vector, or formula from one window, then
29977middle-click to paste that value into the other window. When you
29978paste text into the Calc window, Calc interprets it as an algebraic
29979entry. It doesn't matter where you click in the Calc window; the
29980new value is always pushed onto the top of the stack.
29981
29982The @code{xterm} program that is typically used for general-purpose
29983shell windows in X interprets the mouse buttons in the same way.
29984So you can use the mouse to move data between Calc and any other
29985Unix program. One nice feature of @code{xterm} is that a double
29986left-click selects one word, and a triple left-click selects a
29987whole line. So you can usually transfer a single number into Calc
29988just by double-clicking on it in the shell, then middle-clicking
29989in the Calc window.
29990
29991@node Keypad Mode, Embedded Mode, Kill and Yank, Top
29992@chapter Keypad Mode
29993
29994@noindent
29995@kindex C-x * k
29996@pindex calc-keypad
29997The @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) command starts the Calculator
29998and displays a picture of a calculator-style keypad. If you are using
29999the X window system, you can click on any of the ``keys'' in the
30000keypad using the left mouse button to operate the calculator.
30001The original window remains the selected window; in Keypad mode
30002you can type in your file while simultaneously performing
30003calculations with the mouse.
30004
30005@pindex full-calc-keypad
30006If you have used @kbd{C-x * b} first, @kbd{C-x * k} instead invokes
30007the @code{full-calc-keypad} command, which takes over the whole
30008Emacs screen and displays the keypad, the Calc stack, and the Calc
30009trail all at once. This mode would normally be used when running
30010Calc standalone (@pxref{Standalone Operation}).
30011
30012If you aren't using the X window system, you must switch into
30013the @samp{*Calc Keypad*} window, place the cursor on the desired
30014``key,'' and type @key{SPC} or @key{RET}. If you think this
30015is easier than using Calc normally, go right ahead.
30016
30017Calc commands are more or less the same in Keypad mode. Certain
30018keypad keys differ slightly from the corresponding normal Calc
30019keystrokes; all such deviations are described below.
30020
30021Keypad mode includes many more commands than will fit on the keypad
30022at once. Click the right mouse button [@code{calc-keypad-menu}]
30023to switch to the next menu. The bottom five rows of the keypad
30024stay the same; the top three rows change to a new set of commands.
30025To return to earlier menus, click the middle mouse button
30026[@code{calc-keypad-menu-back}] or simply advance through the menus
30027until you wrap around. Typing @key{TAB} inside the keypad window
30028is equivalent to clicking the right mouse button there.
30029
30030You can always click the @key{EXEC} button and type any normal
30031Calc key sequence. This is equivalent to switching into the
30032Calc buffer, typing the keys, then switching back to your
30033original buffer.
30034
30035@menu
30036* Keypad Main Menu::
30037* Keypad Functions Menu::
30038* Keypad Binary Menu::
30039* Keypad Vectors Menu::
30040* Keypad Modes Menu::
30041@end menu
30042
30043@node Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode, Keypad Mode
30044@section Main Menu
30045
30046@smallexample
30047@group
5a83c46e 30048|----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
4009494e
GM
30049|FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
30050|----+----+----+----+----+----|
30051| LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
30052|----+----+----+----+----+----|
30053|SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
30054|----+----+----+----+----+----|
30055| ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
30056|-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
30057| INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
30058|-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30059| HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
30060|-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30061|EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
30062|-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30063| OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
30064|-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
30065@end group
30066@end smallexample
30067
30068@noindent
30069This is the menu that appears the first time you start Keypad mode.
30070It will show up in a vertical window on the right side of your screen.
30071Above this menu is the traditional Calc stack display. On a 24-line
30072screen you will be able to see the top three stack entries.
30073
30074The ten digit keys, decimal point, and @key{EEX} key are used for
30075entering numbers in the obvious way. @key{EEX} begins entry of an
30076exponent in scientific notation. Just as with regular Calc, the
30077number is pushed onto the stack as soon as you press @key{ENTER}
30078or any other function key.
30079
30080The @key{+/-} key corresponds to normal Calc's @kbd{n} key. During
30081numeric entry it changes the sign of the number or of the exponent.
30082At other times it changes the sign of the number on the top of the
30083stack.
30084
30085The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys modify other keys. As well as
30086having the effects described elsewhere in this manual, Keypad mode
30087defines several other ``inverse'' operations. These are described
30088below and in the following sections.
30089
30090The @key{ENTER} key finishes the current numeric entry, or otherwise
30091duplicates the top entry on the stack.
30092
30093The @key{UNDO} key undoes the most recent Calc operation.
30094@kbd{INV UNDO} is the ``redo'' command, and @kbd{HYP UNDO} is
30095``last arguments'' (@kbd{M-@key{RET}}).
30096
30097The @key{<-} key acts as a ``backspace'' during numeric entry.
30098At other times it removes the top stack entry. @kbd{INV <-}
30099clears the entire stack. @kbd{HYP <-} takes an integer from
30100the stack, then removes that many additional stack elements.
30101
30102The @key{EXEC} key prompts you to enter any keystroke sequence
30103that would normally work in Calc mode. This can include a
30104numeric prefix if you wish. It is also possible simply to
30105switch into the Calc window and type commands in it; there is
30106nothing ``magic'' about this window when Keypad mode is active.
30107
30108The other keys in this display perform their obvious calculator
30109functions. @key{CLN2} rounds the top-of-stack by temporarily
30110reducing the precision by 2 digits. @key{FLT} converts an
30111integer or fraction on the top of the stack to floating-point.
30112
30113The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys combined with several of these keys
30114give you access to some common functions even if the appropriate menu
30115is not displayed. Obviously you don't need to learn these keys
30116unless you find yourself wasting time switching among the menus.
30117
30118@table @kbd
30119@item INV +/-
30120is the same as @key{1/x}.
30121@item INV +
30122is the same as @key{SQRT}.
30123@item INV -
30124is the same as @key{CONJ}.
30125@item INV *
30126is the same as @key{y^x}.
30127@item INV /
30128is the same as @key{INV y^x} (the @expr{x}th root of @expr{y}).
30129@item HYP/INV 1
30130are the same as @key{SIN} / @kbd{INV SIN}.
30131@item HYP/INV 2
30132are the same as @key{COS} / @kbd{INV COS}.
30133@item HYP/INV 3
30134are the same as @key{TAN} / @kbd{INV TAN}.
30135@item INV/HYP 4
30136are the same as @key{LN} / @kbd{HYP LN}.
30137@item INV/HYP 5
30138are the same as @key{EXP} / @kbd{HYP EXP}.
30139@item INV 6
30140is the same as @key{ABS}.
30141@item INV 7
30142is the same as @key{RND} (@code{calc-round}).
30143@item INV 8
30144is the same as @key{CLN2}.
30145@item INV 9
30146is the same as @key{FLT} (@code{calc-float}).
30147@item INV 0
30148is the same as @key{IMAG}.
30149@item INV .
30150is the same as @key{PREC}.
30151@item INV ENTER
30152is the same as @key{SWAP}.
30153@item HYP ENTER
30154is the same as @key{RLL3}.
30155@item INV HYP ENTER
30156is the same as @key{OVER}.
30157@item HYP +/-
30158packs the top two stack entries as an error form.
30159@item HYP EEX
30160packs the top two stack entries as a modulo form.
30161@item INV EEX
30162creates an interval form; this removes an integer which is one
30163of 0 @samp{[]}, 1 @samp{[)}, 2 @samp{(]} or 3 @samp{()}, followed
30164by the two limits of the interval.
30165@end table
30166
30167The @kbd{OFF} key turns Calc off; typing @kbd{C-x * k} or @kbd{C-x * *}
30168again has the same effect. This is analogous to typing @kbd{q} or
30169hitting @kbd{C-x * c} again in the normal calculator. If Calc is
30170running standalone (the @code{full-calc-keypad} command appeared in the
30171command line that started Emacs), then @kbd{OFF} is replaced with
30172@kbd{EXIT}; clicking on this actually exits Emacs itself.
30173
30174@node Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Mode
30175@section Functions Menu
30176
30177@smallexample
30178@group
30179|----+----+----+----+----+----2
30180|IGAM|BETA|IBET|ERF |BESJ|BESY|
30181|----+----+----+----+----+----|
30182|IMAG|CONJ| RE |ATN2|RAND|RAGN|
30183|----+----+----+----+----+----|
30184|GCD |FACT|DFCT|BNOM|PERM|NXTP|
30185|----+----+----+----+----+----|
30186@end group
30187@end smallexample
30188
30189@noindent
30190This menu provides various operations from the @kbd{f} and @kbd{k}
30191prefix keys.
30192
30193@key{IMAG} multiplies the number on the stack by the imaginary
30194number @expr{i = (0, 1)}.
30195
30196@key{RE} extracts the real part a complex number. @kbd{INV RE}
30197extracts the imaginary part.
30198
30199@key{RAND} takes a number from the top of the stack and computes
30200a random number greater than or equal to zero but less than that
30201number. (@xref{Random Numbers}.) @key{RAGN} is the ``random
30202again'' command; it computes another random number using the
30203same limit as last time.
30204
30205@key{INV GCD} computes the LCM (least common multiple) function.
30206
30207@key{INV FACT} is the gamma function.
30208@texline @math{\Gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
30209@infoline @expr{gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
30210
30211@key{PERM} is the number-of-permutations function, which is on the
30212@kbd{H k c} key in normal Calc.
30213
30214@key{NXTP} finds the next prime after a number. @kbd{INV NXTP}
30215finds the previous prime.
30216
30217@node Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode
30218@section Binary Menu
30219
30220@smallexample
30221@group
30222|----+----+----+----+----+----3
30223|AND | OR |XOR |NOT |LSH |RSH |
30224|----+----+----+----+----+----|
30225|DEC |HEX |OCT |BIN |WSIZ|ARSH|
30226|----+----+----+----+----+----|
30227| A | B | C | D | E | F |
30228|----+----+----+----+----+----|
30229@end group
30230@end smallexample
30231
30232@noindent
30233The keys in this menu perform operations on binary integers.
30234Note that both logical and arithmetic right-shifts are provided.
30235@key{INV LSH} rotates one bit to the left.
30236
30237The ``difference'' function (normally on @kbd{b d}) is on @key{INV AND}.
30238The ``clip'' function (normally on @w{@kbd{b c}}) is on @key{INV NOT}.
30239
30240The @key{DEC}, @key{HEX}, @key{OCT}, and @key{BIN} keys select the
30241current radix for display and entry of numbers: Decimal, hexadecimal,
30242octal, or binary. The six letter keys @key{A} through @key{F} are used
30243for entering hexadecimal numbers.
30244
30245The @key{WSIZ} key displays the current word size for binary operations
30246and allows you to enter a new word size. You can respond to the prompt
30247using either the keyboard or the digits and @key{ENTER} from the keypad.
30248The initial word size is 32 bits.
30249
30250@node Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Modes Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Mode
30251@section Vectors Menu
30252
30253@smallexample
30254@group
30255|----+----+----+----+----+----4
30256|SUM |PROD|MAX |MAP*|MAP^|MAP$|
30257|----+----+----+----+----+----|
30258|MINV|MDET|MTRN|IDNT|CRSS|"x" |
30259|----+----+----+----+----+----|
30260|PACK|UNPK|INDX|BLD |LEN |... |
30261|----+----+----+----+----+----|
30262@end group
30263@end smallexample
30264
30265@noindent
30266The keys in this menu operate on vectors and matrices.
30267
30268@key{PACK} removes an integer @var{n} from the top of the stack;
30269the next @var{n} stack elements are removed and packed into a vector,
30270which is replaced onto the stack. Thus the sequence
30271@kbd{1 ENTER 3 ENTER 5 ENTER 3 PACK} enters the vector
30272@samp{[1, 3, 5]} onto the stack. To enter a matrix, build each row
30273on the stack as a vector, then use a final @key{PACK} to collect the
30274rows into a matrix.
30275
30276@key{UNPK} unpacks the vector on the stack, pushing each of its
30277components separately.
30278
30279@key{INDX} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds a vector of
30280integers from 1 to @var{n}. @kbd{INV INDX} takes three numbers
30281from the stack: The vector size @var{n}, the starting number,
30282and the increment. @kbd{BLD} takes an integer @var{n} and any
30283value @var{x} and builds a vector of @var{n} copies of @var{x}.
30284
30285@key{IDNT} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds an @var{n}-by-@var{n}
30286identity matrix.
30287
30288@key{LEN} replaces a vector by its length, an integer.
30289
30290@key{...} turns on or off ``abbreviated'' display mode for large vectors.
30291
30292@key{MINV}, @key{MDET}, @key{MTRN}, and @key{CROSS} are the matrix
30293inverse, determinant, and transpose, and vector cross product.
30294
30295@key{SUM} replaces a vector by the sum of its elements. It is
30296equivalent to @kbd{u +} in normal Calc (@pxref{Statistical Operations}).
30297@key{PROD} computes the product of the elements of a vector, and
30298@key{MAX} computes the maximum of all the elements of a vector.
30299
30300@key{INV SUM} computes the alternating sum of the first element
30301minus the second, plus the third, minus the fourth, and so on.
30302@key{INV MAX} computes the minimum of the vector elements.
30303
30304@key{HYP SUM} computes the mean of the vector elements.
30305@key{HYP PROD} computes the sample standard deviation.
30306@key{HYP MAX} computes the median.
30307
30308@key{MAP*} multiplies two vectors elementwise. It is equivalent
30309to the @kbd{V M *} command. @key{MAP^} computes powers elementwise.
30310The arguments must be vectors of equal length, or one must be a vector
30311and the other must be a plain number. For example, @kbd{2 MAP^} squares
30312all the elements of a vector.
30313
30314@key{MAP$} maps the formula on the top of the stack across the
30315vector in the second-to-top position. If the formula contains
30316several variables, Calc takes that many vectors starting at the
30317second-to-top position and matches them to the variables in
30318alphabetical order. The result is a vector of the same size as
30319the input vectors, whose elements are the formula evaluated with
30320the variables set to the various sets of numbers in those vectors.
30321For example, you could simulate @key{MAP^} using @key{MAP$} with
30322the formula @samp{x^y}.
30323
30324The @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable name @expr{x} onto the
30325stack. To build the formula @expr{x^2 + 6}, you would use the
30326key sequence @kbd{"x" 2 y^x 6 +}. This formula would then be
30327suitable for use with the @key{MAP$} key described above.
30328With @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, or @key{INV} and @key{HYP}, the
30329@kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable names @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and
30330@expr{t}, respectively.
30331
30332@node Keypad Modes Menu, , Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Mode
30333@section Modes Menu
30334
30335@smallexample
30336@group
30337|----+----+----+----+----+----5
30338|FLT |FIX |SCI |ENG |GRP | |
30339|----+----+----+----+----+----|
30340|RAD |DEG |FRAC|POLR|SYMB|PREC|
30341|----+----+----+----+----+----|
30342|SWAP|RLL3|RLL4|OVER|STO |RCL |
30343|----+----+----+----+----+----|
30344@end group
30345@end smallexample
30346
30347@noindent
30348The keys in this menu manipulate modes, variables, and the stack.
30349
30350The @key{FLT}, @key{FIX}, @key{SCI}, and @key{ENG} keys select
30351floating-point, fixed-point, scientific, or engineering notation.
30352@key{FIX} displays two digits after the decimal by default; the
30353others display full precision. With the @key{INV} prefix, these
30354keys pop a number-of-digits argument from the stack.
30355
30356The @key{GRP} key turns grouping of digits with commas on or off.
30357@kbd{INV GRP} enables grouping to the right of the decimal point as
30358well as to the left.
30359
30360The @key{RAD} and @key{DEG} keys switch between radians and degrees
30361for trigonometric functions.
30362
30363The @key{FRAC} key turns Fraction mode on or off. This affects
30364whether commands like @kbd{/} with integer arguments produce
30365fractional or floating-point results.
30366
30367The @key{POLR} key turns Polar mode on or off, determining whether
30368polar or rectangular complex numbers are used by default.
30369
30370The @key{SYMB} key turns Symbolic mode on or off, in which
30371operations that would produce inexact floating-point results
30372are left unevaluated as algebraic formulas.
30373
30374The @key{PREC} key selects the current precision. Answer with
30375the keyboard or with the keypad digit and @key{ENTER} keys.
30376
30377The @key{SWAP} key exchanges the top two stack elements.
30378The @key{RLL3} key rotates the top three stack elements upwards.
30379The @key{RLL4} key rotates the top four stack elements upwards.
30380The @key{OVER} key duplicates the second-to-top stack element.
30381
30382The @key{STO} and @key{RCL} keys are analogous to @kbd{s t} and
30383@kbd{s r} in regular Calc. @xref{Store and Recall}. Click the
30384@key{STO} or @key{RCL} key, then one of the ten digits. (Named
30385variables are not available in Keypad mode.) You can also use,
30386for example, @kbd{STO + 3} to add to register 3.
30387
30388@node Embedded Mode, Programming, Keypad Mode, Top
30389@chapter Embedded Mode
30390
30391@noindent
30392Embedded mode in Calc provides an alternative to copying numbers
30393and formulas back and forth between editing buffers and the Calc
30394stack. In Embedded mode, your editing buffer becomes temporarily
30395linked to the stack and this copying is taken care of automatically.
30396
30397@menu
30398* Basic Embedded Mode::
30399* More About Embedded Mode::
30400* Assignments in Embedded Mode::
30401* Mode Settings in Embedded Mode::
30402* Customizing Embedded Mode::
30403@end menu
30404
30405@node Basic Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30406@section Basic Embedded Mode
30407
30408@noindent
30409@kindex C-x * e
30410@pindex calc-embedded
30411To enter Embedded mode, position the Emacs point (cursor) on a
30412formula in any buffer and press @kbd{C-x * e} (@code{calc-embedded}).
30413Note that @kbd{C-x * e} is not to be used in the Calc stack buffer
30414like most Calc commands, but rather in regular editing buffers that
30415are visiting your own files.
30416
30417Calc will try to guess an appropriate language based on the major mode
30418of the editing buffer. (@xref{Language Modes}.) If the current buffer is
30419in @code{latex-mode}, for example, Calc will set its language to La@TeX{}.
30420Similarly, Calc will use @TeX{} language for @code{tex-mode},
30421@code{plain-tex-mode} and @code{context-mode}, C language for
30422@code{c-mode} and @code{c++-mode}, FORTRAN language for
30423@code{fortran-mode} and @code{f90-mode}, Pascal for @code{pascal-mode},
30424and eqn for @code{nroff-mode} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
30425These can be overridden with Calc's mode
30426changing commands (@pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}). If no
30427suitable language is available, Calc will continue with its current language.
30428
30429Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
30430nearest opening and closing @dfn{formula delimiters}. The simplest
30431delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that Embedded mode
30432understands are:
30433
30434@enumerate
30435@item
30436The @TeX{} and La@TeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
30437@samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
30438@item
30439Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
30440@item
30441Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
30442@item
30443Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
30444@item
30445Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
30446@end enumerate
30447
30448@xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to make Calc recognize
30449your own favorite delimiters. Delimiters like @samp{$ $} can appear
30450on their own separate lines or in-line with the formula.
30451
30452If you give a positive or negative numeric prefix argument, Calc
30453instead uses the current point as one end of the formula, and includes
30454that many lines forward or backward (respectively, including the current
30455line). Explicit delimiters are not necessary in this case.
30456
30457With a prefix argument of zero, Calc uses the current region (delimited
30458by point and mark) instead of formula delimiters. With a prefix
30459argument of @kbd{C-u} only, Calc uses the current line as the formula.
30460
30461@kindex C-x * w
30462@pindex calc-embedded-word
30463The @kbd{C-x * w} (@code{calc-embedded-word}) command will start Embedded
30464mode on the current ``word''; in this case Calc will scan for the first
30465non-numeric character (i.e., the first character that is not a digit,
30466sign, decimal point, or upper- or lower-case @samp{e}) forward and
30467backward to delimit the formula.
30468
30469When you enable Embedded mode for a formula, Calc reads the text
30470between the delimiters and tries to interpret it as a Calc formula.
30471Calc can generally identify @TeX{} formulas and
30472Big-style formulas even if the language mode is wrong. If Calc
30473can't make sense of the formula, it beeps and refuses to enter
30474Embedded mode. But if the current language is wrong, Calc can
30475sometimes parse the formula successfully (but incorrectly);
30476for example, the C expression @samp{atan(a[1])} can be parsed
30477in Normal language mode, but the @code{atan} won't correspond to
30478the built-in @code{arctan} function, and the @samp{a[1]} will be
30479interpreted as @samp{a} times the vector @samp{[1]}!
30480
30481If you press @kbd{C-x * e} or @kbd{C-x * w} to activate an embedded
30482formula which is blank, say with the cursor on the space between
30483the two delimiters @samp{$ $}, Calc will immediately prompt for
30484an algebraic entry.
30485
30486Only one formula in one buffer can be enabled at a time. If you
30487move to another area of the current buffer and give Calc commands,
30488Calc turns Embedded mode off for the old formula and then tries
30489to restart Embedded mode at the new position. Other buffers are
30490not affected by Embedded mode.
30491
30492When Embedded mode begins, Calc pushes the current formula onto
30493the stack. No Calc stack window is created; however, Calc copies
30494the top-of-stack position into the original buffer at all times.
30495You can create a Calc window by hand with @kbd{C-x * o} if you
30496find you need to see the entire stack.
30497
30498For example, typing @kbd{C-x * e} while somewhere in the formula
30499@samp{n>2} in the following line enables Embedded mode on that
30500inequality:
30501
30502@example
30503We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n>2$.
30504@end example
30505
30506@noindent
30507The formula @expr{n>2} will be pushed onto the Calc stack, and
30508the top of stack will be copied back into the editing buffer.
30509This means that spaces will appear around the @samp{>} symbol
30510to match Calc's usual display style:
30511
30512@example
30513We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n > 2$.
30514@end example
30515
30516@noindent
30517No spaces have appeared around the @samp{+} sign because it's
30518in a different formula, one which we have not yet touched with
30519Embedded mode.
30520
30521Now that Embedded mode is enabled, keys you type in this buffer
30522are interpreted as Calc commands. At this point we might use
30523the ``commute'' command @kbd{j C} to reverse the inequality.
30524This is a selection-based command for which we first need to
30525move the cursor onto the operator (@samp{>} in this case) that
30526needs to be commuted.
30527
30528@example
30529We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $2 < n$.
30530@end example
30531
30532The @kbd{C-x * o} command is a useful way to open a Calc window
30533without actually selecting that window. Giving this command
30534verifies that @samp{2 < n} is also on the Calc stack. Typing
30535@kbd{17 @key{RET}} would produce:
30536
30537@example
30538We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $17$.
30539@end example
30540
30541@noindent
30542with @samp{2 < n} and @samp{17} on the stack; typing @key{TAB}
30543at this point will exchange the two stack values and restore
30544@samp{2 < n} to the embedded formula. Even though you can't
30545normally see the stack in Embedded mode, it is still there and
30546it still operates in the same way. But, as with old-fashioned
30547RPN calculators, you can only see the value at the top of the
30548stack at any given time (unless you use @kbd{C-x * o}).
30549
30550Typing @kbd{C-x * e} again turns Embedded mode off. The Calc
30551window reveals that the formula @w{@samp{2 < n}} is automatically
30552removed from the stack, but the @samp{17} is not. Entering
30553Embedded mode always pushes one thing onto the stack, and
30554leaving Embedded mode always removes one thing. Anything else
30555that happens on the stack is entirely your business as far as
30556Embedded mode is concerned.
30557
30558If you press @kbd{C-x * e} in the wrong place by accident, it is
30559possible that Calc will be able to parse the nearby text as a
30560formula and will mangle that text in an attempt to redisplay it
30561``properly'' in the current language mode. If this happens,
30562press @kbd{C-x * e} again to exit Embedded mode, then give the
30563regular Emacs ``undo'' command (@kbd{C-_} or @kbd{C-x u}) to put
30564the text back the way it was before Calc edited it. Note that Calc's
30565own Undo command (typed before you turn Embedded mode back off)
30566will not do you any good, because as far as Calc is concerned
30567you haven't done anything with this formula yet.
30568
30569@node More About Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Basic Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30570@section More About Embedded Mode
30571
30572@noindent
30573When Embedded mode ``activates'' a formula, i.e., when it examines
30574the formula for the first time since the buffer was created or
30575loaded, Calc tries to sense the language in which the formula was
30576written. If the formula contains any La@TeX{}-like @samp{\} sequences,
30577it is parsed (i.e., read) in La@TeX{} mode. If the formula appears to
30578be written in multi-line Big mode, it is parsed in Big mode. Otherwise,
30579it is parsed according to the current language mode.
30580
30581Note that Calc does not change the current language mode according
30582the formula it reads in. Even though it can read a La@TeX{} formula when
30583not in La@TeX{} mode, it will immediately rewrite this formula using
30584whatever language mode is in effect.
30585
30586@tex
30587\bigskip
30588@end tex
30589
30590@kindex d p
30591@pindex calc-show-plain
30592Calc's parser is unable to read certain kinds of formulas. For
30593example, with @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) you can
30594specify matrix display styles which the parser is unable to
30595recognize as matrices. The @kbd{d p} (@code{calc-show-plain})
30596command turns on a mode in which a ``plain'' version of a
30597formula is placed in front of the fully-formatted version.
30598When Calc reads a formula that has such a plain version in
30599front, it reads the plain version and ignores the formatted
30600version.
30601
30602Plain formulas are preceded and followed by @samp{%%%} signs
30603by default. This notation has the advantage that the @samp{%}
30604character begins a comment in @TeX{} and La@TeX{}, so if your formula is
30605embedded in a @TeX{} or La@TeX{} document its plain version will be
30606invisible in the final printed copy. Certain major modes have different
30607delimiters to ensure that the ``plain'' version will be
30608in a comment for those modes, also.
30609See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode} to see how to change the ``plain''
30610formula delimiters.
30611
30612There are several notations which Calc's parser for ``big''
30613formatted formulas can't yet recognize. In particular, it can't
30614read the large symbols for @code{sum}, @code{prod}, and @code{integ},
30615and it can't handle @samp{=>} with the righthand argument omitted.
30616Also, Calc won't recognize special formats you have defined with
30617the @kbd{Z C} command (@pxref{User-Defined Compositions}). In
30618these cases it is important to use ``plain'' mode to make sure
30619Calc will be able to read your formula later.
30620
30621Another example where ``plain'' mode is important is if you have
30622specified a float mode with few digits of precision. Normally
30623any digits that are computed but not displayed will simply be
30624lost when you save and re-load your embedded buffer, but ``plain''
30625mode allows you to make sure that the complete number is present
30626in the file as well as the rounded-down number.
30627
30628@tex
30629\bigskip
30630@end tex
30631
30632Embedded buffers remember active formulas for as long as they
30633exist in Emacs memory. Suppose you have an embedded formula
30634which is @cpi{} to the normal 12 decimal places, and then
30635type @w{@kbd{C-u 5 d n}} to display only five decimal places.
30636If you then type @kbd{d n}, all 12 places reappear because the
30637full number is still there on the Calc stack. More surprisingly,
30638even if you exit Embedded mode and later re-enter it for that
30639formula, typing @kbd{d n} will restore all 12 places because
30640each buffer remembers all its active formulas. However, if you
30641save the buffer in a file and reload it in a new Emacs session,
30642all non-displayed digits will have been lost unless you used
30643``plain'' mode.
30644
30645@tex
30646\bigskip
30647@end tex
30648
30649In some applications of Embedded mode, you will want to have a
30650sequence of copies of a formula that show its evolution as you
30651work on it. For example, you might want to have a sequence
30652like this in your file (elaborating here on the example from
30653the ``Getting Started'' chapter):
30654
30655@smallexample
30656The derivative of
30657
30658 ln(ln(x))
30659
30660is
30661
30662 @r{(the derivative of }ln(ln(x))@r{)}
30663
30664whose value at x = 2 is
30665
30666 @r{(the value)}
30667
30668and at x = 3 is
30669
30670 @r{(the value)}
30671@end smallexample
30672
30673@kindex C-x * d
30674@pindex calc-embedded-duplicate
30675The @kbd{C-x * d} (@code{calc-embedded-duplicate}) command is a
30676handy way to make sequences like this. If you type @kbd{C-x * d},
30677the formula under the cursor (which may or may not have Embedded
30678mode enabled for it at the time) is copied immediately below and
30679Embedded mode is then enabled for that copy.
30680
30681For this example, you would start with just
30682
30683@smallexample
30684The derivative of
30685
30686 ln(ln(x))
30687@end smallexample
30688
30689@noindent
30690and press @kbd{C-x * d} with the cursor on this formula. The result
30691is
30692
30693@smallexample
30694The derivative of
30695
30696 ln(ln(x))
30697
30698
30699 ln(ln(x))
30700@end smallexample
30701
30702@noindent
30703with the second copy of the formula enabled in Embedded mode.
30704You can now press @kbd{a d x @key{RET}} to take the derivative, and
30705@kbd{C-x * d C-x * d} to make two more copies of the derivative.
30706To complete the computations, type @kbd{3 s l x @key{RET}} to evaluate
30707the last formula, then move up to the second-to-last formula
30708and type @kbd{2 s l x @key{RET}}.
30709
30710Finally, you would want to press @kbd{C-x * e} to exit Embedded
30711mode, then go up and insert the necessary text in between the
30712various formulas and numbers.
30713
30714@tex
30715\bigskip
30716@end tex
30717
30718@kindex C-x * f
30719@kindex C-x * '
30720@pindex calc-embedded-new-formula
30721The @kbd{C-x * f} (@code{calc-embedded-new-formula}) command
30722creates a new embedded formula at the current point. It inserts
30723some default delimiters, which are usually just blank lines,
30724and then does an algebraic entry to get the formula (which is
30725then enabled for Embedded mode). This is just shorthand for
30726typing the delimiters yourself, positioning the cursor between
30727the new delimiters, and pressing @kbd{C-x * e}. The key sequence
30728@kbd{C-x * '} is equivalent to @kbd{C-x * f}.
30729
30730@kindex C-x * n
30731@kindex C-x * p
30732@pindex calc-embedded-next
30733@pindex calc-embedded-previous
30734The @kbd{C-x * n} (@code{calc-embedded-next}) and @kbd{C-x * p}
30735(@code{calc-embedded-previous}) commands move the cursor to the
30736next or previous active embedded formula in the buffer. They
30737can take positive or negative prefix arguments to move by several
30738formulas. Note that these commands do not actually examine the
30739text of the buffer looking for formulas; they only see formulas
30740which have previously been activated in Embedded mode. In fact,
30741@kbd{C-x * n} and @kbd{C-x * p} are a useful way to tell which
30742embedded formulas are currently active. Also, note that these
30743commands do not enable Embedded mode on the next or previous
30744formula, they just move the cursor.
30745
30746@kindex C-x * `
30747@pindex calc-embedded-edit
30748The @kbd{C-x * `} (@code{calc-embedded-edit}) command edits the
30749embedded formula at the current point as if by @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}).
30750Embedded mode does not have to be enabled for this to work. Press
30751@kbd{C-c C-c} to finish the edit, or @kbd{C-x k} to cancel.
30752
30753@node Assignments in Embedded Mode, Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30754@section Assignments in Embedded Mode
30755
30756@noindent
30757The @samp{:=} (assignment) and @samp{=>} (``evaluates-to'') operators
30758are especially useful in Embedded mode. They allow you to make
30759a definition in one formula, then refer to that definition in
30760other formulas embedded in the same buffer.
30761
30762An embedded formula which is an assignment to a variable, as in
30763
30764@example
30765foo := 5
30766@end example
30767
30768@noindent
30769records @expr{5} as the stored value of @code{foo} for the
30770purposes of Embedded mode operations in the current buffer. It
30771does @emph{not} actually store @expr{5} as the ``global'' value
30772of @code{foo}, however. Regular Calc operations, and Embedded
30773formulas in other buffers, will not see this assignment.
30774
30775One way to use this assigned value is simply to create an
30776Embedded formula elsewhere that refers to @code{foo}, and to press
30777@kbd{=} in that formula. However, this permanently replaces the
30778@code{foo} in the formula with its current value. More interesting
30779is to use @samp{=>} elsewhere:
30780
30781@example
30782foo + 7 => 12
30783@end example
30784
30785@xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a general discussion of @samp{=>}.
30786
30787If you move back and change the assignment to @code{foo}, any
30788@samp{=>} formulas which refer to it are automatically updated.
30789
30790@example
30791foo := 17
30792
30793foo + 7 => 24
30794@end example
30795
30796The obvious question then is, @emph{how} can one easily change the
30797assignment to @code{foo}? If you simply select the formula in
30798Embedded mode and type 17, the assignment itself will be replaced
30799by the 17. The effect on the other formula will be that the
30800variable @code{foo} becomes unassigned:
30801
30802@example
3080317
30804
30805foo + 7 => foo + 7
30806@end example
30807
30808The right thing to do is first to use a selection command (@kbd{j 2}
30809will do the trick) to select the righthand side of the assignment.
30810Then, @kbd{17 @key{TAB} @key{DEL}} will swap the 17 into place (@pxref{Selecting
30811Subformulas}, to see how this works).
30812
30813@kindex C-x * j
30814@pindex calc-embedded-select
30815The @kbd{C-x * j} (@code{calc-embedded-select}) command provides an
30816easy way to operate on assignments. It is just like @kbd{C-x * e},
30817except that if the enabled formula is an assignment, it uses
30818@kbd{j 2} to select the righthand side. If the enabled formula
30819is an evaluates-to, it uses @kbd{j 1} to select the lefthand side.
30820A formula can also be a combination of both:
30821
30822@example
30823bar := foo + 3 => 20
30824@end example
30825
30826@noindent
30827in which case @kbd{C-x * j} will select the middle part (@samp{foo + 3}).
30828
30829The formula is automatically deselected when you leave Embedded
30830mode.
30831
30832@kindex C-x * u
30833@pindex calc-embedded-update-formula
30834Another way to change the assignment to @code{foo} would simply be
30835to edit the number using regular Emacs editing rather than Embedded
30836mode. Then, we have to find a way to get Embedded mode to notice
30837the change. The @kbd{C-x * u} (@code{calc-embedded-update-formula})
30838command is a convenient way to do this.
30839
30840@example
30841foo := 6
30842
30843foo + 7 => 13
30844@end example
30845
30846Pressing @kbd{C-x * u} is much like pressing @kbd{C-x * e = C-x * e}, that
30847is, temporarily enabling Embedded mode for the formula under the
30848cursor and then evaluating it with @kbd{=}. But @kbd{C-x * u} does
30849not actually use @kbd{C-x * e}, and in fact another formula somewhere
30850else can be enabled in Embedded mode while you use @kbd{C-x * u} and
30851that formula will not be disturbed.
30852
30853With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * u} updates all active
30854@samp{=>} formulas in the buffer. Formulas which have not yet
30855been activated in Embedded mode, and formulas which do not have
30856@samp{=>} as their top-level operator, are not affected by this.
30857(This is useful only if you have used @kbd{m C}; see below.)
30858
30859With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{C-u C-x * u} updates only in the
30860region between mark and point rather than in the whole buffer.
30861
30862@kbd{C-x * u} is also a handy way to activate a formula, such as an
30863@samp{=>} formula that has freshly been typed in or loaded from a
30864file.
30865
30866@kindex C-x * a
30867@pindex calc-embedded-activate
30868The @kbd{C-x * a} (@code{calc-embedded-activate}) command scans
30869through the current buffer and activates all embedded formulas
30870that contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols. This does not mean
30871that Embedded mode is actually turned on, but only that the
30872formulas' positions are registered with Embedded mode so that
30873the @samp{=>} values can be properly updated as assignments are
30874changed.
30875
30876It is a good idea to type @kbd{C-x * a} right after loading a file
30877that uses embedded @samp{=>} operators. Emacs includes a nifty
30878``buffer-local variables'' feature that you can use to do this
30879automatically. The idea is to place near the end of your file
30880a few lines that look like this:
30881
30882@example
30883--- Local Variables: ---
30884--- eval:(calc-embedded-activate) ---
30885--- End: ---
30886@end example
30887
30888@noindent
30889where the leading and trailing @samp{---} can be replaced by
30890any suitable strings (which must be the same on all three lines)
30891or omitted altogether; in a @TeX{} or La@TeX{} file, @samp{%} would be a good
30892leading string and no trailing string would be necessary. In a
30893C program, @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} would be good leading and
30894trailing strings.
30895
30896When Emacs loads a file into memory, it checks for a Local Variables
30897section like this one at the end of the file. If it finds this
30898section, it does the specified things (in this case, running
30899@kbd{C-x * a} automatically) before editing of the file begins.
30900The Local Variables section must be within 3000 characters of the
30901end of the file for Emacs to find it, and it must be in the last
30902page of the file if the file has any page separators.
30903@xref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the
30904Emacs manual}.
30905
30906Note that @kbd{C-x * a} does not update the formulas it finds.
30907To do this, type, say, @kbd{M-1 C-x * u} after @w{@kbd{C-x * a}}.
30908Generally this should not be a problem, though, because the
30909formulas will have been up-to-date already when the file was
30910saved.
30911
30912Normally, @kbd{C-x * a} activates all the formulas it finds, but
30913any previous active formulas remain active as well. With a
30914positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * a} first deactivates
30915all current active formulas, then actives the ones it finds in
30916its scan of the buffer. With a negative prefix argument,
30917@kbd{C-x * a} simply deactivates all formulas.
30918
30919Embedded mode has two symbols, @samp{Active} and @samp{~Active},
30920which it puts next to the major mode name in a buffer's mode line.
30921It puts @samp{Active} if it has reason to believe that all
30922formulas in the buffer are active, because you have typed @kbd{C-x * a}
30923and Calc has not since had to deactivate any formulas (which can
30924happen if Calc goes to update an @samp{=>} formula somewhere because
30925a variable changed, and finds that the formula is no longer there
30926due to some kind of editing outside of Embedded mode). Calc puts
30927@samp{~Active} in the mode line if some, but probably not all,
30928formulas in the buffer are active. This happens if you activate
30929a few formulas one at a time but never use @kbd{C-x * a}, or if you
30930used @kbd{C-x * a} but then Calc had to deactivate a formula
30931because it lost track of it. If neither of these symbols appears
30932in the mode line, no embedded formulas are active in the buffer
30933(e.g., before Embedded mode has been used, or after a @kbd{M-- C-x * a}).
30934
30935Embedded formulas can refer to assignments both before and after them
30936in the buffer. If there are several assignments to a variable, the
30937nearest preceding assignment is used if there is one, otherwise the
30938following assignment is used.
30939
30940@example
30941x => 1
30942
30943x := 1
30944
30945x => 1
30946
30947x := 2
30948
30949x => 2
30950@end example
30951
30952As well as simple variables, you can also assign to subscript
30953expressions of the form @samp{@var{var}_@var{number}} (as in
30954@code{x_0}), or @samp{@var{var}_@var{var}} (as in @code{x_max}).
30955Assignments to other kinds of objects can be represented by Calc,
30956but the automatic linkage between assignments and references works
30957only for plain variables and these two kinds of subscript expressions.
30958
30959If there are no assignments to a given variable, the global
30960stored value for the variable is used (@pxref{Storing Variables}),
30961or, if no value is stored, the variable is left in symbolic form.
30962Note that global stored values will be lost when the file is saved
30963and loaded in a later Emacs session, unless you have used the
30964@kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save them;
30965@pxref{Operations on Variables}.
30966
30967The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns automatic
30968recomputation of @samp{=>} forms on and off. If you turn automatic
30969recomputation off, you will have to use @kbd{C-x * u} to update these
30970formulas manually after an assignment has been changed. If you
30971plan to change several assignments at once, it may be more efficient
30972to type @kbd{m C}, change all the assignments, then use @kbd{M-1 C-x * u}
30973to update the entire buffer afterwards. The @kbd{m C} command also
30974controls @samp{=>} formulas on the stack; @pxref{Evaluates-To
30975Operator}. When you turn automatic recomputation back on, the
30976stack will be updated but the Embedded buffer will not; you must
30977use @kbd{C-x * u} to update the buffer by hand.
30978
30979@node Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Customizing Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30980@section Mode Settings in Embedded Mode
30981
30982@kindex m e
30983@pindex calc-embedded-preserve-modes
30984@noindent
30985The mode settings can be changed while Calc is in embedded mode, but
30986by default they will revert to their original values when embedded mode
30987is ended. However, the modes saved when the mode-recording mode is
30988@code{Save} (see below) and the modes in effect when the @kbd{m e}
30989(@code{calc-embedded-preserve-modes}) command is given
30990will be preserved when embedded mode is ended.
30991
30992Embedded mode has a rather complicated mechanism for handling mode
30993settings in Embedded formulas. It is possible to put annotations
30994in the file that specify mode settings either global to the entire
30995file or local to a particular formula or formulas. In the latter
30996case, different modes can be specified for use when a formula
30997is the enabled Embedded mode formula.
30998
30999When you give any mode-setting command, like @kbd{m f} (for Fraction
31000mode) or @kbd{d s} (for scientific notation), Embedded mode adds
31001a line like the following one to the file just before the opening
31002delimiter of the formula.
31003
31004@example
31005% [calc-mode: fractions: t]
31006% [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
31007@end example
31008
31009When Calc interprets an embedded formula, it scans the text before
31010the formula for mode-setting annotations like these and sets the
31011Calc buffer to match these modes. Modes not explicitly described
31012in the file are not changed. Calc scans all the way to the top of
31013the file, or up to a line of the form
31014
31015@example
31016% [calc-defaults]
31017@end example
31018
31019@noindent
31020which you can insert at strategic places in the file if this backward
31021scan is getting too slow, or just to provide a barrier between one
31022``zone'' of mode settings and another.
31023
31024If the file contains several annotations for the same mode, the
31025closest one before the formula is used. Annotations after the
31026formula are never used (except for global annotations, described
31027below).
31028
31029The scan does not look for the leading @samp{% }, only for the
31030square brackets and the text they enclose. In fact, the leading
31031characters are different for different major modes. You can edit the
31032mode annotations to a style that works better in context if you wish.
31033@xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to change the style
31034that Calc uses when it generates the annotations. You can write
31035mode annotations into the file yourself if you know the syntax;
31036the easiest way to find the syntax for a given mode is to let
31037Calc write the annotation for it once and see what it does.
31038
31039If you give a mode-changing command for a mode that already has
31040a suitable annotation just above the current formula, Calc will
31041modify that annotation rather than generating a new, conflicting
31042one.
31043
31044Mode annotations have three parts, separated by colons. (Spaces
31045after the colons are optional.) The first identifies the kind
31046of mode setting, the second is a name for the mode itself, and
31047the third is the value in the form of a Lisp symbol, number,
31048or list. Annotations with unrecognizable text in the first or
31049second parts are ignored. The third part is not checked to make
31050sure the value is of a valid type or range; if you write an
31051annotation by hand, be sure to give a proper value or results
31052will be unpredictable. Mode-setting annotations are case-sensitive.
31053
31054While Embedded mode is enabled, the word @code{Local} appears in
31055the mode line. This is to show that mode setting commands generate
31056annotations that are ``local'' to the current formula or set of
31057formulas. The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command
31058causes Calc to generate different kinds of annotations. Pressing
31059@kbd{m R} repeatedly cycles through the possible modes.
31060
31061@code{LocEdit} and @code{LocPerm} modes generate annotations
31062that look like this, respectively:
31063
31064@example
31065% [calc-edit-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
31066% [calc-perm-mode: float-format: (sci 5)]
31067@end example
31068
31069The first kind of annotation will be used only while a formula
31070is enabled in Embedded mode. The second kind will be used only
31071when the formula is @emph{not} enabled. (Whether the formula
31072is ``active'' or not, i.e., whether Calc has seen this formula
31073yet, is not relevant here.)
31074
31075@code{Global} mode generates an annotation like this at the end
31076of the file:
31077
31078@example
31079% [calc-global-mode: fractions t]
31080@end example
31081
31082Global mode annotations affect all formulas throughout the file,
31083and may appear anywhere in the file. This allows you to tuck your
31084mode annotations somewhere out of the way, say, on a new page of
31085the file, as long as those mode settings are suitable for all
31086formulas in the file.
31087
31088Enabling a formula with @kbd{C-x * e} causes a fresh scan for local
31089mode annotations; you will have to use this after adding annotations
31090above a formula by hand to get the formula to notice them. Updating
31091a formula with @kbd{C-x * u} will also re-scan the local modes, but
31092global modes are only re-scanned by @kbd{C-x * a}.
31093
31094Another way that modes can get out of date is if you add a local
31095mode annotation to a formula that has another formula after it.
31096In this example, we have used the @kbd{d s} command while the
31097first of the two embedded formulas is active. But the second
31098formula has not changed its style to match, even though by the
31099rules of reading annotations the @samp{(sci 0)} applies to it, too.
31100
31101@example
31102% [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
311031.23e2
31104
31105456.
31106@end example
31107
31108We would have to go down to the other formula and press @kbd{C-x * u}
31109on it in order to get it to notice the new annotation.
31110
31111Two more mode-recording modes selectable by @kbd{m R} are available
31112which are also available outside of Embedded mode.
31113(@pxref{General Mode Commands}.) They are @code{Save}, in which mode
31114settings are recorded permanently in your Calc init file (the file given
dcf7843e 31115by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el})
4009494e
GM
31116rather than by annotating the current document, and no-recording
31117mode (where there is no symbol like @code{Save} or @code{Local} in
31118the mode line), in which mode-changing commands do not leave any
31119annotations at all.
31120
31121When Embedded mode is not enabled, mode-recording modes except
31122for @code{Save} have no effect.
31123
31124@node Customizing Embedded Mode, , Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
31125@section Customizing Embedded Mode
31126
31127@noindent
31128You can modify Embedded mode's behavior by setting various Lisp
31129variables described here. These variables are customizable
31130(@pxref{Customizing Calc}), or you can use @kbd{M-x set-variable}
31131or @kbd{M-x edit-options} to adjust a variable on the fly.
31132(Another possibility would be to use a file-local variable annotation at
31133the end of the file;
31134@pxref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the Emacs manual}.)
31135Many of the variables given mentioned here can be set to depend on the
31136major mode of the editing buffer (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
31137
31138@vindex calc-embedded-open-formula
31139The @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} variable holds a regular
31140expression for the opening delimiter of a formula. @xref{Regexp Search,
31141, Regular Expression Search, emacs, the Emacs manual}, to see
31142how regular expressions work. Basically, a regular expression is a
31143pattern that Calc can search for. A regular expression that considers
31144blank lines, @samp{$}, and @samp{$$} to be opening delimiters is
31145@code{"\\`\\|^\n\\|\\$\\$?"}. Just in case the meaning of this
31146regular expression is not completely plain, let's go through it
31147in detail.
31148
31149The surrounding @samp{" "} marks quote the text between them as a
31150Lisp string. If you left them off, @code{set-variable} or
31151@code{edit-options} would try to read the regular expression as a
31152Lisp program.
31153
31154The most obvious property of this regular expression is that it
31155contains indecently many backslashes. There are actually two levels
31156of backslash usage going on here. First, when Lisp reads a quoted
31157string, all pairs of characters beginning with a backslash are
31158interpreted as special characters. Here, @code{\n} changes to a
31159new-line character, and @code{\\} changes to a single backslash.
31160So the actual regular expression seen by Calc is
31161@samp{\`\|^ @r{(newline)} \|\$\$?}.
31162
31163Regular expressions also consider pairs beginning with backslash
31164to have special meanings. Sometimes the backslash is used to quote
31165a character that otherwise would have a special meaning in a regular
31166expression, like @samp{$}, which normally means ``end-of-line,''
31167or @samp{?}, which means that the preceding item is optional. So
31168@samp{\$\$?} matches either one or two dollar signs.
31169
31170The other codes in this regular expression are @samp{^}, which matches
31171``beginning-of-line,'' @samp{\|}, which means ``or,'' and @samp{\`},
31172which matches ``beginning-of-buffer.'' So the whole pattern means
31173that a formula begins at the beginning of the buffer, or on a newline
31174that occurs at the beginning of a line (i.e., a blank line), or at
31175one or two dollar signs.
31176
31177The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} looks just
31178like this example, with several more alternatives added on to
31179recognize various other common kinds of delimiters.
31180
31181By the way, the reason to use @samp{^\n} rather than @samp{^$}
31182or @samp{\n\n}, which also would appear to match blank lines,
31183is that the former expression actually ``consumes'' only one
31184newline character as @emph{part of} the delimiter, whereas the
31185latter expressions consume zero or two newlines, respectively.
31186The former choice gives the most natural behavior when Calc
31187must operate on a whole formula including its delimiters.
31188
31189See the Emacs manual for complete details on regular expressions.
31190But just for your convenience, here is a list of all characters
31191which must be quoted with backslash (like @samp{\$}) to avoid
31192some special interpretation: @samp{. * + ? [ ] ^ $ \}. (Note
31193the backslash in this list; for example, to match @samp{\[} you
31194must use @code{"\\\\\\["}. An exercise for the reader is to
31195account for each of these six backslashes!)
31196
31197@vindex calc-embedded-close-formula
31198The @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} variable holds a regular
31199expression for the closing delimiter of a formula. A closing
31200regular expression to match the above example would be
31201@code{"\\'\\|\n$\\|\\$\\$?"}. This is almost the same as the
31202other one, except it now uses @samp{\'} (``end-of-buffer'') and
31203@samp{\n$} (newline occurring at end of line, yet another way
31204of describing a blank line that is more appropriate for this
31205case).
31206
4a65fb7a
JB
31207@vindex calc-embedded-word-regexp
31208The @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} variable holds a regular expression
31209used to define an expression to look for (a ``word'') when you type
31210@kbd{C-x * w} to enable Embedded mode.
4009494e
GM
31211
31212@vindex calc-embedded-open-plain
31213The @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} variable is a string which
31214begins a ``plain'' formula written in front of the formatted
31215formula when @kbd{d p} mode is turned on. Note that this is an
31216actual string, not a regular expression, because Calc must be able
31217to write this string into a buffer as well as to recognize it.
31218The default string is @code{"%%% "} (note the trailing space), but may
31219be different for certain major modes.
31220
31221@vindex calc-embedded-close-plain
31222The @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} variable is a string which
31223ends a ``plain'' formula. The default is @code{" %%%\n"}, but may be
31224different for different major modes. Without
31225the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
31226that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
31227
31228@vindex calc-embedded-open-new-formula
31229The @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} variable is a string
31230which is inserted at the front of a new formula when you type
31231@kbd{C-x * f}. Its default value is @code{"\n\n"}. If this
31232string begins with a newline character and the @kbd{C-x * f} is
31233typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip this
31234first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in
31235the file.
31236
31237@vindex calc-embedded-close-new-formula
31238The @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} variable is the corresponding
31239string which is inserted at the end of a new formula. Its default
31240value is also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by
31241@w{@kbd{C-x * f}} if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if
31242@kbd{C-x * f} is typed on a blank line, both a leading opening
31243newline and a trailing closing newline are omitted.)
31244
31245@vindex calc-embedded-announce-formula
31246The @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} variable is a regular
31247expression which is sure to be followed by an embedded formula.
31248The @kbd{C-x * a} command searches for this pattern as well as for
31249@samp{=>} and @samp{:=} operators. Note that @kbd{C-x * a} will
31250not activate just anything surrounded by formula delimiters; after
31251all, blank lines are considered formula delimiters by default!
31252But if your language includes a delimiter which can only occur
31253actually in front of a formula, you can take advantage of it here.
31254The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, but may be
31255different for different major modes.
31256This pattern will check for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of
31257lines beginning with @samp{%} and a space. This last is important to
31258make Calc consider mode annotations part of the pattern, so that the
31259formula's opening delimiter really is sure to follow the pattern.
31260
31261@vindex calc-embedded-open-mode
31262The @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} variable is a string (not a
31263regular expression) which should precede a mode annotation.
31264Calc never scans for this string; Calc always looks for the
31265annotation itself. But this is the string that is inserted before
31266the opening bracket when Calc adds an annotation on its own.
31267The default is @code{"% "}, but may be different for different major
31268modes.
31269
31270@vindex calc-embedded-close-mode
31271The @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} variable is a string which
31272follows a mode annotation written by Calc. Its default value
31273is simply a newline, @code{"\n"}, but may be different for different
31274major modes. If you change this, it is a good idea still to end with a
31275newline so that mode annotations will appear on lines by themselves.
31276
31277@node Programming, Copying, Embedded Mode, Top
31278@chapter Programming
31279
31280@noindent
31281There are several ways to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator, depending
31282on the nature of the problem you need to solve.
31283
31284@enumerate
31285@item
31286@dfn{Keyboard macros} allow you to record a sequence of keystrokes
31287and play them back at a later time. This is just the standard Emacs
31288keyboard macro mechanism, dressed up with a few more features such
31289as loops and conditionals.
31290
31291@item
31292@dfn{Algebraic definitions} allow you to use any formula to define a
31293new function. This function can then be used in algebraic formulas or
31294as an interactive command.
31295
31296@item
31297@dfn{Rewrite rules} are discussed in the section on algebra commands.
31298@xref{Rewrite Rules}. If you put your rewrite rules in the variable
31299@code{EvalRules}, they will be applied automatically to all Calc
31300results in just the same way as an internal ``rule'' is applied to
31301evaluate @samp{sqrt(9)} to 3 and so on. @xref{Automatic Rewrites}.
31302
31303@item
31304@dfn{Lisp} is the programming language that Calc (and most of Emacs)
31305is written in. If the above techniques aren't powerful enough, you
31306can write Lisp functions to do anything that built-in Calc commands
31307can do. Lisp code is also somewhat faster than keyboard macros or
31308rewrite rules.
31309@end enumerate
31310
31311@kindex z
31312Programming features are available through the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z}
31313prefix keys. New commands that you define are two-key sequences
31314beginning with @kbd{z}. Commands for managing these definitions
31315use the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix. (The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing})
31316command is described elsewhere; @pxref{Troubleshooting Commands}.
31317The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command is also
31318described elsewhere; @pxref{User-Defined Compositions}.)
31319
31320@menu
31321* Creating User Keys::
31322* Keyboard Macros::
31323* Invocation Macros::
31324* Algebraic Definitions::
31325* Lisp Definitions::
31326@end menu
31327
31328@node Creating User Keys, Keyboard Macros, Programming, Programming
31329@section Creating User Keys
31330
31331@noindent
31332@kindex Z D
31333@pindex calc-user-define
31334Any Calculator command may be bound to a key using the @kbd{Z D}
31335(@code{calc-user-define}) command. Actually, it is bound to a two-key
31336sequence beginning with the lower-case @kbd{z} prefix.
31337
31338The @kbd{Z D} command first prompts for the key to define. For example,
31339press @kbd{Z D a} to define the new key sequence @kbd{z a}. You are then
31340prompted for the name of the Calculator command that this key should
31341run. For example, the @code{calc-sincos} command is not normally
31342available on a key. Typing @kbd{Z D s sincos @key{RET}} programs the
31343@kbd{z s} key sequence to run @code{calc-sincos}. This definition will remain
31344in effect for the rest of this Emacs session, or until you redefine
31345@kbd{z s} to be something else.
31346
31347You can actually bind any Emacs command to a @kbd{z} key sequence by
31348backspacing over the @samp{calc-} when you are prompted for the command name.
31349
31350As with any other prefix key, you can type @kbd{z ?} to see a list of
31351all the two-key sequences you have defined that start with @kbd{z}.
31352Initially, no @kbd{z} sequences (except @kbd{z ?} itself) are defined.
31353
31354User keys are typically letters, but may in fact be any key.
31355(@key{META}-keys are not permitted, nor are a terminal's special
31356function keys which generate multi-character sequences when pressed.)
31357You can define different commands on the shifted and unshifted versions
31358of a letter if you wish.
31359
31360@kindex Z U
31361@pindex calc-user-undefine
31362The @kbd{Z U} (@code{calc-user-undefine}) command unbinds a user key.
31363For example, the key sequence @kbd{Z U s} will undefine the @code{sincos}
31364key we defined above.
31365
31366@kindex Z P
31367@pindex calc-user-define-permanent
31368@cindex Storing user definitions
31369@cindex Permanent user definitions
31370@cindex Calc init file, user-defined commands
31371The @kbd{Z P} (@code{calc-user-define-permanent}) command makes a key
31372binding permanent so that it will remain in effect even in future Emacs
31373sessions. (It does this by adding a suitable bit of Lisp code into
31374your Calc init file; that is, the file given by the variable
dcf7843e 31375@code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}.) For example,
4009494e
GM
31376@kbd{Z P s} would register our @code{sincos} command permanently. If
31377you later wish to unregister this command you must edit your Calc init
31378file by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
31379use a different file for the Calc init file.)
31380
31381The @kbd{Z P} command also saves the user definition, if any, for the
31382command bound to the key. After @kbd{Z F} and @kbd{Z C}, a given user
31383key could invoke a command, which in turn calls an algebraic function,
31384which might have one or more special display formats. A single @kbd{Z P}
31385command will save all of these definitions.
31386To save an algebraic function, type @kbd{'} (the apostrophe)
31387when prompted for a key, and type the function name. To save a command
31388without its key binding, type @kbd{M-x} and enter a function name. (The
31389@samp{calc-} prefix will automatically be inserted for you.)
31390(If the command you give implies a function, the function will be saved,
31391and if the function has any display formats, those will be saved, but
31392not the other way around: Saving a function will not save any commands
31393or key bindings associated with the function.)
31394
31395@kindex Z E
31396@pindex calc-user-define-edit
31397@cindex Editing user definitions
31398The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command edits the definition
31399of a user key. This works for keys that have been defined by either
31400keyboard macros or formulas; further details are contained in the relevant
31401following sections.
31402
31403@node Keyboard Macros, Invocation Macros, Creating User Keys, Programming
31404@section Programming with Keyboard Macros
31405
31406@noindent
31407@kindex X
31408@cindex Programming with keyboard macros
31409@cindex Keyboard macros
31410The easiest way to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator is to use standard
31411keyboard macros. Press @w{@kbd{C-x (}} to begin recording a macro. From
31412this point on, keystrokes you type will be saved away as well as
31413performing their usual functions. Press @kbd{C-x )} to end recording.
31414Press shift-@kbd{X} (or the standard Emacs key sequence @kbd{C-x e}) to
31415execute your keyboard macro by replaying the recorded keystrokes.
31416@xref{Keyboard Macros, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for further
31417information.
31418
31419When you use @kbd{X} to invoke a keyboard macro, the entire macro is
31420treated as a single command by the undo and trail features. The stack
31421display buffer is not updated during macro execution, but is instead
31422fixed up once the macro completes. Thus, commands defined with keyboard
31423macros are convenient and efficient. The @kbd{C-x e} command, on the
31424other hand, invokes the keyboard macro with no special treatment: Each
31425command in the macro will record its own undo information and trail entry,
31426and update the stack buffer accordingly. If your macro uses features
31427outside of Calc's control to operate on the contents of the Calc stack
31428buffer, or if it includes Undo, Redo, or last-arguments commands, you
31429must use @kbd{C-x e} to make sure the buffer and undo list are up-to-date
31430at all times. You could also consider using @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args})
31431instead of @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
31432
31433Calc extends the standard Emacs keyboard macros in several ways.
31434Keyboard macros can be used to create user-defined commands. Keyboard
31435macros can include conditional and iteration structures, somewhat
31436analogous to those provided by a traditional programmable calculator.
31437
31438@menu
31439* Naming Keyboard Macros::
31440* Conditionals in Macros::
31441* Loops in Macros::
31442* Local Values in Macros::
31443* Queries in Macros::
31444@end menu
31445
31446@node Naming Keyboard Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31447@subsection Naming Keyboard Macros
31448
31449@noindent
31450@kindex Z K
31451@pindex calc-user-define-kbd-macro
31452Once you have defined a keyboard macro, you can bind it to a @kbd{z}
31453key sequence with the @kbd{Z K} (@code{calc-user-define-kbd-macro}) command.
31454This command prompts first for a key, then for a command name. For
31455example, if you type @kbd{C-x ( n @key{TAB} n @key{TAB} C-x )} you will
31456define a keyboard macro which negates the top two numbers on the stack
31457(@key{TAB} swaps the top two stack elements). Now you can type
31458@kbd{Z K n @key{RET}} to define this keyboard macro onto the @kbd{z n} key
31459sequence. The default command name (if you answer the second prompt with
31460just the @key{RET} key as in this example) will be something like
31461@samp{calc-User-n}. The keyboard macro will now be available as both
31462@kbd{z n} and @kbd{M-x calc-User-n}. You can backspace and enter a more
31463descriptive command name if you wish.
31464
31465Macros defined by @kbd{Z K} act like single commands; they are executed
31466in the same way as by the @kbd{X} key. If you wish to define the macro
31467as a standard no-frills Emacs macro (to be executed as if by @kbd{C-x e}),
31468give a negative prefix argument to @kbd{Z K}.
31469
31470Once you have bound your keyboard macro to a key, you can use
31471@kbd{Z P} to register it permanently with Emacs. @xref{Creating User Keys}.
31472
31473@cindex Keyboard macros, editing
31474The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31475been defined by a keyboard macro tries to use the @code{edmacro} package
31476edit the macro. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and update
31477the definition stored on the key, or, to cancel the edit, kill the
31478buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
31479The special characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC},
31480@code{DEL}, and @code{NUL} must be entered as these three character
31481sequences, written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes @code{C-} and
31482@code{M-}. Spaces and line breaks are ignored. Other characters are
31483copied verbatim into the keyboard macro. Basically, the notation is the
31484same as is used in all of this manual's examples, except that the manual
31485takes some liberties with spaces: When we say @kbd{' [1 2 3] @key{RET}},
31486we take it for granted that it is clear we really mean
31487@kbd{' [1 @key{SPC} 2 @key{SPC} 3] @key{RET}}.
31488
31489@kindex C-x * m
31490@pindex read-kbd-macro
31491The @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) command reads an Emacs ``region''
31492of spelled-out keystrokes and defines it as the current keyboard macro.
31493It is a convenient way to define a keyboard macro that has been stored
31494in a file, or to define a macro without executing it at the same time.
31495
31496@node Conditionals in Macros, Loops in Macros, Naming Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31497@subsection Conditionals in Keyboard Macros
31498
31499@noindent
31500@kindex Z [
31501@kindex Z ]
31502@pindex calc-kbd-if
31503@pindex calc-kbd-else
31504@pindex calc-kbd-else-if
31505@pindex calc-kbd-end-if
31506@cindex Conditional structures
31507The @kbd{Z [} (@code{calc-kbd-if}) and @kbd{Z ]} (@code{calc-kbd-end-if})
31508commands allow you to put simple tests in a keyboard macro. When Calc
31509sees the @kbd{Z [}, it pops an object from the stack and, if the object is
31510a non-zero value, continues executing keystrokes. But if the object is
31511zero, or if it is not provably nonzero, Calc skips ahead to the matching
31512@kbd{Z ]} keystroke. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a set of commands for
31513performing tests which conveniently produce 1 for true and 0 for false.
31514
31515For example, @kbd{@key{RET} 0 a < Z [ n Z ]} implements an absolute-value
31516function in the form of a keyboard macro. This macro duplicates the
31517number on the top of the stack, pushes zero and compares using @kbd{a <}
31518(@code{calc-less-than}), then, if the number was less than zero,
31519executes @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}). Otherwise, the change-sign
31520command is skipped.
31521
31522To program this macro, type @kbd{C-x (}, type the above sequence of
31523keystrokes, then type @kbd{C-x )}. Note that the keystrokes will be
31524executed while you are making the definition as well as when you later
31525re-execute the macro by typing @kbd{X}. Thus you should make sure a
31526suitable number is on the stack before defining the macro so that you
31527don't get a stack-underflow error during the definition process.
31528
31529Conditionals can be nested arbitrarily. However, there should be exactly
31530one @kbd{Z ]} for each @kbd{Z [} in a keyboard macro.
31531
31532@kindex Z :
31533The @kbd{Z :} (@code{calc-kbd-else}) command allows you to choose between
31534two keystroke sequences. The general format is @kbd{@var{cond} Z [
31535@var{then-part} Z : @var{else-part} Z ]}. If @var{cond} is true
31536(i.e., if the top of stack contains a non-zero number after @var{cond}
31537has been executed), the @var{then-part} will be executed and the
31538@var{else-part} will be skipped. Otherwise, the @var{then-part} will
31539be skipped and the @var{else-part} will be executed.
31540
31541@kindex Z |
31542The @kbd{Z |} (@code{calc-kbd-else-if}) command allows you to choose
31543between any number of alternatives. For example,
31544@kbd{@var{cond1} Z [ @var{part1} Z : @var{cond2} Z | @var{part2} Z :
31545@var{part3} Z ]} will execute @var{part1} if @var{cond1} is true,
31546otherwise it will execute @var{part2} if @var{cond2} is true, otherwise
31547it will execute @var{part3}.
31548
31549More precisely, @kbd{Z [} pops a number and conditionally skips to the
31550next matching @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]} key. @w{@kbd{Z ]}} has no effect when
31551actually executed. @kbd{Z :} skips to the next matching @kbd{Z ]}.
31552@kbd{Z |} pops a number and conditionally skips to the next matching
31553@kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]}; thus, @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z |} are functionally
31554equivalent except that @kbd{Z [} participates in nesting but @kbd{Z |}
31555does not.
31556
31557Calc's conditional and looping constructs work by scanning the
31558keyboard macro for occurrences of character sequences like @samp{Z:}
31559and @samp{Z]}. One side-effect of this is that if you use these
31560constructs you must be careful that these character pairs do not
31561occur by accident in other parts of the macros. Since Calc rarely
31562uses shift-@kbd{Z} for any purpose except as a prefix character, this
31563is not likely to be a problem. Another side-effect is that it will
31564not work to define your own custom key bindings for these commands.
31565Only the standard shift-@kbd{Z} bindings will work correctly.
31566
31567@kindex Z C-g
31568If Calc gets stuck while skipping characters during the definition of a
31569macro, type @kbd{Z C-g} to cancel the definition. (Typing plain @kbd{C-g}
31570actually adds a @kbd{C-g} keystroke to the macro.)
31571
31572@node Loops in Macros, Local Values in Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31573@subsection Loops in Keyboard Macros
31574
31575@noindent
31576@kindex Z <
31577@kindex Z >
31578@pindex calc-kbd-repeat
31579@pindex calc-kbd-end-repeat
31580@cindex Looping structures
31581@cindex Iterative structures
31582The @kbd{Z <} (@code{calc-kbd-repeat}) and @kbd{Z >}
31583(@code{calc-kbd-end-repeat}) commands pop a number from the stack,
31584which must be an integer, then repeat the keystrokes between the brackets
31585the specified number of times. If the integer is zero or negative, the
31586body is skipped altogether. For example, @kbd{1 @key{TAB} Z < 2 * Z >}
31587computes two to a nonnegative integer power. First, we push 1 on the
31588stack and then swap the integer argument back to the top. The @kbd{Z <}
31589pops that argument leaving the 1 back on top of the stack. Then, we
31590repeat a multiply-by-two step however many times.
31591
31592Once again, the keyboard macro is executed as it is being entered.
31593In this case it is especially important to set up reasonable initial
31594conditions before making the definition: Suppose the integer 1000 just
31595happened to be sitting on the stack before we typed the above definition!
31596Another approach is to enter a harmless dummy definition for the macro,
31597then go back and edit in the real one with a @kbd{Z E} command. Yet
31598another approach is to type the macro as written-out keystroke names
31599in a buffer, then use @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the
31600macro.
31601
31602@kindex Z /
31603@pindex calc-break
31604The @kbd{Z /} (@code{calc-kbd-break}) command allows you to break out
31605of a keyboard macro loop prematurely. It pops an object from the stack;
31606if that object is true (a non-zero number), control jumps out of the
31607innermost enclosing @kbd{Z <} @dots{} @kbd{Z >} loop and continues
31608after the @kbd{Z >}. If the object is false, the @kbd{Z /} has no
31609effect. Thus @kbd{@var{cond} Z /} is similar to @samp{if (@var{cond}) break;}
31610in the C language.
31611
31612@kindex Z (
31613@kindex Z )
31614@pindex calc-kbd-for
31615@pindex calc-kbd-end-for
31616The @kbd{Z (} (@code{calc-kbd-for}) and @kbd{Z )} (@code{calc-kbd-end-for})
31617commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and @kbd{Z >}, except that they make the
31618value of the counter available inside the loop. The general layout is
31619@kbd{@var{init} @var{final} Z ( @var{body} @var{step} Z )}. The @kbd{Z (}
31620command pops initial and final values from the stack. It then creates
31621a temporary internal counter and initializes it with the value @var{init}.
31622The @kbd{Z (} command then repeatedly pushes the counter value onto the
31623stack and executes @var{body} and @var{step}, adding @var{step} to the
31624counter each time until the loop finishes.
31625
31626@cindex Summations (by keyboard macros)
31627By default, the loop finishes when the counter becomes greater than (or
31628less than) @var{final}, assuming @var{initial} is less than (greater
31629than) @var{final}. If @var{initial} is equal to @var{final}, the body
31630executes exactly once. The body of the loop always executes at least
31631once. For example, @kbd{0 1 10 Z ( 2 ^ + 1 Z )} computes the sum of the
31632squares of the integers from 1 to 10, in steps of 1.
31633
31634If you give a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{Z (}, the loop is
31635forced to use upward-counting conventions. In this case, if @var{initial}
31636is greater than @var{final} the body will not be executed at all.
31637Note that @var{step} may still be negative in this loop; the prefix
31638argument merely constrains the loop-finished test. Likewise, a prefix
31639argument of @mathit{-1} forces downward-counting conventions.
31640
31641@kindex Z @{
31642@kindex Z @}
31643@pindex calc-kbd-loop
31644@pindex calc-kbd-end-loop
31645The @kbd{Z @{} (@code{calc-kbd-loop}) and @kbd{Z @}}
31646(@code{calc-kbd-end-loop}) commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and
31647@kbd{Z >}, except that they do not pop a count from the stack---they
31648effectively create an infinite loop. Every @kbd{Z @{} @dots{} @kbd{Z @}}
31649loop ought to include at least one @kbd{Z /} to make sure the loop
31650doesn't run forever. (If any error message occurs which causes Emacs
31651to beep, the keyboard macro will also be halted; this is a standard
31652feature of Emacs. You can also generally press @kbd{C-g} to halt a
31653running keyboard macro, although not all versions of Unix support
31654this feature.)
31655
31656The conditional and looping constructs are not actually tied to
31657keyboard macros, but they are most often used in that context.
31658For example, the keystrokes @kbd{10 Z < 23 @key{RET} Z >} push
31659ten copies of 23 onto the stack. This can be typed ``live'' just
31660as easily as in a macro definition.
31661
31662@xref{Conditionals in Macros}, for some additional notes about
31663conditional and looping commands.
31664
31665@node Local Values in Macros, Queries in Macros, Loops in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31666@subsection Local Values in Macros
31667
31668@noindent
31669@cindex Local variables
31670@cindex Restoring saved modes
31671Keyboard macros sometimes want to operate under known conditions
31672without affecting surrounding conditions. For example, a keyboard
31673macro may wish to turn on Fraction mode, or set a particular
31674precision, independent of the user's normal setting for those
31675modes.
31676
31677@kindex Z `
31678@kindex Z '
31679@pindex calc-kbd-push
31680@pindex calc-kbd-pop
31681Macros also sometimes need to use local variables. Assignments to
31682local variables inside the macro should not affect any variables
31683outside the macro. The @kbd{Z `} (@code{calc-kbd-push}) and @kbd{Z '}
31684(@code{calc-kbd-pop}) commands give you both of these capabilities.
31685
31686When you type @kbd{Z `} (with a backquote or accent grave character),
31687the values of various mode settings are saved away. The ten ``quick''
31688variables @code{q0} through @code{q9} are also saved. When
31689you type @w{@kbd{Z '}} (with an apostrophe), these values are restored.
31690Pairs of @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} commands may be nested.
31691
31692If a keyboard macro halts due to an error in between a @kbd{Z `} and
31693a @kbd{Z '}, the saved values will be restored correctly even though
31694the macro never reaches the @kbd{Z '} command. Thus you can use
31695@kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} without having to worry about what happens
31696in exceptional conditions.
31697
31698If you type @kbd{Z `} ``live'' (not in a keyboard macro), Calc puts
31699you into a ``recursive edit.'' You can tell you are in a recursive
31700edit because there will be extra square brackets in the mode line,
31701as in @samp{[(Calculator)]}. These brackets will go away when you
31702type the matching @kbd{Z '} command. The modes and quick variables
31703will be saved and restored in just the same way as if actual keyboard
31704macros were involved.
31705
31706The modes saved by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} are the current precision
31707and binary word size, the angular mode (Deg, Rad, or HMS), the
31708simplification mode, Algebraic mode, Symbolic mode, Infinite mode,
31709Matrix or Scalar mode, Fraction mode, and the current complex mode
31710(Polar or Rectangular). The ten ``quick'' variables' values (or lack
31711thereof) are also saved.
31712
31713Most mode-setting commands act as toggles, but with a numeric prefix
31714they force the mode either on (positive prefix) or off (negative
31715or zero prefix). Since you don't know what the environment might
31716be when you invoke your macro, it's best to use prefix arguments
31717for all mode-setting commands inside the macro.
31718
31719In fact, @kbd{C-u Z `} is like @kbd{Z `} except that it sets the modes
31720listed above to their default values. As usual, the matching @kbd{Z '}
31721will restore the modes to their settings from before the @kbd{C-u Z `}.
31722Also, @w{@kbd{Z `}} with a negative prefix argument resets the algebraic mode
31723to its default (off) but leaves the other modes the same as they were
31724outside the construct.
31725
31726The contents of the stack and trail, values of non-quick variables, and
31727other settings such as the language mode and the various display modes,
31728are @emph{not} affected by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '}.
31729
31730@node Queries in Macros, , Local Values in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31731@subsection Queries in Keyboard Macros
31732
31733@c @noindent
31734@c @kindex Z =
31735@c @pindex calc-kbd-report
31736@c The @kbd{Z =} (@code{calc-kbd-report}) command displays an informative
31737@c message including the value on the top of the stack. You are prompted
31738@c to enter a string. That string, along with the top-of-stack value,
31739@c is displayed unless @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) has been used
31740@c to turn such messages off.
31741
31742@noindent
31743@kindex Z #
31744@pindex calc-kbd-query
31745The @kbd{Z #} (@code{calc-kbd-query}) command prompts for an algebraic
31746entry which takes its input from the keyboard, even during macro
31747execution. All the normal conventions of algebraic input, including the
31748use of @kbd{$} characters, are supported. The prompt message itself is
31749taken from the top of the stack, and so must be entered (as a string)
31750before the @kbd{Z #} command. (Recall, as a string it can be entered by
31751pressing the @kbd{"} key and will appear as a vector when it is put on
31752the stack. The prompt message is only put on the stack to provide a
31753prompt for the @kbd{Z #} command; it will not play any role in any
31754subsequent calculations.) This command allows your keyboard macros to
31755accept numbers or formulas as interactive input.
31756
31757As an example,
31758@kbd{2 @key{RET} "Power: " @key{RET} Z # 3 @key{RET} ^} will prompt for
31759input with ``Power: '' in the minibuffer, then return 2 to the provided
31760power. (The response to the prompt that's given, 3 in this example,
31761will not be part of the macro.)
31762
31763@xref{Keyboard Macro Query, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for a description of
31764@kbd{C-x q} (@code{kbd-macro-query}), the standard Emacs way to accept
31765keyboard input during a keyboard macro. In particular, you can use
31766@kbd{C-x q} to enter a recursive edit, which allows the user to perform
31767any Calculator operations interactively before pressing @kbd{C-M-c} to
31768return control to the keyboard macro.
31769
31770@node Invocation Macros, Algebraic Definitions, Keyboard Macros, Programming
31771@section Invocation Macros
31772
31773@kindex C-x * z
31774@kindex Z I
31775@pindex calc-user-invocation
31776@pindex calc-user-define-invocation
31777Calc provides one special keyboard macro, called up by @kbd{C-x * z}
31778(@code{calc-user-invocation}), that is intended to allow you to define
31779your own special way of starting Calc. To define this ``invocation
31780macro,'' create the macro in the usual way with @kbd{C-x (} and
31781@kbd{C-x )}, then type @kbd{Z I} (@code{calc-user-define-invocation}).
31782There is only one invocation macro, so you don't need to type any
31783additional letters after @kbd{Z I}. From now on, you can type
31784@kbd{C-x * z} at any time to execute your invocation macro.
31785
31786For example, suppose you find yourself often grabbing rectangles of
31787numbers into Calc and multiplying their columns. You can do this
31788by typing @kbd{C-x * r} to grab, and @kbd{V R : *} to multiply columns.
31789To make this into an invocation macro, just type @kbd{C-x ( C-x * r
31790V R : * C-x )}, then @kbd{Z I}. Then, to multiply a rectangle of data,
31791just mark the data in its buffer in the usual way and type @kbd{C-x * z}.
31792
31793Invocation macros are treated like regular Emacs keyboard macros;
31794all the special features described above for @kbd{Z K}-style macros
31795do not apply. @kbd{C-x * z} is just like @kbd{C-x e}, except that it
31796uses the macro that was last stored by @kbd{Z I}. (In fact, the
31797macro does not even have to have anything to do with Calc!)
31798
31799The @kbd{m m} command saves the last invocation macro defined by
31800@kbd{Z I} along with all the other Calc mode settings.
31801@xref{General Mode Commands}.
31802
31803@node Algebraic Definitions, Lisp Definitions, Invocation Macros, Programming
31804@section Programming with Formulas
31805
31806@noindent
31807@kindex Z F
31808@pindex calc-user-define-formula
31809@cindex Programming with algebraic formulas
31810Another way to create a new Calculator command uses algebraic formulas.
31811The @kbd{Z F} (@code{calc-user-define-formula}) command stores the
31812formula at the top of the stack as the definition for a key. This
31813command prompts for five things: The key, the command name, the function
31814name, the argument list, and the behavior of the command when given
31815non-numeric arguments.
31816
31817For example, suppose we type @kbd{' a+2b @key{RET}} to push the formula
31818@samp{a + 2*b} onto the stack. We now type @kbd{Z F m} to define this
31819formula on the @kbd{z m} key sequence. The next prompt is for a command
31820name, beginning with @samp{calc-}, which should be the long (@kbd{M-x}) form
31821for the new command. If you simply press @key{RET}, a default name like
31822@code{calc-User-m} will be constructed. In our example, suppose we enter
31823@kbd{spam @key{RET}} to define the new command as @code{calc-spam}.
31824
31825If you want to give the formula a long-style name only, you can press
31826@key{SPC} or @key{RET} when asked which single key to use. For example
31827@kbd{Z F @key{RET} spam @key{RET}} defines the new command as
31828@kbd{M-x calc-spam}, with no keyboard equivalent.
31829
31830The third prompt is for an algebraic function name. The default is to
31831use the same name as the command name but without the @samp{calc-}
31832prefix. (If this is of the form @samp{User-m}, the hyphen is removed so
31833it won't be taken for a minus sign in algebraic formulas.)
31834This is the name you will use if you want to enter your
31835new function in an algebraic formula. Suppose we enter @kbd{yow @key{RET}}.
31836Then the new function can be invoked by pushing two numbers on the
31837stack and typing @kbd{z m} or @kbd{x spam}, or by entering the algebraic
31838formula @samp{yow(x,y)}.
31839
31840The fourth prompt is for the function's argument list. This is used to
31841associate values on the stack with the variables that appear in the formula.
31842The default is a list of all variables which appear in the formula, sorted
31843into alphabetical order. In our case, the default would be @samp{(a b)}.
31844This means that, when the user types @kbd{z m}, the Calculator will remove
31845two numbers from the stack, substitute these numbers for @samp{a} and
31846@samp{b} (respectively) in the formula, then simplify the formula and
31847push the result on the stack. In other words, @kbd{10 @key{RET} 100 z m}
31848would replace the 10 and 100 on the stack with the number 210, which is
31849@expr{a + 2 b} with @expr{a=10} and @expr{b=100}. Likewise, the formula
31850@samp{yow(10, 100)} will be evaluated by substituting @expr{a=10} and
31851@expr{b=100} in the definition.
31852
31853You can rearrange the order of the names before pressing @key{RET} to
31854control which stack positions go to which variables in the formula. If
31855you remove a variable from the argument list, that variable will be left
31856in symbolic form by the command. Thus using an argument list of @samp{(b)}
31857for our function would cause @kbd{10 z m} to replace the 10 on the stack
31858with the formula @samp{a + 20}. If we had used an argument list of
31859@samp{(b a)}, the result with inputs 10 and 100 would have been 120.
31860
31861You can also put a nameless function on the stack instead of just a
31862formula, as in @samp{<a, b : a + 2 b>}. @xref{Specifying Operators}.
31863In this example, the command will be defined by the formula @samp{a + 2 b}
31864using the argument list @samp{(a b)}.
31865
31866The final prompt is a y-or-n question concerning what to do if symbolic
31867arguments are given to your function. If you answer @kbd{y}, then
31868executing @kbd{z m} (using the original argument list @samp{(a b)}) with
31869arguments @expr{10} and @expr{x} will leave the function in symbolic
31870form, i.e., @samp{yow(10,x)}. On the other hand, if you answer @kbd{n},
31871then the formula will always be expanded, even for non-constant
31872arguments: @samp{10 + 2 x}. If you never plan to feed algebraic
31873formulas to your new function, it doesn't matter how you answer this
31874question.
31875
31876If you answered @kbd{y} to this question you can still cause a function
31877call to be expanded by typing @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}).
31878Also, Calc will expand the function if necessary when you take a
31879derivative or integral or solve an equation involving the function.
31880
31881@kindex Z G
31882@pindex calc-get-user-defn
31883Once you have defined a formula on a key, you can retrieve this formula
31884with the @kbd{Z G} (@code{calc-user-define-get-defn}) command. Press a
31885key, and this command pushes the formula that was used to define that
31886key onto the stack. Actually, it pushes a nameless function that
31887specifies both the argument list and the defining formula. You will get
31888an error message if the key is undefined, or if the key was not defined
31889by a @kbd{Z F} command.
31890
31891The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31892been defined by a formula uses a variant of the @code{calc-edit} command
31893to edit the defining formula. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and
31894store the new formula back in the definition, or kill the buffer with
31895@kbd{C-x k} to
31896cancel the edit. (The argument list and other properties of the
31897definition are unchanged; to adjust the argument list, you can use
31898@kbd{Z G} to grab the function onto the stack, edit with @kbd{`}, and
31899then re-execute the @kbd{Z F} command.)
31900
31901As usual, the @kbd{Z P} command records your definition permanently.
31902In this case it will permanently record all three of the relevant
31903definitions: the key, the command, and the function.
31904
31905You may find it useful to turn off the default simplifications with
31906@kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) when entering a formula to be
31907used as a function definition. For example, the formula @samp{deriv(a^2,v)}
31908which might be used to define a new function @samp{dsqr(a,v)} will be
31909``simplified'' to 0 immediately upon entry since @code{deriv} considers
31910@expr{a} to be constant with respect to @expr{v}. Turning off
31911default simplifications cures this problem: The definition will be stored
31912in symbolic form without ever activating the @code{deriv} function. Press
31913@kbd{m D} to turn the default simplifications back on afterwards.
31914
31915@node Lisp Definitions, , Algebraic Definitions, Programming
31916@section Programming with Lisp
31917
31918@noindent
31919The Calculator can be programmed quite extensively in Lisp. All you
31920do is write a normal Lisp function definition, but with @code{defmath}
31921in place of @code{defun}. This has the same form as @code{defun}, but it
31922automagically replaces calls to standard Lisp functions like @code{+} and
31923@code{zerop} with calls to the corresponding functions in Calc's own library.
31924Thus you can write natural-looking Lisp code which operates on all of the
31925standard Calculator data types. You can then use @kbd{Z D} if you wish to
31926bind your new command to a @kbd{z}-prefix key sequence. The @kbd{Z E} command
31927will not edit a Lisp-based definition.
31928
31929Emacs Lisp is described in the GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual. This section
31930assumes a familiarity with Lisp programming concepts; if you do not know
31931Lisp, you may find keyboard macros or rewrite rules to be an easier way
31932to program the Calculator.
31933
31934This section first discusses ways to write commands, functions, or
31935small programs to be executed inside of Calc. Then it discusses how
31936your own separate programs are able to call Calc from the outside.
31937Finally, there is a list of internal Calc functions and data structures
31938for the true Lisp enthusiast.
31939
31940@menu
31941* Defining Functions::
31942* Defining Simple Commands::
31943* Defining Stack Commands::
31944* Argument Qualifiers::
31945* Example Definitions::
31946
31947* Calling Calc from Your Programs::
31948* Internals::
31949@end menu
31950
31951@node Defining Functions, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions, Lisp Definitions
31952@subsection Defining New Functions
31953
31954@noindent
31955@findex defmath
31956The @code{defmath} function (actually a Lisp macro) is like @code{defun}
31957except that code in the body of the definition can make use of the full
31958range of Calculator data types. The prefix @samp{calcFunc-} is added
31959to the specified name to get the actual Lisp function name. As a simple
31960example,
31961
31962@example
31963(defmath myfact (n)
31964 (if (> n 0)
31965 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31966 1))
31967@end example
31968
31969@noindent
31970This actually expands to the code,
31971
31972@example
31973(defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
31974 (if (math-posp n)
31975 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
31976 1))
31977@end example
31978
31979@noindent
31980This function can be used in algebraic expressions, e.g., @samp{myfact(5)}.
31981
31982The @samp{myfact} function as it is defined above has the bug that an
31983expression @samp{myfact(a+b)} will be simplified to 1 because the
31984formula @samp{a+b} is not considered to be @code{posp}. A robust
31985factorial function would be written along the following lines:
31986
31987@smallexample
31988(defmath myfact (n)
31989 (if (> n 0)
31990 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31991 (if (= n 0)
31992 1
31993 nil))) ; this could be simplified as: (and (= n 0) 1)
31994@end smallexample
31995
31996If a function returns @code{nil}, it is left unsimplified by the Calculator
31997(except that its arguments will be simplified). Thus, @samp{myfact(a+1+2)}
31998will be simplified to @samp{myfact(a+3)} but no further. Beware that every
31999time the Calculator reexamines this formula it will attempt to resimplify
32000it, so your function ought to detect the returning-@code{nil} case as
32001efficiently as possible.
32002
32003The following standard Lisp functions are treated by @code{defmath}:
32004@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^} or
32005@code{expt}, @code{=}, @code{<}, @code{>}, @code{<=}, @code{>=},
32006@code{/=}, @code{1+}, @code{1-}, @code{logand}, @code{logior}, @code{logxor},
32007@code{logandc2}, @code{lognot}. Also, @code{~=} is an abbreviation for
32008@code{math-nearly-equal}, which is useful in implementing Taylor series.
32009
32010For other functions @var{func}, if a function by the name
32011@samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if a function by the
32012name @samp{math-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if @var{func} itself
32013is defined as a function it is used, otherwise @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} is
32014used on the assumption that this is a to-be-defined math function. Also, if
32015the function name is quoted as in @samp{('integerp a)} the function name is
32016always used exactly as written (but not quoted).
32017
32018Variable names have @samp{var-} prepended to them unless they appear in
32019the function's argument list or in an enclosing @code{let}, @code{let*},
32020@code{for}, or @code{foreach} form,
32021or their names already contain a @samp{-} character. Thus a reference to
32022@samp{foo} is the same as a reference to @samp{var-foo}.
32023
32024A few other Lisp extensions are available in @code{defmath} definitions:
32025
32026@itemize @bullet
32027@item
32028The @code{elt} function accepts any number of index variables.
32029Note that Calc vectors are stored as Lisp lists whose first
32030element is the symbol @code{vec}; thus, @samp{(elt v 2)} yields
32031the second element of vector @code{v}, and @samp{(elt m i j)}
32032yields one element of a Calc matrix.
32033
32034@item
32035The @code{setq} function has been extended to act like the Common
32036Lisp @code{setf} function. (The name @code{setf} is recognized as
32037a synonym of @code{setq}.) Specifically, the first argument of
32038@code{setq} can be an @code{nth}, @code{elt}, @code{car}, or @code{cdr} form,
32039in which case the effect is to store into the specified
32040element of a list. Thus, @samp{(setq (elt m i j) x)} stores @expr{x}
32041into one element of a matrix.
32042
32043@item
32044A @code{for} looping construct is available. For example,
32045@samp{(for ((i 0 10)) body)} executes @code{body} once for each
32046binding of @expr{i} from zero to 10. This is like a @code{let}
32047form in that @expr{i} is temporarily bound to the loop count
32048without disturbing its value outside the @code{for} construct.
32049Nested loops, as in @samp{(for ((i 0 10) (j 0 (1- i) 2)) body)},
32050are also available. For each value of @expr{i} from zero to 10,
32051@expr{j} counts from 0 to @expr{i-1} in steps of two. Note that
32052@code{for} has the same general outline as @code{let*}, except
32053that each element of the header is a list of three or four
32054things, not just two.
32055
32056@item
32057The @code{foreach} construct loops over elements of a list.
32058For example, @samp{(foreach ((x (cdr v))) body)} executes
32059@code{body} with @expr{x} bound to each element of Calc vector
32060@expr{v} in turn. The purpose of @code{cdr} here is to skip over
32061the initial @code{vec} symbol in the vector.
32062
32063@item
32064The @code{break} function breaks out of the innermost enclosing
32065@code{while}, @code{for}, or @code{foreach} loop. If given a
32066value, as in @samp{(break x)}, this value is returned by the
32067loop. (Lisp loops otherwise always return @code{nil}.)
32068
32069@item
32070The @code{return} function prematurely returns from the enclosing
32071function. For example, @samp{(return (+ x y))} returns @expr{x+y}
32072as the value of a function. You can use @code{return} anywhere
32073inside the body of the function.
32074@end itemize
32075
32076Non-integer numbers (and extremely large integers) cannot be included
32077directly into a @code{defmath} definition. This is because the Lisp
32078reader will fail to parse them long before @code{defmath} ever gets control.
32079Instead, use the notation, @samp{:"3.1415"}. In fact, any algebraic
32080formula can go between the quotes. For example,
32081
32082@smallexample
32083(defmath sqexp (x) ; sqexp(x) == sqrt(exp(x)) == exp(x*0.5)
32084 (and (numberp x)
32085 (exp :"x * 0.5")))
32086@end smallexample
32087
32088expands to
32089
32090@smallexample
32091(defun calcFunc-sqexp (x)
32092 (and (math-numberp x)
32093 (calcFunc-exp (math-mul x '(float 5 -1)))))
32094@end smallexample
32095
32096Note the use of @code{numberp} as a guard to ensure that the argument is
32097a number first, returning @code{nil} if not. The exponential function
32098could itself have been included in the expression, if we had preferred:
32099@samp{:"exp(x * 0.5)"}. As another example, the multiplication-and-recursion
32100step of @code{myfact} could have been written
32101
32102@example
32103:"n * myfact(n-1)"
32104@end example
32105
32106A good place to put your @code{defmath} commands is your Calc init file
32107(the file given by @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
dcf7843e 32108@file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), which will not be loaded until Calc starts.
4009494e
GM
32109If a file named @file{.emacs} exists in your home directory, Emacs reads
32110and executes the Lisp forms in this file as it starts up. While it may
32111seem reasonable to put your favorite @code{defmath} commands there,
32112this has the unfortunate side-effect that parts of the Calculator must be
32113loaded in to process the @code{defmath} commands whether or not you will
32114actually use the Calculator! If you want to put the @code{defmath}
32115commands there (for example, if you redefine @code{calc-settings-file}
32116to be @file{.emacs}), a better effect can be had by writing
32117
32118@example
32119(put 'calc-define 'thing '(progn
32120 (defmath ... )
32121 (defmath ... )
32122))
32123@end example
32124
32125@noindent
32126@vindex calc-define
32127The @code{put} function adds a @dfn{property} to a symbol. Each Lisp
32128symbol has a list of properties associated with it. Here we add a
32129property with a name of @code{thing} and a @samp{(progn ...)} form as
32130its value. When Calc starts up, and at the start of every Calc command,
32131the property list for the symbol @code{calc-define} is checked and the
32132values of any properties found are evaluated as Lisp forms. The
32133properties are removed as they are evaluated. The property names
32134(like @code{thing}) are not used; you should choose something like the
32135name of your project so as not to conflict with other properties.
32136
32137The net effect is that you can put the above code in your @file{.emacs}
32138file and it will not be executed until Calc is loaded. Or, you can put
32139that same code in another file which you load by hand either before or
32140after Calc itself is loaded.
32141
32142The properties of @code{calc-define} are evaluated in the same order
32143that they were added. They can assume that the Calc modules @file{calc.el},
32144@file{calc-ext.el}, and @file{calc-macs.el} have been fully loaded, and
32145that the @samp{*Calculator*} buffer will be the current buffer.
32146
32147If your @code{calc-define} property only defines algebraic functions,
32148you can be sure that it will have been evaluated before Calc tries to
32149call your function, even if the file defining the property is loaded
32150after Calc is loaded. But if the property defines commands or key
32151sequences, it may not be evaluated soon enough. (Suppose it defines the
32152new command @code{tweak-calc}; the user can load your file, then type
32153@kbd{M-x tweak-calc} before Calc has had chance to do anything.) To
32154protect against this situation, you can put
32155
32156@example
32157(run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
32158@end example
32159
32160@findex calc-check-defines
32161@noindent
32162at the end of your file. The @code{calc-check-defines} function is what
32163looks for and evaluates properties on @code{calc-define}; @code{run-hooks}
32164has the advantage that it is quietly ignored if @code{calc-check-defines}
32165is not yet defined because Calc has not yet been loaded.
32166
32167Examples of things that ought to be enclosed in a @code{calc-define}
32168property are @code{defmath} calls, @code{define-key} calls that modify
32169the Calc key map, and any calls that redefine things defined inside Calc.
32170Ordinary @code{defun}s need not be enclosed with @code{calc-define}.
32171
32172@node Defining Simple Commands, Defining Stack Commands, Defining Functions, Lisp Definitions
32173@subsection Defining New Simple Commands
32174
32175@noindent
32176@findex interactive
32177If a @code{defmath} form contains an @code{interactive} clause, it defines
32178a Calculator command. Actually such a @code{defmath} results in @emph{two}
32179function definitions: One, a @samp{calcFunc-} function as was just described,
32180with the @code{interactive} clause removed. Two, a @samp{calc-} function
32181with a suitable @code{interactive} clause and some sort of wrapper to make
32182the command work in the Calc environment.
32183
32184In the simple case, the @code{interactive} clause has the same form as
32185for normal Emacs Lisp commands:
32186
32187@smallexample
32188(defmath increase-precision (delta)
32189 "Increase precision by DELTA." ; This is the "documentation string"
32190 (interactive "p") ; Register this as a M-x-able command
32191 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
32192@end smallexample
32193
32194This expands to the pair of definitions,
32195
32196@smallexample
32197(defun calc-increase-precision (delta)
32198 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32199 (interactive "p")
32200 (calc-wrapper
32201 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta))))
32202
32203(defun calcFunc-increase-precision (delta)
32204 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32205 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta)))
32206@end smallexample
32207
32208@noindent
32209where in this case the latter function would never really be used! Note
32210that since the Calculator stores small integers as plain Lisp integers,
32211the @code{math-add} function will work just as well as the native
32212@code{+} even when the intent is to operate on native Lisp integers.
32213
32214@findex calc-wrapper
32215The @samp{calc-wrapper} call invokes a macro which surrounds the body of
32216the function with code that looks roughly like this:
32217
32218@smallexample
32219(let ((calc-command-flags nil))
32220 (unwind-protect
c57008f6 32221 (save-current-buffer
4009494e
GM
32222 (calc-select-buffer)
32223 @emph{body of function}
32224 @emph{renumber stack}
32225 @emph{clear} Working @emph{message})
32226 @emph{realign cursor and window}
32227 @emph{clear Inverse, Hyperbolic, and Keep Args flags}
32228 @emph{update Emacs mode line}))
32229@end smallexample
32230
32231@findex calc-select-buffer
32232The @code{calc-select-buffer} function selects the @samp{*Calculator*}
32233buffer if necessary, say, because the command was invoked from inside
32234the @samp{*Calc Trail*} window.
32235
32236@findex calc-set-command-flag
32237You can call, for example, @code{(calc-set-command-flag 'no-align)} to
32238set the above-mentioned command flags. Calc routines recognize the
32239following command flags:
32240
32241@table @code
32242@item renum-stack
32243Stack line numbers @samp{1:}, @samp{2:}, and so on must be renumbered
32244after this command completes. This is set by routines like
32245@code{calc-push}.
32246
32247@item clear-message
32248Calc should call @samp{(message "")} if this command completes normally
32249(to clear a ``Working@dots{}'' message out of the echo area).
32250
32251@item no-align
32252Do not move the cursor back to the @samp{.} top-of-stack marker.
32253
32254@item position-point
32255Use the variables @code{calc-position-point-line} and
32256@code{calc-position-point-column} to position the cursor after
32257this command finishes.
32258
32259@item keep-flags
32260Do not clear @code{calc-inverse-flag}, @code{calc-hyperbolic-flag},
32261and @code{calc-keep-args-flag} at the end of this command.
32262
32263@item do-edit
32264Switch to buffer @samp{*Calc Edit*} after this command.
32265
32266@item hold-trail
32267Do not move trail pointer to end of trail when something is recorded
32268there.
32269@end table
32270
32271@kindex Y
32272@kindex Y ?
32273@vindex calc-Y-help-msgs
32274Calc reserves a special prefix key, shift-@kbd{Y}, for user-written
32275extensions to Calc. There are no built-in commands that work with
32276this prefix key; you must call @code{define-key} from Lisp (probably
32277from inside a @code{calc-define} property) to add to it. Initially only
32278@kbd{Y ?} is defined; it takes help messages from a list of strings
32279(initially @code{nil}) in the variable @code{calc-Y-help-msgs}. All
32280other undefined keys except for @kbd{Y} are reserved for use by
32281future versions of Calc.
32282
32283If you are writing a Calc enhancement which you expect to give to
32284others, it is best to minimize the number of @kbd{Y}-key sequences
32285you use. In fact, if you have more than one key sequence you should
32286consider defining three-key sequences with a @kbd{Y}, then a key that
32287stands for your package, then a third key for the particular command
32288within your package.
32289
32290Users may wish to install several Calc enhancements, and it is possible
32291that several enhancements will choose to use the same key. In the
32292example below, a variable @code{inc-prec-base-key} has been defined
32293to contain the key that identifies the @code{inc-prec} package. Its
32294value is initially @code{"P"}, but a user can change this variable
32295if necessary without having to modify the file.
32296
32297Here is a complete file, @file{inc-prec.el}, which makes a @kbd{Y P I}
32298command that increases the precision, and a @kbd{Y P D} command that
32299decreases the precision.
32300
32301@smallexample
32302;;; Increase and decrease Calc precision. Dave Gillespie, 5/31/91.
32303;; (Include copyright or copyleft stuff here.)
32304
32305(defvar inc-prec-base-key "P"
32306 "Base key for inc-prec.el commands.")
32307
32308(put 'calc-define 'inc-prec '(progn
32309
32310(define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sI" inc-prec-base-key)
32311 'increase-precision)
32312(define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sD" inc-prec-base-key)
32313 'decrease-precision)
32314
32315(setq calc-Y-help-msgs
32316 (cons (format "%s + Inc-prec, Dec-prec" inc-prec-base-key)
32317 calc-Y-help-msgs))
32318
32319(defmath increase-precision (delta)
32320 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32321 (interactive "p")
32322 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
32323
32324(defmath decrease-precision (delta)
32325 "Decrease precision by DELTA."
32326 (interactive "p")
32327 (setq calc-internal-prec (- calc-internal-prec delta)))
32328
32329)) ; end of calc-define property
32330
32331(run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
32332@end smallexample
32333
32334@node Defining Stack Commands, Argument Qualifiers, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions
32335@subsection Defining New Stack-Based Commands
32336
32337@noindent
32338To define a new computational command which takes and/or leaves arguments
32339on the stack, a special form of @code{interactive} clause is used.
32340
32341@example
32342(interactive @var{num} @var{tag})
32343@end example
32344
32345@noindent
32346where @var{num} is an integer, and @var{tag} is a string. The effect is
32347to pop @var{num} values off the stack, resimplify them by calling
32348@code{calc-normalize}, and hand them to your function according to the
32349function's argument list. Your function may include @code{&optional} and
32350@code{&rest} parameters, so long as calling the function with @var{num}
32351parameters is valid.
32352
32353Your function must return either a number or a formula in a form
32354acceptable to Calc, or a list of such numbers or formulas. These value(s)
32355are pushed onto the stack when the function completes. They are also
32356recorded in the Calc Trail buffer on a line beginning with @var{tag},
32357a string of (normally) four characters or less. If you omit @var{tag}
32358or use @code{nil} as a tag, the result is not recorded in the trail.
32359
32360As an example, the definition
32361
32362@smallexample
32363(defmath myfact (n)
32364 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32365 (interactive 1 "fact")
32366 (if (> n 0)
32367 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
32368 (and (= n 0) 1)))
32369@end smallexample
32370
32371@noindent
32372is a version of the factorial function shown previously which can be used
32373as a command as well as an algebraic function. It expands to
32374
32375@smallexample
32376(defun calc-myfact ()
32377 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32378 (interactive)
32379 (calc-slow-wrapper
32380 (calc-enter-result 1 "fact"
32381 (cons 'calcFunc-myfact (calc-top-list-n 1)))))
32382
32383(defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
32384 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32385 (if (math-posp n)
32386 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
32387 (and (math-zerop n) 1)))
32388@end smallexample
32389
32390@findex calc-slow-wrapper
32391The @code{calc-slow-wrapper} function is a version of @code{calc-wrapper}
32392that automatically puts up a @samp{Working...} message before the
32393computation begins. (This message can be turned off by the user
32394with an @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) command.)
32395
32396@findex calc-top-list-n
32397The @code{calc-top-list-n} function returns a list of the specified number
32398of values from the top of the stack. It resimplifies each value by
32399calling @code{calc-normalize}. If its argument is zero it returns an
32400empty list. It does not actually remove these values from the stack.
32401
32402@findex calc-enter-result
32403The @code{calc-enter-result} function takes an integer @var{num} and string
32404@var{tag} as described above, plus a third argument which is either a
32405Calculator data object or a list of such objects. These objects are
32406resimplified and pushed onto the stack after popping the specified number
32407of values from the stack. If @var{tag} is non-@code{nil}, the values
32408being pushed are also recorded in the trail.
32409
32410Note that if @code{calcFunc-myfact} returns @code{nil} this represents
32411``leave the function in symbolic form.'' To return an actual empty list,
32412in the sense that @code{calc-enter-result} will push zero elements back
32413onto the stack, you should return the special value @samp{'(nil)}, a list
32414containing the single symbol @code{nil}.
32415
32416The @code{interactive} declaration can actually contain a limited
32417Emacs-style code string as well which comes just before @var{num} and
32418@var{tag}. Currently the only Emacs code supported is @samp{"p"}, as in
32419
32420@example
32421(defmath foo (a b &optional c)
32422 (interactive "p" 2 "foo")
32423 @var{body})
32424@end example
32425
32426In this example, the command @code{calc-foo} will evaluate the expression
32427@samp{foo(a,b)} if executed with no argument, or @samp{foo(a,b,n)} if
32428executed with a numeric prefix argument of @expr{n}.
32429
32430The other code string allowed is @samp{"m"} (unrelated to the usual @samp{"m"}
32431code as used with @code{defun}). It uses the numeric prefix argument as the
32432number of objects to remove from the stack and pass to the function.
32433In this case, the integer @var{num} serves as a default number of
32434arguments to be used when no prefix is supplied.
32435
32436@node Argument Qualifiers, Example Definitions, Defining Stack Commands, Lisp Definitions
32437@subsection Argument Qualifiers
32438
32439@noindent
32440Anywhere a parameter name can appear in the parameter list you can also use
32441an @dfn{argument qualifier}. Thus the general form of a definition is:
32442
32443@example
32444(defmath @var{name} (@var{param} @var{param...}
32445 &optional @var{param} @var{param...}
32446 &rest @var{param})
32447 @var{body})
32448@end example
32449
32450@noindent
32451where each @var{param} is either a symbol or a list of the form
32452
32453@example
32454(@var{qual} @var{param})
32455@end example
32456
32457The following qualifiers are recognized:
32458
32459@table @samp
32460@item complete
32461@findex complete
32462The argument must not be an incomplete vector, interval, or complex number.
32463(This is rarely needed since the Calculator itself will never call your
32464function with an incomplete argument. But there is nothing stopping your
32465own Lisp code from calling your function with an incomplete argument.)
32466
32467@item integer
32468@findex integer
32469The argument must be an integer. If it is an integer-valued float
32470it will be accepted but converted to integer form. Non-integers and
32471formulas are rejected.
32472
32473@item natnum
32474@findex natnum
32475Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must be non-negative.
32476
32477@item fixnum
32478@findex fixnum
32479Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must fit into a native Lisp integer,
32480which on most systems means less than 2^23 in absolute value. The
32481argument is converted into Lisp-integer form if necessary.
32482
32483@item float
32484@findex float
32485The argument is converted to floating-point format if it is a number or
32486vector. If it is a formula it is left alone. (The argument is never
32487actually rejected by this qualifier.)
32488
32489@item @var{pred}
32490The argument must satisfy predicate @var{pred}, which is one of the
32491standard Calculator predicates. @xref{Predicates}.
32492
32493@item not-@var{pred}
32494The argument must @emph{not} satisfy predicate @var{pred}.
32495@end table
32496
32497For example,
32498
32499@example
32500(defmath foo (a (constp (not-matrixp b)) &optional (float c)
32501 &rest (integer d))
32502 @var{body})
32503@end example
32504
32505@noindent
32506expands to
32507
32508@example
32509(defun calcFunc-foo (a b &optional c &rest d)
32510 (and (math-matrixp b)
32511 (math-reject-arg b 'not-matrixp))
32512 (or (math-constp b)
32513 (math-reject-arg b 'constp))
32514 (and c (setq c (math-check-float c)))
32515 (setq d (mapcar 'math-check-integer d))
32516 @var{body})
32517@end example
32518
32519@noindent
32520which performs the necessary checks and conversions before executing the
32521body of the function.
32522
32523@node Example Definitions, Calling Calc from Your Programs, Argument Qualifiers, Lisp Definitions
32524@subsection Example Definitions
32525
32526@noindent
32527This section includes some Lisp programming examples on a larger scale.
32528These programs make use of some of the Calculator's internal functions;
32529@pxref{Internals}.
32530
32531@menu
32532* Bit Counting Example::
32533* Sine Example::
32534@end menu
32535
32536@node Bit Counting Example, Sine Example, Example Definitions, Example Definitions
32537@subsubsection Bit-Counting
32538
32539@noindent
32540@ignore
32541@starindex
32542@end ignore
32543@tindex bcount
32544Calc does not include a built-in function for counting the number of
32545``one'' bits in a binary integer. It's easy to invent one using @kbd{b u}
32546to convert the integer to a set, and @kbd{V #} to count the elements of
32547that set; let's write a function that counts the bits without having to
32548create an intermediate set.
32549
32550@smallexample
32551(defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32552 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32553 (let ((count 0))
32554 (while (> n 0)
32555 (if (oddp n)
32556 (setq count (1+ count)))
32557 (setq n (lsh n -1)))
32558 count))
32559@end smallexample
32560
32561@noindent
32562When this is expanded by @code{defmath}, it will become the following
32563Emacs Lisp function:
32564
32565@smallexample
32566(defun calcFunc-bcount (n)
32567 (setq n (math-check-natnum n))
32568 (let ((count 0))
32569 (while (math-posp n)
32570 (if (math-oddp n)
32571 (setq count (math-add count 1)))
32572 (setq n (calcFunc-lsh n -1)))
32573 count))
32574@end smallexample
32575
32576If the input numbers are large, this function involves a fair amount
32577of arithmetic. A binary right shift is essentially a division by two;
32578recall that Calc stores integers in decimal form so bit shifts must
32579involve actual division.
32580
32581To gain a bit more efficiency, we could divide the integer into
32582@var{n}-bit chunks, each of which can be handled quickly because
32583they fit into Lisp integers. It turns out that Calc's arithmetic
32584routines are especially fast when dividing by an integer less than
325851000, so we can set @var{n = 9} bits and use repeated division by 512:
32586
32587@smallexample
32588(defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32589 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32590 (let ((count 0))
32591 (while (not (fixnump n))
32592 (let ((qr (idivmod n 512)))
32593 (setq count (+ count (bcount-fixnum (cdr qr)))
32594 n (car qr))))
32595 (+ count (bcount-fixnum n))))
32596
32597(defun bcount-fixnum (n)
32598 (let ((count 0))
32599 (while (> n 0)
32600 (setq count (+ count (logand n 1))
32601 n (lsh n -1)))
32602 count))
32603@end smallexample
32604
32605@noindent
32606Note that the second function uses @code{defun}, not @code{defmath}.
32607Because this function deals only with native Lisp integers (``fixnums''),
32608it can use the actual Emacs @code{+} and related functions rather
32609than the slower but more general Calc equivalents which @code{defmath}
32610uses.
32611
32612The @code{idivmod} function does an integer division, returning both
32613the quotient and the remainder at once. Again, note that while it
32614might seem that @samp{(logand n 511)} and @samp{(lsh n -9)} are
32615more efficient ways to split off the bottom nine bits of @code{n},
32616actually they are less efficient because each operation is really
32617a division by 512 in disguise; @code{idivmod} allows us to do the
32618same thing with a single division by 512.
32619
32620@node Sine Example, , Bit Counting Example, Example Definitions
32621@subsubsection The Sine Function
32622
32623@noindent
32624@ignore
32625@starindex
32626@end ignore
32627@tindex mysin
32628A somewhat limited sine function could be defined as follows, using the
32629well-known Taylor series expansion for
32630@texline @math{\sin x}:
32631@infoline @samp{sin(x)}:
32632
32633@smallexample
32634(defmath mysin ((float (anglep x)))
32635 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32636 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32637 (let ((sum x) ; Initial term of Taylor expansion of sin.
32638 newsum
32639 (nfact 1) ; "nfact" equals "n" factorial at all times.
32640 (xnegsqr :"-(x^2)")) ; "xnegsqr" equals -x^2.
32641 (for ((n 3 100 2)) ; Upper limit of 100 is a good precaution.
32642 (working "mysin" sum) ; Display "Working" message, if enabled.
32643 (setq nfact (* nfact (1- n) n)
32644 x (* x xnegsqr)
32645 newsum (+ sum (/ x nfact)))
32646 (if (~= newsum sum) ; If newsum is "nearly equal to" sum,
32647 (break)) ; then we are done.
32648 (setq sum newsum))
32649 sum))
32650@end smallexample
32651
32652The actual @code{sin} function in Calc works by first reducing the problem
32653to a sine or cosine of a nonnegative number less than @cpiover{4}. This
32654ensures that the Taylor series will converge quickly. Also, the calculation
32655is carried out with two extra digits of precision to guard against cumulative
32656round-off in @samp{sum}. Finally, complex arguments are allowed and handled
32657by a separate algorithm.
32658
32659@smallexample
32660(defmath mysin ((float (scalarp x)))
32661 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32662 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32663 (with-extra-prec 2 ; Evaluate with extra precision.
32664 (cond ((complexp x)
32665 (mysin-complex x))
32666 ((< x 0)
32667 (- (mysin-raw (- x))) ; Always call mysin-raw with x >= 0.
32668 (t (mysin-raw x))))))
32669
32670(defmath mysin-raw (x)
32671 (cond ((>= x 7)
32672 (mysin-raw (% x (two-pi)))) ; Now x < 7.
32673 ((> x (pi-over-2))
32674 (- (mysin-raw (- x (pi))))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/2.
32675 ((> x (pi-over-4))
32676 (mycos-raw (- x (pi-over-2)))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/4.
32677 ((< x (- (pi-over-4)))
32678 (- (mycos-raw (+ x (pi-over-2))))) ; Now -pi/4 <= x <= pi/4,
32679 (t (mysin-series x)))) ; so the series will be efficient.
32680@end smallexample
32681
32682@noindent
32683where @code{mysin-complex} is an appropriate function to handle complex
32684numbers, @code{mysin-series} is the routine to compute the sine Taylor
32685series as before, and @code{mycos-raw} is a function analogous to
32686@code{mysin-raw} for cosines.
32687
32688The strategy is to ensure that @expr{x} is nonnegative before calling
32689@code{mysin-raw}. This function then recursively reduces its argument
32690to a suitable range, namely, plus-or-minus @cpiover{4}. Note that each
32691test, and particularly the first comparison against 7, is designed so
32692that small roundoff errors cannot produce an infinite loop. (Suppose
32693we compared with @samp{(two-pi)} instead; if due to roundoff problems
32694the modulo operator ever returned @samp{(two-pi)} exactly, an infinite
32695recursion could result!) We use modulo only for arguments that will
32696clearly get reduced, knowing that the next rule will catch any reductions
32697that this rule misses.
32698
32699If a program is being written for general use, it is important to code
32700it carefully as shown in this second example. For quick-and-dirty programs,
32701when you know that your own use of the sine function will never encounter
32702a large argument, a simpler program like the first one shown is fine.
32703
32704@node Calling Calc from Your Programs, Internals, Example Definitions, Lisp Definitions
32705@subsection Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs
32706
32707@noindent
32708A later section (@pxref{Internals}) gives a full description of
32709Calc's internal Lisp functions. It's not hard to call Calc from
32710inside your programs, but the number of these functions can be daunting.
32711So Calc provides one special ``programmer-friendly'' function called
32712@code{calc-eval} that can be made to do just about everything you
32713need. It's not as fast as the low-level Calc functions, but it's
32714much simpler to use!
32715
32716It may seem that @code{calc-eval} itself has a daunting number of
32717options, but they all stem from one simple operation.
32718
32719In its simplest manifestation, @samp{(calc-eval "1+2")} parses the
32720string @code{"1+2"} as if it were a Calc algebraic entry and returns
32721the result formatted as a string: @code{"3"}.
32722
32723Since @code{calc-eval} is on the list of recommended @code{autoload}
32724functions, you don't need to make any special preparations to load
32725Calc before calling @code{calc-eval} the first time. Calc will be
32726loaded and initialized for you.
32727
32728All the Calc modes that are currently in effect will be used when
32729evaluating the expression and formatting the result.
32730
32731@ifinfo
32732@example
32733
32734@end example
32735@end ifinfo
32736@subsubsection Additional Arguments to @code{calc-eval}
32737
32738@noindent
32739If the input string parses to a list of expressions, Calc returns
32740the results separated by @code{", "}. You can specify a different
32741separator by giving a second string argument to @code{calc-eval}:
32742@samp{(calc-eval "1+2,3+4" ";")} returns @code{"3;7"}.
32743
32744The ``separator'' can also be any of several Lisp symbols which
32745request other behaviors from @code{calc-eval}. These are discussed
32746one by one below.
32747
32748You can give additional arguments to be substituted for
32749@samp{$}, @samp{$$}, and so on in the main expression. For
32750example, @samp{(calc-eval "$/$$" nil "7" "1+1")} evaluates the
32751expression @code{"7/(1+1)"} to yield the result @code{"3.5"}
32752(assuming Fraction mode is not in effect). Note the @code{nil}
32753used as a placeholder for the item-separator argument.
32754
32755@ifinfo
32756@example
32757
32758@end example
32759@end ifinfo
32760@subsubsection Error Handling
32761
32762@noindent
32763If @code{calc-eval} encounters an error, it returns a list containing
32764the character position of the error, plus a suitable message as a
32765string. Note that @samp{1 / 0} is @emph{not} an error by Calc's
32766standards; it simply returns the string @code{"1 / 0"} which is the
32767division left in symbolic form. But @samp{(calc-eval "1/")} will
32768return the list @samp{(2 "Expected a number")}.
32769
32770If you bind the variable @code{calc-eval-error} to @code{t}
32771using a @code{let} form surrounding the call to @code{calc-eval},
32772errors instead call the Emacs @code{error} function which aborts
32773to the Emacs command loop with a beep and an error message.
32774
32775If you bind this variable to the symbol @code{string}, error messages
32776are returned as strings instead of lists. The character position is
32777ignored.
32778
32779As a courtesy to other Lisp code which may be using Calc, be sure
32780to bind @code{calc-eval-error} using @code{let} rather than changing
32781it permanently with @code{setq}.
32782
32783@ifinfo
32784@example
32785
32786@end example
32787@end ifinfo
32788@subsubsection Numbers Only
32789
32790@noindent
32791Sometimes it is preferable to treat @samp{1 / 0} as an error
32792rather than returning a symbolic result. If you pass the symbol
32793@code{num} as the second argument to @code{calc-eval}, results
32794that are not constants are treated as errors. The error message
32795reported is the first @code{calc-why} message if there is one,
32796or otherwise ``Number expected.''
32797
32798A result is ``constant'' if it is a number, vector, or other
32799object that does not include variables or function calls. If it
32800is a vector, the components must themselves be constants.
32801
32802@ifinfo
32803@example
32804
32805@end example
32806@end ifinfo
32807@subsubsection Default Modes
32808
32809@noindent
32810If the first argument to @code{calc-eval} is a list whose first
32811element is a formula string, then @code{calc-eval} sets all the
32812various Calc modes to their default values while the formula is
32813evaluated and formatted. For example, the precision is set to 12
32814digits, digit grouping is turned off, and the Normal language
32815mode is used.
32816
32817This same principle applies to the other options discussed below.
32818If the first argument would normally be @var{x}, then it can also
32819be the list @samp{(@var{x})} to use the default mode settings.
32820
32821If there are other elements in the list, they are taken as
32822variable-name/value pairs which override the default mode
32823settings. Look at the documentation at the front of the
32824@file{calc.el} file to find the names of the Lisp variables for
32825the various modes. The mode settings are restored to their
32826original values when @code{calc-eval} is done.
32827
32828For example, @samp{(calc-eval '("$+$$" calc-internal-prec 8) 'num a b)}
32829computes the sum of two numbers, requiring a numeric result, and
32830using default mode settings except that the precision is 8 instead
32831of the default of 12.
32832
32833It's usually best to use this form of @code{calc-eval} unless your
32834program actually considers the interaction with Calc's mode settings
32835to be a feature. This will avoid all sorts of potential ``gotchas'';
32836consider what happens with @samp{(calc-eval "sqrt(2)" 'num)}
32837when the user has left Calc in Symbolic mode or No-Simplify mode.
32838
32839As another example, @samp{(equal (calc-eval '("$<$$") nil a b) "1")}
32840checks if the number in string @expr{a} is less than the one in
32841string @expr{b}. Without using a list, the integer 1 might
32842come out in a variety of formats which would be hard to test for
32843conveniently: @code{"1"}, @code{"8#1"}, @code{"00001"}. (But
32844see ``Predicates'' mode, below.)
32845
32846@ifinfo
32847@example
32848
32849@end example
32850@end ifinfo
32851@subsubsection Raw Numbers
32852
32853@noindent
32854Normally all input and output for @code{calc-eval} is done with strings.
32855You can do arithmetic with, say, @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" nil a b)}
32856in place of @samp{(+ a b)}, but this is very inefficient since the
32857numbers must be converted to and from string format as they are passed
32858from one @code{calc-eval} to the next.
32859
32860If the separator is the symbol @code{raw}, the result will be returned
32861as a raw Calc data structure rather than a string. You can read about
32862how these objects look in the following sections, but usually you can
32863treat them as ``black box'' objects with no important internal
32864structure.
32865
32866There is also a @code{rawnum} symbol, which is a combination of
32867@code{raw} (returning a raw Calc object) and @code{num} (signaling
32868an error if that object is not a constant).
32869
32870You can pass a raw Calc object to @code{calc-eval} in place of a
32871string, either as the formula itself or as one of the @samp{$}
32872arguments. Thus @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" 'raw a b)} is an
32873addition function that operates on raw Calc objects. Of course
32874in this case it would be easier to call the low-level @code{math-add}
32875function in Calc, if you can remember its name.
32876
32877In particular, note that a plain Lisp integer is acceptable to Calc
32878as a raw object. (All Lisp integers are accepted on input, but
32879integers of more than six decimal digits are converted to ``big-integer''
32880form for output. @xref{Data Type Formats}.)
32881
32882When it comes time to display the object, just use @samp{(calc-eval a)}
32883to format it as a string.
32884
32885It is an error if the input expression evaluates to a list of
32886values. The separator symbol @code{list} is like @code{raw}
32887except that it returns a list of one or more raw Calc objects.
32888
32889Note that a Lisp string is not a valid Calc object, nor is a list
32890containing a string. Thus you can still safely distinguish all the
32891various kinds of error returns discussed above.
32892
32893@ifinfo
32894@example
32895
32896@end example
32897@end ifinfo
32898@subsubsection Predicates
32899
32900@noindent
32901If the separator symbol is @code{pred}, the result of the formula is
32902treated as a true/false value; @code{calc-eval} returns @code{t} or
32903@code{nil}, respectively. A value is considered ``true'' if it is a
32904non-zero number, or false if it is zero or if it is not a number.
32905
32906For example, @samp{(calc-eval "$<$$" 'pred a b)} tests whether
32907one value is less than another.
32908
32909As usual, it is also possible for @code{calc-eval} to return one of
32910the error indicators described above. Lisp will interpret such an
32911indicator as ``true'' if you don't check for it explicitly. If you
32912wish to have an error register as ``false'', use something like
32913@samp{(eq (calc-eval ...) t)}.
32914
32915@ifinfo
32916@example
32917
32918@end example
32919@end ifinfo
32920@subsubsection Variable Values
32921
32922@noindent
32923Variables in the formula passed to @code{calc-eval} are not normally
32924replaced by their values. If you wish this, you can use the
32925@code{evalv} function (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}). For example,
32926if 4 is stored in Calc variable @code{a} (i.e., in Lisp variable
32927@code{var-a}), then @samp{(calc-eval "a+pi")} will return the
32928formula @code{"a + pi"}, but @samp{(calc-eval "evalv(a+pi)")}
32929will return @code{"7.14159265359"}.
32930
32931To store in a Calc variable, just use @code{setq} to store in the
32932corresponding Lisp variable. (This is obtained by prepending
32933@samp{var-} to the Calc variable name.) Calc routines will
32934understand either string or raw form values stored in variables,
32935although raw data objects are much more efficient. For example,
32936to increment the Calc variable @code{a}:
32937
32938@example
32939(setq var-a (calc-eval "evalv(a+1)" 'raw))
32940@end example
32941
32942@ifinfo
32943@example
32944
32945@end example
32946@end ifinfo
32947@subsubsection Stack Access
32948
32949@noindent
32950If the separator symbol is @code{push}, the formula argument is
32951evaluated (with possible @samp{$} expansions, as usual). The
32952result is pushed onto the Calc stack. The return value is @code{nil}
32953(unless there is an error from evaluating the formula, in which
32954case the return value depends on @code{calc-eval-error} in the
32955usual way).
32956
32957If the separator symbol is @code{pop}, the first argument to
32958@code{calc-eval} must be an integer instead of a string. That
32959many values are popped from the stack and thrown away. A negative
32960argument deletes the entry at that stack level. The return value
32961is the number of elements remaining in the stack after popping;
32962@samp{(calc-eval 0 'pop)} is a good way to measure the size of
32963the stack.
32964
32965If the separator symbol is @code{top}, the first argument to
32966@code{calc-eval} must again be an integer. The value at that
32967stack level is formatted as a string and returned. Thus
32968@samp{(calc-eval 1 'top)} returns the top-of-stack value. If the
32969integer is out of range, @code{nil} is returned.
32970
32971The separator symbol @code{rawtop} is just like @code{top} except
32972that the stack entry is returned as a raw Calc object instead of
32973as a string.
32974
32975In all of these cases the first argument can be made a list in
32976order to force the default mode settings, as described above.
32977Thus @samp{(calc-eval '(2 calc-number-radix 16) 'top)} returns the
32978second-to-top stack entry, formatted as a string using the default
32979instead of current display modes, except that the radix is
32980hexadecimal instead of decimal.
32981
32982It is, of course, polite to put the Calc stack back the way you
32983found it when you are done, unless the user of your program is
32984actually expecting it to affect the stack.
32985
32986Note that you do not actually have to switch into the @samp{*Calculator*}
32987buffer in order to use @code{calc-eval}; it temporarily switches into
32988the stack buffer if necessary.
32989
32990@ifinfo
32991@example
32992
32993@end example
32994@end ifinfo
32995@subsubsection Keyboard Macros
32996
32997@noindent
32998If the separator symbol is @code{macro}, the first argument must be a
32999string of characters which Calc can execute as a sequence of keystrokes.
33000This switches into the Calc buffer for the duration of the macro.
33001For example, @samp{(calc-eval "vx5\rVR+" 'macro)} pushes the
33002vector @samp{[1,2,3,4,5]} on the stack and then replaces it
33003with the sum of those numbers. Note that @samp{\r} is the Lisp
33004notation for the carriage-return, @key{RET}, character.
33005
33006If your keyboard macro wishes to pop the stack, @samp{\C-d} is
33007safer than @samp{\177} (the @key{DEL} character) because some
33008installations may have switched the meanings of @key{DEL} and
33009@kbd{C-h}. Calc always interprets @kbd{C-d} as a synonym for
33010``pop-stack'' regardless of key mapping.
33011
33012If you provide a third argument to @code{calc-eval}, evaluation
33013of the keyboard macro will leave a record in the Trail using
33014that argument as a tag string. Normally the Trail is unaffected.
33015
33016The return value in this case is always @code{nil}.
33017
33018@ifinfo
33019@example
33020
33021@end example
33022@end ifinfo
33023@subsubsection Lisp Evaluation
33024
33025@noindent
33026Finally, if the separator symbol is @code{eval}, then the Lisp
33027@code{eval} function is called on the first argument, which must
33028be a Lisp expression rather than a Calc formula. Remember to
33029quote the expression so that it is not evaluated until inside
33030@code{calc-eval}.
33031
33032The difference from plain @code{eval} is that @code{calc-eval}
33033switches to the Calc buffer before evaluating the expression.
33034For example, @samp{(calc-eval '(setq calc-internal-prec 17) 'eval)}
33035will correctly affect the buffer-local Calc precision variable.
33036
33037An alternative would be @samp{(calc-eval '(calc-precision 17) 'eval)}.
33038This is evaluating a call to the function that is normally invoked
33039by the @kbd{p} key, giving it 17 as its ``numeric prefix argument.''
33040Note that this function will leave a message in the echo area as
33041a side effect. Also, all Calc functions switch to the Calc buffer
33042automatically if not invoked from there, so the above call is
33043also equivalent to @samp{(calc-precision 17)} by itself.
33044In all cases, Calc uses @code{save-excursion} to switch back to
33045your original buffer when it is done.
33046
33047As usual the first argument can be a list that begins with a Lisp
33048expression to use default instead of current mode settings.
33049
33050The result of @code{calc-eval} in this usage is just the result
33051returned by the evaluated Lisp expression.
33052
33053@ifinfo
33054@example
33055
33056@end example
33057@end ifinfo
33058@subsubsection Example
33059
33060@noindent
33061@findex convert-temp
33062Here is a sample Emacs command that uses @code{calc-eval}. Suppose
33063you have a document with lots of references to temperatures on the
33064Fahrenheit scale, say ``98.6 F'', and you wish to convert these
33065references to Centigrade. The following command does this conversion.
33066Place the Emacs cursor right after the letter ``F'' and invoke the
33067command to change ``98.6 F'' to ``37 C''. Or, if the temperature is
33068already in Centigrade form, the command changes it back to Fahrenheit.
33069
33070@example
33071(defun convert-temp ()
33072 (interactive)
33073 (save-excursion
33074 (re-search-backward "[^-.0-9]\\([-.0-9]+\\) *\\([FC]\\)")
33075 (let* ((top1 (match-beginning 1))
33076 (bot1 (match-end 1))
33077 (number (buffer-substring top1 bot1))
33078 (top2 (match-beginning 2))
33079 (bot2 (match-end 2))
33080 (type (buffer-substring top2 bot2)))
33081 (if (equal type "F")
33082 (setq type "C"
33083 number (calc-eval "($ - 32)*5/9" nil number))
33084 (setq type "F"
33085 number (calc-eval "$*9/5 + 32" nil number)))
33086 (goto-char top2)
33087 (delete-region top2 bot2)
33088 (insert-before-markers type)
33089 (goto-char top1)
33090 (delete-region top1 bot1)
33091 (if (string-match "\\.$" number) ; change "37." to "37"
33092 (setq number (substring number 0 -1)))
33093 (insert number))))
33094@end example
33095
33096Note the use of @code{insert-before-markers} when changing between
33097``F'' and ``C'', so that the character winds up before the cursor
33098instead of after it.
33099
33100@node Internals, , Calling Calc from Your Programs, Lisp Definitions
33101@subsection Calculator Internals
33102
33103@noindent
33104This section describes the Lisp functions defined by the Calculator that
33105may be of use to user-written Calculator programs (as described in the
33106rest of this chapter). These functions are shown by their names as they
33107conventionally appear in @code{defmath}. Their full Lisp names are
33108generally gotten by prepending @samp{calcFunc-} or @samp{math-} to their
33109apparent names. (Names that begin with @samp{calc-} are already in
33110their full Lisp form.) You can use the actual full names instead if you
33111prefer them, or if you are calling these functions from regular Lisp.
33112
33113The functions described here are scattered throughout the various
33114Calc component files. Note that @file{calc.el} includes @code{autoload}s
33115for only a few component files; when Calc wants to call an advanced
33116function it calls @samp{(calc-extensions)} first; this function
33117autoloads @file{calc-ext.el}, which in turn autoloads all the functions
33118in the remaining component files.
33119
33120Because @code{defmath} itself uses the extensions, user-written code
33121generally always executes with the extensions already loaded, so
33122normally you can use any Calc function and be confident that it will
33123be autoloaded for you when necessary. If you are doing something
33124special, check carefully to make sure each function you are using is
33125from @file{calc.el} or its components, and call @samp{(calc-extensions)}
33126before using any function based in @file{calc-ext.el} if you can't
33127prove this file will already be loaded.
33128
33129@menu
33130* Data Type Formats::
33131* Interactive Lisp Functions::
33132* Stack Lisp Functions::
33133* Predicates::
33134* Computational Lisp Functions::
33135* Vector Lisp Functions::
33136* Symbolic Lisp Functions::
33137* Formatting Lisp Functions::
33138* Hooks::
33139@end menu
33140
33141@node Data Type Formats, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals, Internals
33142@subsubsection Data Type Formats
33143
33144@noindent
33145Integers are stored in either of two ways, depending on their magnitude.
33146Integers less than one million in absolute value are stored as standard
33147Lisp integers. This is the only storage format for Calc data objects
33148which is not a Lisp list.
33149
33150Large integers are stored as lists of the form @samp{(bigpos @var{d0}
33151@var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for positive integers 1000000 or more, or
33152@samp{(bigneg @var{d0} @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for negative integers
33153@mathit{-1000000} or less. Each @var{d} is a base-1000 ``digit,'' a Lisp integer
33154from 0 to 999. The least significant digit is @var{d0}; the last digit,
33155@var{dn}, which is always nonzero, is the most significant digit. For
33156example, the integer @mathit{-12345678} is stored as @samp{(bigneg 678 345 12)}.
33157
33158The distinction between small and large integers is entirely hidden from
33159the user. In @code{defmath} definitions, the Lisp predicate @code{integerp}
33160returns true for either kind of integer, and in general both big and small
33161integers are accepted anywhere the word ``integer'' is used in this manual.
33162If the distinction must be made, native Lisp integers are called @dfn{fixnums}
33163and large integers are called @dfn{bignums}.
33164
33165Fractions are stored as a list of the form, @samp{(frac @var{n} @var{d})}
33166where @var{n} is an integer (big or small) numerator, @var{d} is an
33167integer denominator greater than one, and @var{n} and @var{d} are relatively
33168prime. Note that fractions where @var{d} is one are automatically converted
33169to plain integers by all math routines; fractions where @var{d} is negative
33170are normalized by negating the numerator and denominator.
33171
33172Floating-point numbers are stored in the form, @samp{(float @var{mant}
33173@var{exp})}, where @var{mant} (the ``mantissa'') is an integer less than
33174@samp{10^@var{p}} in absolute value (@var{p} represents the current
33175precision), and @var{exp} (the ``exponent'') is a fixnum. The value of
33176the float is @samp{@var{mant} * 10^@var{exp}}. For example, the number
33177@mathit{-3.14} is stored as @samp{(float -314 -2) = -314*10^-2}. Other constraints
33178are that the number 0.0 is always stored as @samp{(float 0 0)}, and,
33179except for the 0.0 case, the rightmost base-10 digit of @var{mant} is
33180always nonzero. (If the rightmost digit is zero, the number is
33181rearranged by dividing @var{mant} by ten and incrementing @var{exp}.)
33182
33183Rectangular complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(cplx @var{re}
33184@var{im})}, where @var{re} and @var{im} are each real numbers, either
33185integers, fractions, or floats. The value is @samp{@var{re} + @var{im}i}.
33186The @var{im} part is nonzero; complex numbers with zero imaginary
33187components are converted to real numbers automatically.
33188
33189Polar complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(polar @var{r}
33190@var{theta})}, where @var{r} is a positive real value and @var{theta}
33191is a real value or HMS form representing an angle. This angle is
33192usually normalized to lie in the interval @samp{(-180 ..@: 180)} degrees,
33193or @samp{(-pi ..@: pi)} radians, according to the current angular mode.
33194If the angle is 0 the value is converted to a real number automatically.
33195(If the angle is 180 degrees, the value is usually also converted to a
33196negative real number.)
33197
33198Hours-minutes-seconds forms are stored as @samp{(hms @var{h} @var{m}
33199@var{s})}, where @var{h} is an integer or an integer-valued float (i.e.,
33200a float with @samp{@var{exp} >= 0}), @var{m} is an integer or integer-valued
33201float in the range @w{@samp{[0 ..@: 60)}}, and @var{s} is any real number
33202in the range @samp{[0 ..@: 60)}.
33203
33204Date forms are stored as @samp{(date @var{n})}, where @var{n} is
33205a real number that counts days since midnight on the morning of
33206January 1, 1 AD. If @var{n} is an integer, this is a pure date
33207form. If @var{n} is a fraction or float, this is a date/time form.
33208
33209Modulo forms are stored as @samp{(mod @var{n} @var{m})}, where @var{m} is a
33210positive real number or HMS form, and @var{n} is a real number or HMS
33211form in the range @samp{[0 ..@: @var{m})}.
33212
33213Error forms are stored as @samp{(sdev @var{x} @var{sigma})}, where @var{x}
33214is the mean value and @var{sigma} is the standard deviation. Each
33215component is either a number, an HMS form, or a symbolic object
33216(a variable or function call). If @var{sigma} is zero, the value is
33217converted to a plain real number. If @var{sigma} is negative or
33218complex, it is automatically normalized to be a positive real.
33219
33220Interval forms are stored as @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{lo} @var{hi})},
33221where @var{mask} is one of the integers 0, 1, 2, or 3, and @var{lo} and
33222@var{hi} are real numbers, HMS forms, or symbolic objects. The @var{mask}
33223is a binary integer where 1 represents the fact that the interval is
33224closed on the high end, and 2 represents the fact that it is closed on
33225the low end. (Thus 3 represents a fully closed interval.) The interval
33226@w{@samp{(intv 3 @var{x} @var{x})}} is converted to the plain number @var{x};
33227intervals @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{x} @var{x})} for any other @var{mask}
33228represent empty intervals. If @var{hi} is less than @var{lo}, the interval
33229is converted to a standard empty interval by replacing @var{hi} with @var{lo}.
33230
33231Vectors are stored as @samp{(vec @var{v1} @var{v2} @dots{})}, where @var{v1}
33232is the first element of the vector, @var{v2} is the second, and so on.
33233An empty vector is stored as @samp{(vec)}. A matrix is simply a vector
33234where all @var{v}'s are themselves vectors of equal lengths. Note that
33235Calc vectors are unrelated to the Emacs Lisp ``vector'' type, which is
33236generally unused by Calc data structures.
33237
33238Variables are stored as @samp{(var @var{name} @var{sym})}, where
33239@var{name} is a Lisp symbol whose print name is used as the visible name
33240of the variable, and @var{sym} is a Lisp symbol in which the variable's
33241value is actually stored. Thus, @samp{(var pi var-pi)} represents the
33242special constant @samp{pi}. Almost always, the form is @samp{(var
33243@var{v} var-@var{v})}. If the variable name was entered with @code{#}
33244signs (which are converted to hyphens internally), the form is
33245@samp{(var @var{u} @var{v})}, where @var{u} is a symbol whose name
33246contains @code{#} characters, and @var{v} is a symbol that contains
33247@code{-} characters instead. The value of a variable is the Calc
33248object stored in its @var{sym} symbol's value cell. If the symbol's
33249value cell is void or if it contains @code{nil}, the variable has no
33250value. Special constants have the form @samp{(special-const
33251@var{value})} stored in their value cell, where @var{value} is a formula
33252which is evaluated when the constant's value is requested. Variables
33253which represent units are not stored in any special way; they are units
33254only because their names appear in the units table. If the value
33255cell contains a string, it is parsed to get the variable's value when
33256the variable is used.
33257
33258A Lisp list with any other symbol as the first element is a function call.
33259The symbols @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^},
33260and @code{|} represent special binary operators; these lists are always
33261of the form @samp{(@var{op} @var{lhs} @var{rhs})} where @var{lhs} is the
33262sub-formula on the lefthand side and @var{rhs} is the sub-formula on the
33263right. The symbol @code{neg} represents unary negation; this list is always
33264of the form @samp{(neg @var{arg})}. Any other symbol @var{func} represents a
33265function that would be displayed in function-call notation; the symbol
33266@var{func} is in general always of the form @samp{calcFunc-@var{name}}.
33267The function cell of the symbol @var{func} should contain a Lisp function
33268for evaluating a call to @var{func}. This function is passed the remaining
33269elements of the list (themselves already evaluated) as arguments; such
33270functions should return @code{nil} or call @code{reject-arg} to signify
33271that they should be left in symbolic form, or they should return a Calc
33272object which represents their value, or a list of such objects if they
33273wish to return multiple values. (The latter case is allowed only for
33274functions which are the outer-level call in an expression whose value is
33275about to be pushed on the stack; this feature is considered obsolete
33276and is not used by any built-in Calc functions.)
33277
33278@node Interactive Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Data Type Formats, Internals
33279@subsubsection Interactive Functions
33280
33281@noindent
33282The functions described here are used in implementing interactive Calc
33283commands. Note that this list is not exhaustive! If there is an
33284existing command that behaves similarly to the one you want to define,
33285you may find helpful tricks by checking the source code for that command.
33286
33287@defun calc-set-command-flag flag
33288Set the command flag @var{flag}. This is generally a Lisp symbol, but
33289may in fact be anything. The effect is to add @var{flag} to the list
33290stored in the variable @code{calc-command-flags}, unless it is already
33291there. @xref{Defining Simple Commands}.
33292@end defun
33293
33294@defun calc-clear-command-flag flag
33295If @var{flag} appears among the list of currently-set command flags,
33296remove it from that list.
33297@end defun
33298
33299@defun calc-record-undo rec
33300Add the ``undo record'' @var{rec} to the list of steps to take if the
33301current operation should need to be undone. Stack push and pop functions
33302automatically call @code{calc-record-undo}, so the kinds of undo records
33303you might need to create take the form @samp{(set @var{sym} @var{value})},
33304which says that the Lisp variable @var{sym} was changed and had previously
33305contained @var{value}; @samp{(store @var{var} @var{value})} which says that
33306the Calc variable @var{var} (a string which is the name of the symbol that
33307contains the variable's value) was stored and its previous value was
33308@var{value} (either a Calc data object, or @code{nil} if the variable was
33309previously void); or @samp{(eval @var{undo} @var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})},
33310which means that to undo requires calling the function @samp{(@var{undo}
33311@var{args} @dots{})} and, if the undo is later redone, calling
33312@samp{(@var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})}.
33313@end defun
33314
33315@defun calc-record-why msg args
33316Record the error or warning message @var{msg}, which is normally a string.
33317This message will be replayed if the user types @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why});
33318if the message string begins with a @samp{*}, it is considered important
33319enough to display even if the user doesn't type @kbd{w}. If one or more
33320@var{args} are present, the displayed message will be of the form,
33321@samp{@var{msg}: @var{arg1}, @var{arg2}, @dots{}}, where the arguments are
33322formatted on the assumption that they are either strings or Calc objects of
33323some sort. If @var{msg} is a symbol, it is the name of a Calc predicate
33324(such as @code{integerp} or @code{numvecp}) which the arguments did not
33325satisfy; it is expanded to a suitable string such as ``Expected an
33326integer.'' The @code{reject-arg} function calls @code{calc-record-why}
33327automatically; @pxref{Predicates}.
33328@end defun
33329
33330@defun calc-is-inverse
33331This predicate returns true if the current command is inverse,
33332i.e., if the Inverse (@kbd{I} key) flag was set.
33333@end defun
33334
33335@defun calc-is-hyperbolic
33336This predicate is the analogous function for the @kbd{H} key.
33337@end defun
33338
33339@node Stack Lisp Functions, Predicates, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals
33340@subsubsection Stack-Oriented Functions
33341
33342@noindent
33343The functions described here perform various operations on the Calc
33344stack and trail. They are to be used in interactive Calc commands.
33345
33346@defun calc-push-list vals n
33347Push the Calc objects in list @var{vals} onto the stack at stack level
33348@var{n}. If @var{n} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements
33349are pushed at the top of the stack. If @var{n} is greater than 1, the
33350elements will be inserted into the stack so that the last element will
33351end up at level @var{n}, the next-to-last at level @var{n}+1, etc.
33352The elements of @var{vals} are assumed to be valid Calc objects, and
33353are not evaluated, rounded, or renormalized in any way. If @var{vals}
33354is an empty list, nothing happens.
33355
33356The stack elements are pushed without any sub-formula selections.
33357You can give an optional third argument to this function, which must
33358be a list the same size as @var{vals} of selections. Each selection
33359must be @code{eq} to some sub-formula of the corresponding formula
33360in @var{vals}, or @code{nil} if that formula should have no selection.
33361@end defun
33362
33363@defun calc-top-list n m
33364Return a list of the @var{n} objects starting at level @var{m} of the
33365stack. If @var{m} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements are
33366taken from the top of the stack. If @var{n} is omitted, it also
33367defaults to 1, so that the top stack element (in the form of a
33368one-element list) is returned. If @var{m} is greater than 1, the
33369@var{m}th stack element will be at the end of the list, the @var{m}+1st
33370element will be next-to-last, etc. If @var{n} or @var{m} are out of
33371range, the command is aborted with a suitable error message. If @var{n}
33372is zero, the function returns an empty list. The stack elements are not
33373evaluated, rounded, or renormalized.
33374
33375If any stack elements contain selections, and selections have not
33376been disabled by the @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command,
33377this function returns the selected portions rather than the entire
33378stack elements. It can be given a third ``selection-mode'' argument
33379which selects other behaviors. If it is the symbol @code{t}, then
33380a selection in any of the requested stack elements produces an
33381``invalid operation on selections'' error. If it is the symbol @code{full},
33382the whole stack entry is always returned regardless of selections.
33383If it is the symbol @code{sel}, the selected portion is always returned,
33384or @code{nil} if there is no selection. (This mode ignores the @kbd{j e}
33385command.) If the symbol is @code{entry}, the complete stack entry in
33386list form is returned; the first element of this list will be the whole
33387formula, and the third element will be the selection (or @code{nil}).
33388@end defun
33389
33390@defun calc-pop-stack n m
33391Remove the specified elements from the stack. The parameters @var{n}
33392and @var{m} are defined the same as for @code{calc-top-list}. The return
33393value of @code{calc-pop-stack} is uninteresting.
33394
33395If there are any selected sub-formulas among the popped elements, and
33396@kbd{j e} has not been used to disable selections, this produces an
33397error without changing the stack. If you supply an optional third
33398argument of @code{t}, the stack elements are popped even if they
33399contain selections.
33400@end defun
33401
33402@defun calc-record-list vals tag
33403This function records one or more results in the trail. The @var{vals}
33404are a list of strings or Calc objects. The @var{tag} is the four-character
33405tag string to identify the values. If @var{tag} is omitted, a blank tag
33406will be used.
33407@end defun
33408
33409@defun calc-normalize n
33410This function takes a Calc object and ``normalizes'' it. At the very
33411least this involves re-rounding floating-point values according to the
33412current precision and other similar jobs. Also, unless the user has
33413selected No-Simplify mode (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), this involves
33414actually evaluating a formula object by executing the function calls
33415it contains, and possibly also doing algebraic simplification, etc.
33416@end defun
33417
33418@defun calc-top-list-n n m
33419This function is identical to @code{calc-top-list}, except that it calls
33420@code{calc-normalize} on the values that it takes from the stack. They
33421are also passed through @code{check-complete}, so that incomplete
33422objects will be rejected with an error message. All computational
33423commands should use this in preference to @code{calc-top-list}; the only
33424standard Calc commands that operate on the stack without normalizing
33425are stack management commands like @code{calc-enter} and @code{calc-roll-up}.
33426This function accepts the same optional selection-mode argument as
33427@code{calc-top-list}.
33428@end defun
33429
33430@defun calc-top-n m
33431This function is a convenient form of @code{calc-top-list-n} in which only
33432a single element of the stack is taken and returned, rather than a list
33433of elements. This also accepts an optional selection-mode argument.
33434@end defun
33435
33436@defun calc-enter-result n tag vals
33437This function is a convenient interface to most of the above functions.
33438The @var{vals} argument should be either a single Calc object, or a list
33439of Calc objects; the object or objects are normalized, and the top @var{n}
33440stack entries are replaced by the normalized objects. If @var{tag} is
33441non-@code{nil}, the normalized objects are also recorded in the trail.
33442A typical stack-based computational command would take the form,
33443
33444@smallexample
33445(calc-enter-result @var{n} @var{tag} (cons 'calcFunc-@var{func}
33446 (calc-top-list-n @var{n})))
33447@end smallexample
33448
33449If any of the @var{n} stack elements replaced contain sub-formula
33450selections, and selections have not been disabled by @kbd{j e},
33451this function takes one of two courses of action. If @var{n} is
33452equal to the number of elements in @var{vals}, then each element of
33453@var{vals} is spliced into the corresponding selection; this is what
33454happens when you use the @key{TAB} key, or when you use a unary
33455arithmetic operation like @code{sqrt}. If @var{vals} has only one
33456element but @var{n} is greater than one, there must be only one
33457selection among the top @var{n} stack elements; the element from
33458@var{vals} is spliced into that selection. This is what happens when
33459you use a binary arithmetic operation like @kbd{+}. Any other
33460combination of @var{n} and @var{vals} is an error when selections
33461are present.
33462@end defun
33463
33464@defun calc-unary-op tag func arg
33465This function implements a unary operator that allows a numeric prefix
33466argument to apply the operator over many stack entries. If the prefix
33467argument @var{arg} is @code{nil}, this uses @code{calc-enter-result}
33468as outlined above. Otherwise, it maps the function over several stack
33469elements; @pxref{Prefix Arguments}. For example,
33470
33471@smallexample
33472(defun calc-zeta (arg)
33473 (interactive "P")
33474 (calc-unary-op "zeta" 'calcFunc-zeta arg))
33475@end smallexample
33476@end defun
33477
33478@defun calc-binary-op tag func arg ident unary
33479This function implements a binary operator, analogously to
33480@code{calc-unary-op}. The optional @var{ident} and @var{unary}
33481arguments specify the behavior when the prefix argument is zero or
33482one, respectively. If the prefix is zero, the value @var{ident}
33483is pushed onto the stack, if specified, otherwise an error message
33484is displayed. If the prefix is one, the unary function @var{unary}
33485is applied to the top stack element, or, if @var{unary} is not
33486specified, nothing happens. When the argument is two or more,
33487the binary function @var{func} is reduced across the top @var{arg}
33488stack elements; when the argument is negative, the function is
33489mapped between the next-to-top @mathit{-@var{arg}} stack elements and the
33490top element.
33491@end defun
33492
33493@defun calc-stack-size
33494Return the number of elements on the stack as an integer. This count
33495does not include elements that have been temporarily hidden by stack
33496truncation; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
33497@end defun
33498
33499@defun calc-cursor-stack-index n
33500Move the point to the @var{n}th stack entry. If @var{n} is zero, this
33501will be the @samp{.} line. If @var{n} is from 1 to the current stack size,
33502this will be the beginning of the first line of that stack entry's display.
33503If line numbers are enabled, this will move to the first character of the
33504line number, not the stack entry itself.
33505@end defun
33506
33507@defun calc-substack-height n
33508Return the number of lines between the beginning of the @var{n}th stack
33509entry and the bottom of the buffer. If @var{n} is zero, this
33510will be one (assuming no stack truncation). If all stack entries are
33511one line long (i.e., no matrices are displayed), the return value will
33512be equal @var{n}+1 as long as @var{n} is in range. (Note that in Big
33513mode, the return value includes the blank lines that separate stack
33514entries.)
33515@end defun
33516
33517@defun calc-refresh
33518Erase the @code{*Calculator*} buffer and reformat its contents from memory.
33519This must be called after changing any parameter, such as the current
33520display radix, which might change the appearance of existing stack
33521entries. (During a keyboard macro invoked by the @kbd{X} key, refreshing
33522is suppressed, but a flag is set so that the entire stack will be refreshed
33523rather than just the top few elements when the macro finishes.)
33524@end defun
33525
33526@node Predicates, Computational Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Internals
33527@subsubsection Predicates
33528
33529@noindent
33530The functions described here are predicates, that is, they return a
33531true/false value where @code{nil} means false and anything else means
33532true. These predicates are expanded by @code{defmath}, for example,
33533from @code{zerop} to @code{math-zerop}. In many cases they correspond
33534to native Lisp functions by the same name, but are extended to cover
33535the full range of Calc data types.
33536
33537@defun zerop x
33538Returns true if @var{x} is numerically zero, in any of the Calc data
33539types. (Note that for some types, such as error forms and intervals,
33540it never makes sense to return true.) In @code{defmath}, the expression
33541@samp{(= x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-zerop x)},
33542and @samp{(/= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-zerop x))}.
33543@end defun
33544
33545@defun negp x
33546Returns true if @var{x} is negative. This accepts negative real numbers
33547of various types, negative HMS and date forms, and intervals in which
33548all included values are negative. In @code{defmath}, the expression
33549@samp{(< x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-negp x)},
33550and @samp{(>= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-negp x))}.
33551@end defun
33552
33553@defun posp x
33554Returns true if @var{x} is positive (and non-zero). For complex
33555numbers, none of these three predicates will return true.
33556@end defun
33557
33558@defun looks-negp x
33559Returns true if @var{x} is ``negative-looking.'' This returns true if
33560@var{x} is a negative number, or a formula with a leading minus sign
33561such as @samp{-a/b}. In other words, this is an object which can be
33562made simpler by calling @code{(- @var{x})}.
33563@end defun
33564
33565@defun integerp x
33566Returns true if @var{x} is an integer of any size.
33567@end defun
33568
33569@defun fixnump x
33570Returns true if @var{x} is a native Lisp integer.
33571@end defun
33572
33573@defun natnump x
33574Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative integer of any size.
33575@end defun
33576
33577@defun fixnatnump x
33578Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative Lisp integer.
33579@end defun
33580
33581@defun num-integerp x
33582Returns true if @var{x} is numerically an integer, i.e., either a
33583true integer or a float with no significant digits to the right of
33584the decimal point.
33585@end defun
33586
33587@defun messy-integerp x
33588Returns true if @var{x} is numerically, but not literally, an integer.
33589A value is @code{num-integerp} if it is @code{integerp} or
33590@code{messy-integerp} (but it is never both at once).
33591@end defun
33592
33593@defun num-natnump x
33594Returns true if @var{x} is numerically a nonnegative integer.
33595@end defun
33596
33597@defun evenp x
33598Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer.
33599@end defun
33600
33601@defun looks-evenp x
33602Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer, or a formula with a leading
33603multiplicative coefficient which is an even integer.
33604@end defun
33605
33606@defun oddp x
33607Returns true if @var{x} is an odd integer.
33608@end defun
33609
33610@defun ratp x
33611Returns true if @var{x} is a rational number, i.e., an integer or a
33612fraction.
33613@end defun
33614
33615@defun realp x
33616Returns true if @var{x} is a real number, i.e., an integer, fraction,
33617or floating-point number.
33618@end defun
33619
33620@defun anglep x
33621Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or HMS form.
33622@end defun
33623
33624@defun floatp x
33625Returns true if @var{x} is a float, or a complex number, error form,
33626interval, date form, or modulo form in which at least one component
33627is a float.
33628@end defun
33629
33630@defun complexp x
33631Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular or polar complex number
33632(but not a real number).
33633@end defun
33634
33635@defun rect-complexp x
33636Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular complex number.
33637@end defun
33638
33639@defun polar-complexp x
33640Returns true if @var{x} is a polar complex number.
33641@end defun
33642
33643@defun numberp x
33644Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or a complex number.
33645@end defun
33646
33647@defun scalarp x
33648Returns true if @var{x} is a real or complex number or an HMS form.
33649@end defun
33650
33651@defun vectorp x
33652Returns true if @var{x} is a vector (this simply checks if its argument
33653is a list whose first element is the symbol @code{vec}).
33654@end defun
33655
33656@defun numvecp x
33657Returns true if @var{x} is a number or vector.
33658@end defun
33659
33660@defun matrixp x
33661Returns true if @var{x} is a matrix, i.e., a vector of one or more vectors,
33662all of the same size.
33663@end defun
33664
33665@defun square-matrixp x
33666Returns true if @var{x} is a square matrix.
33667@end defun
33668
33669@defun objectp x
33670Returns true if @var{x} is any numeric Calc object, including real and
33671complex numbers, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33672modulo forms. (Note that error forms and intervals may include formulas
33673as their components; see @code{constp} below.)
33674@end defun
33675
33676@defun objvecp x
33677Returns true if @var{x} is an object or a vector. This also accepts
33678incomplete objects, but it rejects variables and formulas (except as
33679mentioned above for @code{objectp}).
33680@end defun
33681
33682@defun primp x
33683Returns true if @var{x} is a ``primitive'' or ``atomic'' Calc object,
33684i.e., one whose components cannot be regarded as sub-formulas. This
33685includes variables, and all @code{objectp} types except error forms
33686and intervals.
33687@end defun
33688
33689@defun constp x
33690Returns true if @var{x} is constant, i.e., a real or complex number,
33691HMS form, date form, or error form, interval, or vector all of whose
33692components are @code{constp}.
33693@end defun
33694
33695@defun lessp x y
33696Returns true if @var{x} is numerically less than @var{y}. Returns false
33697if @var{x} is greater than or equal to @var{y}, or if the order is
33698undefined or cannot be determined. Generally speaking, this works
33699by checking whether @samp{@var{x} - @var{y}} is @code{negp}. In
33700@code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(< x y)} will automatically be
33701converted to @samp{(lessp x y)}; expressions involving @code{>}, @code{<=},
33702and @code{>=} are similarly converted in terms of @code{lessp}.
33703@end defun
33704
33705@defun beforep x y
33706Returns true if @var{x} comes before @var{y} in a canonical ordering
33707of Calc objects. If @var{x} and @var{y} are both real numbers, this
33708will be the same as @code{lessp}. But whereas @code{lessp} considers
33709other types of objects to be unordered, @code{beforep} puts any two
33710objects into a definite, consistent order. The @code{beforep}
33711function is used by the @kbd{V S} vector-sorting command, and also
33712by @kbd{a s} to put the terms of a product into canonical order:
33713This allows @samp{x y + y x} to be simplified easily to @samp{2 x y}.
33714@end defun
33715
33716@defun equal x y
33717This is the standard Lisp @code{equal} predicate; it returns true if
33718@var{x} and @var{y} are structurally identical. This is the usual way
33719to compare numbers for equality, but note that @code{equal} will treat
337200 and 0.0 as different.
33721@end defun
33722
33723@defun math-equal x y
33724Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y} are numerically equal, either because
33725they are @code{equal}, or because their difference is @code{zerop}. In
33726@code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(= x y)} will automatically be
33727converted to @samp{(math-equal x y)}.
33728@end defun
33729
33730@defun equal-int x n
33731Returns true if @var{x} and @var{n} are numerically equal, where @var{n}
33732is a fixnum which is not a multiple of 10. This will automatically be
33733used by @code{defmath} in place of the more general @code{math-equal}
33734whenever possible.
33735@end defun
33736
33737@defun nearly-equal x y
33738Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y}, as floating-point numbers, are
33739equal except possibly in the last decimal place. For example,
33740314.159 and 314.166 are considered nearly equal if the current
33741precision is 6 (since they differ by 7 units), but not if the current
33742precision is 7 (since they differ by 70 units). Most functions which
33743use series expansions use @code{with-extra-prec} to evaluate the
33744series with 2 extra digits of precision, then use @code{nearly-equal}
33745to decide when the series has converged; this guards against cumulative
33746error in the series evaluation without doing extra work which would be
33747lost when the result is rounded back down to the current precision.
33748In @code{defmath}, this can be written @samp{(~= @var{x} @var{y})}.
33749The @var{x} and @var{y} can be numbers of any kind, including complex.
33750@end defun
33751
33752@defun nearly-zerop x y
33753Returns true if @var{x} is nearly zero, compared to @var{y}. This
33754checks whether @var{x} plus @var{y} would by be @code{nearly-equal}
33755to @var{y} itself, to within the current precision, in other words,
33756if adding @var{x} to @var{y} would have a negligible effect on @var{y}
33757due to roundoff error. @var{X} may be a real or complex number, but
33758@var{y} must be real.
33759@end defun
33760
33761@defun is-true x
33762Return true if the formula @var{x} represents a true value in
33763Calc, not Lisp, terms. It tests if @var{x} is a non-zero number
33764or a provably non-zero formula.
33765@end defun
33766
33767@defun reject-arg val pred
33768Abort the current function evaluation due to unacceptable argument values.
33769This calls @samp{(calc-record-why @var{pred} @var{val})}, then signals a
33770Lisp error which @code{normalize} will trap. The net effect is that the
33771function call which led here will be left in symbolic form.
33772@end defun
33773
33774@defun inexact-value
33775If Symbolic mode is enabled, this will signal an error that causes
33776@code{normalize} to leave the formula in symbolic form, with the message
33777``Inexact result.'' (This function has no effect when not in Symbolic mode.)
33778Note that if your function calls @samp{(sin 5)} in Symbolic mode, the
33779@code{sin} function will call @code{inexact-value}, which will cause your
33780function to be left unsimplified. You may instead wish to call
33781@samp{(normalize (list 'calcFunc-sin 5))}, which in Symbolic mode will
33782return the formula @samp{sin(5)} to your function.
33783@end defun
33784
33785@defun overflow
33786This signals an error that will be reported as a floating-point overflow.
33787@end defun
33788
33789@defun underflow
33790This signals a floating-point underflow.
33791@end defun
33792
33793@node Computational Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Predicates, Internals
33794@subsubsection Computational Functions
33795
33796@noindent
33797The functions described here do the actual computational work of the
33798Calculator. In addition to these, note that any function described in
33799the main body of this manual may be called from Lisp; for example, if
33800the documentation refers to the @code{calc-sqrt} [@code{sqrt}] command,
33801this means @code{calc-sqrt} is an interactive stack-based square-root
33802command and @code{sqrt} (which @code{defmath} expands to @code{calcFunc-sqrt})
33803is the actual Lisp function for taking square roots.
33804
33805The functions @code{math-add}, @code{math-sub}, @code{math-mul},
33806@code{math-div}, @code{math-mod}, and @code{math-neg} are not included
33807in this list, since @code{defmath} allows you to write native Lisp
33808@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, and unary @code{-},
33809respectively, instead.
33810
33811@defun normalize val
33812(Full form: @code{math-normalize}.)
33813Reduce the value @var{val} to standard form. For example, if @var{val}
33814is a fixnum, it will be converted to a bignum if it is too large, and
33815if @var{val} is a bignum it will be normalized by clipping off trailing
33816(i.e., most-significant) zero digits and converting to a fixnum if it is
33817small. All the various data types are similarly converted to their standard
33818forms. Variables are left alone, but function calls are actually evaluated
33819in formulas. For example, normalizing @samp{(+ 2 (calcFunc-abs -4))} will
33820return 6.
33821
33822If a function call fails, because the function is void or has the wrong
33823number of parameters, or because it returns @code{nil} or calls
33824@code{reject-arg} or @code{inexact-result}, @code{normalize} returns
33825the formula still in symbolic form.
33826
33827If the current simplification mode is ``none'' or ``numeric arguments
33828only,'' @code{normalize} will act appropriately. However, the more
33829powerful simplification modes (like Algebraic Simplification) are
33830not handled by @code{normalize}. They are handled by @code{calc-normalize},
33831which calls @code{normalize} and possibly some other routines, such
33832as @code{simplify} or @code{simplify-units}. Programs generally will
33833never call @code{calc-normalize} except when popping or pushing values
33834on the stack.
33835@end defun
33836
33837@defun evaluate-expr expr
33838Replace all variables in @var{expr} that have values with their values,
33839then use @code{normalize} to simplify the result. This is what happens
33840when you press the @kbd{=} key interactively.
33841@end defun
33842
33843@defmac with-extra-prec n body
33844Evaluate the Lisp forms in @var{body} with precision increased by @var{n}
33845digits. This is a macro which expands to
33846
33847@smallexample
33848(math-normalize
33849 (let ((calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec @var{n})))
33850 @var{body}))
33851@end smallexample
33852
33853The surrounding call to @code{math-normalize} causes a floating-point
33854result to be rounded down to the original precision afterwards. This
33855is important because some arithmetic operations assume a number's
33856mantissa contains no more digits than the current precision allows.
33857@end defmac
33858
33859@defun make-frac n d
33860Build a fraction @samp{@var{n}:@var{d}}. This is equivalent to calling
33861@samp{(normalize (list 'frac @var{n} @var{d}))}, but more efficient.
33862@end defun
33863
33864@defun make-float mant exp
33865Build a floating-point value out of @var{mant} and @var{exp}, both
33866of which are arbitrary integers. This function will return a
33867properly normalized float value, or signal an overflow or underflow
33868if @var{exp} is out of range.
33869@end defun
33870
33871@defun make-sdev x sigma
33872Build an error form out of @var{x} and the absolute value of @var{sigma}.
33873If @var{sigma} is zero, the result is the number @var{x} directly.
33874If @var{sigma} is negative or complex, its absolute value is used.
33875If @var{x} or @var{sigma} is not a valid type of object for use in
33876error forms, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33877@end defun
33878
33879@defun make-intv mask lo hi
33880Build an interval form out of @var{mask} (which is assumed to be an
33881integer from 0 to 3), and the limits @var{lo} and @var{hi}. If
33882@var{lo} is greater than @var{hi}, an empty interval form is returned.
33883This calls @code{reject-arg} if @var{lo} or @var{hi} is unsuitable.
33884@end defun
33885
33886@defun sort-intv mask lo hi
33887Build an interval form, similar to @code{make-intv}, except that if
33888@var{lo} is less than @var{hi} they are simply exchanged, and the
33889bits of @var{mask} are swapped accordingly.
33890@end defun
33891
33892@defun make-mod n m
33893Build a modulo form out of @var{n} and the modulus @var{m}. Since modulo
33894forms do not allow formulas as their components, if @var{n} or @var{m}
33895is not a real number or HMS form the result will be a formula which
33896is a call to @code{makemod}, the algebraic version of this function.
33897@end defun
33898
33899@defun float x
33900Convert @var{x} to floating-point form. Integers and fractions are
33901converted to numerically equivalent floats; components of complex
33902numbers, vectors, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33903modulo forms are recursively floated. If the argument is a variable
33904or formula, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33905@end defun
33906
33907@defun compare x y
33908Compare the numbers @var{x} and @var{y}, and return @mathit{-1} if
33909@samp{(lessp @var{x} @var{y})}, 1 if @samp{(lessp @var{y} @var{x})},
339100 if @samp{(math-equal @var{x} @var{y})}, or 2 if the order is
33911undefined or cannot be determined.
33912@end defun
33913
33914@defun numdigs n
33915Return the number of digits of integer @var{n}, effectively
33916@samp{ceil(log10(@var{n}))}, but much more efficient. Zero is
33917considered to have zero digits.
33918@end defun
33919
33920@defun scale-int x n
33921Shift integer @var{x} left @var{n} decimal digits, or right @mathit{-@var{n}}
33922digits with truncation toward zero.
33923@end defun
33924
33925@defun scale-rounding x n
33926Like @code{scale-int}, except that a right shift rounds to the nearest
33927integer rather than truncating.
33928@end defun
33929
33930@defun fixnum n
33931Return the integer @var{n} as a fixnum, i.e., a native Lisp integer.
33932If @var{n} is outside the permissible range for Lisp integers (usually
3393324 binary bits) the result is undefined.
33934@end defun
33935
33936@defun sqr x
33937Compute the square of @var{x}; short for @samp{(* @var{x} @var{x})}.
33938@end defun
33939
33940@defun quotient x y
33941Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return an integer quotient
33942and discard the remainder. If @var{x} or @var{y} is negative, the
33943direction of rounding is undefined.
33944@end defun
33945
33946@defun idiv x y
33947Perform an integer division; if @var{x} and @var{y} are both nonnegative
33948integers, this uses the @code{quotient} function, otherwise it computes
33949@samp{floor(@var{x}/@var{y})}. Thus the result is well-defined but
33950slower than for @code{quotient}.
33951@end defun
33952
33953@defun imod x y
33954Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return the integer remainder
33955and discard the quotient. Like @code{quotient}, this works only for
33956integer arguments and is not well-defined for negative arguments.
33957For a more well-defined result, use @samp{(% @var{x} @var{y})}.
33958@end defun
33959
33960@defun idivmod x y
33961Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return a cons cell whose
33962@code{car} is @samp{(quotient @var{x} @var{y})} and whose @code{cdr}
33963is @samp{(imod @var{x} @var{y})}.
33964@end defun
33965
33966@defun pow x y
33967Compute @var{x} to the power @var{y}. In @code{defmath} code, this can
33968also be written @samp{(^ @var{x} @var{y})} or
33969@w{@samp{(expt @var{x} @var{y})}}.
33970@end defun
33971
33972@defun abs-approx x
33973Compute a fast approximation to the absolute value of @var{x}. For
33974example, for a rectangular complex number the result is the sum of
33975the absolute values of the components.
33976@end defun
33977
33978@findex e
33979@findex gamma-const
33980@findex ln-2
33981@findex ln-10
33982@findex phi
33983@findex pi-over-2
33984@findex pi-over-4
33985@findex pi-over-180
33986@findex sqrt-two-pi
33987@findex sqrt-e
33988@findex two-pi
33989@defun pi
33990The function @samp{(pi)} computes @samp{pi} to the current precision.
33991Other related constant-generating functions are @code{two-pi},
33992@code{pi-over-2}, @code{pi-over-4}, @code{pi-over-180}, @code{sqrt-two-pi},
33993@code{e}, @code{sqrt-e}, @code{ln-2}, @code{ln-10}, @code{phi} and
33994@code{gamma-const}. Each function returns a floating-point value in the
33995current precision, and each uses caching so that all calls after the
33996first are essentially free.
33997@end defun
33998
33999@defmac math-defcache @var{func} @var{initial} @var{form}
34000This macro, usually used as a top-level call like @code{defun} or
34001@code{defvar}, defines a new cached constant analogous to @code{pi}, etc.
34002It defines a function @code{func} which returns the requested value;
34003if @var{initial} is non-@code{nil} it must be a @samp{(float @dots{})}
34004form which serves as an initial value for the cache. If @var{func}
34005is called when the cache is empty or does not have enough digits to
34006satisfy the current precision, the Lisp expression @var{form} is evaluated
34007with the current precision increased by four, and the result minus its
34008two least significant digits is stored in the cache. For example,
34009calling @samp{(pi)} with a precision of 30 computes @samp{pi} to 34
34010digits, rounds it down to 32 digits for future use, then rounds it
34011again to 30 digits for use in the present request.
34012@end defmac
34013
34014@findex half-circle
34015@findex quarter-circle
34016@defun full-circle symb
34017If the current angular mode is Degrees or HMS, this function returns the
34018integer 360. In Radians mode, this function returns either the
34019corresponding value in radians to the current precision, or the formula
34020@samp{2*pi}, depending on the Symbolic mode. There are also similar
34021function @code{half-circle} and @code{quarter-circle}.
34022@end defun
34023
34024@defun power-of-2 n
34025Compute two to the integer power @var{n}, as a (potentially very large)
34026integer. Powers of two are cached, so only the first call for a
34027particular @var{n} is expensive.
34028@end defun
34029
34030@defun integer-log2 n
34031Compute the base-2 logarithm of @var{n}, which must be an integer which
34032is a power of two. If @var{n} is not a power of two, this function will
34033return @code{nil}.
34034@end defun
34035
34036@defun div-mod a b m
34037Divide @var{a} by @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. This returns @code{nil} if
34038there is no solution, or if any of the arguments are not integers.
34039@end defun
34040
34041@defun pow-mod a b m
34042Compute @var{a} to the power @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. If @var{a},
34043@var{b}, and @var{m} are integers, this uses an especially efficient
34044algorithm. Otherwise, it simply computes @samp{(% (^ a b) m)}.
34045@end defun
34046
34047@defun isqrt n
34048Compute the integer square root of @var{n}. This is the square root
34049of @var{n} rounded down toward zero, i.e., @samp{floor(sqrt(@var{n}))}.
34050If @var{n} is itself an integer, the computation is especially efficient.
34051@end defun
34052
34053@defun to-hms a ang
34054Convert the argument @var{a} into an HMS form. If @var{ang} is specified,
34055it is the angular mode in which to interpret @var{a}, either @code{deg}
34056or @code{rad}. Otherwise, the current angular mode is used. If @var{a}
34057is already an HMS form it is returned as-is.
34058@end defun
34059
34060@defun from-hms a ang
34061Convert the HMS form @var{a} into a real number. If @var{ang} is specified,
34062it is the angular mode in which to express the result, otherwise the
34063current angular mode is used. If @var{a} is already a real number, it
34064is returned as-is.
34065@end defun
34066
34067@defun to-radians a
34068Convert the number or HMS form @var{a} to radians from the current
34069angular mode.
34070@end defun
34071
34072@defun from-radians a
34073Convert the number @var{a} from radians to the current angular mode.
34074If @var{a} is a formula, this returns the formula @samp{deg(@var{a})}.
34075@end defun
34076
34077@defun to-radians-2 a
34078Like @code{to-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a degrees to
34079radians conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*pi/180}.
34080@end defun
34081
34082@defun from-radians-2 a
34083Like @code{from-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a radians to
34084degrees conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*180/pi}.
34085@end defun
34086
34087@defun random-digit
34088Produce a random base-1000 digit in the range 0 to 999.
34089@end defun
34090
34091@defun random-digits n
34092Produce a random @var{n}-digit integer; this will be an integer
34093in the interval @samp{[0, 10^@var{n})}.
34094@end defun
34095
34096@defun random-float
34097Produce a random float in the interval @samp{[0, 1)}.
34098@end defun
34099
34100@defun prime-test n iters
34101Determine whether the integer @var{n} is prime. Return a list which has
34102one of these forms: @samp{(nil @var{f})} means the number is non-prime
34103because it was found to be divisible by @var{f}; @samp{(nil)} means it
34104was found to be non-prime by table look-up (so no factors are known);
34105@samp{(nil unknown)} means it is definitely non-prime but no factors
34106are known because @var{n} was large enough that Fermat's probabilistic
34107test had to be used; @samp{(t)} means the number is definitely prime;
34108and @samp{(maybe @var{i} @var{p})} means that Fermat's test, after @var{i}
34109iterations, is @var{p} percent sure that the number is prime. The
34110@var{iters} parameter is the number of Fermat iterations to use, in the
34111case that this is necessary. If @code{prime-test} returns ``maybe,''
34112you can call it again with the same @var{n} to get a greater certainty;
34113@code{prime-test} remembers where it left off.
34114@end defun
34115
34116@defun to-simple-fraction f
34117If @var{f} is a floating-point number which can be represented exactly
34118as a small rational number. return that number, else return @var{f}.
34119For example, 0.75 would be converted to 3:4. This function is very
34120fast.
34121@end defun
34122
34123@defun to-fraction f tol
34124Find a rational approximation to floating-point number @var{f} to within
34125a specified tolerance @var{tol}; this corresponds to the algebraic
34126function @code{frac}, and can be rather slow.
34127@end defun
34128
34129@defun quarter-integer n
34130If @var{n} is an integer or integer-valued float, this function
34131returns zero. If @var{n} is a half-integer (i.e., an integer plus
34132@mathit{1:2} or 0.5), it returns 2. If @var{n} is a quarter-integer,
34133it returns 1 or 3. If @var{n} is anything else, this function
34134returns @code{nil}.
34135@end defun
34136
34137@node Vector Lisp Functions, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Computational Lisp Functions, Internals
34138@subsubsection Vector Functions
34139
34140@noindent
34141The functions described here perform various operations on vectors and
34142matrices.
34143
34144@defun math-concat x y
34145Do a vector concatenation; this operation is written @samp{@var{x} | @var{y}}
34146in a symbolic formula. @xref{Building Vectors}.
34147@end defun
34148
34149@defun vec-length v
34150Return the length of vector @var{v}. If @var{v} is not a vector, the
34151result is zero. If @var{v} is a matrix, this returns the number of
34152rows in the matrix.
34153@end defun
34154
34155@defun mat-dimens m
34156Determine the dimensions of vector or matrix @var{m}. If @var{m} is not
34157a vector, the result is an empty list. If @var{m} is a plain vector
34158but not a matrix, the result is a one-element list containing the length
34159of the vector. If @var{m} is a matrix with @var{r} rows and @var{c} columns,
34160the result is the list @samp{(@var{r} @var{c})}. Higher-order tensors
34161produce lists of more than two dimensions. Note that the object
34162@samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} is a vector of vectors not all the same size,
34163and is treated by this and other Calc routines as a plain vector of two
34164elements.
34165@end defun
34166
34167@defun dimension-error
34168Abort the current function with a message of ``Dimension error.''
34169The Calculator will leave the function being evaluated in symbolic
34170form; this is really just a special case of @code{reject-arg}.
34171@end defun
34172
34173@defun build-vector args
34174Return a Calc vector with @var{args} as elements.
34175For example, @samp{(build-vector 1 2 3)} returns the Calc vector
34176@samp{[1, 2, 3]}, stored internally as the list @samp{(vec 1 2 3)}.
34177@end defun
34178
34179@defun make-vec obj dims
34180Return a Calc vector or matrix all of whose elements are equal to
34181@var{obj}. For example, @samp{(make-vec 27 3 4)} returns a 3x4 matrix
34182filled with 27's.
34183@end defun
34184
34185@defun row-matrix v
34186If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a row matrix, i.e.,
34187a matrix whose single row is @var{v}. If @var{v} is already a matrix,
34188leave it alone.
34189@end defun
34190
34191@defun col-matrix v
34192If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a column matrix, i.e., a
34193matrix with each element of @var{v} as a separate row. If @var{v} is
34194already a matrix, leave it alone.
34195@end defun
34196
34197@defun map-vec f v
34198Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the Calc vector @var{v}. For example,
34199@samp{(map-vec 'math-floor v)} returns a vector of the floored components
34200of vector @var{v}.
34201@end defun
34202
34203@defun map-vec-2 f a b
34204Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the two vectors @var{a} and @var{b}.
34205If @var{a} and @var{b} are vectors of equal length, the result is a
34206vector of the results of calling @samp{(@var{f} @var{ai} @var{bi})}
34207for each pair of elements @var{ai} and @var{bi}. If either @var{a} or
34208@var{b} is a scalar, it is matched with each value of the other vector.
34209For example, @samp{(map-vec-2 'math-add v 1)} returns the vector @var{v}
34210with each element increased by one. Note that using @samp{'+} would not
34211work here, since @code{defmath} does not expand function names everywhere,
34212just where they are in the function position of a Lisp expression.
34213@end defun
34214
34215@defun reduce-vec f v
34216Reduce the function @var{f} over the vector @var{v}. For example, if
34217@var{v} is @samp{[10, 20, 30, 40]}, this calls @samp{(f (f (f 10 20) 30) 40)}.
34218If @var{v} is a matrix, this reduces over the rows of @var{v}.
34219@end defun
34220
34221@defun reduce-cols f m
34222Reduce the function @var{f} over the columns of matrix @var{m}. For
34223example, if @var{m} is @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4], [5, 6]]}, the result
34224is a vector of the two elements @samp{(f (f 1 3) 5)} and @samp{(f (f 2 4) 6)}.
34225@end defun
34226
34227@defun mat-row m n
34228Return the @var{n}th row of matrix @var{m}. This is equivalent to
34229@samp{(elt m n)}. For a slower but safer version, use @code{mrow}.
34230(@xref{Extracting Elements}.)
34231@end defun
34232
34233@defun mat-col m n
34234Return the @var{n}th column of matrix @var{m}, in the form of a vector.
34235The arguments are not checked for correctness.
34236@end defun
34237
34238@defun mat-less-row m n
34239Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th row deleted. The
34240number @var{n} must be in range from 1 to the number of rows in @var{m}.
34241@end defun
34242
34243@defun mat-less-col m n
34244Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th column deleted.
34245@end defun
34246
34247@defun transpose m
34248Return the transpose of matrix @var{m}.
34249@end defun
34250
34251@defun flatten-vector v
34252Flatten nested vector @var{v} into a vector of scalars. For example,
34253if @var{v} is @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} the result is @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
34254@end defun
34255
34256@defun copy-matrix m
34257If @var{m} is a matrix, return a copy of @var{m}. This maps
34258@code{copy-sequence} over the rows of @var{m}; in Lisp terms, each
34259element of the result matrix will be @code{eq} to the corresponding
34260element of @var{m}, but none of the @code{cons} cells that make up
34261the structure of the matrix will be @code{eq}. If @var{m} is a plain
34262vector, this is the same as @code{copy-sequence}.
34263@end defun
34264
34265@defun swap-rows m r1 r2
34266Exchange rows @var{r1} and @var{r2} of matrix @var{m} in-place. In
34267other words, unlike most of the other functions described here, this
34268function changes @var{m} itself rather than building up a new result
34269matrix. The return value is @var{m}, i.e., @samp{(eq (swap-rows m 1 2) m)}
34270is true, with the side effect of exchanging the first two rows of
34271@var{m}.
34272@end defun
34273
34274@node Symbolic Lisp Functions, Formatting Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Internals
34275@subsubsection Symbolic Functions
34276
34277@noindent
34278The functions described here operate on symbolic formulas in the
34279Calculator.
34280
34281@defun calc-prepare-selection num
34282Prepare a stack entry for selection operations. If @var{num} is
34283omitted, the stack entry containing the cursor is used; otherwise,
34284it is the number of the stack entry to use. This function stores
34285useful information about the current stack entry into a set of
34286variables. @code{calc-selection-cache-num} contains the number of
34287the stack entry involved (equal to @var{num} if you specified it);
34288@code{calc-selection-cache-entry} contains the stack entry as a
34289list (such as @code{calc-top-list} would return with @code{entry}
34290as the selection mode); and @code{calc-selection-cache-comp} contains
34291a special ``tagged'' composition (@pxref{Formatting Lisp Functions})
34292which allows Calc to relate cursor positions in the buffer with
34293their corresponding sub-formulas.
34294
34295A slight complication arises in the selection mechanism because
34296formulas may contain small integers. For example, in the vector
34297@samp{[1, 2, 1]} the first and last elements are @code{eq} to each
34298other; selections are recorded as the actual Lisp object that
34299appears somewhere in the tree of the whole formula, but storing
34300@code{1} would falsely select both @code{1}'s in the vector. So
34301@code{calc-prepare-selection} also checks the stack entry and
34302replaces any plain integers with ``complex number'' lists of the form
34303@samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)}. This list will be displayed the same as a
34304plain @var{n} and the change will be completely invisible to the
34305user, but it will guarantee that no two sub-formulas of the stack
34306entry will be @code{eq} to each other. Next time the stack entry
34307is involved in a computation, @code{calc-normalize} will replace
34308these lists with plain numbers again, again invisibly to the user.
34309@end defun
34310
34311@defun calc-encase-atoms x
34312This modifies the formula @var{x} to ensure that each part of the
34313formula is a unique atom, using the @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)} trick
34314described above. This function may use @code{setcar} to modify
34315the formula in-place.
34316@end defun
34317
34318@defun calc-find-selected-part
34319Find the smallest sub-formula of the current formula that contains
34320the cursor. This assumes @code{calc-prepare-selection} has been
34321called already. If the cursor is not actually on any part of the
34322formula, this returns @code{nil}.
34323@end defun
34324
34325@defun calc-change-current-selection selection
34326Change the currently prepared stack element's selection to
34327@var{selection}, which should be @code{eq} to some sub-formula
34328of the stack element, or @code{nil} to unselect the formula.
34329The stack element's appearance in the Calc buffer is adjusted
34330to reflect the new selection.
34331@end defun
34332
34333@defun calc-find-nth-part expr n
34334Return the @var{n}th sub-formula of @var{expr}. This function is used
34335by the selection commands, and (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) treats
34336sums and products as flat many-element formulas. Thus if @var{expr}
34337is @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, calling @code{calc-find-nth-part} with
34338@var{n} equal to four will return @samp{d}.
34339@end defun
34340
34341@defun calc-find-parent-formula expr part
34342Return the sub-formula of @var{expr} which immediately contains
34343@var{part}. If @var{expr} is @samp{a*b + (c+1)*d} and @var{part}
34344is @code{eq} to the @samp{c+1} term of @var{expr}, then this function
34345will return @samp{(c+1)*d}. If @var{part} turns out not to be a
34346sub-formula of @var{expr}, the function returns @code{nil}. If
34347@var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, the function returns @code{t}.
34348This function does not take associativity into account.
34349@end defun
34350
34351@defun calc-find-assoc-parent-formula expr part
34352This is the same as @code{calc-find-parent-formula}, except that
34353(unless @kbd{j b} has been used) it continues widening the selection
34354to contain a complete level of the formula. Given @samp{a} from
34355@samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, @code{calc-find-parent-formula} will
34356return @samp{a + b} but @code{calc-find-assoc-parent-formula} will
34357return the whole expression.
34358@end defun
34359
34360@defun calc-grow-assoc-formula expr part
34361This expands sub-formula @var{part} of @var{expr} to encompass a
34362complete level of the formula. If @var{part} and its immediate
34363parent are not compatible associative operators, or if @kbd{j b}
34364has been used, this simply returns @var{part}.
34365@end defun
34366
34367@defun calc-find-sub-formula expr part
34368This finds the immediate sub-formula of @var{expr} which contains
34369@var{part}. It returns an index @var{n} such that
34370@samp{(calc-find-nth-part @var{expr} @var{n})} would return @var{part}.
34371If @var{part} is not a sub-formula of @var{expr}, it returns @code{nil}.
34372If @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, it returns @code{t}. This
34373function does not take associativity into account.
34374@end defun
34375
34376@defun calc-replace-sub-formula expr old new
34377This function returns a copy of formula @var{expr}, with the
34378sub-formula that is @code{eq} to @var{old} replaced by @var{new}.
34379@end defun
34380
34381@defun simplify expr
34382Simplify the expression @var{expr} by applying various algebraic rules.
34383This is what the @w{@kbd{a s}} (@code{calc-simplify}) command uses. This
34384always returns a copy of the expression; the structure @var{expr} points
34385to remains unchanged in memory.
34386
34387More precisely, here is what @code{simplify} does: The expression is
34388first normalized and evaluated by calling @code{normalize}. If any
34389@code{AlgSimpRules} have been defined, they are then applied. Then
34390the expression is traversed in a depth-first, bottom-up fashion; at
34391each level, any simplifications that can be made are made until no
34392further changes are possible. Once the entire formula has been
34393traversed in this way, it is compared with the original formula (from
34394before the call to @code{normalize}) and, if it has changed,
34395the entire procedure is repeated (starting with @code{normalize})
34396until no further changes occur. Usually only two iterations are
34397needed:@: one to simplify the formula, and another to verify that no
34398further simplifications were possible.
34399@end defun
34400
34401@defun simplify-extended expr
34402Simplify the expression @var{expr}, with additional rules enabled that
34403help do a more thorough job, while not being entirely ``safe'' in all
34404circumstances. (For example, this mode will simplify @samp{sqrt(x^2)}
34405to @samp{x}, which is only valid when @var{x} is positive.) This is
34406implemented by temporarily binding the variable @code{math-living-dangerously}
34407to @code{t} (using a @code{let} form) and calling @code{simplify}.
34408Dangerous simplification rules are written to check this variable
34409before taking any action.
34410@end defun
34411
34412@defun simplify-units expr
34413Simplify the expression @var{expr}, treating variable names as units
34414whenever possible. This works by binding the variable
34415@code{math-simplifying-units} to @code{t} while calling @code{simplify}.
34416@end defun
34417
34418@defmac math-defsimplify funcs body
34419Register a new simplification rule; this is normally called as a top-level
34420form, like @code{defun} or @code{defmath}. If @var{funcs} is a symbol
34421(like @code{+} or @code{calcFunc-sqrt}), this simplification rule is
34422applied to the formulas which are calls to the specified function. Or,
34423@var{funcs} can be a list of such symbols; the rule applies to all
34424functions on the list. The @var{body} is written like the body of a
34425function with a single argument called @code{expr}. The body will be
34426executed with @code{expr} bound to a formula which is a call to one of
34427the functions @var{funcs}. If the function body returns @code{nil}, or
34428if it returns a result @code{equal} to the original @code{expr}, it is
34429ignored and Calc goes on to try the next simplification rule that applies.
34430If the function body returns something different, that new formula is
34431substituted for @var{expr} in the original formula.
34432
34433At each point in the formula, rules are tried in the order of the
34434original calls to @code{math-defsimplify}; the search stops after the
34435first rule that makes a change. Thus later rules for that same
34436function will not have a chance to trigger until the next iteration
34437of the main @code{simplify} loop.
34438
34439Note that, since @code{defmath} is not being used here, @var{body} must
34440be written in true Lisp code without the conveniences that @code{defmath}
34441provides. If you prefer, you can have @var{body} simply call another
34442function (defined with @code{defmath}) which does the real work.
34443
34444The arguments of a function call will already have been simplified
34445before any rules for the call itself are invoked. Since a new argument
34446list is consed up when this happens, this means that the rule's body is
34447allowed to rearrange the function's arguments destructively if that is
34448convenient. Here is a typical example of a simplification rule:
34449
34450@smallexample
34451(math-defsimplify calcFunc-arcsinh
34452 (or (and (math-looks-negp (nth 1 expr))
34453 (math-neg (list 'calcFunc-arcsinh
34454 (math-neg (nth 1 expr)))))
34455 (and (eq (car-safe (nth 1 expr)) 'calcFunc-sinh)
34456 (or math-living-dangerously
34457 (math-known-realp (nth 1 (nth 1 expr))))
34458 (nth 1 (nth 1 expr)))))
34459@end smallexample
34460
34461This is really a pair of rules written with one @code{math-defsimplify}
34462for convenience; the first replaces @samp{arcsinh(-x)} with
34463@samp{-arcsinh(x)}, and the second, which is safe only for real @samp{x},
34464replaces @samp{arcsinh(sinh(x))} with @samp{x}.
34465@end defmac
34466
34467@defun common-constant-factor expr
34468Check @var{expr} to see if it is a sum of terms all multiplied by the
34469same rational value. If so, return this value. If not, return @code{nil}.
34470For example, if called on @samp{6x + 9y + 12z}, it would return 3, since
344713 is a common factor of all the terms.
34472@end defun
34473
34474@defun cancel-common-factor expr factor
34475Assuming @var{expr} is a sum with @var{factor} as a common factor,
34476divide each term of the sum by @var{factor}. This is done by
34477destructively modifying parts of @var{expr}, on the assumption that
34478it is being used by a simplification rule (where such things are
34479allowed; see above). For example, consider this built-in rule for
34480square roots:
34481
34482@smallexample
34483(math-defsimplify calcFunc-sqrt
34484 (let ((fac (math-common-constant-factor (nth 1 expr))))
34485 (and fac (not (eq fac 1))
34486 (math-mul (math-normalize (list 'calcFunc-sqrt fac))
34487 (math-normalize
34488 (list 'calcFunc-sqrt
34489 (math-cancel-common-factor
34490 (nth 1 expr) fac)))))))
34491@end smallexample
34492@end defun
34493
34494@defun frac-gcd a b
34495Compute a ``rational GCD'' of @var{a} and @var{b}, which must both be
34496rational numbers. This is the fraction composed of the GCD of the
34497numerators of @var{a} and @var{b}, over the GCD of the denominators.
34498It is used by @code{common-constant-factor}. Note that the standard
34499@code{gcd} function uses the LCM to combine the denominators.
34500@end defun
34501
34502@defun map-tree func expr many
34503Try applying Lisp function @var{func} to various sub-expressions of
34504@var{expr}. Initially, call @var{func} with @var{expr} itself as an
34505argument. If this returns an expression which is not @code{equal} to
34506@var{expr}, apply @var{func} again until eventually it does return
34507@var{expr} with no changes. Then, if @var{expr} is a function call,
34508recursively apply @var{func} to each of the arguments. This keeps going
34509until no changes occur anywhere in the expression; this final expression
34510is returned by @code{map-tree}. Note that, unlike simplification rules,
34511@var{func} functions may @emph{not} make destructive changes to
34512@var{expr}. If a third argument @var{many} is provided, it is an
34513integer which says how many times @var{func} may be applied; the
34514default, as described above, is infinitely many times.
34515@end defun
34516
34517@defun compile-rewrites rules
34518Compile the rewrite rule set specified by @var{rules}, which should
34519be a formula that is either a vector or a variable name. If the latter,
34520the compiled rules are saved so that later @code{compile-rules} calls
34521for that same variable can return immediately. If there are problems
34522with the rules, this function calls @code{error} with a suitable
34523message.
34524@end defun
34525
34526@defun apply-rewrites expr crules heads
34527Apply the compiled rewrite rule set @var{crules} to the expression
34528@var{expr}. This will make only one rewrite and only checks at the
34529top level of the expression. The result @code{nil} if no rules
34530matched, or if the only rules that matched did not actually change
34531the expression. The @var{heads} argument is optional; if is given,
34532it should be a list of all function names that (may) appear in
34533@var{expr}. The rewrite compiler tags each rule with the
34534rarest-looking function name in the rule; if you specify @var{heads},
34535@code{apply-rewrites} can use this information to narrow its search
34536down to just a few rules in the rule set.
34537@end defun
34538
34539@defun rewrite-heads expr
34540Compute a @var{heads} list for @var{expr} suitable for use with
34541@code{apply-rewrites}, as discussed above.
34542@end defun
34543
34544@defun rewrite expr rules many
34545This is an all-in-one rewrite function. It compiles the rule set
34546specified by @var{rules}, then uses @code{map-tree} to apply the
34547rules throughout @var{expr} up to @var{many} (default infinity)
34548times.
34549@end defun
34550
34551@defun match-patterns pat vec not-flag
34552Given a Calc vector @var{vec} and an uncompiled pattern set or
34553pattern set variable @var{pat}, this function returns a new vector
34554of all elements of @var{vec} which do (or don't, if @var{not-flag} is
34555non-@code{nil}) match any of the patterns in @var{pat}.
34556@end defun
34557
34558@defun deriv expr var value symb
34559Compute the derivative of @var{expr} with respect to variable @var{var}
34560(which may actually be any sub-expression). If @var{value} is specified,
34561the derivative is evaluated at the value of @var{var}; otherwise, the
34562derivative is left in terms of @var{var}. If the expression contains
34563functions for which no derivative formula is known, new derivative
34564functions are invented by adding primes to the names; @pxref{Calculus}.
34565However, if @var{symb} is non-@code{nil}, the presence of undifferentiable
34566functions in @var{expr} instead cancels the whole differentiation, and
34567@code{deriv} returns @code{nil} instead.
34568
34569Derivatives of an @var{n}-argument function can be defined by
34570adding a @code{math-derivative-@var{n}} property to the property list
34571of the symbol for the function's derivative, which will be the
34572function name followed by an apostrophe. The value of the property
34573should be a Lisp function; it is called with the same arguments as the
34574original function call that is being differentiated. It should return
34575a formula for the derivative. For example, the derivative of @code{ln}
34576is defined by
34577
34578@smallexample
34579(put 'calcFunc-ln\' 'math-derivative-1
34580 (function (lambda (u) (math-div 1 u))))
34581@end smallexample
34582
34583The two-argument @code{log} function has two derivatives,
34584@smallexample
34585(put 'calcFunc-log\' 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / dx
34586 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34587(put 'calcFunc-log\'2 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / db
34588 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34589@end smallexample
34590@end defun
34591
34592@defun tderiv expr var value symb
34593Compute the total derivative of @var{expr}. This is the same as
34594@code{deriv}, except that variables other than @var{var} are not
34595assumed to be constant with respect to @var{var}.
34596@end defun
34597
34598@defun integ expr var low high
34599Compute the integral of @var{expr} with respect to @var{var}.
34600@xref{Calculus}, for further details.
34601@end defun
34602
34603@defmac math-defintegral funcs body
34604Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of one argument;
34605this macro is very similar in format to @code{math-defsimplify}.
34606The main difference is that here @var{body} is the body of a function
34607with a single argument @code{u} which is bound to the argument to the
34608function being integrated, not the function call itself. Also, the
34609variable of integration is available as @code{math-integ-var}. If
34610evaluation of the integral requires doing further integrals, the body
34611should call @samp{(math-integral @var{x})} to find the integral of
34612@var{x} with respect to @code{math-integ-var}; this function returns
34613@code{nil} if the integral could not be done. Some examples:
34614
34615@smallexample
34616(math-defintegral calcFunc-conj
34617 (let ((int (math-integral u)))
34618 (and int
34619 (list 'calcFunc-conj int))))
34620
34621(math-defintegral calcFunc-cos
34622 (and (equal u math-integ-var)
34623 (math-from-radians-2 (list 'calcFunc-sin u))))
34624@end smallexample
34625
34626In the @code{cos} example, we define only the integral of @samp{cos(x) dx},
34627relying on the general integration-by-substitution facility to handle
34628cosines of more complicated arguments. An integration rule should return
34629@code{nil} if it can't do the integral; if several rules are defined for
34630the same function, they are tried in order until one returns a non-@code{nil}
34631result.
34632@end defmac
34633
34634@defmac math-defintegral-2 funcs body
34635Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of two arguments.
34636This is exactly analogous to @code{math-defintegral}, except that @var{body}
34637is written as the body of a function with two arguments, @var{u} and
34638@var{v}.
34639@end defmac
34640
34641@defun solve-for lhs rhs var full
34642Attempt to solve the equation @samp{@var{lhs} = @var{rhs}} by isolating
34643the variable @var{var} on the lefthand side; return the resulting righthand
34644side, or @code{nil} if the equation cannot be solved. The variable
34645@var{var} must appear at least once in @var{lhs} or @var{rhs}. Note that
34646the return value is a formula which does not contain @var{var}; this is
34647different from the user-level @code{solve} and @code{finv} functions,
34648which return a rearranged equation or a functional inverse, respectively.
34649If @var{full} is non-@code{nil}, a full solution including dummy signs
34650and dummy integers will be produced. User-defined inverses are provided
34651as properties in a manner similar to derivatives:
34652
34653@smallexample
34654(put 'calcFunc-ln 'math-inverse
34655 (function (lambda (x) (list 'calcFunc-exp x))))
34656@end smallexample
34657
34658This function can call @samp{(math-solve-get-sign @var{x})} to create
34659a new arbitrary sign variable, returning @var{x} times that sign, and
34660@samp{(math-solve-get-int @var{x})} to create a new arbitrary integer
34661variable multiplied by @var{x}. These functions simply return @var{x}
34662if the caller requested a non-``full'' solution.
34663@end defun
34664
34665@defun solve-eqn expr var full
34666This version of @code{solve-for} takes an expression which will
34667typically be an equation or inequality. (If it is not, it will be
34668interpreted as the equation @samp{@var{expr} = 0}.) It returns an
34669equation or inequality, or @code{nil} if no solution could be found.
34670@end defun
34671
34672@defun solve-system exprs vars full
34673This function solves a system of equations. Generally, @var{exprs}
34674and @var{vars} will be vectors of equal length.
34675@xref{Solving Systems of Equations}, for other options.
34676@end defun
34677
34678@defun expr-contains expr var
34679Returns a non-@code{nil} value if @var{var} occurs as a subexpression
34680of @var{expr}.
34681
34682This function might seem at first to be identical to
34683@code{calc-find-sub-formula}. The key difference is that
34684@code{expr-contains} uses @code{equal} to test for matches, whereas
34685@code{calc-find-sub-formula} uses @code{eq}. In the formula
34686@samp{f(a, a)}, the two @samp{a}s will be @code{equal} but not
34687@code{eq} to each other.
34688@end defun
34689
34690@defun expr-contains-count expr var
34691Returns the number of occurrences of @var{var} as a subexpression
34692of @var{expr}, or @code{nil} if there are no occurrences.
34693@end defun
34694
34695@defun expr-depends expr var
34696Returns true if @var{expr} refers to any variable the occurs in @var{var}.
34697In other words, it checks if @var{expr} and @var{var} have any variables
34698in common.
34699@end defun
34700
34701@defun expr-contains-vars expr
34702Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables, or @code{nil} if @var{expr}
34703contains only constants and functions with constant arguments.
34704@end defun
34705
34706@defun expr-subst expr old new
34707Returns a copy of @var{expr}, with all occurrences of @var{old} replaced
34708by @var{new}. This treats @code{lambda} forms specially with respect
34709to the dummy argument variables, so that the effect is always to return
34710@var{expr} evaluated at @var{old} = @var{new}.
34711@end defun
34712
34713@defun multi-subst expr old new
34714This is like @code{expr-subst}, except that @var{old} and @var{new}
34715are lists of expressions to be substituted simultaneously. If one
34716list is shorter than the other, trailing elements of the longer list
34717are ignored.
34718@end defun
34719
34720@defun expr-weight expr
34721Returns the ``weight'' of @var{expr}, basically a count of the total
34722number of objects and function calls that appear in @var{expr}. For
34723``primitive'' objects, this will be one.
34724@end defun
34725
34726@defun expr-height expr
34727Returns the ``height'' of @var{expr}, which is the deepest level to
34728which function calls are nested. (Note that @samp{@var{a} + @var{b}}
34729counts as a function call.) For primitive objects, this returns zero.
34730@end defun
34731
34732@defun polynomial-p expr var
34733Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable (or sub-expression)
34734@var{var}. If so, return the degree of the polynomial, that is, the
34735highest power of @var{var} that appears in @var{expr}. For example,
34736for @samp{(x^2 + 3)^3 + 4} this would return 6. This function returns
34737@code{nil} unless @var{expr}, when expanded out by @kbd{a x}
34738(@code{calc-expand}), would consist of a sum of terms in which @var{var}
34739appears only raised to nonnegative integer powers. Note that if
34740@var{var} does not occur in @var{expr}, then @var{expr} is considered
34741a polynomial of degree 0.
34742@end defun
34743
34744@defun is-polynomial expr var degree loose
34745Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable or sub-expression
34746@var{var}, and, if so, return a list representation of the polynomial
34747where the elements of the list are coefficients of successive powers of
34748@var{var}: @samp{@var{a} + @var{b} x + @var{c} x^3} would produce the
34749list @samp{(@var{a} @var{b} 0 @var{c})}, and @samp{(x + 1)^2} would
34750produce the list @samp{(1 2 1)}. The highest element of the list will
34751be non-zero, with the special exception that if @var{expr} is the
34752constant zero, the returned value will be @samp{(0)}. Return @code{nil}
34753if @var{expr} is not a polynomial in @var{var}. If @var{degree} is
34754specified, this will not consider polynomials of degree higher than that
34755value. This is a good precaution because otherwise an input of
34756@samp{(x+1)^1000} will cause a huge coefficient list to be built. If
34757@var{loose} is non-@code{nil}, then a looser definition of a polynomial
34758is used in which coefficients are no longer required not to depend on
34759@var{var}, but are only required not to take the form of polynomials
34760themselves. For example, @samp{sin(x) x^2 + cos(x)} is a loose
34761polynomial with coefficients @samp{((calcFunc-cos x) 0 (calcFunc-sin
34762x))}. The result will never be @code{nil} in loose mode, since any
34763expression can be interpreted as a ``constant'' loose polynomial.
34764@end defun
34765
34766@defun polynomial-base expr pred
34767Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in any variable that occurs in it;
34768if so, return that variable. (If @var{expr} is a multivariate polynomial,
34769this chooses one variable arbitrarily.) If @var{pred} is specified, it should
34770be a Lisp function which is called as @samp{(@var{pred} @var{subexpr})},
34771and which should return true if @code{mpb-top-expr} (a global name for
34772the original @var{expr}) is a suitable polynomial in @var{subexpr}.
34773The default predicate uses @samp{(polynomial-p mpb-top-expr @var{subexpr})};
34774you can use @var{pred} to specify additional conditions. Or, you could
34775have @var{pred} build up a list of every suitable @var{subexpr} that
34776is found.
34777@end defun
34778
34779@defun poly-simplify poly
34780Simplify polynomial coefficient list @var{poly} by (destructively)
34781clipping off trailing zeros.
34782@end defun
34783
34784@defun poly-mix a ac b bc
34785Mix two polynomial lists @var{a} and @var{b} (in the form returned by
34786@code{is-polynomial}) in a linear combination with coefficient expressions
34787@var{ac} and @var{bc}. The result is a (not necessarily simplified)
34788polynomial list representing @samp{@var{ac} @var{a} + @var{bc} @var{b}}.
34789@end defun
34790
34791@defun poly-mul a b
34792Multiply two polynomial coefficient lists @var{a} and @var{b}. The
34793result will be in simplified form if the inputs were simplified.
34794@end defun
34795
34796@defun build-polynomial-expr poly var
34797Construct a Calc formula which represents the polynomial coefficient
34798list @var{poly} applied to variable @var{var}. The @kbd{a c}
34799(@code{calc-collect}) command uses @code{is-polynomial} to turn an
34800expression into a coefficient list, then @code{build-polynomial-expr}
34801to turn the list back into an expression in regular form.
34802@end defun
34803
34804@defun check-unit-name var
34805Check if @var{var} is a variable which can be interpreted as a unit
34806name. If so, return the units table entry for that unit. This
34807will be a list whose first element is the unit name (not counting
34808prefix characters) as a symbol and whose second element is the
34809Calc expression which defines the unit. (Refer to the Calc sources
34810for details on the remaining elements of this list.) If @var{var}
34811is not a variable or is not a unit name, return @code{nil}.
34812@end defun
34813
34814@defun units-in-expr-p expr sub-exprs
34815Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables which can be
34816interpreted as units. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{t}, the entire
34817expression is searched. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{nil}, this
34818checks whether @var{expr} is directly a units expression.
34819@end defun
34820
34821@defun single-units-in-expr-p expr
34822Check whether @var{expr} contains exactly one units variable. If so,
34823return the units table entry for the variable. If @var{expr} does
34824not contain any units, return @code{nil}. If @var{expr} contains
34825two or more units, return the symbol @code{wrong}.
34826@end defun
34827
34828@defun to-standard-units expr which
34829Convert units expression @var{expr} to base units. If @var{which}
34830is @code{nil}, use Calc's native base units. Otherwise, @var{which}
34831can specify a units system, which is a list of two-element lists,
34832where the first element is a Calc base symbol name and the second
34833is an expression to substitute for it.
34834@end defun
34835
34836@defun remove-units expr
34837Return a copy of @var{expr} with all units variables replaced by ones.
34838This expression is generally normalized before use.
34839@end defun
34840
34841@defun extract-units expr
34842Return a copy of @var{expr} with everything but units variables replaced
34843by ones.
34844@end defun
34845
34846@node Formatting Lisp Functions, Hooks, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Internals
34847@subsubsection I/O and Formatting Functions
34848
34849@noindent
34850The functions described here are responsible for parsing and formatting
34851Calc numbers and formulas.
34852
34853@defun calc-eval str sep arg1 arg2 @dots{}
34854This is the simplest interface to the Calculator from another Lisp program.
34855@xref{Calling Calc from Your Programs}.
34856@end defun
34857
34858@defun read-number str
34859If string @var{str} contains a valid Calc number, either integer,
34860fraction, float, or HMS form, this function parses and returns that
34861number. Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}.
34862@end defun
34863
34864@defun read-expr str
34865Read an algebraic expression from string @var{str}. If @var{str} does
34866not have the form of a valid expression, return a list of the form
34867@samp{(error @var{pos} @var{msg})} where @var{pos} is an integer index
34868into @var{str} of the general location of the error, and @var{msg} is
34869a string describing the problem.
34870@end defun
34871
34872@defun read-exprs str
34873Read a list of expressions separated by commas, and return it as a
34874Lisp list. If an error occurs in any expressions, an error list as
34875shown above is returned instead.
34876@end defun
34877
34878@defun calc-do-alg-entry initial prompt no-norm
34879Read an algebraic formula or formulas using the minibuffer. All
34880conventions of regular algebraic entry are observed. The return value
34881is a list of Calc formulas; there will be more than one if the user
34882entered a list of values separated by commas. The result is @code{nil}
34883if the user presses Return with a blank line. If @var{initial} is
34884given, it is a string which the minibuffer will initially contain.
34885If @var{prompt} is given, it is the prompt string to use; the default
34886is ``Algebraic:''. If @var{no-norm} is @code{t}, the formulas will
34887be returned exactly as parsed; otherwise, they will be passed through
34888@code{calc-normalize} first.
34889
34890To support the use of @kbd{$} characters in the algebraic entry, use
34891@code{let} to bind @code{calc-dollar-values} to a list of the values
34892to be substituted for @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on, and bind
34893@code{calc-dollar-used} to 0. Upon return, @code{calc-dollar-used}
34894will have been changed to the highest number of consecutive @kbd{$}s
34895that actually appeared in the input.
34896@end defun
34897
34898@defun format-number a
34899Convert the real or complex number or HMS form @var{a} to string form.
34900@end defun
34901
34902@defun format-flat-expr a prec
34903Convert the arbitrary Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form,
34904in the style used by the trail buffer and the @code{calc-edit} command.
34905This is a simple format designed
34906mostly to guarantee the string is of a form that can be re-parsed by
34907@code{read-expr}. Most formatting modes, such as digit grouping,
34908complex number format, and point character, are ignored to ensure the
34909result will be re-readable. The @var{prec} parameter is normally 0; if
34910you pass a large integer like 1000 instead, the expression will be
34911surrounded by parentheses unless it is a plain number or variable name.
34912@end defun
34913
34914@defun format-nice-expr a width
34915This is like @code{format-flat-expr} (with @var{prec} equal to 0),
34916except that newlines will be inserted to keep lines down to the
34917specified @var{width}, and vectors that look like matrices or rewrite
34918rules are written in a pseudo-matrix format. The @code{calc-edit}
34919command uses this when only one stack entry is being edited.
34920@end defun
34921
34922@defun format-value a width
34923Convert the Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form, using the
34924format seen in the stack buffer. Beware the string returned may
34925not be re-readable by @code{read-expr}, for example, because of digit
34926grouping. Multi-line objects like matrices produce strings that
34927contain newline characters to separate the lines. The @var{w}
34928parameter, if given, is the target window size for which to format
34929the expressions. If @var{w} is omitted, the width of the Calculator
34930window is used.
34931@end defun
34932
34933@defun compose-expr a prec
34934Format the Calc number or formula @var{a} according to the current
34935language mode, returning a ``composition.'' To learn about the
34936structure of compositions, see the comments in the Calc source code.
34937You can specify the format of a given type of function call by putting
34938a @code{math-compose-@var{lang}} property on the function's symbol,
34939whose value is a Lisp function that takes @var{a} and @var{prec} as
34940arguments and returns a composition. Here @var{lang} is a language
34941mode name, one of @code{normal}, @code{big}, @code{c}, @code{pascal},
34942@code{fortran}, @code{tex}, @code{eqn}, @code{math}, or @code{maple}.
34943In Big mode, Calc actually tries @code{math-compose-big} first, then
34944tries @code{math-compose-normal}. If this property does not exist,
34945or if the function returns @code{nil}, the function is written in the
34946normal function-call notation for that language.
34947@end defun
34948
34949@defun composition-to-string c w
34950Convert a composition structure returned by @code{compose-expr} into
34951a string. Multi-line compositions convert to strings containing
34952newline characters. The target window size is given by @var{w}.
34953The @code{format-value} function basically calls @code{compose-expr}
34954followed by @code{composition-to-string}.
34955@end defun
34956
34957@defun comp-width c
34958Compute the width in characters of composition @var{c}.
34959@end defun
34960
34961@defun comp-height c
34962Compute the height in lines of composition @var{c}.
34963@end defun
34964
34965@defun comp-ascent c
34966Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is on or
34967above the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be one.
34968@end defun
34969
34970@defun comp-descent c
34971Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is below
34972the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be zero.
34973@end defun
34974
34975@defun comp-first-char c
34976If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the first
34977(leftmost) character of the composition as an integer. Otherwise,
34978return @code{nil}.
34979@end defun
34980
34981@defun comp-last-char c
34982If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the last
34983(rightmost) character, otherwise return @code{nil}.
34984@end defun
34985
34986@comment @node Lisp Variables, Hooks, Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
34987@comment @subsubsection Lisp Variables
34988@comment
34989@comment @noindent
34990@comment (This section is currently unfinished.)
34991
34992@node Hooks, , Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
34993@subsubsection Hooks
34994
34995@noindent
34996Hooks are variables which contain Lisp functions (or lists of functions)
34997which are called at various times. Calc defines a number of hooks
34998that help you to customize it in various ways. Calc uses the Lisp
34999function @code{run-hooks} to invoke the hooks shown below. Several
35000other customization-related variables are also described here.
35001
35002@defvar calc-load-hook
35003This hook is called at the end of @file{calc.el}, after the file has
35004been loaded, before any functions in it have been called, but after
35005@code{calc-mode-map} and similar variables have been set up.
35006@end defvar
35007
35008@defvar calc-ext-load-hook
35009This hook is called at the end of @file{calc-ext.el}.
35010@end defvar
35011
35012@defvar calc-start-hook
35013This hook is called as the last step in a @kbd{M-x calc} command.
35014At this point, the Calc buffer has been created and initialized if
35015necessary, the Calc window and trail window have been created,
35016and the ``Welcome to Calc'' message has been displayed.
35017@end defvar
35018
35019@defvar calc-mode-hook
35020This hook is called when the Calc buffer is being created. Usually
35021this will only happen once per Emacs session. The hook is called
35022after Emacs has switched to the new buffer, the mode-settings file
35023has been read if necessary, and all other buffer-local variables
35024have been set up. After this hook returns, Calc will perform a
35025@code{calc-refresh} operation, set up the mode line display, then
35026evaluate any deferred @code{calc-define} properties that have not
35027been evaluated yet.
35028@end defvar
35029
35030@defvar calc-trail-mode-hook
35031This hook is called when the Calc Trail buffer is being created.
35032It is called as the very last step of setting up the Trail buffer.
35033Like @code{calc-mode-hook}, this will normally happen only once
35034per Emacs session.
35035@end defvar
35036
35037@defvar calc-end-hook
35038This hook is called by @code{calc-quit}, generally because the user
35039presses @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} while in Calc. The Calc buffer will
35040be the current buffer. The hook is called as the very first
35041step, before the Calc window is destroyed.
35042@end defvar
35043
35044@defvar calc-window-hook
35045If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc window.
35046Upon return, this new Calc window should be the current window.
35047(The Calc buffer will already be the current buffer when the
35048hook is called.) If the hook is not defined, Calc will
35049generally use @code{split-window}, @code{set-window-buffer},
35050and @code{select-window} to create the Calc window.
35051@end defvar
35052
35053@defvar calc-trail-window-hook
35054If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc Trail
35055window. The variable @code{calc-trail-buffer} will contain the buffer
35056which the window should use. Unlike @code{calc-window-hook}, this hook
35057must @emph{not} switch into the new window.
35058@end defvar
35059
35060@defvar calc-embedded-mode-hook
35061This hook is called the first time that Embedded mode is entered.
35062@end defvar
35063
35064@defvar calc-embedded-new-buffer-hook
35065This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is entered in a
35066new buffer.
35067@end defvar
35068
35069@defvar calc-embedded-new-formula-hook
35070This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is enabled for a
35071new formula.
35072@end defvar
35073
35074@defvar calc-edit-mode-hook
35075This hook is called by @code{calc-edit} (and the other ``edit''
35076commands) when the temporary editing buffer is being created.
35077The buffer will have been selected and set up to be in
35078@code{calc-edit-mode}, but will not yet have been filled with
35079text. (In fact it may still have leftover text from a previous
35080@code{calc-edit} command.)
35081@end defvar
35082
35083@defvar calc-mode-save-hook
35084This hook is called by the @code{calc-save-modes} command,
35085after Calc's own mode features have been inserted into the
35086Calc init file and just before the ``End of mode settings''
35087message is inserted.
35088@end defvar
35089
35090@defvar calc-reset-hook
35091This hook is called after @kbd{C-x * 0} (@code{calc-reset}) has
35092reset all modes. The Calc buffer will be the current buffer.
35093@end defvar
35094
35095@defvar calc-other-modes
35096This variable contains a list of strings. The strings are
35097concatenated at the end of the modes portion of the Calc
35098mode line (after standard modes such as ``Deg'', ``Inv'' and
35099``Hyp''). Each string should be a short, single word followed
35100by a space. The variable is @code{nil} by default.
35101@end defvar
35102
35103@defvar calc-mode-map
35104This is the keymap that is used by Calc mode. The best time
35105to adjust it is probably in a @code{calc-mode-hook}. If the
35106Calc extensions package (@file{calc-ext.el}) has not yet been
35107loaded, many of these keys will be bound to @code{calc-missing-key},
35108which is a command that loads the extensions package and
35109``retypes'' the key. If your @code{calc-mode-hook} rebinds
35110one of these keys, it will probably be overridden when the
35111extensions are loaded.
35112@end defvar
35113
35114@defvar calc-digit-map
35115This is the keymap that is used during numeric entry. Numeric
35116entry uses the minibuffer, but this map binds every non-numeric
35117key to @code{calcDigit-nondigit} which generally calls
35118@code{exit-minibuffer} and ``retypes'' the key.
35119@end defvar
35120
35121@defvar calc-alg-ent-map
35122This is the keymap that is used during algebraic entry. This is
35123mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-map}.
35124@end defvar
35125
35126@defvar calc-store-var-map
35127This is the keymap that is used during entry of variable names for
35128commands like @code{calc-store} and @code{calc-recall}. This is
35129mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-completion-map}.
35130@end defvar
35131
35132@defvar calc-edit-mode-map
35133This is the (sparse) keymap used by @code{calc-edit} and other
35134temporary editing commands. It binds @key{RET}, @key{LFD},
35135and @kbd{C-c C-c} to @code{calc-edit-finish}.
35136@end defvar
35137
35138@defvar calc-mode-var-list
35139This is a list of variables which are saved by @code{calc-save-modes}.
35140Each entry is a list of two items, the variable (as a Lisp symbol)
35141and its default value. When modes are being saved, each variable
35142is compared with its default value (using @code{equal}) and any
35143non-default variables are written out.
35144@end defvar
35145
35146@defvar calc-local-var-list
35147This is a list of variables which should be buffer-local to the
35148Calc buffer. Each entry is a variable name (as a Lisp symbol).
35149These variables also have their default values manipulated by
35150the @code{calc} and @code{calc-quit} commands; @pxref{Multiple Calculators}.
35151Since @code{calc-mode-hook} is called after this list has been
35152used the first time, your hook should add a variable to the
35153list and also call @code{make-local-variable} itself.
35154@end defvar
35155
35156@node Copying, GNU Free Documentation License, Programming, Top
35157@appendix GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
35158@include gpl.texi
35159
35160@node GNU Free Documentation License, Customizing Calc, Copying, Top
35161@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
35162@include doclicense.texi
35163
35164@node Customizing Calc, Reporting Bugs, GNU Free Documentation License, Top
35165@appendix Customizing Calc
35166
35167The usual prefix for Calc is the key sequence @kbd{C-x *}. If you wish
35168to use a different prefix, you can put
35169
35170@example
35171(global-set-key "NEWPREFIX" 'calc-dispatch)
35172@end example
35173
35174@noindent
35175in your .emacs file.
35176(@xref{Key Bindings,,Customizing Key Bindings,emacs,
35177The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information on binding keys.)
35178A convenient way to start Calc is with @kbd{C-x * *}; to make it equally
35179convenient for users who use a different prefix, the prefix can be
35180followed by @kbd{=}, @kbd{&}, @kbd{#}, @kbd{\}, @kbd{/}, @kbd{+} or
35181@kbd{-} as well as @kbd{*} to start Calc, and so in many cases the last
35182character of the prefix can simply be typed twice.
35183
35184Calc is controlled by many variables, most of which can be reset
35185from within Calc. Some variables are less involved with actual
2c695727 35186calculation and can be set outside of Calc using Emacs's
4009494e
GM
35187customization facilities. These variables are listed below.
35188Typing @kbd{M-x customize-variable RET @var{variable-name} RET}
35189will bring up a buffer in which the variable's value can be redefined.
35190Typing @kbd{M-x customize-group RET calc RET} will bring up a buffer which
35191contains all of Calc's customizable variables. (These variables can
35192also be reset by putting the appropriate lines in your .emacs file;
35193@xref{Init File, ,Init File, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.)
35194
35195Some of the customizable variables are regular expressions. A regular
35196expression is basically a pattern that Calc can search for.
35197See @ref{Regexp Search,, Regular Expression Search, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}
35198to see how regular expressions work.
35199
35200@defvar calc-settings-file
35201The variable @code{calc-settings-file} holds the file name in
35202which commands like @kbd{m m} and @kbd{Z P} store ``permanent''
35203definitions.
35204If @code{calc-settings-file} is not your user init file (typically
35205@file{~/.emacs}) and if the variable @code{calc-loaded-settings-file} is
35206@code{nil}, then Calc will automatically load your settings file (if it
35207exists) the first time Calc is invoked.
35208
dcf7843e
JB
35209The default value for this variable is @code{"~/.emacs.d/calc.el"}
35210unless the file @file{~/.calc.el} exists, in which case the default
35211value will be @code{"~/.calc.el"}.
4009494e
GM
35212@end defvar
35213
35214@defvar calc-gnuplot-name
35215See @ref{Graphics}.@*
35216The variable @code{calc-gnuplot-name} should be the name of the
35217GNUPLOT program (a string). If you have GNUPLOT installed on your
35218system but Calc is unable to find it, you may need to set this
35219variable. You may also need to set some Lisp variables to show Calc how
35220to run GNUPLOT on your system, see @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices} .
35221The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-name} is @code{"gnuplot"}.
35222@end defvar
35223
35224@defvar calc-gnuplot-plot-command
35225@defvarx calc-gnuplot-print-command
35226See @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices}.@*
35227The variables @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
35228@code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} represent system commands to
35229display and print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
35230@code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
35231@samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
35232Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
35233to display or print the output.
35234
35235The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} is @code{nil},
35236and the default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} is
35237@code{"lp %s"}.
35238@end defvar
35239
35240@defvar calc-language-alist
35241See @ref{Basic Embedded Mode}.@*
35242The variable @code{calc-language-alist} controls the languages that
35243Calc will associate with major modes. When Calc embedded mode is
35244enabled, it will try to use the current major mode to
35245determine what language should be used. (This can be overridden using
35246Calc's mode changing commands, @xref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
35247The variable @code{calc-language-alist} consists of a list of pairs of
35248the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} . @var{LANGUAGE})}; for example,
35249@code{(latex-mode . latex)} is one such pair. If Calc embedded is
35250activated in a buffer whose major mode is @var{MAJOR-MODE}, it will set itself
35251to use the language @var{LANGUAGE}.
35252
35253The default value of @code{calc-language-alist} is
35254@example
35255 ((latex-mode . latex)
35256 (tex-mode . tex)
35257 (plain-tex-mode . tex)
35258 (context-mode . tex)
35259 (nroff-mode . eqn)
35260 (pascal-mode . pascal)
35261 (c-mode . c)
35262 (c++-mode . c)
35263 (fortran-mode . fortran)
35264 (f90-mode . fortran))
35265@end example
35266@end defvar
35267
35268@defvar calc-embedded-announce-formula
35269@defvarx calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist
35270See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35271The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} helps determine
35272what formulas @kbd{C-x * a} will activate in a buffer. It is a
35273regular expression, and when activating embedded formulas with
35274@kbd{C-x * a}, it will tell Calc that what follows is a formula to be
35275activated. (Calc also uses other patterns to find formulas, such as
35276@samp{=>} and @samp{:=}.)
35277
35278The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, which checks
35279for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of lines beginning with
35280@samp{%} and a space.
35281
35282The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist} is used to
35283set @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} to different regular
35284expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35285It consists of a list of pairs of the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} .
35286@var{REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35287@example
35288 ((c++-mode . "//Embed\n\\(// .*\n\\)*")
35289 (c-mode . "/\\*Embed\\*/\n\\(/\\* .*\\*/\n\\)*")
35290 (f90-mode . "!Embed\n\\(! .*\n\\)*")
35291 (fortran-mode . "C Embed\n\\(C .*\n\\)*")
35292 (html-helper-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35293 (html-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35294 (nroff-mode . "\\\\\"Embed\n\\(\\\\\" .*\n\\)*")
35295 (pascal-mode . "@{Embed@}\n\\(@{.*@}\n\\)*")
35296 (sgml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35297 (xml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35298 (texinfo-mode . "@@c Embed\n\\(@@c .*\n\\)*"))
35299@end example
35300Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35301should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
35302and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
35303@end defvar
35304
35305@defvar calc-embedded-open-formula
35306@defvarx calc-embedded-close-formula
35307@defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist
35308See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35309The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
8dc6104d 35310@code{calc-embedded-close-formula} control the region that Calc will
4009494e
GM
35311activate as a formula when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x * e}.
35312They are regular expressions;
35313Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
35314nearest text matching these regular expressions to be the ``formula
35315delimiters''.
35316
35317The simplest delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that
35318Embedded mode understands by default are:
35319@enumerate
35320@item
35321The @TeX{} and La@TeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
35322@samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
35323@item
35324Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
35325@item
35326Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
35327@item
35328Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
35329@item
35330Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
35331@end enumerate
35332
35333The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist} is used to
35334set @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
35335@code{calc-embedded-close-formula} to different regular
35336expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35337It consists of a list of lists of the form
35338@code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-FORMULA-REGEXP}
35339@var{CLOSE-FORMULA-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35340@code{nil}.
35341@end defvar
35342
4a65fb7a
JB
35343@defvar calc-embedded-word-regexp
35344@defvarx calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist
4009494e 35345See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
4a65fb7a
JB
35346The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} determines the expression
35347that Calc will activate when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x *
35348w}. It is a regular expressions.
35349
35350The default value of @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} is
35351@code{"[-+]?[0-9]+\\(\\.[0-9]+\\)?\\([eE][-+]?[0-9]+\\)?"}.
35352
35353The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist} is used to
35354set @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} to a different regular
35355expression depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
4009494e 35356It consists of a list of lists of the form
4a65fb7a 35357@code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{WORD-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
4009494e
GM
35358@code{nil}.
35359@end defvar
35360
35361@defvar calc-embedded-open-plain
35362@defvarx calc-embedded-close-plain
35363@defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist
35364See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35365The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
35366@code{calc-embedded-open-plain} are used to delimit ``plain''
35367formulas. Note that these are actual strings, not regular
35368expressions, because Calc must be able to write these string into a
35369buffer as well as to recognize them.
35370
35371The default string for @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} is
35372@code{"%%% "}, note the trailing space. The default string for
35373@code{calc-embedded-close-plain} is @code{" %%%\n"}, without
35374the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
35375that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
35376
35377The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist} is used to
35378set @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
35379@code{calc-embedded-close-plain} to different strings
35380depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35381It consists of a list of lists of the form
35382@code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-PLAIN-STRING}
35383@var{CLOSE-PLAIN-STRING})}, and its default value is
35384@example
35385 ((c++-mode "// %% " " %%\n")
35386 (c-mode "/* %% " " %% */\n")
35387 (f90-mode "! %% " " %%\n")
35388 (fortran-mode "C %% " " %%\n")
35389 (html-helper-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35390 (html-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35391 (nroff-mode "\\\" %% " " %%\n")
35392 (pascal-mode "@{%% " " %%@}\n")
35393 (sgml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35394 (xml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35395 (texinfo-mode "@@c %% " " %%\n"))
35396@end example
35397Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
35398should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35399and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
35400@end defvar
35401
35402@defvar calc-embedded-open-new-formula
35403@defvarx calc-embedded-close-new-formula
35404@defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist
35405See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35406The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
35407@code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} are strings which are
35408inserted before and after a new formula when you type @kbd{C-x * f}.
35409
35410The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} is
35411@code{"\n\n"}. If this string begins with a newline character and the
35412@kbd{C-x * f} is typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip
35413this first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in the
35414file. The default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} is
35415also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by @w{@kbd{C-x * f}}
35416if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if @kbd{C-x * f} is
35417typed on a blank line, both a leading opening newline and a trailing
35418closing newline are omitted.)
35419
35420The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist} is used to
35421set @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
35422@code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} to different strings
35423depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35424It consists of a list of lists of the form
35425@code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-NEW-FORMULA-STRING}
35426@var{CLOSE-NEW-FORMULA-STRING})}, and its default value is
35427@code{nil}.
35428@end defvar
35429
35430@defvar calc-embedded-open-mode
35431@defvarx calc-embedded-close-mode
35432@defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist
35433See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35434The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
35435@code{calc-embedded-close-mode} are strings which Calc will place before
35436and after any mode annotations that it inserts. Calc never scans for
35437these strings; Calc always looks for the annotation itself, so it is not
35438necessary to add them to user-written annotations.
35439
35440The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} is @code{"% "}
35441and the default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} is
35442@code{"\n"}.
35443If you change the value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode}, it is a good
35444idea still to end with a newline so that mode annotations will appear on
35445lines by themselves.
35446
35447The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist} is used to
35448set @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
35449@code{calc-embedded-close-mode} to different strings
35450expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35451It consists of a list of lists of the form
35452@code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-MODE-STRING}
35453@var{CLOSE-MODE-STRING})}, and its default value is
35454@example
35455 ((c++-mode "// " "\n")
35456 (c-mode "/* " " */\n")
35457 (f90-mode "! " "\n")
35458 (fortran-mode "C " "\n")
35459 (html-helper-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35460 (html-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35461 (nroff-mode "\\\" " "\n")
35462 (pascal-mode "@{ " " @}\n")
35463 (sgml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35464 (xml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35465 (texinfo-mode "@@c " "\n"))
35466@end example
35467Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}
35468should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35469and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}.
35470@end defvar
35471
2e78df6b
JB
35472@defvar calc-logunits-power-reference
35473@defvarx calc-logunits-field-reference
35474See @ref{Logarithmic Units}.@*
35475The variables @code{calc-logunits-power-reference} and
35476@code{calc-logunits-field-reference} are unit expressions (written as
35477strings) which Calc will use as reference quantities for logarithmic
35478units.
35479
35480The default value of @code{calc-logunits-power-reference} is @code{"mW"}
35481and the default value of @code{calc-logunits-field-reference} is
35482@code{"20 uPa"}.
35483@end defvar
35484
2c695727
JB
35485@defvar calc-highlight-selections-with-faces
35486@defvarx calc-selected-face
35487@defvarx calc-nonselected-face
443c2c03 35488See @ref{Displaying Selections}.@*
2c695727
JB
35489The variable @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces}
35490determines how selected sub-formulas are distinguished.
35491If @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is nil, then
35492a selected sub-formula is distinguished either by changing every
35493character not part of the sub-formula with a dot or by changing every
35494character in the sub-formula with a @samp{#} sign.
35495If @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is t,
35496then a selected sub-formula is distinguished either by displaying the
35497non-selected portion of the formula with @code{calc-nonselected-face}
35498or by displaying the selected sub-formula with
443c2c03 35499@code{calc-nonselected-face}.
2c695727
JB
35500@end defvar
35501
4009494e
GM
35502@defvar calc-multiplication-has-precedence
35503The variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} determines
45b778a6
JB
35504whether multiplication has precedence over division in algebraic
35505formulas in normal language modes. If
35506@code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is non-@code{nil}, then
35507multiplication has precedence (and, for certain obscure reasons, is
35508right associative), and so for example @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted
35509as @samp{a/(b*c)}. If @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is
35510@code{nil}, then multiplication has the same precedence as division
35511(and, like division, is left associative), and so for example
4009494e
GM
35512@samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted as @samp{(a/b)*c}. The default value
35513of @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is @code{t}.
35514@end defvar
35515
ec06459c
JB
35516@defvar calc-undo-length
35517The variable @code{calc-undo-length} determines the number of undo
35518steps that Calc will keep track of when @code{calc-quit} is called.
35519If @code{calc-undo-length} is a non-negative integer, then this is the
35520number of undo steps that will be preserved; if
35521@code{calc-undo-length} has any other value, then all undo steps will
35522be preserved. The default value of @code{calc-undo-length} is @expr{100}.
35523@end defvar
35524
4009494e
GM
35525@node Reporting Bugs, Summary, Customizing Calc, Top
35526@appendix Reporting Bugs
35527
35528@noindent
35529If you find a bug in Calc, send e-mail to Jay Belanger,
35530
35531@example
35532jay.p.belanger@@gmail.com
35533@end example
35534
35535@noindent
35536There is an automatic command @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug} which helps
35537you to report bugs. This command prompts you for a brief subject
35538line, then leaves you in a mail editing buffer. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to
35539send your mail. Make sure your subject line indicates that you are
35540reporting a Calc bug; this command sends mail to the maintainer's
35541regular mailbox.
35542
35543If you have suggestions for additional features for Calc, please send
35544them. Some have dared to suggest that Calc is already top-heavy with
35545features; this obviously cannot be the case, so if you have ideas, send
35546them right in.
35547
35548At the front of the source file, @file{calc.el}, is a list of ideas for
35549future work. If any enthusiastic souls wish to take it upon themselves
35550to work on these, please send a message (using @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug})
35551so any efforts can be coordinated.
35552
35553The latest version of Calc is available from Savannah, in the Emacs
b9f978f0 35554repository. See @uref{http://savannah.gnu.org/projects/emacs}.
4009494e
GM
35555
35556@c [summary]
35557@node Summary, Key Index, Reporting Bugs, Top
35558@appendix Calc Summary
35559
35560@noindent
5a83c46e 35561This section includes a complete list of Calc keystroke commands.
4009494e
GM
35562Each line lists the stack entries used by the command (top-of-stack
35563last), the keystrokes themselves, the prompts asked by the command,
35564and the result of the command (also with top-of-stack last).
35565The result is expressed using the equivalent algebraic function.
35566Commands which put no results on the stack show the full @kbd{M-x}
35567command name in that position. Numbers preceding the result or
35568command name refer to notes at the end.
35569
35570Algebraic functions and @kbd{M-x} commands that don't have corresponding
35571keystrokes are not listed in this summary.
35572@xref{Command Index}. @xref{Function Index}.
35573
35574@iftex
35575@begingroup
35576@tex
35577\vskip-2\baselineskip \null
35578\gdef\sumrow#1{\sumrowx#1\relax}%
35579\gdef\sumrowx#1\:#2\:#3\:#4\:#5\:#6\relax{%
35580\leavevmode%
35581{\smallfonts
35582\hbox to5em{\sl\hss#1}%
35583\hbox to5em{\tt#2\hss}%
35584\hbox to4em{\sl#3\hss}%
35585\hbox to5em{\rm\hss#4}%
35586\thinspace%
35587{\tt#5}%
35588{\sl#6}%
35589}}%
35590\gdef\sumlpar{{\rm(}}%
35591\gdef\sumrpar{{\rm)}}%
35592\gdef\sumcomma{{\rm,\thinspace}}%
35593\gdef\sumexcl{{\rm!}}%
35594\gdef\sumbreak{\vskip-2.5\baselineskip\goodbreak}%
35595\gdef\minus#1{{\tt-}}%
35596@end tex
35597@let@:=@sumsep
35598@let@r=@sumrow
35599@catcode`@(=@active @let(=@sumlpar
35600@catcode`@)=@active @let)=@sumrpar
35601@catcode`@,=@active @let,=@sumcomma
35602@catcode`@!=@active @let!=@sumexcl
35603@end iftex
35604@format
35605@iftex
35606@advance@baselineskip-2.5pt
35607@let@c@sumbreak
35608@end iftex
35609@r{ @: C-x * a @: @: 33 @:calc-embedded-activate@:}
35610@r{ @: C-x * b @: @: @:calc-big-or-small@:}
35611@r{ @: C-x * c @: @: @:calc@:}
35612@r{ @: C-x * d @: @: @:calc-embedded-duplicate@:}
35613@r{ @: C-x * e @: @: 34 @:calc-embedded@:}
35614@r{ @: C-x * f @:formula @: @:calc-embedded-new-formula@:}
35615@r{ @: C-x * g @: @: 35 @:calc-grab-region@:}
35616@r{ @: C-x * i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
35617@r{ @: C-x * j @: @: @:calc-embedded-select@:}
35618@r{ @: C-x * k @: @: @:calc-keypad@:}
35619@r{ @: C-x * l @: @: @:calc-load-everything@:}
35620@r{ @: C-x * m @: @: @:read-kbd-macro@:}
35621@r{ @: C-x * n @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-next@:}
35622@r{ @: C-x * o @: @: @:calc-other-window@:}
35623@r{ @: C-x * p @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-previous@:}
35624@r{ @: C-x * q @:formula @: @:quick-calc@:}
35625@r{ @: C-x * r @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-rectangle@:}
35626@r{ @: C-x * s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
35627@r{ @: C-x * t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
35628@r{ @: C-x * u @: @: @:calc-embedded-update-formula@:}
35629@r{ @: C-x * w @: @: @:calc-embedded-word@:}
35630@r{ @: C-x * x @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35631@r{ @: C-x * y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35632@r{ @: C-x * z @: @: @:calc-user-invocation@:}
35633@r{ @: C-x * : @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-down@:}
35634@r{ @: C-x * _ @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-across@:}
35635@r{ @: C-x * ` @:editing @: 30 @:calc-embedded-edit@:}
35636@r{ @: C-x * 0 @:(zero) @: @:calc-reset@:}
35637
35638@c
35639@r{ @: 0-9 @:number @: @:@:number}
35640@r{ @: . @:number @: @:@:0.number}
35641@r{ @: _ @:number @: @:-@:number}
35642@r{ @: e @:number @: @:@:1e number}
35643@r{ @: # @:number @: @:@:current-radix@tfn{#}number}
35644@r{ @: P @:(in number) @: @:+/-@:}
35645@r{ @: M @:(in number) @: @:mod@:}
35646@r{ @: @@ ' " @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35647@r{ @: h m s @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35648
35649@c
35650@r{ @: ' @:formula @: 37,46 @:@:formula}
35651@r{ @: $ @:formula @: 37,46 @:$@:formula}
35652@r{ @: " @:string @: 37,46 @:@:string}
35653
35654@c
35655@r{ a b@: + @: @: 2 @:add@:(a,b) a+b}
35656@r{ a b@: - @: @: 2 @:sub@:(a,b) a@minus{}b}
35657@r{ a b@: * @: @: 2 @:mul@:(a,b) a b, a*b}
35658@r{ a b@: / @: @: 2 @:div@:(a,b) a/b}
35659@r{ a b@: ^ @: @: 2 @:pow@:(a,b) a^b}
35660@r{ a b@: I ^ @: @: 2 @:nroot@:(a,b) a^(1/b)}
35661@r{ a b@: % @: @: 2 @:mod@:(a,b) a%b}
35662@r{ a b@: \ @: @: 2 @:idiv@:(a,b) a\b}
35663@r{ a b@: : @: @: 2 @:fdiv@:(a,b)}
35664@r{ a b@: | @: @: 2 @:vconcat@:(a,b) a|b}
35665@r{ a b@: I | @: @: @:vconcat@:(b,a) b|a}
35666@r{ a b@: H | @: @: 2 @:append@:(a,b)}
35667@r{ a b@: I H | @: @: @:append@:(b,a)}
35668@r{ a@: & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(a) 1/a}
35669@r{ a@: ! @: @: 1 @:fact@:(a) a!}
35670@r{ a@: = @: @: 1 @:evalv@:(a)}
35671@r{ a@: M-% @: @: @:percent@:(a) a%}
35672
35673@c
8dc6104d
JB
35674@r{ ... a@: @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35675@r{ ... a@: @summarykey{SPC} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35676@r{... a b@: @summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b a}
35677@r{. a b c@: M-@summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b c a}
35678@r{... a b@: @summarykey{LFD} @: @: 1 @:@:... a b a}
35679@r{ ... a@: @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35680@r{... a b@: M-@summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:... b}
35681@r{ @: M-@summarykey{RET} @: @: 4 @:calc-last-args@:}
4009494e
GM
35682@r{ a@: ` @:editing @: 1,30 @:calc-edit@:}
35683
35684@c
35685@r{ ... a@: C-d @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35686@r{ @: C-k @: @: 27 @:calc-kill@:}
35687@r{ @: C-w @: @: 27 @:calc-kill-region@:}
35688@r{ @: C-y @: @: @:calc-yank@:}
35689@r{ @: C-_ @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35690@r{ @: M-k @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-as-kill@:}
35691@r{ @: M-w @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-region-as-kill@:}
35692
35693@c
35694@r{ @: [ @: @: @:@:[...}
35695@r{[.. a b@: ] @: @: @:@:[a,b]}
35696@r{ @: ( @: @: @:@:(...}
35697@r{(.. a b@: ) @: @: @:@:(a,b)}
35698@r{ @: , @: @: @:@:vector or rect complex}
35699@r{ @: ; @: @: @:@:matrix or polar complex}
35700@r{ @: .. @: @: @:@:interval}
35701
35702@c
35703@r{ @: ~ @: @: @:calc-num-prefix@:}
35704@r{ @: < @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-left@:}
35705@r{ @: > @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-right@:}
35706@r{ @: @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-down@:}
35707@r{ @: @} @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-up@:}
35708@r{ @: ? @: @: @:calc-help@:}
35709
35710@c
35711@r{ a@: n @: @: 1 @:neg@:(a) @minus{}a}
35712@r{ @: o @: @: 4 @:calc-realign@:}
35713@r{ @: p @:precision @: 31 @:calc-precision@:}
35714@r{ @: q @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35715@r{ @: w @: @: @:calc-why@:}
35716@r{ @: x @:command @: @:M-x calc-@:command}
35717@r{ a@: y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35718
35719@c
35720@r{ a@: A @: @: 1 @:abs@:(a)}
35721@r{ a b@: B @: @: 2 @:log@:(a,b)}
35722@r{ a b@: I B @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
35723@r{ a@: C @: @: 1 @:cos@:(a)}
35724@r{ a@: I C @: @: 1 @:arccos@:(a)}
35725@r{ a@: H C @: @: 1 @:cosh@:(a)}
35726@r{ a@: I H C @: @: 1 @:arccosh@:(a)}
35727@r{ @: D @: @: 4 @:calc-redo@:}
35728@r{ a@: E @: @: 1 @:exp@:(a)}
35729@r{ a@: H E @: @: 1 @:exp10@:(a) 10.^a}
35730@r{ a@: F @: @: 1,11 @:floor@:(a,d)}
35731@r{ a@: I F @: @: 1,11 @:ceil@:(a,d)}
35732@r{ a@: H F @: @: 1,11 @:ffloor@:(a,d)}
35733@r{ a@: I H F @: @: 1,11 @:fceil@:(a,d)}
35734@r{ a@: G @: @: 1 @:arg@:(a)}
35735@r{ @: H @:command @: 32 @:@:Hyperbolic}
35736@r{ @: I @:command @: 32 @:@:Inverse}
35737@r{ a@: J @: @: 1 @:conj@:(a)}
35738@r{ @: K @:command @: 32 @:@:Keep-args}
35739@r{ a@: L @: @: 1 @:ln@:(a)}
35740@r{ a@: H L @: @: 1 @:log10@:(a)}
35741@r{ @: M @: @: @:calc-more-recursion-depth@:}
35742@r{ @: I M @: @: @:calc-less-recursion-depth@:}
35743@r{ a@: N @: @: 5 @:evalvn@:(a)}
f8b91752 35744@r{ @: O @:command @: 32 @:@:Option}
4009494e
GM
35745@r{ @: P @: @: @:@:pi}
35746@r{ @: I P @: @: @:@:gamma}
35747@r{ @: H P @: @: @:@:e}
35748@r{ @: I H P @: @: @:@:phi}
35749@r{ a@: Q @: @: 1 @:sqrt@:(a)}
35750@r{ a@: I Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
35751@r{ a@: R @: @: 1,11 @:round@:(a,d)}
35752@r{ a@: I R @: @: 1,11 @:trunc@:(a,d)}
35753@r{ a@: H R @: @: 1,11 @:fround@:(a,d)}
35754@r{ a@: I H R @: @: 1,11 @:ftrunc@:(a,d)}
35755@r{ a@: S @: @: 1 @:sin@:(a)}
35756@r{ a@: I S @: @: 1 @:arcsin@:(a)}
35757@r{ a@: H S @: @: 1 @:sinh@:(a)}
35758@r{ a@: I H S @: @: 1 @:arcsinh@:(a)}
35759@r{ a@: T @: @: 1 @:tan@:(a)}
35760@r{ a@: I T @: @: 1 @:arctan@:(a)}
35761@r{ a@: H T @: @: 1 @:tanh@:(a)}
35762@r{ a@: I H T @: @: 1 @:arctanh@:(a)}
35763@r{ @: U @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35764@r{ @: X @: @: 4 @:calc-call-last-kbd-macro@:}
35765
35766@c
35767@r{ a b@: a = @: @: 2 @:eq@:(a,b) a=b}
35768@r{ a b@: a # @: @: 2 @:neq@:(a,b) a!=b}
35769@r{ a b@: a < @: @: 2 @:lt@:(a,b) a<b}
35770@r{ a b@: a > @: @: 2 @:gt@:(a,b) a>b}
35771@r{ a b@: a [ @: @: 2 @:leq@:(a,b) a<=b}
35772@r{ a b@: a ] @: @: 2 @:geq@:(a,b) a>=b}
35773@r{ a b@: a @{ @: @: 2 @:in@:(a,b)}
35774@r{ a b@: a & @: @: 2,45 @:land@:(a,b) a&&b}
35775@r{ a b@: a | @: @: 2,45 @:lor@:(a,b) a||b}
35776@r{ a@: a ! @: @: 1,45 @:lnot@:(a) !a}
35777@r{ a b c@: a : @: @: 45 @:if@:(a,b,c) a?b:c}
35778@r{ a@: a . @: @: 1 @:rmeq@:(a)}
35779@r{ a@: a " @: @: 7,8 @:calc-expand-formula@:}
35780
35781@c
35782@r{ a@: a + @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:sum@:(a,i,l,h)}
35783@r{ a@: a - @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:asum@:(a,i,l,h)}
35784@r{ a@: a * @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:prod@:(a,i,l,h)}
35785@r{ a b@: a _ @: @: 2 @:subscr@:(a,b) a_b}
35786
35787@c
35788@r{ a b@: a \ @: @: 2 @:pdiv@:(a,b)}
35789@r{ a b@: a % @: @: 2 @:prem@:(a,b)}
35790@r{ a b@: a / @: @: 2 @:pdivrem@:(a,b) [q,r]}
35791@r{ a b@: H a / @: @: 2 @:pdivide@:(a,b) q+r/b}
35792
35793@c
35794@r{ a@: a a @: @: 1 @:apart@:(a)}
35795@r{ a@: a b @:old, new @: 38 @:subst@:(a,old,new)}
35796@r{ a@: a c @:v @: 38 @:collect@:(a,v)}
35797@r{ a@: a d @:v @: 4,38 @:deriv@:(a,v)}
35798@r{ a@: H a d @:v @: 4,38 @:tderiv@:(a,v)}
35799@r{ a@: a e @: @: @:esimplify@:(a)}
35800@r{ a@: a f @: @: 1 @:factor@:(a)}
35801@r{ a@: H a f @: @: 1 @:factors@:(a)}
35802@r{ a b@: a g @: @: 2 @:pgcd@:(a,b)}
35803@r{ a@: a i @:v @: 38 @:integ@:(a,v)}
35804@r{ a@: a m @:pats @: 38 @:match@:(a,pats)}
35805@r{ a@: I a m @:pats @: 38 @:matchnot@:(a,pats)}
35806@r{ data x@: a p @: @: 28 @:polint@:(data,x)}
35807@r{ data x@: H a p @: @: 28 @:ratint@:(data,x)}
35808@r{ a@: a n @: @: 1 @:nrat@:(a)}
35809@r{ a@: a r @:rules @:4,8,38 @:rewrite@:(a,rules,n)}
35810@r{ a@: a s @: @: @:simplify@:(a)}
35811@r{ a@: a t @:v, n @: 31,39 @:taylor@:(a,v,n)}
35812@r{ a@: a v @: @: 7,8 @:calc-alg-evaluate@:}
35813@r{ a@: a x @: @: 4,8 @:expand@:(a)}
35814
35815@c
35816@r{ data@: a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:fit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35817@r{ data@: I a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:xfit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35818@r{ data@: H a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:efit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35819@r{ a@: a I @:v, l, h @: 38 @:ninteg@:(a,v,l,h)}
35820@r{ a b@: a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeq@:(op,a,b)}
35821@r{ a b@: I a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqr@:(op,a,b)}
35822@r{ a b@: H a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqp@:(op,a,b)}
35823@r{ a g@: a N @:v @: 38 @:minimize@:(a,v,g)}
35824@r{ a g@: H a N @:v @: 38 @:wminimize@:(a,v,g)}
35825@r{ a@: a P @:v @: 38 @:roots@:(a,v)}
35826@r{ a g@: a R @:v @: 38 @:root@:(a,v,g)}
35827@r{ a g@: H a R @:v @: 38 @:wroot@:(a,v,g)}
35828@r{ a@: a S @:v @: 38 @:solve@:(a,v)}
35829@r{ a@: I a S @:v @: 38 @:finv@:(a,v)}
35830@r{ a@: H a S @:v @: 38 @:fsolve@:(a,v)}
35831@r{ a@: I H a S @:v @: 38 @:ffinv@:(a,v)}
35832@r{ a@: a T @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:table@:(a,i,l,h)}
35833@r{ a g@: a X @:v @: 38 @:maximize@:(a,v,g)}
35834@r{ a g@: H a X @:v @: 38 @:wmaximize@:(a,v,g)}
35835
35836@c
35837@r{ a b@: b a @: @: 9 @:and@:(a,b,w)}
35838@r{ a@: b c @: @: 9 @:clip@:(a,w)}
35839@r{ a b@: b d @: @: 9 @:diff@:(a,b,w)}
35840@r{ a@: b l @: @: 10 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
35841@r{ a n@: H b l @: @: 9 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
35842@r{ a@: b n @: @: 9 @:not@:(a,w)}
35843@r{ a b@: b o @: @: 9 @:or@:(a,b,w)}
35844@r{ v@: b p @: @: 1 @:vpack@:(v)}
35845@r{ a@: b r @: @: 10 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
35846@r{ a n@: H b r @: @: 9 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
35847@r{ a@: b t @: @: 10 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
35848@r{ a n@: H b t @: @: 9 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
35849@r{ a@: b u @: @: 1 @:vunpack@:(a)}
35850@r{ @: b w @:w @: 9,50 @:calc-word-size@:}
35851@r{ a b@: b x @: @: 9 @:xor@:(a,b,w)}
35852
35853@c
35854@r{c s l p@: b D @: @: @:ddb@:(c,s,l,p)}
35855@r{ r n p@: b F @: @: @:fv@:(r,n,p)}
35856@r{ r n p@: I b F @: @: @:fvb@:(r,n,p)}
35857@r{ r n p@: H b F @: @: @:fvl@:(r,n,p)}
35858@r{ v@: b I @: @: 19 @:irr@:(v)}
35859@r{ v@: I b I @: @: 19 @:irrb@:(v)}
35860@r{ a@: b L @: @: 10 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
35861@r{ a n@: H b L @: @: 9 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
35862@r{ r n a@: b M @: @: @:pmt@:(r,n,a)}
35863@r{ r n a@: I b M @: @: @:pmtb@:(r,n,a)}
35864@r{ r n a@: H b M @: @: @:pmtl@:(r,n,a)}
35865@r{ r v@: b N @: @: 19 @:npv@:(r,v)}
35866@r{ r v@: I b N @: @: 19 @:npvb@:(r,v)}
35867@r{ r n p@: b P @: @: @:pv@:(r,n,p)}
35868@r{ r n p@: I b P @: @: @:pvb@:(r,n,p)}
35869@r{ r n p@: H b P @: @: @:pvl@:(r,n,p)}
35870@r{ a@: b R @: @: 10 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
35871@r{ a n@: H b R @: @: 9 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
35872@r{ c s l@: b S @: @: @:sln@:(c,s,l)}
35873@r{ n p a@: b T @: @: @:rate@:(n,p,a)}
35874@r{ n p a@: I b T @: @: @:rateb@:(n,p,a)}
35875@r{ n p a@: H b T @: @: @:ratel@:(n,p,a)}
35876@r{c s l p@: b Y @: @: @:syd@:(c,s,l,p)}
35877
35878@r{ r p a@: b # @: @: @:nper@:(r,p,a)}
35879@r{ r p a@: I b # @: @: @:nperb@:(r,p,a)}
35880@r{ r p a@: H b # @: @: @:nperl@:(r,p,a)}
35881@r{ a b@: b % @: @: @:relch@:(a,b)}
35882
35883@c
35884@r{ a@: c c @: @: 5 @:pclean@:(a,p)}
35885@r{ a@: c 0-9 @: @: @:pclean@:(a,p)}
35886@r{ a@: H c c @: @: 5 @:clean@:(a,p)}
35887@r{ a@: H c 0-9 @: @: @:clean@:(a,p)}
35888@r{ a@: c d @: @: 1 @:deg@:(a)}
35889@r{ a@: c f @: @: 1 @:pfloat@:(a)}
35890@r{ a@: H c f @: @: 1 @:float@:(a)}
35891@r{ a@: c h @: @: 1 @:hms@:(a)}
35892@r{ a@: c p @: @: @:polar@:(a)}
35893@r{ a@: I c p @: @: @:rect@:(a)}
35894@r{ a@: c r @: @: 1 @:rad@:(a)}
35895
35896@c
35897@r{ a@: c F @: @: 5 @:pfrac@:(a,p)}
35898@r{ a@: H c F @: @: 5 @:frac@:(a,p)}
35899
35900@c
35901@r{ a@: c % @: @: @:percent@:(a*100)}
35902
35903@c
35904@r{ @: d . @:char @: 50 @:calc-point-char@:}
35905@r{ @: d , @:char @: 50 @:calc-group-char@:}
35906@r{ @: d < @: @: 13,50 @:calc-left-justify@:}
35907@r{ @: d = @: @: 13,50 @:calc-center-justify@:}
35908@r{ @: d > @: @: 13,50 @:calc-right-justify@:}
35909@r{ @: d @{ @:label @: 50 @:calc-left-label@:}
35910@r{ @: d @} @:label @: 50 @:calc-right-label@:}
35911@r{ @: d [ @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-up@:}
35912@r{ @: d ] @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-down@:}
35913@r{ @: d " @: @: 12,50 @:calc-display-strings@:}
8dc6104d
JB
35914@r{ @: d @summarykey{SPC} @: @: @:calc-refresh@:}
35915@r{ @: d @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:calc-refresh-top@:}
4009494e
GM
35916
35917@c
35918@r{ @: d 0 @: @: 50 @:calc-decimal-radix@:}
35919@r{ @: d 2 @: @: 50 @:calc-binary-radix@:}
35920@r{ @: d 6 @: @: 50 @:calc-hex-radix@:}
35921@r{ @: d 8 @: @: 50 @:calc-octal-radix@:}
35922
35923@c
35924@r{ @: d b @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-line-breaking@:}
35925@r{ @: d c @: @: 50 @:calc-complex-notation@:}
35926@r{ @: d d @:format @: 50 @:calc-date-notation@:}
35927@r{ @: d e @: @: 5,50 @:calc-eng-notation@:}
35928@r{ @: d f @:num @: 31,50 @:calc-fix-notation@:}
35929@r{ @: d g @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-group-digits@:}
35930@r{ @: d h @:format @: 50 @:calc-hms-notation@:}
35931@r{ @: d i @: @: 50 @:calc-i-notation@:}
35932@r{ @: d j @: @: 50 @:calc-j-notation@:}
35933@r{ @: d l @: @: 12,50 @:calc-line-numbering@:}
35934@r{ @: d n @: @: 5,50 @:calc-normal-notation@:}
35935@r{ @: d o @:format @: 50 @:calc-over-notation@:}
35936@r{ @: d p @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-plain@:}
35937@r{ @: d r @:radix @: 31,50 @:calc-radix@:}
35938@r{ @: d s @: @: 5,50 @:calc-sci-notation@:}
35939@r{ @: d t @: @: 27 @:calc-truncate-stack@:}
35940@r{ @: d w @: @: 12,13 @:calc-auto-why@:}
35941@r{ @: d z @: @: 12,50 @:calc-leading-zeros@:}
35942
35943@c
35944@r{ @: d B @: @: 50 @:calc-big-language@:}
35945@r{ @: d C @: @: 50 @:calc-c-language@:}
35946@r{ @: d E @: @: 50 @:calc-eqn-language@:}
35947@r{ @: d F @: @: 50 @:calc-fortran-language@:}
35948@r{ @: d M @: @: 50 @:calc-mathematica-language@:}
35949@r{ @: d N @: @: 50 @:calc-normal-language@:}
35950@r{ @: d O @: @: 50 @:calc-flat-language@:}
35951@r{ @: d P @: @: 50 @:calc-pascal-language@:}
35952@r{ @: d T @: @: 50 @:calc-tex-language@:}
35953@r{ @: d L @: @: 50 @:calc-latex-language@:}
35954@r{ @: d U @: @: 50 @:calc-unformatted-language@:}
35955@r{ @: d W @: @: 50 @:calc-maple-language@:}
35956
35957@c
35958@r{ a@: f [ @: @: 4 @:decr@:(a,n)}
35959@r{ a@: f ] @: @: 4 @:incr@:(a,n)}
35960
35961@c
35962@r{ a b@: f b @: @: 2 @:beta@:(a,b)}
35963@r{ a@: f e @: @: 1 @:erf@:(a)}
35964@r{ a@: I f e @: @: 1 @:erfc@:(a)}
35965@r{ a@: f g @: @: 1 @:gamma@:(a)}
35966@r{ a b@: f h @: @: 2 @:hypot@:(a,b)}
35967@r{ a@: f i @: @: 1 @:im@:(a)}
35968@r{ n a@: f j @: @: 2 @:besJ@:(n,a)}
35969@r{ a b@: f n @: @: 2 @:min@:(a,b)}
35970@r{ a@: f r @: @: 1 @:re@:(a)}
35971@r{ a@: f s @: @: 1 @:sign@:(a)}
35972@r{ a b@: f x @: @: 2 @:max@:(a,b)}
35973@r{ n a@: f y @: @: 2 @:besY@:(n,a)}
35974
35975@c
35976@r{ a@: f A @: @: 1 @:abssqr@:(a)}
35977@r{ x a b@: f B @: @: @:betaI@:(x,a,b)}
35978@r{ x a b@: H f B @: @: @:betaB@:(x,a,b)}
35979@r{ a@: f E @: @: 1 @:expm1@:(a)}
35980@r{ a x@: f G @: @: 2 @:gammaP@:(a,x)}
35981@r{ a x@: I f G @: @: 2 @:gammaQ@:(a,x)}
35982@r{ a x@: H f G @: @: 2 @:gammag@:(a,x)}
35983@r{ a x@: I H f G @: @: 2 @:gammaG@:(a,x)}
35984@r{ a b@: f I @: @: 2 @:ilog@:(a,b)}
35985@r{ a b@: I f I @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
35986@r{ a@: f L @: @: 1 @:lnp1@:(a)}
35987@r{ a@: f M @: @: 1 @:mant@:(a)}
35988@r{ a@: f Q @: @: 1 @:isqrt@:(a)}
35989@r{ a@: I f Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
35990@r{ a n@: f S @: @: 2 @:scf@:(a,n)}
35991@r{ y x@: f T @: @: @:arctan2@:(y,x)}
35992@r{ a@: f X @: @: 1 @:xpon@:(a)}
35993
35994@c
35995@r{ x y@: g a @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add@:}
35996@r{ @: g b @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-border@:}
35997@r{ @: g c @: @: @:calc-graph-clear@:}
35998@r{ @: g d @: @: 41 @:calc-graph-delete@:}
35999@r{ x y@: g f @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast@:}
36000@r{ @: g g @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-grid@:}
36001@r{ @: g h @:title @: @:calc-graph-header@:}
36002@r{ @: g j @: @: 4 @:calc-graph-juggle@:}
36003@r{ @: g k @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-key@:}
36004@r{ @: g l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-x@:}
36005@r{ @: g n @:name @: @:calc-graph-name@:}
36006@r{ @: g p @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-plot@:}
36007@r{ @: g q @: @: @:calc-graph-quit@:}
36008@r{ @: g r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-x@:}
36009@r{ @: g s @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-line-style@:}
36010@r{ @: g t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-x@:}
36011@r{ @: g v @: @: @:calc-graph-view-commands@:}
36012@r{ @: g x @:display @: @:calc-graph-display@:}
36013@r{ @: g z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-x@:}
36014
36015@c
36016@r{ x y z@: g A @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add-3d@:}
36017@r{ @: g C @:command @: @:calc-graph-command@:}
36018@r{ @: g D @:device @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-device@:}
36019@r{ x y z@: g F @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast-3d@:}
36020@r{ @: g H @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-hide@:}
36021@r{ @: g K @: @: @:calc-graph-kill@:}
36022@r{ @: g L @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-y@:}
36023@r{ @: g N @:number @: 43,51 @:calc-graph-num-points@:}
36024@r{ @: g O @:filename @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-output@:}
36025@r{ @: g P @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-print@:}
36026@r{ @: g R @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-y@:}
36027@r{ @: g S @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-point-style@:}
36028@r{ @: g T @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-y@:}
36029@r{ @: g V @: @: @:calc-graph-view-trail@:}
36030@r{ @: g X @:format @: @:calc-graph-geometry@:}
36031@r{ @: g Z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-y@:}
36032
36033@c
36034@r{ @: g C-l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-z@:}
36035@r{ @: g C-r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-z@:}
36036@r{ @: g C-t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-z@:}
36037
36038@c
36039@r{ @: h b @: @: @:calc-describe-bindings@:}
36040@r{ @: h c @:key @: @:calc-describe-key-briefly@:}
36041@r{ @: h f @:function @: @:calc-describe-function@:}
36042@r{ @: h h @: @: @:calc-full-help@:}
36043@r{ @: h i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
36044@r{ @: h k @:key @: @:calc-describe-key@:}
36045@r{ @: h n @: @: @:calc-view-news@:}
36046@r{ @: h s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
36047@r{ @: h t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
36048@r{ @: h v @:var @: @:calc-describe-variable@:}
36049
36050@c
36051@r{ @: j 1-9 @: @: @:calc-select-part@:}
8dc6104d
JB
36052@r{ @: j @summarykey{RET} @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-selection@:}
36053@r{ @: j @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 27 @:calc-del-selection@:}
4009494e
GM
36054@r{ @: j ' @:formula @: 27 @:calc-enter-selection@:}
36055@r{ @: j ` @:editing @: 27,30 @:calc-edit-selection@:}
36056@r{ @: j " @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-expand-formula@:}
36057
36058@c
36059@r{ @: j + @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-add-both-sides@:}
36060@r{ @: j - @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-sub-both-sides@:}
36061@r{ @: j * @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-mul-both-sides@:}
36062@r{ @: j / @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-div-both-sides@:}
36063@r{ @: j & @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-invert@:}
36064
36065@c
36066@r{ @: j a @: @: 27 @:calc-select-additional@:}
36067@r{ @: j b @: @: 12 @:calc-break-selections@:}
36068@r{ @: j c @: @: @:calc-clear-selections@:}
36069@r{ @: j d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-selections@:}
36070@r{ @: j e @: @: 12 @:calc-enable-selections@:}
36071@r{ @: j l @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-less@:}
36072@r{ @: j m @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-more@:}
36073@r{ @: j n @: @: 4 @:calc-select-next@:}
36074@r{ @: j o @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once@:}
36075@r{ @: j p @: @: 4 @:calc-select-previous@:}
36076@r{ @: j r @:rules @:4,8,27 @:calc-rewrite-selection@:}
36077@r{ @: j s @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here@:}
36078@r{ @: j u @: @: 27 @:calc-unselect@:}
36079@r{ @: j v @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-evaluate@:}
36080
36081@c
36082@r{ @: j C @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-commute@:}
36083@r{ @: j D @: @: 4,27 @:calc-sel-distribute@:}
36084@r{ @: j E @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-jump-equals@:}
36085@r{ @: j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@:}
36086@r{ @: H j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@: (full)}
36087@r{ @: j L @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-left@:}
36088@r{ @: j M @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-merge@:}
36089@r{ @: j N @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-negate@:}
36090@r{ @: j O @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once-maybe@:}
36091@r{ @: j R @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-right@:}
36092@r{ @: j S @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here-maybe@:}
36093@r{ @: j U @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-unpack@:}
36094
36095@c
36096@r{ @: k a @: @: @:calc-random-again@:}
36097@r{ n@: k b @: @: 1 @:bern@:(n)}
36098@r{ n x@: H k b @: @: 2 @:bern@:(n,x)}
36099@r{ n m@: k c @: @: 2 @:choose@:(n,m)}
36100@r{ n m@: H k c @: @: 2 @:perm@:(n,m)}
36101@r{ n@: k d @: @: 1 @:dfact@:(n) n!!}
36102@r{ n@: k e @: @: 1 @:euler@:(n)}
36103@r{ n x@: H k e @: @: 2 @:euler@:(n,x)}
36104@r{ n@: k f @: @: 4 @:prfac@:(n)}
36105@r{ n m@: k g @: @: 2 @:gcd@:(n,m)}
36106@r{ m n@: k h @: @: 14 @:shuffle@:(n,m)}
36107@r{ n m@: k l @: @: 2 @:lcm@:(n,m)}
36108@r{ n@: k m @: @: 1 @:moebius@:(n)}
36109@r{ n@: k n @: @: 4 @:nextprime@:(n)}
36110@r{ n@: I k n @: @: 4 @:prevprime@:(n)}
36111@r{ n@: k p @: @: 4,28 @:calc-prime-test@:}
36112@r{ m@: k r @: @: 14 @:random@:(m)}
36113@r{ n m@: k s @: @: 2 @:stir1@:(n,m)}
36114@r{ n m@: H k s @: @: 2 @:stir2@:(n,m)}
36115@r{ n@: k t @: @: 1 @:totient@:(n)}
36116
36117@c
36118@r{ n p x@: k B @: @: @:utpb@:(x,n,p)}
36119@r{ n p x@: I k B @: @: @:ltpb@:(x,n,p)}
36120@r{ v x@: k C @: @: @:utpc@:(x,v)}
36121@r{ v x@: I k C @: @: @:ltpc@:(x,v)}
36122@r{ n m@: k E @: @: @:egcd@:(n,m)}
36123@r{v1 v2 x@: k F @: @: @:utpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
36124@r{v1 v2 x@: I k F @: @: @:ltpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
36125@r{ m s x@: k N @: @: @:utpn@:(x,m,s)}
36126@r{ m s x@: I k N @: @: @:ltpn@:(x,m,s)}
36127@r{ m x@: k P @: @: @:utpp@:(x,m)}
36128@r{ m x@: I k P @: @: @:ltpp@:(x,m)}
36129@r{ v x@: k T @: @: @:utpt@:(x,v)}
36130@r{ v x@: I k T @: @: @:ltpt@:(x,v)}
36131
2e78df6b
JB
36132@c
36133@r{ a b@: l + @: @: 2 @:lupoweradd@:(a,b)}
36134@r{ a b@: H l + @: @: 2 @:lufieldadd@:(a,b)}
36135@r{ a b@: l - @: @: 2 @:lupowersub@:(a,b)}
36136@r{ a b@: H l - @: @: 2 @:lufieldsub@:(a,b)}
36137@r{ a b@: l * @: @: 2 @:lupowermul@:(a,b)}
36138@r{ a b@: H l * @: @: 2 @:lufieldmul@:(a,b)}
36139@r{ a b@: l / @: @: 2 @:lupowerdiv@:(a,b)}
36140@r{ a b@: H l / @: @: 2 @:lufielddiv@:(a,b)}
36141@r{ a@: l d @: @: 1 @:dbpowerlevel@:(a)}
36142@r{ a b@: O l d @: @: 2 @:dbpowerlevel@:(a,b)}
36143@r{ a@: H l d @: @: 1 @:dbfieldlevel@:(a)}
36144@r{ a b@: O H l d @: @: 2 @:dbfieldlevel@:(a,b)}
36145@r{ a@: l n @: @: 1 @:nppowerlevel@:(a)}
36146@r{ a b@: O l n @: @: 2 @:nppowerlevel@:(a,b)}
36147@r{ a@: H l n @: @: 1 @:npfieldlevel@:(a)}
36148@r{ a b@: O H l n @: @: 2 @:npfieldlevel@:(a,b)}
36149@r{ a@: l q @: @: 1 @:powerquant@:(a)}
36150@r{ a b@: O l q @: @: 2 @:powerquant@:(a,b)}
36151@r{ a@: H l q @: @: 1 @:fieldquant@:(a)}
36152@r{ a b@: O H l q @: @: 2 @:fieldquant@:(a,b)}
36153
4009494e
GM
36154@c
36155@r{ @: m a @: @: 12,13 @:calc-algebraic-mode@:}
36156@r{ @: m d @: @: @:calc-degrees-mode@:}
36157@r{ @: m e @: @: @:calc-embedded-preserve-modes@:}
36158@r{ @: m f @: @: 12 @:calc-frac-mode@:}
36159@r{ @: m g @: @: 52 @:calc-get-modes@:}
36160@r{ @: m h @: @: @:calc-hms-mode@:}
36161@r{ @: m i @: @: 12,13 @:calc-infinite-mode@:}
36162@r{ @: m m @: @: @:calc-save-modes@:}
36163@r{ @: m p @: @: 12 @:calc-polar-mode@:}
36164@r{ @: m r @: @: @:calc-radians-mode@:}
36165@r{ @: m s @: @: 12 @:calc-symbolic-mode@:}
36166@r{ @: m t @: @: 12 @:calc-total-algebraic-mode@:}
36167@r{ @: m v @: @: 12,13 @:calc-matrix-mode@:}
36168@r{ @: m w @: @: 13 @:calc-working@:}
36169@r{ @: m x @: @: @:calc-always-load-extensions@:}
36170
36171@c
36172@r{ @: m A @: @: 12 @:calc-alg-simplify-mode@:}
36173@r{ @: m B @: @: 12 @:calc-bin-simplify-mode@:}
36174@r{ @: m C @: @: 12 @:calc-auto-recompute@:}
36175@r{ @: m D @: @: @:calc-default-simplify-mode@:}
36176@r{ @: m E @: @: 12 @:calc-ext-simplify-mode@:}
36177@r{ @: m F @:filename @: 13 @:calc-settings-file-name@:}
36178@r{ @: m N @: @: 12 @:calc-num-simplify-mode@:}
36179@r{ @: m O @: @: 12 @:calc-no-simplify-mode@:}
36180@r{ @: m R @: @: 12,13 @:calc-mode-record-mode@:}
36181@r{ @: m S @: @: 12 @:calc-shift-prefix@:}
36182@r{ @: m U @: @: 12 @:calc-units-simplify-mode@:}
36183
538c2573
JB
36184@c
36185@r{ @: r s @:register @: 27 @:calc-copy-to-register@:}
36186@r{ @: r i @:register @: @:calc-insert-register@:}
36187
4009494e
GM
36188@c
36189@r{ @: s c @:var1, var2 @: 29 @:calc-copy-variable@:}
36190@r{ @: s d @:var, decl @: @:calc-declare-variable@:}
36191@r{ @: s e @:var, editing @: 29,30 @:calc-edit-variable@:}
36192@r{ @: s i @:buffer @: @:calc-insert-variables@:}
36193@r{ @: s k @:const, var @: 29 @:calc-copy-special-constant@:}
36194@r{ a b@: s l @:var @: 29 @:@:a (letting var=b)}
36195@r{ a ...@: s m @:op, var @: 22,29 @:calc-store-map@:}
36196@r{ @: s n @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-neg@: (v/-1)}
36197@r{ @: s p @:var @: 29 @:calc-permanent-variable@:}
36198@r{ @: s r @:var @: 29 @:@:v (recalled value)}
36199@r{ @: r 0-9 @: @: @:calc-recall-quick@:}
36200@r{ a@: s s @:var @: 28,29 @:calc-store@:}
36201@r{ a@: s 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-quick@:}
36202@r{ a@: s t @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-into@:}
36203@r{ a@: t 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-into-quick@:}
36204@r{ @: s u @:var @: 29 @:calc-unstore@:}
36205@r{ a@: s x @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-exchange@:}
36206
36207@c
36208@r{ @: s A @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-AlgSimpRules@:}
36209@r{ @: s D @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Decls@:}
36210@r{ @: s E @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-EvalRules@:}
36211@r{ @: s F @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-FitRules@:}
36212@r{ @: s G @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-GenCount@:}
36213@r{ @: s H @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Holidays@:}
36214@r{ @: s I @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-IntegLimit@:}
36215@r{ @: s L @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-LineStyles@:}
36216@r{ @: s P @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PointStyles@:}
36217@r{ @: s R @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PlotRejects@:}
36218@r{ @: s T @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-TimeZone@:}
36219@r{ @: s U @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Units@:}
36220@r{ @: s X @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-ExtSimpRules@:}
36221
36222@c
36223@r{ a@: s + @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-plus@: (v+a)}
36224@r{ a@: s - @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-minus@: (v-a)}
36225@r{ a@: s * @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-times@: (v*a)}
36226@r{ a@: s / @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-div@: (v/a)}
36227@r{ a@: s ^ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-power@: (v^a)}
36228@r{ a@: s | @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-concat@: (v|a)}
36229@r{ @: s & @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-inv@: (v^-1)}
36230@r{ @: s [ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-decr@: (v-1)}
36231@r{ @: s ] @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-incr@: (v-(-1))}
36232@r{ a b@: s : @: @: 2 @:assign@:(a,b) a @tfn{:=} b}
36233@r{ a@: s = @: @: 1 @:evalto@:(a,b) a @tfn{=>}}
36234
36235@c
36236@r{ @: t [ @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-first@:}
36237@r{ @: t ] @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-last@:}
36238@r{ @: t < @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-left@:}
36239@r{ @: t > @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-right@:}
36240@r{ @: t . @: @: 12 @:calc-full-trail-vectors@:}
36241
36242@c
36243@r{ @: t b @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-backward@:}
36244@r{ @: t d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-trail-display@:}
36245@r{ @: t f @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-forward@:}
36246@r{ @: t h @: @: @:calc-trail-here@:}
36247@r{ @: t i @: @: @:calc-trail-in@:}
36248@r{ @: t k @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-kill@:}
36249@r{ @: t m @:string @: @:calc-trail-marker@:}
36250@r{ @: t n @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-next@:}
36251@r{ @: t o @: @: @:calc-trail-out@:}
36252@r{ @: t p @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-previous@:}
36253@r{ @: t r @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-backward@:}
36254@r{ @: t s @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-forward@:}
36255@r{ @: t y @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-yank@:}
36256
36257@c
36258@r{ d@: t C @:oz, nz @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
36259@r{d oz nz@: t C @:$ @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
36260@r{ d@: t D @: @: 15 @:date@:(d)}
36261@r{ d@: t I @: @: 4 @:incmonth@:(d,n)}
36262@r{ d@: t J @: @: 16 @:julian@:(d,z)}
36263@r{ d@: t M @: @: 17 @:newmonth@:(d,n)}
36264@r{ @: t N @: @: 16 @:now@:(z)}
36265@r{ d@: t P @:1 @: 31 @:year@:(d)}
36266@r{ d@: t P @:2 @: 31 @:month@:(d)}
36267@r{ d@: t P @:3 @: 31 @:day@:(d)}
36268@r{ d@: t P @:4 @: 31 @:hour@:(d)}
36269@r{ d@: t P @:5 @: 31 @:minute@:(d)}
36270@r{ d@: t P @:6 @: 31 @:second@:(d)}
36271@r{ d@: t P @:7 @: 31 @:weekday@:(d)}
36272@r{ d@: t P @:8 @: 31 @:yearday@:(d)}
36273@r{ d@: t P @:9 @: 31 @:time@:(d)}
36274@r{ d@: t U @: @: 16 @:unixtime@:(d,z)}
36275@r{ d@: t W @: @: 17 @:newweek@:(d,w)}
36276@r{ d@: t Y @: @: 17 @:newyear@:(d,n)}
36277
36278@c
36279@r{ a b@: t + @: @: 2 @:badd@:(a,b)}
36280@r{ a b@: t - @: @: 2 @:bsub@:(a,b)}
36281
36282@c
36283@r{ @: u a @: @: 12 @:calc-autorange-units@:}
36284@r{ a@: u b @: @: @:calc-base-units@:}
36285@r{ a@: u c @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-units@:}
36286@r{ defn@: u d @:unit, descr @: @:calc-define-unit@:}
36287@r{ @: u e @: @: @:calc-explain-units@:}
36288@r{ @: u g @:unit @: @:calc-get-unit-definition@:}
36289@r{ @: u p @: @: @:calc-permanent-units@:}
36290@r{ a@: u r @: @: @:calc-remove-units@:}
36291@r{ a@: u s @: @: @:usimplify@:(a)}
36292@r{ a@: u t @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-temperature@:}
36293@r{ @: u u @:unit @: @:calc-undefine-unit@:}
36294@r{ @: u v @: @: @:calc-enter-units-table@:}
36295@r{ a@: u x @: @: @:calc-extract-units@:}
36296@r{ a@: u 0-9 @: @: @:calc-quick-units@:}
36297
36298@c
36299@r{ v1 v2@: u C @: @: 20 @:vcov@:(v1,v2)}
36300@r{ v1 v2@: I u C @: @: 20 @:vpcov@:(v1,v2)}
36301@r{ v1 v2@: H u C @: @: 20 @:vcorr@:(v1,v2)}
36302@r{ v@: u G @: @: 19 @:vgmean@:(v)}
36303@r{ a b@: H u G @: @: 2 @:agmean@:(a,b)}
36304@r{ v@: u M @: @: 19 @:vmean@:(v)}
36305@r{ v@: I u M @: @: 19 @:vmeane@:(v)}
36306@r{ v@: H u M @: @: 19 @:vmedian@:(v)}
36307@r{ v@: I H u M @: @: 19 @:vhmean@:(v)}
36308@r{ v@: u N @: @: 19 @:vmin@:(v)}
36309@r{ v@: u S @: @: 19 @:vsdev@:(v)}
36310@r{ v@: I u S @: @: 19 @:vpsdev@:(v)}
36311@r{ v@: H u S @: @: 19 @:vvar@:(v)}
36312@r{ v@: I H u S @: @: 19 @:vpvar@:(v)}
36313@r{ @: u V @: @: @:calc-view-units-table@:}
36314@r{ v@: u X @: @: 19 @:vmax@:(v)}
36315
36316@c
36317@r{ v@: u + @: @: 19 @:vsum@:(v)}
36318@r{ v@: u * @: @: 19 @:vprod@:(v)}
36319@r{ v@: u # @: @: 19 @:vcount@:(v)}
36320
36321@c
36322@r{ @: V ( @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-parens@:}
36323@r{ @: V @{ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-braces@:}
36324@r{ @: V [ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-brackets@:}
36325@r{ @: V ] @:ROCP @: 50 @:calc-matrix-brackets@:}
36326@r{ @: V , @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-commas@:}
36327@r{ @: V < @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-left-justify@:}
36328@r{ @: V = @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-center-justify@:}
36329@r{ @: V > @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-right-justify@:}
36330@r{ @: V / @: @: 12,50 @:calc-break-vectors@:}
36331@r{ @: V . @: @: 12,50 @:calc-full-vectors@:}
36332
36333@c
36334@r{ s t@: V ^ @: @: 2 @:vint@:(s,t)}
36335@r{ s t@: V - @: @: 2 @:vdiff@:(s,t)}
36336@r{ s@: V ~ @: @: 1 @:vcompl@:(s)}
36337@r{ s@: V # @: @: 1 @:vcard@:(s)}
36338@r{ s@: V : @: @: 1 @:vspan@:(s)}
36339@r{ s@: V + @: @: 1 @:rdup@:(s)}
36340
36341@c
36342@r{ m@: V & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(m) 1/m}
36343
36344@c
36345@r{ v@: v a @:n @: @:arrange@:(v,n)}
36346@r{ a@: v b @:n @: @:cvec@:(a,n)}
36347@r{ v@: v c @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mcol@:(v,n)}
36348@r{ v@: v c @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrcol@:(v,-n)}
36349@r{ m@: v c @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
36350@r{ v@: v d @: @: 25 @:diag@:(v,n)}
36351@r{ v m@: v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m)}
36352@r{ v m f@: H v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m,f)}
36353@r{ v a@: v f @: @: 26 @:find@:(v,a,n)}
36354@r{ v@: v h @: @: 1 @:head@:(v)}
36355@r{ v@: I v h @: @: 1 @:tail@:(v)}
36356@r{ v@: H v h @: @: 1 @:rhead@:(v)}
36357@r{ v@: I H v h @: @: 1 @:rtail@:(v)}
36358@r{ @: v i @:n @: 31 @:idn@:(1,n)}
36359@r{ @: v i @:0 @: 31 @:idn@:(1)}
36360@r{ h t@: v k @: @: 2 @:cons@:(h,t)}
36361@r{ h t@: H v k @: @: 2 @:rcons@:(h,t)}
36362@r{ v@: v l @: @: 1 @:vlen@:(v)}
36363@r{ v@: H v l @: @: 1 @:mdims@:(v)}
36364@r{ v m@: v m @: @: 2 @:vmask@:(v,m)}
36365@r{ v@: v n @: @: 1 @:rnorm@:(v)}
36366@r{ a b c@: v p @: @: 24 @:calc-pack@:}
36367@r{ v@: v r @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mrow@:(v,n)}
36368@r{ v@: v r @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrrow@:(v,-n)}
36369@r{ m@: v r @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
36370@r{ v i j@: v s @: @: @:subvec@:(v,i,j)}
36371@r{ v i j@: I v s @: @: @:rsubvec@:(v,i,j)}
36372@r{ m@: v t @: @: 1 @:trn@:(m)}
36373@r{ v@: v u @: @: 24 @:calc-unpack@:}
36374@r{ v@: v v @: @: 1 @:rev@:(v)}
36375@r{ @: v x @:n @: 31 @:index@:(n)}
36376@r{ n s i@: C-u v x @: @: @:index@:(n,s,i)}
36377
36378@c
36379@r{ v@: V A @:op @: 22 @:apply@:(op,v)}
36380@r{ v1 v2@: V C @: @: 2 @:cross@:(v1,v2)}
36381@r{ m@: V D @: @: 1 @:det@:(m)}
36382@r{ s@: V E @: @: 1 @:venum@:(s)}
36383@r{ s@: V F @: @: 1 @:vfloor@:(s)}
36384@r{ v@: V G @: @: @:grade@:(v)}
36385@r{ v@: I V G @: @: @:rgrade@:(v)}
36386@r{ v@: V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,n)}
36387@r{ v w@: H V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,w,n)}
36388@r{ v1 v2@: V I @:mop aop @: 22 @:inner@:(mop,aop,v1,v2)}
36389@r{ m@: V J @: @: 1 @:ctrn@:(m)}
5a83c46e 36390@r{ m1 m2@: V K @: @: @:kron@:(m1,m2)}
4009494e
GM
36391@r{ m@: V L @: @: 1 @:lud@:(m)}
36392@r{ v@: V M @:op @: 22,23 @:map@:(op,v)}
36393@r{ v@: V N @: @: 1 @:cnorm@:(v)}
36394@r{ v1 v2@: V O @:op @: 22 @:outer@:(op,v1,v2)}
36395@r{ v@: V R @:op @: 22,23 @:reduce@:(op,v)}
36396@r{ v@: I V R @:op @: 22,23 @:rreduce@:(op,v)}
36397@r{ a n@: H V R @:op @: 22 @:nest@:(op,a,n)}
36398@r{ a@: I H V R @:op @: 22 @:fixp@:(op,a)}
36399@r{ v@: V S @: @: @:sort@:(v)}
36400@r{ v@: I V S @: @: @:rsort@:(v)}
36401@r{ m@: V T @: @: 1 @:tr@:(m)}
36402@r{ v@: V U @:op @: 22 @:accum@:(op,v)}
36403@r{ v@: I V U @:op @: 22 @:raccum@:(op,v)}
36404@r{ a n@: H V U @:op @: 22 @:anest@:(op,a,n)}
36405@r{ a@: I H V U @:op @: 22 @:afixp@:(op,a)}
36406@r{ s t@: V V @: @: 2 @:vunion@:(s,t)}
36407@r{ s t@: V X @: @: 2 @:vxor@:(s,t)}
36408
36409@c
36410@r{ @: Y @: @: @:@:user commands}
36411
36412@c
36413@r{ @: z @: @: @:@:user commands}
36414
36415@c
36416@r{ c@: Z [ @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-if@:}
36417@r{ c@: Z | @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-else-if@:}
36418@r{ @: Z : @: @: @:calc-kbd-else@:}
36419@r{ @: Z ] @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-if@:}
36420
36421@c
36422@r{ @: Z @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-kbd-loop@:}
36423@r{ c@: Z / @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-break@:}
36424@r{ @: Z @} @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-loop@:}
36425@r{ n@: Z < @: @: @:calc-kbd-repeat@:}
36426@r{ @: Z > @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-repeat@:}
36427@r{ n m@: Z ( @: @: @:calc-kbd-for@:}
36428@r{ s@: Z ) @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-for@:}
36429
36430@c
36431@r{ @: Z C-g @: @: @:@:cancel if/loop command}
36432
36433@c
36434@r{ @: Z ` @: @: @:calc-kbd-push@:}
36435@r{ @: Z ' @: @: @:calc-kbd-pop@:}
36436@r{ @: Z # @: @: @:calc-kbd-query@:}
36437
36438@c
36439@r{ comp@: Z C @:func, args @: 50 @:calc-user-define-composition@:}
36440@r{ @: Z D @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define@:}
36441@r{ @: Z E @:key, editing @: 30 @:calc-user-define-edit@:}
36442@r{ defn@: Z F @:k, c, f, a, n@: 28 @:calc-user-define-formula@:}
36443@r{ @: Z G @:key @: @:calc-get-user-defn@:}
36444@r{ @: Z I @: @: @:calc-user-define-invocation@:}
36445@r{ @: Z K @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define-kbd-macro@:}
36446@r{ @: Z P @:key @: @:calc-user-define-permanent@:}
36447@r{ @: Z S @: @: 30 @:calc-edit-user-syntax@:}
36448@r{ @: Z T @: @: 12 @:calc-timing@:}
36449@r{ @: Z U @:key @: @:calc-user-undefine@:}
36450
36451@end format
36452
36453@noindent
36454NOTES
36455
36456@enumerate
36457@c 1
36458@item
36459Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
36460Negative prefix arguments apply to the @expr{-n}th stack entry.
36461A prefix of zero applies to the entire stack. (For @key{LFD} and
36462@kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, the meaning of the sign is reversed.)
36463
36464@c 2
36465@item
36466Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
36467Negative prefix arguments apply to the top stack entry
36468and the next @expr{-n} stack entries.
36469
36470@c 3
36471@item
36472Positive prefix arguments rotate top @expr{n} stack entries by one.
36473Negative prefix arguments rotate the entire stack by @expr{-n}.
36474A prefix of zero reverses the entire stack.
36475
36476@c 4
36477@item
36478Prefix argument specifies a repeat count or distance.
36479
36480@c 5
36481@item
36482Positive prefix arguments specify a precision @expr{p}.
36483Negative prefix arguments reduce the current precision by @expr{-p}.
36484
36485@c 6
36486@item
36487A prefix argument is interpreted as an additional step-size parameter.
36488A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix means to prompt for the step size.
36489
36490@c 7
36491@item
36492A prefix argument specifies simplification level and depth.
364931=Default, 2=like @kbd{a s}, 3=like @kbd{a e}.
36494
36495@c 8
36496@item
36497A negative prefix operates only on the top level of the input formula.
36498
36499@c 9
36500@item
36501Positive prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, unsigned.
36502Negative prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, signed.
36503
36504@c 10
36505@item
36506Prefix arguments specify the shift amount @expr{n}. The @expr{w} argument
36507cannot be specified in the keyboard version of this command.
36508
36509@c 11
36510@item
36511From the keyboard, @expr{d} is omitted and defaults to zero.
36512
36513@c 12
36514@item
36515Mode is toggled; a positive prefix always sets the mode, and a negative
36516prefix always clears the mode.
36517
36518@c 13
36519@item
36520Some prefix argument values provide special variations of the mode.
36521
36522@c 14
36523@item
36524A prefix argument, if any, is used for @expr{m} instead of taking
36525@expr{m} from the stack. @expr{M} may take any of these values:
36526@iftex
36527{@advance@tableindent10pt
36528@end iftex
36529@table @asis
36530@item Integer
36531Random integer in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36532@item Float
36533Random floating-point number in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36534@item 0.0
36535Gaussian with mean 1 and standard deviation 0.
36536@item Error form
36537Gaussian with specified mean and standard deviation.
36538@item Interval
36539Random integer or floating-point number in that interval.
36540@item Vector
36541Random element from the vector.
36542@end table
36543@iftex
36544}
36545@end iftex
36546
36547@c 15
36548@item
36549A prefix argument from 1 to 6 specifies number of date components
36550to remove from the stack. @xref{Date Conversions}.
36551
36552@c 16
36553@item
36554A prefix argument specifies a time zone; @kbd{C-u} says to take the
36555time zone number or name from the top of the stack. @xref{Time Zones}.
36556
36557@c 17
36558@item
36559A prefix argument specifies a day number (0-6, 0-31, or 0-366).
36560
36561@c 18
36562@item
36563If the input has no units, you will be prompted for both the old and
36564the new units.
36565
36566@c 19
36567@item
36568With a prefix argument, collect that many stack entries to form the
36569input data set. Each entry may be a single value or a vector of values.
36570
36571@c 20
36572@item
36573With a prefix argument of 1, take a single
36574@texline @var{n}@math{\times2}
36575@infoline @mathit{@var{N}x2}
36576matrix from the stack instead of two separate data vectors.
36577
36578@c 21
36579@item
36580The row or column number @expr{n} may be given as a numeric prefix
36581argument instead. A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix says to take @expr{n}
36582from the top of the stack. If @expr{n} is a vector or interval,
36583a subvector/submatrix of the input is created.
36584
36585@c 22
36586@item
36587The @expr{op} prompt can be answered with the key sequence for the
36588desired function, or with @kbd{x} or @kbd{z} followed by a function name,
36589or with @kbd{$} to take a formula from the top of the stack, or with
36590@kbd{'} and a typed formula. In the last two cases, the formula may
36591be a nameless function like @samp{<#1+#2>} or @samp{<x, y : x+y>}, or it
36592may include @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, etc. (where @kbd{$} will correspond to the
36593last argument of the created function), or otherwise you will be
36594prompted for an argument list. The number of vectors popped from the
36595stack by @kbd{V M} depends on the number of arguments of the function.
36596
36597@c 23
36598@item
36599One of the mapping direction keys @kbd{_} (horizontal, i.e., map
36600by rows or reduce across), @kbd{:} (vertical, i.e., map by columns or
36601reduce down), or @kbd{=} (map or reduce by rows) may be used before
36602entering @expr{op}; these modify the function name by adding the letter
36603@code{r} for ``rows,'' @code{c} for ``columns,'' @code{a} for ``across,''
36604or @code{d} for ``down.''
36605
36606@c 24
36607@item
36608The prefix argument specifies a packing mode. A nonnegative mode
36609is the number of items (for @kbd{v p}) or the number of levels
36610(for @kbd{v u}). A negative mode is as described below. With no
36611prefix argument, the mode is taken from the top of the stack and
36612may be an integer or a vector of integers.
36613@iftex
36614{@advance@tableindent-20pt
36615@end iftex
36616@table @cite
36617@item -1
36618(@var{2}) Rectangular complex number.
36619@item -2
36620(@var{2}) Polar complex number.
36621@item -3
36622(@var{3}) HMS form.
36623@item -4
36624(@var{2}) Error form.
36625@item -5
36626(@var{2}) Modulo form.
36627@item -6
36628(@var{2}) Closed interval.
36629@item -7
36630(@var{2}) Closed .. open interval.
36631@item -8
36632(@var{2}) Open .. closed interval.
36633@item -9
36634(@var{2}) Open interval.
36635@item -10
36636(@var{2}) Fraction.
36637@item -11
36638(@var{2}) Float with integer mantissa.
36639@item -12
36640(@var{2}) Float with mantissa in @expr{[1 .. 10)}.
36641@item -13
36642(@var{1}) Date form (using date numbers).
36643@item -14
36644(@var{3}) Date form (using year, month, day).
36645@item -15
36646(@var{6}) Date form (using year, month, day, hour, minute, second).
36647@end table
36648@iftex
36649}
36650@end iftex
36651
36652@c 25
36653@item
36654A prefix argument specifies the size @expr{n} of the matrix. With no
36655prefix argument, @expr{n} is omitted and the size is inferred from
36656the input vector.
36657
36658@c 26
36659@item
36660The prefix argument specifies the starting position @expr{n} (default 1).
36661
36662@c 27
36663@item
36664Cursor position within stack buffer affects this command.
36665
36666@c 28
36667@item
36668Arguments are not actually removed from the stack by this command.
36669
36670@c 29
36671@item
36672Variable name may be a single digit or a full name.
36673
36674@c 30
36675@item
36676Editing occurs in a separate buffer. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} (or
36677@key{LFD}, or in some cases @key{RET}) to finish the edit, or kill the
36678buffer with @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @key{LFD} key prevents evaluation
36679of the result of the edit.
36680
36681@c 31
36682@item
36683The number prompted for can also be provided as a prefix argument.
36684
36685@c 32
36686@item
36687Press this key a second time to cancel the prefix.
36688
36689@c 33
36690@item
36691With a negative prefix, deactivate all formulas. With a positive
36692prefix, deactivate and then reactivate from scratch.
36693
36694@c 34
36695@item
36696Default is to scan for nearest formula delimiter symbols. With a
36697prefix of zero, formula is delimited by mark and point. With a
36698non-zero prefix, formula is delimited by scanning forward or
36699backward by that many lines.
36700
36701@c 35
36702@item
36703Parse the region between point and mark as a vector. A nonzero prefix
36704parses @var{n} lines before or after point as a vector. A zero prefix
36705parses the current line as a vector. A @kbd{C-u} prefix parses the
36706region between point and mark as a single formula.
36707
36708@c 36
36709@item
36710Parse the rectangle defined by point and mark as a matrix. A positive
36711prefix @var{n} divides the rectangle into columns of width @var{n}.
36712A zero or @kbd{C-u} prefix parses each line as one formula. A negative
36713prefix suppresses special treatment of bracketed portions of a line.
36714
36715@c 37
36716@item
36717A numeric prefix causes the current language mode to be ignored.
36718
36719@c 38
36720@item
36721Responding to a prompt with a blank line answers that and all
36722later prompts by popping additional stack entries.
36723
36724@c 39
36725@item
36726Answer for @expr{v} may also be of the form @expr{v = v_0} or
36727@expr{v - v_0}.
36728
36729@c 40
36730@item
36731With a positive prefix argument, stack contains many @expr{y}'s and one
36732common @expr{x}. With a zero prefix, stack contains a vector of
36733@expr{y}s and a common @expr{x}. With a negative prefix, stack
36734contains many @expr{[x,y]} vectors. (For 3D plots, substitute
36735@expr{z} for @expr{y} and @expr{x,y} for @expr{x}.)
36736
36737@c 41
36738@item
36739With any prefix argument, all curves in the graph are deleted.
36740
36741@c 42
36742@item
36743With a positive prefix, refines an existing plot with more data points.
36744With a negative prefix, forces recomputation of the plot data.
36745
36746@c 43
36747@item
36748With any prefix argument, set the default value instead of the
36749value for this graph.
36750
36751@c 44
36752@item
36753With a negative prefix argument, set the value for the printer.
36754
36755@c 45
36756@item
36757Condition is considered ``true'' if it is a nonzero real or complex
36758number, or a formula whose value is known to be nonzero; it is ``false''
36759otherwise.
36760
36761@c 46
36762@item
36763Several formulas separated by commas are pushed as multiple stack
36764entries. Trailing @kbd{)}, @kbd{]}, @kbd{@}}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{"}
36765delimiters may be omitted. The notation @kbd{$$$} refers to the value
36766in stack level three, and causes the formula to replace the top three
36767stack levels. The notation @kbd{$3} refers to stack level three without
36768causing that value to be removed from the stack. Use @key{LFD} in place
36769of @key{RET} to prevent evaluation; use @kbd{M-=} in place of @key{RET}
36770to evaluate variables.
36771
36772@c 47
36773@item
36774The variable is replaced by the formula shown on the right. The
36775Inverse flag reverses the order of the operands, e.g., @kbd{I s - x}
36776assigns
36777@texline @math{x \coloneq a-x}.
36778@infoline @expr{x := a-x}.
36779
36780@c 48
36781@item
36782Press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see how to choose a model. Answer the
36783variables prompt with @expr{iv} or @expr{iv;pv} to specify
36784independent and parameter variables. A positive prefix argument
36785takes @mathit{@var{n}+1} vectors from the stack; a zero prefix takes a matrix
36786and a vector from the stack.
36787
36788@c 49
36789@item
36790With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, replace the current region of the
36791destination buffer with the yanked text instead of inserting.
36792
36793@c 50
36794@item
36795All stack entries are reformatted; the @kbd{H} prefix inhibits this.
36796The @kbd{I} prefix sets the mode temporarily, redraws the top stack
36797entry, then restores the original setting of the mode.
36798
36799@c 51
36800@item
36801A negative prefix sets the default 3D resolution instead of the
36802default 2D resolution.
36803
36804@c 52
36805@item
36806This grabs a vector of the form [@var{prec}, @var{wsize}, @var{ssize},
36807@var{radix}, @var{flfmt}, @var{ang}, @var{frac}, @var{symb}, @var{polar},
36808@var{matrix}, @var{simp}, @var{inf}]. A prefix argument from 1 to 12
36809grabs the @var{n}th mode value only.
36810@end enumerate
36811
36812@iftex
36813(Space is provided below for you to keep your own written notes.)
36814@page
36815@endgroup
36816@end iftex
36817
36818
36819@c [end-summary]
36820
36821@node Key Index, Command Index, Summary, Top
36822@unnumbered Index of Key Sequences
36823
36824@printindex ky
36825
36826@node Command Index, Function Index, Key Index, Top
36827@unnumbered Index of Calculator Commands
36828
36829Since all Calculator commands begin with the prefix @samp{calc-}, the
36830@kbd{x} key has been provided as a variant of @kbd{M-x} which automatically
36831types @samp{calc-} for you. Thus, @kbd{x last-args} is short for
36832@kbd{M-x calc-last-args}.
36833
36834@printindex pg
36835
36836@node Function Index, Concept Index, Command Index, Top
36837@unnumbered Index of Algebraic Functions
36838
36839This is a list of built-in functions and operators usable in algebraic
36840expressions. Their full Lisp names are derived by adding the prefix
36841@samp{calcFunc-}, as in @code{calcFunc-sqrt}.
36842@iftex
36843All functions except those noted with ``*'' have corresponding
36844Calc keystrokes and can also be found in the Calc Summary.
36845@end iftex
36846
36847@printindex tp
36848
36849@node Concept Index, Variable Index, Function Index, Top
36850@unnumbered Concept Index
36851
36852@printindex cp
36853
36854@node Variable Index, Lisp Function Index, Concept Index, Top
36855@unnumbered Index of Variables
36856
36857The variables in this list that do not contain dashes are accessible
36858as Calc variables. Add a @samp{var-} prefix to get the name of the
36859corresponding Lisp variable.
36860
36861The remaining variables are Lisp variables suitable for @code{setq}ing
36862in your Calc init file or @file{.emacs} file.
36863
36864@printindex vr
36865
36866@node Lisp Function Index, , Variable Index, Top
36867@unnumbered Index of Lisp Math Functions
36868
36869The following functions are meant to be used with @code{defmath}, not
36870@code{defun} definitions. For names that do not start with @samp{calc-},
36871the corresponding full Lisp name is derived by adding a prefix of
36872@samp{math-}.
36873
36874@printindex fn
36875
36876@bye